IMAGE EVALUATION 
 TEST TARGET (MT-3) 
 
 
 / 
 
 A 
 
 
 
 
 
 Cl 
 
 r/x 
 
 V] 
 
 /a 
 
 K^V 
 
 % 
 
 ssi. ^, 
 
 "*• 
 
 '/ 
 
 /A 
 
 Photograpliic 
 
 Sciences 
 
 Corporation 
 
 23 WIST MAIN STRUT 
 
 WMSTM.N.Y. USIO 
 
 (716) •7a-4S03 
 

 CiHM/ICMH 
 
 Microfiche 
 
 Series. 
 
 CIHIVI/ICMH 
 Collection de 
 microfiches. 
 
 Canadian Inatituta for Hiatorical Microraproductiona 
 
 Inatitut Canadian da microraproductions hiatoriquaa 
 
 1980 
 
Technical and Bibliographic Notes/Notes techniques et bibliographiques 
 
 The 
 tol 
 
 The Institute has attempted to obtain the best 
 original copy available for filming. Features of this 
 copy which may be bibliographically unique, 
 which may alter any of the images in the 
 reproduction, or which may significantly change 
 the usual method of filming, are checked below. 
 
 D 
 
 D 
 
 V 
 
 D 
 D 
 
 D 
 
 Coloured covers/ 
 Couverture de couleur 
 
 I I Covers damaged/ 
 
 Couverture endommagde 
 
 Covers restored and/or laminated/ 
 Couverture restaur^ et/ou pelliculAe 
 
 I I Cover title missing/ 
 
 Le titre de couverture manque 
 
 I I Coloured maps/ 
 
 Cartes giographiques en couleur 
 
 Coloured ink (i.e. other than blue or black)/ 
 Encre de couleur (i.e. autre que bleue ou noire) 
 
 I I Coloured plates and/or illustrations/ 
 
 Planches et/ou illustrations en couleur 
 
 Bound with other material/ 
 Reiid avec d'autres documents 
 
 Tight binding may cause shadows or distortion 
 along Interior margin/ 
 
 La reliure serrie peut causer de i'ombre ou de la 
 distortion le long de la marge intirieure 
 
 Blank leaves added during restoration may 
 appear within the text. Whenever possible, these 
 have been omitted from filming/ 
 II se peut que certalnes pages blanches ajoutAes 
 lors d'une restauration apparaissent dans le texte, 
 mais, lorsque cela Atait possible, ces pages n'ont 
 pas M fiimies. 
 
 L'Instltut a microfilm^ le meilleur exemplaire 
 qu'il lui a M possible de se procurer. Les details 
 de cet exemplaire qui sont peut-Atre uniques du 
 point de vue bibliographique, qui peuvent modifier 
 une image reproduite, ou qui peuvent exiger une 
 modification dans la methods normale de filmage 
 sont indiquAs ci-dessous. 
 
 D 
 D 
 D 
 □ 
 D 
 D 
 D 
 D 
 D 
 D 
 
 Coloured pages/ 
 Pages de couleur 
 
 Pages damaged/ 
 Pages endommag6es 
 
 Pages restored and/or laminated/ 
 Pages restaur^es et/ou peilicuiies 
 
 Pages discoloured, stained or foxed/ 
 Pages d6color6es, tachetdes ou piqudes 
 
 Pages detached/ 
 Pages d6tach6es 
 
 Showthrough/ 
 Transparence 
 
 Quality of print varies/ 
 Qualit^ inigale de I'impression 
 
 Includes supplementary material/ 
 Comprend du materiel suppldmentaire 
 
 Only edition available/ 
 Seule Mition disponible 
 
 Pages wholly or partially obscured by errata 
 slips, tissues, etc., have been refilmed to 
 ensure the best possible image/ 
 Les pages totalement ou partiellement 
 obscurcies par un feuillet d'errata, une pelure, 
 etc., ont 6X6 film^es A nouveau de fa9on A 
 obtenir la meilleure image possible. 
 
 Tht 
 pot 
 of 1 
 filn 
 
 Ori 
 be] 
 the 
 sio 
 otii 
 firs 
 sio 
 or i 
 
 Th< 
 shi 
 
 Tir 
 
 wh 
 
 Ma 
 
 difi 
 enl 
 be 
 rig] 
 rec 
 mf 
 
 □ 
 
 Additional comments:/ 
 Commentaires suppiimentaires; 
 
 This item is filmed at the reduction ratio checked below/ 
 
 Ce document est film* au taux de rMuction indiqu* ci-dessous. 
 
 
 10X 
 
 
 
 
 14X 
 
 
 
 18X 
 
 
 
 
 22X 
 
 
 
 
 26X 
 
 
 
 
 30X 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 1 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 >/ 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 lax 
 
 16X 20X 
 
 24X 28X 32X 
 
ails 
 
 du 
 
 idifier 
 
 une 
 
 nage 
 
 The copy filmed here has been reproduced thanks 
 to the generosity of: 
 
 Library of the Public 
 Archives of Canada 
 
 The images appearing here are the best quality 
 possible considering the condition and legibility 
 of the original copy and in keeping with the 
 filming contract specifications. 
 
 Original copies in printed paper covers are filmed 
 beginning with the front cover and ending on 
 the last page with a printed or illustrated impres- 
 sion, or the back cover when appropriate. All 
 other original copies are filmed beginning on the 
 first page with a printed or illustrated impres- 
 sion, and ending on the last page with a printed 
 or illustrated impression. 
 
 The last recorded frame on each microfiche 
 shall contain the symbol -^> (meaning "CON- 
 TINUED"), or the symbol V (meaning "END"), 
 whichever applies. 
 
 Maps, plates, charts, etc., may be filmed at 
 different reduction ratios. Those too large to be 
 entirely included in one exposure are filmed 
 beginning In the upper left hand corner, left to 
 right and top to bottom, as many frames as 
 required. The following diagrams illustrate the 
 method: 
 
 L'exemplaire filmA f ut reproduit grAce A la 
 g4n6rositA de: 
 
 La bibliothdque des Archives 
 pubiiques du Canada 
 
 Lee images suivantes ont At6 reproduites avec le 
 plus grand soin, compte tenu de la condition et 
 de la nettet6 de l'exemplaire filmi, et en 
 conformity avec les conditions du contrat de 
 filmage. 
 
 Les exemplaires originaux dont la couverture en 
 papier est imprim6e sont fiimis en commen9ant 
 par le premier plat et en terminant soit par la 
 dernlAre page qui comporte une empreinte 
 d'Impression ou d'iilustration, soit par le second 
 plat, selon le cas. Tous les autres exemplaires 
 originaux sont filmAs en commenpant par la 
 premiere page qui comporte une empreinte 
 d'Impression ou d'iilustration et en terminant par 
 la derniAre page qui comporte une telle 
 empreinte. 
 
 Un des symboles suivants apparaftra sur la 
 dernlAre image de cheque microfiche, selon le 
 cas: le symbols — ► signifie "A SUIVRE ", le 
 symbols V signifie 'FIN ". 
 
 Les cartes, planches, tableaux, etc., peuvent Atre 
 fiimis i des taux de reduction diff^rents. 
 Lorsque le document est trop grand pour Atre 
 reproduit en un seul clich6, 11 est film* A partir 
 de I'angle supArieur gauche, do gauche A droite, 
 et de haut en bas, en prenant le nombre 
 d'images n^cessaire. Les diagrammes suivants 
 illustrent la mAthode. 
 
 rrata 
 :o 
 
 pelure, 
 1 d 
 
 n 
 
 32X 
 
 1 
 
 2 
 
 3 
 
 1 
 
 2 
 
 3 
 
 4 
 
 5 
 
 6 
 
THE 
 
 YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 THE NARRATIVE OF W. H. DALL, LEADER OF THE 
 EXPEDITION TO ALASKA IN i86&^i868 
 
 THE NARRATIVE OF AN EXPLORATION MADE IN 1887 
 
 IN THE YUKON DISTRICT 
 
 BY GEORGE M. DAWSON, D.S., F.G.S. 
 
 EXTRACTS FROM THE REPORT OF AN EXPLORATION 
 MADE IN 1896-1897 BY VVm. OGILVIE, D.L.S., F.R.G.S. 
 
 iNTRODUCTlON M* 
 
 F. MORTIMER TRIMMER. F.R.G.S. 
 
 WITH MAP OF THE TERRITORY 
 FIFTY WOODCUTS AXn TIVENTY-TWO FUU-PAG/-: ILLUSTRATIONS 
 
 I>0\V\i:Y .\- V{^, i.iMiTM, 
 12 YORK STREET, COVENT GAUDKN, LONDON 
 
 189S 
 
[The pubUshen thankfully ackmwhdse the permisdon panted by the Iluur 
 COMMISSIONKR lOR THE DOMINION OK CANADA to print Parts II. and 
 III, of this vcliinie.'] 
 
 ^3 0,^9 
 
INTRODUCTION. 
 
 GREAT public interest during the past six months has 
 been directed to that remote territory in the North-Wcst 
 corner of the continent of North America which may be geo- 
 graphically described under the comprehensive term of the 
 Yukon Territory. And in the succeeding pages will be found 
 all the information of economic and scientific value that so 
 far has been gathered on the spot, and prepared for publica- 
 tion by trained and responsible observers acting in an official 
 capacity. • 
 
 In San Francisco last spring the present writer had the 
 advantage of meeting a number of times with practical men — 
 miners and prospectors — from the Yukon, who had come South 
 for the winter season and were then returning northwards. 
 Some of them were men known previously to the writer in 
 Colorado and in other Western mining districts, but who 
 since then had drifted off towards the arctic circle, in the roving 
 manner characteristic of Western miners. 
 
 Comparing the accounts of the Yukon country given to me 
 by these with what is set out in the chapters following here, I 
 find there is little that can profitably be added. 
 
 The gold discoveries that have attracted so much attention 
 have been made on some of the smaller tributaries of the main 
 Yukon River. Dawson City settlement is the centre of the 
 trading and supply point of this district. This place, as the 
 
VI 
 
 INTRODUCTION 
 
 map shows, is in Canadian territory, and not very far from the 
 point where the Yukon River is crossed by the international 
 boundary Hne. 
 
 The raiif^e from which the gold-bearing side-streams come 
 down to join the Yukon may be described as the arctic prolonga- 
 tion of the fundamental range of the continent of America ; a 
 range dotted at intervals, greater or less, with gold and silver 
 camps from Klondyke to Cape Horn. The source of the Yukon 
 gold is a significant point, as the permanent character of the 
 mineral-bearing lodes of the Rocky Mountains (as the range is 
 known north of Mexico) has been so long and thoroughly 
 established wherever they have been uncovered — though as far 
 as information goes, the fountain head, the mother lode of the 
 Klondyke placers, remains to be discovered yet. 
 
 This mother lode, unless all precedents fail, will be found 
 somewhere up the mountain sides towards the sources of 
 these same streams the placers have been formed on, or on 
 the summits of the range. 
 
 The placers in the valleys have been formed by the gathering 
 through long ages of fragments detarhed from exposed portions 
 of permanent reefs ; by weathering or water action — the gold 
 finding its way slowly to the lowest level. 
 
 In this connection it is worth perhaps recalling — as some 
 persons have seen in these rich Klondyke discoveries a possible 
 solution of the present deadlock in the commercial ratio 
 between gold and silver — that the uncovering of placer gold has 
 sometimes in the Rocky Mountains led to the uncovering of 
 silver-bearing ores, instead of gold, by prospectors seeking for 
 the mother lode. A notable instance of this is the great silver 
 camp at Leadville, originally a gold placer camp ; and other 
 cases might be cited. 
 
 A question asked sometimes, but not often answered, is, How 
 does gold come in these veins ? how are they formed ? 
 
INTRODUCTION 
 
 VU 
 
 An answer to this interesting question comes from China, 
 where philosophers long ago have solved the problem to their 
 satisfaction by a theory which if it has no other merit has that 
 at least of novelty. My authority here is a Chinaman, a 
 trader, and a man of education whom I used to know in Idaho. 
 
 Our planet's centre (so Chinese professors hold) is full of 
 molten gold, and whenever any orographic catastrophe in the 
 past has occurred of magnitude sufficient to fracture the earth's 
 crust right down to the seething molten mass below, some of 
 the gold is squeezed out to the surface through the cracks. 
 
 This theory though crude is plausible, and simple. 
 
 Since the Klondyke " rush " set in a great deal has been 
 written descriptive of the difficulties and the hardships to be 
 encountered, and probably these have not been exaggerated. 
 But the story of all big " gold rushes," and of many small ones, 
 too, has been of hardships to be faced in the preliminary struggle. 
 Only in days gone by there was less known to the outside 
 civilized world of what was happening. In these latter days it 
 is different, and now an increase of knowledge is apt to be 
 confounded with an increase of facts. 
 
 Still, there does remain the severity of the Arctic winters, 
 which must always be a drawback, though in the end this 
 drawback will mean nothing more serious perhaps than a slower 
 development. The climate of the Yukon Basin proper, in its 
 upper half, that is in the share of it which falls within the 
 Canadian Dominion, is in marked contrast to the climate of 
 the seaboard. 
 
 This interior country has a companitively dry and clear 
 atmosphere, with a limited precipitation, though here the cold 
 is intense. Along the sea front of the Coast Range, on the 
 other hand, the conditions are reversed completely as to mois- 
 ture, and the degree of cold is by comparison quite moderate. 
 
 In the lower or Western half of the Yukon Basin a gradual 
 
Vlll 
 
 INTRODUCTION 
 
 increase of precipitation marches with the fall of the land 
 westward towards the river's mouth. 
 
 Communication with that section which has made so much 
 stir, is kept up at present under difficulties. 
 
 At its mouth, the Yukon River is navigable for a very short 
 period — from the beginning of July to the end of September ; 
 but on its upper part it is navigable from May until the middle 
 of October. Travellers seeking the easiest route go by steamer 
 during the open season from one or other of the ports on the 
 Pacific Coast to St. Michael's on Behring Sea, near the Yukon 
 mouth, transferring there to river steamers which make the 
 trip to Dawson City, distant some sixteen hundred miles. The 
 duration of the river trip depends somewhat on the risks and 
 chances of the river navigation. 
 
 The route of which most has been heard since the rush first 
 started is one by trails across the Coast Range at the Chilcat 
 and neighbouring passes, starting from tide-water at the head 
 of the Lynn Canal, as an arm there of the sea is known. 
 
 The advantage of this route is its shortness, and once the 
 Coast Range difficulties have been passed, the head-waters of 
 streams navigable for boats flowing to the Yukon are quickly 
 reached. Down these the trip is continued, going with the 
 stream all the way to Dawson City, and without serious 
 obstacles other than portages at several points necessitated by 
 dangerous rapids. The distance, as measured in miles, from 
 tide-water on the Lynn Canal across these passes to the head of 
 navigation, is small, but the difficulties to be overcome at the 
 crossing of the passes make the trip a serious undertaking, 
 until some very necessary engineering outlay has been made 
 upon the trails. 
 
 But the route said to be the coming main route to the 
 interior, and one growing already in favour in spite of the 
 primitive conditions of the trail, is that entering by the 
 
INTRODUCTION Jx 
 
 Stikine River; a very full description of the features along the 
 course of which river is given in Dr. Dawson's itinerary, starting 
 from Fort Wrangel at the river's mouth. 
 
 Arrangements are reported to have been completed for open- 
 ing up this route by the building of a railway from the head of 
 navigation on the Stikine to the head of steam navigation on 
 the Lewes, this being one of the main Yukon branches -the 
 length of the gap to be filled being about two hundred miles. 
 
 The Stikine Valley climate contrasts phenomenally with that 
 of the interior. The mean annual temperature in the Dawson 
 City region being as low as i6° Fahrenheit, while at Wrangel, 
 near the Stikine mouth, 47° Fahrenheit is given as the corre- 
 sponding figure. 
 
 So favoured indeed is the Stikine Valley, that, on his trip 
 through there, Dr. Dawson met with the humming-bird. 
 
 February, i8g8. 
 
 F. Mortimer Trimmer. 
 
CONTENTS. 
 
 Travkls on thk Yukon 
 
 1866-1868, Hv W. H. Dali 
 
 PART I. 
 
 AND IN THK YUKON TkKRITOKV IN 
 
 PART II. 
 
 Extracts krom thh: Rhport on an Exploration maok in 
 1887 IN THE Yukon Territory, N.W.T, and a.hacknt 
 Northern Portion ok British Columhia, bv George 
 
 M. Dawson, D.S., F.G.S 
 
 ••■••■ 243 
 
 PART III. 
 
 Extracts from the Report ok an Exploration maok iv 
 
 1896-1897 BY Wm. Ogiiaie, D.L.S., F.R.Q.S. . 38, 
 
 Index 
 
 424 
 
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS. 
 
 Dog Driving near f he .Vasoli.i Sopka 
 
 St. Michael's Redoiiht . 
 
 Diagram of Inniiit Topck 
 
 Bidarra . 
 
 Bidarka . . . _ 
 
 Interior of Fort Darabin, from above 
 
 Nul.-ito and (he Viikon from the HiufTs 
 
 Wolasatux barrabora in winter 
 
 The Koyukiik Sopka from above 
 
 Pipes . . . ^ 
 
 Tohonidola . 
 
 Mount Ilohoniia from the Melozikakat 
 
 Looking out of Nowikakat I farijour 
 
 The Twin Mountains from the Melozikakat Mouth 
 
 V ouug Nuklukahyet tyone 
 
 Nose Ornament of the Yukon Indians 
 
 In the Ramparts 
 
 Looking liack at the Rapids 
 
 Looking back at the end of the Ramparts 
 
 Fort Yukon in June, 1867 
 
 Knife of Kutchin manufacture . 
 
 Sakhniti 
 
 Red Leggins ... 
 
 Diagram of Innuit casine 
 
 Kegiktowruk in the fall ... 
 
 Toponika and Tolstoi Point from the Sc 
 
 liigalik grave 
 
 Lobrets and Earrings 
 
 Amulets 
 
 Hone needle-case • . . , 
 Innuit fire drill • . . . 
 
 Pigulka 
 
 Innuit grave 
 
 Innuit fish-hook and .sinkar 
 
 Toface 
 
 To face 
 
 PACB 
 
 Frontispiere 
 To J ace 1 1 
 
 •3 
 «S 
 
 IS 
 46 
 
 47 
 
 65 
 
 77 
 
 81 
 
 82 
 
 84 
 
 87 
 
 93 
 
 94 
 
 95 
 
 96 
 
 97 
 100 
 
 103 
 105 
 107 
 no 
 
 127 
 
 128 
 130 
 
 '32 
 
 140 
 
 141 
 14a 
 
 142 
 
 '43 
 146 
 148 
 
 face 
 
 Tojace 
 Toface 
 
XIV 
 
 LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS 
 
 Innuit sled of Norton Sound 
 
 Hudson Bay sled, lop.ded 
 
 Ingalik sled of the Yukon* 
 
 Jearny's barrabora . 
 
 Yukon grouse si are 
 
 Different kinds of snow shoes 
 
 Snow goggles of the Yukon Indians 
 
 Site of Kwikhtana barrabora . 
 
 Lofka's barrabora . 
 
 Klan-ti-lin-ten 
 
 Kantngs and wooden ladle 
 
 Anvik Starcek 
 
 Indian pottery 
 
 Ingalik birch canoe 
 
 First Premorska village . 
 
 Ekogmut grave 
 
 Ekogmut bow 
 
 Village on the Lower Yukon during the fishing 
 
 Andreaffsky . 
 
 Kullik . 
 
 The Emperor goose 
 
 Ivory bodkin . " . 
 
 Seine needle . ' . 
 
 Innuit drawings on hone . 
 
 On the Upper Pelly River, nineteen miles above the Macmillan 
 
 Junction of Forty Mile and Yukon Riv 
 
 Tahl-tan Valley, at Trail Crossing . 
 
 J. Le Duis House — Sixty Mile post 
 
 Dease River above " First Lake," looking west 
 
 Lake Lindeman, looking up from Outlet 
 
 White Horse Rapids 
 
 Miles Canon 
 
 Junction of FortyMile and Yukon Rivers (lefl-liand view) 
 Junction of V'ntty Mile and Yukon Rivers (ii};ht-hand view) 
 The Frozen ^■ukon, from IXiwson City 
 
 
 • 
 
 TAGB 
 
 i6S 
 i66 
 
 
 176 
 178 
 
 
 190 
 
 
 195 
 
 
 2IO 
 
 
 211 
 
 Toface 
 
 2'S 
 216 
 
 To face 
 
 217 
 218 
 
 
 219 
 
 
 223 
 
 
 227 
 228 
 
 Toface 
 
 228 
 
 
 230 
 
 
 234 
 
 
 236 
 236 
 
 To/ace 
 
 252 
 
 
 
 274 
 
 
 
 292 
 
 
 
 302 
 
 
 
 3'o 
 336 
 
 364 
 366 
 
 376 
 378 
 
 
 
 412 
 
X 
 
 PART I. 
 
 TRAVELS ON THE YUKON AND IN THE YL'KO>r 
 
 TERRITORY. 
 
CHAPTER I. 
 
 Arrival in Norton Sound. — Circumstances of previous visit. — News of the death of 
 Robert Kennicott. — Change of plans. — Receive my appointment as Director of 
 the Scientific Corps, and determine to remain in the country. — Landing, organiza- 
 tion, and departure of the vessels. — Dei)arture of the Wilder for Unalaklik. — 
 Ru.ssian peechka. — St. Michael's Redoubt and Island. — Russian traders. — Stc- 
 panoff. — Natives and their houses. — Skin boats. — Departure from the Redoubt. 
 
 — Journey to Unalaklik. -»- Detention at Kcgiktowruk. — Seal-hunting. — Innuit 
 graves. — Hath as enjoyed by the Innuit. — Character of the coast. — Depar- 
 ture from Kegiktowruk. — Topanika. — Arrival oflf the mouth of the river. — Ice- 
 cakes. — Arrival at Unalaklik. — Cockroaches. — Native clothing. — Descrip- 
 tion of the post and village. — Deficiency of medical supplies. — Departure for 
 Nulato via Ulukuk. — Iktigalik and its inhabitants. — Telegraph stew. — Escape 
 of dogs and return to Unalaklik. — Russian baths. — Disagreeable trip to Iktigalik, 
 
 — All gone on my arrival. — Second return to Unalaklik. — Impromptu theatricals, 
 
 — Departure for Ulukuk. — Deserted village. — Arrival at Ulukuk. — Springs. — 
 Transportation of goods — Arrival of .Mike with the brigade from Nulato. — De- 
 parture for Nulato. — Parhelia. — Mysterious caterpillar. — First view of the Yu- 
 kon. — Arrival at Nulato. 
 
 ON the 24th of September, 1866, the clipper ship Nightin- 
 gale came to anchor half a mile southeast of Egg Island, 
 Norton Sound. 
 
 A driving storm from the north and northeast obscured the 
 atmosphere, and covered the deck with an inch or two of half- 
 melted snow and hail. The waves were yellow with sediment, 
 churned up by their own violence, and the very white-caps had 
 a sullied look which spoke of shallow water. We were drawing 
 nineteen feet, with a rise and fall of the waves of at least twelve 
 feel more, auu the breeze was freshening. This did nut leave 
 a very large margin under the keel, and the well-known rapidity 
 with which a north wind will diminish the depth of water in 
 the Sound, sometimes making a difference of a fathom in the 
 course of a few hours, added to the an.xiety of our ship's officers. 
 Our indefatigable commander, Captain Scammon, was seriously 
 ill. Altogether, the circumstances attending our arrival in the 
 vicinity of Redoubt St. Michael's were not propitious. 
 
4 THE YUKON TEKRITORV. 
 
 A little more than a year before, we had visited this point in 
 the bark Golden Gate. We left a party to make the prelimi- 
 nary explorations, previous to deciding; on the line on which it 
 was proposed to build the international telegraph. This party 
 was under the command of the Director of the Scientific Corps, 
 Robert Kennicott, whose previous e.xperience in the Hudson Bay 
 Territory to the westward had fitted him above all others to fill 
 the arduous post of commander of the explorations in Russian 
 America. Several members of the Scientific Corps were of his 
 party, and to their combined labors we looked hopefully for a 
 solution of the problem of the identity of the Yukon River with 
 the so-called Kwikhpak of the Russians. This identity was 
 stoutly upheld by Mr. Kennicott, though persistently denied by 
 many, who looked upon the so-called Colvile River, flowing into 
 the Arctic Ocean, as the true mouth of the Yukon, while they 
 considered the Kwikhpak as a distinct river. The question was 
 regarded as uncertain by all. Information received from the 
 Russians, however, soon put the matter beyond a doubt, and 
 we looked to Mr. Kennicott and his party as the favored few who 
 were to pass the terra incognita between the limit of Russian 
 explorations and the Hudson Hay Territory, and thus complete 
 the exploration of the Lower Yukon. 
 
 Though their equipment was not such as we could have wished, 
 and though grave doubts prevailed as to the value of a miniaiure 
 steamer, of which much had been expected, still we left all of them 
 in the highest spirits, and with the heartiest wishes for their 
 success, as we sailed slowly away from Stuart Island, September 
 17, 1865. 
 
 During the year which had passed many changes had taken 
 place in the organization of the Fl.xpedition. No word had been 
 received from the party even through the Russian mail, which is 
 carried overland from St. Michaels every winter to Nushergak 
 and thence by sea to Sitka. 
 
 Various detentions kept the vessels of the fleet lying in San 
 Francisco Hay long after they should have reached the shores of 
 Bering Sea, and it was only in the month of July that the E.xpe- 
 dition finally set .sail. We had been lying in Plover Hay .several 
 weeks, during which time a rumor had reached us that an explor- 
 ing party had been at Graniley Harbor during the winter, and that 
 
THE YUKON' TERRITORY. 
 
 one member of the party had been badly frost-bitten. All were 
 i.iipposed to be alive and well. 
 
 Now that we had again come within reach of our friends and 
 companions, our an.xiety may be imagined. The state of the 
 weather and our distance from St. Michael's, almost twelve miles, 
 prevented our landing in a body. A boat with two officers was 
 despatched late in the afternoon, but the distance and the still 
 increasing storm forbade us to expect their return that night. 
 
 My own impatience was so great that I soon abandoned the 
 attempt to sleep, and accompanied the officer of the deck m his 
 inclement night-watch, pacing up and down in the rain and 
 sleet ; and I almost fancied that there was something derisive in 
 the whistle of the wind through the rigging and insulting in the 
 masses of slush which ciie swaying cordage occasionally threw in 
 our faces. 
 
 The ne.xt morning the storm continued with little abatement. 
 About noon we saw the steamer George S. Wright, which we 
 knew had arrived with the commander of the expedition a day or 
 two before, getting up steam behind the point of Stuart Island. 
 About four o'clock in the afternoon she came out and anchored 
 under the lee of Egg Island near us, and we soon saw a boat put 
 off from her. Every glass was pointed at her, and every eye was 
 strained for a glimpse of some familiar face ; but the long hair and 
 beards, the unfamiliar deer-skin dresses and hoods defied recog- 
 nition. 
 
 Pressing forward to the gangway, as the first man came over 
 the side, my first question was, " Where is Kennicott .' " and the 
 answer, " Dead, poor fellow, last May," stunned me with its sudden 
 anguish. I stayed to hear no more, but went to my cabin as 
 one walks in a dream. 
 
 So he was gone, that noble, impetuous, but tender-hearted man, 
 who had been to me and many others as more than a brother I 
 During the past two years many had had bitter controversies with 
 him, hut all felt and expressed their grief at his untimely death. 
 I le was one who made enemies as well as friends, but even ene- 
 mies could not but respect the purity of motive, the open-handed 
 generosity, the consideration, almost too ;'reat, for his subor- 
 dinates, and the untiring energy and lively spirits which wcru 
 the prominent characteristics of the man. 
 
IMHHMI 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 The details of his explorations and death will be found else- 
 where. His body had been tenderly cared for, brought down the 
 Yukon from the point where he died, placed in a vault at the 
 Redoubt, and was to be taken home in charge of Mr. Charles 
 Pease, who had been his friend from boyhood, and Mr. H. M. 
 Bannister, both members of the Scientific Corps. This would 
 leave the Corps without a single representative in the whole of 
 Russian \merica north of Sitka. 
 
 My own plan had been, to e.xplain the operations of the Corps 
 during the past year to Mr. Kennicott, and if approved by him 
 to cross to the Siberian side and obtain such information and col- 
 lections as opportunity might offer, and especially to determine 
 by the barometer the height of the different volcanoes for which 
 Kamchatka is renowned. 
 
 Under the circumstances, however, and considering the infor- 
 mation in regard to North American natural history and geology 
 more important than that relating to the other continent, I re- 
 solved to remain at St. Michael's or in the valley of the Yukon 
 during the ensuing season. I determined to use my best energies 
 to complete the scientific exploration of the northwest extremity 
 of the continent, as it had been planned by Mr. Kennicott, and 
 which comprised the exploration of, — 
 
 First, the region between Fort Yukon, at the junction of the 
 Yukon and the Porcupine, and Nulato, the most eastern Russian 
 post on the former river ; 
 
 Second, the region between Nulato and the sea, westward across 
 the portage, and south by way of the Yukon to the sea ; and, — 
 
 Lastly, the whole region bordering on Norton Sound and the 
 sea to the north and south of it. 
 
 Toward this considerable collections and many observations 
 had been made at St. Michael's, but little had been done in 
 other parts of the country. 
 
 Captain Charles S. Bulkley, U. S. A., Engineer-in-chief of 
 the P^xpedition, having signified his desire that I should succeed 
 Mr. Kennicott as Director of the Scientific Corps, and learning 
 that I desired to remain in the country, ordered me to act as 
 Surgeon in general charge of the district between Bering Strait 
 and the Yukon. I submitted my plans for the scientific opera- 
 tions of the coming year to him, and they met with his entire 
 approval. 
 
 »l! 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Great expedition was necessary in making my preparations. 
 
 The continued north wind began to tell on the depth of water 
 in the Sound, and on Saturday we grounded with every swell. 
 Luckily the bottom here is an impalpable soft mud, without any 
 stones, otherwise the old Nightingale would have left her bones 
 there ; and as it was, every few moments she came thumping 
 down, with a severity that shook everything, from truck to 
 kelson. 
 
 The following morning it cleared off, and those who were 
 to remain took their seats in a large scow loaded with coal, which 
 was to be towed ashore by the steamer Wilder. The Wilder was 
 one of two small stern-wheel steamers, Ixiilt in San Francisco, 
 and brought up on the deck of the Nightingale, designed for 
 river navigation. They were shaped much like an old-fashioned 
 flat-iron, and were just about as valuable for the purposes 
 required ; being unable to tow anything, or to carry any freight, 
 while in a breeze of any strength it was no easy matter to steer 
 them. 
 
 Sitting pensively on the larger lumps of coal, we had ample 
 opportunity of studying the defects of our tug, and it became an 
 interesting matter as to what we should do if she should break 
 down before reaching shore, as seemed likely. A cold and 
 extremely penetrating rain gave us a foretaste of the concom- 
 itants of exploration, and rendered our dcimrture anything but 
 romantic. Indeed, I could not help thinking that we bore much 
 more resemblance to a party of slaves cii route for the galleys, as 
 Victor Hugo describes them, than to a party of young and ardent 
 explorers, defying the powers of winter, and only anxious for an 
 opportunity to exhibit our prowess. 
 
 We finally arrived in safety at the landing, near the Russian 
 trading-post of St. Michael. Having pocketed some biscuit, I 
 was provisioned, and, picking out a soft plank in a back room, 
 I rolled my.self in a blanket, and after .some difficulty got to sleep. 
 The rain continued ; the Russians were holding an orgie, with 
 liquor obtained from the vessels ; the dogs howled nearly all 
 night ; the roof leaked, not water, but fine volcanic gravel, with 
 which it was covered. If this is a sample of the country, I 
 thought, it is not prepossessing ! 
 
 On rising in the morning I found, as might be expected, that 
 
THE YUKON TEKKITOKY. 
 
 I was likely to feel for some time the eftect of my new style of 
 bed in a way that was anything but agreeable. 
 
 On Monday, the 1st of October, 1866, the Nightingale sailed 
 for Plover Hay. All was activity on shore, preparing the Wilder 
 and all available boats for a trip to Unalaklik, the seaboard 
 terminus of the portage to the Yukon, at the mouth of the Una- 
 laklik River. My friend, Mr. Whymper, the genial and excellent 
 artist of the expedition, proposed to leave for Unalaklik on the 
 steamer. 
 
 The work of construction and exploration had been divided. 
 The larger number of men, and the work to be done in the region 
 west of the Yukon, had been placed in charge of Mr. W. H. 
 Ennis and several assistants. Here the work of exploration had 
 been mainly finished, and construction, e.xclusive of putting up 
 the wires, was to be immediately commenced. 
 
 The work of exploration and future construction, to the north 
 and east of Nulato on the Yukon, was intrusted to Mr. F. E. 
 Ketchum, to whom, with Mr. Michael Lebarge, the honor of 
 exploring the region between Nulato and Fort Yukon had fallen 
 after Kennicott's death. 
 
 Mr. Ketchum, who bore the title of Captain in the service of 
 the Expedition, was thoroughly qualified for the execution of the 
 trust committed to him. He had been eminently faithful to Mr. 
 Kennicott during his arduous explorations, and had successfully 
 carried out his plans after his death. 
 
 I proposed to accompany him to Nulato, the place best suited 
 for the prosecution of the scientific work, and as he had decided 
 to remain for a while at St. Michael's, after consultation with him, 
 we secured a room in the Russian quarters together. 
 
 On Tuesday the steamer, in charge of Captain E. E. Smith, with 
 a Russian pilot, started for Unalaklik. As we were waving our 
 congratulations, to our dismay we saw her come to a stand-still, 
 plump on a rock at the entrance of the cove. It seemed as if her 
 career were about to come to an ignominious conclusion, but after 
 a good deal of labor she worked off without damage, and proceeded 
 on her way. 
 
 We returned to our quarters, where we built a fire in the 
 Russian stove. These stoves are a " peculiar institution," in use 
 throughout the territory, and worthy of description. Here they 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 are built of fragments of basalt, the prevalent rock, and smeared 
 inside and out with a mortar made of clay. A damper in the 
 chimney is so arranged as to shut oft" all draught, and is taken 
 out when the fire is made. After the whole has been thoroughly 
 heated by a wood fire the coals are removed. The damper is put 
 in, thus preventing the escape of hot air by the chimney, and 
 without further fire this stove will warm the room for twenty-four 
 hours. It is admirably suited to the climate and country, and its 
 only objectionable point is the amount of room it occupies. A 
 good deal of cooking, baking, &c., can be accomplished in a large 
 one, and the remainder is done in a building erected for the pur- 
 pose, and called the />ovdniia. The Russian name for this stove is 
 pccclika, but an iron stove, such as is used in the United States, is 
 called dLkanccla. The foundation of the peechka is of wood, filled 
 in with volcanic gravel, and covered with brick or slabs of lava. 
 In Russia they are generally built of brick entirely, and are often 
 tiled over on the outside with painted tiles, such as are yet to be 
 found in some of the older houses in New England. 
 
 Our beds, as in all the houses in this part of the territory, were 
 made on a platform raised a few feet from the floor, and about 
 seven feet wide. Mine consisted of a reindeer skin with the hair 
 on, and with one end sewn up, so as to make a sort of bag to put 
 ihe feet in ; a pillow of wild-goose and other feathers is essential 
 to comfort ; this, with a pair of good blankets, is all that one needs 
 in most instances. Sheets are unknown in this part of the world, 
 and counterpanes are almost so. 
 
 Our time was well occupied in getting everything in readiness 
 for transportation, if the steamer should return as we hoped. If, 
 as was probable, she found ice in the Unalaklik River, she would 
 have to go into winter quarters at once. 
 
 Meanwhile I took a careful survey of the old trading-post, or 
 Michaelovski Redoubt, as the Russians call it. 
 
 By order of Baron WrangcU, Michael Tebenkoft", an officer of 
 the Russian American Company, established this post in 1833. 
 It is stated by different writers to be in latitude 63° l}^ or 63^ 28' 
 north, and longitude 161° 55' or 161° 44' west of Greenwich. 
 Few points were established by the Russians with the accuracy 
 deemed indispensable in modern English or American surveys. 
 It is stated by Tikhmenief that, in 1836, the Unaligmuts of the 
 
lO 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 vicinity attacked the Redoubt, which was successfully defended 
 by Kurupanoff, the commander. 
 
 It is built of spruce logs, brought by the sea from the mouths of 
 the Yukon and Kuskoqui'm, which annually discharge immense 
 quantities of driftwood. This is stacked up by the Russians in 
 the fall, for miles along the coast north and west of the Redoubt, 
 and is carried in winter to the fort over the ice by means of dogs 
 and sleds. No other fuel exists on the island and adjoining 
 shores. These are entirely destitute of wood, if we except low, 
 scrubby willows and alders, which are found in the vicinity of 
 water. St. Michael's is situated on a small point of the island of 
 the same name, which puts out into the sound and forms a small 
 cove, abounding in rocks and very shallow. Here a temporary 
 landing-place is built out into water deep enough for loaded boats 
 drawing five feet to come up at high tide. This is removed when 
 winter approaches, as otherwise it would be destroyed by the ice. 
 The shore is sandy, and affords a moderately sloping beach, on 
 which boats may be drawn up. A few feet only from high-water 
 mark are perpendicular banks from six to ten feet high, composed 
 of decayed pumice and ashes, covered with a layer, about four 
 feet thick, of clay and vegetable matter resembling peat. This 
 forms a nearly even meadow, with numerous pools of water, which 
 gradually ascends for a mile or more to a low hill of volcanic ori- 
 gin, known as the Shaman Mountain. 
 
 The fort is composed of log buildings with plank roofs, placed in 
 the form of a square, and with the intervals filled by a palisade about 
 ten feet high, surmounted by a chr^'anx-dc-frise of pointed stakes. 
 This is also continued round the eaves of the buildings. There are 
 two outlying bastions, pierced for cannon and musketry, and con- 
 taining a number of pieces of artillery of very small calibre and 
 mostly very old-fashioned and rusty, except two fine brass howitzers 
 of more modern manufacture. The principal buildings are the com- 
 mander's house, — consisting of two private rooms, an armory and 
 a counting-room, or contonim, — a couple of buildings used as store- 
 houses, a bath-house, and separate houses for the married and 
 unmarried workmen. There is a flag-staff leaning apologetically 
 as if consciously out of place, and a gallery for the watchman, who 
 is on duty day and night, with reliefs, and who tolls a bell on the 
 hour stroke to notify the inmates that he is not asleep. One of 
 
THE YUKON TERRITOKV. 
 
 I I 
 
 the bastions is without cannon, and is used as a guard-house for 
 refractory subjects. 
 
 Outside of the stockade are several other buil(hn< 
 
 a sm 
 
 all 
 
 storehouse used for furs, a large shed where boats are drawn up in 
 winter, a blacksmith's shop, and a church. The latter is octagonal 
 in shape, with a small dome, surmounted by a cross, and a beam 
 bearing a bell at the side of a small porch which covers the door- 
 way. Other small buildings are scattered about ; a sun-dial is to 
 be found not far from the church, and a noticeable feature in the 
 fall is the stacks of bleached driftwood, which, from a distance, 
 look not uidike tents or bastions. 
 
 Between the point on which St. Michael's is built and the main- 
 land, a small arm of the sea makes in, in which three fathoms 
 may be carried until the flagstaff of the fort bears west by 
 north. This is the best-jirotected anchorage, and has as much 
 water and as good bottom as can be found much farther out. 
 
 At the southwest extremity of this arm, known as Tebenkoff 
 Cove, we enter a narrow and tortuous chi.nnel, often not more 
 than fifty feet wide, which separates the island of St. Michael 
 from the mainland. This has been aptly named the Canal by 
 the Russians, and it divides midway into two branches which are, 
 it seems to me, equally tortuous, though they are styled the 
 Straight and the Crooked respectively. 
 
 The mainland near St. Michael's gradually rises from the Canal 
 and the adjacent shores into low basaltic hills, with a rugged and 
 rocky, though not elevated coast. 
 
 The inmates of the fort — with the exception of Sergei Stepan- 
 olf Ri'isanoff, an old soldier, who commands not only this, but all 
 tlie trading-posts in the District of St. Michael, under the title 
 of I'provali'slia — may be c'lvided into three classes: convicts, 
 Creoles, and natives. 
 
 The workmen of the Russian American Company were, al- 
 most without exception, convieN, mostly from Siberia, where 
 the Company was originally organized. They were men con- 
 victed of such crimes as theft, incorrigible drunkenness, burglary, 
 and even manslaughter. These men, after a continued resi- 
 dence in the eountrv, naturally took to themselves wives, .alter the 
 fashion of the eountrv, since Russian subjects in the Company's 
 employ were prohibiteil from legal marriage with native women. 
 
12 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 These connections are looked upon with a different feeling from 
 that which prevails in most communities, and these native 
 women mix freely with the few Russian and half-breed women in 
 the territory who have been legally married. Their children are 
 termed Creoles, and formerly were taken from their parents and 
 educated in Sitka by the Company, in whose service they were 
 obliged to pass a certain number of years, when they became 
 what is called " free Creoles," and were at liberty to continue in 
 the service or not, as they liked. Many of the most distinguished 
 officers of the Company were Creoles, among them Etolin, Kush- 
 evaroff, and Malakoff. 
 
 There are a few Yakuts in the service of the Company, and these, 
 with some native workmen, who are generally of the tribe which 
 inhabits the immediate vicinity of the post, compose the garrison. 
 
 The reg.i ar workman gets about fifty pounds rf flour, a pound 
 of lea, and three pounds of sugar, a month ; his pay is about 
 twenty cents a day. Some of the older men get thirty cents and 
 a corresponding addition to the ration of flour. They work with 
 little energy and spirit as a general thing, but can accomplish 
 a great deal if roused by necessity. Small offences are punished 
 by confinement in the guard-house, or boofka, and greater ones by 
 a thrashing administered by the commander in person ; those who 
 commit considerable crimes are forced to r \ the gauntlet, receive 
 one or two hu.dred blows with a stick, or in extreme cases are sent 
 for trial to Sitka, or, in case of murder, to St. Petersburg. 
 
 The present Uprovali'sha, Stepanoff, has been in office about 
 four years. He is a middle-aged man of great energy and iron 
 will, with the Russian fondness for strong liquor and with un- 
 governable passions in certain directions. He has a soldier's con- 
 tempt for making money by small ways, a certain code of honor 
 of his own, is generous in his own way, and seldom does a mean 
 thing when he is sober, but nevertheless is a good deal of a brute. 
 lie will gamble and drink in the most democratic way with his 
 workmen, and bears no malice for a black eye when received in a 
 drunken brawl ; but woe to the unfortunate who infringes discipline 
 while he is sober, for he slvUi certainly receive his reward ; and 
 Stepanotf often says of his men, when speaking to an American, 
 " \oy.\ can expect nothing good of this rabble ; they left Russia 
 because they v-'ere not wanted there." 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 13 
 
 The commanders, or hUdrsfiiks, of the smaller posts in the Dis- 
 trict of St. Michael are appointed by Stepanoff, who has absolute 
 authority over them, and does not fail to let them understand it, 
 making them row his boat, when the annual supply-ship is in Dort, 
 as Alexander might have called his captive kings to do him menial 
 service. But Stepanoff trembles before the captain of the ship or 
 an old officer of the Company, much in the same way that his 
 workmen cringe before him. This sort of subserviency, the fruit 
 of a despotic government, is characteristic of the lower classes of 
 Russians ; and to such an extent is ii ingrained in their characters 
 that it seems impossible for them to comprehend any motives of 
 honor or truthfulness as being superior to self-interest. 
 
 The native inhabitants of this part of the coast belong to the 
 great family of Innuit. The name of the tribe is Vtialcct, and their 
 name for the village, half a mile west of the Redoubt on the island 
 of St. Michael, is T'satsihiii. The few families living there bear 
 the local designation of Tutsoganiit, much as we should say 
 Bostonian or New-Yorker. The village comprises half a dozen 
 houses and a dance-house, built in the native fashion ; that is to 
 say, half underground, with the entrance more or less so, and the 
 roof furnished with a square opening in the centre, for the escape 
 of smoke and admission of light. 
 
 Di.iKr.im (if liimiit Tdpek. 
 
 They arc built of spruce logs, without nails or pins, and an' 
 usually about twelve or fifteen feet scjuare. Tlie cntrai.cr is a 
 small hole through which one must enter on hands and knees, and 
 is usually furni.shed with a bear or deer skin or a piece of matting 
 to exclude the air. Outside of this entrance is a passage-\\ay. 
 hardly larger, which opens under a small shed, at the surface of 
 the ground, to protect it from the weather. 
 
>4 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 
 They are about eight feet high in the middle, but the eaves are 
 rarely more than three or four feet above the ground. The floor 
 i.s divided by two logs into three areas of nearly equal size, the 
 entrance being at the end of the middle one. This portion of 
 the floor is always the native earth, usually hardened by constant 
 passing over it. In the middle, under the aperture in the roof, 
 the fire is built, and here are sometimes placed a few stones. 
 On cither side the portion separated by the logs before men- 
 tioned is occupied as a place to sit and work in during the day, 
 and as a sleeping-place during the night. The earth is usually 
 covered with straw, or spruce branches when obtainable, and 
 over this is laid a mat woven out of grass. Sometimes the 
 space is raised, or a platform is built of boards, or logs hewn flat 
 on one side. This is a work of such labor, however, that it is 
 seldom resorted to. The beds, which generally consist of a 
 blanket of dressed deerskin, or rabbit-skins sewed together, are 
 rolled up and put out of the way during the day. Almost all 
 sorts of work are done in the houses after the cold weather sets 
 in. At this time, however, there did not appear to be any people 
 in the village, and Captain Ketchum told me that they would not 
 return for a week or two, being absent at Pastolik, where they 
 were killing the beluga or white whale. A solitary old woman, 
 perhaps of exceptional ugliness, spent her time picking berries, 
 which were abundant near the village. 
 
 Sntiday, October jth. — A party of natives of the IMahlemut 
 tribe arrived, in a skin boat, bringing letters from Unalaklik, 
 saying that the boats had arrived safely at that point. The tur- 
 rets or bastions of the Russian post were being fitted up for the 
 accommodation of the officers, and winter quarters for the men 
 were being arranged and made comfortable. The ground was 
 well covered with snow, and we were advised to use all practi- 
 cable expedition in reaching Unalaklik by water, before the forma- 
 tion of ice should interfere with navigation. The thermometer 
 averaged 9° Fahrenheit during the day, and no time was to be 
 lost. 
 
 We therefore made arrangements for starting the next day, — 
 Captain Ketchum and myself in one boat, Mr. Westdahl our 
 astronomer, and a i)arty of natives, with two others. 
 
 The skin boats, in which most of the travelling by water is done. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 15 
 
 are of three kinds. One is a large open boat, flat-bottomed and con- 
 sistin>r ot' a wooden frame tied with sealskin thongs, or rnniii, and 
 
 liidarnl. 
 
 witli the skins of the seal properly prepared, oiled, and sewed to- 
 gether, stretched over this frame and held in place by walrus-skin 
 lini-, or III i/ioiit. This kind of boat is known among all the I11- 
 nuit l)v the name ooiiiiak, and is called a bidarrd by the Russians. 
 
 nid.irk.i. 
 
 Another, a smaller boat, for one man, is made essentially in the 
 same way, but covered completely over, except a hole in which the 
 occupant sits, and around the projecting rim of which, when at sea, 
 lie tics the edge of a waterproof shirt, called a kauildyka by the 
 Russians. This is securely tied around the wrists and face also ; 
 the head being covered by a hood, so that no water can by any 
 means penetrate to the interior of the boat. This boat is called 
 by the natives a kyak\ and by the Russians a luddrkw. 
 
 Tlie other kind is used only by the Russians, and was copied 
 from those of the Aleutians, differing from the last only by being 
 longer and having two or three holes ; it is adapted to carry two or 
 three people. Tiiese boats are admirably light and strong, and 
 extremely valuable for making short journeys. It is, with persons 
 skilled in their use, all but impossible to swamp them, and the 
 Russians have introduced thi;m into every part of the territory 
 as an invaluable adjunct to exploration. They call them simply 
 two or three holed bid.irkas. Tiiey are propelled by single or 
 double ended paddles, and attain an extraordinary speed. 
 
 Monday, St//. — The weather being clear and fine, the wind 
 nearly tair, we determined to put off lor Unalakli'k. We left .St. 
 Miciiael's about noon, Westdahl leading, but the wind hauling 
 ahead we ran closer in, and left him making a long tack, which 
 Ketchum was rather ajiprehcnsive would be unsuccessful, as it is 
 
 H 
 
i6 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 impossible, or almost so, to beat against the wind with one of 
 these flat-bottomed skin boats. 
 
 About eight o'clock p. m. we put into a small rocky cove about 
 twenty-two miles from the Redoubt. This, f'^om two small rocky 
 islets which protect it, is known to the Unaleets as Kegiktozvruk, 
 a word derived frohi kiklUuk, meaning an island. There is quite 
 a village on the high bank back of the cove, and the inhabitants 
 came down and helped us to haul our boat up on a sort of ways, 
 built of round logs, held in place by large masses of rock. These 
 are necessary, as the cove is very shallow and so full of rocks that 
 the skin boats are very liable to be cut on them at low tide. 
 There were no signs of the other boats. 
 
 The village is notable on account of the number of graves 
 scattered over the plain about it, and also for the large size of the 
 dance-house, or cosine as the Russians term it. This building is 
 to be found in almost every village, and serves for a general work- 
 room, a sort of town-hall, a steam bath-house, a caravanserai for 
 travellers, and a meeting-house for celebrating their annual dances 
 and festivals. 
 
 It is usually the largest and cleanest house in the village, and 
 generally empty at night, so that travellers prefer it to one of the 
 smaller and more dirty and crowded houses. In the present case 
 we were quartered in it very comfortably. 
 
 We immediately sent out our teakettle, in this country always 
 made of copper, and universally known as the chyuik, — tea be- 
 ing chy in the Russian, a derivative from the original Chinese 
 cliah. 
 
 Chy being ready, we imbibed deeply, and filling up the chynik 
 with water we dispensed the diluted fluid to our native friends, in 
 the bountiful tin cups provided by the Company. A small hand- 
 ful of broken biscuit added to the acceptability of the treat and 
 disguised the weakness of the chy. This is the invariable and 
 expected tribute to the hospitality of the natives from all travellers 
 who avail themselves of the casine and other accommodations of 
 the village ; for which the Innuit have not yet learned to charge 
 by the night's lodging. 
 
 iXppreciating the banquet, and warmed to enthusiasm by the 
 hot water, an old blear-eyed individual seized an article something 
 between a drum and a tambourine, and began to beat upon it with 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 17 
 
 one 
 
 of 
 
 ■e about 
 .11 rocky 
 'it6i\.'nik, 
 is quite 
 labitants 
 of ways, 
 These 
 (cks that 
 o\v tide. 
 
 if graves 
 ze of the 
 
 ilding is 
 
 
 -al work- 
 
 '\ 
 
 serai for 
 
 
 il dances 
 
 i^ 
 
 lage, and 
 
 
 le of the 
 
 
 lent case 
 
 
 y always 
 
 
 ~ tea be- 
 
 
 Chinese 
 
 
 
 1 
 
 e chynik 
 
 
 icnds, in 
 
 
 dl hand- 
 
 \ 
 
 reat and 
 
 
 ihlc and 
 
 ij 
 
 ravcUcrs 
 
 
 tions of 
 
 ■A 
 
 ) charge 
 
 '•. 
 
 1 by the 
 
 ■5 
 
 nething 
 
 ' 
 
 I it with 
 
 1 
 
 a long elastic rod. He was joined by all the old men in the 
 vicinity, in a dismal chorus of 
 
 Ung hi y;il), ah ha yah, yah yah yah, «S:c., 
 
 keeping time upon his drum with an energy which .showed that the 
 vigor of his youth had not departed from him. 
 
 Four or five of the young men began to dance, posturing in 
 different attitudes, moving their arms and legs, stamping on the 
 floor, all in perfect accord with one another, and keeping accurate 
 time with the drum. We were too tired, however, to appreciate 
 this exhibition, and signified as much to the company, who finally 
 (eft us to enjoy a good night's rest. 
 
 Tuesday, ()t/i. — We were awakened by an officious native, who 
 put his head in, bawling at the top of his lungs that the weather 
 was bad, very bad indeed, and that we could not get away to- 
 [lay ; after which pleasing piece of information he left us to our 
 own reflections. 
 
 On getting up and going out I found that the sky was clouiiy 
 and the wind adverse, and ordering one of our Mdhlemuts to put 
 on the chynik, I went down and reported the situation, which 
 involved our remaining a day or two where we were. Breakfast, 
 consisting of chy, with sugar, — but of course no milk, — biscuit, 
 and a savory jMcce of bacon, was duly discussed ; and after a com- 
 forting i^ipe, we were quite ready to bear our detention with the 
 true voyageur's philosophy. 
 
 I went out, and soon made the acquaintance, by signs and the 
 very few native words which I had picked up, of a fine-looking 
 young IMahlemut, who was also on his way to Unalakh'k with his 
 family. The interview commenced by his begging for a little 
 tobacco, upon receiving which he was so delighted as to take me 
 to his tent, a poor little atfair, made of unbleached sheeting pro- 
 cured from the Russians. Here he introduced me by signs to his 
 wife and cliild, the latter about two years old. The former was 
 not particularly ugly or pretty, but was engaged in manufacturing 
 tinder, which rather detracted from the neatness of lier person. 
 This tinder is made out of the fur of the rabbit, the down from the 
 seed-vessels of the river poplar, or cotton lint obtained from the 
 Russians ; either of which is rubbed up with charcoal and water, 
 with a very little gunpowder, and then dried. The rubbing i)ro- 
 
i8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 i i' 
 
 I) f 
 
 cess was just going on, and I was thankful that etiquette did not 
 require hand-shaking, among the Innuit of Norton Sound. The 
 husband was a fine-looking, athletic fellow, standing about five 
 feet five inches, with a clear brunette complexion, fine color, dark 
 eyes, and finely arched eyebrows. The flat nose, common to all 
 the Eskimo tribes, was not very strongly marked in him, and a 
 pleasant smile displaying two rows of very white teeth conquered 
 any objection I might have felt to his large mouth. The baby 
 looked like any other Ijaby, and was notable only from never show- 
 ing any disposition to disturb the peace. 
 
 Returning after awhile to the casine, I observed that the aper- 
 ture in the roof was closed by a covering composed of the intestines 
 of seals, cut down on one side, cleaned, oiled, and sewed together 
 into a sheet, which is sufficiently translucent to admit the light 
 while it retains the warm air. 
 
 The universal salutation of the Innuit is Chanimi ! Cluimmi ! 
 and as likely as not, some greasy old fellow will hug you like 
 a brother upon a first meeting. As they are given to raising a 
 certain kind of live-stock, this method of proceeding is not likely 
 to suit the fastidious. 
 
 A note arrived from Westdahl by a native, one of his crew, 
 saying that on account of rough weather he had been obliged 
 to put into a small cove, .some miles south of us, had cut his 
 bidarra on the rocks and wet almost everything. 
 
 Ketchum immediately despatched four men with a needle, some 
 twisted thread made of deer sinew, called gila, and a piece of seal- 
 skin prepared for use, technically known as Itivtdk. These, with 
 some grease to rub on the seam, are all that is needed to repair 
 any injury done to the skin of a bidarra or bidiirka. 
 
 Wednesday, \oth. — The water of the little cove in front of the 
 village was white with foam when we rose in the morning : evi- 
 dently we were not to get away yet. We walked over to a small 
 bay on the other side of the point on which Kegiktcnvruk is situ- 
 ated. Mere we found a cache, that is to say, a kind of small log en- 
 closure about six feet square, covered with logs held down by heavy 
 stones. In it were the bodies of four small hair seal, called m'rpa 
 by the Russians and niksuk by the Mahlemuts. They are covered 
 with short, stiff hair of a greenish silvery tinge, with darker spots 
 surrounded by dark rings, especially on the back. The young are 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 19 
 
 very beautiful, covered with long, silky, silvery hair, softer than in 
 the adult and without the dark spots. They are about eighteen 
 inches long, and the adults not more than four feet. The flippers 
 have five long nails and are covered with hair like that on the 
 body. The eye of the seal is black, very large and liquid, 
 almost human in its expression, and the whiskers are placed like 
 those on a cat ; the bristles are perfectly transparent, three-sided 
 and twisted, looking like glass threads, about four inches long. 
 The blood of these seal is very black, and so is the flesh, both 
 having a slightly disagreeable odor when fresh. They are caught 
 in rawhide nets. There is a much larger seal (like Plioca jubata) 
 which is called maklok by the natives ; the name has been 
 frequently applied to both species, but erroneously. The fat or 
 blubber is about an inch and a half thick, very white and firm. 
 The natives eat it, as well as the meat, and trade it with the 
 Indians of the interior. The oil is used for burning, and the 
 casine is lighted by means of four saucer-shaped dishes full of 
 dry moss or sphagnum soaked in this oil, which give out quite 
 as much smoke as light. 
 
 Returning, our attention was attracted by the numerous 
 graves. These are well worth the careful attention of the eth- 
 nologist ; many of them are very old. The usual fashion is to 
 place the body, doubled up, on its side, in a box of plank hewed 
 out of spruce logs and about four feet long ; this is elevated sev- 
 eral feet above the ground on four posts, which project above the 
 coffin or box. The sides are often painted with red chalk, in fig- 
 ures of fur animals, birds, and fishes. According to the wealth 
 of the dead man, a number of articles which belonged to him are 
 attached to the coffin or strewed around it. Some of them have 
 kyaks, bows and arrows, hunting implements, snowshoes or even 
 kettles, around the grave or fastened to it ; and almost invariably 
 the wooden dish, or kaiitdi^, from which the deceased was accus- 
 tomed to cat is hung on one of the posts. 
 
 There are many more graves than present inhabitants of the 
 village, and the story is that the whole coast was once much more 
 densely populated. 
 
 On arriving at the casine we met some men carrying long sticks 
 of light-wood, and were requested to remove our bedding and other 
 traps from the building, as the inhabitants were about to take a 
 
 
20 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 bath. This we did, much to our disgust, and adjourned to one of 
 the houses till it should be over, as a cold wind was blowing. 
 
 These baths are made by building a very hot fire in the casine, 
 the middle part of the floor being removable, so that the earth 
 may be exposed. Here the fire is built, and when it has sub- 
 sided into coals the gut cover before mentioned is put over the 
 smoke-hole, and the inmates proceed to bathe themselves in an 
 unmentionable liquid, which is carefully saved for this and other 
 purposes. Strange as it may appear, this habit was not con- 
 tracted without reason, for the alkaline properties of this fluid 
 combine with the oil with which they are smeared, and form a 
 soapy lather, which cleanses as thoroughly as soap, which they 
 cannot obtain, and removes the dirt, which water alone would not 
 do. After this they wash off" with water and retire to certain 
 shelves, which are placed near the roof of the building, and repose, 
 wrapped in a deerskin, until the lassitude produced by the bath 
 passes away. 
 
 We waited as long as possible before entering the casine, but as 
 evening came on we were obliged to return to it. As might be 
 supposed, the ammoniacal odor was nearly stifling, and only the 
 raw. blustering weather prevented us from sleeping outside. 
 
 Thursday, wth. — To our great delight the sea had gone 
 down a good deal and the wind was fair. We bundled our 
 
 things 
 
 into 
 
 the boat, and although short-handed — two of our 
 
 men having remained with Westdahl — we put out about eight 
 o'clock, and just as we rounded the point saw the other boats, 
 which had repaired damages, following. The character of the 
 shore is abrupt and rocky from the Redoubt to Kegiktowruk, 
 thence to Golsova River, known by the two small islets or rather 
 rocks in the vicinity, and finally around Tolstoi Point to a 
 place called Topanika. There are very few points at which 
 a boat, especially a skin boat, can land even in perfectly smooth 
 weather, and in rough weather only two between Tolstoi Point 
 and the Redoubt. The first of these is the Major's Cove, so 
 named because it was the first point .it which Major Kennicott 
 landed, after leaving St. Michael's with his party. The other 
 is Kegiktowruk. We passed Tolstoi Point and reached To- 
 panika in safety. Here there is, except at high tide, a narrow, 
 shelving beach, backed by perpendicular walls of sandstone in 
 
 ■I 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 21 
 
 gone 
 our 
 our 
 eight 
 3oats, 
 of the 
 5\vruk, 
 ather 
 to a 
 which 
 mooth 
 Point 
 v'c, so 
 nicott 
 other 
 To- 
 irrow, 
 ne in 
 
 bluffs from twenty to one hundred feet high. This beach con- 
 tinues all the way to the mouth of the Unalaklik River, the bluff 
 growing gradually lower, until near the mouth of the river there 
 is only a marshy plain behind the beach. As the wind was light 
 we sent two of our men ashore with a long mahout line to "track" 
 the boats along the beach. We were now about ten English miles 
 from Unalaklik. The wind blowing fair and freshening, we took 
 our men on board and made a straight course for the mouth of the 
 river. Meanwhile it was growing dark. I had been snoozing 
 under a deerskin for an hour or two, as the air was very cold, 
 but finally took up the paddle to warm myself, when Kctchum's 
 experienced ear caught the crunch of ice, and in a minute we were 
 into it. Large cakes about four inches thick covered the surface of 
 the water, and we all had our hands full in staving them off, as 
 they would have sunk the boat had they nipped us. We were not 
 far from shore ; the lights at the trading-post at the mouth of 
 the river were plainly visible. We fired several shots, but appar- 
 ently without rousing any one, and were obliged to go nearly a 
 mile north of the post to find a bit of beach sufficiently clear of 
 ice to land upon. Having succeeded in hauling the boat above 
 high-water mark, we stumbled amongst the driftwood with which 
 the beach was strewn, up to the fort or trading-post, which 
 was closed, every one being asleep. We soon roused them, how- 
 ever, and after a regale of tea and bread I appropriated the bed 
 of a Russian, and sank to slumber, surrounded and overrun by 
 not less than thirty thousand adult cockroaches and their families. 
 
 I-'riday, \2tli. — Rose with the determination of going some- 
 where where there were no tarakdiioff, as the Russians call the 
 insects with which their apartment was infested. I obtained a 
 tent, pitched it, and moved most of my traps out into it. Planted 
 a flag-pole and threw the ensign of the Scientific Corps to the 
 breeze, with the resolution to carry the blue cross and scallop, 
 before the year was out, where no other flag had yet floated, if 
 that were possible. 
 
 I began to provide myself with suitable clothing, such as the 
 natives wear. First, an arU'i^i, or pdrha, as the Russians call it. 
 This is a shirt of dressed deerskin, with the hair on, coming down 
 to the knees, and to be confined by a belt around the waist. 
 There is no opening in the breast or back, but a hood large 
 
 f 
 
 
22 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 "l ■'! 
 
 enough to cover the head, which may be pushed back when not 
 needed. This garment is trimmed around the skirt, wrists, and 
 hood with strips of white deerskin and wolverine or wolfskin, 
 both of which are highly prized for the purpose. Around the 
 hood the wolfskin is broad and taken from the back of the animal, 
 where the longest hairs are barred with white and black, which, 
 when the hood is drawn up, makes a kind of halo about the face 
 which is not unbecoming. When travelling, these long hairs 
 shield the face from a side wind to a surprising extent. The 
 parka is exceedingly warm, and the wind does not penetrate it ; 
 while in exceedingly cold weather a light one, made of fawn-skin, 
 or zvipcrotky, as the Russians term it, may be worn with the hair 
 turned in, inside of the usual garment, which is made of various 
 skins, according to the fancy. The fall skin of the young deer, 
 known as nccdrcss, is the most common and perhaps the best. 
 The skins of Parry's marmot {Spcnnophilus Parryi) and the musk- 
 rat (Fiber dbcthicus) are praised for their durability, and wipe- 
 rotky parkies are neat and light, but do not last long. On the 
 whole the needress is as strong, durable, and warm as any, and 
 almost as handsome when well trimmed. 
 
 The next most important articles are the torbassd or Eskimo 
 boots. These are made of the skin of the reindeer's legs, where 
 the hair is short, smooth, and stiff. These are sewed together to 
 make the tops of the boots, which come up nearly to the knee, 
 where they are tied. The sole is made of sealskin, or luvtak pre- 
 pared in the same way as for making boats. This sole is turned 
 over at heel and toe, and gathered like the skirt of a dress, so as to 
 protect those parts, and brought up on each side. It is of course 
 nearly waterproof and rather durable, but can be easily replaced in 
 half an hour by a new one if iiccessary. It is wetted before being 
 sewed, which makes the sealskin flexible, and the proper formation 
 of the toe is aided by the teeth of the seamstress. In wearing 
 these boots, which are made much larger than the foot, a pad of 
 dry grass, folded to the shape of the sole, is worn under the foot. 
 This absorbs any moisture, serves as a non-conductor, and protects 
 the foot from the inequalities of ice or the soil. The whole fur- 
 nishes a warm and comfortable covering, indispensable to winter 
 travel. There are a pair of strings, one on each side, which are 
 tied about the ankle, supporting it and preventing the foot from 
 slipping about in the boot. 
 
 -s 
 
 il 
 
THE VUKOX TERRITORY. 
 
 23 
 
 toot, 
 tects 
 
 fiir- 
 1 liter 
 
 are 
 roni 
 
 Deerskin breeches arc worn by the natives, but are rarely 
 needed by white men when provided with clothing of ordinary 
 warmth and thickness. 
 
 The value of a good parka is at present about six dollars. 
 Boots and other articles are usually obtained by barter. Ten 
 musket-balls and a few caps are the regular price for a pair of 
 torbassa, a pair of deerskin mittens being worth from four to six 
 balls ; ornamental gloves and other articles are more or less 
 costly, according to the amount of work and the scarcity of the 
 article at the time. So far, the natives have not yet learned to 
 make a well-shaped thumb to gloves and mittens, a triangular 
 shapeless protuberance serving their needs, but they may be easily 
 taught a better mode of manufacture. 
 
 A deer or bear skin in the raw, dry state is used as a bed, and 
 a blanket of dressed deer or rabbit skins, in addition to a pair of 
 woollen ones, completes the list of articles needed for winter 
 travel, though a small pillow is a great addition to one's com- 
 fort. A deerskin is worth, at the regular price, about si.xty 
 cents. 
 
 For a number of days nothing occurred of special interest. 
 Captain Ketchum delayed starting across the portage to the 
 Yukon for NuUito, as it was still doubtful whether all the small 
 rivers were securely frozen over. I found my nights in the tent 
 not uncomfortable, though the thermometer ranged from twenty- 
 eight to zero of Fahrenheit. Waking one morning, I found myself 
 so deeply snowed up that I had a good deal of difficulty in get- 
 ting out of the tent. It proved to be only a drift, however. A 
 tin dipper of water frozen the first night showed no signs of 
 melting. 
 
 The Russian trading-post at this point is much smaller than 
 the Redoubt. It is in rather a decayed condition, and has only 
 two glass windows, the remainder being made of gut, as used by 
 the natives. Glass is a rare article here. 
 
 The stockade is built after the same plan as that at St. 
 Michael's, and encloses one barrack building, with a room for 
 the commander, a store, cook-house, bath-house, and a shed for 
 storing oil, &c. ; it is defended by two square bastions pierced 
 for cannon. The guns had lately been removed, and the 
 turrets fitted up for the accommodation of our officers. They 
 
 :v- 
 
 I 
 
 ■I! 
 
 ,'l 
 
24 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I , 
 
 were of the most antiquated description, and likely to do as 
 much damage by the breech as by the muzzle. 
 
 The fort is situated on the right bank of the Unalakli'k River, 
 where it empties into Norton Sound. It is said to have been 
 built in 1840 and 1841. 
 
 To the north are two assemblages of houses occujMed by Innuit 
 of the Kaviak, IMdhlemut, and Unaleet tribes during part of the 
 year, the latter being the only permanent residents. The village 
 was formerly situated on the left bank of the river, but, an epi- 
 demic occurring, they removed and built new houses on the 
 north side. The remains of the old houses and the graves may 
 be distinctly traced. 
 
 The steamer Wilder, with the assistance of several hundred 
 natives and our own party, under the direction of Captain Smith, 
 had been hauled up on the beach beyond the reach of the ice, 
 and might be considered as in winter quarters. 
 
 The Cantain, who was an enthusiastic and successful sportsman, 
 gave me the first specimens I had seen of the beautiful snow- 
 white arctic grouse {Lngopiis a/l'iis), which may be started in 
 coveys on all the plains around the mouth of the river. 
 
 The beach at Unalakli'k is shelving and saudy, and is bounded 
 by a ridge, on which the houses are built. Back of ihis ridge the 
 land is knv, and overflowed for some distance when the freshets 
 occur in the spring ; beyond this low strip, which is parallel 
 with the beach, it rises .slowly and evenly, culminating in the 
 ridges of the Shaktolik hills, which trend in a northeast and 
 southwesterly direction, and attaii. a height of about a thousand 
 feet above the .".ea. Several miles north of the river tiiey come 
 down to the shore in high bluffs of gray sandstone. The coun- 
 try to the south, already mentioned, is much the .same, though 
 the hills are farther inland and attain a higher elevation. I'^rom 
 the beach near the fort, Hesborough Island may be seen standing 
 sharply and precipitously out of the sea, about thirty miles north- 
 northwest. Mgg Island and Stuart's Island, to the southwest, ore 
 so low that it is only on a very clear day, with a faint mirage 
 to elevate them, that they can be distinguished. Covereil with 
 snow and without trees, the ea.sy slopes and gracefully rouiuli'd 
 hills have an aspect of serene beauty ; the etfect on a calm moon- 
 light evening is delightful. 
 
 .1 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Thursday, October 25///, — Captain Ketchum having made up 
 his mind to an early start across the portage, we entered on the 
 necessary preparations for our journey. Appointing Lieutenant 
 V. M. Smith Acting Surgeon for the Unalal<h'k party, I divided 
 our exceedingly insutticient supply of medicines with liim. The 
 liberal scale on wiiich everything was purchased allowed of no ex- 
 cuse for the inefficiency and red tape whi :h left fifty men for a year, 
 in a country where nothing of the kind was obtainable, with a sup- 
 ply of medicines which could be packed into a Manila cigar-box. 
 
 The proposed party for Nulato was composed of Cajitain 
 Ketclium in charge of that division, Mr. Frederick Whymper 
 the artist of the Expedition, Mr. Francis the engineer of the 
 W'il.ler, Lieutenant Michael Lebargj, a constructor who may be 
 called Scratchett, and myself. Mr. Dyer the quartermaster pro- 
 posed t^o join us later in the season. It will doubtless be noticed 
 that this comprised some six officers to one man, but it must 
 be recollected that the work laid out for the coming year in our 
 division compreheniled only exploration, and that we relied on 
 ihc Indians in the vicinity of Nulato for such manual labor as 
 we should need. The following season we expected to receive a 
 large number of constructors, who should proceed to build the 
 line as soon as the route was determined. 
 
 We intended tJ travel with dogs and sleds, the universal and 
 onlv practicable mode of winter transportation in this country. 
 The sleils, harness, and so forth, 1 shall take another opportunity 
 of describing miiuitely, and will only state at present that the 
 tlogs are about tiic size of those of Newfoundland, with shorter 
 legs, and of all colors, from white, gray, and piebald to black. 
 They are harnessed to the sled on each siv'" of a line, to which 
 the traces are attached, — two and two, \ ith a leader in front; 
 and the usual number is either live or seven, according to the 
 lo:ul. Tiu'v will draw when in good condition abmit one hun- 
 dred pounds apiece with the help of the driver, who seldom rides, 
 luiless over a smooth bit of ice or with an emjity sled The sleds 
 of the l'",skimo are heavy, and shod with bone sawed tiom the 
 upper edge of the jaw of the bowhead whale. These bones are 
 obtained in tiie vicinity of Hering .Strait, and good oiu;s are (piite 
 valuable. The remaiiuler of the sled is nuule of spruce wood. 
 Tiiey will carry from six to eight hundred pounds. The sleds 
 
 ; 'IS 
 
 \\- 
 
26 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 1' 1 
 
 i) I, 
 
 used in the interior are mucli lighter and differently constructed. 
 The Eskimo sleds are suitable only for travelling over ice and 
 the hard snow of the coast. 
 
 Saturday, 2-jth. — Having loaded four sleds and finding the 
 number of dogs insufficient, we sent down to the village and pro- 
 cured an additional supply, seizing any stray dog whose owners 
 were not forthcoming, and pressing him into the service. About 
 eleven o'clock, just as we were ready to start, an old woman, howl- 
 ing dismally, cut the harness of one of these conscripts and let him 
 go. He was, however, immediately secured, the old woman paci- 
 fied with a small present of tobacco ; and with a salute of one gun 
 from the fort and a volley of revolver shots from our friends we 
 started up the Unalaklik River on the ice. We got along very well, 
 with the usual number of small casualties, such as the loss of one 
 or two of the vicious dogs, who gnawed their harness in two. uo ) 
 the breaking of the bones With which some of the sleds were 
 shod. We proceeded until darkness and ?n open jpot in the 
 river arrested our progress, and we camped on the bank for 
 the night. The atmosphere being about ten below zero, we 
 all relished our tea, biscuit, and bacon, and the ever-grateful pipe 
 which followed it, before retiring. No tents are used in the 
 winter, as they become coated with ice from the breath of the 
 sleepers and are also liable to take fire ; so, pulling our blankets 
 over our heads, we slept very comfortably, with nothing above us 
 except the branches of the spruce-trees and the canopy of the sky. 
 The trees commence as soon as we get sufficiently far up the river 
 to be out of the way of the coast winds and salt air, and are prin- 
 cipally willows, birch, poplar, and spruce. 
 
 Sunday, 28///. — Woke to the disagreeable discovery that four 
 of our dogs had taken advantage of the darkness to gnaw their 
 sealskin harnesses and decamp to Unalaklik. Pushing n, literally, 
 w'th only three dogs, and five hundred pounds on the sled, I found 
 rather hard work for a beginner. At last, about noon, we arrived 
 at the first Indian village, called Ikti'galik, where we unloaded our 
 sleds, fed our dogs, and went into an Indian house built after the 
 Eskimo fashion and very clean and comfortable. 
 
 Iktigalik is a fishing village with a large, population in sumuier 
 than in winter. On the left bank of the river, which is about six 
 lumdred feet wide, arc eight or ten summer houses, built on the 
 
 # 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 27 
 
 J 
 
 
 kcts 
 
 m 
 
 c us 
 
 m 
 
 sky. 
 
 m 
 
 iver 
 
 iffir 
 
 jrin- 
 
 JB^y 
 
 
 '. ■*•' 
 
 foiir 
 
 %r 
 
 lii>ir 
 
 
 ally. 
 
 v'^^^P 
 
 iind 
 
 
 ivod 
 
 
 our 
 
 9 
 
 the 
 
 1 
 
 iiicr 
 
 
 six 
 
 M 
 
 the 
 
 1 
 
 i)ank, of split spruce logs driven into the ground, and roofed 
 with birch bark. The door is at the end facing the river, and is 
 an oval opening some three feet high. The houses are about 
 twelve feet square and entirely above ground, as in summer the 
 underground houses are full of water. Behind these houses are 
 the caches, called kradoivoi by the Russians. They are simply 
 small houses, about six feet square and high, elevated from six to 
 ten feet above the ground on four upright posts. They are well 
 roofed and are used only as storehouses for provisions, dry fish, 
 and furs, and are thus elevated in order that dampness or field- 
 mice may not gain access to them ; much like an old-fashioned 
 corn-crib. Frames are also erected where the sleds, boats, and 
 snow-shoes may be put out of the way of the dogs, who are always 
 on the alert for any animal substance, and will cat sealskin and 
 even tanned leather wi*h avidity, even when moderately well 
 fed. 
 
 On ihe other side of the river are two winter houses and several 
 caches. One of these houses was the property of an old and 
 rather wealthy Indian, as Indians go, who had been christened 
 Ami'lka by the Russians. Ami'lka was anxious to obtain the title 
 of Tyoiu; or chief, which is here merely a title ai.d conveys no 
 authority except what age and wealth may bring with it. He 
 liad been invested with the title by the explorers during the pre- 
 vious season, and, though an exceedingly mean old fellow, had 
 been of some assistance to them. In the house with him were his 
 wife, a very fine-looking Indian woman of considm'able intelli- 
 gence ; and a young f'dlow called Ingechuk by the Russians, who 
 had a wife about four feet high, of whom he was exceedingly 
 fond and jealous. The other occupants were an intelligent fellow 
 Known as Andrea, and his wife, an old, very ugly, but dignified 
 .ind hospitable woman. On our entering, she ordered some one 
 to clear a place, and spreading out .1 clean grass mat motioned to 
 us to be seated. Without relaxing her diligent oversight of the 
 children around her, of her work, or of a kettle that was boiling 
 by the fire, she sent out to the cache and obtained some dried 
 backfat of the reindeer, the greatest delicacy in this part of the 
 world ; cutting it into pieces of uniform size, she placed it on a 
 clean wooden dish and handed it to us, with an air of quiet dig- 
 nity quite unaffected, and as elegant as that ilisplayed by many a 
 
28 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 civilized dame when doing the honors of a palace. No return 
 was asked or expected, but a present of a few leaves of tobacco 
 was received with thanks. The backfat, when toasted over the 
 fire, has a rich nutty flavor and is extremely good. 
 
 The other house was occupied by a dirty old rascal called 
 Matfdy, and another, equally dirty and more stupid, called Meesh- 
 ka. Matfdy bore his greedy and deceitful disposition plainly im- 
 pressed on his countenance, and evidently felt aggrieved that we 
 had not honored his house with our presence, instead of sending 
 our Mahlemuts there, who would make him no presents. 
 
 Ketchum had actually gone into his place at first, thinking, as 
 the honse was new, that it would be the cleaner of the two ; but 
 after a , r • 't it had beaten a hasty retreat. 
 
 These i is belong to a branch of the family of Ti'nneh, or 
 
 Chippewayauo, similar to those of Mackenzie River ; their tribal 
 name is Ingalik, or, in their own language, Kaiyuh-khataiia, or 
 people of the lowlands. The tribe extends from the edge of 
 the wooded district near the sea to and across the Yukon be- 
 low Nulato, on the Yukon and its affluents to the head of the 
 delta, and across the portage to the Kuskoquim River and its 
 branches. Many of the adults have been christened, but not 
 Christianized, by the missionaries of the Greek Church, and are 
 usually known by their Russian names. They retain and use 
 among themselves, however, their original Indian names. 
 
 Monday, 2qth. — After a long night's rest, woke a good deal 
 refreshed, though rather stiff, and enjoyed our breakfast thor- 
 oughly. Francis and myself took a walk some distance up the 
 river, finding many open places in the ice. After our return I 
 made a few sketches of the houses and Indians, and obtained a 
 beginning of a vocabulary of Ingalik words. These Indians all 
 understand a little Russian, and by this means are enabled to 
 communicate with the whites. No one in the territory under- 
 stands any English. The Innuit, especially the Mahlemut dia- 
 lect, is so easy to acquire that the fur-traders learn it in prefer- 
 ence to attempting the difficult task of teaching them Russian. 
 Very few of the Innuit understand any Russian, while almost all 
 the Russians understand some I'^skimo, On the othei hand, 
 the Indian dialect is so much harder to learn than the Russian, 
 that the Indians pick up Russian with facility, while none of the 
 
 I 
 
 I 
 
 I 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 29 
 
 
 Russians, except an old interpreter named Tcle'ezhik, know more 
 tiian a few words of the Indian dialects. 
 
 In the afternoon Ingechuk brought us some white grouse and 
 some fresh reindeer meat. Of the latter a delicious dish was con- 
 cocted, which I will describe for the benefit of future explorers. 
 It was invented by the members of Kennicott's party during the 
 first year's explorations. The frozen reindeer meat was cut into 
 small cubes about half an inch in diameter. An equal amount of 
 backfat was treated in the same way. Hardly covered with 
 water, this was simmered in a stewpan for nearly an hour ; water, 
 pepper, and salt being added as needed. When nearly done, a 
 little more water was added, and the finely broken biscuit from the 
 bottom of the bread-bag slowly stirred in, until the whole of the 
 gravy was absorbed. This done, we sat down to enjoy a dish 
 which would have awakened enthusiasm at the table of Lucullus. 
 It was known among the initiated as " telegraph stew," and the 
 mere mention of its name would no doubt touch, in the breast of 
 any one of them, a chord of electric sympathy. 
 
 The Russian name for the reindeer is alctu', perhaps derived 
 from the French. These deer are migratory, feeding on the twigs 
 of the willow and the fine white moss, or rather lichen, which is to 
 be found on every hillside. They frequent the hills during the 
 summer, and are driven thence only by the mosquitoes to seek 
 refuge in the water. In the fall and winter they prefer the more 
 sheltered valleys, and appear on the plains in immense herds in 
 the spring. 
 
 Tiicsdity, y:)tlt. — Walked down the river, and, looking into some 
 deserted Indian huts, obtained some exquisite green mosses anil 
 lichens which were flourishing there notwithstanding the cold 
 weather. 
 
 A number of sleds arrived from Unalaklik, bringing a large 
 amount of goods and provisions for transmission to Nuhito. 
 
 On the rolling plain between the summer houses and the bases 
 of the Uli'ikuk Hills I found the larch {Larix microcarpa ^ ) grow- 
 ing sparingly to the height of twelve feet, and abundance of alders. 
 The snow-covered sides of these symmetrical hills stood out witli 
 striking beauty against the dark clouds which formed the back- 
 ground of a rich crimson and purple sunset. 
 
 \\\tiiicsiiay, i\st. — Ketchum decided to send back all the heavy 
 
 I: 
 
30 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Mahlemut sleds, and kept nine dogs to assist us in taking the 
 goods up to Nulcito on the light Ingalik sleds. The weather, being 
 above the freezing point, was so warm as to render the prospect 
 of our being able to cross the Uliikuk River on the ice rather 
 dubious ; it would have been useless to start until we could cross 
 it, as it is only a few miles from Ikti'galik. After the sleds had 
 started for Unalaklik, we let out the dogs from an empty summer 
 lodge where they had been confined to prevent their following 
 their comrades down the river. 
 
 At this period of our explorations arose the famous controversy 
 between two of our party, in regard to the relative merits of beans 
 and rice as articles of food. However insignificant the subject, 
 such was the earnestness and even eloquence developed on both 
 sides, such was the array of facts brought forward to sustain the 
 several arguments, that the interest of every one was awakened 
 in the discussion. This lasted late into the night, and was renewed 
 immediately the following morning. I am sorry to be obliged to 
 record, however, that, as in many other discussions, both literary 
 and scientific, no definite result was arrived at, although each was 
 convinced against his will of the valuable properties of the escu- 
 lent defended by his opponent. 
 
 Thursday, Novanbcr \st. — The weather was still warm and snow 
 fplling fast. We made the discovery that nine or ten of our dogs 
 had apparently decided to hold a town meeting in Unalaklik, and 
 had accordingly left for that place. This was exceedingly pro- 
 voking, as it would render our starting impossible in the event of 
 a sudden cold snap. I therefore proposed to Ketchum to go 
 back to Unalaklik and get the dogs, and Francis offered to do the 
 same thing. The decision was postponed till the next day. 
 Ketchum, finding dry fish likely to be scarce, called on the Indians 
 to bring out what they had to spare, and purchased it. This fish 
 is principally .salmon and some small white fish, and is dried in 
 the sun without smoke or salt. It is the principal staple of food, 
 under the name of I'lkali, for all travellers, both men and dogs ; 
 being very light and portable, yet full of oil ; of not the most 
 agreeable flavor, it is at least strong if not strengthening. Occa- 
 sionally one does get hold of a clean, well-dried ukali, that tastes 
 very well when broiled over the fire ; though in my own case the 
 use of it invariably produced heartburn. The ration for a dog is 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 31 
 
 snow 
 
 dogs 
 
 I, and 
 
 pro- 
 fit of 
 go 
 the 
 
 day. 
 dians 
 s fish 
 cd in 
 
 food, 
 dogs ; 
 
 most 
 Occa- 
 tastes 
 ■e the 
 log is 
 
 one salmon weighing from a pound and a half to two pounds, or 
 as many smaller fish as will amount to the same. They will travel 
 on less, but the best policy is to feed your dogs well, and you may 
 then, with proper attention, be sure that they will work well and 
 rarely run away. 
 
 At this time Ketchum made an arrangement with Lofka, a 
 newly arrived Indian, and Andrea, to accompany him in a pro- 
 posed winter trip up the Yukon, and paid them partly in advance. 
 
 Friday, 2d. — Francis and I started at nine o'clock for Unala- 
 klik to bring back the missing dogs. Found the walking good but 
 wet, and we occasionally had to take to the bank. The distance 
 is twenty-two English miles in a direct line, but at least thirty by 
 the river, which is exceedingly tortuous. We arrived at the post 
 at two o'clock, just in time for a glorious Russian bath and a hot 
 cup of tea. These baths are an institution to be proud of Every 
 Russian trading-post in the territory is furnished with a bath-house, 
 and once a week all the inmates avail themselves of it. As they 
 reckon time according to Old Style in the Russian colonies, their 
 Sunday falls on our Saturday, and as a consequence bath-day 
 comes on Friday. The apparatus is very simple. A rude arch 
 of loose stones, of the hardest obtainable kind, is built, and more 
 stones piled over it, so that a fire made beneath the arch can pen- 
 etrate between them. There is no chimney, but a trap-door in 
 the roof A large cask full of water heated for the purpose, and 
 another of cold water, generally with ice floating in it, and a suc- 
 cession of benches one abov^e the other, complete the equipment. 
 When the stones are thoroughly heated and the smoke has all 
 passed out, all coals are removed and the trap-door is shut ; any 
 smoke or coals remaining will make the eyes smart and the bath 
 very uncomfortable. Each one leaves his clothing in an outer 
 room, and on entering wets his head and throws hot water on 
 the heated stones until as much steam is produced as he can 
 bear, lie then mounts as high on the benches as he finds com- 
 fortable, and the perspiration issues from every pore. He then 
 takes a sort of broom or bunch of dried mint or birch twigs, with 
 the leaves still on them, which is prepared at the proper season 
 and called miUiiik. With this he thrashes himself until all im- 
 purities are thoroughly loosened from the skin, and finishes with 
 a wash oft" in hot water and soap. Then taking a kantag, or 
 
 H." 
 
 If 
 
 
I ■ 
 
 i r 
 
 ) i, 
 
 :'::■ 
 
 1' .' 
 
 32 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 wooden dish, full of ice-cold water, he dashes it over himself and 
 rushes out into the dressing-room. This last process is disagree- 
 able to the uninitiated, but is absolutely necessary to prevent tak- 
 ing cold. I have known cases of acute rheumatism brought on by 
 omitting it. The dressing-room is spread with straw and always 
 communicates with the outer air. The temperature is often many 
 degrees below zero ; but such is the activity of the circulation, that 
 one dresses in perfect comfort notwithstanding. A warm dressing- 
 room would be insupportable. 
 
 These baths cannot be recommended for those with a tendency 
 to heart disease or apoplexy, but to persons in a healthy condition 
 the effect is delightful ; rheumatic patients are frequently cured by 
 their means, with proper precautions. One of these baths will re- 
 move all traces of extreme exertion or fatigue as if by magic, and 
 they may be advantageously followed by a few cups of hot tea 
 and an hour's repose. 
 
 After our bath we found to our disgust that the dogs had been 
 sent back, thanks to the energy of Mr, Dyer, and must have passed 
 us on the way, while making a short portage. The weather be- 
 coming disagreeable, we were soon reconciled to our disappoint- 
 ment, and were snugly ensconced in one of the bastions, which 
 had been hung with reindeer skins for comfort and warmth dur- 
 ing the severe winter, relating our experiences over the ever- 
 grateful cup of tea, while the sleet was driving and the storm 
 howled outside. 
 
 Saturday, yi. — The weather continued warm and disagreeable. 
 The ice was very wet and bad, and we concluded not to return to 
 Ikti'galik to-day. The village beyond Iktigalik is called Ulukuk, 
 and many of the Russians call the former village New Ulukuk, as 
 it was built since the latter, by Ulukuk Indians, the point being a 
 good one for the fisheries. 
 
 The mouth of the Unalakli'k River is obstructed by a bar, over 
 which at low tide there is only a few feet of water, except in a 
 narrow and tortuous channel, which is continually changing as 
 the river deposits fresh detritus. Inside of this bar we get two 
 or three fathoms of water for a few miles, but the river has only a 
 few feet in the channel, most of the summer, from the mouth to 
 Ulukuk. The tide-water comes up a mile or two, and from this 
 cause it is difficult at times to procure fresh water for drinking 
 
 ?i 
 
 1 
 
 i 
 
 "I 
 
 •I 
 
 -« 
 
THE YUKON TERRITOKV. 
 
 '1 -> 
 
 purposes, as the well water is disagreeably brackish. The same 
 trouble is found at St. Michael's, where the only good water is 
 obtained from springs on the mainland, near the shore opposite 
 the island. There are many of these springs near the shore along 
 the coast, and they are unfrozen all winter, the water having 
 a temperature of 28" to 30° Fahrenheit, even when the air is 
 several degrees below zero. Whether this is due to any latent 
 volcanic heat cannot yet be decided, but the islands of Stuart and 
 St. -Michael, as well as the coast as far north as Tolstoi Point, are 
 composed of basaltic lava, full of amygdaloidal cavities and crys- 
 tals of olivine, and, in many places, roughly columnar in five-sided 
 pillars. 
 
 Siiiuiay, ^th. — In the morning a strong northeast wind was 
 blowing, with the thermometer about 16°, and a great deal of 
 loose snow driving about. I determined, in spite of the remon- 
 strances of the others, to delay no longer, and, putting some bis- 
 cuit and ukali in my pocket, I started alone, about eleven o'clock, 
 for Ikti'galik. The wind sweeping over the broad plains near the 
 mouth of the river was so violent, and the sleet was so blinding, 
 that I was unable to face it, and was obliged to go from side to 
 side of the river diagonally. In doing this I was misled by a 
 branch of the river, and proceeded several miles before I found 
 out my mistake. Retracing my steps, I took the right direction, 
 and reached the wooded part of the river, where the trees made a 
 shelter from the force of the wind and driving snow, late in the 
 afternoon. I found the ice rather soft and covered in many 
 places with drifted snow, so that the travelling was very laborious. 
 To add to my annoyances, it soon became very dark, and I had to 
 grope my way over ice-hummocks and through snow-drifts until 
 nearly worn out by the e.xertion. Passing round a bend in tlie 
 river, the ice gave way under me, and I had only time to 
 throw myself on one side, where it proved more solid, and I got 
 off with a wetting up to my knees. Taking off my boots and 
 socks, I wrung out the water and put them on again, when they 
 froze immediately. Nothing but the want of an axe preventetl my 
 camping then and there ; but a howling, which came evidently 
 trom no great distance, reminded me that it might not prove 
 healthy to sleep without a fire. I trudged along, and, to my great 
 delight, about eight o'clock, the moon rose, and I soon saw the 
 3 
 
 l-l 
 
 
 M 
 
 tj 
 
 til 
 
i ' 
 
 4 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ''I 
 
 ( ! 
 
 ( 
 
 
 h I 
 
 high caches of the village standing out against the sky. I 
 heard no dogs, however, and on reaching the entrance of 
 the house on the bank I found it closed with a block of wood. 
 Climbing on to the roof and looking through the gut cover, I 
 thought I saw a glimmer as of live coals where the fire had been. 
 My shouts finally aroused Ingechuk, who was the only occupant. 
 Ketchum had evidently gone, and I had my labor for my pains ! 
 Between the small stock of Russian which I had picked up, and 
 the little Ingechuk knew, I finally managed to make out that 
 they had left that day and gone to Uliikuk. I made him boil the 
 chynik, and changed my wet clothes, which were frozen so hard 
 as to be difficult to get off; and then, after taking my tea, retired 
 with a feeling that I had earned a good night's sleep. 
 
 Monday, ^th. — Not wishing to take another useless tramp, I 
 prevailed on Ingechuk to take a note to Ketchum, if he was at 
 Uliikuk and if he wished me to join him ; and feeling rather stiff, 
 I remained in the house, writing and resting most of the day. 
 About the middle of the afternoon, Francis arrived. He had met 
 an Indian with a note from Ketchum, on the river, and knew that 
 he was gone, but had kept on to Ikti'galik. Soon after, Ingechuk 
 returned with a note from Ketchum, who was on the point of 
 starting for Nuhito, and advised us to return to Unalakli'k and 
 come up with the next brigade of sleds. 
 
 Tuesday, Qitli. — Breakfasted on some fine salmon trout {koko- 
 limya of the Indians, and kolslick of the Russians) which Ketchum 
 had sent down to us. These fish, when broiled in their skins on 
 a stick over the fire, are exceedingly fine eating, but if fried or 
 cleaned before cooking lose much of their flavor. 
 
 Leaving some of our things with Ingechuk, to follow us the next 
 day, we started for Unalakli'k about eleven, and reached it about 
 five o'clock in the afternoon ; our return created some amuse- 
 ment. The ice being very glairy made the travelling very disa- 
 greeable, and we were well satisfied when we came to our jour- 
 ney's end. 
 
 Adams, one of the original party, now justly known as the 
 pioneers, had left for the Redoubt in a bidarra, but had not re- 
 turned ; some fears were excited that he might not be able to 
 do so until the sea ice had fully formed. Temperature varied 
 from 15° to 20°. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 35 
 
 For several days we remained /// statu quo. Our time was 
 taken up in increasing our knowledge of Russian and the 
 Miihlemut dialect, in preparations for another attempt to cross 
 the portage, and in reading a variety of matter provided by the 
 kindness of some of the officers who did not remain in the coun- 
 try. Several evenings were pleasantly diversified by an amateur 
 theatrical performance, aided by several violins. Many capital 
 personal hits were made, which, being taken in good part by the 
 victims, were productive of a great deal of merriment. 
 
 Monday, \2th. — Started for Iktigalik about ten o'clock, with 
 two Mahlemuts, Shurugeluk and Ichiluk by name, commonly 
 known as Shuggy and New-Years, the latter having been hired 
 the previous year by Mr. Kennicott on New-Year's day. We had 
 two heavily loaded sleds of Mahlemut make, drawn by five and 
 four dogs respectively, dogs being scarce. The party consisted, 
 besides the two Eskimo above referred to, of Messrs. Dyer and 
 Francis, and myself, — Mr. Francis and I, not wishing to be idle, 
 having volunteered to assist in transporting the Nulato goods to 
 Ulukuk. By making several short portages, the distance was 
 materially reduced, and we arrived in good condition at Iktigalik 
 about two o'clock in the afternoon. 
 
 Tuesday, \yh. — After breakfast, loaded up one Mahlemut and 
 one light Ingalik sled and started at half past ten for Ulukuk, 
 which is about eleven miles from Iktigalik by several portages 
 and tlic river. About half-way on a bend of the river were two 
 roofless deserted houses, once a summer fishing village, called by 
 the Indians N'tsoh. Unromantic as it may appear, the sight of 
 these poor ruins, indicating probably a death in the midst of the 
 primeval woods, could hardly fail to produce a touch of emotion 
 in any mind less occupied than that of the hardy and careless 
 voyageur. They formed a rude, half-effaced, but effective monu- 
 ment of human sorrow, in a country where humanity se( \<-'\ 
 iiardly to have taken root, existing as it does, only by a constant 
 struggle for the necessities of life. 
 
 Pursuing our way up steep banks and down sharp declivities 
 requiring the greatest care in the management of dogs and sleds, 
 over the ice-bound river and the rolling plains, dotted with clumps 
 ot larch and willow, we finally struck the river at a sharp bend, 
 just l)elow the point where the village of Ulukuk is situated. 
 
 n 
 
 m 
 
 B! 
 
 •iii 
 
 i'i 
 
 ■I' 
 
 ^1 
 
 ■I' (I , 
 
11 M ! 
 
 36 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ! ; 
 
 I, 1 
 
 El 
 It '. 
 
 Here a large number of springs exist, some of them loelow the 
 bed of the river, whose waters are never frozen, an open patch 
 being found here during the most severe winters. The water in 
 these springs, measured by a standard thermometer of Greenes 
 make, was not very warm, but retained a temperature of thirty- 
 two to thirty-four degrees Fahrenheit during extremely cold 
 weather. I counted seven springs in the gravel beach near the 
 village, all without any ice about them ; most of them continue 
 open during the entire year, but are covered by the river during 
 the spring freshets. 
 
 The village contains five winter houses, a small casine, and a 
 row of high caches. It is situated on the right bank of the river, 
 which is here about two hundred feet wide ; about four miles to 
 the eastward the Uliikuk Hills rise to a height of about two thou- 
 sand feet. At this time they were snow covered of course, but 
 they are free from snow during the summer. 
 
 The open water in the river makes it somewhat difficult to ap- 
 proach the village with sleds from below, the banks, though low. 
 being steep and covered with small trees. Snow or ice, plar 
 upon the smooth pebbles from beneath which the springs w 
 flowing, soon melted, though the weather was at zero. With the 
 atmosphere at eight below zero, the temperature of one spring, 
 which gave out beautifully clear water with a slight saline taste 
 like bicarbonate of soda, was thirty-two degrees ; another, quite 
 tasteless, was thirty-four degrees Fahrenheit. 
 
 The water in the river, at the edge of the ice, which was about 
 eighteen inches thick, had a temperature of thirty-one degrees. A 
 remarkable abundance of fish frequents the vicinity of this patch of 
 open water, especially the delicious salmon trout for which Uliikuk 
 is noted, and a small cyprinoid fish not elsewhere observed. 
 
 Ami'lka has a house in this village also, and into it we took our 
 baggage and rested ; an old Indian called Sammdk roasted some 
 trout for our evening meal, while with some fresh alene meat and 
 backfat Dyer concocted one of those appetizing telegraph stews 
 previously mentioned. 
 
 Wi'dncsiiay, i^t/i. — Francis and our two Eskimo started oft' 
 with three sleds to bring loads from Iktigalik. Several sick Ind- 
 ians came to me for treatment, their own medical knowledge be- 
 ing confined to steam-baths and to counter-irritants in the form of 
 
THK YUKON TKKRITORY. 
 
 2>1 
 
 low the 
 1 patch 
 :ater in 
 ireenes 
 ■ thirty- 
 :ly cold 
 lear the 
 :ontiiiuc 
 r during 
 
 e, and a 
 he river, 
 miles to 
 wo thou- 
 urse, but 
 
 lit to ap- 
 lugh low. 
 e, plar 
 ngs w 
 With the 
 |e spring, 
 line taste 
 er, quite 
 
 ras about 
 
 ;rees. A 
 
 patch of 
 
 Uliikuk 
 
 Id. 
 
 Itook our 
 ;d some 
 leat and 
 hh stews 
 
 Irted oft" 
 lick Ind- 
 ulge be- 
 Ibrm of 
 
 
 bleeding by means of a large number of small cuts and the actual 
 cautery. They have no knowledge of the uses of the indigenous 
 herbs of the country or of any medicines. 
 
 I purchased a fine pair of snow-shoes about five feet long for a 
 sheath-knife, and Dyer obtained a large number of the river trout 
 from the Indians. I cannot understand why Kane and other 
 Arctic travellers could not preserve fresh provisions in a frozen 
 state, for winter use. In this country immense quantities of meat 
 and fish are so preserved without taint all the year round. E.xca- 
 vations are made in the earth to the depth of two or three 
 feet, where it is usually frozen, and the contents are thus pro- 
 tected from the rays of the sun. 
 
 Towards evening Francis and the sleds returned with heavy 
 loads of goods from the other village. 
 
 Thursday, I'-^th. — It being my turn to take charge of the bri- 
 gade, I started with the dogs and men about half past ten, with 
 empty sleds. Reached Iktigalik about two o'cli> k, and by means 
 of a little diplomacy induced Ingechuk and Am ilka to lend me 
 their dogs, and also got hold of another sled. 
 
 Friday, \6t/i. — Rose early, and after chy peet, as the Russians 
 call a meal of bread and tea, harnessed up the dogs, and, taking 
 all the remaining goods, except some dog feed, started about half 
 past eight and arrived at Ulukuk about noon. Cached the goods 
 and repaired sleds and harness. 
 
 News arrived from Ketchum in the afternoon, by an Indian who 
 brought a sled and a worn-out dog from a jwint called Vesolia 
 .S(')pka, or Cheerful Mountain. He said that Ketchum had passed 
 that point with three sleds ai route for Nulato, but that the roads 
 were very bad, the snow being deep and soft. One of our party 
 had been trading with Lofka, who, having an ear for music, bought 
 an accordeon, giving in exchange two dogs, one of which was sup- 
 posed to be running wild in the woods. Lofka knew nothing of 
 the use of the instrument, and it was a moot question which had 
 the best of the bargain. The instrument having been u.sed to 
 play " Tramp, tramp, the boys are marching "' for some four 
 months, about twenty-four times a day, was, to say the least, not 
 in a condition to be much injured by Indian fingering. 
 
 Alter waiting a day for the return of the Nulato brigade which 
 was due. Dyer returned to Unalaklik, leaving Francis and myself 
 
 i> 
 
 rf 
 
 ^ 
 
 H; 
 
 I. 
 
 \ ' 
 
 ... t. 
 
-J 
 
 1 
 
 i ; 
 
 i ! 
 
 ) [ 
 
 I, 
 
 " 1 
 
 ' I 
 
 38 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY, 
 
 with nothing to do but eat, drink, and sleep, which was extreme- 
 ly tedious, as the days were very short. We finally determined, if 
 the brigade did not arrive the next day, we would get a few dogs 
 together and carry a load to Ves()lia Sopka. If it were a finiall one 
 it would be of assistance, and anything would be better than con- 
 tinued idleness. A large number of Indians arrived from dif- 
 ferent quarters, and I improved the opportunity to enlarge my 
 Ingalik vocabularies. One of them went out, and returned with 
 three brace of beautiful rutited grouse {Bouasa nmhdhts) I also 
 purchased some small fish, which were devoted to the interests of 
 science. 
 
 Wednesday, 21st. — Heard a howling early in the morning 
 and an outcry among the Indians, and jumpeci into my clothes 
 just in time to catch a sight of Mike's j)leasant face coming 
 up the bank, with two Russians, six sleds, and nearly forty 
 dogs behind him. A rapid interchange of news ensued, while 
 unharnessing the dogs and putting the sleds up or the stages 
 provided for the purpose. Mike was delighted to find that the 
 work of carrying the goods from Unalaklik to Uli'ikuk had been 
 taken ori" his hands. The Russians were to go on to Unalaklik, 
 and we should immediately proceed to Nuhito. Ketchum sent 
 word to me to come up immediately, as uiy services were likely 
 to be needed ; but unfortunately he wis obliged to ask Francis to 
 wait for the next brigade, as the supply of provisions at Nuhito 
 was exceedingly small. Nuhito. as the natives -ay, is emjihati- 
 cally a " hungry " place. We all regretted the provoking neces- 
 sity which deprived us for a time of the society of our lively and 
 energetic companion. He therefore made arrangements for 
 returning a third time to Unalaklik with the Russians. 
 
 Thursdixy, ?2d. — Rising early, the sleds were soon in readi- 
 ness, and, buying a 'ot of fresh trout, for our own use and to send 
 by the Russians to UnalakUk, we started about noon for Ves(')lia 
 bupka ; our party consisting of six Indians, one man to each 
 sled, besides Mike and myself The road was excellent, and we 
 dill not require snow-shoes; the ilogs were in good condition, and 
 we progressed very well. 
 
 After leaving Uliikuk, crossing the river and a belt of spruce 
 timber of small size and about a mile in breadth, we came to 
 open rolling land, between the river and the base of the hills. 
 
 li. I 
 
THE YUKON' TERRITORY. 
 
 39 
 
 This country is almost level, with hillocks here and there, and 
 occasional clumps of low willows. This prairic-like plain is called 
 a ti'tiuim by the Russians. 
 
 From Ulukuk to the river at the Vesolia Sopka is about four- 
 teen miles,* the greater part of which is over the tundra, which is 
 occasionally intersected by small streams falling into the Ulukuk 
 branch of the Unalaklik River, and forming deep gullies, which, 
 until filled with snow, arc difficult to pass with loaded sleds. The 
 dogs have sometimes to be unhitched and the sled carefully easeil 
 over the ravine and lifted up the opposite bank, — a work fre- 
 quently of no small labor. 
 
 The VescSlia Sopka forms the termination of the range of the 
 Ulukuk Hills, but is somewhat lower and detached from the rest. 
 It attains a height of about eight hundred feet above the sur- 
 rounding plain, and has an even and beautifully rounded summit. 
 At its base, hidden by large and very tall spruce and poplar, runs 
 the Ulukuk River. We crossed the stream, which is about two 
 hundred feet wide, and soon reached a spot where the Russians 
 rue accustomed to camp, on the opposite bank, from which the 
 Sopka (Russian for cone or peak, particularly a volcanic one) 
 probably derived its name of Ves(')lia (cheerful). Near this point 
 a small stream, known to tht' inhabitants as Poplar Creek, en- 
 ters the river, This is an excellent locality for trapping, as the 
 numerous fox and marten tracks testified. We boiled the chynik 
 and partook of a cheerful meal of bacon and biscuit, and then 
 pushed on by moonlight, over wooded hills, to an Indian summer 
 lodge, or /^rt;-w7;<;/vr, built of spruce poles and birch bark. Here 
 we campetl, and passed a rather uncomfortable night, as the frail 
 walls retained the smoke and admitted the cold wind. This point 
 is about eight miles from the S(')i)ka. 
 
 Friday, 2t,(/. — Rose early, and after reloading the sleds and 
 discussing chy, with accompaniments of bacon, I iscuit, ukali, and 
 molasses, we passed on over hillsides sparsely wot)ded wilii spruce 
 and alder, through valleys, and up anil dov 'i some rather bad 
 hills, occasionally along the river on the ice. About dark we 
 came upon some open tundra, just beyond a low marsh, known as 
 Heaver Lake, as it is covered with water in the spring ; here a 
 strong north wind was blowing full in our teeth, carrying tlie 
 
 * I'lilcss otlu'iwisc St, 111 (I, Miiulisli st,\liiU' niilr> .in' im,inl. 
 
 ''■'u 
 
 til 
 
 •!J| 
 
 I'i 
 
 
 ¥ 
 
V 
 
 1 , 
 
 ; 
 
 U ( 
 
 'i 
 
 I 
 
 40 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 snow along the ground in blinding sleet. The atmosphere was 
 six below zero. The other sleds were some distance behind, but 
 as our sled carried the teakettle and axes, we felt pretty sure the 
 Indians would follow, though much against their will. We strug- 
 gled on until we arrived at an old camp of Ketchum's, where one 
 tree mocked us with its inefficient attempt at shelter. We de- 
 cided to camp here, no more suitable locality being within reach. 
 By placing the sleds to windward, with a piece of cotton drill 
 stretched around them, we managed to keep off the driving snow 
 a little. The hot tea in our tin cups burned the hand on one 
 side, while the keen wind gnawed it on the other. Smoking was 
 out of the question, and we lay down, using the bacon as pil- 
 lows, and watched the dogs, who, growling their disapprobation, 
 sheltered their noses with their tails, and, more fortunate than 
 ourselves, soon sank into unconscious slumber. 
 
 Satiird(i]\ 24///. — About four o'clock in the morning an old 
 Indian called Ivan, from Nulato, came along with his son. They 
 pulled their own sled, and had a few marten skins with which they 
 were going to Unalaklik to buy oil for winter use. Shortly after, 
 we broke camp and proceeded. About nine o'clock the sun rose, 
 attended by three beautiful mock suns, or parlicliix. One was 
 nearly thirty degrees above the real sun, and there was one on 
 each side, similar, but more brilliant. All were connected by an 
 arch resembling a rainbow, except that it was of an orange color 
 with a dark reddish band on the inner side, and threw out rays 
 of light from the 01 jr edge. About a quarter of another similar 
 arch was reversed, loucliing the lower arch at the point where the 
 upper mock sun was seen, and a cross of brilliant light was noticed 
 at each junction of the arch with the mock suns. This beautiful 
 exhibition continued for six hours, from sunrise to sunset, and 
 IVIike tells me they are not uncommon here in winter. 
 
 .Shot a Canada jay, or whiskey jack {Pcrisorcits canadensis), with 
 a dark brown "woolly bear" caterpillar in his mouth, just killed. 
 Where it had come from was a mystery I do not pretend to solve, 
 probably from beneath the snow. 
 
 We decided to camp early, as we were all very tired, and after 
 descending a deep declivity called by the Russians Pcrivdlli, we 
 stopped on the bank of a small stream, made a good camp, en- 
 joyed our supper, tea, and pipes, and slept soundl)'. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 41 
 
 Sti/idayy 26//1. — Off at six. Passed over the flanks of some hi<:(h 
 Iiills, from one of which I caught my first glimpse of the great 
 river Yukon, broad, smooth, and ice-bound. A natural impatience 
 urged me forward, and after a smart tramp of several miles we 
 arrived at the steep bank of the river. It was with a feeling akin 
 to that which urged Balboa forward into the very waves of a 
 newly discovered ocean, that I rushed by the dogs and down the 
 steep declivity, forgetting everything else in the desire to be first 
 on the ice, and to enjoy the magnificent prospect before me. 
 
 There lay a stretch of forty miles of this great broad, snow- 
 covered river, with broken fragments of ice-cakes glowing in the 
 rutldy light of the setting sun ; the low opposite shore, three miles 
 away, seemed a mere black streak on the horizon. A few islands 
 covered with dark evergreens were in sight above. Below, a faint 
 purple tinged the snowy crests of far-off mountains, whose height, 
 though not extreme, seemed greater from the low banks near me 
 and the clear sky beyond. This was the river I had read and 
 dreamed of, which had seemed as if shrouded in mystery, in spite 
 of the tales of those who had seen it. On its banks live thousands 
 who know neither its outlet nor its source, who look to it for food 
 and even for clothing, and, recognizing its magnificence, call them- 
 selves proudly nwii of the Yukon. 
 
 Stolid indeed must he be, who surveys the broad expanse of the 
 Missouri of the North for the first time witho' emotion. A little 
 Innuit lad, who ran before the dogs and - it for the first 
 time, shouted at the sight, saying, amidst his cxprcs^iniis of 
 astonishment, " It is not a river, it is a sea ! " and even \\<^ Indians 
 had no word of ridicule for him, often as they had seen it. 
 
 A half-mile above the point where wc struck the river bank 
 is a cluster of winter houses and caches, which goes b)' the 
 name of Kaltag. Tliither we turned our steps, a piercing 
 IK irth wester sweeping down the river being an effectual argument 
 against fiu-ther progress. We entered one of the houses, a large, 
 clean, and well-constructed building, where we founii a very old 
 man known as Kultdi^ S/dirck by the Russians (s/onr'/,- meaning 
 old man), and his wife, with another woman, busily at work on 
 some winter clothing. They made room for us, spread some clean 
 mats, and Mike, who was a general favorite, especially among the 
 indigenous female population, by a present of a pair of scissors 
 
 ■I ft f 
 
 i 
 
 km 
 
 m 
 
 \ > 
 
 % 
 
42 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 \ I 
 
 I ; 
 
 I: I 
 
 ii 
 
 l\ 
 
 t ' 
 
 induced the old woman to give us tliree or four ptarmigan, with a 
 promise of six more on his next visit. He then proceeded with 
 the aid of some rice to concoct a stew which did great credit to 
 his culinary abilities. 
 
 We went out together to feed the dogs, and returning unex- 
 pectedly, I found one of the Indians investigating with his fingers 
 the recesses of a spare chynik which contained our molasses. 
 Such incidents are not uncommon, when travelling with the na- 
 tives. 
 
 After discussing our supper and congratulating ourselves on 
 the accomplishment of the portage without storm or accident, we 
 turned in early, to enjoy a good night's rest and thereby prepare 
 for an early start the next day. 
 
 Monday, 26th. — Pushed oft' quite early, travelling on the middle 
 of the river, finding the ice, which seemed so even and smooth 
 from the bank, to be broken, strewed with numerous cakes, 
 and diversified by hummocks, over which about eighteen inches 
 of snow had already collected. Here and there were patches 
 of smooth ice, evidently of recent formation, and once or twice 
 a light cloud over an opening indicated that the surface was 
 not entirely frozen. Numerous long islands, covered with 
 spruce, poplar, and willow, obstructed the view of the opposite 
 shore, which is quite low, while here and there we could catch 
 glimpses of the summits of the Kaiyuh Mountains, a range of 
 high hills to the eastward. Tiie right bank consists of rounded 
 bluffs following each other like waves, reaching a heiglit of 
 fifty to one hundred and fifty feet, cau.sed by the bending of 
 the strata, which are composed of layers of brown tertiary 
 sandstones of Miocene age. The sides of these bluft's, with the 
 ravines between them, are well wooded with spruce and birch, 
 which often attain a considerable height. The left bank is uni- 
 formly low and densely wooded. Thr thermometer to-day fell to 
 thirty-two below zero, but the air was still, and travelling was not 
 uncomfortable. About six o'clock we reached a broad ravine, 
 through which a small brook ran, and where an Ingalik named 
 Alikoft' had built a small house, known as Alikolfs barr;ibora. 
 This is about twenty miles from Kaltag, which, I forgot to state, 
 is about twenty-five miles from Ivan's barnibora and thirty-six 
 from Nuliito, perhaps a few miles more by the M)ad we took. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Here we decided to camp for the night, and found the house, 
 which was empty, rather smoky and uncomfortable. 
 
 Tuesday, 2^(11. — Making an early start for Nukito, we ))roceedcd 
 up the river, the temperature being about twenty-eight below 
 zero. About eleven o'clock, arrived at an open space near!)- two 
 miles long, bounded on the south by a sharp bluff known as the 
 Shaman Mountain. Here a seam of coal had been reported, and, 
 stopping for a moment, I ascertained that the report was correct. 
 Reserving a careful examination for some other occasion, I started 
 ahead of the dogs, following the old tracks on the snow, and soon 
 left the brigade behind me. In half an hour I reached a [»oint on 
 the river where a party of three Russians were engaged in setting 
 fish-weirs under the ice. An old fellow, whose head shook like that 
 of a Chinese mandarin, informed me that the post of Nulato was 
 only a mile beyond. A steady walk of nearly an hour convinced 
 me that it was nearer three miles, but I soon espied the stockade 
 and two turrets at no great distance. Ascending the bank. I 
 went into the enclosure, and, inquiring for the Americans, was 
 directed to a low building on one side. On entering I was 
 soon shaking hands with Ketchum, and with W'hympcr, who 
 was already engaged in sketching. 
 
 We were congratulated on our quick trip from Ulukuk, and 
 exchanged items of news. The noise of the dogs was soon heard, 
 and we were busily engaged in unloading and storing the goods, 
 as well as unharnessing the dogs, who seemed as glad as anybody 
 that their journey had come to a satisfactory conclusion. 
 
 M 
 
 I' 
 
 I 
 
 ; 1 
 
 m 
 
 ' i .■ 
 
CHAPTER II. 
 
 \ : 
 
 I . 
 
 I 
 
 I -. 
 
 M i 
 
 ' 11 
 
 II \ 
 
 Arrival at Xulato, and introduction to the Creole bidarshik. — Description of the post 
 and its inhabitants. — Adjacent points. — History. — The Nulato massacre and its 
 cause. — Barnard's grave. — Daily life at Nulato. — Larriown. - Koyukun Indians. 
 
 — Ingaliks. — Kurilla. — Plans for the coining season. — Examination of a coal- 
 seam. — Nuklukahyct chief. — Christmas festivities. — New Year's and erection of 
 the first telegraph poie. — Aurora. — Return of Ketchum. — Collections in Natural 
 History. — Indian rumor. — Cannibalism. — Russian ingenuity. — Founding of Fort 
 Kennicott. — Departure of Ketchum and Mike on their winter journey to Fort 
 Yukon. — Arrival of our bidarra. — Trip to Wolasatu.x' barrabora. — Scarcity of 
 food. — First signs of spring. — Robbing a grave. — First goose. — Indian children. 
 
 — Rescue of the bidarshik. — Anecdote of Major Kennicott and erection of a mon- 
 ument to his memory. — Formation of alluvium. — Preparations for our journey. — 
 Breaking up of the ice on the Yukon. 
 
 IT AVING finally arrived at Nulato, which I proposed to 
 1 make my head-quarters, and having rested from the fa- 
 tigue of the journey, I was introduced to Ivan I'avloflf, the bidar- 
 shik or commander of the trading-post. He was a short, thick- 
 set, swarthy, low-browcd man, a half-breed between a Russian 
 and a native of Kenai, and was legally married to a full-blooccd 
 Indian woman, named Marina, the widow of a previous bidarshik, 
 by whom he had a large family of children. He appeared to be 
 a good-humored fellow, though the Indian clearly predominated 
 in him. While evidently understanding nothing of the object of 
 the collections and observations which I proposed to make, he yet 
 assured me that I should be welcome to any information or assist- 
 ance I might need. A disagreeable servility marked his inter- 
 course with the Americans and full-blooded Russians, the latter 
 regarding him with unconcealed contempt on account of his 
 Indian blood, notwithstanding his responsible position. This 
 accounted for the expression which might often be observed 
 on his face while conversing with him. It seemed a mi.xture 
 of stupidity and low cunning, as if he were apprehensive that 
 some covert ridicule, or attempt at overreaching, lay hidden in 
 the conversation addressed to him. He was an insatiable drinker, 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY, 
 
 45 
 
 and ungovernable as a mad bull when drunk, thoup;h at other 
 times quiet and uncxcitable. He was continually pestering us 
 with requests for liquor, until I was obliged to poison all the 
 alcohol intended for collecting purposes. Notwithstanding his 
 faults, most of which were hereditary, he brought up his chil- 
 dren and treated his wife as well as his light allowed him to 
 do. He had a large proportion of generosity and hospitality 
 in his character, was unusually free from any disposition to 
 immorality, and was never known to sell any furs, purchased 
 by him and belonging to the Russian American Company, to 
 any of our party, as he might easily have done. He could not 
 read or write, and the accounts were kept by an assistant called 
 Yagor Ivanovich. He cherished in his heart a dislike to the 
 Americans on account of their superior energy and intelligence, 
 which led them to regard him with no very respectful eye. When 
 he was drunk, the bitter and unfounded prejudices which he cher- 
 ished came to the surface ; otherwise we should hardly have sus- 
 pected them. I have been thus careful in drawing his portrait, 
 not because the individual is of any particular consequence but 
 because he is in many respects a type of the largest class of 
 the civilized inhabitants of Russian America. They are known 
 among the Russians as Creoles. The other inhabitants of the 
 post of Nulato were two Russians, the only whites beside our- 
 selves, named Karpoff and Paspi'lkoff (the Pomoghnik, or assist- 
 ant, who kept the accounts, was a Creole, like the bidurshik) ; 
 an old Yakut, named Yagorsha, who was a curiosity in himself; 
 two half-breeds ; and a few Indians ; while a nearly equal number 
 of Indian women were employed in and about the post. 
 
 The fort was a large one, two sides and a part of the third 
 formed by buildings, the remainder a stockade, thus enclosing 
 a large yard, On one side was a long structure, containing two 
 rooms, which .served for the bidarshik and his assistant and their 
 families. These rooms were separated by a covered space from 
 the rest of the building, which contained a magazine for trading- 
 goods and furs, a store-room where fish were kept, and another, 
 which was principally occupied by our goods. Opposite to this was 
 another building of the same size, containiii,, one large room, sepa- 
 rated in the same way from a small one, in both of which workmen 
 and their families lived. ICach of them was surmounted wilii a 
 
 • 'X ^ 
 
 ■. '■?! 
 
 m 
 
 *i '^f 
 
 t»i 
 
46 
 
 THK YUKON TERRITOKV. 
 
 I 
 
 ■ 
 
 1 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 ' 
 
 
 
 
 
 I , 
 
 V^' I 
 
 I 
 
 i, M 
 
 I! y 
 
 
 'I' 
 
 I r 
 
 
 1 
 
 1 '■' 
 
 
 ■j " 
 
 
 > 
 
 
 
 
 1 
 
 
 itt 
 
 1 
 / 
 
 turret pierced for ljuiis, and in one of these were two antique, rusty, 
 and almost useless six-pounders. The third side was occupied 
 by a low-studded buildiny, about twenty feet long and ten wide, 
 which we occupied ; a shed, where fuel might be kept dry ; the 
 bath-house, and a shed used to cook in, and called by courtesy 
 the /^ot'dm in, or kitchen. The front of the yard was closed in by 
 a stockade about sixteen feet high, of pointed logs set upright in 
 the ground, and was provided with a large gate. 'J"hc houses 
 were of round logs ; the roofs, nearly flat and covered with earth, 
 could be reached by means of steps provided for the purpose. 
 The windows were all of the parchment, or seal intestines, before 
 mentioned, and the buildings were warmed by the universal 
 peechkas, the seams of the walls being calked with dry moss. 
 
 Interior of I'ort Der.lbin, frnm above. 
 
 Directly across from the fort, which faces the river, is a low 
 island, less than a mile long. Tlie river is narrow here, beina 
 by exact measurement only a mile and a half wide. The lati- 
 tude of the fort is nearly 64 42' north, and the longitude 157° 54' 
 west. The variation of the compass is nearly thirty-two degrees 
 to the eastward. 
 
 A mile and a furlong east-northeast is a small creek, a raging 
 torrent in the spring, called /\/,r/-hr/,-//ii///chy the Indians, literally 
 " Stop-a-bit River." Half a mile west-southwest is the mouth of 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 47 
 
 the Nuluto River, from which the post takes its name, thouj^h it 
 was originally called Fort Derabin, from its builder and first 
 bidarshik. Between these two streams the land is low, gradually 
 rising from the river into low hills, and for the most part densely 
 wooded. A short distance from its nioulh the Xuldto River 
 
 .1 
 
 i f 
 
 ' I 
 
 Niilato and tlic Vukon fmm tlie liluffs. 
 
 receives two streams of no great size. Its total length is about 
 twenty miles, inclusive of windings. The opposite bank of 
 the Klat-kixkhdtnc rises abruptly into a rocky, precipitous bluff, 
 affording a fine view down the river. Not far below the mouth 
 of the Nulato the river-bank rises, but not so abruptly, into bluffs 
 
 1 . 
 
 
48 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 :! 
 
 if, I 
 
 M 
 
 about one hundred feet high, with higher hills behind them. 
 Neither deer nor moose are often found in this vicinity. 
 
 In 1838, Malakoff, a Creole, explored the Yukon as far north as 
 Nulato. Here he built a small trading-post, without a stockade, 
 consisting of several small houses. This was occupied during 
 the summer and fall, but in consequence of the scarcity of pro- 
 visions, at the approach of winter the Russians, under Notarmi 
 the bidarshik, left it and returned to the Redoubt. On their 
 return, in the spring, it was found that the Indians, jealous of the 
 permanent settlement of the whites in their immediate vicinity, 
 had destroyed it by fire. The same thing was repeated in 1839, 
 the buildings being burned and contents carried otf. 
 
 In 1841, according to Tikhmenief, the historian of the Russian 
 American Company, Derabin was sent to Nulato and rebuilt the 
 fort, after arranging the difficulty with the natives by means of 
 numerous presents given to the most influential chiefs. Yet, not 
 having benefited by previous experience, the post was composed of 
 several detached log-houses, strongly built, but several hundred 
 yr.rds apart, and without a stockade or other efficient means of de- 
 fence. Other buildings were added as necessity called for them, 
 and in 1842, Lieutenant Zagoskin, I. R. N., a special explorer of the 
 Company, arrived, and assisted at the erection of some of these. 
 
 For ten years, though frequently threatened, the little settle- 
 ment escaped injury, Derabin meanwhile carrying on a lucrative 
 traffic with the natives for furs. In the spring of 185 i, Lieutenant 
 Barnard, of H. M. S. Enterprise, arrived at Nulato with the bidar- 
 shik, in search of information in regard to the fate of Sir John 
 Franklin. He was a member of Captain Collinson's Expedition, 
 and, with Mr. Adams a surgeon, and one man, had been left by 
 the Enterprise at St. Michael's the preceding fall Being prob- 
 ably a blunt, straightforward Englishman, with no knowledge 
 of Indian character and suspicion, he made the remark, in the 
 presence of others, that he intended to " send " for the principal 
 chief of the Koyukun tribe of Indians, whose head-quarters were 
 on the Koyiikuk and Kotelkakat Rivers, and who were then hold- 
 ing one of their annual festivals, about twenty-five miles from 
 Nulato. This unfortunately-worded remark was conveyed to the 
 chief in question, through some of the Indians at the post, by a 
 passing native. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 49 
 
 This chief was the most wealthy and influential in that part of 
 the coimtry, widely known and distinguished by a remarkably 
 large and prominent Roman nose, from which he had received 
 a name which, literally translated, means " humpbacked nose.' 
 
 He was not accustomed to be " .sent "' for. When the Russians 
 desired to see him they respectfully requested the honor of his 
 presence. His Indian pride rose at the insult, and he immediately 
 called a council to discuss the rumor. The shamans were of 
 course first consulted, and they unanimously declared that it 
 boded no good to the chief in question. The council then de- 
 cided that, if the report proved true, they would, with all the 
 Indians there assembled, go together to the fort and demand 
 satisfaction. They waited some time, and finally were about to 
 disperse to their homes, when a single dog-sled appeared on the 
 river. 
 
 This sled was accompanied by Ivan Biilegin, a Russian, and an 
 Indian workman of the NuUito tribe, who had been sent up to see 
 if any information were attainable, and if so, to bring down the 
 Tyone of Koyi'ikuk. 
 
 The ill-fated Biilegin drew his sled up on the bank, sending the 
 Indian who accompanied him for water to boil the chynik. Sit- 
 ting down on his sled to rest himself, he was approached stealth- 
 ily from behind and, being struck on the head with an axe or 
 club, was instantly killed. 
 
 The sled was dragged away and plundered ; when the Nulato 
 Indian returned and saw what had been done, he turned to run, 
 but the Koyukuns called to him, saying, " Are you not one of us .' 
 We will not hurt you." Overcome by l'<;ar, he returned and un- 
 willingly assisted in the atrocity which followed. Biilegin's body 
 was stripped, the flesh cut in slices from the bones, and the sav- 
 ages, infuriated like wild animals by the siglit of blood, roasted 
 these remains and devoured them. An Indian, who noticed the 
 reluctance with which Biilegin's companion joined in the horrid 
 feast, crept up behind him and drove his knife up to the hilt in 
 his neck. The fighting men present then stripped themselves 
 of all incumbrances e.xcept their bows and arrows, and, putting 
 on their snowshoes, set out at once for Nulato. Less than a 
 half-mile below the trading-post were three large winter houses, 
 crowded with Ingaliks of the Nulato tribe, — in all, about a hun- 
 
 ■^i 
 
 ii 
 
 •i 
 
 i 
 
 |. * 
 
 
 ■h -i 
 
 ■i i 
 
 
 'Ml 
 
 111 
 
I 
 
 50 
 
 THE YUKON TEKRITORY. 
 
 t -.'< 
 
 drcd men, women, and children. These houses were situated near 
 the river-bank, a few rods northeast of the mouth of the Nukito 
 River. It being in the month of February, and an unusually 
 warm spring, the Nuh'ito Indians had taken the precaution to clear 
 away the snow from above their birch-bark canoes, forty or fifty of 
 which were lying about. Intending to forestall retaliation for the 
 death of Biilegin's companion, the Koyiikuns approached with the 
 greatest quietness, not to disturb the sleeping inmates. The canoes 
 were seized, broken up, thrust into the apertures in the roofs and 
 the narrow underground entrances of the houses, and fired. The 
 frightened inhabitants, wakened by the noise and crackling of the 
 flames, endeavored vainly to force a passage through the fire. 
 Some of the men, seizing axes, cut their way out through the 
 wooden walls, but were mercilessly shot down by the arrows of 
 the Koyukuns. Many were suffocated in the smoke. A few 
 women were taken by the victors, and one or two children were 
 able to save themselves in the woods, through the negligence or 
 pity of the conquerors. 
 
 A young man called Wolasatu.x, renowned for his skill with the 
 bow, escaped to the mountains, eluding the vigilance of the pur- 
 suers by his swiftness of foot. All the rest were smothered or fell 
 beneath the knives and arrows of the assailants. But little noise 
 was made, except by the screams of the women and the shouts of 
 the destroyers, for at that time the Indians had no guns. The 
 slumbers of the Russians were not disturbed. 
 
 It is said that two Indian women who were employed at the 
 fort, having risen early to boil the chyniks for the morning meal, 
 heard and understood the cries of the victims, but, overcome by 
 fear and anguish at the death of their kindred, stupidly shut 
 themselves into the cook-house, and did not alarm the Russians. 
 
 The Koyukuns next made for the trading-post, and found the 
 bidarshik, just risen, sitting behind one of the houses. Saying 
 to Ivan, one of their tribe who had been employed at the fort 
 as interpreter, " If you do not kill the bidarshik, we will kill 
 you," they forced him to consent. He approached Derabin and 
 stabbed him in the back repeatedly, so that he fell to rise no 
 more. The Russian interpreter, a man said to have understood 
 seven languages, happening to come out, saw the act, and turning 
 unarmed to the Indians, upbraided them for the murder, but fell 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 51 
 
 in the doorway, pierced with seven arrows. Rushing over his 
 prostrate body, they entered the house. Harnard was lyini^ on 
 his bed readini; ; at the sij.;ht of th ; '.lostile Indians he raised him- 
 self up to reach his gun, which hung above his head. Twice he 
 fired, and twice the barrel was struck upwards, the balls taking 
 effect in the ceiling. An Indian shaman --christened Larriown by 
 the Russians — and his brother seized the arms, and one plunged 
 his knife into the ICnglishman's abdomen, so that when it was 
 withdrawn the intestines followed it, and he fell back mortally 
 wounded. Several shots were fired, and one struck Larriown in 
 the groin. Three children and their mother were killed ; their 
 father, Teleezhik, being absent in the Kaviak peninsula, as inter- 
 preter, with Captain Bedford Pim. 
 
 Leaving the bidarshik's house, the Indians ne.xt attacked the 
 casdniiiT, or room where the workmen lived, where there were 
 two Russians and several Creoles. They had barricaded the door, 
 and being at some distance from the other house, knew nothing 
 that had happened. One of them aimed through the window at 
 the crowd of Indians ; when the other, hoping to avoid blood- 
 shed, advised him to fire above their heads, in hope that they 
 would disperse. The crowd separated, but did not retreat, and 
 only answered by a shower of arrows. The ne.xt shot, better 
 aimed, killed one of the Indians, when a panic seemed to seize 
 them, and they immediately retreated with their booty and pris- 
 oners to Koyukuk. Larriown sat in great agony in the outer 
 room of the bidarshik's house. A Russian lay in the inner room, 
 helpless from fever, who had been overlooked by the Indians in the 
 excitement. His wife, an Indian woman named Maria, brought 
 him a loaded pistol, and held him up while he fired at the sha- 
 man. Mis trembling hands could not direct the ball, and Lar- 
 riown dragged himself out to the river-bank. Here he found a 
 Koyukun woman, who had been staying at the fort, with her 
 i).'iby on a little sled, which she was drawing by a band over her 
 forehead. He threw the child into the snow, and ordered her to 
 draw him to Koyukuk. She refused, and he stabbed her to the 
 heart ! How he fi* Jly got away, no one knows. Thus ended 
 the Nulato massacre. 
 
 An Ingalik, named Lofka, was sent by the Russians with a 
 letter to the Redoubt. He placed it in his boot, fortunately, for 
 
 i;. 
 
 ■k[ 
 
 it. 
 
 If 
 

 I • 
 
 I >i 
 
 ( ll 
 
 52 
 
 THE YUKON TEURITOKV. 
 
 he was stopped on the river and searched by two Koyiikuns, who 
 suspected his errand. Finding nothing, they let him go. 
 
 Mr. Adams, the surgeon, imn:ediately started, with Teleczhik 
 and a party of Russians, for Nulito. Captain Pirn, having re- 
 turned from his adventurous journey frost-bitten, could not ac- 
 company him, and remained at Unalaklik. 
 
 The Russians had sewed up the wounds ; but, before Mr. 
 Adams arrived, Lieut'.'nant Barnard was dead. It only remained 
 for him to perform the last sad offices and to erect a cross over 
 his grave, with the following inscription : — 
 
 LIEUiENANT J. J. liARXARD, 
 
 Ok II. M. Kntkkprisk, 
 
 Killed F"l) 16, 1851, 
 
 IIY TIM. Koi'Kl'K l.\I)l.\NS, 
 
 V. A. 
 
 The Russian American Company, as is the wont of trading 
 companies, never took any measures of retaliation for this mas- 
 sacre. Larriown. and Ivan, the murdeier of the bidarshik, are 
 frequent visitors at the fort. Presents were sent to the Koyukun 
 chiefs, and there the matter ended. A stockaded fort was soon 
 built on the jiresent site, and the graves of Barnard and Deni- 
 bin lie a stone's throw behind it, The excavations where the 
 Indian houses stood are still to be seen, and form the graves of 
 those natives who jierished by the massacre. 
 
 On the 29th of November the indefatigable Mike started 
 again for Ulukuk. I occupied myself with putting my instru- 
 ments in order for meteorological observations. The thermome- 
 ter, a standard one, registered thirty-si.\ below zero. Our cook 
 and principal assistant about the house, in the absence of the 
 fairer sex, was Peetka, the son of Ivan, previously mi-iitioned as 
 the murderer of Denibin. His father was acting as an inter- 
 preter for the Russians. In an Indian house, outside the stock- 
 ade, Larriown was domiciled with his wit\' and eliild. The ajijiear- 
 ance of this man was remarkable. A small round head and face, 
 piercing eyes, thin scattered hair, a sho ■ pug nose (unusual in an 
 Indian), a tremendous development ol the muscles of the jaw, 
 a very dark complexion, and a fiendish expression of countenance 
 combined to make his appearance the reverse of attractive, even 
 when in good humor. 
 
Ili 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 53 
 
 His wife possessed some of these characteristics in a lesser 
 degree, but was equally repulsive. Both of them had gained, 
 by a long list of evil deeds, a reputation as sorcerers or shamans, 
 which made their influence among the Indians immense. Both 
 of them were well acquainted with the uses of intoxicating liquors, 
 which for some years the Koyiikuns have obtained from traders 
 at Kotzebue Sound. This circumstance has done much to ren- 
 der the tribe, naturally cruel and turbulent, one of the worst in 
 the territory. Fortunately, disease and the scarcity of Ibod, annu- 
 ally increased by the use of firearms in killing reindeer, have 
 reduced their numbers, and at present they can hardly muster 
 over two hundred families. From increased immorality, chie to 
 the introduction of liquor, the births are few, and hardly replace 
 the deaths. Few women have more than two children, while 
 many have only one, a large proportion being barren. The 
 tribe, therefore, may be regarded as on its way to extinction. 
 
 They are of the f;\niily of Tinneh, belonging, with the Ingaliks 
 and Nowikakat Indians, to the division of Fastern Ti'nneh. 
 Their dialect is closely allied to the Ingalik, hardly differing 
 more from it than the widely separated local dialects of Ingalik 
 differ from one another. Their principal villages are on the 
 Kotclk;lkat and Kotelno Rivers, the largest being known as 
 Kotelk;ikat. 
 
 The Indians living on the Yukon between Koyukuk and 
 Xuklukahyet are known to ihe Ingaliks as Urakat.iri.i, or 
 " lar-off people," and call tl'.emselves, with most other Indians 
 living on the river, Yukor.ikatiina, or " men of the ^'ukon." 
 
 The Nulato Ingaliks are nearly e.xtinct. Tlie Ingaliks liv- 
 ing on the other side of the Yukon, between it and the Kaiyuh 
 Mountains (known os Takai'tsky to the Russians), bear the name 
 of K;iiyuhkatana, or ■' lowland people," and the other branches of 
 Ingaliks have simila' names, while preserving their general tribal 
 name. 
 
 The Ingaliks are, as a rule, tall, well-made, but slender. They 
 have very long, squarely oval faces, high prominent cheek-bones, 
 large ears, small mouths, no.ses, and eyes, ami an unusually large 
 lower jaw. The nose is well formed and a(|uiline, but small in 
 proportion to the rest of the face. 1'he hair is King, coarse, and 
 black, and generally parted in the middle. Ikit few of them 
 
 ,11 
 
 
 I 
 
 m 
 
 
 !' I 
 
 I ", 
 
 
 if 
 
 ( l>; 
 
 i 
 
m 
 
 Ll 
 
 ' ! I 
 
 h :> 
 
 
 n 
 
 '•|! 
 
 54 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 shave the crown, as is the custom among the Eskimo. Their 
 complexion is an ashy brown, perhaps from dirt in many cases, 
 and they seldom have much color. On the other hand, the 
 Koyiikuns, with the same high cheek-bones and piercing eyes, 
 have much shorter faces, more roundly oval, of a pale olive hue, 
 and frequently arched eyebrows and a fine color. They are the 
 most attractive in appearance of the Indians in this part of the 
 territory, as they are the most untamable. The women espe- 
 cially are more attractive than those among the Ingaliks, whose 
 square faces and ashy complexion render the latter very plain, 
 not to say repulsive. The women do up their hair in two braids, 
 one on each side ; but among the Koyiikuns it is not uncommon 
 to see the hair cut short, especially after a death in the family. 
 The detached hair is tied up in a little bundle and placed in the 
 crotch of a tree, or anywhere where it will not be disturbed by 
 animals. Parings from the nails are treated in the same way, as 
 they have a superstition that disease will follow the disturbance 
 of such remains by wild animals. 
 
 The original dress of the male Koyukuns consists of a pair 
 of breeches of deerskin, with the moccasins, or coverings for the 
 feet, attached, and a deerskin parka without any hood, long 
 and pointed before and behind. At present they buy many 
 articles of clothing from the Eskimo and from the Russians, 
 especially for winter wear. They are fond of ornaments and gay 
 colors, while the Ingaliks, who wear clothing much like that 
 adopted by the Ivskimo, care little for ornaments or beads. 
 Both build houses similar to those already described, while the 
 other tribes of the same fixmily, to the eastward, build only tem- 
 porary lodges of skins and poles, which they transport from place 
 to place. The habits, utensils, and mode of life of the Ingaliks 
 and Koyukuns are very similar, and will be more fully describeil 
 hereafter. 
 
 They depend for food upon the reindeer and moose, salmon 
 and other fish, anil small game, more or less, according to the re- 
 sources of the locality in which they live. At Nukito the only 
 dependence is fish, and some small game, such as grou.sc and 
 water-fowl in their seasons. There are no deer or moose at 
 Nuliito, and food is often very scarce. 
 
 I found a constant current of cokl air, with a temperature from 
 
 ^1' 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 55 
 
 \m 
 
 — 32° to — 55° Fah., entering our room by means of the cracks 
 in the floor, which was composed of logs squared on the upper 
 side. Needles, forks, spoons, and other articles of use and orna- 
 ment followed each other into the abyss. The matter, though 
 laughable, was also serious, as our stock of the last-named 
 articles amounted to only one apiece. After consultation we 
 employed Kun'lla, one of the few surviving Nulato Indians, 
 to calk the seams with moss. Our stock of this was soon ex- 
 hausted, following the spoons, and we made the best of a bad 
 job by covering the floor thickly with straw, that again with 
 mats, and over all nailing some old blankets. By placing a few 
 reindeer-skins about for rugs, we managed to improve matters a 
 good deal. Previously, one day when the freshly heated peechka 
 was pouring out a generous supply of hot air, I tried the ther- 
 mometer at the eaves, where it stood at ninety ; four feet above the 
 floor gave a temperature of forty-five, while on the floor the mer- 
 cury indicated several degrees below freezing. The walls were 
 anything but tight, and the warm air of the room deposited its 
 e.xtra moisture in hoar-frost, like feathers, near the fissures. 
 
 Peetka proved very unreliable, disappearing and staying so, 
 just when we wanted him, and Kurilla, the Indian before men- 
 tioned, was secured as a substitute. His history was romantic. 
 Son of a wealthy and influential chief and shaman, at the time 
 of the Nulato massacre he was but three or four years old ; in it 
 his father, mother, and all their family perished. The boy and 
 his sister, a year older, were in the trading-post at the time, and 
 escaped unharmed, from their extreme youth. Some of the Rus- 
 sians had taken pity on them and brought them up, until, as they 
 grew older, they were able to earn their own liying. 
 
 His sister, christened Anna, was one of the most comely Inga- 
 liks who came under our notice. Both of them were unusu- 
 ally tall ; both had acquired habits of neatness and an excel- 
 lent knowledge of the Russian language, from their residence in 
 tile trading-post. Anna was married to a very good kind of 
 tellow, an Ingalik, who had accompanied us in our journey from 
 Ulukuk and who was named Little Sid(')rka, to distinguish him 
 from another of the same name but of greater longitudi'. 
 
 Kurilla i^roved to be a faithful and intelligent lellow, and having 
 had some experience in cooking ior our parties during the previ- 
 
 'hi 
 
 >': 
 
 :: ^ 
 
WW 
 
 ^ I. 
 
 r' 
 
 h 1 
 
 ( ' t 
 
 
 56 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ous year, was well qualified to assist in the culinary department. 
 To be sure, our style of living was simple and unostentatious, 
 consisting principally of fried white-fish three times a day, varied 
 by bacon, of which we were very sparing when fish was obtain- 
 able. 
 
 Finding a blanket on the bare boards, even alleviated by a 
 deerskin, rather uncomfortable sleeping arrangements, we pur- 
 chased several large feather-beds, filled with spoils from the wild 
 geese and ducks, and had a small mattress made from them for 
 each one of the party. With the addition of a pillow from the 
 same source, we felt as if we could enjoy the sleep of the just, 
 without danger of rheumatism. 
 
 Our plans for the coming season were now discussed and 
 approximately settled. VVhymper and myself decided to ascend 
 the Yukon together, as far as Fort Yukon, by water in the spring. 
 Ketchum proposed, in company with Mike Lebaige, to make the 
 same journey over the ice, with dogs and sleds, in February. 
 Dyer was to descend the Yukon and investigate the delta. On 
 the 4th of December the temperature was fifty-six below zero. 
 Faint parhelia aj^jpeaied. In a short walk I observed that the 
 atmosphere seemed filled with an icy mist, small acicular crystals 
 of ice suspended in the air. On the 7th, the weather being 
 milder (twenty-two below zero), I decided to visit the coal scam 
 below Nukito before the snow should cover it. Only one dog was 
 available ; so, getting a small sled, and packing our blankets, 
 chynik, and mess-pan upon it, with a bag for bringing some coal 
 from the vein for trial, I started ahead, while Kurilla followed 
 with the sled. We met Yagor.sha on the way, who with many 
 gesticulations declared that we were going to have a severe snow- 
 storm, and that we had better turn back. I concluded to risk it, 
 however, and we finally arrived at the Shamdn IJluff, where wc 
 soon found a sheltered ravine with plenty of dry wood ; spread- 
 ing a blanket as an awning to keep off the snow, which came 
 thick and fast, we built a cheerful fire and enjoyed our tea. 
 After a good night's rest and a hearty breakfast of bacon, biscuit, 
 and tea, I went to the end of the bluff, where the coal was situ- 
 ated. A thorough examination of it showed that the seam was 
 much contorted, running out at each end completely ; that the 
 only mass of coal was in a large pocket or elbow of the contorted 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY, 
 
 57 
 
 seam ; and that the whole deposit contained less than a ton. 
 What there was of it was of excellent quality, hardened by- 
 heat and compression ; it was enclosed on each side by thin 
 layers of shale and the brown Miocene sandstone previously 
 alluded to. 
 
 Filling a bag with fragments of coal and geological specimens 
 as trophies, we started homeward. The poor dog, I am afraid, 
 had a hard time of it, what with the soft new sinow and the 
 weight of the bag, but we arrived without detention or accident, 
 though rather tired. 
 
 Kun'lla, who was an excellent shot and an enthusiastic sports- 
 man, liked nothing better than to spend an hour every day shoot- 
 ing specimens for our collection. I obtained many more than 
 I had dared to hope for in this way, — redpolls, downy and 
 three-toed woodpeckers, pine grosbeaks, titmice, hawk-owls, and 
 (strange to say) a bullfinch {Pyrr/iii/a), the first ever shot on the 
 American continent. On the iith, Mike returned from Ulukuk 
 with Francis, and this event, with the news that our friends 
 brought from below, was quite a relief to the monotony of our 
 daily life. 
 
 On the 1 2th, a chief arrived at the fort from Nuklukahydt, 
 where the Tananah River joins the Yukon. lie greeted Ketchum 
 as an old acquaintance, and promised to have plenty of moose 
 meat for us when we should come that way in the spring. Me 
 remained several days at the fort, and on one of them assembled 
 a number of Indians in our room and discoursed to them at the 
 top of his lungs for nearly two hours. I expected to see him 
 drop from exhaustion, every minute of the last half-hour, but long 
 practice had doubtless inured him to it, and I resigned myself, 
 while one of the party took up a conceitina and played " Tramp, 
 tramp" by way of diversity. 
 
 The return brigade was intrusted to Scratchett, who left, 
 with Francis, for L'nalaklik on the 17th, while Mike rested his 
 weary l)ones for a season. 
 
 I continued adding to my collections and vocabularies, and 
 setting traps for foxes, who iuul a fashion of carrying otf the bait 
 without disturbing the trap. Iv;in I'avloff, however, succt-cded in 
 
 trapping several, of which I sociu'cd tlie skt'lct 
 
 ons. 
 
 W 
 
 lymper 
 
 was busily at work on his sketches, while Mike and Ketch 
 
 urn 
 
 •i H 
 
 I 
 
 
 ■ • i 
 
 .i . 
 \ 
 
 
 ;i 
 
 
 ■-■1 
 
 
 Mi 
 
 1 
 
i in 
 
 !l 
 
 7 
 
 
 i ft 
 
 ill! 
 
 I i 
 
 
 : V 
 
 i 
 
 ', i 
 
 • 1 
 
 1 ;! 
 
 5« 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 were getting ready for their proposed journey. Altogether, time 
 did not hang very heavily on our hands. 
 
 We found the Indians to be a great nuisance in one way. 
 They had a habit of coming in and sitting down, doing and 
 saying nothing, but watching everything. At meal-times they 
 seemed to count and weigh every morsel we ate, and were never 
 backward in assisting to dispose of the remains of the meal. 
 Occasionally we would get desperate and clean them all out ; 
 but they would drop in again, and we could do nothing but 
 resign ourselves to the annoyance, as we did not wish to offend 
 them. They intended no offence, doubtless, but wanted an oppor- 
 tunity of studying the Anglo-Sa.xon species of the genus /nn^w in 
 its lair. 
 
 Fish growing scarce, Karpoff was fitted out with some trading- 
 goods, and sent to Koyukuk in hope that he might obtain some 
 grouse or rabbits from the Indians of that locality. 
 
 Christmas time approaching, we joined in endeavoring to cele- 
 brate the day appropriately. Our knowledge of chemistry and 
 the domestic arts was ta.xed to the utmost in the production 
 of pies, gingerbread, and cranberry dumplings ; while a piece 
 of Uliikuk reindeer meat, which had been kept frozen ever 
 since our journey across the portage, performed the office of 
 the customary " roast beef of old England," and a brace of 
 roasted ptarmigan represented the Yankee turkeys. Green peas, 
 tomatoes, and other preserved vegetables were produced for the 
 occasion; and, with the company of the bidarshik and his assist- 
 ant, we sat down to the best dinner ever eaten in that part of the 
 continent. The day was enlivened by the reading of several 
 original literary productions, and the brewing of a mild bowl 
 of punch from a supply of old Jamaica, which we owed to the 
 kind thoiightfulness of Mr.s. Scammon. Altogether the occasion 
 was one which will long be remembered with pleasure by those 
 who took part in it. 
 
 The 27th of December an observation was made, wliich 
 .showed the day to be just three hours long. As nearly as 
 our watches could determine, the sun rose at a quarter before 
 eleven, and set at a quarter of two. Proposing on New-^'ear's 
 day to raise the first telegraph pole in the division of the Yu- 
 kon, Mike went out with Kun'lla, and returned with a fine 
 
'If 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 59 
 
 spruce, of the orthodox dimensions, for the purpose. An In- 
 dian, with the euphonious Russian name of Squirtzottj was em- 
 ployed to peel and trim it. 
 
 On the 31st we sat the Old Year out, and hailed the New 
 with its prospect of successful explorations. We had hoped 
 that our party might all be present on New- Year's day ; but 
 there was no sign of the expected arrival of Mr. Dyer. After 
 breakfast we went out in a body and raised the first telegraph 
 pole, ornamented with the flags of the United States, the Tele- 
 graph Expedition, the Masonic fraternity, and the Scientific 
 Corps. A salute of thirty-six guns was fired, — one for each 
 State ; and the enthusiastic Kurilla was brought to the ground 
 by the recoil of a great Russian blunderbuss, which he had 
 undertaken to discharge. 
 
 A few days after, Ivan Pavloff returned from a journey of 
 several hundred miles with dog-sleds, bringing about five hundred 
 marten or American sable skins. 
 
 The Russians throughout this territory compute their time 
 according to Old Style, and hence are always eleven days behind 
 time. They celebrated Christmas and New- Year's day on the 5th 
 and 1 2th of January, respectively. 
 
 Dyer arrived on the 3d, and on the 5th Captain Ketchum 
 started on a last visit to the Redoubt. 
 
 Strong endeavors were made to construct some sleds for 
 Ketchum's trip, after the style of the Hudson Bay Company ; but, 
 having no patterns, much good birch was spoiled without satis- 
 factory results. 
 
 We had entertained great expectations of seeing exhibitions 
 of the Aurora Borealis of unusual beauty ; but they were not 
 realized. The few displays which were observed were of an 
 insignificant character. No colored lights were noticed, and the 
 l)rilliancy of the light was far below what we had anticipated. 
 Several of these displays, however, presented phenomena which 
 may not be uninteresting to the general reader, as showing dis- 
 tinctly some points not previously establisheil in rcgaril to the 
 mode of appearance of the aurora under some circumstances. 
 February 1 ith, 1867, an aurora was observed under the following 
 conditions. From a gap in the hills north of Nuhito, a white 
 light was seen to issue, early in the evening. The sky was 
 
 I 
 
 ; if 
 
 uki'! 
 
rr 
 
 rry^ 
 
 I* 
 
 % 
 
 I 
 
 1 ; i 
 
 ' 
 
 I 
 
 60 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 much overcast with cirro-stratus clouds, which were rapidly pass- 
 ing in a different direction from the wind at the surface of 
 the earth, which last was from the north. The light before alluded 
 to approached with the wind, at about half the pace of the wind, 
 in a cloudlike shape or condition, not far from the surface of the 
 earth. The form of this luminous cloud was in successive waves, 
 or ripples, and resembled the rings of smoke rising from a pipe, 
 one within another, gradually expanding. The inner or focal 
 rings were more intense than the outer ones, and the light was 
 more intense in some parts of the rings than in others. They 
 advanced as the ripples do when a stone is thrown into still 
 water, and these ripples were compressed in an oval form by 
 the wind, the longer diameter being east and west, across the 
 current. It showed unmistakably that the shining medium was in 
 consistence similar to cloud or mist. From the brighter portions 
 of the rings, light streams of the same medium occasionally 
 dripped, and dissipated at some distance below the point whence 
 they originated ; from which it might be inferred that the more 
 intense portion of this medium was denser than the atmosphere. 
 No rays or streamers issued upwards from the upper edges of 
 the rings, which were clearly defined and below the real clouds, of 
 which the altitude seemed less than fifteen hundred feet. The 
 hills from between which the auroral cloud had issued, and the 
 tops of the higher trees between the fort and the hills, were 
 dimly seen, or obscured by the lower portion of the haze, or cloud, 
 which seemed not more than a hundred feet above the earth, as 
 seen from the roof of the higher building. It followed the air- 
 currents entirely; and all its motions seemed guided or controlled 
 by them. Wavy outlines in the ripples seemed caused by the dif- 
 fering velocity of the air in different parts of the current. It cov- 
 ered the whole sky in about two houis from the time of its first 
 appearance. As it spread and enlarged, the light became fainter. 
 It (lid not give out a positive light, but had a mildly luminous 
 appearance, like phosphorescence.* 
 
 Captain Ketchum and Mike had returned February ist, bring- 
 ing with them Captain Everett Smith, of the Wilder, and a 
 
 * These remarkable phenomena were observed, in a greater or lesser degree, in 
 several instances, of which an account was coinniunicated to the National Academy, 
 at its session in September, 1869, by the writer. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 6i 
 
 good budget of news. Several miles of poles had been erected 
 in the vicinity of Grantley Harbor and Unalakli'k. Provisions, 
 especially tea and sugar, were at a high premium. Our sup- 
 ply of tea had been very small, and coffee in this climate is 
 worthless. 
 
 A point near the Klatkakhatne River was decided upon for the 
 location of the head-quarters of the Yukon division, and a bargain 
 was made with Paspilkoff, the shaky-headed Russian, to put up 
 the building, which was to be of logs. 
 
 I prepared the specimens of natural history which had been 
 obtained during the winter, for transportation to Unalakli'k and 
 the Redoubt. They filled two large bo.xes, many acceptable ad- 
 ditions having been made through the kindness of my compan- 
 ions. 
 
 A walk with Captain Smith, near the fort, resulted in obtaining 
 a fine specimen of the Hudson Bay titmouse {Pants Iliidsonicus), 
 a bird which I had not previously collected, and the first specimen 
 of which I owe, with many other valuable birds, to his quick eye 
 and unerring aim. 
 
 About this time a little excitement occurred, owing to a rumor, 
 started by one of the Indian women in the fort, to the effect that 
 Larridwn had planned the destruction of one of the proposed 
 parties which were to ascend the Yukon. A council of inquiry 
 proved, however, that the rumor had no more reliable foundation 
 than a dream. 
 
 The Indians are exceedingly suspicious in the most unimportant 
 things, and the following incident is a good illustration of it. In 
 talking over the scarcity of provisions, some one had jokingly 
 remarked, that, if we were driven to the wall, we should have to 
 make soup of Paspi'lkoff's baby, a new addition to our population. 
 This was repeated by one of the women, and very soon old Iv;in 
 the interpreter made his appearance, saying that the Indians 
 wished to know if we were cannibals. He added that, since the 
 time of Ikilegin's murder at Koyukuk, there was no instance 
 known where the Indians had eaten human flesh. After indulg- 
 ing in a hearty laugh, we relieved his apprehensions, which seemed 
 to be serious, and thereafter were more guarded in our remarks. 
 
 Peetka, his .son, had been very active in procuring birds for 
 my collection, and much to my regret appeared one day with 
 
 it 
 
 u 
 
 m 
 
 
 w 
 
 : I'l 
 
 
 I 
 
■|i 
 
 i 
 
 62 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 three fingers of his left hand nearly blown off, by carelessly pull- 
 ing his gun through the bushes by the muzzle. The injury was 
 so serious that amputation seemed necessary, but by careful ap- 
 plication of water dressings twice daily, I was enabled to preserve 
 them, though in a stiff and useless condition. Sometime after, 
 the little fellow brought me in a marten, one of his own trapping, 
 tlie only fee for medical .services I received in Russian America 
 during two years' practice. 
 
 The details of our Yukon trip were settled, and the boatmen 
 engaged, so that we felt a reasonable confidence in the suc- 
 cessful result of our proposed explorations. In the mean time I 
 occupied myself taking angles and measurements for a chart of 
 the Yukon and the small rivers near Nulato, in the constant ad- 
 dition of specimens to the collection, with the meteorological rec- 
 ords, and the enlargement of my vocabularies. 
 
 One of the Russians took occasion one evening to express his 
 dislike of the Americans by beating and abusing, without cause, 
 a boy in our employ called Antoshka. Wii ut recourse to the 
 bidarshik, Ketchum treated him to his deserts, — a well merited 
 thrashing. This timely protection to our Indian .servants much 
 increased our popularity among the Indians, and enforced re- 
 spect from the Russian convicts employed by the Russian Ameri- 
 can Company, in a salutary manner. 
 
 Breaking the minute-hand of my watch one day, I repaired the 
 damage by unwinding the silver thread from a violin-string and 
 twisting a portion of it around the barrel of the broken hand. 
 Opportunities for the exercise of ingenuity of this kind are fre- 
 quent in this country, where few mechanics of any kind are to 
 be found. The remarkable facility with which the Russian peas- 
 ant can turn his hand to anything was well exemplihed among 
 the men in the fort. All of them, with the t(r/>or, or .short-handled 
 Russian broad-axe, could accomplish almost any piece of carpen- 
 tering, from squaring a log to building a boat or a house. Many 
 of them could handle blacksmiths' tools, and even manufacture, 
 from sheet copper (provided by the Russian Company), chy- 
 niks, kettles, and lamps for burning the seal oil used in winter. 
 There are several good blacksmiths in the country, and Aleuts, 
 Creoles, and even Indians learn the use of their tools with re- 
 markable ease. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 63 
 
 On the 6th of March the plans for our proposed new station 
 were decided upon, and the exact location selected. The en- 
 closure was to be one hundred feet by si.\ty-five, and to con- 
 tain a barrack, officers' quarters, bath-house, cook-house, and 
 several store-houses. Paspilkoff promised to set about the work 
 at once, and il was agreed that the members of the party would 
 assist him in bringing and raising the heavy timbers. 
 
 On the nth of March, having completed his preparations. Cap- 
 tain Ketchum set out on his adventurous journey with Mike over 
 the ice to Fort Yukon. It was undertaken under the most dis- 
 couraging circumstances. Neither his provisions nor his dog- 
 feed were sufficient to last during the journey of over six hun- 
 dred miles. Russians and Indians alike shook their heads and 
 declared their disbelief in his prospects of success. The snow 
 would be soft and impassable. The dogs would run away, or 
 give out for want of food, and die. He could not feed himself 
 or his Indians, and all would perish of starvation. The Ulukuk 
 Indians who had engai^cd to go backed out at the last mo- 
 ment, and there was extreme difficulty in obtaining two men and 
 two boys to take their place. This was finally done through 
 the intervention of old Ivan, who sent his own son Peetka, and 
 induced the others to go. The very day was dull and cloudy, 
 with indications of snow. For two white men to undertake such 
 a journey, in the face of all this discouragement, through a coun- 
 try of which the resources were known to be very precarious, 
 with the prospect of certain starvation if their guns did not sup- 
 ply them with sufficient game to feed the dogs and party, was 
 resolute and courageous in the extreme. From this point of view 
 the journey was unquestionably one of the most remarkable 
 undertaken by modern explorers. 
 
 As their heavily laden sleds moved slowly away over the soft 
 snow, we hoisted the stars and stripes, gave them three volleys 
 from the big gun, a hearty cheer, and any number of salutes from 
 guns and pistols. As they passed out of sight, the chances of 
 success and failure seemed so unevenly balanced that we hardly 
 dared to anticipate the realization of the plans which they were 
 so bravely and energetically endeavoring to carry out. 
 
 Our party now consisted only of Messrs. Dyer, Whymper, and 
 mvself, with Scratchett the constructor, and two Indians. 
 
 I I 
 
 iM 
 
 , k 
 
 \k 
 
 li! 
 
 
 1 ' 
 
 M 
 
 
I . 
 
 64 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I 
 
 I 
 
 IT I '! 
 
 .'. ■ 'I 
 
 On the 1 8th our eyes were gladdened by the appearance of old 
 Yagorsha, with the little skin boat, purchased at Ulukuk last fall, 
 for which he had been sent. It came up from Ulukuk entire, on 
 a sled drawn by five dogs, and had sustamcd some slight injuries. 
 In this boat, Mr. Whymper and myself were to ascend the Yu- 
 kon after the spring freshet. Antoshka and another Indian were 
 sent by Dyer down the Yukon to a place called Ycxknts-kahiteuik, 
 where a three-holed bidarka was supposed to lie, which he pro- 
 posed to use in descending the Yukon and pursuing his examina- 
 tion of the delta. 
 
 We determined, although it was not strictly in the line of 
 our duty, to cut and erect the poles necessary to bear the line be- 
 tween the Nulato post and the proposed site of our new Fort 
 Kennicott. The distance was a few rods over a mile, and re- 
 quired about thirty poles. The work was done entirely by the 
 four members of our party, except clearing away the brush and 
 trees for twelve feet on each side, which we intrusted to one of 
 the Russian workmen. 
 
 Dog-feed and fresh provisions giving out, I proposed to make 
 a trip to the Kaiyuh villages, and endeavor to purchase any sup- 
 plies which the Indians might be able to spare. I arrived with 
 Kun'lla and the dogs at a small village of two houses, on the left 
 bank of the river, nearly opposite Alikofif's barrabora, and being 
 the residence of the old veteran Wolasdtux. The village is known 
 by his name. I found all the Indians away, and was obliged to 
 take some fish out of his cache to feed the dogs with. 
 
 Wolasatu.x barrabora is a well built Indian winter house, and 
 stands near another smaller one, with two or three caches about 
 it, on a small clearing in a dense growth of poplars and willows. 
 These trees grow so close together, that they have reached the 
 height of some thirty or forty feet, almost without branches, and 
 so slender that it gives one a feeling as of standing on a Hat pin- 
 cushion beset with enormous needles and pins. An old man 
 finally appeared, who sold us a few ukali and some grouse. The 
 next morning, Kun'lla went out, and in the course of his hunting 
 met some Indians, who informed him that Antoshka had not been 
 able to obtain any dog-feed here or at Kaltag, and that it was not 
 improbable his dogs might be starving. Also, that all the Indians 
 were away after deer, and that it was uncertain when they would 
 
THE YUKUN TERRITORY. 
 
 65 
 
 It 
 
 1- 
 n 
 
 
 or 
 
 II 
 t 
 
 Is 
 
 ll 
 
 return. This determined mc to return to Nuhlto, so that Dyer 
 might send some fish from our slender store to Antoshka, and 
 thus prevent his journey from coming to an unfortunate con- 
 clusion. There was no prospect of buying anything wliere we 
 
 were. 
 
 The next morning we set out for Xuhito, and found that the 
 moist snow rendered the travelling very hard. The weather was 
 so warm that the snow adiiered in large lumps to the snowshoes, 
 adding a weight of ten or twelve pounds to the foot at each step, 
 
 Wolasatux' bnrraboia in winter. 
 
 until the masses would break oft" by their own weiglit, the same 
 process being repeated indefinitely. We were exceedingly fa- 
 tigued upon our arrival, near dusk. 
 
 It was immediately determined to send Scratchett down to 
 Kaltag with some fish for Antoshka. Our prospects of food at 
 this time were anything but encouraging. Wherever the blame 
 should have fallen, the ct remained, that if it had not been for 
 the flour and fish we obtained from the Russians, we sliould have 
 been in a starving condition ; while it was said, and never denied, 
 so far as I know, that the Nightingale, on her return, carried with 
 S 
 
 i,' II 
 
 1 I 
 
 1 
 
 ^ 
 
 ii 
 
 ' , 1 
 
 :* :i 
 
 i> '" ■' 
 
 .id 
 
w^. 
 
 \i\ 
 
 11 
 
 i V ; ,1 
 
 ■.!.H I 
 
 'i' 
 
 ')\l > 
 
 66 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 her ten thousand rations. The iireposterous folly of issuing food 
 by ordinary rations to men in an arctic, or nearly arctic climate, 
 was never more fully demonstrated. On the resources of the 
 country as developed by the natives, who have all they can do to 
 {ccd then-selves, a large body of men cannot support them.selves 
 in this part of the territory, unless their time be devoted to noth- 
 
 mg else. 
 
 On the 8th of April, Scratchctt returned with a load of fresh 
 reimleer meat, which he had obtained from the Indians, a number 
 of whom accompanied him. Among them was W'olasatu.x and 
 his foster-son Mikai.shka, and Tekunka, a noted shaman and 
 tyone among the Kaiyuh Indians. The latter proved to be a 
 very good kind of fellow ; he sold us a large amount of me;U, 
 rel"using the offers of the Russians, who saw his sled-load taken 
 into our store-house with unconcealed disgust. The day had 
 gone b)- when they couUl contrt)l the trade of that kind, and force 
 the reluctant Indian to sell against his will his hard-earned booty 
 for a leaf or two of tobacco and a few balls. 
 
 We paid liberally, but not extravagantly, for provisions of all 
 kinds, and as the supply was very limited, the Russians, un- 
 willing to raise their tariff of prices, were often obliged to go 
 without. 
 
 The continued warm weather was melting the snow ri'pidly, 
 and although we had cleaned off the roof as much as possible, 
 still the melting ice caused i constant c'. '.pping during the day. 
 The evening rost would put an end to it for a while, bul it 
 returned with the heat of the morning sun. 
 
 The Nulato and other small rivers had felt the effects of 
 the melting snow, and the ice on the jdge of the ^'ukon, which 
 rests on and is frozen to the beach, was covered with water ironi 
 them. 
 
 Flies, to all appearance the common universal house-fly, as \\c]\ 
 as the bluebottle, had appeared in large numbers, and migh be 
 seen on the sunny siile of every wall. 
 
 On the loth I found the first fully expanded willow catkins, 
 and the preltv red c.itkin of the alder. A whiU'-winged crossbill. 
 the first so far obtained, was shot in ,i grove of po])lars not far 
 from the' jiost. 
 
 On the roof of the house I obtained a larg<; number of small 
 
 il 
 
THE Yl'KON' TERRITORY. 
 
 67 
 
 musk-beetles, of a stccl-grccn color and stronnj odor. Several 
 other species wero obtained from the .stumps and mossy hillocks 
 which bcyan to project above the level of the snow. The field- 
 mice were also beginniuL; to be active, and the chiUlren about the 
 fort eagerly scanned with their keen eyes, bow and arrow in hand, 
 the various stumps and crevices where they mi;;ht tint! them; 
 when successful they flockeil with their prizes to me, sure of a 
 few beads or some other trinket to rejxiy them for their labor. 
 
 The wliiti: [flarmigan be^an moultin^i;", or rather brown feathers 
 ben'an to appear in their necks and oi. .he echoes of the wings, 
 where the first change may be looked for. 
 
 While skinning a hawk-owl I discovered in the ovary an egg, 
 nearly perfect. Ivun'Ua, on his return from a foraging expedition, 
 brought fine specimens of the great gray owl {Sj'n/i/nii riiit-irinin, 
 which measured four feet across the wings, and the white owl 
 (.VjvAvc uk'iv). The latter frcciueiulv flies by (la_,' without difii- 
 culty, and he is a sharj) hunter who i an apjjroach it within gun- 
 shot, even at midday. 
 
 .Al)ril 23d being a good snowy day, I took adxantage oi the 
 opportunity, to visit a gra\e on iIk point, near the Nul.'ito River. 
 Carefully lifting the covii, \ removed the cranium, and putting 
 it into my haversack, I retunnd iiy a roundabout way to the 
 fort. I had long liad my e\c upon this grave, and had bi-en 
 waiting for weather wluch wnuld cover up my tracks, in urder 
 to secure the skull. The Iiulians are vmv superstitious in regard 
 to touching anything that has belonged with a de.id bod\-, and 
 wouUI have been highly incensed ha<l it btcome known. I'here- 
 fo'-e I look the first opportunit) of packing safelv awav the only 
 Ingalik cranium ever collecte-d. 
 
 /\n e.\|)e(lition to tile blutls aixive \iil;ito rr-^ulted in my obtain- 
 ing a iMuiiber ot tos-^ils, wliitli probabh' 1 i(heale a Miocene age 
 for these bei'.^. There are very f<w and very poor fossils in 
 these sands'^ones, notwithstanding their vide extent and gre'at 
 thi( km ss. 
 
 liirds became niori- j)lentirul ;is spring ad\aiued, manv sum- 
 mer visitors arriving in Apiil and the eaiK put ol' M;iv. Tiie 
 hawks and (jwls were already laying iheii- e-gs, and the young 
 of the Canada jay, as 1 afterwards learned, wtii' alreadv hatched. 
 Scratehett started lor Unalakb'k April j^th, uiih Mie last mails. 
 
 
 m 
 
 v\ 
 
 \,\i 
 
r 
 
 '^ 
 
 ^1 
 
 ■X I 
 
 I'i 
 
 68 
 
 THK YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 and on the last trip possible this season. The Russians prophe- 
 sied that he would not be able to get through, and the weather 
 gave some prol^ability to their croakings. 
 
 The 25th oi"i\pril was a great holiday, or prnsuik, of th(.- Rus- 
 sians. It was their Kaster, and was a day of rejoieing for us 
 also, as Antcishka returned from a foraging expedition on the 
 Kdiyuh River with a good load of deer meat from Tekunka. 
 Out of our plenty we sent a haunch in to Ivan IVivloliT, to his 
 great satisfaction. 
 
 The walls of Fort Kennicott already began to assume their 
 proportions, and we frec|uently went up to assist Paspilkoff in the 
 work of raising the logs to their i)roper places. 
 
 On the 28th old Maria died. She was an Indian woman, 
 long domiciled with the Russians, and had been present at the 
 Nulato massacre. 
 
 On the following day the first goose was seen, the .solitary 
 advance-guard of the thousands to come. Strolling on the 
 beach, I obtained a small hawk and the first snipe of the season. 
 The weather hail become exceedingly warm. Shirt-sleeves were 
 the rule, and the little children enjoyed themselves on the broad 
 river-beach, building houses with pebbles and making mud pies, 
 much as their brothers and sisters do all over the world when 
 a vacation or a holiday releases them from restraint and the 
 mother's watchful eye. I never saw a young child punished in 
 Russian America, except the well-grown boys of the Russian 
 bidarshik. They behave quite as well as civilized children, and 
 grow up with cpiite as much respect for their ))arents. .An 
 Indian baby, uidess sick, never cries; and why should it .■■ It has 
 no one to rub .soap in its eyes, and never feels the weight ol the 
 ixu'ental hand. The mother makes it a doll, if a girl, out of bits 
 of squirrel-skin and fur. If a boy, the father builds for him a 
 little sable-trap, a miniature caciie, in which to put his shining 
 pebbles and other chiklish treasures, or a tiny fish-trap, in which 
 the mother takes care that a choice bit of ukali, a rabbit's head, or 
 a piece of reindeer fat shall be caught in some mysterious way. 
 As soon as they can toddle about they are instructed in the 
 mysteries of .setting snares, and the pnde wiili wlveh the bins or 
 girls bring home their first grouse, or even, l)y great gootl luck, an 
 imfortunate rabbit, is fully siiared by the parents. Tlu'ir dresses 
 
■<.,^ J 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 69 
 
 arc ornamented with the choicest beads ; the sweet marrow or 
 tongue of the fallen reindeer is reserved for them by the father 
 successful in the chase. They travel hundreds of miles with the 
 dog-sleds, and from these little children I have often obtained 
 dozens of mice or small birds, caught near some solitary lodge 
 far away among the mountains, which rumor had informetl them 
 I would ])urchase with beads or trinkets. They carried these 
 proudly home again as their own earnings and the prize of their 
 own industry. I always paid something for such specimens, even 
 if cpiite worthless, to encourage them to perseverance, and in 
 this way I obtained many invaluable specimens. 
 
 Scratchett arrived from Unalaklik on the 4th of May, having 
 had a very hard journey, and getting up to his neck in water 
 while crossing some of the small rivers, swelled witii the melting 
 snow. The scurvy had attacked the parties at Unalaklik, from 
 the absence of fresh provisions, but was fortunately stayed in its 
 progress by the providential advent on the Unalaklik plains of 
 large herds of deer, of which many were killed. 
 
 On the T)d, Kurilla killed a goose, a white-cheeked brant (/>'. 
 laicoparcw), and two ducks, — a mallard and a Golden-eye He 
 received the annual pound of tobacco, the percpiisite of him 
 who kills the first goose in the spring, l-'rom this time we 
 hoped to obtain an abundance of water-fowK which are the only 
 support of the inhabitants of Nulato until the freshets subside 
 and the salmon begin to ascend the river. Curiously enough, 
 there are no fish in these rivers which will take the hook. 
 
 On the 7lh of May the first swans were seen. They are the 
 small American species, the trum|)eter not being found in this 
 region, and very rarely visiting Fort Yukon. The geese did not 
 arrive in large numbers until the 9th of May. ten days later than 
 on the previous year. The commonest ducks were the pin-tail 
 and the green-winged teal. 
 
 On the iJth of May the water came down with a rush, break- 
 ing uj) the ice on the Nulato Rivi'r, and llooding tiie ice on the 
 \'ukon. At the same tinu; a torrent poured down the KKit- 
 kakh.itne River. Ivan I'avloff, having gone shooting over to the 
 island, on his return was caught between the two currents and 
 swept into a hole in the ice. I'aspilkoff gave the alarm, and, 
 catching up two paddles, I huiried to tiie beach, where Scratchett 
 
 I I 
 
 .1 
 
 k\ ^i 
 
 \* 
 
 
 ». I » 
 
 '! i 
 1^' 1 
 
 
 V 
 
70 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 hi 
 
 i/il 
 
 had already launched a birch canoe. With Antoshka, he rapidly 
 made his way among the fragments which threatened to crush 
 the frail boat, and succeeded in extricating the Russian in safety. 
 To his credit be it said, the act was very handsomely done. The 
 Russians were shouting and running wildly about, like chickens 
 when a hawk is preparing for a swoop, and were not of the slight- 
 est assistance. 
 
 A year before, the ice having broken up, a convict named 
 Tarentoff had beei: to the island in a birch-bark canoe. Return- 
 ing, he was nipped between the ice-cakes and was sinking, when 
 Major Kennicott saw him from his seat on the roof of the fort, 
 and hurried two men to his assistance, unquestionably saving his 
 life. When the Russian had changed his clothes, he came with 
 protestations of gratitude to his preserver, who answered, " Do not 
 thank me, Tareiitofif ; thank God." The next day, while walking 
 in the early morning on the beach near the fort, taking the angles 
 of the mountains for his proposed map, and with thoughts per- 
 haps intent on the long anticipated journey, then only awaiting 
 the disappearance of the floating ice, the Major was called to his 
 eternal home ! His remains were found where he fell ; struck 
 down by disease of the heart, aggravated by exposure, privation, 
 and anxiety. On the sad anniversary of his death we erected, on 
 the nearest hillock not swept by the spring freshets, a cross, which 
 was hewn out by the blacksmith Paspi'lkoff, and which upheld a 
 tablet with the following inscription : — 
 
 In Ml.M'iRY OF 
 
 ROBERT KENNICOTT, 
 
 N.vn'KAi.isr. 
 
 7i'//(' (/ill/ iiciir f/i/s/>/iiii; 
 
 A/iiy i.V//. i86f), ,i};i\/ thirty. 
 
 On asking Pas])ilkoff what he wanted for his labor in hewing 
 out the arms of the cross, lie replied, " We Russians take nothing 
 for what wi^ may do for the dead ; we do not know when it may 
 be our turn." 
 
 On the 1 2th of May the mosquitoes made tliur appearance, 
 though the snow still hi) on the ground in abundance. The^ 
 were larger than our home mosquitors, and vcay bloodthirstj . 
 After a few days it was imi>ossible to sleep without a net. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 71 
 
 We had abundance to do, getting our bidarra in order for the 
 journey, and packing our stores into the smallest possible space, 
 knowing by experience that every ounce counted. Collecting 
 was not neglected ; and many specimens of birds were obtained 
 which are only summer visitors. A walk to the blufl" above the 
 Klatkakhatne River was rewarded by the discovery of a few more 
 fossils, and some very minute land-shells, similar to, if not identi- 
 cal with, Eastern American and Northern European species. 
 
 I had at this time a good opportunity of observing the forma- 
 tion of the alluvial soil of the islands and banks of the Yukon. 
 Two or three feet below th'. surface, the ground is frozen, and 
 probably always continues so, as there are no roots of living trees 
 below that depth. The soil is composed of distinct layers, each 
 layer consisting of a stratum of sand, overlaid by mud, and 
 covered with a thin sheet of vegetable matter. These layers 
 evidently mark the annual inundations, the materials brought 
 down settling according to their specific gravity. Tiiey varied 
 in thickness from half an inch to three inches, but averaged about 
 about an inch. I counted one hundred and eighty of them in 
 one bank, exposed by the undermining and washing away of the 
 soil by the river, leaving a perpendicular bank about ten feet 
 high. This action of deposition and denudation is constantly 
 going on ; and so great is the amount carried out to sea by the 
 Yukon water, that the water of liering Sea is discolored by it 
 for many miles, even quite out of sight of the land. 
 
 Occasionally the roots and stumps of trees might be seen 
 exposed, in their natural position, but deep below the surface. 
 These had evidently been broken off in some ancient flood, and 
 finally buried under new deposits of alluvium. I even thought 
 I detected, in the lower and older layers, indications of carbon- 
 ization, or transformation into a kind of lignite, among the strata 
 of vegetable matter. 
 
 The Russians had already put their large bidarra in order, 
 and, looking with contempt upon our little l)oat, which was 
 shapeil like a dory, about fifteen feet long and four and a half 
 wide, asserted that we could not keej) up with tiiein ; that it was 
 impossible to row such a bag-siiaped contrivance against the 
 ra|)id river current ; that it would not bear a sail as large as the 
 one we had had maile ; and, finally, that, witii such a boat, it 
 
 
 U 
 
 M \:\ 
 
 A'M 
 
 i' 
 
 V 
 
 I 
 
 n 
 

 
 72 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 was useless to attempt ascending the river, for we should cer- 
 tainly fail. We did not fail to appreciate the consideratic n for 
 our weakness and inexperience, which was indicated by such 
 comments ; and it but strengthened our determination to reach 
 Fort Yukon at all hazards, even if the boat had to be replaced by 
 a raft. 
 
 We had provided a mast, and Kun'Ila exercised his taste and 
 ingenuity in carving an arrow, with a broad tail to which some 
 blue cotton vvas attached, to serve as a fly. The square sail was 
 composed of stout linen towelling, purchased of the Russians ; 
 and we were provided with an A-tent, and a large piece of 
 drill, with which our Indians might make a tent for their own 
 shelter. 
 
 Our boat was too small to admit of a rudder, and an enormous 
 paddle for use in steering was made by Kun'Ila, and ornamented 
 with bars and stripes of red ochre. We had provided several 
 oars cut out of seasoned spruce, no harder wood being attain- 
 able, except birch, which is too brittle. 
 
 On the 1 6th and i8th of May we all united in erecting the 
 poles between the Nukito post and Fort Kennicott. Dyer had 
 decided to take Antoshka, and a Creole called Aloshka, who 
 understood the Eskimo dialect of the Innuit of the Yukon- 
 mouth, serving as an interpreter as well as an assistant in 
 paddling the three-holed bidarka in which the journey was to 
 be made. Scratchett was to remain at Nuldto and secure logs 
 for the buildings to be put up at Fort Kennicott after the ice 
 had passed out of the river. 
 
 The ice on the Yukon was separated from the shore by a wide 
 belt of water, and we hourly looked for a rise which should give 
 it a start down stream. 
 
 On the 19th of iMay, about one o'clock, as Whymper and my- 
 self were sitting on the roof we perceived :i slight motion, and 
 upon our raising a shout to that effect, the whole population of 
 the fort was soon out on the bank, watching the slow progress 
 of the great sheet of ice between us and the island. The pre- 
 vious year the ice had brofc<w up on the iist. The water began 
 to rise very rapidlv. and sooft .overed much of the beach. We 
 watched it with a K'l'at fkal i./' xtterest ; but the sight was by no 
 means as grand as a • had anl'icipated. It passed very quietly 
 
THE YUKON TERRIT(JKV. 
 
 72, 
 
 for a time, and finally sto[7pcd, a jam having occurred somewhere 
 below, and the water being still too low to carry all before it. 
 
 On the 2 1 St it began to move again ; and the water had risen 
 to the foot of an inclined plane opposite the fort-gate, where the 
 bank is usually ascended. The Russians do not start up the 
 river until the ice is well out of it, as the danger to skin-boats 
 would be too great to risk. 
 
 Our necessary trading-goods and provisions amounted to nearly 
 eight hundred pounds, which, with the men, oars, sails, and 
 other baggage, made up nearly eighteen hundred pounds. Of 
 this we intended to put a bag of Hour and one of bread on board 
 the large Russian boat, making about sixteen hundred and fifty 
 pounds that our little bidarra must carry. 
 
 On the 25th, all our preparations being completed, we took our 
 last night's rest in the old Xuldto trading-post. 
 
 
 •1. 
 
 V' 
 
 I 
 
 I 
 
 
 n 
 
 \ 
 
 m 
 
 I!!: 
 
I .1 
 
 I' 
 
 /■:■ 
 1 
 
 If, ' 
 
 'II 
 
 ',1 
 
 ill: 
 
 t 
 11 j . 
 
 Si 
 
 I' 
 
 I 
 
 m 
 
 CHAPTER III. 
 
 Our departure from Nulato. — Sukarce. — Crossing in the ice. — Peculation. — Camp. 
 
 — Koyukuk Sopka. — I5arter on the Yukon. — Inchan grave. — (Jo.skon. — Indian 
 liipcs. — Tohonidola. — Koyukun dress. — Catching l)uttcrrties. — >felozikakat 
 River. —Arrival at Nowikakat. — Trading for meat. — Shaivanism. — Indian theol- 
 ogy- — Treating the sick. — Departure from Xowikakat. — Hirch canoes. — Run- 
 away from Fort Vukon. — Tozikakat River. — Xuklukahyct and the Twin Mountains. 
 — Xuklukahyct tyone and other Indians. — Departure from Xuklukahyct. — The 
 Rann)arts and Rajiids. — Moose killing. — Pass the Ramparts. — Mo.>ic|uitoes. — 
 Plains north of the Vukon. — Kutcha Kutchin camp. — Sachniti. — .Arrival at 
 Fort Yukon. — History of the fort. — Five years without bread. — Dcgr.adation of 
 the servants of the Hudson Hay Company. — Intense heat. — Arrival of the hateau.x. 
 
 — The annual trade. — Tenan Kutchin Indians. — Uther tribes. — Drowning of 
 Cowley. — Red Leggins. — Arrival of Ketchum and Mike. — Missionaries and tiieir 
 value. — Cour.sc of the I ludson Ray Company with the Indians. — .Massacre at Port 
 Nelson. — Indians of the \Vestern United .States. — Furs in the storehouse. — 
 Dejiarture from Fort Vukon. — Arrival at X^ilato. — Unexpected orders. — Start 
 for the Yukon-mouth. — Seal and beluga in the river. — Arrival at .St. Michael's. 
 
 EARLY in the morning of the 26th of May we helped our 
 companion, Mr. Dyer, to pack his baggage into the bidarka, 
 and about seven o'clock saw him fairly started, with Antoshka 
 and Aloshka, on their journey to the Yukon-mouth. Wo gave 
 them a parting salute, and immediately placed our own boat 
 in the water and j^roceeded to load her. The Russians hatl 
 already finished, and were assembled at a pseudo-religious cere- 
 monial before their departure. .\t eight o'clock we pushed off. 
 Yagor and the two Russians who remained behind saluted the 
 flotilla with several discharges of the rusty howitzer. The Rus- 
 sian boat took the lead, with eight oarsmen and a light freight. 
 We followed them at a short distance. Our party was com- 
 posed of Mr. Frederick Whymper and myself; Kurilla ; a little 
 Ingalik called Mikaishka, or in the Indian dialect MenohcMnoi, 
 meaning beetle, in allusion to his diminutiveness ; and lastly, a 
 Koyiikun, whose name was so remarkably long and unpronounce- 
 able, that we decided to call him Tom. All these had arrivetl 
 early in the morning in single birch canoes, a large number of 
 

 THE YUKON TERRITORY, 
 
 75 
 
 which, with their owners, were to accompany us to Xuklukah- 
 yct. 
 
 The rain poured down on us and made everythinj; wet and un- 
 comfortable. I realized, for the first time, the size and power of 
 the logs and fragments of ice which, seen from the banks, seemed 
 so small and insignificant. Kuri'lla, whose Indian name was 
 Unookiik, had had much experience in this sort of navigation, 
 and proved himself active, energetic, and efficient. 
 
 The boat had been hurriedly loaded, and the goods were not 
 arranged to the best advantage. It always takes a day to get the 
 party and boat into good working order. After pulling about six 
 miles we felt the necessity for taking some breaktast, and, the 
 Russians setting the example, we hauled close into the bank and 
 boiled the chyniks. It is, of course, impossible to take or make 
 soft bread on such a journey, as it would very soon mould. The 
 traditional "damper" is a humbug. It is invariably heavy, and a 
 fruitful cause of heartburn, indigestion, and conseouent ill humor. 
 Hence, in the absence of biscuit, a substitute being necessary, the 
 Russians are accustomed to bake a large quantity of bread which, 
 after slicing, they dry in the oven, so that, without browning, it 
 becomes as hard as a rock. This hardness, however, immediately 
 disappears when the siikan'c, as the Russians call it, is immersed 
 in hot tea ; and in this respect it is preferable to biscuit, which 
 takes a long time to soak. It is, however, more liable to break 
 up than biscuit, when carried in a bag, and not unfrequently re- 
 tains dust and grit from the mud walls of the peechka, unless 
 very carefully dried. We had both biscuit and sukaree ; some of 
 the latter having been made of white flour, it proveil execrable, 
 the Russian sukaree being always made of groats or Graham 
 flour. 
 
 Just above the ravine and little brook where we took our tea 
 was a rounded rock, boldly jutting out into the river. Around 
 this a constant stream of ice-cakes, logs, and driftwood was pour- 
 ing. The Russians first reached this ])oiiit, and after one or two 
 trials turned back and camped, hoping that the ice would cease 
 running before the next morning. Kun'lla saw this move with 
 great disgust. "The Russians retreat: Unookuk will not retreat," 
 said he, and struck boldly out into the stream of ice and drift- 
 wood. I'or ten minutes all had their hands full, staving off logs 
 
 i •■ 
 1 
 
 Iv 
 
 \ 
 
 \ 
 
 J 1 
 
 ;; 
 
 M 
 
 — jj 
 
1 
 
 M 
 
 ill t 
 
 
 76 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 and ice-cakes, and the danger was too imminent to think about. 
 A clearer part of the river was soon reached in safety, the drift 
 always running most thickly in the strongest current. Paddling 
 up stream a mile or two, the severity of the rain induced us to 
 camp on an island, where we pitched our tent in a willow grove, 
 and endeavored to dry ourselves. The evening meal consisted of 
 salted white-fish and tea. We now discovered that Scratchett 
 had availed himself of the confusion of our starting to appropriate 
 sundry spoons, and other articles of use and necessity, to his own 
 advantage. Although of iron, the loss was as great as if they had 
 been of gold ; for who can eat bread and tea without a spoon .-' 
 We had just two left, and our Indians must take turn and turn 
 about in using them. Another loss which we all regretted was 
 three pounds of sugar, which I had purchased with a shirt, of the 
 individual above mentioned. It is to be hoped that he has duly 
 repented in his subsequent retirement. 
 
 Several canoes had followed us through the ice in fear and 
 trembling. Their inmates, camped near us, presented a melan- 
 choly spectacle, A woman whose long upper garment consisted 
 of white cotton, with her hair streaming down her back, resembled 
 a drowned rabbit ; and an old man seemed to have received a 
 more thorough washing than for many years previous. We were 
 all very wet, but our clothing repelled the rain much better than 
 deerskins or cotton drill. 
 
 Blessed be the man who invented rubber blankets ! Mine, after 
 a season in the Lake Superior region, did noble service, as well as 
 Whymper's, which he had obtained in British Columbia. Laying 
 them down on the mud in which our camp was situated, only 
 covered by a little willow brush, we spread out our blankets, and 
 were .soon at rest. The Indians, except Kurilla, who, as coxswain, 
 slept in our tent, made their tent out of a great sheet of drill, after 
 their own fashion. Bending down the tops of several slender wil- 
 lows, they crossed them in different directions, and spreading the 
 covering over that, the whole was nearly circular. It was always 
 a marvel to me how they could lie down in it, it was so small. 
 After all got inside, the edges were carefully tucked in and the 
 mosquitoes effectually excluded. 
 
 The rain prevented the latter from being very troublesome, and 
 we slept comfortably. 
 

 I 
 
 if: 
 
 I 
 
 u 
 
 <':' 
 
 
 i 
 
 I • i 
 
 I , 
 
 If 
 
 r ; ^p ': l 
 
 i ill 
 
 ! if "In! 
 
IMAGE EVALUATION 
 TEST TARGET (MT-3) 
 
 
 
 1.0 
 
 I.I 
 
 2.5 
 
 144 1 2.8 
 
 2.0 
 
 L»«.l^ 
 
 1^ ■:£ 
 
 1.8 
 
 
 1.25 1.4 1 A 
 
 
 ■• 6" 
 
 ► 
 
 m 
 
 n 
 
 /, 
 
 V 
 
 '/ 
 
 /A 
 
 £ 
 
 Hiotographi! 
 
 Sdences 
 
 Corporation 
 
 '.') WIST MAIN STUIIT 
 "^ WUSTIR, N.Y. 1 4580 
 (716) 873-4503 
 
 V 
 
 iV 
 
 4 
 
 ^^ 
 
 o 
 
 *> 
 * 
 
 
 Q^ 
 
its 
 
I 
 
 / 1' 
 
 hi ji- 
 
 ff 
 
 
 1 
 I 
 
 ■ill' 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 11 
 
 The brown Miocene sandstones before mentioned are suc- 
 ceeded here by blue sandstones, which at Nulato lie below them. 
 The latter contain few fossils, — mostly sycamore leaves {Pla- 
 taiiiis), and other vegetable remains. 
 
 Monday, May 27///. — Starting about three o'clock in the morn- 
 ing, we soon passed the Russians, who had gone a little fartiier 
 in the night and camped above us. We passed through a small 
 slough or pratoka between some islands. About ten o'clock we 
 arrived at a fine bluff near the mouth of the Koyukuk River, a 
 landmark in this part of the country, and known as the Koyu- 
 kuk Sopka. Mere is a small Koyukun village, where we stopped 
 and took tta. I bought a large pike {Esox cstor) and a quantity 
 of dry reindeer meat. 
 
 After passing the Sopka the river is very winding, and we 
 frequently crossed it in order to shorten the distance. When in 
 tluing so we ':ame to the main channel, it was a hard tug to 
 cross it, and we invariably lest ground, sometimes as much as a 
 mile. 
 
 On rounding a turn in the river we saw a large number of 
 canoes lying near the bank and a crowd of dark figures on the 
 shore. These proved to be Koyiikuns, who proposed to ac- 
 company us. Ivan the tyone, Larriown, and a handsome fellow 
 in a red shirt, named " Cousin " by Ketchum on his last season's 
 trip, accosted us with gesticulations o." welcome. As rain threat- 
 ened, and we wished to keep our provisions dry, we camped in 
 the best place we could find among the den.se thickets of willows 
 which line the shore everywhere. There were a few hills in the 
 distance, but no mountains. The foliage was not fully out, but 
 tlie delicate green of the young leaves made the river banks very 
 beautiful. Close to the water grow willows a.ul alders. A little 
 farther back are belts of broad-leaved poplars (/'. />a/satnifira), 
 and on the dry ground spruce (Abies aU>a), growing to a very 
 huge size and mi.xed with aspens (Poptilns tiriiiii/(>i(hs), whose 
 ligiU-colored bark and silvered leaves contrast finely with the 
 tiark evergreens. On the rocky blutfs a species of juniper is 
 abundant, crawling over the rocks, but not rising from the .soil. 
 
 On the left bank, which is everywhere low, the willows aiu' 
 poplars appear to predominate. The banks in many places are 
 undermined by the ra])id current, and freciuently fall into the 
 
 Y 
 
 il 
 
m 
 
 1 ' v ^ 
 
 78 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 
 1: 
 
 ■V,; 
 
 m 
 
 i ■ 
 
 \\ 
 
 si' 
 
 1 ' ' 
 
 If 
 
 river in large masses, with the trees and shrubs upon them, 
 startling the unaccustomed ear with a noise like thunder. 
 
 The ground where Ketchum camped the previous year, accord- 
 ing to Kun'lla, was under water ; we had camped on a low island 
 somewhat in advance of the Russians. The Koyiikuns brought 
 their stores of dried meat and fat, and I purchased about fifty 
 pounds of the former. The tariff of prices was high, compared 
 with what we had paid for the same things on the coast. We 
 gave five loads of powder for a duck, seven for a goo.sc, if fat ; 
 five balls or a small bundle of leaves of Circassian tobacco, called 
 by the Russians a papods]i, for a beaver-tail ; six to eight balls for 
 the dry breast of a deer ; four or five for a deer's tongue ; and 
 for fat, especially the marrow of the long bones of the reindeer, 
 whatever would buy it, usually a pretty high price. A ball, a 
 charge of powder, or two caps, are the units of trade, and will 
 buy almost anything. Knives, beads, flints and steels, needles, 
 small looking-glasses, handkerchiefs of various colors, woollen 
 scarfs, and cotton drill or calico are all useful, but tobacco and 
 ammunition are th:; great staples. The Circassian or Cherkatsky 
 tobacco, imported only by the Russians, and exceedingly strong, 
 is the prime favorite where the Russians trade ; but those who 
 deal more with the English at Fort Yukon like the long natural 
 Kentucky leaf best. The latter we used for our own smoking, 
 obtaining an excellent article from the Russians for thirty cents a 
 pound. 
 
 Swans, brant, and sandhill cranes were seen, the former abun- 
 dantly. Ivan Pavloff sent me two eggs of the wliite-chceked 
 goose (/)'. lauopairia), which were found on a bit of sandy beach 
 near the camp, and every step added some new plant, insect, or 
 bird to our collections. The Koyiikuk ScSpka is composed of a 
 soft crystalline rock ajiparently unstratificd. 
 
 In this kind of journey, sluggards are out of place. We 
 allowed ourselves but four or five hours for sleep, and after a cup 
 of tea continued on our way. 
 
 Tuesday, 28///. — Ivan the tyone, and old Wolasatux came along 
 in their little canoes with some half-dried fish for sale, which 
 we purchased for our Indians. Passing through a narrow pra- 
 toka between two islands and the shoi'e, we came to a solitary 
 Indian house, quite empty. On the hillside near it stood a 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 79 
 
 solitary grave. A little fence of white spruce stakes was built 
 around it, and from several long poles streamers of white cotton 
 were floating. Kun'lla said that it was the grave of an Indian 
 who had died in the previous fall, and that the house was occu- 
 pied by his wife, who spent all her time (except when procuring 
 food) in watching the grave, and devoting all her property to the 
 purpose of adorning it. The house looked neat and clean, the 
 hillside was green, and the sun shone brightly on the lonely 
 grave, as we passed by on the other side of the pratoka. Just be- 
 yond, a perpendicular and solitary bluff fronted the river. Close 
 to its face rushed the swift current, with its burden of driftwood, 
 at the rate of seven knots an hour. There was no backing out : 
 we had to cross here. The swift part of the current appeared to 
 be narrow. The canoes first essayed it, and were swept like 
 straws a mile down stream in ihe twinkling of an eye. 
 
 This made us careful. We kept close to the rock, where there 
 was a little slarV water, and then, driving our paddles into the 
 water with a will, we passed the current, and reached the op- 
 posite bank, not more than a quarter of a mile below. Waiting 
 to rest, we saw the Russians kill a beaver in the water, and then 
 cross the stream with about the same success as ourselves. Con- 
 tinuing on our way, about si.\ c clock we stopped to boil the 
 chynik and to rest. Ivan Pavloff was invited to take tea with us. 
 Sugar being a very scarce article in this country, it is usually 
 boiled with water into hard cakes, which, when properly done, 
 are not afiected by the weather. Soft sugar will waste away 
 imperceptibly with the dampness. The orthodox way is to take 
 a fragment of this hard sugar, bite off a small piece of it, and 
 drink your tea without putting any into it. This is much more 
 economical, and is hereby recommended to boarding-house keep- 
 ers. I was much amused by observing PiivlotV. who after finish- 
 ing his tea replaced the lump from which he had been biting in 
 the common sugar-box. 
 
 About ten o'clock we came to a very wide part of the river, 
 where the Russians lay to for a while, ami fired a small boat-gun 
 which they carried in their bidarni. This was to notify the In- 
 dians, if any were in the vicinity, that the Russians were ready to 
 trade ; but none made their api)earancc, and the bidarni soon con- 
 tinued on its way. On a low sand-bar, where the sun poured 
 
 
 f 
 
I 
 
 
 ^ 1 i' 
 
 \ 
 
 • 
 
 \ 
 I 
 
 ■ 
 
 1 
 
 ' t 
 
 1 
 
 
 \ 
 
 W 
 
 k 
 
 k 
 
 \\m 
 
 8o 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 down with double force, and mosquitoes hummed in myriads, we 
 also found an old man and his old wife. I afterwards heard that he 
 had a young one. His hair stood out in every direction where it 
 was not matted down by dirt. His clothing hung in the filthiest 
 rags, and his voice sounded like that of a fishhawk with a cold. 
 His name was Ooskon, or Rabbit, and it was stated by Kun'lla 
 that he was noted for his good-humor and generosity. He might 
 have given away all his clothes, which would account for hi' ap- 
 pearance. His wife was his duplicate, except that she was silent, 
 which is an excellent thing in women. The old fellow brought 
 me a gull's egg, which I gratefully accepted, wished to sell me 
 some fish, which I respectfully declined, and finally brought out 
 two stuffed skins of the beautiful northern phalarope, which I 
 purchased, as they were in very fair condition. I afterwards 
 discovered they were stuffed with a very sweet-scented grass. 
 On pointing this out to VVolasatux, he shook his head gravely, 
 and said, " They are rotten ! " These Indians have no apprecia- 
 tion of sweet odors. The wild rose {Rosa ciniiaiitoiiua), which is 
 one of the few fragrant flowers to be found on the Yukon, is 
 called among them by an untranslatable name, on account of its 
 perfume. The only odor they appreciate lies hidden in the steam 
 arising from the soup-kettle. 
 
 Rain coming on, we camped on a steep bank, and the Russians 
 followed our example. 
 
 I afterwards added a green-winged teal and hooded grebe 
 {Podurps corniitns) to our collection. A high sandy blufil" near 
 our camp was full of the nests of the bank swallow. It seemed 
 like a gigantic honeycomb swarming with bees, as the light- 
 winged swallows darted about. The eggs are white, and are 
 laid on a few very fine twigs, which keep them off the sand. 
 I counted nearly eight hundred holes, all of which seemed to be 
 occupied. I obtained from the Indians quite a number of ducks 
 and geese for our kettle. 
 
 \Vc(/)it'sd(iy, 29///. — We broke camp about five o'clock in 
 the morning. Nothing occurred to break the monotony of con- 
 stant steady paddling. Two Indians in the bow of the boat 
 would row until tired, and then we would stop for a few minutes 
 to rest, and let them smoke. The last operation takes less than a 
 minute : their pipes arc so constructed as to hold but a very 
 

 THi: YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 8l 
 
 tat 
 
 cs 
 
 a 
 
 rv 
 
 A. — Kutcliiii. 
 
 B. — Innuit. 
 
 I'll'ES. 
 
 C — Knyukiin. 
 I), K. — Cliiikchee. 
 
 small pinch of tobacco. The bowl, with cars for tying it to 
 the stem, is generally ca.st out of lead. Sometimes it is made of 
 soft stone, bone, or even hard wood. The stem is made of two 
 pieces of wood, hollowed on one 
 side, and bound to the bowl and 
 to each other by a narrow strip 
 of deerskin. In smoking, the 
 economical Indian generally cuts 
 up a little birch wood, or the in- 
 ner bark of the poplar, and mi.xes 
 it with his tobacco. A few rein- 
 deer hairs, pulled from his jiarka, 
 are rolled into a little ball, and 
 placed in the bottom of the bowl to prevent the contents from 
 being drawn into the stem. A pinch of tobacco, cut as fine 
 as snuff, is inserted, and two or three whiffs are afforded by it. 
 The smoke is inhaled into the lungs, producing a momentary 
 stupefaction, and the operation is over. A fungus which grows 
 on decayed birch trees, or tinder manufactured from the down 
 of the poplar rubbed up with charcoal, is used with flint and 
 steel for obtaining a light. Matches are highly valued, and 
 readily purchased. The effect of the Circassian tobacco on the 
 lungs is extremely bad, and among those tribes who use it many 
 die from asthma and congestion of the lungs. This is principally 
 due to the saltpetre with which it is impregnated. The Indian 
 pipe is copied from the Eskimo, as the latter were the first to 
 obtain and use tobacco. Many of the tribes call it by the Eskimo 
 name. The Kutchin and Eastern Tinneh use one modelled after 
 the clay pipes of the Hudson Hay Company, but they also carve 
 very pretty ones out of birch knots and Ihe root of the wild rose- 
 bush. The Chukchees use a pipe similar to those of the ICs- 
 kimo, but with a much larger and shorter stem. This stem is 
 hollow, and is filled with fine birch shavings. After smoking for 
 some months these shavings, impregnated with the oil of tobacco, 
 are taken out through an opening in the lower part of the stem, 
 and smoked over. The Hudson Hay men make passable J^ipe- 
 stems by taking a straight-grained piece of willow or spruce, 
 without knots, and cutting through the outer layers of bark and 
 wood. This stick is heated in the ashes, and by twisting the 
 6 
 
 hi 
 
r9P7 
 
 III 
 
 lik 
 
 i^^ 
 
 \ 
 
 I 
 
 i 
 
 I 
 
 
 
 8a 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ends in contrary directions, the heart-wood may be gradually 
 drawn out, leaving a wooden tube. The Kutchin make pretty 
 pipe-stems out of goose-quills wound about with colored porcu- 
 pine quills. It is the custom in the English forts to make every 
 Indian who comes to trade, a present of a clay pipe filled with 
 tobacco. We were provided with cheap brown ones, with wooden 
 stems, which were much liked by the natives, and it is probable 
 that small brier-wood pipes, which are not liable to break, would 
 form an acceptable addition to any stock of trading-goods. 
 
 For the first time we were able to use our sail, as a fair wind 
 sprang up in the afternoon, and for a short time we made excel- 
 lent progress. 
 
 About five o'clock we camped at a place where in summer the 
 Indians have a fishery, and which is called Kami'n-sikhtcr. 
 
 Thursday, 2,0th. — The sealskin of which the bidarnis are made, 
 by long continuance in the water becomes soft and unsound. 
 Hence, as the weather continued rainy, we decided to lay over 
 a day, take the boat out of the water, dry and oil it ; the Rus- 
 sians doing the same with their bidarra. During the interval, 
 
 many additions were made 
 to our collections. I ob- 
 served a fine-looking Ko- 
 yiikun, called Toho-iiidola, 
 who wore a mantle made 
 of a dressed deerskin. It 
 was cut to a point behind, 
 and into fringes around 
 the edge. It was orna- 
 mented with a few beads, 
 hanging in short strings, 
 and was colored on the 
 inside with red ochre ; 
 making a very graceful ar- 
 ticle of apparel. The breeches had the moccasins continuous 
 with the leg, and were heavily emliroidered with large black and 
 white beads. The pattern universal among the Koyukun men 
 consists of a band of beads in front, from the thigh to the ankle, 
 a short one crossing it at the knee. At the ankle the long band 
 bifurcates, and the two ends, after reaching the sides of the foot, 
 
 Tohoniclola. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 83 
 
 continue all around its edge, except over the heel. The pattern 
 for females is similar, but the perpendicular band on the leg is 
 omitted. The Koyiikun male parka has been described. The 
 pattern of ornamentation is a broad band of beadwork across the 
 breast and back, and over the shoulders, with fringes on the 
 pointed ends, and a few short tails of beadwork in front and on 
 the sleeves. The female parka comes below the knee, and is cut 
 round like an ordinary dress, but a little shorter in front than 
 behind. They are ornamented with a similar band around the 
 shoulders, sometimes one around the wrist, and one around the 
 edge of the skirt in lieu of fringes. Before the introduction of 
 beads by the Russians, this work was done in porcupine quills, 
 often in very tasteful patterns, and among the Tcndn Kutchin, or 
 Tananah River Indians, this practice still obtains White and 
 black or brick red are the only colors I have seen used on cloth- 
 ing, and they are always embroidered in alternate bands. Other 
 beads, of various colors, in strings seven feet long, are valued 
 by the natives as property, having a fi.ved value of two marten- 
 skins a string. They pass from hand to hand, much as we use 
 money. Small beads, of various kinds, are much in demand 
 among the women, who use them as ornaments for their children. 
 Strong beads, over which the hand passes smoothly, are the only 
 kind suited for fur-trading. Red, black, white, dark blue, and 
 amber are the desirable colors. 
 
 Friday, 3UA — Making an early start, we passed a point 
 known as Sakataloiitan, about half past three in the morning. 
 Large stacks of driftwood, as big as houses, came floating down 
 in the current, and great care was necessary to avoid collision. 
 These were piles of logs thrown upon sandbars by previous 
 freshets, which the unusually high water had floated off entire. 
 We passed many low blufts of blue sandstone and a few gravel- 
 banks. Tom found a mallard's nest on the bank, with nine eggs 
 in it, which were devoted to an omelet, after carefully emptying 
 the shells with a small blowpipe. We camped on a high bank 
 without taking the tent out of the boat, as the night was remark- 
 ably pleasant and the mosquitoes unusually quiet. 
 
 Saturday, ytinc \st. — The next morning at one o'clock we 
 were on our way again, working hard against a strong current. 
 The sandstones were now succeeded by conglomerate and meta- 
 
 ; H 
 

 
 lii 
 
 1 
 
 J 
 
 1 
 
 r 
 
 1 
 
 
 
 ' 
 
 1 
 
 
 
 1 
 
 ' 1 
 
 ; ! 
 
 IM 
 
 1,;, 
 i' 
 
 J 
 
 1: 
 
 } 
 
 iti ; 
 
 'It 
 
 
 ■ 1 
 
 i' 
 
 •• 
 
 1 
 
 < 
 
 If 
 
 ' it 
 
 I 
 
 
 84 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 morphous quartzose rocks. Many butterflies, including the fa- 
 miliar swallow-tail {Papilio Tiiriius), and another species some- 
 what similar {P. Aliaska), were hovering over the surface. Upon 
 mentioning that I would give a needle apiece for good speci- 
 mens, a commotion was aroused amongst the little fleet of birch 
 canoes which accompanied us. All was excitement, paddles were 
 flourished in the air, the light canoes darted about after the 
 slowly sailing, unsuspecting butterflies, and the result was a 
 considerable number of passable specimens. I saw, also, several 
 wax-wings (Anipi/is garriilits) in the bushes along shore, and 
 obtained a sandhill crane. A fair wind sprang up and sent the 
 
 Mt. HohoniL-i from the Melozikakat. 
 
 Russians scudding around a six-mile bend under their large sail. 
 Our boat proved a very slow sailei, the wind soon droj^pcd, and 
 we had to pull all the way around the bend. 
 
 After camping we employed Larriown's wife to sew up sonic 
 cuts in the sealskin of our bidarra. These were made by the 
 constant stream of driftwood ; but when sewed up and the seam 
 well rubbed with tallow, the boat was as tight as ever. The 
 skin was old and very rotten, so that we had to exercise the 
 utmost precaution in landing and in avoiding driftwood or rocks. 
 
 Sunday, 2d. — About ten o'clock the next day we took our 
 tea at the mouth of the Melozikakat or Clear River. From this 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 8: 
 
 point a fine view may be had of a mountain which rises per- 
 haps two thousand feet above the river, and is known to the In- 
 dians as Hoho-nila. The upper portion still retained snow in 
 many ravines, though later in the season it disappears entirely. 
 The mosquitoes were exceedingly troublesome. The night had 
 ceased to be dark, as the sun remained only about two hours 
 behind the high hills which shut out the horizon. 
 
 Monday, yi. — Passed the I 'ka-iviUnc or " Look-and-see-it " 
 River. It is a small stream. Near its mouth the Yukon is very 
 broad and full of islands. About noon the sun was so scorching 
 (90° in the shade) that we pulled into the bank and rested for a 
 couple of hours. VVe then proceeded to the point on the right 
 bank where the Russians had camped, waiting the report of a 
 messenger who had been sent to the village of Nowikakat on the 
 left bank a few miles above. As he did not appear I turned in, 
 and had hardly got under the blankets, when I heard the well- 
 known voice of Larriown, who poked his ugly head into the tent, 
 saying there was plenty of dry meat and many Indians at Nowi- 
 kakat, and begging a little tobacco for his information. 
 
 I put on my boots and stepped out of the tent, around which 
 a number of Indians had gathered. The old Nowikakat tyone 
 was there, and one of the men who had gone up with Ketchum 
 suddenly appeared. He gave us the welcome information tlxit 
 Ketchum and the party had reached Fort Yukon in safety, and 
 had started with open water for Fort Selkirk, having sent the In^ 
 dians and six remaining dogs down the river in a bidarni made of 
 moose-hide. 
 
 Tiicsiiiiy, <\th. — VVe struck our tent, broke camp, and started 
 for Nowikakat, in company with the Russians and Indians. We 
 hoisted the American Hag over the blue cross and scallop- 
 shell of the Scientific Corps, and came into Nowikakat Harbor 
 with colors flying. We received and returned a salute of mus- 
 ketry, and, finding with difficulty a place among the myriads of 
 birch canoes where we could moor our boat, we pitched our tent 
 in the middle of the village. We informed the tyone, or chief, 
 that we were exceedingly tired, and must sleep before any trading 
 could be done. This was quite true, as I, for one, hal slept but 
 about two hours out of the last forty-eight. We tied the flaps of 
 the tent closely, but even this did not prevent the Indians from 
 
 ■fi 
 
\ [ 
 
 ill 
 
 ^':i 
 
 V:; 
 
 W I'' 
 
 S6 
 
 THE YUKUN TKKRITOKV. 
 
 raising the edge of the canvas and peering in upon us with as 
 much curiosity and pertinacity as country boys at a circus After 
 a few hours' rest we rose and dressed. We could not keep out 
 the Indians, until we admitted the tyone, whose repeated orders 
 kept them outside for a time. He watched the process of washing 
 with great interest, from which I inferred that he did not indulge 
 in that luxury. He was very anxious that we should present him 
 with our brushes, combs, soap, and other articles for the toilet, 
 which we were obliged to refuse him ; but we made up to him for 
 the disappointment by presents of tobacco, powder, and ball. We 
 heard that Antoine Houle, the Fort Yukon interpreter, was at 
 Nuklukahyct with a trading party, and we desired to send a letter 
 to him ; but old Ivan, the tyone, prevented our doing so, by fright- 
 ening our messenger with an account of the danger of making 
 such a journey alone. For this piece of mischief he got a scold- 
 ing, which astonished him and made him less officious in future. 
 
 After breakfast, which we shared with the Nowikakat tyone, 
 we proceeded to business. Whymper was busy with his sketch- 
 book, and left the trading to me. 
 
 All accounts of the country between Nowikakat and Fort 
 Yukon agreed in representing it as a district where provisions 
 were very scarce, and so we had determined to provide them in 
 advance. I purchased, for seven fathoms of drill, three papooshes 
 of tobacco, and five balls, a birch canoe of the largest size, with its 
 paddles. From the abundant stores of dried meat and lat which 
 the Indians had laid in, I obtained about three hundred pounds 
 of dry deer and moose meat, clear moose fat in birch dishes, and 
 dried entrails of the deer, which were filled with fat of the best 
 kind. I was able to secure, besides, a large number of moose 
 and deer tongues, and dried moose noses, the latter making a 
 delicious dish when thoroughly boiled. We also succeeded in 
 engaging two more men to take this canoe-load of meat at least 
 as far as Nuklukahyct. A large number of birds'-nests, mouse- 
 skins, and other specimens of natural history, were also secured. 
 I had then an opportunity to make a few observations on the 
 place and its inhabitants. 
 
 Nowikakat Village is situated on a beautiful little enclosed bay, 
 into which the river of the same name enters, with several smaller 
 streams. This river is about one hundred miles long, and its 
 
 
 
THE VIKON TERRITORY. 
 
 87 
 
 mouth is about one hundred and thirty miles from Nulato in 
 a direct line. Hy the Yukon the distance is considerably greater. 
 The head-waters are on the southeast side of the Xowikakat and 
 Kdiyuh Mountains, and, according to Indian accounts, a short 
 portage can be made to the head-waters of the S/idgiliik or 
 so-called Innoko River, or, by crossing the mountains, to the 
 Kaiyuh River. These portages are frequently made by the 
 Indians who trade with the Ingaliks. 
 
 A narrow entrance connects the basin with the Yukon. 
 Through this a beautiful view is obtained, across the river and 
 
 Looking out of Nowikakat Harbor. 
 
 through the numerous islands, of the opposite shore and the 
 Yukon Mountains in the distance. The feathery willows and 
 light poplars bend over and are reflected in the dark water, 
 unmixed as yet with Yukon mud ; every island and hillside is 
 clothed in the delicate green of spring, and lu.xuriates in a density 
 of foliage remarkable in such a latitude. 
 
 The village appeared to be a mere collection of huts, temporary 
 lodges, and tents ; one or two winter houses seemed as if long 
 deserted and rapidly going to decay. All these were crowded 
 together on a low bank, from which the willows seemed to have 
 been recently cut away. The shore was absolutely covered with 
 
 f'i 
 
 
! 
 
 i 
 
 i ■« 
 
 I i! 
 
 !■ 
 
 88 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 birch canoes. The dress of the Indians was similar to the 
 Koyukun, already described ; but a few specimens of fine bead- 
 vvork and fringed hnnting-shirts showed the effect of luiglish 
 intercourse. The guns were all English single-barrelled flint- 
 locks, while the Koyukuns are provided with double percussion 
 guns from the traders in Kotzebue Sound, through the Eskimo. 
 The principal supply of food seemed to be moose meat. Fish 
 was evidently scarce, and deer less abundant than near the coast. 
 As evening approached, Larriown the shaman, and his wife, were 
 called upon to exercise their art for the relief of a sick man who 
 apparently had not long to live. 
 
 The belief in shamanism is universal among the natives of 
 Alaska, Eskimo as well as Indians. Even the Aleuts, long 
 nominally converted to Christianity, still retain superstitious 
 feelings in regard to it. It is essentially a belief in spirits who 
 are controlled by the shaman ; who come at his call, imj)art to 
 him the secrets of the future and the past, afflict or cease 
 afflicting men by sickness at his behest, and enable him to 
 advise others as to seasons and places of hunting, good or evil 
 omens, and the death or recovery of the sick. These however 
 are not spirits who were once men. 
 
 Many Indians — in fact, all the Tinneh that I have conversed 
 with, who have not been taught by the luiglish or Russian mis- 
 sionaries — do not believe in the immortality of man. Of those 
 who have a dim notion of the kind none have any idea whatever 
 of future reward and punishment, of any Supreme Power or Deity, 
 of good and evil in a moral .sense, or of anything which can be 
 called a religion. Assertions to the contrary proceed from the 
 ignorance or poetical license of the author, or from an intercourse 
 with tribes who have derived their ideas from missionaries. 
 
 The support which the spiritual instincts of human nature 
 demand is met among the Indians by a belief in shamanism. 
 All animals, woods, waters, and natural phenomena such as the 
 aurora borealis or thunder and lightning, are supposed to be 
 either the abodes or the means of manifestation of spirits. The 
 latter have power and knowledge limited by their respective 
 spheres. The most powerful and beneficent of all are the ob- 
 jects of ridicule and contempt, as often as of fear or reverence, 
 in the Indian legends which relate to them. The whole relation. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 89 
 
 between the Indians and these spirits as they believe in them, 
 is one of self-interest and fear. They preserve all bones out of 
 reach of the dogs for a year, when they are carefully buried, lest 
 the spirits who look after the beavers and sables should consiilei 
 thac they are regarded with contemi^t, and hence no more should 
 be killed or trapped. Other singular superstitions, the result of 
 accident, some local incident, or unexplained coincidence, are 
 found to be peculiar to each narrow territory or small tribe. 
 
 The younger Indians look on these things with contempt and 
 ridicule ; it is only when starvation or sickness impends, or the 
 continued threats of some greedy shaman create alarm, that they 
 pay any heed to them. It is with age alone that these super- 
 stitions become firmly implanted in their minds. The .strange 
 efi'ects which firm belief and vivid imagination have frequently 
 produced among civilized and intelligent human beings are too 
 well known to require further confirmation. Hence it is not to 
 be wondered at among ignorant Indians, whose imagination is 
 untrammelled by knowledge of the .simplest natural laws, that the 
 self-deluding frenzy of the shaman should, as it trequently does, 
 produce seemingly supernatural effects, which confirm his in- 
 fluence. 
 
 Among the Indians who frequent the trading-posts many may 
 be found who have imbibed a few indistinct ideas from Christian 
 theology, without renouncing their native superstitions, or gaining 
 any comprehension of the cardinal principles of morality or re- 
 ligion. It is from intercourse with such, that many of the popular 
 delusions about the " Great Spirit " of the Indians have arisen. 
 
 In the present instance, the Indians formed a circle around 
 a fire, near which lay the sick man wrappetl in a dressed deerskin. 
 Larriown had donned a suit of civilized clothing, which he had 
 obtained from some trader. Me wore a very large black felt hat 
 with a broad brim, and his wife had a sini'" '• equipment, so that 
 it was difficult to distinguish them. They walked in contrary 
 directions around the fire, gazing at it or into vacancy. At inter- 
 vals he uttered a deep bass sound between a shout and a groan, 
 which she answered in a higher key, both quickening their pace 
 and occasionally stop])ing short and shuddering convulsixely from 
 head to foot. At last the responses were more rapid anil assumed 
 a kind of rhythm ; the whole circle of Indians acted as chorus in 
 

 ;m 
 
 '>!-V 
 
 iil 
 
 lie 
 
 i' J! 
 
 .1 i> 
 
 
 90 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 the intervals. In the midnight dusk the circle of tall swarthy 
 forms in strange apparel, the fitful gleams of firelight, the groans 
 of the sick man, and the mysterious writhing forms before him, all 
 united to give to the strauge chorus an intensely dramatic efil'ect. 
 
 Contortions which were almost convulsions shook those two 
 black forms, while the fiendish eyes of Larriown rolled until the 
 whites alone were visible. Between the spasms both made mes- 
 meric passes over the sick man, keeping time with the deep 
 monotonous chorus, which might well have been the despairing 
 wail of a lost spirit. The muscular contortions gradually grew 
 less violent, from sheer weakness. The ring of Indians gradually 
 broke up, the chorus ceased, and the ceremony was over. 
 
 Wednesday, $t/i. — We rose at five, and putting our meat into 
 the canoe and our baggage into the boat, we followed the Rus- 
 sians out of the basin. This is the only place on the Yukon 
 which appears to me safe for wintering a steamer, unless she were 
 beached. The ice descending in the fre.shets would at any other 
 point carry her away or crush her. The heat of the sun was so 
 great that we lay over from eleven until two, and rested in the 
 shade of .some magnificent birches. Nowikakat is noted for the 
 beauty and good workmanship of the birch canoes made there. 
 The single canoes are easily carried in one hand. They are about 
 twelve feet long, just wide enough to sit down in, and have the 
 forward end covered for three or four feet with a piece of bark, to 
 keep water out. They are exceedingly frail. The frame is made of 
 birch wood steamed, bent, and dried. They are sewed with the 
 long slender roots of the spruce, and calked with spruce gum. The 
 bark is put on inside out, shaped, and sewed over a clay model just 
 the shape and size of the proposed canoe. The regular price for a 
 tingle canoe is a shirf, or five marten skins. The paddles are of 
 the usual lance-head shape, with a ridge in the middle on eacli 
 side, running down to the point and strengthening the blade. 
 They are four or five feet long, with a cross-piece at the end of 
 the handle, and gayly colored with red ochre, blue carbonate of 
 copper, or a green fungus which is found in decayed willow wood. 
 The single canoe will carry a man and a bag of flour. 
 
 The large canoes are of the same shape, but will carry three 
 men and their baggage, in all about six or eight hundred pounds. 
 They are .sometimes sixteen feet long, and do not turn up at the 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 9' 
 
 ends, as the canoes of the Lake Superior Indians do, but are 
 straight, and furnished with a Y- shaped prow above the cut- 
 water. Each carries a dish of spruce gum, some e.xtra pieces 
 of bark, and a bundle of spruce roots, to repair damages, which 
 frequently occur ; and a small framework of slats for the occupants 
 to sit on. 
 
 In the afternoon we were surprised to sec a wreath of smoke 
 curling over the trees beyond a point on the river. The small 
 canoes immediately fell back ; and Ivan, with his usual cow- 
 ardice, called out to us to stop, for fear of hostile Indians. Dis- 
 regarding his warning, we took the lead, and saw a white man 
 and two Indians standing by a large fire. We supposeil it was a 
 guide, or Antoine Houle himself, whom we had expected to join 
 at Nuklukahyet. It turned out to be a man from Fort Yukon, 
 who stated that he had left the fort on account of long-continued 
 ill-treatment, and that he had trusted to fortune to enable him to 
 escape from a tyranny which he had resolverl to bear no longer. 
 He had started from the fort, with a little powder, a gun, and a 
 few bullets, in a small canoe, and had supported himself by kill- 
 ing game ; cutting up his bullets into shot, and when these 
 failed using gravel from the beach. He had just been upset, 
 lost his gun and everything except what he had on his ])erson. 
 He had passed Antoine at Nuklukahyet, telling the latter that he 
 had been sent down with letters for us, as he knew from Ketch um 
 that we were coming up. Antoine had given him a letter which 
 Ketchum left for us, and was now on his way back to I'ort 
 Yukon with the furs he had bought. The man gave his name as 
 Peter McLeod, and stated that he had been fourteen years in tlie 
 Hudson Bay Comp:iny's service. We called upon him and Iv;in 
 Pavloff to join us at our noon-day meal, and treated them to 
 bacon, biscuit, and tea. He assured us that he had not tasted 
 breatl for four years. 
 
 Assuming his story to be true, we could not advise him to 
 return. I furnished him with trading-goods sufficient to purchase 
 provisions until he should arrive at Nuhito. Pavlot'f, witli his 
 habitual \i ity, msisted on furnishing him with a l)lanket, 
 
 to replace that which he had lost, a Hint and steel to obtain fire, 
 and an order to ^'agor to feed him until his return. We all 
 united in wishing him a safe arrival, and in supplying him with 
 
 f I. 
 
 ti 
 
 1! 
 
 1 \\ 
 
 iSl 
 
''*. .i 
 
 ; ' ' V 
 
 I I 
 
 
 'i 
 
 
 !!• > 
 
 « / 
 
 iii 
 
 i 
 
 ii 
 
 i 
 
 92 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 such necessaries as we could spare, and then continued on our 
 way. 
 
 Thursday, 6t/i. — We passed through an exceedingly long pra- 
 toka, which was so winding and narrow that I suspected we 
 had got into a small river instead of a slough of the Yukon. We 
 had intended to travel by night and take our rest in the hot noon- 
 time ; but the sight cf some fresh deer meat in the camp of the 
 Indians who had preceded us induced my companion to defer 
 this arrangement until we should leave the Russians at Nuklu- 
 kahyet. We therefore camped, and indulged in the lu.xury of 
 some hot venison steaks. 
 
 Friday, yt/i. — We had hitherto been unable to use the track- 
 ir. 2-line, except at short intervals ; but the slight fall in the water 
 had left a narrow beach, which we now availed ourselves of 
 
 The little river tern, whose bright colors and graceful motions 
 cannot fail to attract the traveller's eye, was very common in this 
 part of the river. One of our men in tracking passed near one of 
 their nests, and the parents immediately attacked him. Swoop- 
 ing and returning, in long curves, they almost brushed his cap, 
 uttering loud cries, and keeping it up for several hundred yards. 
 A* last, annoyed by their conduct, which he did not comprehend, 
 lie brandished a large stick in the air. Even then they did not 
 rest until we were a quarter of a mile from their breeding-place. 
 I obtained a fine piece of black obsidian on the beach, and 
 noticed syenitic rocks for the first time in the Yukon territory. 
 
 Saturday, 8t/i. — About eleven o'clock the next day we reached 
 the mouth of the Tozikakat, which empties into the Yukon some 
 fifteen miles from Nuklukahyet. Here we boiled the chynik 
 and rested for a while. We usually sent one of the small canoes 
 up a little distance when we camped near a small river, in order 
 that we might obtain clear water for making our tea. The Yukon 
 water is full of sediment. The mosquitoes were exceedingly trouble- 
 sonic ; without gloves and a net nothing could be done. The 
 Indians always placed a dish of wet moss with a few coals in it 
 on the Lows of their canoes ; this produced a smoke which kej)! 
 the insects away from the canoe when in motion. We smoked 
 them out of our tent, when camping, in the same way. 
 
 The mouth of the Tozikakat is obstructed by a bar, on which 
 lay piled hundreds of cords of driftwood. 
 
Hi 
 
 
 w 
 
 
 n i 
 
 WB 
 
 hJ 
 
■.1 
 
 k 
 
 II-. 
 
 » ■ M 
 ii' ' 
 
 IN 
 
 X 
 t-l 
 D 
 
 u: 
 
 N 
 
 (A 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 93 
 
 Tc» the east the broad mouth of the Tananah River was seen, 
 where it joins the Yukon. The latter cyrves abruptly to the left, 
 and between them lies the low land, forming a point or island. 
 This is Nuklukahyet, the neutral ground where all the tribes meet 
 in spring to trade. Behind it rose the mountains. Two summits 
 rose above the others, known by the Indian names of Mo-kldn-o- 
 klikli and Mout-klag-at-lhi . The latter is really on the right bank 
 of the Yukon, and the former on the left, but from our point of 
 view this was not perceptible. At the junction the Tananah is 
 much broader than the Yukon, yet into this noble river no white 
 man has dipped his paddle. 
 
 Below the junction the Yukon attains a width of five miles at 
 least. A fair wind sprang up, and, as usual, the Russians left us 
 far behind. By dint of hard paddling, about half past five in the 
 afternoon we rounded the bluff opposite Nuklukahyet. Here we 
 found Pavloff, who, with unexpected consideration, was waiting for 
 us. We crossed together, with our flags flying. The Nuklukahyet 
 tyone, who had been at Nuldto during the winter, hailed us from 
 the beach. Pavloff answered him, and we landed, drew up our 
 boats, and prepared to go through the ceremony for such cases 
 made and provided. We formed in line, with blank charges in 
 oui" guns. The Indians did the same. They advanced on us 
 shouting, and discharged their guns in the air. We returned the 
 compliment, and they retreated to repeat the performance. After 
 ten minutes of this mock fight the tyone appeared between us. 
 He harangued the Indians, who answered by a shout. Turning 
 to us, he informed us that we were now at liberty to transact 
 our business. 
 
 Antoine and his Indians had left for Fort Yukon two days be- 
 fore. There was little or nothing to eat at Nuklukahyet. Some 
 men had been sent by the tyone after moose, and meanwhile the 
 annual dances which take place here were performed on empty 
 stomachs. 
 
 The tyone came in with a little dish of fat as a present. He 
 regretted that there was nothing better to offer us, and gave us a 
 note which Ketchum had written during the winter; in it he re- 
 quested that we would give the tyone, who had materially assisted 
 him, any powder and ball we could spare. The powdjr and ball 
 furnished by the Company was exhausted at Nowikakat, but I 
 
 tl 
 
 %. 
 
 '%\ 
 
 )!l 
 
94 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 made him a present of a can of powder and forty balls from my 
 own private supplies, and asked him to keep a little meat for us 
 when we should return, which he promised to do. He was a 
 rather good-looking Indian, possessed a good deal of intelligence, 
 and was younger than any other tyone we had seen. He wore an 
 English hunting-shirt of red flannel, ornamented on the shoulders 
 with large pearl buttons, and fringes of mooseskin. Around his 
 waist was a long Hu'Lon Bay sash. He wore moccasins, and 
 mooseskin trousers cut in the English fashion, with fringes down 
 
 II, ) 
 I ' 
 
 ' > ' i^ii 
 
 * ( ! 
 
 I 
 
 ii!'! 
 
 \k ■ 
 
 Young Nuklukahyet tyone. 
 
 the outside of the leg, and blue leggins tied with a band of bcad- 
 work below the knee. His black glossy hair was cut slriight 
 around the neck, and parted a little on one side. Altogether, 
 he appeared much cleaner and more attentive to dress than 
 any of the Indians of the Lower \'ukon. 
 
 All these Indians paint their faces. Black is obtained by rub- 
 bing charcoal and fat together. Vermilion is purchased of the 
 traders, and supplies the place of the red oxide of iron which they 
 formerly used. I saw one who appeared to have used graphite, 
 or plumbago, on his face, but on examining the article itself it 
 
 i ;' 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 95 
 
 proved to be micaceous oxide of iron, and was said to be obtained 
 on the banlcs of the Tananah. 
 
 They wear an ornament made of dcntalium, the sookli of the 
 Russians, and " money-shell " of American traders. It is here 
 
 Nijsu iiinanient nf the Yukon Indi.ins. 
 
 represented of natural size. A hole is pierced through the skin 
 of the nose, below the cartilage, when very young. Women 
 and men alike wore it ; while at Koyukuk we noticed it only 
 among the women. 
 
 These Indians are fond of ornaments, and among other things I 
 noticed in use as such were necklaces of bears' claws and teeth, 
 sable tails, wolf ears, bands of beads and dentalia, embroidery of 
 dyed porcupine quills, small ermine skins, hawk and eagle feath- 
 ers, beavers' teeth (with which they whet their knives), and the 
 bright green scalps of the mallard. Some wore hoops of birch 
 wood around the neck and wrists, with various patterns and fig- 
 ures cut on them. These were said to be emblem.s of mourn- 
 ing for the dead. 
 
 I noticed several graves in which the dead were enclosed, in a 
 standing posture, in a circle of sticks squared on four sides and 
 secured by hoops of green wood, thus looking much like a cask. 
 From the sticks hung strips of cloth and fur. 
 
 In the afternoon we witnessed one of their dances. The spec- 
 tators formed a circle around two men who were the performers, 
 and joined in the usual monotonous chorus of" Ho, ho, ha, ha," &c. 
 The (lancers were stripped to the waist, and held in each hand 
 eagles' feathers tipped with bits of swan's-down. Their heads 
 were shaved, and bound with fillets of feathers. The dance con- 
 sisted in motions of the head, arms, legs, and every muscle of 
 the body in succession ; putting themselvi.s in every imaginable 
 posture, joining in the chorus, and keeping exact time with it and 
 with each other. I could not find out its emblematic meaning. 
 
 We engaged two Indians to take the canoe of meat to Fort 
 Yukon. One of them, whom we had called Hidarshik, had come 
 with us from Nowikakat. The other was a wild specimen of the 
 Xuklukahyet tribe, whom we decided to name Dick. A number 
 
 
 1% 
 
 .i \ 
 
 •f* 
 
 m 
 
 i 
 
 ti 
 
li! 
 
 fi 
 
 !i 1/ 
 
 96 
 
 THE VUKOX TERRITORY. 
 
 of others indicated their intention to travel with us to Fort 
 Yukon and trade there. (Jne of them had been employed by 
 Ketch um the previous summer. About three o'clock in the 
 afternoon we left Nuklukahyet and the Russians behind us, 
 receiving a salute from them, which we duly returned. 
 
 The river was becoming deeper and narrower, and the hills 
 were rising and approaching more closely to the Yukon, as we 
 ascended. Late in the afternoon a sunken rock cut a hole in the 
 
 ': r. 
 
 ,1 ' 
 
 111 tlie Ramp.irts. 
 
 bidarra, and \vc halted for repairs. On account of the extreme 
 heat we now decided to travel by night and camp in the hottest 
 part of the day. 
 
 Monday, \oth. — We entered, about three o'clock in the after- 
 noon, between high blurts and hills rising perhaps fifteen hun- 
 dred feet above the river, which here was exceedingly deep 
 and rapid and not more than half a mile wide. The bends 
 were abrupt, and the absence of sunlight and the extreme quiet 
 
THE YIKCJN TERRITOKV. 
 
 97 
 
 Iirocluced a feeling as if \vc had been travelling underground. 
 Ihe appropriate and expressive ICnglish name for these bluft's is 
 '• the Ramparts. ' 
 
 We were approaching the so-called Rapids of the Yukon, of 
 which we had heard so many stories. The Russians had pre- 
 dicted that we should not be able to ascend them. The Indians 
 joined in this expression of opinion, and had no end of stories 
 about the velocity of the current and the difficulty experienced in 
 
 Lonking back at the Rapids. 
 
 1- 
 
 P 
 
 S 
 
 1h 
 
 ascending them. We all felt a little anxious, but were confident 
 of overcoming the supposed difficulty in some way. Wc met 
 some Indians and obtained a little fresh meat. About midnight 
 we arrived at the Rapids. The river is very narrow here, and 
 the rocky hills rise sharply from the water. The rocks are 
 metamorphic quartzites, and a dike or belt of hard granitic rock 
 crosses the river. The fall is about twelve feet in half a mile. 
 The rapid current has worn the granUe away on either side, 
 7 
 
 iiilr 
 
9^ 
 
 THE YUKON TEKRlTORY. 
 
 forming two good channels, but in the middle is an island of 
 granite, over which the river rushes in a sheet of foam during 
 high water. There are several smaller " rips " along the shore, 
 especially near the left bank, but nothing to interrupt steamer 
 navigation, except the very rapid current. 
 
 Several Indians attempted to ascend in their small canoes. 
 We saw them reach a point just below the island, and by dint 
 of the hardest paddling keep stationary there a few minutes ; 
 when, their strength being exhausted, away went the canoes 
 down stream like arrows. 
 
 We joined our tracking-line with several rawhide lines belong- 
 ing to the Indians, and by keeping close to the rocks succeeded 
 in tracking over the worst part without much difficulty. Taking 
 our seats again, we had a hard pull to pass one jutting rock, and 
 our troubles were over. We then enjoyed a well-earned cup of 
 tea, and took a parting glance at the Rapids from above. From 
 this point only a broad patch of foam in the middle of the river 
 indicated their existence. 
 
 Tuesday, wth. — Coal has been said to exist in this vicinity, 
 but erroneously. There are no sandstones or other fossiliferous 
 rocks, and the granite is immediately succeeded by quartzites. 
 I found plenty of wild garlic on the rocks, and currant and goose- 
 berry vines in blossom. The Indians were attended by numerous 
 little dogs, which ran along the shore, following the canoes, and 
 sometimes swam across the Yukon two or three times in a day. 
 These were excellent hunters, but too small to use with sleds. 
 During the day they dislodged a porcupine, of which I secured 
 the skull. 
 
 Several women were with their husbands, who intended to 
 leave them somewhere on the road until their return from trad- 
 ing. They were hideously ugly and dirty, — far worse than the 
 Koyukuns or Ingaliks whom I had seen. They took charge of 
 the large canoes with the baggage, while the husband carried the 
 furs in his small canoe. There were several babies, all very dirty, 
 but otherwise like most Indian babies. During the day they 
 were tied into a kind of chair made of birch bark and packed 
 with clean dry moss, which was changed when occasion required. 
 The object itself looked much like an ordinary willow baby-chair, 
 but had a projection in front between the child's legs, which came 
 
THE YUKON TLKKITOKV, 
 
 99 
 
 
 up as far as its breast, and prevented its tumbling out when 
 untied. 
 
 It is remaricable that there arc no terraces along the river, and 
 the flinty rocks show ice-markings only for a foot or two along 
 high-water mark. 
 
 Wednesday, \2th. — The water, which had fallen some two 
 feet, rose about six inches during the day. The Indians assert 
 that this second rise always takes place, and precedes the starting 
 of the salmon up stream. We passed a dead moose in the water, 
 and shortly after the Indians killed another, some of the meat 
 of which we purchased. Passed a wrecked canoe on some shoals. 
 The next day we passed the Yukutzcharkat River, which Cap- 
 tain Ketchum had called, on his sketch-map, the W'hymper 
 River, in compliment to our friend and companion, Mr. Frederick 
 Whymper. 
 
 Thursday, 13///. — The long handle of our frying-pan having 
 broken oft", as they invariably do in travelling, it had been bent, 
 so that it might be used to catch hold of the pan, put it on and 
 off the fire when hot, &c. We were much annoyed at finding 
 that our Indians had left it behind at the last camp. This may 
 seem trivial ; but it is no small undertaking to use a frying-])an 
 without a handle on an open wood-fire. Such accidents in an un- 
 inhabited country bring forcibly before the mind the great value 
 of many small conveniences which we never think of at home. 
 The night was spent in tracking around a very long bend, which 
 left us in the morning only a few miles in a direct line from the 
 point which we had left in the afternoon. We cut the skin of our 
 bidarra again, but pushed on, keeping her dry by bailing. 
 
 Bidarshik and Mikaishka, who kept in advance of us, killed a 
 large moose, and we were well supplied with fresh meat. 
 
 Friday, i^t/i. — Passed a very small stream called by the In- 
 dians Tdtsun-ikhtnn, or " Caught-in-the-rocks." I found a fos- 
 sil skull of the musk ox {Ovibos uioscliatus) on the beach. WiUl 
 roses, snowballs, and gold-thread were in blossom on the hillsides, 
 and the fragrant juniper scented the air. A fine bluff, with a 
 rocky face like a great staircase, marked the mouth of the Tsee- 
 toht River on the right bank. After this the river begins to 
 widen, and numerous small islands occur. 
 
 Saturday, x^th. — The next day we left the mountains be- 
 
 \ 
 
 
 ui 
 
 - '^ 
 
 I 
 
 ♦I 
 
in I' I 
 
 
 n 
 
 < I 
 
 lOO 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 hind us. Just beyond them the Notokakat, or Dal! River of 
 Ketchum, enters the Yukon from the north. The latter river is 
 very broad at this point. W'e passed through some very strong 
 water. Not the least annoyance in this kind of travel is the con- 
 stant complaining of the Indians, unused to steady hard work 
 and ever ready to shirk, doing on principle the least they can. 
 
 Monday, lyth. — We enjoyed from our camp a fine view of the 
 end of the Ramparts and the intervening islands. Passed by 
 several deserted houses formerly inhabited by some Indians of 
 the Kutchin tribes, who all died five years ago of the scarlet fever. 
 This fever was introduced by a trading-vessel at the mouth of ihe 
 Chilkaht River. From the Chilkaht Indians it spread to those 
 of the Upper Yukon, and down the river to this point, where all 
 died and the disease spent itself. These are known to the Eng- 
 lish as the Small Houses, and the locality is an excellent one for 
 game and fish of all kinds. The women were left behind on an 
 island in the morning, and the Indians, relieved of the heavy 
 canoes, were already far in advance of us. 
 
 Tuesday, \St/i. — One of the few who accompanied us fol- 
 lowed a cow-moose in the water until tired out, when he killed 
 her with his knife, and with some difificulty we towed her ashore. 
 We occasionally saw a black bear or a Canada lynx on the 
 bank. For several days we kept steadily on, little of interest 
 occurring. It was noticed that the trees began to grow smaller 
 and more sparse as we ascended ;V.. river. The sun hardly 
 dipped below the horizon at midnighi, and his noontide rays 
 scorched like a furnace. The mosquitr cs were like smoke in the 
 air. Through constant and enforced observation, I came to dis- 
 tinguish four kinds, — a large gray one, and another with white 
 leg-joints, a very small dust-colored one which held its probos- 
 cis horizontally in advance, and another small one which carried 
 its probe in the orthodox manner. All were distinguished from 
 the civilized species by the reckless daring of their attack, 
 Thousands might be killed before their eye.s, yet the survivors 
 sounded their trumpets and carried on the war. A blanket of- 
 fered them no impediment ; buckskin alone defied their art. At 
 meal-times, forced to remove our nets, we sat until nearly .stifled 
 in the smoke, and, emerging for a breath of air, received no 
 mercy. • My companion's hands, between sunburn and mos- 
 
 
 r% ;2 
 
ler 
 
 the 
 lis- 
 [itc 
 los- 
 licd 
 loni 
 |ck. 
 lors 
 lof- 
 At 
 
 I no 
 
 I OS- 
 
 I-* 
 
!f 
 
 i;it: 
 
 )* 
 
 ''i' 
 
 I 
 
 % 
 
 ii 
 
 
 • I 
 
 ( 
 
 if 
 
 i\ \.i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 IO( 
 
 quitoes, were nearly raw, and I can well conceive that a man 
 without a net, in one of these marshes, would soon die from 
 nervous exhaustion. The mosquitoes drive the moose, deer, and 
 bear into the river, and all nature rejoices when the end of July 
 comes, and their reign is at an end. 
 
 Both banks had become very low and flat ; the region had a 
 dreary appearance. Only five snow covered peaks, supposed to be 
 part of the Romantzoft' range, rose above the level of the plains. 
 These are the only mountains near the Yukon, in Russian 
 America north of the Alaskan range, which b-^ar snow through- 
 out the year. 
 
 The plain here described reaches to the shores of the Arctic 
 Ocean, broken only by a few ranges of low mountains near the 
 coast, of which the Romantzotf are the highest. To the eastward 
 it rises almost imperceptibly, attaining its highest elevation be- 
 tween the head-waters of the Porcupine and the left bank of the 
 Mackenzie. This table-land, somewhat broken and rocky, as seen 
 abutting on the Mackenzie River has the appearance of high 
 hills. These are the "mountains" of Richardson. There are 
 no true mountains north of the Yukon, except the Roman tzoff. 
 Nothing of less than five thousand feet in height has a right to 
 the title of mountain ; but in the careless speech of the Hudson 
 Bay trappers and traders anything more than two hundred feet 
 high is a " mountain." 
 
 Sdiunfay, 22d. — After passing the Birch River of the Eng- 
 lish, called by the Indians Tolnoi'tn-niikdkat, we came upon a 
 camp of the Kutcha Kutchin'. Camping here, I purchased a 
 number of fish, which they were catching and drying. There 
 were four or five men, a boy or two, and five women. All were 
 much finer-looking than the Unakhatana we had left behind us 
 at Nuklukahyet. All wore manv articles of luiglish make ; one 
 of the women had a calico dress on. They had many dogs, all 
 of the black, .short-haired, long-legged English breed. 
 
 The men wore the Hudson Bay moccasins, leggins, and fringed 
 hunting-shirts of buckskin, originally introduced by the ICnglish 
 traders, who obtained them from the tril)es to the southeast. 
 They had abundance of the fine bead-work in which the French 
 Canadians delight, and which those women who frequent the forts 
 learn to excel in. 
 
 \\ 
 
 I 
 
 ' M 
 
 ' w 
 
 I 
 
 ■Mi 
 
I02 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 U, 
 
 M 
 
 The next afternoon, when we awoke we found the old chief 
 from Fort Yukon waiting to see us. After a liberal present of 
 tobacco and a tin cup, he returned the compliment by a small 
 piece of very fat moose meat. The old fellow's name was Sakh- 
 ni-ti, which the traders have corrupted into Senatee. The heat 
 was so extreme that we deferred our start until half past eight 
 in the evening. 
 
 Sunday, 2id. — We stopped for tea and rest twice ; and when 
 opposite the mouth of the Porcupine River we delayed a few mo- 
 ments, to set the colors and load our fire-arms. Rounding a bend 
 of the river, about noon we saw the white buildings of the fort on 
 the right bank, about a mile above the mouth of the Porcupine. 
 We gave them a hearty salute, which was returned by a fusillade 
 from a large crowd of Indians who had collected on the bank. 
 Landing, we received a cordial greeting from an old French Cana- 
 dian and two Scotchmen, who were the only occupants. The 
 commander and Antoine Houle were daily expected, with the 
 remainder of the men and the annual supply of goods from La 
 Pierre's house, by way of the Porcupine River. 
 
 We were shown to a room in the commander's houre, where 
 we deposited our baggage ; and, after putting our boat and 
 equipment in safety, we turned in for a good nap. 
 
 The journey, exclusive of the time spent at Nowikakat and 
 Kamensikhter, had occupied less than twenty-seven days, and 
 the distance travelled we estimated as about six hundred and 
 thirty miles. In a straight line the distance from Nulato to Fort 
 Yukon is over four hundred and eighty miles. 
 
 We were much elated at the successful issue of our journey, 
 and I confess to having felt a pardonable pride in being the first 
 American to reach I*"ort Yukon from the sea. 
 
 This trading-post was founded by McMurray in the season of 
 1 846- 47, and the original fort was a mile or more farther up the 
 river. The present fort was commenced in 1864, and at the 
 time of our visit needed only the erection of a stockade to com- 
 I)lete it. The cause of the change of location was the undermin- 
 ing and washing away by the river of the steep bank on which 
 the old fort was built. At this period, the old houses had been 
 removed, and some of the remaining foundation-timbers projected 
 far over the water. 
 

 f, 
 
jih 
 
 '^i 
 
 
 lii^t 
 
 :.! I 
 
 
 I '' 
 
 \ 
 
 \ i 
 
 i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 103 
 
 
 The present buildings consist of a large house, containing six 
 rooms, for the commander : a block of three houses, of one room 
 each, for the workmen ; a large storehouse ; a kitchen ; and four 
 block-houses, or bastions pierced for musketry, at the corners of 
 the proposed stockade. Outside of the fort is a small house of 
 two rooms, belonging to Antoine Houle the interpreter. 
 
 All the houses were strongly built, roofed with sheets of spruce 
 bark pinned and fastened down by long poles. The sides were 
 plastered with a white mortar made from shell-marl, obtainable in 
 the vicinity. Most of the windows were of parchment, but those 
 of the commander's house were of glass. The latter was provided 
 with good plank floors, and the doors and sashes were painted 
 red with ochre. The yard was free from dirt, and the houses, 
 with their white walls and red trimmings, made a very favorable 
 comparison with any of those in the Russian posts. 
 
 The fort is situated about two hundred miles from La Pierre's 
 House, by the Porcupine River, the journey there and back being 
 performed in about twenty days. Further particulars in regard 
 to its geographical position will be found elsewhcie. The inhab- 
 itants are all employes of the Hudson Bay Company. Most of 
 them are from the Orkney Islands and the north of Scotland, 
 while a few are French Canadians, with a mixture of Indian blood. 
 At this time the garrison consisted of Mr. J. McDougal the com- 
 mander, and six men, of whom four were Scotchmen. The Rev. 
 Mr. McDonald, a missionary of the Established Church, was also 
 expected with the boats. 
 
 The next day we got up a good breakfast, and invited the three 
 men who had received us. The repast consisted of flapjacks, 
 bacon, tea with sugar, and moose meat. As several of them had 
 been some years without tasting bread, it may be imagined this 
 was a rare treat to them. The larc for men and dogs at this place 
 is the same, i. e. dry moose meat alternating with dry deer meat, 
 occasionally varied by fresh meat of the same kind, and the slight 
 supply of game and fish which is now and then obtainable. The 
 trading-goods which are designed for this point take two years 
 in transportation from York P'actory on Hudson Bay. One 
 portage of over fifty miles has to be made, between P'ort AIc- 
 I'herson, on Peel River, to La Pierre's House on the Upper Por- 
 cupine. Here the goods are carried on sleds in winter, across 
 
 1^= 
 
 i^ii 
 
 ■IV; i 
 
I04 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 the high, rough, and broken table-land between the two rivers. 
 On account of these diflficulties in transportation, few provisions 
 are ever sent to this isolated post. These few find their way to 
 the table of the commander, or to the Indian tyones who bring 
 large quantities of furs to the annual trade. The men should re- 
 ceive three pounds of tea and six of sugar, annually, to flavor 
 their diet of dry meat ; but I was informed that this supply was 
 exceedingly irregular, and often failed entirely. 
 
 The Indian chiefs often obtain a small present of tea, sugar, or 
 flour, but the latter is quite inaccessible to the men, except through 
 the favor of the commander. These men are allowed two suits 
 of clothes annually, if the supply holds out ; but for anything else 
 they must wait until the furs are all purchased, and then, if any- 
 thing remain after the Indians are satisfied, the men are allowed 
 to purchase. Even if by their own skill they trap furs enough to 
 buy articles of clothing, the Indians still take the precedence. 
 They are allowed to purchase what they can from the Indians, 
 but must turn it all in to the Company, and, if they need it, must 
 buy it at Company's prices. The standard of value is the beaver- 
 skin. One " made beaver," as they express it, is worth two shil- 
 lings, or two marten skins. A man bu3's a dressed mooseskin, 
 to make moccasins of, at its regular value of two " made beaver," 
 or four shillings. He cannot set his wife at work making mocca- 
 sins, but must sell it to the Company for what he paid the In- 
 dians, and buy it back for tiveuty shillings, which is the Company's 
 selling-price. If he does not do this he is liable to lose all his 
 past earnings which happen to be in the Company's hands, and 
 take a flogging beside from the commander. Every eflbrt is 
 made, to make these men marry Indian wives ; thus forcing them 
 to remain in the country by burdening them with females whom 
 they are ashamed to take back to civilization, and cannot desert. 
 They perform a larger amount of manual labor for smaller pay 
 than any other civilized people on the globe. 
 
 The hardships and exposures to which they are subjected are 
 beyond belief In fact, the whole system is one of the most exact- 
 ing tyranny ; and only in the north of Scotland could men of 
 intelligence be found who would submit to it. The systematic 
 way in which the white "servant of the Company" is jj^round 
 down below the level of the Indians about him, is a degrada- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 105 
 
 tion few could bear. They are not even furnished with good 
 tools. The Hudson Bay axe is a narrow wedge, which an 
 American lumberman would reject with contempt. The Hud- 
 son Bay knives — at least such as I saw at Fort Yukon — 
 are so worthless that even the Indians prefer to buy files, and 
 
 Knife of Kutcliin manufacture. 
 
 manufacture their own knives from them. The guns are all 
 flint-locks of the most miserable description ; and this rubbish 
 must be bought at treble its value by the Hudson Bay voy- 
 ageur, in a country where the axe and gun are a man's right and 
 left hands ! There is some comfort in reflecting that a few years 
 will put an end to this. Free traders already pass through the 
 greater part of the Hudson Bay territory without restraint, and 
 they will not be long in reaching a district so rich in valuable 
 furs as that of Fort Yukon. 
 
 The sun was so intensely hot that in the middle of the day we 
 could do nothing, but during the cooler hours much of interest 
 was added to my collection and my companion's portfolio. At 
 noon, out of the direct rays of the sun, one of Greene's standard 
 thermometers stood at 112" Fahrenheit. The men informed me 
 that on several occasions spirit thermometers had burst with the 
 heat. In the depth of winter the spirit falls sometimes as low as 
 sixty-eight and sixty-nine below zero, making a range for the 
 year of one hundred and eighty degrees Fahrenheit ! Neverthe- 
 less, potatoes, turnips, lettuce, and other hardy garden vegetables 
 mature during the short hot summer, and barley was said to have 
 succeeded once, but only reached a few inches in height. 
 
 We were very well pleased to hear from an Indian runner 
 that the boats were not far otf. On the 26th of June, Messrs. 
 McUougal, McDonald, and Sibbeston arrived with the bateaux. 
 The latter were about forty feet long, nine feet beam, and drew 
 two and a half feet of water. They are well adapted to the 
 navigation of the Porcupine, which is full of shoals and sand- 
 bars, and they brought a load of nine thousand pounds each from 
 La Pierre's House. 
 
 ■-: : 
 
 \ 
 
 
 h 
 
 i 
 
 m 
 
 
io6 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ( ' 
 
 ^! : 
 
 We invited the commander and Mr. McDonald to be our 
 guests for the day, and did our best to provide a good dinner. 
 We found them to be typical Scots, — quiet, reserved, cautious, but 
 hospitably inclined. Antoine Houle the interpreter, who arrived 
 with them, was of mi.xed French and Indian blood, and was a thor- 
 ough voyageur. More independent than most of the Company's 
 servants, he had his house to himself outside of the fort ; and 
 like many of his Indian cousins, deaf to the remonstrances of the 
 missionaries, had provided himself with one more wife than is 
 usual in civilized countries. This was the more excusable, as the 
 poor fellow suffered from ossification of the knee-joint, and could 
 do but little to help himself His house was always open to 
 every one, and was a noted resort of the Indians, with whom he 
 was a great favorite. With them he could talk in their own 
 dialects, while the usual mode of communication between the 
 whites and Indians in this locality is a jargon somewhat like 
 Chinook, known by the name of " Broken Slave." The basis of 
 this jargon, which includes many modified French and English 
 words, is the dialect of Liard River. The native name of the 
 tribe called Slav^ is Achcto-tinnch, or " People living out of the 
 wind." 
 
 The ne.xt business for Mr. McDougal, after storing his goods, 
 was the annual trade. Every spring the Yukon, and other In- 
 dians who do not trade with the Russians, assemble at Fort Yukon, 
 there await the arrival of the boats with the new supply of tobacco 
 and goods, and then do their trading. After this is over, the furs 
 are put into a large press, which is a conspicuous object in the 
 yard, and pressed into bundles weighing about ninety pounds 
 each. These bundles are covered with beaver-skins of the poorest 
 class, and are pressed so solid by means of wedges that, even if 
 dropped into the river, the water will not penetrate them. Each 
 bundle contains a certain number of marten or fox .skins packed in 
 beaver ; they are bound with rawhide cut in strips known as 
 " babiche," and each bundle is called a " piece." 
 
 After the trade is over and the furs are packed, thiy are taken 
 in the boats to La Pierre's House, and the boats return empty. 
 Any remaining goods are laid aside, and sent down the river in 
 the following spring to Nuklukahyet. During the remainder of 
 the year but little trading is done, and months i^ass without an 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 > 1 
 
 107 
 
 Indian visiting the fort. A certain amount of tobacco is distrib- 
 uted among the men, and a certain amount is cached, in order 
 that they may not be entirely without the article in the spring. 
 The flint-lock guns sold by the Hudson Bay Company are pre- 
 ferred by the Indians to percussion guns, as caps are not always 
 obtainable, while a flint may be picked up on any beach. These 
 guns are valued at forty marten skins. They cost five dollars 
 apiece, and the skins will average one hundred and fifty dollars 
 in total value. 
 
 On the afternoon of the 27th a shout was raised that the 
 Tananah Indians were coming. On going to the beach, some 
 
 ! n 
 
 ! 
 
 Sakhniti. 
 
 twenty-five single canoes were seen approaching. The occupants 
 kept perfect time with their paddles, advancing in three platoons, 
 and passed over the water as swiftly and beautifully as a flock of 
 ducks. 
 
 Sakhni'ti, the chief of the Kutch.i Kutchin, or Fort Yukon In- 
 dians, stood on the bank dressed in his gayest costume, with a 
 richly embroidered blue blanket wrapped about him. He hailed 
 the foremost canoes as soon as they were out of the current. 
 After a harangue of a few minutes a fusillade was commenced by 
 
w, 
 
 J/ 
 
 r: 
 
 li 
 
 (1^, 
 
 1 : , 
 
 
 t i 
 
 
 n: 
 
 if 
 
 l' 
 (■ ■ 
 
 " 
 
 1 08 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 the Indians on shore, and returned by those in the canoes, after 
 which they landed. The Tenan Kutchin (people of the moun- 
 tains), or Indians of the Tananah, are known to the Hudson Hay 
 men as Gens des Buttes. They arc without doubt the tribe of all 
 others which has had the least to do with the whites. No white 
 man has yet explored the river on which they live. We only know 
 that its head-waters are not very far from Fort Yukon, and that 
 its general course is parallel with the Yukon. It is represented 
 as running between mountains, and obstructed with rapids and 
 cascades. The Tenan Kutchin are regarded with fear by the 
 adjacent tribes, and are doubtless a wild and untamable people. 
 Their numbers are supposed not to exceed one hundred and fifty 
 families. Of their mode of life nothing is known, except that they 
 obtain their subsistence principally by hunting the deer. No 
 women accompanied this party. They were all dressed in the 
 pointed parkies, which were once the universal male dress of the 
 family of Tinneh, and from which they have been called Chippe- 
 wayans, meaning " pointed coats." These coats were ornamented 
 in the same manner with beads or quills as the dress of the male 
 Koyukuns, already described. Their parkies and breeches were 
 smeared with red ochre. All wore the dentalium nose-ornament 
 previously noted. The most striking peculiarity about them was 
 their method of dressing their hair. Allowed to grow to its full 
 length, and parted in the middle, each lock was smeared with a 
 mixture of grease and red ochre. These then presented the ap- 
 pearance of compressed cylinders of red mud about the size of the 
 finger. This enormous load, weighing in some of the adults at 
 least fir .1 pounds, is gathered in behind the head by a fillet of 
 dentaliuui shells. A much smaller bunch hangs on each side of 
 the face. The whole is then powdered with swan's-down, cut up 
 finely, so that it adheres to the hair, presenting a most remarkable 
 and singular appearance. The dressing of grease and ochre re- 
 mains through life, more being added as the hair grows. 
 
 The fat is soon rancid, and a position to leeward of one of 
 these gentry is highly undesirable. This method of dressing 
 the hair is peculiar to the men. Among civilized nations such 
 practices are confined to the fairer sex. The gulf between 
 pomatum with gold powder and tallow with red ochre is not as 
 wide as it seems at first sight ; and the addition of swan's- 
 
 I 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 109 
 
 down is a suggestion which is worthy of consideration by the 
 ladies. 
 
 The tribes now represented at the fort, beside the Kutcha 
 and Tenan Kutchin, were the following : the Natclu' Kutchin, 
 or Gens de Large, from north of the Porcupine River ; the 
 Vuntd Kiiichiit, or Rat Indians, from farther up the Porcupine; 
 the Han Kutchin (wood people), or Gens de Bois, from the 
 Y ;kon, above Fort Yukon ; and finally, the Tutc/ionc Kutchin 
 (crow people), or Gens de P'ou-x, from still farther up the Yukon. 
 
 The tribes resembled each other in appearance and dress. 
 They all belong to the family of Tinneh, which is their name 
 for " people." Their habits of life differ somewhat according to 
 locality, but none have settled villages, — carrying their deerskin 
 lodges wherever food is most abundant. 
 
 Those who live in mountainous districts, hunting the active 
 deer from summit to summit, are notably the most savage and 
 unruly. Those who live by hunting the more phlegmatic moose, 
 which inhabits the lowlands, are much more docile. Their lan- 
 guages are similar in construction and roots, though not in 
 the forms of many words. The dialect of the Upper Tananah 
 assimilates closely to the Kutchin languages, while that spoken 
 near Nuklukahy^t resembles more nearly the Ingalik. The 
 Tananah Indians brought the news of the body of a white man 
 having been found in the river below. 
 
 A sad event had happened at Fort Yukon in the early spring. 
 A young man named Cowley had been acting as clerk at the 
 fort, and at the time of the freshet was shooting geese on an 
 island across the river. He had crossed in a large canoe with 
 one of the men employed at the fort. He was a new arrival, and 
 not accustomed to the mode of life, and was therefore subjected 
 to many practical jokes from the old voyageurs. Wishing to 
 return, he could not find the canoe, and supposing that some trick 
 had been played upon him, the two embarked in a very small 
 single canoe and attempted to cross. The river was full of ice, 
 and nothing more was ever seen of them. The wrecked canoe 
 which we had passed in the Ramparts was doubtless the one in 
 question. The Rev. Mr. McDonald, being informed of the Indian 
 rumor, immediately started down the river with a companion, to 
 investigate the matter, and if necessary to perform the last rites 
 over the remains. 
 
 \' 
 
 1^^^ 
 
'll 
 
 'hill 
 
 
 I 
 
 i!^ 
 
 i! 
 
 .1 ,1 
 
 (. 
 1 
 
 ' j 1 
 f, ■ 
 
 ) 
 
 , 1 
 
 (I' 
 
 } 
 t 
 
 M 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Among the chiefs at the fort was a man of remarkable intelli- 
 gence, who had been of great service to the whites on various 
 occasions. He went by the name of Red Leggins, and possessed 
 great influence among the Indians. I applied to him for assist- 
 ance in obtaining ethnological specimens and vocabularies, and 
 improved the opportunity by taking his portrait. 
 
 On the 29th of June we were called out by the Indians, wh? 
 said that Ketchum was coming. Two canoes were seen in the 
 distance, and before long we had the gratification of shaking the 
 hands of our fellow-explorers, and offering them our hearty con- 
 gratulations on the complete success of their arduous explora- 
 tions. They had arrived safely at the site of Fort Selkirk, 
 and brought back as a trophy a piece of one of the blackened 
 timbers which remained. They reported the river to be open to 
 navigation up to that point; but just beyond it was a rapid, 
 where a portage would be necessary. The country was a fine 
 one, well timbered, abundantly supplied with moose and game, 
 and inhabited by friendly Indians. An enumeration of the ob- 
 stacles which they had encountered would be out of place here, 
 but it may fairly be said that only extreme jMi'ence, endurance, 
 indefatigable energy and courage, could have surmounted them. 
 They were principally, however, not such as would impede a 
 well-provided party ot' regular explorers. We " laid ourselves 
 out," in California parlance, to get up a good dinner for our 
 friends ; what with this oiid the interchange of news and informa- 
 tion, it was well into the next day before we sought our i)illows. 
 
 Mr. McDonald returned, having determined the body to be 
 that of Ward, Cowley's companion. He had buried it near the 
 point where it was found. 
 
 After the trade, which occupied severnl days, we obtained 
 the necessary goods to pay our Indians for the trip. To those 
 who had come up with us from Nulato we gave each a gun ; the 
 Nuklukahydt man received a good capote; and we gave a knife, 
 shirt, and ])owder-horn to Hiilarshik. 
 
 Our diet while at the fort consisted chiefly of boiled dried 
 meat, which when cooked resembles in flavor and stringiness a 
 boiled skein of yarn. 
 
 Mr. McDonald during our stay performed several services 
 among the Indians, lie was an earnest and well-disposed man. 
 
Ki. 1) l.r.dlllNS. 
 
; I. 
 
 1 i' 
 
 ii i i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I I I 
 
 a fair type of most missionaries to the Indians. His disrourscs 
 were rendered into broken Slave by Antoine Houle. In the 
 evening the Indians, old and young, gatiiered in the fort-yard and 
 sang several hymns with excellent effect. Altogether, it was a 
 scene which would have delighted the hearts of many very good 
 people who know nothing of Indian character ; and as such will 
 doubtless figure in some missionary report. To any one who at 
 all understood the situation, however, the absurdity of the pro- 
 ceeding was so palpable that it appeared almost like blasphemy. 
 
 Old Sakhnfti, who has at least eighteen wives, whose hands 
 are bloody with repeated and most atrocious murders, who knows 
 nothing of what we understand by right and wrong, by a future 
 state of reward and punishment, or by a Supreme Being, — this old 
 heathen was singing as sweetly as his voice would allow, and with 
 quite as much comprehension of the hymn as one of the dogs in 
 the yard. 
 
 Indians iro fond of singing: they are also fond of tobacco; 
 and for a pipeful apiece you may baptize a whole tribe. Why 
 will intelligent men still go on, talking three or four times a year 
 to Indians, on doctrinal subjects, by means of a jargon which can- 
 not express an abstract idea, and the use of vvhich onb throws 
 ridicule on sacred things, — and still call such work spreading 
 the truths of Christianity .' 
 
 When the missionary will leave the trading-posts, strike out into 
 the wilderness, live with the Indians, teach them cleanliness first, 
 morality next, and by slow and simple teaching lead thcii thoughts 
 -Im'X'o the hunt or the camp, — then, and not until then, will they 
 :■;' c.inpetent to comprehend the simplest principles of right 
 ^■■■''.i \ >x)ng. The Indian does not think in the methotl that 
 ^.1' li cii men adopt ; he looks at everything as " through a glass, 
 darK.y. His whole train of thought and habit of mind must be 
 educateil to a higher and dilt'erent standard before Christianity 
 can reach him. 
 
 The Indian, unchanged by contact with the whites, is in luind 
 a child without the trusting affectio'-. of chiUiiiood, and with the 
 will and passions of a man. Read by this standard, he may be 
 lairly judged. One fact may be unhesitatingly avowed : if he 
 'in obtain intoxicating liquors he is lost. Neither missionaries 
 ■lor tv-.ichers can savi; him while it is within his reach. A general 
 
 I; Fill 
 
I 12 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ) t 
 
 i 
 
 glance at the condition of the American Indians at this time con- 
 veys only one idea, which is, that the trader outstrips all re- 
 straints and that the whole race is irrevocably doomed. 
 
 In dealings with them they appreciate justice, but do not prac- 
 tise it, and they respect the strong arm alone. It has often been 
 asked why the Hudson Bay Company has succeeded in its in- 
 tercourse with the aborigines without the misery and bloodshed 
 which has stained our western frontier. The inference has been 
 as often drawn that it was owing to the justice which was charac- 
 teristic of the Company's dealings with the Indians. That there 
 is no foundation for tb's opinion I propose to show. 
 
 In the first place, wi ) '• Hudson Bay traders have had few 
 contests with the Indiai 11, in proportion to the number of 
 
 whites, full as many Indiai. outrages have taken place as in the 
 Western United States. The following from the pen of Bernard 
 R. Ross, Esq., of the Hudson Bay Company, is pertinent to the 
 question.* Speaking of the Eastern Tinneh, he says: — 
 
 " As a whole, the race under consideration is unwarlike. I have 
 never known, in my long residence among this people, of arms having 
 been resorted to in conflict. In most cases tlieir mode of personal 
 combat is a species of wrestling, and consists in tlie opjjonents grasp- 
 ing each other's long hair. Tliis is usually a very harmless way of set- 
 tling disputes, as wlioever is thrown loses ; yet instances have occu.red 
 of necks having been dislocated in the tussle. Knives are almost in- 
 variably laid aside previous to the contest. Some of tiiem box tolera- 
 bly well ; but this metiiod of fighting does not seem to be generally ap- 
 proved of, nor is it much practised. Un examination of the subject 
 closely, I am dis|)ose(l to consider that this peaceful disposition pro- 
 ceeds more from timidity than from any actual disinclination to shed 
 blood. These Indians, whether in want or not, will take the life of any 
 animal, however useless to lliem, if they be able to do so, and that they 
 can on occasion be sufficiently treacherous and cruel is evinced by the 
 massacre at St. John's, on i'eace River, and at Fort Nelson, on the 
 I, lard River. It may not be out of place here to give a brief account of 
 the latter catastrophe. 
 
 "In 1 84 1 the post of Fort Nelson, on the Liard River, was in charge 
 of a Mr. Henry, a well-educated and clever man, but of a Jiasty tem- 
 per and morose disposition. While equipping the Indians in the au- 
 tunm he had a violent dispute with one of the ])rincipal chiefs of the 
 
 * From the iinmial Report of the .Smithsonian Institution. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I I 
 
 Bastard Beaver Indians resorting to the establisiiment, wiio departed 
 greatly enraged, and muttering suppressed tlireats, which were little 
 thought of at the time. In the winter a 'courier' arrived at the fort 
 to infonn the whites that there were the carcasses of several moose 
 deer lying at the camp ready to be hauled, and requested dog-sleds to 
 be sent for that purpose. Mr. Henry, never in the least suspecting any 
 treachery, immediately despatched all the men and dogs that he could 
 muster. On their way out they met an hulian, who told them that they 
 had better turn back, as the wolverines had eaten all the meat. This 
 information, as it turned out, was given from a friendly motive ; but 
 fear of ulterior consequences to himself prevented the man from speak- 
 ing more plainly. The fort interpreter, who was of the party, took the 
 precaution to carry his gun with him, and when they drew near to the 
 path which led from the bed of the river to the top of the bank, where 
 the Indians were encamped, he lingered a little behind. On the others 
 mounting the ascent, they were simultaneously shot down, at one dis- 
 charge, by the natives, who were in ambush awaiting them. When the 
 interpreter heard the shots he was convinced of foul play; he therefore 
 turned and made for the fort as quickly as he could, pursued by the 
 whole party of savages, whose aim was to prevent him from alarming 
 the establishment. The man was a famous runner, and despite the 
 disadvantage of small snow-shoes, which permitted him to sink more 
 deeply than the Indians, who, on their huge hunting snow-shoes, al- 
 most skimmed over the surface of the snow, he would have reached the 
 houses before them, had not the line that confined the snow-shoe on 
 his foot broken. His enemies were too close upon him to allow time 
 for its repair ; so, wishing to sell his life as dearly as i.>ossible, he levelled 
 his gun at the nearest Indian, wiio evaded the shot by fallinsr upon his 
 face, whereupon the whole party despatched h'm. After perpetrating 
 this additional murder the band proceeded to the fort, which they 
 reached at early dawn. A poor old Canadian was, without suspicion 
 of evil, cutting fire-wood at the back gate. His brains were dashed 
 out with their a.\es, and they entered the establishment, whose inhabi- 
 tants, consisting, with one exception, of women and children, were 
 buried in profound repose. They first opened Mr. Henry's room, 
 where he was asleep. The chief pushed him with the end of jiis gun 
 to awaken him. He awoke, and seeing numerous fiendish and stern 
 faces around him, made a spring to reach a i)air of pistols that were 
 hanging over his head ; but before he could grasp them, he fell a bleed- 
 ing corpse 
 
 \' 
 
 on 
 
 the bosom of his wife, who, in tum, became a helpless 
 victim of the sanguinary and lustful revenge of the infuriated s.nages. 
 
114 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I :. / 
 
 Maddened by the blood, they next proceeded to wreak their vengeance 
 on the innocent women and children, who expired in agonies and under 
 treatment too horrible to relate. The pillage of the stores was the 
 next step, after which they departed, leaving the bodies of the dead un- 
 buried. No measures further than the abandonment of the fort for 
 several years were taken by the Northwest Company, to whom the 
 establishment belonged, to punish the perpetrators of the atrocious 
 deed; yet it is a curious fact that when I visited Fort Liards in 1849, 
 but one of the actors survived, all the others having met with violent 
 deaths, either by accident or at the hands of other Indians. This man, 
 who was at the time only a lad, confessed to have dashed the brains 
 out of an infant, taking it by the heels and swinging it against the walls 
 of the house." 
 
 This, and the long list of forts pillaged by the Indians or aban- 
 doned on account of their hostility* by the Hudson Bay Com- 
 pany, is sufficient to show that their occupation has not been 
 wholly peaceful. But little has been said of these outrages, as it 
 was evidently for the interest of the Company that they should 
 not be talked about. 
 
 It must also be noticed that the policy of the Company has 
 always been to put cis fcvv men as possible in these trading-posts. 
 A very few white men can go in safety where a large body would 
 instantly excite hostilities. After the fort has been in operation 
 for years, and a demand created for tobacco and other articles, 
 the Indians feel that it is to their advantage to have them there, 
 and the whites in small numbers no longer excite their jealousy. 
 Then, whenever a new post was established, the influential chiefs 
 were handsomely provided with presents, the whites in the fort 
 were kept in subjection to the extent already described, going 
 about in rags, while the Indians obtained broadcloth and clothing 
 of every description for their furs. This obvious superiority 
 pleased the vanity of the savage. Little or no retribution fol- 
 lowed the outrages previously mentioned. In some cases pres- 
 ents were plentifully distributed to appease their anger, and any 
 ofience toward an Indian was severely punished. The self-re- 
 spect of the white man was sacrificed to the desire of obtaining 
 furs. Lastly, the most warlike and bloody tribes had been reduced 
 to comparative quietness in the early colonial wars. 
 
 * This includes Forts Seli<iil<, I'clly ISaiiks, Dcisc, I'Yanccs, lialiinc, Peace Kiver, 
 aiul others, — all burnt or pill.iged and abandoned. 
 
 % 
 
 •i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 115 
 
 ; ft 
 
 On the other hand, the Indians of the western plains were 
 races more vigorous and active than their northern congeners. 
 They were met by large bodies of pioneers, bent on settling and 
 occupying the territory. Indian outrages, provoked or unpro- 
 voked, met with speedy return from the colonists, and matters 
 were still further complicated by the recognition of the hypo- 
 thetical authority of the chiefs by the government. Promises 
 were made by the former, of which they had not power to en- 
 force the fulfilment by the Indians, who were erroneously sup- 
 posed to obey them. The pernicious system of making presents 
 to the chiefs, the introduction by traders of intoxicating liquors, 
 and, above all, the failure of the government in any instance to 
 enforce respect by its strong arm, have created an animosity 
 which will die out only with the Indians thcnisel 'es. 
 
 It would seem brutal to advise force as a civilizer, but the 
 Aleuts, who were thoroughly crushed and subjugated by the 
 early Russian traders, and subsequently by the Russian American 
 Company, are to-day the only large body of aborigines in America 
 who give any promise of ultimate civilization. 
 
 After the trade was over, we had an opportunity of looking at 
 the results. It was a sight seldom witnessed by others than 
 traders. The large loft over the store-house was literally over- 
 flowing with valuable furs. Among other trophies of the chase 
 were forty-five silver fo.\es. The commander confessed to five 
 thousand sables purchased the previous year. The men in the 
 fort said that the amount was nearer eight thousand, with half as 
 many beaver, and five hundred foxes of all kinds. Few otter, and 
 very few mink are obtained here, but black bearskins, dressed 
 mooseskins, and black and silver foxes are especially abundant. 
 The value of the furs annually obtained at this post cannot be es- 
 timated as less than fifty thousand dollars. 
 
 We decided to start down the river on the 8th of July. The 
 women in the fort were very busy filling orders for mocca- 
 sins, and other specimens of their work, which wc tlcsigned for 
 friends below. I was indetjted to one of the men for a fine 
 pair of otter-skin mittens, which have since done mc good ser- 
 vice. Kctchum decided to take a small boy, Jean Haptiste by 
 name, who was well qualified to act as interpreter with several 
 tribes of Indians. He spoke comparatively little ICnglish, but 
 
 I 
 
 li.' 
 ■'I 
 
 
 
 \' 
 
 
 ■ 51 
 
 ■ I 
 
 ;n 
 
 lii 
 
 'i : :, 
 
 * 
 
 l \ i 
 
 1 
 
 
 i 
 
 J 
 
 1 
 
T 
 
 ii6 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 h 
 
 
 U 
 
 {• 
 
 understood Canadian French, having a little Canadian blood in 
 his veins. 
 
 The commander coolly proposed to Ketchum that he should 
 kidnap, iron, and send back to Fort Yukon the unfortunate run- 
 away McLeod ! However, we let it pass without remark, for we 
 were under great obligations to Mr. McDougal for hospitality 
 shown us, and assistance rendered in paying our men. Ketchum 
 arranged it so that, in going back, Whymper and Mike should 
 take the bidarra, while he and I had each a large birch canoe, 
 with Indians fore and aft to paddle it. Having got everything 
 on board, we shook hands and bade our kind entertainers good 
 by. About two o'clock in the morning of the 8th we left Fort 
 Yukon behind us. A tremendous firing from the assembled In- 
 dians announced our departure, and we returned the compliment 
 to the best of our ability. 
 
 Travelling down stream is always easy. Our journey seemed 
 easier still as, in the broad channel, out of reach of the mosquitoes, 
 we drifted on without impediment at the rate of four or five miles 
 an hour. Points appeared, were passed, and faded out of view, 
 almost without our perceiving it ; while between them, going up, 
 we had passed many hours of hard paddling in the hot sun. No 
 sand-bars or shoal water obstructed our progress anywhere, ex- 
 cept where the swift current brought us close to the bank. We 
 tied our canoes together, and floated down, sometimes sleeping, 
 and often in a revery which recalled the lotus-eaters of the Nile. 
 We did not camp anywhere. We boiled the chynik and cooked 
 our meals ashore, and, pushing out into the broad stream, ate 
 them while calmly drifting with the current. Sometimes the 
 mosquitoes would try to follow us, and we could see them vainly 
 endeavoring to make headway against the fresh breeze usually to 
 be found in midstream. They were always unsuccessful, and we 
 discarded our nets and laughed at the discomfited insects. About 
 three o'clock in the afternoon of the 9th we re-entered the Ram- 
 parts, and here, in the swifter current, our progress was more rapid. 
 
 Large fires were burning in the forests, and on the sides of the 
 hills. They had been kindled by some neglected camp-fire, and 
 spread rapidly over the mossy sod and leaves dried by the mid- 
 summer sun. The smoke hung over all the country, obscuring 
 everything with a lurid haze. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 117 
 
 About six o'clock on the afternoon of the lOth we passed the 
 Rapids. The water had fallen, and we should not have known 
 the place but for the Indians. One of the party refused to believe 
 it. A long island of rock, smoothed by the water, divided the 
 river, which flowed smoothly but with great swiftness on either 
 side. The riffle which had attracted most of our attention had 
 been caused by an insignificant ledge of rock, now bare. The 
 difierence between the level of the ice in winter and extreme high- 
 water mark, as indicated on the rocks, cannot be much less than 
 thirty feet. Some distance below we found the Nuklukahyet 
 chief and his people fishing for salmon with large hand-nets. 
 The little canoes sailed down stream with the current, the Indians 
 keeping in line like soldiers, and joining in a monotonous but not 
 discordant chorus. At a given signal, all plunged their nets be- 
 low the surface, and on raising them a great salmon frequently 
 was seen struggling in the meshes. In this case all joined in a 
 derisive shout and song. The dried meat which the chief had 
 promised was not forthcoming. A " cash " business is the only 
 safe one with Indians. They never pay old debts, giving as a 
 reason that the articles purchased are already worn out. 
 
 We had a good deal of amusement chasing the young geese. 
 Their wing feathers not being grown, they could not fly ; but they 
 were very expert divers, and were beneath the water almost as soon 
 as the cap flashed. We obtained quite a number, and found them 
 very delicate eating. We passed numerous fishing-camps, where 
 the banks were red with the salmon, split and hung up to dry. 
 
 About eight o'clock on the evening of the I2th we arrived at 
 the bluffs above Nukito. Here old Yagorsha, the Yakut, was fish- 
 ing, and hailed us from the bank. He told us that the whole of 
 Russian America had been bought by an American company, and 
 that an American ship and steamer were already at the Redoubt! 
 The pleasure which we felt at this intelligence was marred by 
 doubts of its truth ; but, passing on, about ten o'clock we arrived 
 at Nulato. Here the air resounded with the discharges of cannon, 
 which welcomed our return. Indians and Russians vied in the 
 expenditure of gunpowder, and the enthusiastic Kun'Ua used up 
 all his ammunition in returning the salute. 
 
 Our delight was soon damped, however, by an incompre- 
 hensible order which awaited us. This instructed us to trans- 
 
 it t: 
 
 [ 
 
ii8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 |i I' 
 
 w. 
 
 •■■{■ 
 
 ■ |! 
 
 i! 
 
 mit, without delay, all movable property belonging to the Tele- 
 graph Company to the Redoubt. Various rumors about the sale 
 of the country were current among the Russians. Nothing was 
 certain, and one of them remarked to me with a sneer, " Perhaps, 
 Gospodin Doctor, it is the Americans, and not the Russians, who 
 are about to march ! " 
 
 The Koyiikuns occupied the beach, fishing, and with character- 
 istic insolence took fish out ot the Russian nets before their eyes. 
 The latter were too few in n"mber to resent the insult, the 
 bidarshik and two men being ;ibsent at the Redoubt. 
 
 We proceeded to carry out our instructions, purchasing the 
 large Russian bidarra, putting all the collections and other 
 valuable property aboard, and hiring six men to accompany us 
 to the sea-coast. Near midnight, July 15th, we started down 
 the river, full of anxiety, not knowing what changes were at 
 hand. 
 
 The river was lined with Indian fishing-camps laying in the 
 winter supplies of likali. Had we possessed the necessary trad- 
 ing-goods and transportation, we might have bought thousands of 
 salmon. 
 
 On the night of the 17th we saw the first star visible since the 
 end of April. On the 19th of July, about eleven o'clock at night, 
 we felt a shock as if we had struck a snag. Next morning we 
 arrived at the Russian mission of the Greek Catholic Church. 
 There we learned that there had been an earthquake shock in 
 the night, of sufficient severity to throw down books and other 
 articles from the shelves on which they were placed. The priest, 
 or " Pope " as the Russians call him, with most of the Russians 
 who belonged here, was absent at the Redoubt. In this part of 
 the river the channel is deep enough for vessels of any size. It 
 is extremely broad, the low left bank being sometimes barely 
 visible. Sloughs and innumerable islands characterize this por- 
 tion of the Yukon. 
 
 The weather was much of it hot, cloudy, and disagreeable, 
 with occasional rain, forming a marked contrast to that which 
 we had experienced farther inland. The white-winged gull 
 {Lams Iciicoptcnts) replaces the familiar silver gull {L. argciitatus) 
 of the Upper Yukon. On the morning of the 22d we saw numer- 
 ous leopard seal {iicrpa) sporting in the river. Seal have been 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 119 
 
 occasionally seen at Nulato, and on one occasion a white whale 
 or Beluga was killed only a few miles below Nulato, at least four 
 hundred miles from salt water. About five o'clock the same day 
 we reached the post of Andreaffsky, occupied by two men only, 
 one of them a native. The other received us as hospitably as his 
 means would allow, and spread us a repast of salted salmon and 
 bread. We made his heart glad by a present of some tea, as his 
 own supply was exhausted, and borrowed his assistant to guide 
 us to the Uphoon, or northernmost mouth of the Yukon, by 
 which the sea-coast is reached. A strong breeze arose, and we 
 scudded before it, reaching the Uphoon and dismissing our guide 
 about three o'clock the next morning. 
 
 About noon we reached a Russian house at Kiitlik, whose in- 
 mates were absent at the Redoubt. Five channels leading in 
 different directions misled us, and we pulled nearly ten miles up 
 a small river, until the tide turned and we saw our mistake. 
 The next trial was more successful, and we soon reached Pastolik, 
 an Eskimo village opposite the Uphoon-mouth, where we camped 
 ashore for the first time since leaving Nulato. 
 
 The next morning we divided our load, hiring another bidarra 
 and some Unaligmut Eskimo to assist us in our voyage along the 
 sea-coast to St. Michael's. At noon we reached Point Romanoff, 
 the Cape Shallow Water of Cook. This is the only hill or land- 
 mark north of Cape Ronianzoff on the coast. Here is a small 
 village of a few huts, where we purchased some fish and game. 
 
 About two o'clock in the morning of the 25th we reached 
 the southeastern entrance of the Canal between St. Michael's 
 Island and the mainland. Here we stopped and arrayed our- 
 selves in apparel more suitable for civilized society. We tracked 
 through the Canal, hoisted our flags, and bore away for the 
 Redoubt with a light wind. Here we arrived about noon of 
 July 25th, finding all the members of the exploring and con 
 structing parties gathered to receive us. The news was soon 
 told. 
 
 The Atlantic cable was a triumphant success. The United 
 States were in negotiation for the purchase of Russian America. 
 Our costly and doubtful enterprise was abandoned, and the 
 bark Clara Bell was soon expected, to take all hands to San 
 l""rancisco. The ill-fed and hard-worked constructors hailed their 
 
 - \ 
 
t 
 
 ', I 
 
 i 
 
 1 20 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 deliverance with joy ; but the weather-beaten explorers, with their 
 carefully matured plans for more thorough and extended explo- 
 rations during the coming year, felt a regret and disappointment 
 which could hardly be over-estimated, as with a few words these 
 prospects were destroyed. There was, of course, nothing to be 
 done but to pitch our tents on the beach, and there await the re- 
 turn of the vessel, now absent in search of the parties which had 
 been left at Grantley Harbor, Bering Strait. 
 
 fi'i 
 
 I : 
 
 II 
 
 }': 
 
C H A P T I<: R IV. 
 
 Arrival of the vessel. — Arrange to remain in the country. — Departure of the Clara 
 Bell. — Mushrooms. — Plans for the season. — .Start for Unalaklik. — The Major's 
 Cove. — Voyage to Kegiktowruk. — Description of the casine. — End of the old 
 biilarra. — Leave Kegiktowruk. — Crossing the bar of the Unalaklik River — Send 
 hack for the goods. — Trip to Ulukuk. — Death of Stareek. — Hears and bear-hunt- 
 ing. — Geological reconnoissance, and discovery of fossils. — Return to Unalaklik. — 
 Purchasing winter supplies. — Innuit of Norton Sound. — Tribes, physique, games, 
 kyaks. — Disposition, morality, marriages, and infanticide. — Treatment of the 
 women, and work allotted to the sexes. — Dress, labrets of the different tribes. — 
 Property, method of computation, and map-drawing. — F^ire-drills. — Weapons of 
 bone, flint, and ivory. — Guns and trading. — Intercourse with Indians, and boun- 
 dary lines of their territory. — Shamanism. — Patron spirits. — Interment of the 
 dead. — Habits, and means of gaining subsistence throughout the year. — Dances 
 and festivals. — Arrival of my new bidarra. — .Sudden illness, and departure for the 
 Redoubt. — Storm and detention at Kegiktowruk. — Proceed to the Redoubt 
 on foot. — Return to Unalaklik. — Kill a deer. — Cowardly abuse of the natives by 
 the Russians. — Kamokin and his barbarity to the sick. — Deaths in the village. — 
 Making dog-harness. 
 
 ALONG month passed by and brought no signs of the 
 ship. A party of seven bidarras, manned with Okeeogemuts 
 and other Bering Strait Innuit, arrived at St. Michael's. They 
 brought the news that the Grantley Harbor parties had safely 
 embarked, and departed. We began to fear that some accident 
 had happened to the vessel. Our daily walk was invariably to 
 the northeast bluff, whence we could look seaward. A pound of 
 tobacco was promised to the first person who should .see the ship. 
 About three o'clock in the afternoon of the i8th of August an 
 old woman came breathless from the bluff, .saying the ship was 
 coming. All started to confirm the report, which proved true, and 
 the venerable Martha was made the recipient of more tobacco 
 than she had ever before possessed. 
 
 It was the Clara Bell, and about eight o'clock she anchored in 
 the bay. I had by this time become pretty well versed in colonial 
 Russian, as spoken in the territory. I had also .some knowledge of 
 the Innuit and Indian dialects, and understood the mode of life 
 
 .*ff 
 
122 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 'J ': 
 
 ••II 
 
 I I 
 
 ntcessary in the Yukon Tf^rritory. 1 had formed my plans, and 
 immediately took the opportunity of explaining them to Major 
 George M. Wright, adjutant of the Expedition, and now in charge 
 of all the men and materials which were to be shipped on board 
 the Clara Bell. 
 
 A pretty thorough reconnoissan :e had been made of the geology 
 and natural histon of the Yukon above aiid at Nulato, and on 
 the shores of Norton Sound. The Lower Yukon and the delta 
 had yet to be examined. I felt unwilling that the plans of Mr. 
 Kennicott, so far carried on successfully, should be left uncom- 
 pleted, I therefore proposed to carry them out alone, and at my 
 own expense, and relied on Major Wright for the co-operat'on ne- 
 cessary to accomplish this arrangement. With his characteristic 
 politeness he agreed to do what lay in his power. He could leave 
 me no provisions, as they were already short of them. He could 
 sell me, at the Company's prices, a small amount of trading-good.s, 
 and he would pay a certain proportion of the salary due nvj from 
 the Company into the hands of Stcpanoff (the chief factor of the 
 Russian American Company at St. Michael'.s), who could furnish 
 me with some trading-goods and a limited supply of provisions ; 
 while for the rest I must depend upon the natural re jurces of the 
 country. 
 
 Explaining to Stepanoff that I had no desire to interfere with 
 the fur-trade, he expressed himself willing to co-operate with me, 
 and the proposed arrangement was carried into ettect. 
 
 To my companions of the previous year, and to the officers of 
 the vessel I was greatly indebted for many articles useful in the 
 country, and otherwise unattainable. The boy who had been 
 brought from Fort Yukon was left in my care to be sent home. 
 My mail was made up for transmission by the vessel to San I'ran- 
 r.isr.o ; the Reports on the Medical Department and tht. Scien- 
 tific Corps were placed in the adjutant's hands. The collections 
 of the previous year were also .sent aboard. I depended, for the 
 means of reaching civilization again, on some passing trader or 
 the a.niual store-ship of the Russian.s. On the 23d of yXugust 
 everything was concluded, and I went on board and bade all hands 
 good by. I returned, with the boy Johnny and Stepanoff, in the 
 Russian boat. About four o'clock in the afternoon the Clara 
 Bell stood out to sea. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 123 
 
 ic 
 
 :n 
 
 le. 
 
 n- 
 
 n- 
 
 us 
 
 ho 
 
 or 
 
 1st 
 
 cUi 
 
 he 
 
 Ira 
 
 As I saw her white sails disappear in the distance I realized 
 more thoroughly the loneliness of my position, and that I was the 
 only person in the whole of that portion of the territory who spoke 
 linglish. If I needed companions, I must seek them among alien 
 convicts or Indians, in a foreign tongue. 
 
 Returning to my room in the fort, I soon stifled any feeling 
 of regret by busying myself in putting on paper a brief sketch 
 of my plan of exploration for the coming year. 
 
 Stepanoff called me, saying that there was no meat or other 
 fresh provisions in the fort, and we must go out and get some- 
 thing for dinner. At first I took down my gun, but he informed 
 me that it was unnecessary, and after walking a short distance he 
 pointed out various fungi, which he assured me were eatable. 
 They were of two or three species, all poisonous in our climate ; 
 but in this extreme northern region they proved to be innocuous 
 and eatable, though quite tasteless. 
 
 During our walk we came to a definite conclusion on the sub- 
 ject of fur-trading. Stepanoff said that he did not believe in the 
 rumor which prevailed as to the sale of the country ; that his 
 duty to the Russian American Company would compel him to 
 prevent any one from trading except the authorized employes of 
 the Company ; that when the oflficial information should arrive I 
 might trade as much as I chose, but until then I must refrain. 
 I assured him that trading was not my object in remaining in the 
 country, and that I would not do anything of the kind until he 
 had received definite information. The latter might be expected, 
 if at all, by a midwinter courier from Nushergdk to the Kolma- 
 koff Redoubt on the Kuskoqumi. .Such couriers had been sent 
 on rare and important occasions, .uid a mail was always sent to 
 Nushergdk from St. Michael's every December. 
 
 Stepanoff begged me to consider myself his guest while at the 
 Redoubt, and offered to have any orders sent to NuJ.to in regard 
 to the building in which we had spent the prev'"us winter, if I 
 desired to use it during the coming season. 
 
 My plans were as follows : First, to examine the rocks along 
 the shores of Norton Sound and across the portage as thoroughly 
 as i)ossible. Next, to take my trading-goods and such provisions 
 as I could obtain to Nulato ; spend the winter in making ex|)Iora- 
 tions in that vicinity, and, if posuble, make a winter visit to Kot- 
 
124 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 *|i| 
 
 ■ I i' 
 
 Pi . 
 
 zebue Sound ; to take a boat across the portage and descend the 
 Yukon in the spring, examining the rocks carefully, and making 
 as thorough collections as possible of specimens of natural his- 
 tory ; to spend some time at the Yukon-mouth ; and finally 
 return by sea to the Redoubt, and there await some opportunity 
 of getting a passage to Sitka or San Francisco with the collec- 
 tions. 
 
 I therefore requested Stepanoff to order Ivan Pavloff to have 
 the house put in thorough repair, the seams calked, floor put in 
 order, and the peechka replastered. The building at Fort Ken- 
 nicott was too large and too cold to be readily made habitable. 
 The orders were sent by Kurilla, whom I engaged as my {)er- 
 manent assistant. He, with Antoshka and Tekunka, started for 
 Nukito via Unalaklik, in the three-holed bidarka in which Dyer 
 had descended the Yukon. Kun'Ua was to get our dogs and sleds 
 together, hire Indians, buy ukali for dog-feed, and meet me at 
 Unalaklik as soon as the Yukon was ice-bound. Then we would 
 proceed together to Nulato. I furnished him with the necessary 
 trading-goods for purchasing dog-feed and hiring Indians, and he 
 dej^arted in high spirits at the responsibility intrusted to him. 
 
 One day when Stepanoft' was away shooting, on the marshes 
 about the Canal, one of the Russians came to me with a sable, for 
 which he wanted alcohol. I refused him, and added that I had 
 promised Stepanoff not to purchase furs, and should keep my 
 word. The meaning of truth and honesty is incomprehensible to 
 these degraded wretches, r ,cl h' still urged me, .saying Stepanoff 
 would never hear of it. As he did not take any notice of re- 
 peated refusal, I became at last so angry that I pitched him heels 
 over head out of the door and down the steps, into the muddy 
 courtyard, greatly to the amusement of old Martha, who had 
 just previously brought in .some work, and was waiting for her 
 pay. 
 
 Life among the natives is far preferable to being surrounded 
 by white men of such a despicable class. It is not to be won- 
 dered at that the knout and the brand were formerly in use in 
 Russia. Nothing else would seem capable of insjMring a respect 
 for the law in such minds. 
 
 My time was passed in running lead into balls, adding to the 
 collection, and making general preparations fur starting i'or Una- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 125 
 
 
 lakli'k as soon as any natives should arrive from Pastolik, where 
 they were hunting the beluga. 
 
 I accompanied Stepanoff on several of his shooting expeditions 
 in the Canal, and secured a large number of geese, ducks, and 
 swans. These are salted, and form an acceptable addition to the 
 winter fare. 
 
 On September 22d I purchased my supplies, including six 
 hundred pounds of flour, twenty-five of tea, fifty of sugar, and a 
 variety of trading-goods. I also laid in a supply of crockery — 
 a mug, plate, and bowl apiece — for myself, Johnny, and Kurilla. 
 China ware is more precious in this part of the world than silver 
 plate in more civilized localities. I also purchased fil'ty pounds 
 of sukaree, and some large iikali for use on the ruad. Several 
 Mdhlemuts having arrived, I engaged them to accompany me to 
 Unalaklfk. I proposed to take the old bidarni in which we had 
 descended the Yukon from Nulato. I had engaged to have a 
 small bidarra made at Pastolik and forwarded to me for use the 
 coming spring ; but it had not yet arrived. The old one was 
 very large, and the lashings and covering very rotten. I hardly 
 dared risk my invaluable trading-goods ; but, taking counsel with 
 some of the Innuit, we concluded that we could pmhably reach 
 Unalaklik in safety with it. 
 
 My crew was composed of Johnny, a Mahlemnt called Myunuk, 
 an old man whom I called New- Years, and a ■ ;• Kaviiigeniut. 
 The latter had an extremely stupid appearance, but was an « \cel- 
 lent hunter. 
 
 On the 23d of September I put my goods on board, toe' ;i 
 mail for the Russians at Unalaklik, and put to sea. The wind 
 was hardly fair, and rather light, and I was obliged to beat across 
 the southeast arm of the Sound, and put into the IMajor's Cove. 
 I had hoped to reach Kegiktowruk, but the wind was adverse, 
 and so high I could not risk it. Having pitched our tent under 
 the shelter of the hill, I sent Johnny off to shoot ptarmigan, and 
 rigged some fishing-poles, in hopes to catch some small fish, of a 
 species known here as wai'tch-iu\ a kind of tom-cod. Our success 
 was not very great, but we got a mess for supper, and Johnny 
 returned with an arctic hare which had already donned its winter 
 coat of white. 
 
 The next day the wind was still high, and it was impossible to 
 
 liiil 
 
 m 
 
I ■ 
 
 i 
 li 
 
 n 
 
 m 
 
 '}) 
 
 ! '.fv 
 
 '!■ 
 
 \,( 
 
 I 
 
 \ 
 I I, ( ■ 
 
 I , V 
 
 m 
 
 \i 
 
 4 :J 
 
 ri 
 h: 
 
 I 
 
 11 i 
 
 
 126 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 get away. The anchor dragged so much that I was obliged to 
 haul the bidarra up on the beach. Our sail had proved too small, 
 and we occupied ourselves in sewing on a strip of drill on each 
 side. Having; experienced the difficulty of transporting heavy 
 goods by sleds to Ulukuk, I hoped to get them to that point by 
 water ; but the ice was already forming in the ponds on the tun- 
 dra, and I began to fear that the Unalakh'k River would be frozen 
 over before my arrival. The next day the weather was equally 
 bad, and we were compelled to remain. Game and fish were 
 both very scarce, and we lived principally on sukaree and tea, as 
 I had no bacon. 
 
 On the 26th the wind was very variable and the waves very 
 high. Toward noon it came from the westward, and against the 
 wishes of the men I decided to start. Just as we left the cove 
 some tremendous rollers came in, but we rode over them safely, 
 and New-Years remarked, " The far-ofif wind has died away." 
 Looking out to sea, I saw that the rollers mentioned above were 
 the last, and the sea was quite smooth. 
 
 The wind grew fresher and fresher, being nearly a-beam. The 
 coast between the cove and Kegiktowruk is rocky, with no land- 
 ing-places. The wind increased and rain came in squalls. The 
 darkness rapidly closed over us and the clouds were so heavy 
 that the land was indistinguishable. P'or three hours I held the 
 tiller, almost blinded by the rain, fearing every moment that the 
 wind would haul ahead and drive us on the lee shore ; my only 
 guide in steering was the white line of breakers on the rock-bound 
 coast. We passed a rocky point, known as Pallonoi or Burning 
 Point, in safety, and about half past eight the moon suddenly 
 broke throuL;h the clouds, revealing the three rounded hills which 
 lie back of Kegiktowruk. We pulled into the cove, and I sent up 
 to the village to obtain help in hauling up the heavy boat, but 
 the inhabitants had gone to sleep or refusctl to come. We did 
 our best to put her in safety, and went up to the casine, where we 
 boiled the chynik and turned in. 
 
 The Kegiktowruk casine is the largest in the country. The an- 
 nexed section gives an idea of its construction. Its area is about 
 twenty-five feet by thirty, and its height fifteen feet from floor 
 to smoke-hole. The entrance is similar to that of the ordinary 
 houses, but at a is a .second opening, by which the cavit} beneath 
 
 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 127 
 
 the floor may be reached. In the middle of the floor is a hole 
 (li) where, during their dances, the performers come up from 
 below, not entering by the ordinary door at i. A portion of 
 the floor about twelve feet square (ff) is composed of planks, 
 which may be removed when it is desired to build a fire on the 
 earth beneath. Broad planks about three feet and a half above 
 the floor form seats (s) where the spectators may place them- 
 selves. The opening (l) in the roof is for the admission of light 
 and egress of smoke. There are no other windows. The en- 
 trance (i) is usually closed by a hanging bearskin. The sides 
 are of logs split in two and placed on end in the earth with the 
 flat side inward. The roof is supported by large logs laid across 
 so as to support each other. These are covered by a layer of 
 small timbers, split, or hewn flat on one side ; and the latter are 
 
 DLigram of Innuit casine. 
 
 kept in place by large timbers laid over them outside and at- 
 tached by a saddle-joint at the four corners of the roof. The 
 latter is covered with straw, and the straw with earth, pounded 
 down hard, so as to be waterproof There is not a nail or a pin 
 in the whole structure, which is of the most solid description. 
 Some of the logs arc two feet in diameter, and the broad seats on 
 each side, previously referred to, are each composed of a single 
 plank forty-four inches wide, thirty feet long, and four inches 
 thick. These enormous planks are from drift-logs, and were 
 hewn with the stone a.xes of the natives. 
 
 I was informed that, the old casine being decayed, all the 
 Innuit of Norton Sound had joined in building the present one. 
 Many logs were towed from distant parts of the coast. The 
 whole work had occupied six seasons in construction, and had 
 been standing about seven years. 
 
 \l 
 
 iiir 
 
i 
 
 r 
 
 1 
 
 ; I 
 
 \ ■ 
 
 h 
 / 
 
 i r 
 
 
 "I, % 
 
 ii' 
 
 
 kmt 
 
 128 
 
 THE VLKOX TERRITORY. 
 
 I: ^1 ; 
 
 The annexed sketch of the village was taken on the spot. On 
 the right is tlie casine. There are several ordinary winter houses, 
 which are on the brow of a high bank. Caches are scattered 
 about, and stages, on which the kyaks are elevated out of reach 
 of the dogs. In the engraving, the kyaks are represented too 
 mucli curved upwards, lore and aft. They are nearly straight, 
 except at the bow. 
 
 At the left of the houses is a mass of perpendicular timbers, 
 projecting from the ground. This was the dwelling of an old 
 couple, who died in the summer while the other inhabitants were 
 away. Returning from the chase, rather than touch the bodies, 
 they broke down the house over them, and filled it in with earth; 
 a few projecting ujirights are their only monument. 
 
 There is no beach, the cove is shallow and full of rocks, and 
 the skin-boats must be hauled up on ways built for the purpose, 
 of logs. The village is a very dirty one. Travellers are usually 
 detained there by adverse winds. The inhabitants have no 
 reputation for honesty, and it is in every respect the meanest 
 place on the Sound, The principal support of the inhabitants 
 is the seal-fishery, but in the fall reindeer abound in the 
 vicinity. Our young Kaviak started in search of deer, as the 
 weather would not permit of our continuing the voyage. W'e 
 started with a fair breeze about noon, but just as we had got 
 well out of the cove the wind shifted dead ahead, and we had 
 to put back. 
 
 The boat made so much water that I suspected a hole, and un- 
 loaded her. The K;i\iak and New-Years were away, and My- 
 unuk was sick ; so I had an hour's hard work unloading her alone. 
 I called some of the natives who were looking on to help turn 
 her over. As soon as we raised one side the whole frame gave 
 way, and the sides of tlie boat shut together like the leaves of a 
 book ! The sealskin lashings were quite rotted away, and only 
 the weight of the goods had kept her in shape. Mere was a 
 quandary I There was only one bidarni in the village, and she 
 was v^ery small and narrow. She belonged to an old man, who 
 saw his advantage and useil it. After long persuasion I induced 
 him to lend her to mc to take my goods to Unalaklik. He 
 required for her hire an enormous price, more than the l)()at had 
 cost him originally. He demaniled his pay in advance, antl his 
 
 1 I 
 
Mm 
 
 J ■' I ! 
 
 m 
 
'^i 
 
 ; Ml 
 !'' 
 
 h I' 
 ■ 1 
 
 
 
 f::^f 
 
 u 
 
 i 
 
 8 
 
 ii 
 
 I! I; 
 
 ;i : 
 
 VJ !.( 
 
 
 (i 
 
 i 
 
 'I 
 
 ipti 
 
 :/! I 
 
 / 
 
 li i; 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 129 
 
 wife stood by him while I measured out the drill, powder, ball, 
 and tobacco, and, as I gave him the required quantity of each, 
 would exclaim, " It is too little, we must have more ! " I was 
 very much provoked, but there was no way in which I could help 
 myself, and I was obliged to satisfy her avarice, and make her a 
 present besides, while wishing her at the bottom of the sea. I 
 then loaded the boat, but she was so dry that the water came in 
 at all the seams, and I was obliged to unload her again. It was 
 evident that I must leave a large part of my load at the village, 
 and send back for it. I was very loath to do this, as the Kegik- 
 towruk men are notorious thieves ; but there was no help for it. 
 Having picked out the most valuable part of the cargo, including 
 the flour, sugar, tea, lead, and powder, I placed the rest in charge 
 of the old man to whom the boat belonged. I then loaded up for 
 the third time, after greasing the seams with tallow. This day's 
 experience will give a faint idea of the annoyances sometimes 
 endured, and the patience required, in travelling among these 
 natives. 
 
 That afternoon an old acquaintance arrived, — a Mahlemut 
 called Ark-hannok, and his family. His bidarra was so full that 
 he could not take any goods for me, but he promised to send back 
 his men and boat from Unalakli'k, to fetch the goods I left behind. 
 In the evening the absent Kdviak returned with two haunches of 
 venison on his back, having killed a deer. We had a good supper 
 off them, and retired early. The next morning I rose at four 
 o'clock and found the wind fair. We boiled the chynik and 
 took a hasty breakfast, getting off about six. Our boat was very 
 low, her gunwale amidships being only four inches above the 
 water. She was so narrow and crank that we were obliged to 
 lash a kyak alongside with two oars, as an outrigger. Even then 
 the Innuit were unwilling to sail from point to point, but insisted 
 on hugging the shore. 
 
 The wind was light, and we only reached Golsova River by 
 noon. We rounded Tolstoi Point with a fair breeze. At To- 
 panika we landed, and found a Mahlemut chief, called Ark-na-py- 
 ak, camped with his family. Here we drank tea, and took on 
 board a lad about twelve years old, whom we had named Tommy 
 the previous year. He wished to go to Unalakli'k, and to oblige 
 th natives I ofiered him a i)assage. We started about three 
 
 ii 
 
 n 
 
 '''If 
 
 ' ! 'I 
 
 : 
 
 1 ■* 
 
 \ 1 1 
 
 ■It 
 
vi r 
 
 
 
 ; I: '. (I 
 
 ' '' I r 
 , I 
 
 ^ r !r 
 
 I r 
 
 
 
 III' 
 
 I; 
 I 
 
 i;o 
 
 THE YUKOxN TERRITORY. 
 
 o'clock, with a strong breeze from the southwest, wind coming;' in 
 pufts with intervals. The water was perfectly smooth, and we 
 sailed finely for some time. The wind grew stronger rapidly, and 
 soon raised a sea which made me anxious. The tide was high, 
 and the perpendicular sandstone blufts rose direct from the 
 water, the narrow beach being covered. There was no oppor- 
 tunity for landing until the bluffs were passed. The waves began 
 to don their white caps, and occasionally tossed a handful of spray 
 in our faces, as a foretaste of what was coming. I resigned the 
 steering-paddle into the more experienced hands of old New- 
 Years, and stood by him with another, in case that should break. 
 I distributed tin cups to all hands, as I knew we should have to 
 use them very soon in bailing. 
 
 The end of the bluffs was passed, but to my dismay I saw the 
 long low beach piled with driftwood, forming an impenetrable 
 clicvaux-dc-frisc at high-water mark. Against it the waves were 
 dashing. There was no choice but to go on. It was rapidly 
 growing dark, but the mouth of the river was discernible. We 
 managed, by constant bailing, to keep her free, though every tenth 
 wave would throw in a dozen bucketfuls. The worst was yet to 
 come. I knew that the sea would be breaking on the bar at the 
 mouth of the Unalaklik River, where there is seldom over five 
 feet of water. The only question was, could we pass through that 
 line of breakers in safety .' I hardly dared to hope we could. 
 We already heard them roaring on the bar, and could see their 
 white caps dimly. We were all so thoroughly drenched that we 
 could be no wetter. The old Mahlemut never flinched. With 
 his eye on the breakers, as we drew nearer and nearer, he sat 
 silent and rigid as a carved image. The younger men crouched 
 in the bottom of the boat. The little ICskimo lad looked fright- 
 ened, but did not stop bailing for a moment. I threw off my 
 hunting-shirt, and made ready for swimming. As we were just 
 upon the breakers I glanced at the steersman. He moved not a 
 muscle of his weather-beaten face. The next moment a crash 
 announced that our outriggers were broken. I threw myself 
 upon the kyak and, with the young Kaviak, held it for a moment 
 in place. The crest of the advancing roller struck us on the 
 stern, deluging us with water, and before I had time to realize it 
 another followed it, almost burying us ; and for a second I thought 
 
i 
 
f< 
 
 MM 
 
 './! 
 
 / 
 
 t 
 
 i 
 
 ■! 1 
 
 ( 
 
 1 
 
 
 11 : 
 
 1 
 
 i 
 
 1 i 
 ■ 
 
 ,/ 
 
 id 
 
THK YUKOX TERRITORY. 
 
 I.^I 
 
 we were going down. She rose again, however, more than half 
 filled ; and shaking the water out of his scanty hair, the old man 
 said calmly, " Here is the river, t.i^re is the fort." We were in 
 smooth water. The last breaker had carried us over the bar. 
 
 All hands bailed for dear life, and as soon as we had freed the 
 boat from a dangerous amount of watei" we pulled for the shore. 
 Here we found ice, and were obliged to pull half a mile to find 
 a landing-place. The Innuit shouted at the top of their lungs, 
 and wc were soon answered. Eskimo of all ages and both 
 sexes came out from their dens, helped to haul up the boat, and 
 unloaded her above high-water mark. I expected to find the 
 flour and sugar, which were in bags, entirely spoiled. Popoff, the 
 Unalakli'k bidarshik, finally awoke, and opened the gates. With 
 the help of the natives, I carried the goods into the storehouse, 
 dismissed the men, who took refuge with their friends in the 
 village, and, quite exhausted, followed Popoff into the casarmer. 
 Here I stripped off my clothes. I had literally not a dry stitch 
 on me, and there was about a gallon of salt water in each boot. 
 P()poff kindly supplied me with dry clothing, and we sat down 
 around the hospitable samovar. I dare not say how many cups of 
 fragrant tea I disposed of. I know the last was well among tlic 
 " teens." The bed was only a plank and a blanket, but, with a 
 tobacco-box under my head, I lost myself in a well-earned slumber. 
 
 The next day, thanks to the tea, I arose as fresh as ever, though 
 not until nearly noon. My first act was to overhaul the goods. 
 The tea I had taken the precaution to solder up in an empty tin 
 before leaving the Redoubt. The powder was in tight cans. 
 The lead of course was not injured by wetting. The flour, to my 
 surprise, was but slightly wet. Water does not easily penetrate 
 flour in the bags. Our clothes, except what were in tight seal- 
 skin bags, and our blankets, were soaked. The sugar had sutilercd 
 most. About half of it was well salted. This was a serious loss, 
 but might be partly made good. Altogether we got off much 
 better than I had dared to anticipate. 
 
 Popoff, another Russian named Ostrofskoi, two native work- 
 men, and a Creole \ jman comprised the entire garrison at the 
 fort. Popoff was a much pleasanter fellow than most of the 
 Russians, and I got along with him very well. The village con- 
 tained very few natives, most of them being still absent hunting 
 
 '' '::i 
 
 •I i 
 
 I'i 
 
■1 $1 
 
 132 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 
 deer. The next day I secured Ark-hannok's bidarra, and de- 
 spatched it with a crew of five to fetch the remaining goods from 
 Kegiktowruk. On the night of October ist they returned, to 
 my surprise, with their load. The ras( als at Kegiktowruk had 
 stolen some thirty pounds of backfat and a hatchet. The re- 
 mainder of the goods were safe. 
 
 The weather continued warm and rainy. A few days cleared 
 the ice completely out of tlie river. I therefore made immediate 
 arrangements for taking the heavy goods by water to Ulukuk, thus 
 saving time, and transportation over a very bad portage in winter. 
 
 On the 3d of October I took three men and the Kegiktowruk 
 bidarra, and started up the Unalaklik River. We found the cur- 
 rent very strong and the water low. We drew, loaded, a foot and 
 a half, finding occasional difficulty in crossing the sandbars. 
 
 
 i ' ; if 
 
 Ingalik grave. 
 
 '■ ii 
 
 Ulukuk, in a straight line, is only thirty-three miles from Unala- 
 klik. Hy the river, which is more winding than the ancient 
 Meander, it is at least double the distance, and probably more. 
 On the mornii.g of the 4th we reached Iktigalik. Here we 
 found many of the Ingaliks. They wanted to go up in my boat 
 to Ulukuk, and attempted to detain me by all sorts of contradic- 
 tory stories about the river. I had had some experience in estimat- 
 ing the value of such talk, and pushed on. Every night new ice 
 formed in the river, and I used all my energy in travelling, in 
 order that we might not be caught and froz 1 in. On the morn- 
 ing of the 6th we arrived at Ulukuk. As we drew near we heard 
 a low wailing chant, and Mikala, one of my men, informed me 
 that it was women lamenting for the dead. On landing I saw 
 } vcral Indians hewing out the box in which the dead are placed. 
 
 ti 
 a I 
 
 lai 
 ro 
 fill 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 '33 
 
 On inquiry I found that our old acquaintance of the previous 
 year, " Kaltag Stareelc," had gone to his long home. He had been 
 for many years the " oldest inhabitant," and was much respected 
 by the Russians. The body lay on its side in a deerskin. The 
 heels were lashed to the small of the back, and the head bent for- 
 ward on the chest, so that his coffin needed to be only about four 
 feet long. 
 
 We lost no time in putting the goods into an empty cache, 
 covering them with walrus hide, and nailing up the door. During 
 a long experience I have never known of goods being meddled 
 with or broken open if properly secured, no matter how lonely the 
 situation of the cache, or how long it remained unvisited. " A 
 cache is sacred " is one of the axioms of the wilderness. This 
 goes far to prove that the average of honesty among these In- 
 dians is higher than that which obtains among white men. The 
 Innuit, as at Kegiktowruk, are occasionally less trustworthy. 
 
 The Ingaliks had just returned from a bear hunt. Bears are 
 not uncommon in this part of the territory. There are three 
 species : The large brown bear of the mountains, known as the 
 "grizzly" among the Hudson Bay voyageurs ; the barren-ground 
 bear {Ursiis Richanisonii oi Mayne Reid), .vhich is confined in Rus- 
 sian America to the extreme northeast ; and the black bear, which 
 frequents the vicinity of the Yukon, iu the wooded district only. 
 The polar or white bear is found orily in the vicinity of Bering 
 Strait, on the shores of the Arctij Ocean, and on St. Matthew's 
 Island in Bering Sea. It has probably reached the latter locality 
 on floating ice ; we only know of its existence there from whalers, 
 who apply the name of Be."r Island to the locality, from the abun- 
 dance of these animals. We know that it is not found on the 
 mainland south of latitude 65°. The cubs of the black bear are of 
 the same color as the parent, and the adult is very much smaller 
 than its brown cousin, which sometimes reaches a length of nine 
 feet, with a girth nearly as great. The brown bear, or grizzly, is 
 the only one which manifests any ferocity, and it always avoids 
 any contest unless brought to bay. 
 
 The manner of hunting it is as follows. After discovering its 
 lair the natives carefully measure the opening. Timbers of the 
 requisite length, and from four to six inches in diameter, are care- 
 fully cut, and carried to the vicinity. During the day, when the 
 
 i! ' 
 
 4. 
 
 
 <:-: 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 bear is known to have returned to the cave, the Indians collect 
 in large numbers, and approach with the utmost quietness, each 
 carrying a timber or a large stone. The timbers are then fitted 
 into the mouth of the den, forming a barricade, and stones in 
 large numbers are piled up against them, only leaving an open- 
 ing about a foot square. Burning brands are then thrown in to 
 arouse the animal, who puts his head out of the opening, which is 
 too small for egress. A volley of balls soon puts an end to his 
 existence. After satisfying themselves of his death, the hunters 
 remove the barricade, and divide the body among themselves. 
 The skin is valuable only as a rug or bed, or to hang in the 
 doorway of a lodge to exclude the cold. 
 
 The Indians were an.xious that I should pass the night at 
 Uliikuk; but, fearful of being frozen in, I decided to return with- 
 out delay. Coming up, while examining the rocks I discovered 
 a fossil elephant tusk about eight feet long on one of the bars 
 in the river. I put it up on end in order to see it and take it 
 with me on my return. A snow-storm came on, which obscured 
 everything, so that we passed down without seeing it, and 
 arrived at Ikti'galik about seven in the evening. The next morn- 
 ing we left Ikti'galik about nine o'clock, and half-way down came 
 upon the three-holed bidarka which Kurilla and his companions 
 had left on the shore when they struck across the summer port- 
 age. I thought it might prove useful, and took it aboard. 
 About two o'clock we arrived at Unalaklik, just in time to enjoy 
 a steam bath. While I had been absent some I*2skimo from Kot- 
 zebue Sound had arrived, bringing alcohol, purchased from the 
 traders. 
 
 The whole village was in a turmoil, and the Russians at the 
 fort in no little alarm, anticipating an attack. Some natives 
 having reported a remarkable and unknown object as cast upon 
 the beach, Popoffand myself walked four or five miles to examine 
 it. It proved to be the carcass of a walrus deprived of its head. 
 These animals, as well as wliales, are unknown in Norton Sound, 
 and this carcass had probably been driven by the wind and sea 
 from the north. 
 
 On the 9th of October I had the bidarka repaired and well 
 oiled. The next day, with Tommy, Johnny and a Kaviak, I 
 started for Topanika, to examine the geological character of the 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 135 
 
 in 
 
 ho 
 
 111 
 I 
 
 shore. At night we arrived at a creek where an old Mahlemut 
 chief, Allu-iokan, and his people were camped. Here I purchased 
 some deer meat and a large number of tongues. 
 
 The next morning the Innuit left us for Unalaklik. Johnny 
 and Tommy started into the interior in search of deer. Taking 
 my haversack, I proceeded to Tolstoi Point, examining the rocks, 
 and taking notes of the character, thickness, and dip of the 
 strata. I found no fossils except indistinct vegetable remains. 
 Climbing the bluff, I followed the edge of a deep ravine inland 
 for half a mile. I'eeling thirsty, I managed to swing myself down 
 the precipitous sides, by the birches which grew sparingly in 
 riits of the rock. Here I found a stream of pure cold water, and, 
 bending down to drink, some fine fossils attracted my attention. 
 Securing a bundle of about fifty pounds' weight, I had a piece of 
 hard work packing them on my back out of the ravine. I was 
 obliged to walk in the bed of the stream, as the sides were 
 too abrupt to ascend with my load. I finally arrived at camp, 
 after dark, and pretty tired. No one was there, and I built 
 a large fire, fearing that Johnny might be unable to return 
 in the obscurity over the rough and broken hills. The boys 
 arrived at last, having killed two deer, bringing, however, only 
 the tongues and kiilneys. I rated them well for the folly of de- 
 stroying game which they could not use or bring home. Econ- 
 omy in such matters is incomprehensible to the native mind. 
 They are always ready to destroy life even if they cannot avail 
 themselves of the remains. 
 
 The next day, having completed my observations, I availed 
 myself of an invitation to take passage for Unalaklik in a 
 passing Mahlemut bidarra. I occupied myself for several days 
 in purchasing articles which I had found from experience were 
 necessary or useful in the interior. These were principally 
 h'skimo winter boots, of deerskin with sealskin solos ; deerskin 
 mittens, parkies, and breeches, some destined for the ethnological 
 collection, and others for use ; boot-soles, to replace old ones 
 when worn out ; deer sinew, for sewing skin tlMihing ; fine seal- 
 skin line, for lashing sleds, bidarra-frames, dog-liarness, and boot- 
 strings ; mahout, or walrus hide cut in long strips, for tracking- 
 line ; prepareil sealskin, for meniling boats ; oil, for lamps in 
 winter ; ukali, by the thousand, for dog and man feed ; the white 
 
136 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Mil 
 
 111 
 
 bellies of the deer, with dried fish skins and wolverine skins, for 
 trimming skin clothes ; and the backfat of the reindeer, to supply 
 the total absence of pork, bacon, and butter. 
 
 The reindeer, in summer, is furnished with a broad layer of 
 fat, between the muscle and the skin, along the back from the 
 shoulder to the haunch. This layer comes off in a single piece 
 fifteen inches broad and from half an inch to four inches thick. 
 This is called the " backfat." Other fat in smaller quantity is 
 procured from the vicinity of the kidneys, the omentum, and the 
 intestines. A little is also procured with the marrow, by pound- 
 ing and boiling the bones. All this in its dried state is liable to 
 spoil. Anticipating this, I had all my fat cut, pounded up, and 
 tried out. When thoroughly extracted, I poured the pure fat into 
 empty tin cans, thus preserving it from injury and rendering it 
 compact for transportation. The Hudson Bay pemmican is made 
 by pounding dry meat between stones, until all the meat is re- 
 duced to powder. The sinews and gristle are picked out, and the 
 rest is mi.\ed with boiling fat and poured into a rawhide bag, 
 where it becomes perfectly solid. Pemmican is unknown to the 
 Russians, whose chief dependence is fish. Indeed, I do not know 
 of any part of Russian America where meat and fat abound in 
 sufficient quantities to be much used in this way. Pemmican is 
 tasteless, unappetizing food, but contains much nourishment in a 
 very compact form. 
 
 I have hitherto deferred any minute account of the Innuit of 
 Norton Sound, preferring to give my own impression of them 
 unafiectcd by that of other observers. During the time spent at 
 Unalakli'k I became moderately proficient in their language, and 
 studied their mode of life with great care. 
 
 The Innuit, as they call themselves, belong to the same family 
 as the Northern and Western Eskimo. I have frequently u.sed 
 the term Eskimo in referring to them, but they are in many 
 respects very difierent people from the typical tribes called l)y 
 that name in the works of Parry, Ross, Simpson, Kane, and 
 other arctic explorers. Comparative vocabularies and an analy- 
 sis of the different branches of the family will be found elsewhere 
 in this volume. The present remarks refer more particularly to 
 their mode of life. 
 
 It should be thoroughly and definitely understood, in the first 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ^2>7 
 
 place, that they are not Indians ; nor have they any known rela- 
 tion, physically, philologically, or otherwise, to the Indian tribes 
 of North America. Their grammar, appearance, habits, and even 
 their anatomy, especially in the form of the skull, separate them 
 widely from the Indian race. On the other hand, it is almost 
 equally questionable whether they are even distinctly related to 
 the Chukchees and other probably Mongolian races, of the east- 
 ern part of Siberia. This is discussed elsewhere. 
 
 The Innuit of Norton Sound and the vicinity are of three 
 tribes, each of which, while migrating at certain seasons, has 
 its own peculiar territory. The peninsula between Kotzebue and 
 Norton Sounds is inhabited by the Kdviaks or Kavidganut Innuit. 
 The neck of this peninsula is occupied by the Mdhlcmut Innuit. 
 The shore of Norton Sound south of Cape Denbigh to Pastolik 
 is the country of the Unaleets or Unalignmt Innuit. The habits 
 of these tribes are essentially similar. They are in every respect 
 superior to any tribe of Indians with which I am acquainted. 
 
 Their complexion I have described as brunette. The effect of 
 the sun and wind, especially in summer, is to darken their hue, 
 and from observing those who lived in the fort, I am inclined to 
 think that a regular course of bathing would do much toward 
 whitening them. They are sometimes very tall ; I have often 
 seen both men and women nearly si.x feet in height, and have 
 known several instances where men were taller. Their aver- 
 age height equals that of most civilized races. Their strength 
 is often very great. I have seen a Mahlemut take a hundred- 
 pound sack of flour under each arm, and another in his teeth, 
 and walk with them from the storehouse to the boat, a distance 
 of some twenty rods, without inconvenience. They are fond of 
 e.xercise, and practise many athletic games, such as football or 
 a similar game, tossing in a blanket or rather walrus hide, run- 
 ning races, hurling stones or lances, lifting weights, and wrestling. 
 Tlieir boats — the kyak or bidarka, and oomiak or bidarrd — have 
 been already described. It may be mentioned in this connection 
 that the oomiak is not considered among the Norton Sound Innuit 
 as a "women's boat," nor is there ever any hesitation about men's 
 using them. In this they differ from the ICskimo as described by 
 arctic explorers. It is notieeal)le that the more northern the canoe, 
 the smaller it is made. The kyak of Nunivak Island is double the 
 
 \ 
 
 1 1 
 
 ! 
 
 ii i 
 

 Mi 
 
 a ' 
 
 ^ IK 
 
 < Wi' 
 
 
 
 
 \\ 5; 
 
 1 
 
 t 
 
 
 
 1 
 
 1 
 
 III 
 
 / 
 
 ! ;: ^ 
 
 
 1 ',; 
 
 
 1 '^ 
 
 
 1 ' 
 
 
 
 
 i' 
 
 
 
 
 K. 
 
 1 
 
 It 
 
 i.^>8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 size of those used in Bering Strait. Tlie l<yaks are often orna- 
 mented with beluga teeth, or carved pieces of walrus ivory, 
 imitations of birds, walrus, or seal. The prow is also fashioned 
 into the semblance of a bird's or fish's head. Securely seated in 
 his kyak, with a gut shirt strongly tied around the edge of the hole, 
 the Innuit is at home. He will even turn over his kyak and come 
 up on the other side, by skilful use of his 2)addle. 
 
 Aziak or Sledge Island is an abrupt rock rising out of the 
 water, with a landing only at low tide in good weather. I was 
 informed by the captain of a trader, a trustworthy person, that 
 he once approached the island to trade, in rough weather, but 
 could not send a boat ashore, as it was impossible to land. He 
 lay as close as he dared under the lee of the island. Here they 
 saw the Innuit tying several men securely into their kyaks, on the 
 top of the rock, some fifteen or twenty feet above the water. 
 When all was done each man grasped his double-ended paddle, 
 and two others took the kyak by bow and stern and tossed it, 
 with its occupant, into the water. For a moment they disappeared 
 under the waves, but instantly rose and righted themselves ; in a 
 few minutes they were alongside, and being taken on board, pro- 
 duced furs and ivory from their kyaks, with which they proceeded 
 to trade for tobacco and other articles. When the tide and wind 
 fell they returned to the island. This is an excellent illustration 
 of the wonderful skill with which they learn to manage these little 
 canoes. In his kyak the Innuit docs not hesitate to attack the 
 seal, walrus, or whale. Those of Norton Sound have only the 
 seal and beluga, but those of Bering Strait have abundant oppor- 
 tunities for hunting the bowhead and walrus. 
 
 They are good-humored and careless, slow to anger, and usually 
 ready to forgive and forget. They are sometimes revengeful ; and 
 murders, generally the result of jealousy, are not very rare. The 
 women are modest, but a want of chastity in an unmarried female 
 is hardly looked upon as a fault. Taking this fact into consider- 
 ation, they are rather free from immorality. Among the Mahle- 
 muts, cousins, however remote, do not marry, and one wife is the 
 rule. Among the Kaviaks, incest is not uncommon, and two or 
 three wives, often sisters, are taken by those who can afford to 
 support them. These people have become demoralized by trad- 
 ing liquor for their furs, and wide-spread immorality is the result. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 139 
 
 The same is also true of the Kotzebue Sound Mahlemuts. What 
 we should call immodesty is often undeserving of such a term. 
 Where a practice is universal there is nothing immodest in it, and 
 it may be quite consistent with morality. For instance, the Aleu- 
 tians, men and women, for ages have been accustomed to bathe 
 toi;ether in the sea. They do not think of there being any im- 
 modesty in it, yet any immorality is exceedingly rare among 
 them. Hence we should not judge these people too harshly. 
 
 There is no ceremony connected with marriage among the 
 Innuit, though presents are often made to the bride's parents. 
 Intermarriage between natives of diflerent tribes is frequent. If 
 ill-behaved or barren, the wife is frequently sent away, and another 
 takes her place. Children are greatly prized, if boys. Girls are 
 at a discount. Infanticide is common among them, both before 
 and after birth. As an excuse, they say that they do not want 
 and cannot support so many daughters. Other women do not 
 like the trouble and care of children, and destroy them for that 
 reason. The usual method is to take the child out, stuff its mouth 
 with grass, and desert it. I have seen several children who had 
 been picked up in this condition, and brought up by others than 
 their parents. The women alone destroy children, but the men 
 seldom punish them for it, and doubtless acquiesce in advance in 
 most cases. Sometimes we find females who refuse to accept 
 husbands, preferring to adopt masculine manners, following the 
 deer on the mountains, trapping and fishing for themselves. 
 
 The men treat their wives and children well. The latter are 
 never punished, and seldom need correction, being obedient and 
 good-humored. The men have their own work. Hunting the 
 deer and seal, building and repairing the winter houses, making 
 frames for boats, sleds, and snow-shoes, preparing sealskins for use 
 (in boats or for boot-soles, trapping, and bringing home the results 
 of the chase, — in fact, all severe labor, — is performed by the 
 men. Snaring partridges, drying and preparing fish, cutting up 
 the meat when brought into camp, picking berries, dressing deer- 
 skins and making clothing, cooking, and taking care of the chil- 
 dren, — these are solely feminine pursuits. Both sexes join in pad- 
 dling the oomiaks, celebrating their annual dances, bringing and 
 cutting wood, and other work of a like nature. The women are 
 seldom beaten, except for ill-temper or incontinency. They keep 
 
 Ji C i-.ii 
 
 .':& 
 
 r. 
 
it 
 
 I 
 
 li 
 
 I'; 
 
 h 
 
 \ 
 
 II 
 
 
 ' ) 
 
 I 
 
 III 
 
 !: 
 
 I 1i 
 
 140 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 their persons moderately clean, braiding the hair on each side, 
 and twisting beads or strips of wolfskin in with the braids for 
 ornament. They are often of pleasing appearance, sometimes 
 quite pretty. They preserve their beauty much longer than In- 
 dian women. Their clear complexion and high color, with their 
 good-humor, make them agreeable companions, and they are often 
 very intelligent. A noticeable feature is their teeth. These are 
 always sound and white, but are almost cylindrical, and in old 
 people are worn down even with the gums, producing a singu- 
 lar appearance. The eyes are not oblique, as in the Mongolian 
 races, but are small, black, and almost even with the face. The 
 nose is flat and disproportionally small. Many of the Innuit 
 have heavy beards and mustaches, while some pull out the 
 former. The men all wear the labrets, but 
 do not tattoo. The women generally have 
 a few lines tattooed on the chin, from the 
 lower lip downward. The inhabitants of the 
 Diomede Islands tattoo extensively ; they also 
 wear large labrets made of hypochlorite and 
 finely polished. The tattooing is in spiral 
 lines and waving scrolls, seldom or never rep- 
 resenting objects. The Norton Sound Innuit 
 women never wear labrets,* but occasionally 
 pierce the nose and ears. I have never seen any ornament 
 worn in the nose, but ear-rings are not uncommon. The fol- 
 lowing sketch represents the usual form. They are carved 
 from beluga teeth. Among the Mdgantiis, a tribe to the 
 south of the Yukon-mouth, the women wear a 
 peculiar labrct. It is flat and curved, like a bent 
 nail, with a broad head, which goes inside the 
 mouth, and prevents the labret from slipping 
 through. They are slightly carved, and orna- 
 mented with dots and lines. The holes are 
 pierced through the front of the lower lip and 
 close together, not under the corners of the mouth, as among the 
 men. The curved ends stick out like little horns. 
 
 In Norton Sound the holes for the labrets are not always pierced 
 
 * The figure represents : A, the Magenuit female labret ; u, C, the Okeeogemut ; the 
 rest are Norton Sound labrets of clitTcrent patterns. 
 
 Labrets. 
 
 Ear-rings. 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 141 
 
 in youth. Whenever the act is performed a feast is given, and 
 the holes are made by means of an awl, with great solemnity. 
 This would indicate that originally the practice had some greater 
 significance than mere ornament. It is now impossible to dis- 
 cover what that significance might have been. At first a mere 
 ivory peg is inserted (f, g) with a hole in which a small wooden 
 peg is put to keep it in place. After the opening has healed, 
 others a little larger are inserted, and so on, until the hole 
 will admit a peg of the full size, and shaped more like a but- 
 ton or stud (n, e). Ornaments carved from beluga teeth are 
 commonly worn. They represent fig- 
 ures of men, animals, or fish. These 
 are some of them, representing a flat- 
 fish, goose, and seal. Walrus teeth, ob- 
 tained by barter, are also used in carv- 
 
 ing- 
 
 Amulets. 
 
 The dress of the men has already 
 been described. It reaches to the mid- 
 dle of the thigh, and is cut around 
 nearly or quite straight. The female 
 dress, on the other hand, is continued in two rounded flaps 
 below the knees, before and behind. They are trimmed with 
 strips of white deerskin with the hair cut short, separated by 
 narrow strips of dried fishskin and edged with strips of wolverine 
 or wolf skin, so cut that the long hair makes a fringe. The hood 
 is trimmed with a broad piece of wolfskin, with frequently a 
 strip of the white skin of the arctic hare inside for warmth. 
 The whole effect is very pretty, especially when the parka is 
 made of the tame Siberian reindeer skin, which is mottled with 
 white and delicate .shades of brown. The fishskin referred to, 
 when prepared for use, looks like brown marbled paper. It has 
 no scales, and I have not seen the fish from which it is taken. 
 
 The women wear breeches and boots made in one piece, while 
 the men use deerskin socks, and boots which are not sewed on 
 to the breeches. All use a belt of some kind. The favorite 
 belt among the women is made of the portion of the lower jaw 
 of the reindeer which contains the front teeth. This piece of bone 
 is very small, — I have counted the teeth of one hundred and fifty 
 deer in one belt, — and these belts are not uncommon. They 
 
 irv 
 
 .11. 
 
 if 
 
M 
 
 i 
 
 I ■! 
 
 A' 
 
 
 m 
 
 W 
 
 i! ' 
 
 ! 
 
 i«l 
 
 11*, M 
 
 u ■ : I' 'I 
 
 / 
 
 
 142 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 are sewed on a broad strip of leather, fastened with a large 
 button or bead in front. From the belt hangs the needle-case, 
 usually made of the humerus of a swan, plugged at one end and 
 
 lione neudle-case. 
 
 having a removable stopper at the other. It is usually orna- 
 mented with black lines, as in the above example. 
 
 A mans wealth is frequently estimated by parkies. They will 
 buy, with their surplus property, large numbers of parkies. Ten 
 deerskin, or two mink parkies, or one sable parka, are equivalent 
 to a gun. Sealskins, sables, guns, and ammunition are also units 
 of value. They can count up to a hundred, and some of the 
 more intelligent to five hundred. They frequently keep accounts 
 by tying knots in a string or notching a stick. They divide the 
 year by the seasons, and time by lunar months id days. They 
 can also estimate with much accuracy how much of the day has 
 passed, by the position of the sun or stars. They are very quick 
 at understanding, and can draw very reliable maps, the only 
 difficulty being that far-off distances are exaggerated when 
 compared with those laid down as nearer their homes. They 
 are all provided with flint and steel for lighting fires, but formerly 
 used a different apparatus on the principle of a fiddle-bow drill. 
 This consisted of a mouthpiece of bone or ivory with a small hol- 
 low in it, a flat piece of very dry soft wood, a pencil-shaped 
 piece of dry hard wood, and a bow with a slackened string. One 
 
 end of the pencil fitted into the hollow 
 ~^' in the mouthpiece. The latter is held 
 
 between the teeth. A turn of the bow- 
 string was taken around the pencil ; the 
 tablet of soft wood was held in the left 
 hand. The pencil was held firmly against 
 the tablet and the bow rapidly moved 
 back and forth by the right hand. The 
 pencil of course revolved rapidly, the fric- 
 tion created a small pile of dust on the 
 tablet, which was quickly ignited by the heat. A piece of tinder 
 preserved the light, and the fire was obtained. 
 
 Inmiit fire-drill. 
 
 W 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 '43 
 
 Piljulka. 
 
 Formerly bows, arrows, and lances were their weapons. In 
 Norton Sound they are now supplanted by guns obtained from 
 the traders. Iron was unknown among these natives two genera- 
 tions ago. i^VU their weapons were of ivory, bone, and slate, 
 except a few native copper implements which came from the 
 Indians of the interior. In early times, the old men say, a knife 
 or a string of beads was worth fifty marten skin.s. A peculiar 
 kind of knife, shaped like a chopping-knife and called a pignlka, 
 is used in cutting skins. It is made of sheet-iron and has a bone 
 handle. It is preferable to scissors in cutting furs, as it only cuts 
 the skin and not the hair. 
 
 To this day the Innuit have no knowledge of working iron by 
 means of heat, although with the aid of a file they 
 will make quite useful knives, saws, and other 
 articles, out of scraps of old sheet or hoop iron. 
 While the ancient Indians made their cutting 
 instruments and tools of stone or native copper, 
 the ancient Innuit substituted, in many cases, 
 bone and ivory. Stone arrowheads, formerly the universal 
 weapons among the Tinneh, are now rarely to be found On 
 the other hand, the ivory weapons of the Innuit are still in 
 use. The Indian discarded the stone arrowhead entirely, for one 
 of iron ; the Innuit retains the ivory head, merely adding to it a 
 tip of iron. The Indian leaves the bow to the children; the more 
 aquatic Innuit finds a gun out of place in his kyak, and still uses 
 the weapon of his ancestors to hunt the seal. Ashore, his weapon 
 is usually a gun. The guns most common among them are very 
 light double-barrelled Belgian fowling-pieces, with an average 
 bore of twenty-eight or thirty. These are obtained frf)m the 
 Kotzebue Sound and Grantley Harbor traders. South of Norton 
 Sound the Innuit are provided with very few guns, and the.se are 
 mostly long Hud.son Bay flintlocks, obtained by trading with the 
 Tinneh tribes of the interior. 
 
 Trading is carried on to a large extent between the Indians 
 and Innuit. The former sell their wooden dishes and other 
 household articles, furs, wolf and wolverine skins, to the latter for 
 oil, sealskins, seal and walrus line, and articles obtained by the 
 Innuit from the traders. The Innuit again trade beaver skins, 
 wooden dishes, and other articles of wood to the Tuski and other 
 
 ); ! i 
 
 M- 
 
 ..I 
 
 ■k 
 
 I 
 
.1' 
 
 
 
 'I 
 
 .t 
 
 j 
 
 <■? 
 
 Ui 
 
 1 I 
 
 ; ^ 
 
 ii: 
 
 144 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 tribes of Boring Strait, in exchange for walrus ivory and skins of 
 the tame Siberian reindeer, which the latter obtain from the 
 Chukchees. In this way a commerce is constantly carried on 
 between the interior tribes of America and Siberia, by means of 
 the Innuit, who act as middle-men. The bitter enmity and con- 
 stant hostility which are found between the northern and western 
 I'.skimo and the Indians do not exist between the latter and the 
 Innuit of the western and southwestern coast. It is true that 
 both exhibit great jealousy in regard to their boundary lines. 
 These lines are generally formed by the summit of the watershed 
 between the small rivers which empty into the sea and those 
 which fall into the Yukon. They coincide nearly with the line 
 of the wooded district to which the Indians are confined. Any 
 man of either race found on the wrong side of the line is liable to 
 be shot at sight, and deaths occur every season from this cause. 
 Nevertheless, a tacit arrangement exists between adjoining tribes 
 of the two races, so that an Innuit who kills a deer on Indian ter- 
 ritory may retain the meat, provided he leaves the skin at the 
 nearest Indian village. The Indians cross the Uliikuk portage 
 every winter, and trade at Unalakli'k with the Innuit. The latter 
 cross the Anvik portage at the same season, and trade with the 
 Yukon Ingaliks. Great caution is used by both while in foreign 
 territory, and nearly every year a panic occurs on the coast or in 
 the interior, from some rumor that the hostile race are preparing 
 for invasion and war. 
 
 The Indians call the Innuit and Eskimo Uskcc'mi, or sorcerers. 
 Kagiiskcnni is the Innuit name for the casines in which their 
 shamans perform their superstitious rites. From this root comes 
 the word Eskimo. The belief in shamanism is much the same 
 among the Innuit as that which is entertained among the In- 
 dians, but the rites of the Innuit shamans differ in the manner 
 of performance from those of the other race, and very much from 
 those of the Chukchees and other inland races of Siberia. 
 
 A Mahlemut .shaman covers his head and the upper part of his 
 body with a kamlayka. He holds a wand, often of ivory, in each 
 hand, and beats on the floor of the casine, keeping time with a 
 monotonous chorus. When the frenzy seizes him he rolls on the 
 floor in violent convulsions. His body and face are concealed 
 beneath the kamlayka, which rustles violently with his motions, 
 
 6 
 
 n 
 b 
 it 
 h 
 
 is 
 cl 
 of 
 
 pr 
 sai 
 a 1 
 Tl 
 
 tht 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 145 
 
 ir 
 
 while all watch anxiously for any words which may escape him 
 during the fit. Such are regarded as omens of deep significance, 
 and the hearers are implicitly guided by them. 
 
 The totemic system is not found among the Innuit. K;ich boy, 
 when arrived at the age of puberty, selects an animal, fish, or bird, 
 which he adopts as a patron. The spirit which looks after the 
 animals of that species is supposed to act henceforth as his guar- 
 dian. Sometimes the animal is selected in early childhood by 
 the parents. If he has long-continued want of success in his 
 pursuits, he will sometimes change his patron. They do not ab- 
 stain from eating or using the flesh and skin of the animal which 
 they have chosen, as do some tribes of Indians. They always 
 wear a piece of the skin or a bone of that animal, which they 
 regard as an amulet, and use every precaution against its loss, 
 which would be regarded as a grave calamity. When desiring 
 assistance or advice they do not themselves seek it, but employ 
 a shaman to address their patron spirit. These customs do not 
 extend to females. The spirits of the deer, seal, salmon, and be- 
 luga, are regarded by all with special veneration ; as to these 
 animals they owe their support. Each has its season, and while 
 hunting, it is almost impossible to induce them to attempt any 
 other work, as they seem to think each spirit demands exclusive 
 attention while he extends his i'avors. The homes of these spirits 
 are supposed to be in the north. The auroras are the reflections 
 from the lights used during supposed dances of the spirits. Sin- 
 gularly enough, they call the constellation of Ursa Major by the 
 name of Okil-okpuk, signifying Great Bear, and consider him to 
 be ever on the watch while the other spirits carry on their festiv- 
 ities. None of the spirits are regarded as supreme, nor have the 
 Innuit any idea of a deity, a state of future reward and pun- 
 ishment, or any system of morality. Many of them have been 
 christened by the Russian missionaries, but none have any idea 
 of Christianity. 
 
 The dead are enclosed above ground in a box, in the manner 
 previously described. The annexed sketch shows the form of the 
 sarcophagus, which in this case is ornamented with snow-shoes, 
 a reel for seal lines, a fishing-rod, and a wooden dish or kantag. 
 The latter is found ' ith every grave, and usually one is placed in 
 the box with the body. Sometimes a part of the property of the 
 
 . i 
 
 I :i 
 
 10 
 
 ^'J 
 
P0 
 
 
 ;.! 
 
 
 \^-i \ 
 
 W f 
 
 ['■ 
 
 >« 
 
 i 
 
 Siii 
 
 .. 
 
 "it 
 
 146 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Inm.it grave. 
 
 dead person is placed in the coffin or about it. Occasionally the 
 whole is thus disposed of. Generally the furs, provisions, and 
 clothing (except such as has been worn) are divided among the 
 nearer relations ^f the dead, or remain in possession of his 
 
 family if he has one. Such cloth- 
 ing, household utensils, and weap- 
 ons as the deceased had in daily 
 use are almost invariably enclosed 
 in his coffin. If there are many 
 deaths about the same time, or an 
 epidemic occurs, everything belong- 
 ing to the dead is destroyed. The 
 house in which a death occurs is 
 always deserted, and usually de- 
 stroyed. In order to avoid this, it 
 is not uncommon to take the sick 
 person out of the house and put him in a tent to die. 
 
 A woman's coffin may be known by the kettles and other fem- 
 inine utensils about it. There is no distinction between the sc.xes 
 in method of burial. On the outside of the coffin figures arc usu- 
 ally drawn in red ochre. Figures of fur animals indicate that the 
 dead person was a good trapper ; of seal or deer, show his profi- 
 ciency as a hunter ; representations of parkies, that he was 
 wealthy: the manner of his death is also occasionally indicated. 
 For four days after a death the women iit the village do no sew- 
 ing, for five days the men do not cut wood with an a.xe. The 
 relatives of the coad must not seek birds' eggs on the overhanging 
 cliffs for a year, or their feet v. ill slip from under them, and they 
 will be dashed to pieces. No mourning is worn or indicated, ex- 
 cept by cutting the hair. Women sit and watch the body, chant- 
 ing a mournful refrain, unti' "t is interred. They seldom su.spect 
 that others have brought the death about by shamanism, as the 
 Indians almost invariably do. At the end of a year from the 
 death a festival is given, presents are made to those who assisted 
 in making the coffin, and the |)eriod of moiiining is over. Their 
 grief seldom seems deep, but they indulge for a long 1 
 in< 
 
 if for the dead at intervals. I have seen several 
 
 une ni wail- 
 women who 
 
 refused to take a second husband, ami had remained single, in 
 spite of repeated offers, for man}- years. 
 
 ^ 
 
 
 ,1: 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 147 
 
 fem- 
 cxcs 
 usu- 
 
 thc 
 rofi- 
 
 was 
 
 :cd. 
 
 c\v- 
 iTlic 
 
 h.'V 
 
 int- 
 
 the 
 the 
 tc' 
 icir 
 ail- 
 ho 
 , hi 
 
 Their habits are very regular. Every season the same round 
 is gone through as in the previous one, only varied by the differ- 
 ences in temperature and in the prevalence of fish and game. 
 
 In February they leave the villages and repair to the moun- 
 tains, with all their families. They pursue the deer until the 
 snow begins to melt. I am informed that among the Mahlemuts, 
 near their more inland villages, they will not permit any water to 
 be boiled inside of the houses while the deer hunt continues. 
 This is only one of many similar superstitions. The deer are 
 stalked ; noosed in mahout snares, set wh. :••; they are accustomed 
 to run ; or driven into pounds built for the purpose, where they 
 are killed by hunc'reds. Since the introduction of fire-arms, about 
 fifteen years ago, the number of deer has been very greatly 
 diminished. At the same time the bow and arrow have fallen 
 into disuse, and it would be impossible at present for them to 
 obtain sufficient food without guns and ammunition. The Kav- 
 iak peninsula formerly abounded with deer ; at present none are 
 found there. 
 
 When the snow melts and the ice comes out of the small rivers, 
 the lunuit return to their homes. Myriads of water-fowl ar- 
 rive, and breed on the steep cliffs of Besboro' Island, and similar 
 promontories of the coast. About this time the young men 
 .seek for e;;gs and kill the parent i)irds, while the older and more 
 wealthy start for Grantley Hai bor and Kolzebue Sound, where 
 the traders meet them as soon as open water affords ojiportunity. 
 As June arrives, eggs arc more abundant, ;ind form for a while 
 the chief article of diet. (iuUs' eggs are rejected by the women 
 and chil<h'en, who believe that they will grow old and decrtpit if 
 ihey ~at them. .Seal may also be obtained in small nunibers, 
 and immense schools of herring visit the shores, remaining 
 alo'.ii ten days anil then disappearing for the season. 
 
 As Jul^ advances the salnum arrive, and every one is found 
 upon thi: siiore. (iill nets are stretched out from the beach, and 
 tile sands an? red with the fish, si)lit anil iiung up to dry ; dogs 
 and m- n have as much as they can eat, and large supplies of 
 ukali are laid in for winter use. W'hili; the fislu ly lasts no wood 
 must be cut with an a.\e, or the salmon will disappear. Near 
 the end of July a small fleet of iMdarras arrive with those who 
 have been away trading, and a deputation of Tuski or Okee- 
 
 !M 
 
f 1 
 
 1. 1 
 
 ) i '): 
 
 
 til 
 
 
 * 
 
 I 
 
 , 1, 
 
 % 
 
 I'! 
 Ilk 
 
 •! t 
 
 l.i 
 
 |.(': 
 
 148 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ogemuts with walrus ivory, whalebone, and tame reindeer skins 
 for barter. 
 
 In August many of the women repair to the hills, where they 
 hunt the young reindeer fawns. The latter are caught by run- 
 ning after them, or in snares. Their skins are valued for cloth- 
 ing, and make a very pretty light parka. They are of a uniform 
 brownish red, lighter on the belly, and not spotted like the young 
 of the red deer. The skins are nearly valueless until about a 
 month old, and it is hardly necessary to contradict Zagoskin's 
 fables about the unborn young. The latter, I believe, are not 
 eaten by the Innuit ; at least, I have frequently seen them thrown 
 to the dogs. The stomach of the adult deer, filled with half- 
 digested willow-tips, is regarded as a delicacy, and eaten as we 
 do salad. The supply of backfat is also laid in at this season ; 
 later it disappears. 
 
 In September many repair to Pastol Hay and Norton Hay, 
 where they kill the beluga, left in shallows by the tide. The 
 seal fisher}' is at this time in full blast, and the natives will not 
 work on the frames of boats or kyaks. As the cold weather 
 comes on, the rutting season of the deer comes with it, and most 
 of the Iiuiuit repair to the mountains after them. At this season 
 the supplies of deerskins, .sinews, and meat are laid in for the 
 winter. About the middle of October the shores of the Sound are 
 girded with ice. The seal disapjicar, but myriads of a small fish, 
 like tom-cod, are found all along the shores, and are 
 fished for through holes in the ice. The hook is pe- 
 culiar. It is made of a small oval piece of bone with 
 a sharp pin inserted into it diagonally. It is not baited. 
 as the fisli Ijite at the ivory, which is tied on a \vli;ile- 
 bone thread, whose elasticity gives the hook a tremu- 
 lous motion in the water. The sinker is also an oval 
 jiicce of bone or ivory. These little fish are excellent 
 eating, and are caught by thousands at I'nalakli'k. 
 By this time the majority ha\i' returned to the villages, 
 iKi'vh'mk ^iitl trapping commences, The women are at work on 
 ,111(1 sinker \^\^^, wiutcr clothiug, and the season of festivity .sets in. 
 The greater part of November and hall of December is occu- 
 pied by dances anil festivals. About January tlie trade with the 
 Indians commences, and in February tli< y again repair to the 
 
lu- 
 
 Int 
 
 1)11 
 
 M- 
 
 11 c 
 
 lie 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 149 
 
 mountains as before. This gives a sivetcli of tlieir mode of life 
 during the year. The dances and winter festivities deserve more 
 minute description. 
 
 All the Innuit are fond of dancing and singing together. The 
 principal point, in both Innuit and Indian dances, is, to make as 
 many different kinds of motion with the body and arms as pos- 
 sible, always keeping the most exact time with the chorus and 
 with each other. The dances take place in the casine of the vil- 
 lage, and time is kept by a number of old men, who lead the 
 chorus and beat time with an elastic wand on a sort of large 
 tambourine. Their festivals maybe divided into two classes, — 
 one where they meet simply to dance and sing, and the other when 
 there are also other ends in view. In the former the singers con- 
 fine themselves strictly to the chorus " Ung hi yah," &c., which 
 has previously been described. These dances are held whenever 
 a sufficient number happen to meet in the casine and desire it, but 
 always in the evening. The other festivals also take place in the 
 evening, and are of different kinds. Mrst, there is the opening 
 'I'stival of the winter, which differs from all the others. Then 
 there are festivals at which the givers desire to indicate their 
 friendship for each other by making presents in a manner which 
 will he afterwards described. A third kind of festival is given a 
 year after the death of a relation. A fourth, when a wealthy man 
 wishes to make himself the reputation of a public benefactor. A 
 fifth, when a man wishes to redress an injury which he has done 
 to another, and a sixth, when the village unites in inviting the 
 inhabitants of another village to partake of their hospitality. 
 
 The opening festival of the season is usually held early in 
 Xovcmber. No women participate, excci)t as spectators. The in- 
 v.iiiable chorus is begun, and kept u|) until all the young male in- 
 lKii)itants are collected in the casine, As soon as all are present, 
 dishes of charcoal ground up with oil arc lirought in ; all the young 
 men strip themselves and proceed to paint their faces and bodies. 
 \o particular pattern is followed, but each one suits his own fancy. 
 When all are duly adorned thev leave the casine in single file. end- 
 ing with the boys. Attired in Adam's original costume, tln'v visit 
 every house in the village, chanting as they go. luich family has 
 prepared dishes of eatables according to their means. The.se are 
 given to the ])erlbrmcrs; and when all the houses ha\e been visited, 
 
 is 
 
ii , ' 
 
 il 
 
 i ■ 
 
 I 
 lift' I '^ 
 
 m 
 
 150 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 — the atmosphere meanwhile perhaps many degrees below zero, — 
 they return laden to the casine. Passing under the floor, each one 
 stands a moment in the central opening, chants for a few seconds 
 while the old men beat the drums, and then springs out and de- 
 posits on the floor the dish h'i carries. When all have come in 
 they form in a hollow square, each one holding a dish in both 
 hands. A peculiar chant is begun by one of the old men, and the 
 others join in with him; they then turn towards the north corner 
 of the building, chanting, and at a given signal all raise the dishes 
 of food which they carry, above their heads in a northerly direc- 
 tion, at the same time looking down and uttering a hissing sound. 
 This is repeated several times ; the chant then continues for a 
 few minutes, when they turn to the east and repeat tlie perform- 
 ance ; and again to the south and west. This is to exorcise evil 
 spirits. This being done, all set to and dispose of the eatables. 
 When the feast is over they proceed to wash off the paint, at 
 which stage of the performance most civilized sjjectators are 
 obliged by the odor to retire. After the washing is concluded 
 all join in the ordinary chorus and disperse to their homes. 
 
 The third kind of festival is given by the relatives of the dead, 
 both male and female. They ai)pear by the underground passage, 
 carrying food and presents. Placing them on the floor, they join 
 in the usual chorus. The motions of the females are graceful and 
 easy. The men strive to outdo each other in jumping and ex- 
 treme exertions of every muscle of the body, always keeping 
 perfect time. Between the meaningless syllables of the chorus, 
 words are interpolated, eulogizing the virtues of the deceased ;uul 
 relating his exploits in hunting and fishing. The men imitate in 
 their actions the motions of approaching the deer, of shooting, 
 pursuing, and of taking off the skin. The same dumb show is car- 
 rietl out until the relation of the history of the dead man is com- 
 pleted. Tlic wonuMi then distribute tiie eatables to tlie friends of 
 the family. The men distribute the presents. .Some trifle, sucli 
 as a leaf of tobacco or a pair of sealskin boot-soles, is given to 
 every spectator. .\ handsome gift falls to him who matle the 
 coffin, and smaller presents to others who assisted at the inter 
 ment. After this is over a more lively chant begin,'^ indicating 
 that the season of mourning is over, and tluit tlic relatives have 
 performed their tUitv. With this the < siiibilion closes. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 151 
 
 in 
 
 tir- 
 liii- 
 
 to 
 
 nc 
 
 IVi' 
 
 The fourth festival is not a very common one, and is more prac- 
 tised among the tribes of the Yukon-mouth and to the southward. 
 The man who proposes to give it often saves up his property for 
 years, and retains nothing, being reduced to poverty by the festi- 
 val. He accumulates deerskins, beaver, sealskins and furs, beads, 
 and other articles ot value. He e.xerts himself to the utmost in 
 preparing food for his guests. When the preparations are com- 
 plete he sends to all the natives of the vicinity, who crowd to the 
 feast. It begins with dancing and singing, each guest doing his 
 utmost to e.xcel in each and do honor to the occasion. The festi- 
 val lasts as many days as the provisions will hold out. On the 
 last day the host, dressed in a new suit, welcomes his friends in 
 the casine. To each he gives presents of whatever he may like 
 best ; when all the store of gifts is exhausted the host strips him- 
 self replacing the new clothing by the poorest rags, and gives the 
 former to whoever has not previously received a gift. His wife 
 does the same. The guests put on their new clothing on the 
 .spot in silence. The host then addresses them, saying that he 
 has nothing left, and depreciating his own generosity as much as 
 possible. He then dismisses the as.sembly, who go back to their 
 homes. No return is asked or expected, and the host is often 
 reduced to extreme destitution, which he regards as a slight 
 matter compared with the reputation which the festival has given 
 him. At .some of these feasts ten guns, two hundred beaver, a 
 hundred sealskins, fifty deerskins, five hundred sable, two hundred 
 fathoms of strung beads, ten wolf or wolverine skins, and as many 
 suits of clothing and blankets, have been given away by one man. 
 Stcpanoff told me of a man who saved for fifteen years, until he 
 accumulated such a store of valuables, and then made a feast and 
 gave everything away. 
 
 The fifth kind of festival is also of rather rare occurrence. I 
 witnessed but one. The man who had originated the (|uarrel 
 sent a messenger some seventy miles to the man who had been 
 injured or offended. The messenger was dressed in a new suit, 
 with a red shirt, and carried a wand ornamented with feathers in 
 '.lis hand. Intimation of the intention had of coin-se reached the 
 recipient in advance. The messenger found him at his work. 
 Chanting as he approaciied, he made known his t;rranil, striking 
 tlie receiver with his waiid ; .iiul suddenly seizini; a knife, he 
 
 ! 5, 
 
 \V 
 

 .] 
 
 ' ' ■; 
 
 
 ^!!i 
 
 ■■, < 
 
 ■ t' 
 
 r^i ' 
 
 
 'i' 4 
 
 1 
 
 152 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITOKV. 
 
 grasped him by the neck and brandished it above his head. The 
 other, understanding the intention, made no resistance ; and con- 
 cluding his chant, the messenger inquired what restitution was 
 desired. The other told what he wished for, and the messenger 
 informed him where and when it would be made. The herald 
 then returned to him who sent him, and his errand was done. 
 Several weeks later the feast was given. The required restitu- 
 tion and much more was presented to the offended party, who, as 
 well as the offender, was dressed in an entirely new suit of clothes. 
 After the gifts had been accepted the two stood up and danced 
 together, keeping time with the drums. They then exchanged 
 clothing, as a sign that they were friends again, and the person 
 who received the presents divided tobacco and sealskins among 
 the spectators, which finished the ceremony. 
 
 The sixth sort of festival is frequent. Iwery winter several 
 take place. In December, i(S67, the Mahlemuts residing at Una- 
 lakli'k invited the Mahlemuts of Shaktolik to participate in a 
 festival at the former place. The guests arrived about the 
 middle of the month, and were quartered in the difterent hou.ses 
 in the village. On the opening of the performances all gathered 
 in the casine. The guests were merely spectators. The princi- 
 pal men of the Unalaklik village, eight in number, appeared by 
 the subterranean passage and formed in line on the floor. Six 
 women, the best dancers in the place, took their places opposite. 
 AUuianok and one or two old men, whose age forbade their join- 
 ing in the dance, took the drums and led the chorus. The men 
 were stripped to the waist. They wore breeches of tame rein- 
 deer skin, and had each a tail of wolf or wolverine attached to 
 the belt behind. They had on gloves trimmed wilh wolverine 
 skin, and boots ornamented with strips of fur and marten tails. 
 Around the head each liad a fillet of deerskin ornamented wilh 
 feathers, which came down on the shoulders behind. The women 
 were provided with long .shirts made of the intestines of the 
 seal, cleaned, split, and sewed together. These shirts were trans- 
 lucent, embroidered with bits of colored worsted, and oriia- 
 nieiUcd with short pendenii strings of beads. Through the semi- 
 transparent ilre'-^ the mofirt^f^ of the body were perceptible. 
 Their breeches wi;*<' of the wliH,.- Siberian reindeer, embroidered, 
 decorated wilh strijiK of vvolfs^K-'Mi , and made to fit the limbs 
 
 f |{i| 
 
THE YUKOX TERRITORY. 
 
 153 
 
 perfectly. The upper dress came a little below the knees. 
 Their hair was arranged and braided on each side, with the 
 greatest care. Strips of white wolfskin and strings of beads 
 were incorporated with the braids, and pendants of beads and 
 bead necklaces ornamented the shoulders. Their hands were en- 
 cased in snow-white gloves, fitting closely and made with great 
 care from the tender skin of the reindeer fawn. These were 
 trimmed around the wrist with a fringe of wolfskin. In each 
 hand they held long eagle feathers, to the edges of which tufts 
 of swan's-down were attached. The opening chant was slow and 
 measured. The motions of the dancers were modest and pleas- 
 ing ; the extreme gracefulness of the women, especially, would 
 have e.xcited admiration anywhere. They kept the most perfect 
 time with the chorus and drum taps. Between the syllables of 
 the former, words of welcome to the strangers were interpolated 
 in such a way as not to interfere with the rhythm. The slowly 
 waving feathers and delicate undulations of the dancers rendered 
 the scene extremely attractive. 
 
 As the performance went on, the spectators joined in the 
 chorus, which became more animated. Other villagers entered 
 into the dance, and all joined in dumb show to imitate the opera- 
 tions of daily life. New songs, invented iu the occasion, de- 
 scriptive of hunting the deer, bear, and fox, oi i;'iisuing the seal 
 in kyaks, of travelling in the oomiaks, of fishing and other pur- 
 suits, were introduced in the chorus. The excitement increased, 
 and was added to by the applause of the spectators. All en- 
 tered freely into the enjoyment of the hour. Childrt;n appeared 
 from below, dressed in new and beautifully decorated clothing. 
 With the greatest gravity, and keeping time in all their motions 
 with the song, they deposited on the floor dishes of boiled fish, 
 meat, oil, and reindeer marrow; berries in a cream-like mixture 
 of snow, oil, and fat ; and other delicacies. This done, they 
 scampered out, to return again. The dance came to a close, and 
 the feast began. That over, all joined in a lively chorus, to- 
 bacco was distributed to the spectators, and the performance 
 closed for the night. The next evening a similar exhibition took 
 ])lace, which was repeated every night for a week. The best 
 dancers took occasion to exhibit their proficiency singly; new 
 and original songs and symbolic pantomimes were introduced 
 
 M 
 
 •V1 
 
154 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 • •<'. 
 
 Ml \ 
 
 f I 
 
 f! 
 
 rh 
 
 ill.. ? 
 
 /t 
 
 !'• : 
 
 every evening. During the whole of the festival only the mosi 
 necessary labor was performed, and it would have been quite 
 impossible to induce anybody to do any outside work. When 
 it came to an end the guests departed, to reciprocate another 
 winter at Shaktolik. In this way the hospitable Innuit vary the 
 monotony of their existence, and by constant interchange of 
 hospitalities produce the most friendly feelings between differ- 
 ent tribes. Those about the Yukon-mouth seldom take part 
 in these festivities on Norton Sound. The latter embrace the 
 different tribes from Pastolik to Kotzebuc Sound and Ikring 
 Strait. 
 
 The dialects of those to the southward are so different that they 
 would have difficulty in intercourse with the former, which is 
 probably the reason of their absence ; but among themselves they 
 carry on an equal amount of such festivities. The semi-re- 
 ligious masked dances and midnight mysteries of the ancient 
 Aleutians find no counterpart among the Innuit of Norton 
 Sound. 
 
 It is impossible to doubt that, among all American aborigines, 
 much in their mode of life, customs, and ceremonials is of a local 
 nature, and due to extraneous circumstances. Much is also due, 
 unquestionably, to the similarity of thought and habit which must 
 obtain among human beings of a low type, and who gain their 
 living by similar means. Hence, a general similarity of many 
 customs may naturally be expected between both Innuit and In- 
 dians, as well as far-distant aborigines of different parts of the 
 world, and this similarity can afford no basis for generalizations 
 in regard to their origin. 
 
 Popoff and myself determined to join in giving a festival of the 
 second class, which has not yet been described. Myunuk was 
 chosen as the messenger. He was dressed in a new suit of clothes, 
 which was his perquisite ; he wore a fillet of wolfskin around his 
 head and carried a wand in his hand. This was about six feet 
 long, and curiously ornamented and carved, somewhat resembling 
 the Roman palms carried in procession by high dignitaries of the 
 Catholic Church on I'alm-Sunday. He received his messages and 
 departeil. Popoff had designated Alluianok as the one whom he 
 desired to honor. I chose Ark-napyak, another chief; and Os- 
 trofskoi another, called Andre. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 155 
 
 IS 
 
 |s, 
 lis 
 
 :t 
 
 ke 
 
 d 
 
 The messenger, first finding where the person indicated is, runs 
 at the top of his speed. On approaching him he shouts, "Oh ! oh I" 
 as loudly as possible, and chants a lively chorus. At the same time 
 he delivers his message, waving his wand about the head of the 
 other, and tells him that Popoff, or whoever it may be, is desirous 
 of giving a festival, and having selected him as a suitable person 
 to honor, desires to know what would be acceptable to him as a 
 present. The other replies that he will accept the honor, and 
 mentions whatever he may want. In this case, Alluianok asked 
 for tobacco and a new shirt, Andre for wolverine skin, and Ark- 
 napyak for a glass of water, meaning liquor. A day was set for 
 the festival ; all who chose to come were welcome. We had a large 
 kettle, containing some ten gallons of rice, cracked wheat, and 
 oil, boiled into a general mush, and flavored with molasses ; and 
 another full of tea. Each guest was served with the former, and 
 received with the latter a slice of bread and a lump of sugar. 
 The presents were then given, and the practice is to give as much 
 as possible over and above what was asked for. Being without the 
 liquor which was so much desired, I chose to understand the request 
 literally, and presented Arknapyak with a large bowl full of scarlet 
 beads, much coveted by the Innuit, and filled up with water. 
 Powder, lead, caps, drill, and a little case of portable tools made up 
 his present, and after the others had received theirs, I distributed 
 among the guests small pieces of black tobacco, careful that none 
 should be overlooked. If the festiv^al had been given by natives 
 only, dances and the chorus would have preceded the feast, but 
 the casarmer of the fort was unsuitable for dancing. The assem- 
 bly then dispersed, and we were notified to attend at the next 
 stage of the proceedmgs, in the casine of the village. 
 
 A day or two after, the messenger came to us to know what we 
 desired in return, using the ceremonial previously described. One 
 of the points which give zest to these festivals is the practice of 
 asking for the thing of all others most difficult to obtain. It is a 
 l)oint of honor with the giver to procure it at any price or risk. 
 In some cases couriers are sent hundreds of miles, and the festival 
 is prolonged until their return, in order that the honor of the host 
 may be untarnished. I asked for a live seal, knowing very well 
 that the seal had left the coast at least three weeks before, and 
 that no amount of trouble would obtain one. Popoff asked for 
 
1 ' ' 
 
 
 V 
 
 i'. ( 
 
 I 
 
 fi ' 
 
 ; i' 
 
 \ f 
 
 156 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 foxskins and beaver ; Ostrofskoi, for a tame reindeer parka, and 
 wolfskin for collars. 
 
 The next day we repaired to the casine in the evening. The 
 custom is for those who bring presents to approach by the under- 
 ground passage. We sat on the floor around the aperture, and 
 Myi'inuk appeared and distributed tobacco to those present, a 
 beaver-skin to Popoff, and a pair of walrus tusks to me. The 
 giver stands in the aperture and dances and sings there for a few 
 moments, the old men, meanwhile, keeping time on the drums. 
 AUuiiinok came up and presented Popoff with three fine red 
 foxes. The giver always depreciates his present, and says there 
 are no more to be had, after which he stoops down and pulls out 
 somctliing more, repeating the remarks until his supply is ex- 
 hausted. Arknapyak brought me a fine pair of winter boots 
 ornamented with wolverine skin, a dish of deer fat, two marten 
 skins, a bundle of boot-soles and some berries. Andre offered 
 fat, berries, a fine kamlayka, wolfskin for collars, half a sealskin 
 for boot-.soles, meat, reindeer tongues, sinew, and a fine pair of 
 tame reindeer breeches. Each, after giving all his presents, 
 howled once or twice, danced in the aperture, and finally jumped 
 out to one side. The old men kept up a persevering drumming 
 and chorus. We distributed the tobacco and fat among them 
 and returned to the fort. Arknapyak said that his men had gone 
 to the edge of the ice after seal, and he could not yet fulfil all 
 of his duty, but would do so before the festival was over. It was 
 again the turn of the Innuit, and hoping to find me unprepared, 
 he asked for a plane, which of all things is most difficult to obtain 
 in this part of the world. I was fortunate enough to find one in 
 the tool-box which I bought of Popofi". It was duly presented at 
 the next meeting, which was similar to the one already described, 
 and in return I asked for a good tame reindeer suit for my ethno- 
 logical collection. The closing evening of the festival arrived, 
 and after the preliminary tlances and singing were concluded, 
 the head of a .seal appeared in the opening of the floor, the body 
 followed, and it began to move about, pulled by strings in the 
 hands of bystanders stationed for the purpose. It was dead, but 
 complete and frozen in a natural attitude. As it was jerked 
 about the Innuit imitated the cry of the seal, much to everybody's 
 amusement. Arknapyak then appeared and stated that owing to 
 
TH1-: vi:kox territokv, 
 
 157 
 
 the lateness of the season he was unable to procure a more lively 
 seal for the purpose, and hoped that this one would prove satis- 
 factory. He added that it would not bite. His explanation was 
 received with applause, and he added many other acceptable 
 articles to his present. The old men rose, and AUuianok the 
 senior chief then declared that the festival had been properly 
 carried out and every one satisfied. He thanked us for joining 
 with them in such a cordial manner, and proclaimed that the 
 feast was at an end. It was the first time on Norton Sound that 
 white men had joined with the Innuit in celebrating these games, 
 although Stepanoff had several times done so, when on trading- 
 expeditions among the more southern Innuit. 
 
 While collecting on the beach west of the river on the i8th 
 of October, I met a native who said that he had come up in my 
 new bidarra from the Redoubt. The stormy weather had de- 
 layed it. The next day it arrived at the fort, in charge of I'chuk 
 Koliak, a trustworthy Mahlemut, who on many occasions had 
 been extremely useful to our parties. His only fault was a pre- 
 dilection for liquor. He was honest, straightforward, and very 
 intelligent. He had received the name of Lsaac from some of the 
 traders, who had also taught bim to write his name legibly, but 
 the Innuit had corrupted Isaac into Ichuk. 
 
 Ingechuk and Andrea having arrived from Ikti'galik, I endeav- 
 ored to engage them to take the bidarra up to that place while 
 the Unalakh'k River was still unfrozen. They agreed, but put oft' 
 starting until the next day. When the morning had arrived we 
 provided bread and ukali for them, when I discovered that the 
 brave Ingaliks expected me to hire somebody to row them up the 
 river ! After expressing my opinion very freely of their laziness 
 and general worthlessness, I hired three Mahlemuts to take their 
 places. That afternoon I was seized with violent pain in my 
 neck and back, accompanied by fever, probably caused by camp- 
 ing on the river. On examining my boxes I was astounded to 
 find that the small supply of medicine had been left at the Re- 
 doubt. I felt that the case admitted of no delay. Although the 
 20th of October, thr njr was mild and pleasant. Not a particle 
 of ice was to be stcn oi; 'he river or along the seashore. I went 
 up to the village, and ilirough Isaac's mediation obtained two 
 men. Putting a li' tie tja, sugar, and two loaves of bread, with 
 
 ^!' 
 
 C 1 
 
 M I 
 
 \--\ 
 
IMAGE EVALUATION 
 TEST TARGET (MT-3) 
 
 
 
 1.0 
 
 I.I 
 
 1.25 
 
 
 1.4 
 
 20 
 
 1.6 
 
 "> 
 
 /a 
 
 7: 
 
 
 y 
 
 /A 
 
 Piiotographic 
 
 Sciences 
 
 Corporation 
 
 23 WIST MAIN STRUT 
 
 WnSTIR.N.Y. 14SI0 
 
 (716) 873-4503 
 
4^ ^^ 
 
 
 1^ 
 
 
Bfl 
 
 158 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 , 
 
 half a dozen salt salmon-trout, into the three-holed biddrka, in 
 half an hour I had started for the Redoubt, a journey as unex- 
 pected as it was sudden. Another day, if the weather continued 
 fine, would bring us there. We camped at Fossil Creek near 
 Topanika, but I passed a sleeple3s and painful night. The next 
 morning we were off again early and plied our paddles vigor- 
 ously, hoping to reach Pallonoi Point. The waves rose very 
 high, however, showing heavy weather to the westward, and the 
 wind began to freshen. The rollers became so large that we were 
 obliged to put on our kamlaykas and tie them round the holes. 
 The bidarka was frequently buried in the water, and as she was 
 very old I was obliged for safety to put in at Kegiktowruk. My 
 situation may be imagined, burning with fever and impatience at 
 the delay. There was no help for it, however. Four days I lay 
 in the casine, suffering from anxiety quite as much as from the 
 pain, which however grew no worse. We got out of provisions 
 the second day, as I had not anticipated such delay. I cut the 
 last loaf into three parts and divided equally with my men. There 
 was nothing else but seal meat obtainable. I tried the heart and 
 liver, which were not objectionable, but the flesh impregnated 
 with the oil was positively revolting. The blubber, when per- 
 fectly fresh, has a taste exactly resembling the smell of the old- 
 fashioned lamp oil. Certain arctic explorers have pronounced 
 this, as well as the raw entrails of the seal, to be "delicious!" 
 I can regard this statement only as the result of a depraved appe- 
 tite goaded by hunger. The blubber of the beluga and whale, 
 and even the flesh of the walrus, sea lion, and fur seal, is eatable. 
 When fresh the taste is but moderately disagreeable and is easily 
 conquered by hunger. Hut the flesh and oil of the leopard-seal 
 are always extremely repulsive, and cannot to the civilized palate, 
 by any stretch of the imagination, be considered otherwise. 
 Whale-blubber is a luxury compared to it. 
 
 I could not force myself to do more than taste it, and the result 
 was immediate nausea. Fortunately, in the evening I obtained a 
 small supply of venison and a deer's tongue. The latter dried or 
 frozen is a great delicacy, and has the flavor of chestnuts. This 
 flavor is lost in great part by cooking. In any shape there is no 
 other kind of tongue which will bear comparison with it. 
 
 Towards night of the 24th the waves fell somewhat. About 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY, 
 
 159 
 
 bit 
 
 but 
 
 midnight I stepped out to look at the weather: snow-clouds were 
 driving across the sky, the surf roared, and billows dashed upon 
 the rocky islets. About five o'clock in the morning I rose and took 
 another look. The wind had subsided, but no boats would leave 
 that cove for six months. The weather was icy cold. As far as 
 the eye could reach seaward was a sheet of ice I Aided by the 
 snow, the intense cold in five hours had covered the entire coast 
 of the Sound with ice. It was not clear, smooth, and solid, such 
 as makes in calm weather, but a white, frothy, rough substance, 
 looking like the white slag from an iron-furnace. Close in shore 
 it was several feet thick, but soft and unsafe, with occasional 
 pools of water. The Russians, who often have a substantive name 
 for conditions of things which we describe by means of adjectives, 
 call it shugdh, in distinction from clear, .solid ice, which is lolit. 
 
 I dismantled the biddrka, raised her on a stage out of reach of 
 the dogs, made up tlirc,; packs of about fifty pounds each, and 
 about ten o'clock started with my men lor the Redoubt cii foot. 
 The travelling was exceedingly hard ; we had to step from one 
 tussock to another, which often gave way, striking the toes against 
 the frozen ground. I had only one light parka without a hood, 
 and the wind was very cold. Hy constant exercise I managed to 
 keep warm, and about nightfall caught sight of the hut on the 
 knoll at the Major's Cove. I told the men we would camp here, 
 and they received the information with exclamations of thankful- 
 ness. The house was a wretched one, much out of repair, and in 
 consequence smoky. My bread was exhausted ; we had fortunately 
 one drawing of tea, but no sugar, and only a small fragment of 
 frozen deer meat. One of my men opened his pack and com- 
 menced unrolling a small bundle. First a piece of paper, next a bit 
 of sealskin, and .so on, until about ten wrappers had been removed 
 To my surprise it was the bread I had given him several days be- 
 fore. I praised his economy, but he interrupted me, saying, " Take 
 it ; you want it more than I do." and insisted upon my accepting 
 it. The other, who was almost a boy, seeing the bruised and 
 battered condition of my feet, brought out .some pieces of cotton 
 drill, which he asked me to use as " iiips " and to return to him 
 at some future time. These instances of kind-heartedness are 
 worthy of being remembered. They give a glimpse of character- 
 istics we never found among the Indians, and which eminently 
 
 I 
 
1 
 
 
 h: 
 
 
 \i 
 
 
 \( 
 
 ' '1 ! 
 
 [r 
 
 hi 
 
 ■■ ; 
 
 f: 
 
 ;' i I 
 
 
 [ 
 
 I 
 
 !1 ftl 
 
 i6o 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 distinguish the Innuit. Several similar instances were related 
 by members of Major Kennicott's party. Mahlemuts in their 
 employ, during a scarcity of provisions, denied themselves in 
 order that others might not suffer. 
 
 The next day we boiled our tea-leaves over again, and made the 
 best of our way over the ice along shore. The mouth of the Canal 
 was frozen, as I had hoped, and with care we crossed safely, and 
 reached the Redoubt just as the service was over and the inhab- 
 itants were coming out of church. Stepanoff, who with astonish- 
 ment had watched us crossing the new ice, received me hospita- 
 bly. I obtained the necessary medicines, and, by heroic doses of 
 calomel and quinine, succeeded in quelling the disorder. 
 
 Four days after, though quite weak and still far from well, I 
 started on my return with a Russian Creole, named Goldsen, a 
 sled with six dogs, and three natives. I had obtained some sugar 
 from Stepanoff, to make up my loss, and a good parka, with other 
 necessary articles. The weather was about twelve below zero, 
 and rather windy. We kept on the ice beyond the Major's Cove, 
 but as it was untrustworthy we were obliged to take to the bank. 
 Here the going was very bad, as previously mentioned. There 
 was no snow, and we stumbled over the frozen hillocks until our 
 feet ached again. We arrived safely at Kegiktowruk in the even- 
 ing. Here we took on the tent and uiher things which I had 
 been obliged to leave behind. 
 
 The next day the travelling was even worse. In many places 
 we had to cut our way through low but heavy willow brush, which 
 grows along small watercourses. We camped in a ravine near 
 the two islands. In the evening the wind fairly howled, and it 
 began to snow. The air was full of fine snow, which the strong 
 wind drove into the eyes. Travelling under such conditions is 
 almost impossible and very dangerous. The Russians call this 
 poorga. It is in such storms that travellers lose their way, and 
 are frozen to death. Clear cold, however grept, can always be 
 borne, with proper clothing and e.xercise, but the poorga, penetrat- 
 ing to the bone, first blinds, then chills, and finally exhausts the 
 hapless traveller, who no sooner falls than he is covered by the 
 snowdrift. 
 
 The next morning was more pleasant. We passed Golsova 
 River about eleven. In the middle of the afternoon we saw a 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 l6l 
 
 |)va 
 a 
 
 herd of deer feeding among the willow brush. The dogs started 
 off on a full gallop, sleds and all, and it was with the greatest dif- 
 ficulty that we checked them. I started in one direction, and 
 Goldsen in another. A doe with her fawn passed near me. I 
 fired, and she sprang into the air and came down full on her 
 horns. A few struggles, and she was dead. The others, alarmed 
 by the shot, were off at full speed. On e.xamination I found that 
 one of the buckshot with which the gun was loaded had struck 
 her on the leg. Falling on her horns, she had come down with 
 such force as to break open the skull and pierce the brain. This, 
 and not the shot, had killed her. On skinning her we found the 
 udder full of milk, which we saved in a tin cup. It was thick 
 and rich, like cream. The winter coat of the reindeer is gray, 
 with long white hair on the throat. It is a very awkward- 
 looking animal when in motion, reminding one of a cow. The 
 eye is large and black. We cached the meat and skin, taking 
 only the heart and liver. ^Ve hung up a handkerchief on a snow- 
 shoe, and poured powder in a wide circle around it to keep off 
 the fo.xes. Pushing on, we crossed Tolstoi Point, and camped in 
 the house at Topanika. To reach it we were obliged to unload 
 the sled, and carry every article, as well as the dogs, through the 
 water around two points of rock. The ice was rotten, and there 
 was a strip of open water ten yards wide between it and the 
 shore. That night we had milk in our tea, the only time during 
 my stay in Russian America. The house at Topanika, though 
 well built, is very smoky, .so much so that in good weather it 
 is better to camp out of doors. 
 
 The ne.xt day we started for Unalaklik about eight o'clock. 
 We had broken all the bone off the runners, and the .sled 
 moved slowly. I pushed on ahead, and reached Unalaklik about 
 two o'clock ; the dogs arrived about two hours afterward. 
 
 The annual rumor of a proposed invasion by the Shageluk In- 
 galiks had reached Unalaklik during my absence, and after two 
 (lays' exciteir.ent had been forgotten. 
 
 November 3d, Isaac's brother arrived from Kotzebue Sound 
 with two kegs of rum, bought from the traders. The whole 
 village was in an uproar very soon, and the Russians barred the 
 doors and loaded their guns, shaking in their shoes with fear. 
 Poor Isaac came up to the fort, without a weapon of any kind, 
 II 
 
 ' H 
 
 I 
 
 1 
 
 if 
 
 'Itvl 
 
 : m 
 
 11 
 
 .mM 
 
 ij 
 
 \m 
 
 } '- 
 
 1 
 
 ■!tl 
 
l62 
 
 THE YUKON TEKKITORY. 
 
 1 , ! 
 
 ( 
 
 A I 
 
 \4\ 
 
 9 
 
 :' 
 
 '■t 
 
 I. 
 
 ii 
 
 
 and the Russians seized him, tied him with ropes, and beat him 
 dreadfully with dog-whips. I remonstrated, but they paid no 
 attention to it, and when weary of abusing him they turned him 
 out of the fort, half naked, and blind with the treatment he had 
 received. As soon as it became known in the village the women 
 united in bewailing the misfortune, and the wind brought their 
 cries distinctly to our ears. Isaac's wife came up to the window 
 of the bidarshik's room and cried, " We will tell the Americans 
 when they come back, and they will not forget us," but she was 
 only answered with curses. More brutality joined to greater 
 cowardice I hope never to witness. 
 
 The storm blew over in time, though the hatred which all the 
 natives bore the Russians was much increased. Isaac was very 
 popular among the Innuit, and had never injured the Russians 
 in any way, I took some medicine and went down to the village 
 next day, and dressed his wounds and bruises, but the Russians 
 were afraid to leave the fort for a week. 
 
 On the 8th of November an old woman died very suddenly 
 in the village. The warm weather in October had occasioned 
 much sickness everywhere among the natives. Pleuri.sy and bron- 
 chitis were very prevalent ; many were sick, and all much alarmed. 
 By the liberal use of mustard I assisted many of them, and my 
 attempts to cure them met with the utmost gratitude from the 
 poor people. The weather was very cold, and a piercing east 
 wind prevailed, which did not help matters. 
 
 Near the fort is a small village of Kaviaks ; their chief, named 
 KamcSkin, had been of much assistance to Captain Pirn and other 
 explorers in search of Franklin. He was always harping on 
 this subject, and brought it forward on every occasion. A more 
 persevering old beggar I never saw, nor were any of the others so 
 unreliable or so mean. A fierce bulldog given him by the l*2nglish 
 was a perfect nuisance in the village. One of his workmen was 
 sick with pneumonia, but not dangerously ; he was in a fair way 
 to recover when the old woman died. Fearful that this man 
 would die in the house, which must then be deserted, Kamokin, 
 with the greatest barbarity, and deaf to our remonstrances, put 
 him out of doors in a cotton tent, without food, blanket, or fire. 
 Of course, in two days, with the temperature thirty below 
 zero and a sharp wind, the poor fellow died. His body was 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 163 
 
 imcd 
 )ther 
 on 
 11 ore 
 [rs so 
 Iglish 
 was 
 way 
 man 
 lokin, 
 i, put 
 fire. 
 )elow 
 was 
 
 dragged a short distance, wrapped in a piece of sealskin, covered 
 with one or two logs, and all his little property, including his gun, 
 scattered about on the ground. Left in this way, the dogs soon 
 attacked it, and it was only by threatening Kamokin that we 
 would take the body and throw it into his house through the 
 smoke-hole, that we finally induced him to give it decent burial. 
 
 The cold weather continued, and we e.xpected Kurilla with the 
 ilogs every day. Meanwhile I had a number of women set at 
 work making new harness, as the old was worn out, and we should 
 need a double supply. These harnesses are made with two bands 
 over the back, sewed on each side to a broad band which passes 
 around the chest and is prolonged into two traces, lieneath, a 
 belly-band with a button and loop holds it on. A single small 
 sealskin will make a dozen good harnesses. The thicker skins 
 make the best, and they are often ornamented with red flannel 
 and bright buttons. 
 
 ■ V 
 
 il 
 
 
\ ( 
 
 CHAPTER V. 
 
 y i i?i 
 
 Arrival of Kurilla jmd the dogs. — Departure from Unalaklik. — Various kinds of 
 sk'dgfs. — Arrival at Iktigalik. — Series of detentions. — Indian avarice. — At 
 L'iukiik antl across the portaj^e. — Comparative merits of different sledges. — Wol- 
 asatu.x. — .\rrival at Nulato. — Sham hysterics. — Fisii-traps. — Kiirilla's return. — 
 Journey to the Kaiyuh Kivcr. — Housekeeping. — Christmas and New- Year's. — 
 Snaring grouse. — Yukon fish. — Continued sickness. — .Arrival ol the mail. — 
 Start for the Redoubt. — Mow the Russians travel r.v. how the .\mericans travel. 
 — .\rrival at the Keduubt. — Return to Iktigaiik. — lireak-down and repairs. — 1 )og- 
 driving, and cam]) life in the \'ukon territory. — Snowshoes. — Arrival at N'ulato. — 
 K.xpeditions among the Nulato Hills. — Hostile Kovukuns. — Reasons for their hos- 
 tility. — Character of the western Tinneh. — I'jidurance. — Prevalent disea.ses. — 
 Snow-goggles. — Totems. — Dances anil songs. — Arms. — Habits of life. — Ad- 
 ditional notes on the Kutchin tribes. — .Making shot. — .Attack on 'I'ekunka and the 
 result. — Arrival of swallows and geese. — Break-up of the ice. — Narrow escape. — 
 Non-arrival of Indians. — I'avlotT's departure. 
 
 EARLY in the forenoon of November I2th I was called out 
 by a cry that dogs were comin<;. On reaching the river- 
 bank I saw the tall form of the indefatigable Kurilla behind a 
 rapidly advancing sled. He had hardly reached the fo. i: when 
 IVivloff, Paspi'lkofil", Peetka, and Ivan the tyone came in sight 
 with two other sleds. All was as usual at Nulato, and there was 
 a fair prospect of abundance of fish in the coming winter. We 
 greeted them heartily, and were soon .seated around the steaming 
 samovar. They were eight days from Nulato, and had found the 
 ice on the Yukon in good condition, though there were still open 
 places in it. The Russians were bound for the Redoubt, and 
 Ivan had come to Unalaklik to buy oil. 
 
 The 14th was stormy, and on the 15th I arranged to start for 
 Uli'ikuk. I was short of dogs, as Stepanoff had taken all the dogs 
 belonging to the Telegraph Company, except those which Kurilla 
 had brought from Nulato. I was able to secure nine from the 
 Unalaklik village, and hired three Mahlemuts to assist us as far as 
 Uliikuk and perhaps to Nulato. I obtained two Innuit sleils, 
 which would be available only as far as Uliikuk. These sleds are 
 
 il'l'^i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 105 
 
 admirably suited for travelling over the ice, but are too heavy to 
 use on a portage. They are made of spruce wood, with the run- 
 ners shod with bone cut from the upper edge of the jawbone of 
 the whale, and pegged on with birch pegs. They arc brought from 
 Ik'ring Strait, and good ones are worth ten sables a pair. The 
 sled is furnished with a flat bottom made of slats, on which the 
 
 liiDiiit >lccl of Norton Suiind. 
 
 load is laid, and with a low horizontal rail. We were accustomed 
 to lash a pole on each side, projecting behind the sled at an angle 
 of fifty degrees with the runner These poles, strengthened with 
 a cross-bar. assisted materially in pushing and guiding the sled 
 and in lifting it up and down steep banks. 
 
 We had brought down from Fort Yukon to Nulato, the previous 
 summer, two Hudson Bay sledges and a set of harness. They are 
 
 for 
 
 riUa 
 I the 
 Ir as 
 
 |eds, 
 arc 
 
 Huilsoii ll.iy sled, loaded. 
 
 made of three birch boards about twelve feet long. These are cut 
 thin at one end, about three feet of which is bent over, lashed and 
 covered with rawhide to keep it in place. Inside of this curve the 
 voyageur carries his kettle. The boards are secured to each other 
 by crosspieces well lashed on. The load is placed inside of a large 
 bag as long as the sled, and made of dressed mooseskin. It is then 
 covered over and firmly lashed by means of a rawhide line and 
 netting attached to each side of the sled. A piece of mahout, 
 known as the tail-line, passes through a loop in the head of the sled 
 and is tied to the lashings over the load, binding it all firmly to- 
 gether. The preceding sketch shows the appearance of the loaded 
 
II 
 
 > I i 
 
 In 
 It'- 
 
 •'in 
 f 
 
 if. 
 
 i 
 
 %ii 
 
 '1 ! 
 
 I 
 
 li 
 
 7 
 
 'M' 
 
 H 
 
 l'( 
 
 P 
 
 II 
 
 1 66 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 slccl. The harness is furnished with a padded collar, like a horsc- 
 coliar, but rounded, which goes over the neck of the dog, and the 
 traces are long. The dogs are harnessed tandem, and three good 
 ones make a team. The traces are buckled on each side of the 
 dog behind, so that the strain all comes on the load and no power 
 is wasted. I found it advantageous to lash two poles to the load 
 behind, as already described, as it is very hard work controlling 
 the motions of the sled by means of the tail-line alone. 
 
 The Indian sled of the country is much lighter. It is made of 
 birch, with thin, broad runners, which bend with the inequalities 
 of the road. The accompanying picture will give a better idea 
 
 Ingalik sled iif tliu Yukon. 
 
 of it than a description. There are no nails or pins, the whole 
 being lashed together by means of rawhide thongs. The load is 
 usually covered with cotton cloth, and firmly lashed to the sides 
 and rail of the sled. The dogs are harnessed two and two, with 
 a leader, to a single line in front of the sled. The traces are tied 
 together, and attached by a short cord to the sled-line. The har- 
 ness was described in the last chapter. 
 
 We had had many discussions during the past season, in regard 
 to the respective merits of the different kinds of sleds, and I was 
 very glad of the opportunity of thus putting them to a practical 
 test. The Hudson Hay sled is the only one used by their voy- 
 ageurs ; while the Russians use a sled similar to the Indian one, 
 but broader and more strongly made. 
 
 We started for Uliikuk about noon of the 15th. Our loads 
 were unusually heavy and the teams small. On each of the Hud- 
 son Hay sleds I placed about four hundred pounds, and gave them 
 three good dogs apiece. The Indian sled took about the same 
 load with four dogs, and the Innuit one had about seven hundred 
 with five dogs. The latter, being shod with bone, will carry a 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 167 
 
 ;ard 
 
 was 
 ;tical 
 voy- 
 
 one, 
 
 oads 
 [ud- 
 thcm 
 Isamc 
 jdred 
 Irry a 
 
 very heavy load over smooth ice with ease. I took one of the 
 Hudson Hay sleds, as I always made it a rule to take as heavy a 
 sled as any man in the hrij^ade. With this arrangement no man 
 could complain of the excessive weij^ht of his load, and laziness 
 was left without an excuse. A light sled should always lead, and 
 hreak the road. This was KuriUa's post ; I brought up the rear, 
 to prevent the natives from needlessly lagging behind. When 
 sure of my men and with a good road, I always took the lead. It 
 is a good plan for the leader to carry the blankets, chynik, and 
 axes ; for if a storm should come up, and the others should drop 
 behind, they cannot camp until the day's work is finished, and 
 they have caught up their lost ground. 
 
 We found the going moderately good, and camped a short dis- 
 tance below Iktigalik about six o'clock. The days were begin- 
 ning lo be short. The sun rose about ten o'clock, and by three 
 in the afternoon had again reached the horizon. His highest 
 elevation was far below the zenith. 
 
 We reached Iktigalik early the next day. Here we camped, 
 bought dog-feed, and rearranged the loads, substituting an In- 
 dian sled for the Innuit one, which was of no further use, as we 
 were about to make portages. Matfay had promised me a new 
 sled and the use of his dogs, for which I had paid him in advance. 
 Now, the old ruffian refused to let his dogs go at all, and gave us 
 a weak and almost worthless old .sled. Ami'lka and others had 
 built some new winter houses near Nuk'kuh, and had deserted 
 Ulukuk entirely, only one house there being still inhabited. All 
 the Ingaliks were going to the Kaiyuh River a little later in the 
 season. Here Tekunka had announced that he would hold a fes- 
 tival. He was now on his way to Unalaklik to purchase oil. We 
 were delayed the next day, having to patch up the old sled, but 
 got oft' about ten o'clock. We had not proceeded far before three 
 of the knees on one side broke. After making the best repairs 
 ill our power we pushed on, and about noon reached the new 
 village. 
 
 Here we found a large number of Indians. There was a new 
 sled there, and the owner asked for it a can ( i lb.) of powder, ten 
 l)alls, and ten percussion-caps. The usual cost of a sled is twenty 
 l)alls ; yet I would have purchased it, even at the outrageous 
 price he named ; but after paying him he stooped down and be- 
 
 .« 
 
 N 
 
B 
 
 168 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 i<.!< 
 
 '.(■ ,■, 
 
 i, 
 
 ■/! 
 
 gan to strip off the lashings, saying that the remni belonged to 
 another man. At this my temper, which had been at the boiling- 
 point ever since I left Matfay, gave way, and I expressed my de- 
 cided opinion of him as thoroughly as my vocabulary permitted 
 me. Leaving the sled and reclaiming the price, I pushed on, de- 
 termined not to submit to such an imposition. About a mile 
 beyond the village the old sled gave out entirely. This was the 
 last drop. I said nothing, but took out my pipe and sat down to 
 calm my nerves. The others did the same, and finally Kurilla 
 spoke up and said that we must go back and buy the sled pre- 
 viously spoken of. He suggested that he had a small tin whicli 
 held only half a pound of powder, and if that were presented to 
 the man he might not detect the difference : in this way we 
 might get even with him. We had plenty of mahout to lash the 
 sled again. I told him he might try, and he went off and soon 
 returned with the sled. We had meanwhile boiled the chynik, 
 and now took our tea, after which we reloaded. One of our 
 dogs had taken the opportunity to gnaw off his harness and dis- 
 appear in the woods. Meanwhile it had become almost dark, 
 and the men were grumbling, and wanted to go back and spend 
 the night at the village. They invented stories about there be- 
 ing no ice in the Uliikuk River, and went grudgingly to their 
 work when I told them that stopping was out of the question, 
 and we should sleep only on our arrival at Uliikuk. This day's 
 adventures are fair specimens of the annoyances sometimes ex- 
 perienced in travelling, and which only patience and energy can 
 overcome. The dogs are given to running away when most 
 wanted, and light steel collars, and chains such as horses are 
 hitched with, would be a very valuable addition to any traveller's 
 equipment. 
 
 We arrived in good order, but some time after dark, and 
 camped in one of the winter houses. There we found a few 
 Indians, and obtained abundance of trout, fresh from the river, 
 with which we fed ourselves and the dogs, reserving the lighter 
 ukali for the road. A small Indian cur occasioned great con- 
 fusion during the night, howling and fighting, and started at 
 last for the woods, with several of our dogs in pursuit. I had 
 reckoned that old Amilka would be willing to lend us his fine 
 team, but he refused; — such is life among the Indians! 
 
THE YUKON' TERRITORY. 
 
 169 
 
 and 
 few 
 river, 
 |rhter 
 con- 
 td at 
 had 
 fine 
 
 The next day was occupied in repairing damages, reloading, 
 and recovering our runaway dogs. The weather was disagree- 
 ably windy, with snow. 
 
 On the 19th we started very early. A few miles from Ulukuk 
 we were astonished to see dogs coming, and in a few moments 
 the previously mentioned cur appeared, with Amt'lka's three dogs 
 in hot pursuit. These were immediately impounded and pressed 
 into the service, forming an exceedingly acceptable addition to 
 our insufficient teams. Even the cur was made to contribute, by 
 tying her to the foremost sled as leader. 
 
 In crossing one of the gullies by which the tundra is inter- 
 sected, the new sled was broken beyond repair. The Indians 
 were in despair; but, by cutting off about three feet of the other 
 runner, I made a short sled, in which two dogs could haul our 
 blankets and other light but bulky articles. The remain'cf of 
 the load and team was distributed among the other sleds. Ow- 
 ing to this delay wi^ ^>ere obliged to camp near the Vesoliu. 
 Sopka. These repeated stoppages were the more annoying as 
 our dog-feed was short. 
 
 The next day we made better time, and camped near Beaver 
 Lake. Many deer tracks were visible, and there were evidently 
 herds in the vicinity. 
 
 The following morning we passed Beaver Lake and One-Tree 
 Camp. The wind and snow were blowing just as they were the 
 year before, when I was travelling with Mike. I little thought 
 at that time that my next journey on that road would be taken 
 alone. Facing the keen wind, I got my nose and checks some- 
 what frostbitten, but soon restored them by rubbing with snow. 
 It has been said that freezing is unaccompanied by pain, but my 
 experience does not confirm it. The feeling is as if a thousand 
 red-hot needles were being driven into the flesh. Of course, 
 after it is frozen beneath the skin, there is no further pain. Im- 
 mediate application of snow will relieve it, and the usual effects 
 are slight. The skin peels oft' and leaves a brown stain resem- 
 bling sunburn, and quite as ephemeral. Fire and warmth should 
 be avoided, as they produce an intense burning pain attended 
 with inflammation. The best plan in cold weather is to face the 
 wind boldly ; after a while the skin will become inured to it. 
 Arriving at Perivalli, we camped, making our supper of likali 
 and tea. 
 
 A 
 
;■ \ 
 
 170 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 1. 
 
 y I 
 
 The next morning we started with the twilight. The valley 
 through which we had been passing is of an hour-glass shape. 
 The narrowest part is near a round, abrupt hill, called by the 
 Russians the Ass's Head. It widens toward Ivan's barrabora 
 and Kaltag. We camped not far from the latter place. For the 
 last three days we had been on snowshoes, and the road was far 
 from good. 
 
 In the following morning early we reached the Yukon, and 
 crossed to the village on the left bank. Here I bought some dog- 
 feed and a couple of rabbits. There were many fresh marten and 
 fox skins on the caches, and most of the men were away trapping. 
 At this season the fur is the best ; toward spring it becomes faded 
 by the sunlight. The next day we continued on our way, reach- 
 ing VVolasatux' barrabora in the afternoon. Dog-feed was very 
 scarce, and I was obliged to give them only half a fish apiece, 
 instead of a whole one, which is the usual ration. I found my- 
 self very tired, having worked with a Hudson Hay sled all day, 
 and with a very heavy load. I came to a conclusion about the 
 sleds, which I have not yet seen any reason to change. 
 
 The virtues of the Hudson Bay style are, that it will carry very 
 heavy loads without breaking ; that it will make fair time on level, 
 hard snow ; that the method of harnessing is good ; and with 
 first-class dogs it will do good service. Its faults are, that it will 
 not carry as large a load of light baggage, dog-feed, &c., as the 
 Russian style ; that it is much harder to guide ; that it is ex- 
 tremely hard work to take it up hill ; that on a side-hill it keeps 
 sliding down, unless a level road is beaten for it ; finally, that it is 
 almost immovable in soft snow, a large pile of snow always form- 
 ing under the head of the sled. 
 
 For the Russian style it may be said, that, while more liable to 
 fracture, it is much lighter ; it will carry an equally heavy load, 
 with the same dogs, as the other style, and the load is above the 
 surface, and not so liable to injury from water or snow ; it rides 
 much more easily on a hillside and in soft snow, and the driver 
 can help the dogs much more efiectually. The Hudson Bay style 
 is the best for carrying such loads as oil, fresh meat, flour, and 
 hardware ; and the other for all lighter loads. The Hudson Bay 
 harness is decidedly the best, but not suitable for a large team, 
 which would infallibly tangle at every declivity. The Innuit sled 
 
11 
 
 111 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 171 
 
 IS 
 
 rni- 
 
 to 
 lad, 
 the 
 des 
 ver 
 vie 
 nd 
 iay 
 im, 
 led 
 
 is superior to both on the ice, and far inferior everywhere else. 
 The Hudson Kay dogs are swifter and better trained, but not so 
 enduring or tough as the dogs of the coast. 
 
 Wolasatux, poor man, was in great tribulation. His eldest son, 
 a bright-eyed, intelligent boy of twelve, was evidently dying. 
 The child was wasted to a skeleton ; his cheeks burned with fever; 
 his stomach alone protruded. The old man and his wife were 
 both laid up with pneumonia, and his breast was covered with 
 scars, where he had applied the actual cautery. I left as much 
 bread as I could spare, and some pieces of backfat for the sick 
 boy, who brought out from its hiding-place the skin of a lemming, 
 which he had prepared for me the previous summer. I made the 
 old man a liberal present, for he was a very generous and kind- 
 hearted old fellow. 
 
 About noon the following day we reached Nulato. Only three 
 Russians were there. The house in which I proposed to winter 
 was unfit for occupancy, being without windows. It had been 
 repaired according to my orders, and I occupied a corner in the 
 bidarshik's house until my own should be ready. Several of my 
 dogs had been taken to feed during the past summer by Indians, 
 who had failed to return them in the fall. I sent ." man to Koyu- 
 kuk, where a great festival was being held, to procure the missing 
 animals. Fish was very scarce, the traps catching very little, as 
 the water continued high in the river. The next day two dogs 
 arrived, but a third had been killed in a rage by the Indian who 
 had it in charge, as he had hoped to keep it permanently. The 
 dogs and sleds were prepared for another journey to Ulukuk, to 
 bring up the remaining goods. On the 28th of November the 
 brigade started, in charge of Kurilla, Johnny accompanying him, 
 with two Indians and the Mahlemuts, The Russians got after 
 my alcohol for collecting, and I was obliged to poison i*^ I set to 
 work making windows, and laying my plans for putting down a 
 fish-trap on my own account. The idea of being dependent on 
 the Russians for fish wa.- repugnant to me, and I knew very well 
 that they were often without fish for their own use. 
 
 Several of the Indians ai the fort had been attacked by a kind 
 of fit, and one of these occurred in my presence. The Russians 
 consulted me as to some means of cure. The patient fell in a 
 sort of convulsion, struggling violently, appearing uncon.scious, 
 
 m 
 
 'l^^HI 
 
172 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 t I 
 
 !'; 
 
 tearing the clothing, nnd breaking everything within reach. 
 There were no symptoms of uny disease, and the fits were epi- 
 demic, seizing one after another at short intervals. The cases 
 resembled the descriptions of those people who were supposed in 
 ancient times to be bewitched, and also some of those appear- 
 ances which have accompanied cases of semi-religious mania in 
 Europe in modern times. Suspecting the cause of the symptoms, 
 I recommended the application of a birch twig, well laid on: the 
 result exceeded my anticipations. The patients arose in a rage, 
 and the epidemic was effectually checked. The reason for such 
 behavior was inexplicable, and is one of the mysteries peculiar to 
 the Indian mind. It is probable that in the course of time these 
 fits, at first wilful, became in a measure involuntary. 
 
 Having finished the windows, I began to put the house in 
 order, and it soon assumed a habitable appearance. My fever, 
 which I had hoped was thoroughly conquered, returned, and I 
 felt anything but well. 
 
 On the 4th of December, PavlofT and his companions returned 
 from the Redoubt. They brought discouraging reports from 
 Kun'lla, whom they represented as without dog-feed. They 
 strongly opposed my putting down an independent fish-trap, say- 
 ing that it would cost me a great deal, that I should catch no 
 fish, and that they could furnish me with all I required ; but I de- 
 termined to persevere in my own plan. These fish-traps are the 
 sole dependence of the Russians and Yukon Indians in winter, 
 for a regular supply of food. They are made in the following man- 
 ner. Green spruce trees, straight-grained and without knots, arc 
 selected. It is often a matter of great difficulty to find them. 
 When obtained they are repeatedly split by means of wedges, 
 until the wood is reduced to strips a quarter of an inch in diam- 
 eter and twelve feet long. The tough green wood does not break. 
 These strips are for the basket and funnel. Thicker ones arc 
 used for making the fences or mats. The former arc carefiiily 
 trimmed until cylindrical. The latter are tied together with 
 osiers until a sheet of network is formed, with the .-itups crossing 
 each other at right angles, and the meshes about two inches 
 long and one high. These sheets are eight feet high and ten 
 long. The basket is twelve feet long, cylindrical, tapering nearly 
 to a point at one end, and open at the other. The aperture in the 
 
 it/ 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 / .> 
 
 Illy 
 ]ith 
 
 Ihcs 
 Itcn 
 jrly 
 Itlic 
 
 point is about eight inches in diameter, and is closed by a small 
 cover. The cylinder is about two feet in diameter. A large 
 funnel of similar network is made. The mouth of it is ei<j;ht feet 
 square, and it tapers to a very small aperture, just large enough 
 to admit a fish The point is inserted into the open end of the 
 cylinder, and the whole is tied together. The network of both is 
 fastened with strong twine of hemp, or the inner bark of the wil- 
 low. Holes are cut into the ice, uprights driven into the mud at 
 the bottom of the river, and the mats are tied strongly to them. 
 In this way a T-shaped fence is made, extending at right angles 
 to the current out into the stream, to a point where it is about eight 
 feet deep. The funnels, with baskets attached, are fastened to the 
 ears of the cross-stroke of the T, one basket pointing up stream 
 and the other down. They are so arranged that they can be 
 lifted to the surface and out of the water. The ice above them 
 is broken away by means of four-sided chisels made for the pur- 
 pose. As they are raised every other day it does not form to any 
 great thickness. The baskets are kept in place by sharp poles 
 attached to the point and to the sides of the funnel, and pushed 
 down into the mud. Fish going up or down stream follow the 
 shore until they come to the fence, which guides them to the 
 mouth of the funnel, when they enter the basket, from which they 
 cannot escape. The water passes freely through the network, and 
 keeps them alive for any length of time. As the water falls, the 
 fence is extended, and baskets moved out or new ones put down. 
 It is a work of no little labor to cut through the ice and put down 
 the trap, or Z(i/>6r, as the Russians call it. This trap was original 
 with the Yukon Indians, but is found only below Koyukuk. The 
 upper Indians and the Hudson Bay i)eople know nothing of it. 
 Yagor.sha informed me that the Yakuts had a similar custom. 
 Without it, in winter, starvation would reign on the Lower Yukon. 
 Similar traps are used in summer and rai.sed by means of boats. 
 The slender network, exceedingly frail when dry, is very tough 
 when wet. The fish are shaken out by opening the cover at the 
 point of the ba.sket. I h.td '■•'•'^"♦; difficulty in getting suitable 
 wood, and had to send „.a or eight miles from Nuhito for it. I cut 
 the willows on the island myself, to be ready for work when Ku- 
 rilla returned. 
 
 MetrikotY, the bidarshik of Nuhito before IVulotil", died suddenly, 
 
 •'(i 
 
 i\\ 
 
 HI 
 
 ll 
 
I'. 
 
 •74 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 r . v: 
 
 M 
 
 leaving two bright, intelligent children. The Russians had re- 
 tained them on sufferance until the Governor could be heard from 
 in regard to them. Maksiitoff's reply was, that the Company 
 would do nothing for them, and they had better be given to the 
 Indians ! Their mother was dead, and the recommendation of 
 the hard-hearted Russian was carried into effect. Ingechuk, who 
 was a relation of the mother, came and took them to Uliikuk. It 
 was hard to see two such boys deprived of all prospect of educa- 
 tion and condemned to a worthless life with the Indians, but it 
 was a fair specimen of the character of the Russians in Northwest 
 America. 
 
 The v/eather had set in very cold, and averaged thirty below 
 zero at noon. The wood for the trap, which had been obtained 
 with so much trouble, proved unsatisfactory, and there was no 
 prospect of obtaining more until Kun'lla returned. Meanwhile, 
 though sick and miserable, I had not neglected the collections, 
 and had already several hundred birdskins of the species which 
 are winter residents. 
 
 Late in the afternoon of December 15th, Kun'lla made his ap- 
 pearance- with the brigade. They had done everything I desired, 
 had b: ought all the goods except a big of oil and some likali, 
 and the train contained four Mahiemut dogs, beside thirteen of 
 mine. The Innuit had come forward and offered dogs as soon as 
 they heard I was in need of them. I could not have trusted any 
 Russian in the territory to do the work as well and faithfully as 
 Kun'lla had done it. 
 
 The Russians were out of fish. I had likali, but none to spare. 
 It was evident that nineteen dogs could not be fed at Nulato for 
 any length of time, and I determined to go to the Kaiyuh River, 
 where Tckunka was giving a festival, and distribute all but one 
 team among the Indians, to be fed and used until I needed them 
 again. 
 
 Notwithstanding they had nothing to eat, — as the day was a 
 Prasnik, or holiday, when they were not obliged to work, — the 
 Russians preferred sitting in the he use and grumbling, to the 
 trouble of going to the fish-trap. 
 
 On the 17th of Decem.ber the Nowikakat tyone and seven men 
 arrived with a small hand-sled loaded with furs, which they sold to 
 Piivloff. When they were at a little distance, though their num- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 175 
 
 ber could be counted, the Russians were seized with one of their 
 cowardly fits, barred the gates, loaded the howitzer, and prepared 
 for an attack from eight men and a boy ! On their stating their 
 errand, the commotion subsided and the gates were opened. 
 
 I made the tyone a present of some tobacco and ammuni- 
 tion, in consideration of his services during the previous spring. 
 With Indian assurance, he immediately demanded a seine, gun, 
 blanket, and a large supply of ammunition, which of course were 
 produced forthwith. 
 
 The next day I harnessed all the dogs into one sled and started 
 for Wolasatux', riding several miles for the first time during my 
 stay in Russian America. We found all sick on our arrival, and 
 very short of provisions. The following morning we proceeded 
 up a small river and across the country, until we arrived at Te- 
 kunka's barrabora on the Kaiyuh River. Here we found the 
 festival in full blast and the place crowded with Indians, dancing 
 and singing all night, so that we got very little rest. 
 
 The country is rolling, sparsely wooded, and full of small lakes 
 and rivers, which contain many fish, especially in summer. 
 
 The next morning, as the Indians were still engaged in their 
 festivities and would not attend to anything else, I put on my 
 snowshoes and travelled about fifteen miles eastward, to the 
 ridge of the Kaiyuh Mountains. These are low hills, trending in 
 a northeast and southwest direction, and at that season covered 
 with snow. Beyond them the country was rolling, with oc- 
 casional hills, and sparingly wooded. The rivers, if any, were 
 hidden by the snow. I returned, and reached the house in time 
 to make a good camp outside, as I felt very tired and unwilling 
 to be deprived of sleep for another night. I made my supper on 
 raw, frozen whitefish, scraped up like frozen pudding. This dish 
 is not unpalatable, as the freezinr^ has all the effect of cooking. 
 Several of Indians made me presents of mink and marten 
 
 skins. 
 
 The next day was devoted to trading. I secured a full sled- 
 load of frozen fish and ukali, keeping six dogs, and hiring In- 
 dians to take and feed the rest. I also purchased a qiuintity of 
 frozen berries, and some mats to cover the floor of the house at 
 Nulato. 
 
 Tekunka promised faithfully to make one of my party down 
 
 iS 
 
 V I 
 
176 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 i'l 
 
 '.'J 
 
 the river in the spring, and I gave him a gun as part payment 
 to clinch the bargain. 
 
 The next day all the Indians dispersed to their homes. We 
 left Tekunka, passing up the river to a place known as Jearny's 
 barrabora. Jearny (meaning fat) was the name of a very stout, 
 greasy Ingalik, who had a house and fish-trap, where I hoped to 
 obtain some more fish. The afternoon was moonlight, the sun 
 
 Jearny's b.irrabora. 
 
 setting very early, and after stopping to buy fish we thought best 
 to push on. The fence of the fish-trap at this place extended 
 clear across the river, and was made of bundles of willow brush 
 tied together and placed side by side. There was only one 
 Indian house and two caches. The building over the entrance 
 to the house was large, square, strongly built of heavy logs, and 
 pierced for musketry. 
 
 V\'e camped five miles beyond. I had determined to return by 
 another route, which would bring us on the Yukon nearly op- 
 posite Nuhito. Here I met with a serious misfortune, losing a 
 fine meerschaum, which had been my constant companion and 
 solace. I was now reduced to a single brierwood, in very poor 
 condition. The next morning, starting with the first light, we 
 followed a very poor, roundabout trail toward the Yukon. I 
 

 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 177 
 
 went on ahead of the dogs, and soon outstripped them. About 
 dark I reached Nuldto, pretty thoroughly tired out, having made 
 nearly forty miles on snowshoes. The train arrived about two 
 hours after. 
 
 On leaving Nulato I had placed all our slender store of crock- 
 ery on a high shelf, that it might be out of any ordinary danger. 
 What was my regret, on going into the house, to find that the 
 shelf had given way, and the whole was in fragments on the floor! 
 No more could be obtained for love or money, and we were re- 
 duced to eating oti" of tin. Luckily, I had purchased of Ketchum 
 a Hudson Bay cup, saucer, and plate, made of iron lined with por- 
 celain. These were uninjured, and afterward did good service. 
 Another plate was repaired by boring small holes with an awl, 
 and sewing the pieces together with strong waxed thread. 
 
 My efforts were soon directed to the work of supplying our 
 household with various necessary utensils. Lamps, small cups, 
 and other articles were manufactured out of old tin cans. Mos- 
 quito-netting furnished the material for a sieve, and with Paspi'l- 
 koff's assistance I made a candle-mould. Seal-oil lamps are very 
 unsatisfactory, requiring constant picking, and making a great 
 deal of smoke. Cotton twine furnished wicks, and I was soon 
 able to make very passable candles from my extra supplies of 
 reindeer fat. 
 
 The flour which I obtained from the Russians was a mixture of 
 rye and wheat meal, usually denominated groats. The husks were 
 so coarse and abundant that sifting became necessary. The Rus- 
 sians raised their bread by means of leaven, but as this made sour 
 bread I adopted another plan, which is here described for the 
 benefit of future travellers. A gallon of warm water was mixed 
 with a handful of coarse salt, flour enough to make a batter, and 
 was placed in a wooden vessel on the warm peechka over night. 
 ICarly in the morning flour enough was stirred in to make it of 
 tlie pro|)cr consistency. At breakfast-time the fire was made, and 
 after breakfast, when the coals were removed from the oven, the 
 bread was kneaded, made into loaves, and put in. An hour usu- 
 ally served to bake it, making a batch of perfectly light, sweet 
 bread, without yeast or leaven. White flour may be treated in 
 the same way, hv^ takes longer to rise. I usually mude up about 
 forty pounds of flour at a time, and the bread would last us about 
 
 1.1 
 
i ( 
 
 .78 
 
 THE YUKON TKRRITORY. 
 
 a week. I soon found, by calculation, that we must be very careful 
 with our flour, and was obliged to weigh out the daily allowance, — 
 a pound each, not a very large piece of such damp brown bread. 
 I allowed each three pounds of sugar per month, and a pound of 
 tea for all hands. In this way I managed to make our supply 
 last, although we were often on short commons. Fish, rabbits, 
 and grouse were unusually scarce, and often entirely deficient. 
 No deer visit Nulato during •^I.e winter. 
 
 I had saved a small piece of frozen deer meat for Christmas, 
 which found us without other supplies in the storehouse. Christ- 
 mas morning I bought two white grouse, and sent Johnny out to 
 shoot another, which he fortunately succeeded in doing. With 
 these, some berry pies, and some sweetened short-cake, I made 
 
 
 Yukon grouse-snare. 
 
 out a pretty fair dinner, and invited Pavloff and Yagor to eat it 
 with me, each bringing his own cup, i>late, and spoon, as my 
 stock did not set the table. It was a loneiy Christmas compared 
 with the last, or with any I had ever spent before. It was impos- 
 sible to help thinking of the dear ones at home, of the Christmas- 
 trees and festivities they were enjoying, and equally impossible to 
 doubt that they were thinking of us as we were of them, though 
 many thousand miles away. 
 
 New- Year's day brought cold weather, forty-eight below zero. 
 My hunters were unsuccessful, and our dinner was reduced to fish 
 soup, cranberry pie, bread, and tea. My family consisted of 
 Johnny, two Indian boys, and Kurdla. I sent the boys out set- 
 ting snares for grouse and rabbits. These were occasionally 
 successful, and eked out our slender bill of fare. The snares are 
 
 il'' 
 
Hi 
 
 L'f 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 179 
 
 )Ugh 
 
 zero. 
 
 fish 
 
 of 
 
 set- 
 
 arc 
 
 made of twisted deer sinew in a running loop. This is attached 
 to a pole, balanced, as in the preceding sketch, between two 
 branches, and caught over a horizontal pole by means of a small 
 pin tied to the snare. Brush is piled on each side ot the tracks 
 which the grouse run in, so that they have to pass through the 
 opening where the snare is set. A touch loosens the pin, and the 
 heavy end of the pole falls, hanging the partridge or rabbit in the 
 air. Some seasons hundreds are caught in this way. These 
 grouse feed entirely on the willow buds, and the crop will some- 
 times contain a pint. The flesh is hard, dry, and tasteless ; a 
 long experience in eating it has left an unfavorable impression. 
 Our fish-trap was in process of manufacture, but illness prevented 
 me from assisting. I seldom rose from my bed, except to weigh 
 out the daily allowance of bread, and I felt my strength failing 
 fast. In spite of this, I could hardly force myself to eat, and was 
 tormented with constant headache. 
 
 Cold days alternated with warm weather, and even occasional 
 rain. Pavloff said he had not known such a season for si.xteen 
 years. Such mild weather in January was unprecedented. 
 
 January i6th the Indians and some Russians, whom I had hired 
 to help, commenced putting down my fish-trap. Kurilla came 
 home with an ugly wound in the thigh, from falling from the sled 
 upon an ice-chisel. I dressed his wound, but this disablement 
 was a serious misfortune. All the Kaiyuh Indians, starved out 
 by the unwonted scarcity of fish, had gone to Uliikuk, where 
 there is always abundance, to stay until March. Weeks passed 
 by, and not an Indian came near the fort. 
 
 The Russians were totally without fish, returning from the 
 examination of fifteen baskets with three poor whitefish. They 
 were living on tea and bread. Their dogs were nearly starving. 
 Ivan started up the river on his annual trip to Nowikakat, and 
 lioped to find dog-feed on the road. 
 
 Kun'lla's wound healed rajiidly, and to my great thankfulness 
 he was able to ride on the sled and examine the fish-trap, which 
 had caught six whitefish, — a good omen. The first week or two, 
 before the resin is washed out of the wood, the trap rarely catches 
 anything. On the 24th of January there were twelve fish in the 
 trap. From that time forward we obtained from ten to thirty 
 fish every two days, which drove the wolf from the door, and 
 
 I 
 
 1^1 
 
 M 
 
 ' s 
 
i8o 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 •irf: 
 
 n i 
 
 lit 
 
 enabled me to save my ukali by leeding the dogs partly on fresh 
 fish. The Russian trap still continued almost empty, and if I 
 had not pcrscve'^ed in my plan of putting down an independent 
 trap, I should have been left without fresh provisions and lost my 
 dogs by starvation. 
 
 The first fish which are caught in early winter on the Yukon, 
 arc the " /os/i" {Lota maailata) of the Hudson Bay men. These 
 arc known in Lake Erie as the " eel pout," and grow in the north- 
 ern rivers to a very large size. I have seen them four feet long 
 and weighing sixty pounds. The liver is very large and full of a 
 rich sweet oil, which we found very useful in cooking. The livers 
 themselves are good eating, but very rich. The flesh is hard and 
 tasteless, and is usually given to the dogs. They present an ana- 
 tomical peculiarity in having from one to four distinct gall blad- 
 ders. The spawn, which occupies a large part of the abdominal 
 cavity, makes an excellent soup. The next most common kind of 
 fish is a red sucker, which grows also to a large size. The heads 
 make a good soup, but the rest of the body is so full of bones as to 
 be uneatable. The pike {Esox cstor) is very common in the lakes 
 and small rivers, but rare in the Yukon. A salmon-trout is rarely 
 caught, and a belated salmon occasionally finds its way into the trap 
 as late as January. There are six kinds of whitcfish, some large 
 and others small. The sea whitefish, or Morskoi scrgd of the Rus- 
 sians, is considered the best. There is also found in spring a fish 
 resembling the whitcfish, but dark-colored, and with a very long 
 dorsal fin, from which it gets the Indian name of " blanket-fish." In 
 July the salmon begin to ascend the river. There are five kinds. 
 Three of them are good eating, but the others are only fit for dogs. 
 After August they arc bruised and in bad condition, being cast 
 in layers a foot deep on the banks of the small rivers. I have 
 seen hundreds of thousands of dead salmon cast up in this way by 
 the stream. Of course, in this condition they are only fit for 
 dog-fccd, though the Indians will cat them if other food be scarce. 
 Most of these fish, except the salmon, are common to the rivers of 
 the Hudson Bay territory. 
 
 On the 30th of January, Pavloff returned. He had not gone far, 
 for want of dog-feed. His trade consisted of a black bearskin and 
 one lynx ; the previous year he had brought back some seven 
 hundred sables. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 i8i 
 
 )gS. 
 
 :ast 
 
 lave 
 
 by 
 
 for 
 
 rce. 
 of 
 
 [far, 
 land 
 Iven 
 
 My collection had thriven pretty well, in spite of sickness. I 
 had a keg of small animals and fish, two boxes of birdskins, and 
 other light specimens. 
 
 Still, I was fearful lest my sickness should increase so as to pre- 
 vent my collecting in the spring. I saw that the Russians and 
 Indians considered me as half dead already, and I resolved to 
 overcome it by force of will, if other means failed. I looked in 
 the glass one day, and saw such a cadaverous reflection there that 
 I turned it to the wall. I had already made preparations for my 
 journey to the sea-coast, and the birch was seasoning from which 
 I intended to have along sled made, expressly to bring the bidarra 
 over the portage without taking it apart. 
 
 On the 3d of February there was a commotion in the fort. 
 Dog-trains were approaching in the distance. A rumor spread 
 that Stepanoff was coming, and it was amusing to watch the un- 
 accustomed energy with which the Russians hastened to clean 
 out the yard, removing the accumulated dirt of months, and 
 sweeping the path clean from the gateway down to the ice. It 
 was not Stepanofl", however, but a Russian and two Creoles, 
 with two of Stepanoffs fine teams from the Redoubt. On ar- 
 riving, they proved to be Kamaroff, Lukeen, and Aloshka ; they 
 brought a bag of oil for Pavloff, a two-gallon keg of molasses, 
 and a larger keg of salted geese, — a present from Stepanoff 
 for me. I knew at once that they had not come so far merely 
 to bring these things. I asked if any news had arrived from 
 Sitka, and received only an evasive reply. After a little I called 
 Lukeen, who was a jolly little Creole, into my house, and stimu- 
 lated him until he told me, with many injunctions of secrecy, 
 that the official news had arrived, via Nushergak and the Kusko- 
 quim, of the sale of the territory to the United States, that the 
 Russian American Company was wound up, and all the Russians 
 would return to Sitka or the A moor River by the vessels in the 
 spring. This was good news, and I lost no time in hoisting the 
 stars and stripes on our flagstaff in front of the fort. The news 
 was soon made public, and all received it with joy. Old men who 
 had been many years in the country, detained by trifling debts to 
 the Company, which they had no means of paying, were extrav- 
 agant in the expression of their delight in the hope, so long 
 deferred, of seeing Russia once more. The native women, who 
 
 n 
 
 
\f ' h 
 
 182 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 /;,. 
 
 : i 
 
 could not accompany their husbands if the latter chose to leave 
 the country, were in tears at the prospect of parting ; while oth- 
 ers, whose husbands had treated them with brutality, did not 
 conceal their pleasure at the hope of getting rid of them. 
 
 Kamaroff decided to try his luck in trading at Koyiikuk, and 
 beyond ; on his return, Pavloff was to go with him to the Redoubt 
 for orders. I decided to accompany them, thinking, if I diti 
 break down on the road, I should be within reach of assistance 
 from them, and I had many misgivings as to my own strength. 
 
 Paspi'lkoff at once set about making my new sled, and ve began 
 to prepare sukaree for the road. By dint of extreme argument I 
 succeeded in getting Peetka to accompany me to the Redoubt. 
 I proposed to take Kurilla, and leave Johnny and the rest to take 
 care of the house. 
 
 Kamaroff and Lukeen returned with a few furs on the 13th, 
 and everything was prepared for an early start the next day. 
 Our loads consisted principally of the collections. I took a Hud- 
 son Bay sled, and the long sled for the boat, with eight dogs. On 
 the 14th we set out. I found myself too weak to walk, a'nd was 
 obliged to ride nearly all day on the sled. We made a very short 
 day's work, as the Russians stopped to get dog-feed from the 
 fish-traps, and camped at VVolasatux' barrabora, where they rum- 
 maged all the caches for ukali, the Indians being at Uliikuk. 
 The next day we camped at Kaltag, The necessity for work and 
 the determination to do it were conquering my weakness. I felt 
 better than for months previously. 
 
 The next day we reached the hill at Beaver Lake. This was 
 an excellent day's work, and I so remarked to Kamaroff. " Yes, 
 Gospodin Doctor," he replied, with an amusing air of superiority, 
 " this is the way the Russians travel." I made no answer, but did 
 not forget the remark. 
 
 The next day we took tea at noon near Ivan's barrabora. The 
 Russian sleds were light, and they had full teams of fine dogs. 
 With our heavy sleds we were soon left behind. I forced myself to 
 walk on snowshoes behind the sled, and relieved the dogs as much 
 as possible. We passed Poplar Creek, and came to the Vesolia 
 Sopka about dusk. The moon was shining, although there were 
 dark clouds coming up, and we pushed on as fast as our tired dogs 
 would go. Stopping a moment to rest, I improved the opportu- 
 
 !■: 
 
:he 
 
 Irtu- 
 
 THE YUKON TEKRITORY. 
 
 183 
 
 nity to sketch the scene, of which the frontispiece gives a good 
 idea. The crust was covered with about three inches of soft dry 
 snow, and thj Hudson Kay sled pulled very hard. Constant e.xer- 
 cise of the lungs and whip were necessary to keep the dogs up to 
 their work. On we trudged, following the track, lifting the sleds 
 up and down gullies, pushing through occasional drifts, and shout- 
 ing encouragement and ntlmonition to the dogs, calling each by 
 his name. 
 
 We did not lurn off from the tundra at Uliikuk, but kept on, 
 until I noticed that there were no new tracks, and called to Ku- 
 ri'lla, inquiring where the Russians were. He rcjilied that he did 
 not know ; perhaps they had camped at Uliikuk ; but as that road 
 was such a bad one he had kept on ihe Indian trail across the 
 tundra direct to Iktigalik. I apnroved of his determination, but 
 saw that we must reach the latter placo before we could camp, as 
 the trees along the edge of the tundra wrr.. small and sparse, the 
 wind was rising, snow beginnuig to fall, and poorga impended. 
 At last we reached the river, and collected all our energies, as the 
 blast, carrying snow and almost blinding us, was increasing in 
 severity. In half an hour we passed a fish-trap, and soon after, 
 the welcome sight of the tall caches against the sky met our eyes. 
 We carried the sleds up the bank with a will and a shout, which 
 brought the Indians like marmots from their burrows. An In- 
 dian who had been with us during the early part of the day came 
 out and inquired where the Russians were. Kun'lla replied that 
 we did not know, probably at Uliikuk. The air rang with their 
 shouts of derision, at the idea that a sick man, with heavy loads 
 and feeble teams, should have outstripped the fine dogs and empty 
 trains of the Russians. The poor dogs were unharnessed, and 
 immediately curled themselves up to sleep, refusing to eat, from 
 fatigue. It was with a pardonable feeling of pride that I took 
 my place in the house by the fire, and discussed the day's work 
 over a cheerful cup of tea. Hy the winding road which we were 
 obliged to take, we had made not less than fifty miles, unquestion- 
 ably the longest day's travel with loaded sleds which had been 
 made in that part of the territory within the memory of the old- 
 est inhabitant. 
 
 The next morning, after a long night's rest, we arose and fed 
 the dogs. The teams were loaded and harnessed up, and I spent 
 
 n s 
 
 It- 
 
 ! 
 
 
 'if 
 
 .; ■ 
 
 
 %■ ^ 
 
 r 
 
 \'4 
 
 L 
 
 LI 
 
 i: 
 
 m 
 
i84 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 .W\ '74' 
 
 ! Ii 'I 
 
 ini:i 
 
 
 ,, M- 
 
 |1 
 
 M 
 
 
 a half-hour purchasing deer meat and likali for my dogs on my 
 return. We then started down the river, and after a mile or two 
 stopped to obtain some water. Just as we were about to push on, 
 the Russians, who had been travelling since daybreak, came over 
 the bank. Kamaroft" advanced, cap in hand, and inquired where 
 I spent the night. I informed him, and he remarked that we had 
 made an excellent day's work yesterday. It was now my turn, 
 and I replied, " Yes, Kamarotf, that is the way the Americans 
 travel ! " 
 
 About three o'clock in the afternoon wc reached Unalakli'k. 
 Here we found Ostrofskoi alone, Popoff having been recalled to 
 the P.edoubt. After some trouble, I hired a Mahlemut sled to 
 take our goods on to St. Michael's. All the Innuit were away 
 hunting deer, only two or three old people remaining in the vil- 
 lage. 
 
 After a cold, rough journey, we reached the Redoubt about 
 noon of the 23d. The wind was very strong, the ice broken and 
 piled up in barricades twenty feet high. The temiierature aver- 
 aged twenty-eight below zero. We were just in time for a hot 
 bath, and Stepanoft' received me with great hospiti.lity. A pri- 
 vate letter from the Russian e.\-governor had informed him of the 
 circumstances of the sale and transfer of the country, and the 
 arrival of General Rousseau at Sitka. The winter expeditions 
 from the Redoubt had been very successful, and more furs had 
 been obtained than for many previqus years. 
 
 I obtained two bags of flour, son.o powder, and tea, from Ste- 
 panoft". At home it would sound queerly to talk of going three 
 hundred and fifty milts for a bag of flour, but here it was well 
 worth the trouble. 
 
 Though still very weak, I felt perfectly well, and could ascribe 
 my recovery only to the exercise of will recpiired by the journey. 
 
 On the 27th of February I started with I'avloff for Nuhito. 
 We were able to pass around Tolstoi Point on the ice, an unusual 
 occurrence, which facilitated our journey. We arrived at Unala- 
 kli'k on the 39th. I found that Ostrofskoi had made away with a 
 good many of the ukali which I had relied on to feed my dogs on 
 the return. It was impossible to obtain restitution, as ukali were 
 not to be had for the asking. These fellows are inveterate thieves. 
 
 On the 2d of March I reached Ikt(galik. I had hired several 
 
 ^, i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 185 
 
 had 
 
 Ste- 
 hree 
 well 
 
 icribe 
 icy. 
 .il.Uo. 
 usual 
 Inala- 
 /ilh a 
 
 i;s on 
 
 extra clogs from the Russians, and found two of my own hen;, 
 which Andrea had stolen. The place was crowded with the 
 Kaiyuh Ingaliks, and I gave him a rating for his dishonesty, in 
 their presence, which made him sneak away like a whipped cur. 
 
 We determined to strike on to the tundra directly beyond 
 Ikti'galik, and I would recommend this plan to all future travel- 
 lers. It is far preferable to the old route by way of Ulukuk. 
 Hy keeping along the bases of the Ulukuk hills, a nearly even 
 road may be obtained as far as the Vesolia Sopka. At the first 
 bank beyond Ikti'galik the runner of the new sled carrying the 
 bidarra broke short off. My mortification was great, and the 
 Russians passed on, thinking us disabled for several days at least. 
 To make a birch runner, the wood must be bent while green, and 
 then well seasoned. To do that here was out of the question, 
 and we lighted our pipes and sat down to consider what could be 
 done. After consultation, Kuri'Ua smarted ofl" with the a.xe over 
 his shoulvler, and I made a good fire, and put on the chynik, 
 determined to be comfortable, whatever might turn up. Kun'Ila 
 returned with a slender spruce tree, which he rapidly hewed 
 into the shape of a runner. I sent an Indian back to tlie village 
 to borrow an awl and buy some small sealskin line. As soon as 
 the runner was hewn out, we bent it in the ^re. and in two 
 hours we had the sled completely repaired. The new runner 
 was thick, heavy, and clumsy, but answered the purpose very 
 well. Deerskins, to prevent the sealskin from chafing, were laid 
 on the sled, which had no rail. The boat was then replaced, and 
 strongly lashed. We took our tea, and proceeded on our way. 
 In the afternoon we passed the Russians, who had camped near 
 a small stream. They were much surpriseil and disgusted at 
 seeing us so soon. We camped just beyond the Ves(')lia S()pka. 
 I had the heaviest load 0.1 one of the Hudson Hay sleds. KLiri'lhi 
 had the bidarra, and an Indian called Blackbird had the oilier 
 sled. 
 
 My team comprised three dogs. The leader was a fine black 
 dog named Ikkee, who had a magnificent bushy tail, which was 
 always erect and curly. Tlie next one was black and white, and 
 called Sawashka, a hard worker and of amiable disposition. 
 Next the sled was old Kann'ik, my favorite, and tlie ugliest dog 
 in the brigade. His tail, poorly furnished with hair, was usually 
 
 1 ^{t 
 
 ^■'"i; 
 
 l>V 
 
 ■ 
 
1 86 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I' 
 
 h 
 
 m 
 
 between his le^s ; his ears were short, and scored with the marks 
 of many battles. His face was stolid, and exhibited emotion 
 only when feeding-time came, or when some other dog ventured 
 too near or lagged behind. His body was large, and his legs 
 were like pillars ; his color was white, with dirty spots. Alto- 
 gether he looked a good deal like a lean pig. But how he would 
 pull! 
 
 A description can give but a faint idea of dog-driving. It is 
 an art in itself. The nature of dogs is cross-grained, and they 
 frequently do the wrong thing with apparently the best inten- 
 tions. Each has a peculiar look and character. Some are irre- 
 claimably lazy, others enjoy hard work unless pushed too far ; 
 some are greedy and snappish, others good-humored and decor- 
 ous. All arc very practical, ''lOwing affection only fjr the man 
 who feeds them, and for him only as long as he feeds them. 
 Hence the voyagcur should always teed his ovvn team himself 
 They dislike the whip, not only when in use, but in the abstract. 
 They will always destroy one if they can get at it. The whip is 
 made with a short handle, a very long Ir.sh, braided of leather or 
 sealskin, and usually loaded with sheet lead or bullets in the 
 core. 
 
 As we walk behrid the sled, which ordinarily travels about four 
 milet an hour, we have an e.rellent opportunity of stu' ing 
 dogs. One habit appears to be ingrained in their nature. It ex- 
 hibits itself at street-corners in cities, and at every bush, stump, 
 or lump of ice which they pass on the road. When travelling 
 rapidly, some clog will stop twenty times an hour to examine 
 any bush or twig which attracts his attention. If a leader, it 
 checks the whole team ; if not, he usually entangles himself in the 
 harness, and jumps frantically to release himself as he hears the 
 well-known crack of the whip about his ears. If a log comes in 
 the way, and the driver is not ready with his help in urging the 
 sled over it, down they all drop on their haunches, wagging their 
 tails and looking about with a pleased expression, or uttering a 
 sentimental howl. With a crack of the whip, and a shout to 
 Kamuk to stir himself, their reveries are broken, and we go on. 
 (loing down hill, the whip and lungs are again called into requi- 
 sition, to keep the dogs out of the way of the descending sled. 
 It has been said that no man Cv.n dilve dogs without swear- 
 
 ' /( 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 187 
 
 ine 
 
 it 
 the 
 the 
 
 in 
 the 
 icir 
 Is a 
 
 to 
 
 on. 
 Iqui- 
 l;lc(i. 
 
 tar- 
 
 ing. I think it is in a measure true. At all events, he must have 
 a ready store of energetic expletives to keep them on the gut vive. 
 In Russian America we always used the indigenous epithets, which, 
 as we did not understand them, were hardly sinful. If there is a 
 tree near the trail, the dogs invariably try to pass it on difterent 
 sides, until checked by their harness ; they constantly exhibit such 
 idiosyncrasies, and it was lucky for Job that h^; was not set to dog- 
 driving : if he had been, I fear his posthumous reputation would 
 have suffered. 
 
 At noon we stop for a cup of tea. Here the true voyageur ex- 
 hibits himself in building the fire. A greenhorn or an Indian will 
 make a conical fire, at the side of which you must place your chy- 
 nik, and wait until it chooses to boil. A white man's fire is built 
 in layers. The sticks in each layer are parallel with each other, 
 and at right angles with those in the layer beneath. A few chips 
 are placed upon this pile, which presents a broad, flat top, on 
 which you set your chynik. A few shavings are whittled from a 
 dry stick, and you light your fire on the top of the pile. The 
 free circulation soon puts it all in t blaze, your kettle boils in ten 
 minutes, you drop in your tea and let it boil up oiicc, and you are 
 ready for "chy peet." If the fire be lighted at the bottom, it 
 takes twice as long to kindle, and if you boil your tea more than 
 an instant, it is ruined. Many travellers drink a caustic decoction 
 of tannin, which they call tea ; such unfortunates are to be pitied. 
 
 Tea over, you empty out your chynik, and set it in the snow a 
 moment to cool, that you may not burn your sled cover. Having 
 replaced it, and seen that the dogs are untangled, you shout to 
 Kamuk, " Be off, you old sinner ! " Down goes his tail, and away 
 you go. A greenhorn will have burnt his skin boots meanwhile, 
 trying to warm his .shins, and have put the axe where it will knock 
 a hole in the chynik or drop out through the slatting of the sled- 
 bottom, if you have n't looked out for him. The wind blows the 
 snow in his eyes; his toes lnnn]i against the bar of his snowshocs ; 
 now and then he trips himself up with them : truly, the poor fel- 
 low has a hard time. If he has the right grit in him, he will soon 
 learn, and laugh at these things as you and I do. Up hill and 
 down dale, until it begins to be dusky in the south. Greenhorn 
 thinks it is the west, because the sun sets there. In June we will 
 show it to him setting due north, and rising there within half an 
 
 '' ■ t. II 
 
 pih! 
 
 V 
 
 )V 
 
 <■, 
 
 ■^ 
 
1 88 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 -i 
 
 .;, ! 
 
 if 
 
 hour after it went down. The chief of the brigade has been on 
 the lookout for a place where there is plenty of dry wood, and 
 having selected his ground, gives the signal for halting. Kurilla, 
 who delights in showing his proficiency in the use of the American 
 axe, makes a straight wake for yonder dead spruce. Greenhorn 
 takes an axe, and chooses a small tree to begin with. Somehow 
 or other, the chips don't fly as they do over yonder ; but, by dint 
 of chopping all round like a beaver, it finally falls, burying him 
 under the branches in the deep snow, where he must stick until 
 somebody picks him up. 
 
 Meanwhile the direction of the wind is noted, and the camp 
 placed accordingly; — not so that it will blow on the backs of 
 those who sit in front of the fire, — because this always makes 
 an eddy where the smoke will remain, choking everybody, — 
 but so that the wind will blow on their sides, lengthways of 
 the camp, and carry the smoke away. In March we must 
 excavate the snow to a depth of eight or ten feet before we 
 can find solid ground to build our fire on. If built above the 
 ground it will gradually sink beneath the snow, leaving us in the 
 cold. One Indian goes in search of water, another cuts sp.uce 
 boughs, and you instruct greenhorn in the art of placing the 
 twigs, stem down and tips up, so as to make a soft and springy 
 bed. A green log is placed at the foot of the bed, to keep the 
 blankets out of the fire. Some one is cutting r-.ics for a tempo- 
 rary stage. On this the sleds are placed, with their loads intact, 
 to keep them out of the way of the omnivorous dogs. The har- 
 nesses are also hung out of reach for the same reason. Then 
 each dog receives his supjier of one dried salmon, and you carry 
 your blankets to ihc camp. Kun'lla comes staggering under the 
 weight of a huge back-log, and follows it up with half a dozen 
 more, and also a supi^ly for morning use. The camp being made, 
 and everything else done, we finally light the fire. Greenhorn 
 asks why you don't do that first, and you explain that the effect 
 would be to keep everybody in the vicinity warming themselves, 
 while the camp was unfinished, and hence the other necessary 
 work would be slighted. 
 
 The ever grateful cup of tea being ready, and such other pro- 
 visions cooked as you may have, you enjoy the evening meal and 
 discuss the events of the day. Supper being over, you light your 
 
 H iil 
 
 't W: 
 
■o- 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 189 
 
 pipe. What demon would have the heart to deprive the weary 
 voyageur of his tobacco, — or what money would buy the pleasure 
 which he derives from it .' Oceans of whiskey would poorly re- 
 place his cup of tea, and untold gold would fail to purchase his pipe. 
 
 That delicious fifteen minutes being over, one last glance must 
 be taken at the sleds and dogs. As you return, the inmates of 
 the camp are invisible, beneath the surface. The fire and smoke 
 and glow, which issue from the excavation in the snow and illu- 
 minate the dark evergreens behind the camp, remind one of the 
 mouth of Inferno. The deerskins are spread ; if you are luxu- 
 rious you have a small pillow, if not, you take the biscuit-bag as 
 a substitute. Water being scarce, a large cake of snow is impaled 
 on a stake before the fire. Beneath it is the chynik, which soon 
 fills with water as the cake melts. Your nips and the straw from 
 your boots are hung in the smoke, to be thoroughly dried for to- 
 morrow's use. Unless this precaution is adopted, you will have 
 cold feet the next day. You cover yourself with a blanket on 
 which skins of the arctic hare or rabbit have been sewn. This 
 forms a light but very warm protection. I have slept comfortably 
 with nothing else and with the air at sixty below zero. You pull 
 your head entirely under the blanket, leaving a very small hole 
 for air, and if the dogs, who like a warm corner, do not come and 
 lie down on top, you may enjoy undisturbed the sleep of the just. 
 
 Leaving our camp in the morning, we pushed on among the 
 trees toward Beaver Lake. Every step was taken on snowshoes. 
 The snow was blown in our teeth, and the wind howled in such a 
 way that we knew poorga was raging on the tuntlra. Near the 
 edge of the timber at Beaver Lake we found an old camp. This 
 we cleaned out and enlarged, making a first-rate camp of it. It 
 was useless to go farther, as there were no trees and it was impos- 
 sible to travel over the open country. The great spruce trees 
 rocked and moaned with the fury of the blast, and the snow flew 
 in sheets far above our heads. The next morning it was even 
 worse. As we were well supplied with provisions and dog-feed, I 
 concluded to remain where we were. In the afternoon the Rus- 
 sians came up. I invited them to occupy part of our camp, and 
 told them they could not go over a mile farther, and then would 
 not be half as comfortable. But no ; their energy was not so 
 easily daunted, and on they went. 
 
 '\ 
 
 ;V! 
 
 \} 
 
 
 s; : : in 
 
 
 m 
 
 i 
 
 4 
 
 l.^i 
 
 y 
 
 II 
 
 11 
 
 ; I 
 
 U 
 
 !? 
 
 ' 1 
 
I go 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 I i 
 
 ■ MV! 
 
 , 'l.li 
 
 ! I 
 
 <•< 
 
 I have spoken of travelling on snowshoes. To travel without 
 them in winter is impossible, but sometimes on an old, well-beaten 
 road, or with a hard crust on the snow, and while travelling over 
 ice, they are not needed. The different kinds of snowshoes are, 
 in a measure, characteristic of the locality where they are used. 
 
 >u. '■ 
 
 Different Kinds of snowshoes. 
 
 The Innuit snowshoe (a) is small and nearly flat. It is seldom 
 over thirty inches long. The netting is open and strong, being 
 made of fine remni. That which supports the foot is made of 
 strong mahout, which passes through holes in the frame. It 
 is strong, simple, and well adapted for walking on the hard snow 
 of the coast. Both shoes are alike. 
 
 The Ingalik snowshoe (c) is much larger. Mine were five feet 
 eight inches long, and strongly curved up in front. They are 
 always rights and lefts, a slight difference being made in the 
 curves of the frame of the two .shoes. They are much wider in 
 front, and the netting, which is of deer sinew twisted into twine, 
 is much closer than in the Innuit shoes. The netting under the 
 foot is the same, In all the snowshoes the strings are alike. 
 Two short loops over the toe, and a long one around the foot 
 above the heel, fasten it to the foot. In walking, the toe sinks 
 into an opening in the netting provided for the purpo.se. Begin- 
 ners generally strike their toes against the bar, but after some 
 experience they learn how to adjust the loops and prevent this. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 19; 
 
 feet 
 ;V are 
 the 
 er in 
 twine, 
 er the 
 alike. 
 ; foot 
 sinlvs 
 Begin- 
 some 
 his. 
 
 The Kutchin snowshoe (n) is made a little smaller than the 
 Ingalik pattern, but much in the same style. The netting is 
 much closer and finer, and is made of fine line, cut from prepared 
 deerskins, called babiche. The whole shoe is prettier and more 
 artistic. It is frequently painted and ornamented with beads. 
 
 The Hudson Bay snowshoe (b) is very small, thirty inches 
 being the regulation size. This is in order that it may sink 
 deeper in the snow and beat a better road for the sleds. It 
 is sharply curved upwards in front, and is furnished with a 
 knob to break the crust of the snow. The frame is flat, not 
 rounded as in the other kinds. The foot netting is put on 
 around the frame, and not through holes in it. All the net- 
 ting is very fine and close, and made of babiche. They are gen- 
 erally painted in gay colors, and ornamented with tufts of colored 
 worsted. The latter in moist snow must be a great nuisance, as 
 the snow must stick to them and greatly increase the weight. 
 In hunting, the Hudson Bay men use the larger Kutchin shoe. 
 The latter is probably the best of all for general use. 
 
 The ne.xt morning the wind had gone down, and we started 
 very early. We passed the Russian camp, about a mile beyond 
 ours, and soon overhauled them on a side hill, where they were 
 stuck in a large drift. I proposed to go ahead and break the 
 road for them, at the same time taking some of their load, 
 though my sleds were already the heaviest. My offer was ac- 
 cepted, and we led the way for the remainder of the trip. We 
 camped near the Ass's Head that night, and about ten miles 
 abave Kaltag on the Yukon the following day. 
 
 The road on the river was e.xceedingly bad. The long March 
 day and the warm sun made the snow moist and sticky. Each 
 snowshoe would raise ten pounds adhering to it, and it was ex- 
 tremely hard travelling. We took tea three times during the day. 
 Tired out with running before the dogs, IVivloffs Indian lay down 
 on the snow and refused to run any further. None of the Rus- 
 sians were in a condition to take his place. We were only some 
 three miles from Nuhito, and I gave my sled to the runner, and 
 took his place. It was really a relief to exercise another set of 
 muscles, after walking behind the sled and pushing all day. We 
 found all in bed at Nulato, as we were not expected for several 
 days, and the Russians were especially surprised to see me, sup- 
 
 11 
 
 ■»'■ 
 
 I: i . 
 
 ^11 
 
J' 
 
 ■'\ 
 
 , 
 
 ^ r. 
 
 '!!;• 
 
 71 
 
 I'S 
 
 IV 
 
 
 M 
 
 192 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 posing me to have been too sick to return immediately. Pavlofifs 
 wife had the samovar ready, and we all took a cup of tea to- 
 gether, which did much to relieve the fatigue of the day. 
 
 The Russian fish-trap was catching nothing. Mine had been 
 very fortunate. There was a pile of several hundred frozen fish 
 in the storehouse, quite sufficient to feed my dogs. The next day 
 Blackbird was handsomely rewarded for his work, and sent back 
 with the e.xtra dogs to Unalaklik. 
 
 Repairs being needed on the fish-trap, I discovered that the 
 Russians had appropriated all my e.xtra wood during my absence. 
 After some trouble I obtained restitution. 
 
 Having a small piece of glass, I inserted it in the window. 
 After getting the light all winter only through parchment, it was 
 a great relief to be able to peep out occasionally, and to admit a 
 few rays of pure sunlight. 
 
 The plans which had been settled upon by the Russians were 
 about as follows : A raft was to be built in the spring, and on his 
 return from the annual trip to Nuklukahyet, PavlofT was to em- 
 bark with all the Russian employes and goods belonging to the 
 Russian American Company, and make the best of his way to the 
 mouth of the river, where boats from the Redoubt would meet 
 him and convey them to St. Michael's. 
 
 In the latter part of the month of March I made several expe- 
 ditions, without dogs, to the hilly region back of Nulato. In this 
 manner much geographical and geological information was ob- 
 tained. 
 
 About the 1st of April, Bidarshik, one of the Koyukuns who had 
 accompanied us to Fort Yukon, arrived from the mountains, where 
 he had been deer-hunting. He brought a sled-load of meat, of 
 which I secured the greater part, — a most acceptable addition to 
 our monotonous fare of fish-soup. He brought the information 
 that Larriown was endeavoring to excite the Koyukuns to active 
 hostilities against the Nulato post. Larriown was one of a family 
 of five brothers, all influential men among the Koyukuns. One, 
 whose name I could not obtain, had recently died, lie had been 
 concerned in the first Nulato massacre, and was accused of having 
 killed Barnard. Since that time he had committed many outrages. 
 A Yukon Indian, named Nikolai, who had been extremely useful to 
 Major Kcnnicott's party in their explorations about Koyiikuk, had 
 
;re 
 
 of 
 
 to 
 kon 
 live 
 lily 
 |nc, 
 
 pen 
 
 ng 
 [es. 
 to 
 lacl 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 '93 
 
 an exceedingly pretty wife, and, with his brother, was possessed of 
 much property. In the fall of 1866, Larriown s brother induced 
 Nikolai and his brother to accompany him to the mountains after 
 deer. There the former killed both of them, and hid the bodies, 
 securing their guns ind ammunition. All the autumn and far into 
 winter, the other Indians sought the brothers in vain. At last 
 the murderer, tired of hearing about them, led the searchers to 
 the place where they lay, and boldly avowed his crime. He then 
 went to the house where they had lived, and plundered it. Niko- 
 lai's mother reproached him with the unprovoked murder, and 
 he threw her into the fire, forced Nikolai's wife to accompany 
 him, and fled to the mountains. Of the whole family, only the 
 little son of Nikolai and his sister, who were away, escaped. 
 There was no one to revenge them, and the murderer escaped 
 unpunished. In the fall of 1867 he died of pleurisy. Much sick- 
 ness of the kind prevailed during the winter, and Larriown, whose 
 dictum as a great shaman was not to be denied, accused the Rus- 
 sians of having caused the sickness and death by their sorceries. 
 This may seem incredible, but such reasoning is characteristic 
 of the Indian mind. The remaining brothers sent beads to the 
 various Indians as an inducement to attack the Russians ; but so 
 fiir they had hesitated, from the scarcity of provisions. Bidarshik, 
 under promise of secrecy, divulged the plot to me, and begged 
 me to leave Nuldto. I took him into the magazine, showed 
 him my stores of ammunition and my arms, and told him that 
 I was prepared for anything ; that the Russians had given 
 me the use of a house in the fort, and if they were attacked I 
 should assist them against their enemies, — giving him permission 
 to inform the Koyiikuns of the determination. Rumors were rife, 
 during the entire spring, of a proposed attack, but none was at- 
 tempted. 
 
 Details have already been given of the practice of shamdnism 
 among the Indians, and the various tribes have been described. 
 A few more particulars in regard to them and their mode of life 
 may not be uninteresting. 
 
 The Indian character, with some modifications, is the same 
 almost everywhere. The Ingaliks are peacefully inclined, and as 
 industrious as any Indians. They are more honest than the major- 
 ity of uneducated whites, and much more so than those tribes who 
 13 
 
 ' I 
 
 w, 
 
 ii 
 
 \i 
 
 H 
 
 :t n 
 
 M 
 
194 
 
 THE YUKON TERKITORV, 
 
 « 'ir 
 
 ';-■( I 
 
 I ; h 
 
 ■ il'f 
 
 have been degraded by the use of liquor. They are courageous, 
 but not bloodthirsty, and are easily controlled by a firm hand. 
 Avarice appears strongly in their characters ; the afifections arc 
 but slightly developed, and are exhibited only toward their chil- 
 dren. The latter are obedient and respectful to their parents, 
 but exhibit no love for them. The old people live on odds and 
 ends of food which the young ones do not eat ; this seems rather 
 to be a custom than any deliberate neglect. The opinions of the 
 old men are always consulted, and usually followed. Foster- 
 children are not uncommon. The fruit of their labor belongs to 
 the person who reared them, and they are in a manner slaves, 
 but still possess property of their own, and marry when they like. 
 The authority of the foster-parent is retained as long as he lives. 
 Children are anxiously desired, even when women have no hus- 
 bands. The Ingalik women are less inclined to sensuality than 
 many others, but are by no means strict in their morals. Incon- 
 tinence on the part of a wife is seldom punished with anything 
 more than a beating. Excessive laziness or ill-temper sometimes 
 induces the men to discard them entirely. The women are rarely 
 chastised, and usually well treated. Both sexes are dirty about 
 their persons, and handsome women are exceedingly rare. The 
 old ones are often hideous. The Ingaliks are tall, but more slen- 
 der than the Innuit, and their legs are often ill-shaped. This 
 comes from constant sitting in a small canoe in summer, and 
 walking on snowshoes in winter. They are seldom very muscu- 
 lar ; those who live on fish are invariably the most dirty, weak, 
 cowardly, degraded, and least intelligent. Their number appears 
 to be decreasing. Few women have more than two children ; 
 twins are almost unheard of Many women are barren. The 
 number of deaths annually increases, from their habit of inhaling 
 the smoke of the Circassian tobacco into the lungs, which greatly 
 adds to the prevalence of lung diseases. 
 
 While the Indians are exposed to privations of every kind from 
 childhood, they are, if anything, less hardy than the whites. A 
 white man of ordinary strength and endurance can invariably tire 
 out any Indian, as soon as he has become accustomed to the 
 mode of life. I believe that the white can surpass the Indian in 
 everything, with but little difficulty, even in those things to which 
 the latter has devoted his attention from infancy. All my own 
 
tly 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 •95 
 
 experience tends to confirm this opinion, and it is certain that 
 Indian sagacity has been greatly overrated, especially in the fables 
 of such romancers as Cooper. 
 
 Diseases are quite as prevalent among them as among civilized 
 people. As yet, among the Ingaliks, zymotic diseases are un- 
 known. Pleurisy, pneumonia, bronchitis, dyspepsia (not rare), 
 asthma, rheumatism, colic, hydrocephalus, calculus, urethritis, and 
 hemorrhoids were noticed, and various mild diseases of the skin, 
 boils, and small tumors are not uncommon. Ophthalmia is pro- 
 duced by the reflection of sunlight from the mist arising from the 
 melting snow in the spring. To obviate this, they, as well as the 
 Innuit, make use of goggles after the annexed pattern. These 
 
 Snow-goggles of tlic Yukon Indiana. 
 
 are made of soft wood, cut to fit the face, and tied by a string 
 behind the head. They are pierced with one or two slits which 
 admit of vision. The inside is blackened with charcoal, and 
 some have a small ledge over the slit, as a shade, also blackened. 
 I found these goggles superior to those of green gla.ss with which 
 we were provided. 
 
 Curiously enough, a taenia, developed from hydroids found in 
 the reindeer, is occasionally found among these Indians. I have 
 seen humpbacks, club-feet, and other malformations among Ko- 
 yi'ikuns, and once a deaf-and-dumb man. Strabismus is common, 
 and I have .seen several cases of cataract. 
 
 Their remedies, besides the rites practised by the shamans, are 
 few and simple. Bleeding, scarification, actual cautery, ligatures, 
 steam baths, and fasting, are practised, but they have no knowl- 
 edge of the virtues of any roots or herbs. The women seem e.\- 
 
 ^U 
 
 f 
 
 m 
 
 
 1 ii 
 
 Hi: 
 
 )\ 
 
 If 
 
 fi 
 
 I 
 
 ■ : 
 
 1/1 
 
 .i1 
 
 i1 
 
 ■Hi 
 
 !i 
 
;' I'l 
 
 
 196 
 
 THK YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 ill: i 
 
 ( ! 
 
 %-\ 
 
 
 empted from the curse of Eve. Delivery takes place in a few 
 minutes, the mother kneeling ; no pain is experienced, and she is 
 about again and at her work in half an hour. The infant is 
 rubbed with grease, washed and put to the breast. They are 
 rarely weaned under three years. 
 
 The Indians are devoid of fortitude, crying at a scratch or cut 
 which we should consider trifling : this may be partly a.scribed to 
 ignorance. They are short-lived, few men reaching forty-five. 
 The women live longer, many reaching sixty. Their exact ages 
 can seldom be determined, as they keep no record and soon for- 
 get. They can count one hundred, but no further. 
 
 The work is divided among the sexes much as among the In- 
 nuit. There is no such enslavement of the women as exists 
 among the Kutchin and other eastern and southern tribes. The 
 men do nearly all the hard work. They have no pride of family 
 such as is so prominent among the Koloshes, and few know who 
 were their grandfathers. A very few of the Ingaliks have more 
 than one wife ; none, as far as I know, have more than two. The 
 Koyiikuns are more lax in this respect. Cousins do not marry 
 among the Ingaliks, but there are no rules observed by the Ko- 
 yiikuns in regard to marriage. There is a superstition among 
 the Koyukuns that a youth must not marry until he has killed a 
 deer, otherwise he will have no children. They believe in love- 
 philters, made of an owl's liver, which, to be successful, must be 
 administered without e.xciting suspicion. The totemic system, 
 properly so called, is unknown among them, but they have the 
 practice, as described among the Innuit, of selecting a patron 
 spirit. Somt: uostitute for an amulet the small brass crosses 
 distributed hy the Russian missionaries ; sometimes both hang 
 around the neck on the same string. 
 
 The Kutchin have always possessed the system of totems, and 
 I quote the following remarks from an acount of them by 
 William L. Hardisty, Esq., of the Hudson Bay Company. All 
 the Kutchin are divided into three castes or totems, called re- 
 spectively Tchit-chc-aJi, Taig-ratscy, and Nat-sali-i, according to 
 Strachan Jones, Esq., late commander at Fort Yukon. Mr. Har- 
 disty says : — 
 
 " With reference to the origin of caste it is difficult to arrive at a cor- 
 rect solution. I believe that they do not know, themselves, for they give 
 
 '.t' 
 
 */ 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 197 
 
 5ses 
 
 by 
 
 AH 
 
 re- 
 
 to 
 
 lar- 
 
 cor- 
 rive 
 
 various accounts of tin; origin of tiic three groat divisions of mankind. 
 Some say it was so from tiie beginning ; others, that it originated when 
 all fowls, animals, and fish were people, — the fish were the Chitsali^ the 
 birds l\iin-^ccsah-tsali, and the animals Xat-siugh ; some, that it refers to 
 the country occui)ied by the three great nations who are supposed to 
 have composed the whole family of man ; while others, that it refers to 
 color, for the words are applicable. Chitsah refers to anything of a pale 
 color, — fair people ; Xat-siiigh, from ah-zhv^h, black, dark, that is, dark 
 jjeople ; 7;//>/,;,r(j-(///-/W/, neither fair nor dark, — between the two, — 
 from iitiii-giYS, the half, middle, and ah-tsali, brightish, from tsa, the sun, 
 bright, glittering, shining, \:c. The country of the Na-tsik-kut-chin is 
 called Nah-t'singh to this day, and it is the country which the Xat-singh 
 were supposed to have occupied. The Na-tsik-kut-chin inhabit the high 
 ridge of land between the \'ukon and the Arctic Sea. They live en- 
 tirely on the flesh of the reindeer, and are very dark-skinned compared 
 with the Chit-sangh, who live a good deal on fish. Some of the Chit- 
 sangh are very fair, — indeed, in some instances approaching to white. 
 The Tain-gees-ah tsa, taken as a whole, are neither so fair as the Chit- 
 sangh nor so dark as the Nah-t'singh. A Chit-sangh cannot, by their 
 rules, marry a Chit-sangh, although the rule is set at naught occasion- 
 ally ; but when it does take place the persons are ridiculed and laughed 
 at. The man is said to have married his sister, even though she may be 
 from another tribe, and there be not the slightest connection by blood 
 between them. It is the same with the other two divisions. The chil- 
 dren receive caste from their mother : if a male Chit-sangh marry a 
 Nah-t'singh woman the children are Nah-t'singh, and if a male Nah- 
 t'singh marry a Chit-sangh woman the children are Chit-sangh ; so that 
 the divisions are always changing. As the fathers die out the country 
 inhabited by the Chit-sangh becomes occupied by the Nah-t'singh, and 
 vice versa. They are thus continually changing countries. J.atterly, 
 however, these rules are not so strictly observed or enforced as formerly, 
 and no doubt will soon disappear altogether. One good thing proceeded 
 from the above arrangement, — it prevented war between two tribes who 
 were naturally hostile. The ties or obligations of color or caste were 
 stronger than those of blood or nationality. In war it was not tribe 
 against tribe, but division against division ; and as the children were 
 never of the same caste as the father, the children would, of course, be 
 against the father, and the father against the children, — part of one tribe 
 against part of another, and part against itself ; so that, as may be sup- 
 posed, there would have been general confusion. This, however, was 
 not likely to occur very often, as the worst of parents would have natu- 
 rally preferred peace to war with his own children." 
 
 ft pi' 
 
 .1?! 
 
 \\ 
 
igS 
 
 THL: YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 w 
 
 I' I ♦ 
 
 hi 
 
 iM 
 
 '-m 
 
 I'ifi 
 
 It is not improbable that the custom or system of totems origi- 
 nated in a desire to prevent war, and to knit the tribes more 
 closely together. It is a well-known fact that most of the inter- 
 tribal Indian wars have occurred between those who did, and 
 those who did not, adopt the system. In all other known tribes 
 the names of the totems are those of animals, and I doubt whether 
 the similarity of the Kutchin names to words indicating color, re- 
 ferred to by Mr. Hardisty, is anything more than an accidental 
 coincidence, or perhaps an error. The system is found in perfec- 
 tion among the Thlinkets or Koloshcs. 
 
 The method of disposing of the dead has been described. The 
 dances or festivals of the Indians are less varied and interesting 
 than those of the Innuit. They r^re held at their yearly meetings 
 at Nuklukahyet, or other neutral trading-grounds. Others are 
 given by men who desire a reputation for liberality ; others by 
 the relatives of a dead person a year after the death ; still others 
 by the inhabitants of a village who desire to extend their hospi- 
 tality to neighboring villr.ges These dances have been pr'^viously 
 alluded to. Their choruses are less euphonious and less varied 
 than those of the Innuit. Their dances have less of a symbolic 
 character. Feasting and giving presents form the chief attrac- 
 tions at their festivals. The universal chorus is "lie! he! ho! 
 ho ! " indefinitely prolonged. When the feast for the dead is 
 given the pre onts are hung on a pole. Around this the dancing 
 is done. The Indians wrap themselves in blankets, and the mo- 
 tions are simple jumping up and down, gradually moving side- 
 \/ays, as in the old game of " threading the needle." There are 
 no graceful motions or posturings of the aims and body, as in the 
 Innuit dances. 
 
 The Indians, particularly the women, are fond of singing, a})art 
 from their festivals. Their ears are very quick, and they soon 
 catch up an air from hearing it sung once or twice. Our parties 
 contained several good singers, who enlivened the evenings with 
 patriotic and comic .songs, The Indians soon caught up the airs; 
 and "Tramp, tramp, the boys r.re marching," " Sixteen cents a 
 dozen," and " Marching through Georgia" may now be heard 
 from the mouth of almost any Yuko". Indian, The women are 
 fond of making up songs of their own, which they hum over their 
 work. Some of these are full of sentiment and not unworthy of 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 199 
 
 preservation. The chorus always forms a prominent part. The 
 following is a free translation, preserving the original rhythm, 
 of one which I heard a Koyiikim woman singing as she sewed. 
 It is a fair specimen of many which were translated to me, some 
 of which I jjreserved. It is the song of a mother hushing her 
 cliild to sleep, and the air was slow and soft. 
 
 IS 
 
 art 
 |)on 
 
 ies 
 rith 
 Irs ; 
 Is a 
 tird 
 lare 
 
 ieir 
 of 
 
 ' The wind blow.s over tlie Yukon. 
 
 .My husband hunts the deer on the Koyukun mountains. 
 Alimi, Ahmi, sleep, little one. 
 
 ' There is no wood for the fire. 
 
 The stone a.xe is broken, my husband carries the other. 
 Where is the sun- warmth ?* Hid in the dam ot" the beaver, waitmg the 
 
 spring-time ? 
 Ahmi, Ahmi, sleep, little one, wake not ! 
 
 ' Look not for ukali, old woman. 
 
 Long since tlie cache was emptied, and tiie crow does not light on the 
 ridge-pole ! 
 
 Long since my husband departed. Why does he wait in the moun- 
 tains ? 
 
 Ahmi, Ahmi, sleep, little one, softly. 
 
 ' Where is my own ? 
 Does he lie starving on the hillside ? Why floes he linger? 
 Comes lie not soon, I will seek him among the mountains. 
 Ahmi, Ahmi, sleep, little one, sleep. 
 
 ' The crow has come, laughing. 
 His beak is red, his eyes glisten, the false one ! 
 ' Thanks for a good meal to Kuskokala the shaman. 
 On the sharp mountain quietly lies your husband.' 
 Ahmi, .Ahmi, sleep, little one, wake not ! 
 
 ' ' Twenty deer's tongues tied to the pack on his shoulders ; 
 Not a tongue in his mouth to call to his wife with. 
 Wolves, foxes, and ravens are tearing and fighting for morsels. 
 Tough and hard are the sinews ; not so the child in your bosom.' 
 Ahmi, Ahmi, sleep, little one, wake not ! 
 
 • Over the mountain slowly staggers the hunter. 
 Two bucks' thiglis on his shoulders, with bladders of fat between them. 
 Twenty deers' tongues in his belt, (io, gather wood, old woman ! 
 OtT Hew the crow, — liar, cheat, and deceiver 1 
 Wake, little sleeper, wake, and call to your father ! 
 
 * I. c. the warm principle of the sunlight, which they regard as a personal sjiirit. 
 
 h\ 
 
 :'\'^ 
 
 M 
 
200 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 n I' 
 
 !ia i 
 
 n lull 
 
 " He brings you backfat, marrow, and venison fresh from the mountain. 
 Tired and worn, he has carved a toy of the deer's horn. 
 While he was sitting and waiting long for the deer on the hillside- 
 Wake, and see the crow, hiding himself from the arrow ! 
 Wake, little o.ie, wake, for here is your father! " 
 
 These songs are heard in every lodge. Some attain wide popu- 
 larity, others are unknown except to the singer, who measures 
 the stroke of her paddle or the motion of her needle by the simple 
 rhythm of the air. 
 
 The bow has long since given place to the gun among the 
 Koyukuns, Kutchin, and northern Ingaliks. Long, single-bar- 
 relled flint-locks have beep obtained from the Hudson Aay Com- 
 pany at Fort Yukon since 1847, and at about the same time 
 traders from the Sandwich Islands began to visit Grantlcy Har- 
 bor and Kotzebue Sound. The latter trade a small Belgian 
 fowling-piece, double-barrelled and of small bor^. These guns, 
 with some ammunition, bring twenty marten-skins, and the Hud- 
 son Bay guns are sold for forty. 
 
 Their habits, though not as regular as those of the Innuit, still 
 pursue a nearly uniform course, each successive year being much 
 like the previous one, and only modified by the greater or less 
 abundance of game and fish. 
 
 Life among the Indians is a constant struggle with nature, 
 wrestling with hunger, cold, and fatigue ; the victory is ever un- 
 certain, and always hard-earned. The opening and closing of 
 navigation are the two great events of the year. The months of 
 April, May, and June are the hardest of the season. Tlie snow 
 is melting, ophthalmia attacks the deer-hunters, and the winter's 
 store of food is nearly or quite gone. In May the geese and 
 ducks arrive. The fish-traps are carried away by the rising water 
 in the rivers, and few have sufficient ammunition to sujiply them- 
 selves with wild fowl for many weeks. The men take their canoes 
 and asceml the small rivers, as .soon as the ice breaks up and the 
 freshets drive the beaver out of their winter houses. For a week 
 or two they support themselves in this way, and then those who 
 have been successful in trapping start for Xuklukahyet to trade. 
 Th(;rc they find the moose and deei driven by the mosciniloes 
 into the river, where they n\ay be killed. Bears leave their winter 
 quarters, and their meat occasionally adds to the spring supply 
 
THE YUKON' TERRITORY. 
 
 20 1 
 
 of food. The women, and such of the men as remain at home, 
 are busy making nets and seines from the inner bark of the wil- 
 low and alder. The wood for the summer fish-traps is also pre- 
 pared, and the baskets and other parts of the trap are tied to- 
 gether, ready for use. On the Lower Yukon the eggs of wild 
 fowl are obtained in sufficient .lumbers to furnish a partial means 
 of subsistence. This is also the season for making birch canoes. 
 Early in June the king salmon {KahtliV of the Ingaliks, or cho- 
 zuichcc of the Russians) begin to ascend the river. After the 
 middle of July only stragglers of this species are caught. The 
 chowi'chee are followed by two or three other kinds, and the 
 salmon fishery is well over about the end of August. During 
 this period most of the Indians are on the river, fishing, splitting, 
 and drying the fish for winter use. Some are smoked, but the 
 "aier part are simply dried in the sun. They have no salt, and 
 never use it, even when ft might be pi-ocured from the Russians. 
 In consequence many oi the likali have a tainted flavor. White- 
 hsii are caught and dried at the same time as the salmon, but are 
 smnller, and not so extensively fished for. They are most plenty 
 and in their best condition in September. In the latter part of 
 October the ice puts a stop to fishing, until it is strong enough to 
 set the winter traps. In August many Indians repai. to the hills, 
 where the reindeer are in prime condition, fat, and less timid than 
 at other seasons. The fawns are also large enough to make their 
 skins of use. Moose are very rare on the Yukon below Koyu- 
 kuk. In August the young geese are fledged, but cannot yet fly, 
 as their '..ing-feathers are not fully grown. The old ones have 
 also m> ,i!li (!. ^nd many of both kinds are caught in nets. In 
 Oct'^1- t '...l November the white grouse have returned to the 
 willow t; ..'.:■ . .'n the river, where they are snared by hundreds. 
 In Decembe; i^ winter fish-traps are put down, and some deer- 
 hunting is done on the mountains. Trapping begins in Octolx;r ; 
 before that, the furs are worthless. In December and January, 
 trading commenc >s with the Innuit for oil and sealskin. In Feb- 
 ruary and March the fish-traps and snares for grouse and rabbits 
 are their principal reliance. In the latter part of March the 
 starving season sets in again, l^y some tribes, April is called the 
 "huiU'T month." In May, rabbits are very plentiful for a week 
 or IvV-- '.hen the wild fowl arrive in millions, and the yearly round 
 is completeu. 
 
 : h; 
 
 i^ 
 
 m 
 
 If if' * 
 
 !;ll 
 
•f If' 
 
 ,' I 
 
 t|ii# 
 
 202 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 The Koyukun and Ingalik names for women generally end in 
 " il'no " as Tdllo-ilno, " dashing water," &c. The names of men 
 frequently end in " ala " as Knsko-kdla, " he who strikes," &c., 
 but are not so regular in their terminations as the female names. 
 With the Kutchin the father takes his name from his child, not 
 the child from the father as with us. Thus, Kiocc-ccJi-ct may have 
 a son and call him SdJi-mi. The father then takes the name 
 Sah-uH-tec, and his former name is forgotten. Sometimes the 
 mother will drop her name, and be called Sah-nu-bc-han, or Sah- 
 nu's mother.* The same practice obtains among the Indian 
 tribes to the south, as the Koloshes ; but the western Tinneh are 
 without it. 
 
 In war, when a Kutchin I v *' kills his adversary, he cuts all 
 his joints. They are governec ihe same chiefs in peace and 
 
 war. The authority of a chief it. very limited ; the Indians are 
 very unruly, and indisposed to submit to authority. The chiefs 
 are chosen on account of their wisdom, wealth, or courage, and 
 not on account of birth. They have no insignia of office, and 
 only such privileges as they can take ; none that the others can 
 withhold from them. This undeniable fact has been universally 
 ignored in the dealings of the United States Government with the 
 Indians. 
 
 The chiefs and old men are all who are entitled to speak in 
 council ; but most young men will not hesitate to rise and give 
 their elders the benefit of their wisdom. Among the Han Kut- 
 chin a metal ring is sometimes used in the nose instead of the 
 dentalium ornament of the western Tinneh. Among the eastern 
 Tinneh the women are literally beasts of burden ; but they have 
 the privilege of disposing of their daughters at any age ; the fathers 
 and brothers having no voice in the matter, according to their 
 customs. They have the singular custom of not cutting the nails 
 of girls until they are four years old. The reason they give is, 
 that, if they did so earlier, the girl when grown up would be lazy, 
 and unable to embroider in porcupine quills, an art which they 
 carry to great perfection. The children arc seldom weaned until 
 three years old. They arrive at the age of puberty at about 
 twelve or fourteen. Some of the women reach a great age ; one 
 
 • ViJt account of Kutchin tribes by .Straclian Jones, Esq., in Sniilhsonian Report, 
 1866 
 
 M< 
 
 I" 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 20- 
 
 V ■.: il<i 
 
 y 
 ii 
 
 lit 
 
 at Fort Simpson was estimated to be ninety-seven years old. 
 The eastern Tinneh and Kutchin tribes far surpass the western 
 Tinneh in their proficiency with the needle, and in their love tor 
 ornament. The latter care little for trinkets, seldom paint, and 
 will barter their furs only for tobacco and useful articles. This 
 should be borne in mind by traders. 
 
 Preparations for the spring shooting soon became necessary. 
 I had no shot, and was obliged to make all I needed. The Rus- 
 sians are accustomed to hammer lead out into slender bars, to cut 
 these in small cubes, and roll them. This process being exceed- 
 ingly laborious, I hit upon another plan. I took a piece of walrus 
 tusk and planed it off until it was about half an inch thick, flat 
 on each side, and about two inches wide by si.\ long. Taking 
 a large nail, I filed the point and rigged a "fiddle-bow drill." 
 With this I bored a hole about three eighths of an inch in 
 diameter, a little smaller at one end than at the other. I then 
 filed off a little more of the point and bored another hole a 
 little smaller, and repeated the process until the last hole was 
 about the diameter of a duck-shot. I ran my lead into small 
 bars, and, greasing them well, wire-drew them through the holes, 
 beginning with the largest. The result was lead vvire of the 
 diameter required. This was cut up into pieces, each piece 
 as long as the diameter of the wire. These were then rolled 
 with a little ashes in an iron pan under a flat stone. This pro- 
 duced shot nearly as round as dropped shot, though not polished. 
 In this way I manufactured seventy pounds of shot of different 
 sizes, which answered every purpose. It wns a work of great 
 labor, but less so than by the Russian method. A man can make 
 in this manner about three pounds in a day. The Russians at Nu- 
 hito were each furnished every spring with five pounds of lead 
 and half a pound of powder. With this they must supply them- 
 selves with game, or go hungry. The same practice is usual at 
 I'ort Yukon, e.xcept that the men arc furnished with manufactured 
 shot. 
 
 As spring approached, we made ready for our journey to the 
 Yukon-mouth. The collections of natural history grew apace. 
 Many hundred birdskins, and other specimens, were brought 
 together, some of which had not previously been collet U'd, On 
 the 2ist of April, Tekunka paid us a visit. He was accompanied 
 
 I 3 ' 1 
 
 f i 
 
 
 ■y 
 
 111 
 
 i -ti 
 

 It 
 
 r >M 
 
 M 
 
 V *i 
 
 .' 'i 
 
 /I ■ f ! . 
 
 Hi 
 
 / 
 
 lii, 
 
 f'V 
 
 204 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 by all the Kaiyuh Ingaliks who were returning from Ulukuk. 
 While sitting peaceably in the casarmer he was insulted and 
 struck by Shabounin, a convict from Archangel in Russia, who 
 had been sent to Nulato to build the raft on which the Russians 
 were to descend in the spring. I heard Kuri'lla calling to Pavloff, 
 in the yard, that Shabounin was killing Tekunka. I rushed into 
 the casarmer at once. Tekunka was standing on one side, his 
 face bleeding, and hurling defiance in good Russian at his assail- 
 ant. The Russians were huddled in one corner, unarmed, and 
 cowed by the crowd of Ingaliks, each with his hand on his gun, 
 which half filled the room. Sure of his power, though himself 
 unarmed, Tekunka did n.ot spare his tongue. He told them that 
 he held their lives in his hand. "A word," said he, "and my 
 men wash this floor with your blood. You call us ' dogs of In- 
 dians ! ' We know what you are, — murderers, thieves, and out- 
 laws, driven from Russia for your crimes ! Yet you come to our 
 country and abuse us without reason, take away our daughters, 
 and pay us with a leaf of tobacco for furs which you cannot trap 
 yourselves ! Why should I not avenge this unprovoked insult .' 
 Why do I not 01 Jer my men to exterminate you like vermin } 
 Because I had rather stand here and tell you in your own casarmer 
 that I hate, despise, and defy you !" 
 
 Pavloff now enteral, and was called upon to redress the injury, 
 which he did sullenly and reluctantly. Shabounin was rebuked 
 before the Indians for his conduct, and a present of tobacco and 
 ammunition was made to Tekunka, who received it with uncon- 
 cealed disdain. The Indians slowly left the room, and I followed 
 them. They took their baggage and sleds, and left the fort. It 
 is very seldom that such an exhibition of spirit is seen among 
 these Indians, but Tekunka was unusually intelligent, and had 
 worked in the fort among the Russians when young. It must 
 also be said that such an outrage on the part of any Russian 
 had never before occurred at Nuk'ito, and probably very seldom 
 anywhere. 
 
 On the nth of April the first swallows appeared, and on the 
 27th Kun'lla earned the pound of tobacco by killing the first 
 goose of the season. 
 
 The Russian raft was well under way, and was a clumsy 
 concern, shaped like a flat-iron, nnd provided with high bul- 
 
 ?(' 
 

 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 10-- 
 
 warks, a mast, rudder, or rather sweep, and a sail. They informed 
 me that it was after the pattern of the rafts on which timber is 
 floated down the rivers of Russia which flow into the Northern 
 Sea. 
 
 Meanwhile the skin had been taken off" our little bidarra, well 
 oiled, repaired, and replaced. The mast, oars, and sail were manu- 
 factured, as well as an enormous paddle, which Kuri'lla, in his 
 capacity as coxswain, proposed to use himself The Russian 
 bidarra was made ready for their trading-voyage to Nuklukahyet. 
 Johnny would accompany them, and go on to Fort Yukon with 
 the Indians. He was a useful little fellow, but gratitude or af- 
 fection formed no part of his nature, and I did not expect to miss 
 him much. 
 
 On the 24th of May the Nulato River broke up, and the water 
 and ice came down with a rush. About four o'clock in the after- 
 noon the ice on the Yukon moved a little, and then stuck fast. 
 An ice-barrier fifteen feet high formed near the bluft" north of 
 Nulato. This remained several days without change. On the 
 28th I went up to the Klat-kakhatne River, and crossed in an old 
 birch canoe which I found there, after hewing out a rough paddle, 
 and leaving my axe in a dry log, four feet abo^'e the water. On 
 the other side the beach between the ice and the high perpen- 
 dicular bluff was only about six feet wide. I collected here a 
 number of interesting fossils which had been uncovered by the 
 melting snow. Suddenly I heard a crash, and the water began to 
 rise very rapidly. The barrier had broken, and I had to run to 
 escape being crushed between the bluff' and the enormous blocks 
 of ice which the rising river ground against it. I was just able 
 to keep pace with the water, and found my canoe on the little 
 point quite submerged. On the other side the log, with the axe 
 in it, was floating away with the ice. I emptied the canoe, and 
 paddled after the axe, and got safely ashore on the Nulato side. 
 Here I stopped awhile and enjoyed the sight, l^locks of ice 
 six feet thick were driven against the bank, cutting off' large 
 trees, and carrying ice and turf many yards inland. In some 
 places the ice was piled thirty feet high. I only regretted that 
 niy artist companion of the previous year, Mr. Whymper, was 
 not there to i)reserve the scene with his ready pencil. The 
 break-up of 1867 was nothing to it. At the fort the ice came 
 
 i *i 
 
-r ■ 
 
 f.| 
 
 
 206 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 .!,! 
 
 liii 
 
 ! I ' * 
 
 close to the bank. A little more, and the biiilclin_<Ts would have 
 been in danger. Pavloff said that he had seen a similar freshet 
 only once before in fifteen years. 
 
 The barrier being removed, the water soon began to fall, and 
 left the great blocks and piles of ice stranded all along the beach. 
 There was hardly room to land a boat anywhere near the fort. 
 
 We now set about packing up in earnest. The store was half 
 full of goods, which I could not carry away. The boxes of collec- 
 tions, with our baggage, filled the bidarra. She was a little 
 beauty, well shaped, light, and elegant. 
 
 The season was very late. On the 1st of June, Pavloff and his 
 men left for Nuklukahyet. The river was full of ice, and Tekunka 
 and his men had not appeared ; so I was still delayed. Johnny 
 departed with the Russians, not even bidding me good by, al- 
 though he was loaded with articles which I had given him. He 
 had letters for Mr. McDougal, the Fort Yukon commander, which 
 I took pleasure in addressing to " Fort Yukon, Alaska Territory, 
 United States of America I' as the Scotchmen had insisted against 
 all reason that the post was situated on the British side of the 
 line. As my Indians did not make their appearance, I secured 
 Kurilla's brother, — "Monday" by name, as he was engaged on 
 that day, — and determined that, if Tekunka failed to keep his 
 promise, I would start the ne.xt day, and trust to luck to obtain 
 another man somewhere on the river below. 
 
 It , J 
 
 ill 
 
 i '! 
 
 M 
 
CHAPTER VI. 
 
 Departure from Niilato. — Lateness of the season. — Veto. — Kwikhtana liarrabora 
 
 — Lofka's. — Habits of tlie beaver. — Swan-shooting. — Indian carvings. — Kirst 
 Indians. — Klantilinten. — .V letter. — Meeting with the Mahleniuts. — .\nvik. — 
 The Starcck. — Pottery. — .Sand-liill cranes. — Canoes. — Lcatiier vilhige on tiie 
 Shagcluk. — Great abundance of food. — Demand for licjuor by the Mahlenuits. — 
 Dances. — Attack and narrow escape. — Leave the vilhige. — ManUi. — Kkognuits. 
 
 — Loon-cap vilhigc. — Carvings, old houses and graves. — flreat breadth of the 
 Lower N'ukon. — Arrive at the Mission. — Pass the Great Bend. Lisliing-village. 
 
 — Myriads of wild fowl. — Energetic collection of specimens. — Rasliinik village. 
 
 — Starry Kwikhpak village. — Obtain a guide. — Andreaffsky. — Tragedy in 1855. 
 
 — Mistake of guide. — Arrive at the Uphooii. — Kutlik. — Enijicror geese. — Ar- 
 rival of Teleezhik. — Go on to Pastolik. — lieluga-hunting. — Innuit carvings. — 
 Drawings on bone. — Rise of the water. — Elephant bones. — Start for the Redoubt. 
 
 — News of the ships. — Arrival at the Redoubt, and meeting with old friends. — 
 — Traders. — Embarkation for California. — .Abuses prevalent in the new territorv. 
 
 — Value of a territorial government. — Necessary legislation. — Disparagement of 
 the territory. — .Vrrival in San Francisco. 
 
 EVERYTHING was ready for our departure. The bidarni 
 was almost transparent from the oil which was smeared 
 upon the outside, and inside it was as dry as a bone. Tekunka 
 had apparently deceived me. There were no signs of him or his 
 men. Long experience had inured me to such disappointments, 
 but there were few Indians at Nuhito, and it was difficult to fill 
 the place of tho.se whom I had expected. By sivinp; to Monday's 
 mother all the likali and oil which were left over, I induced him 
 to go with me, as the old woman, with these provisions, would 
 not suffer from hunger before his return. 
 
 On the morning of the 2d of June everything was put aboard. 
 The supplies which I left behind were put into the storehouse, 
 and the door fastened with a jiadlock and chain and then securelv 
 nailed up. The Koyukuns were already threatening; to burn the 
 post as soon as the Russians left it, but, in case they did not, the 
 goods I left behind might prove of some use to somebody. 
 
 1 he beach in front of the fort was covered with large blocks of 
 
 Lii 
 
 I I 
 
 S 
 
 i ') 
 
 'f: I 
 
208 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 • ! : i 
 
 !'i: -. 
 
 ice, and the quantity of ice in tlie river was much greater than 
 usual for the time of year. We pushed off with some difficulty, 
 on account of the low water, and finally reaching the channel, 
 took a last look at the old fort of Nulato. The day was cloudy 
 and cold, with a head-wind. Not a mosquito had yet shown 
 himself, a fact which proved, more than anything else, the un- 
 common lateness of the season. Our little company consisted of 
 myself, Kurilla, Monday, and a little foxy Koyukun dog called 
 Bushy, which was my especial pet. The stars and stripes and 
 the scallop of the Scientific Corps floated from the mast, which 
 was also decorated with a broad-tailed arrow ornamented with a 
 blue muslin fly. I took the stroke oar and Monday the bow, as 
 Kurilla's skill was needed to avoid the numerous floating cakes of 
 ice in the rapid current. I found that my sickness had unfitted 
 me for severe labor, and after a few hours I changed places with 
 Kurilla. 
 
 The river presented a very different appearance from that of 
 the previous year, when we started up the Yukon. Now large 
 blocks of ice were piled up on the shores, where they had been 
 driven by the first high water; no weather had yet occurred warm 
 enough to melt them. We took our daily tea near the Shaman 
 BlufT, close by the coal seam, and, while enjoying our meal, Kun'Ua 
 was quick enough with his gun to bring down a mallard which 
 flew overhead. As we pulled down the river I was so fortunate 
 as to secure a pair of the beautiful Harlequin duck (//. toi-qiiatiis) 
 which flew from the mouth of a small stream. This elegant duck 
 is very shy and solitary in its habits, preferring the small streams 
 which wind among the trees, away from the main river. We saw 
 no Indians on the banks, as the fishing-season had not com- 
 menced. Late in the evening we arrived at Kaltag, and camped 
 on the left bank. The ground was still muddy from being over- 
 flowed, and the willow leaves were still folded. At the Kaltag 
 village we found Matfay and his family from Uliikuk. They pro- 
 posed to make a trading-voyage down the river a little later in 
 the season. Big Sidorka was also there. He had promised to 
 accompany the Russians to Nuklukahyet, but the threats of the 
 Koyiikuns and the ice in the river had caused him to change his 
 mind. He was now very anxious to go down the Yukon with me, 
 as he had never been below Lofka's barrabora. We boiled our 
 
kis 
 
 Mr 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 JO9 
 
 ducks, and found them all very lean and tough from the scarcity 
 of food. The horsetails {Equischc), on which they feed, had hard- 
 ly begun to show themselves above the mud. 
 
 Wednesday, June yi. — As there was little prospect of obtain- 
 ing a more suitable man farther down the river, I decided to let 
 Sidorka go with us. His Indian name was Yeto, and by that we 
 called him. The brown sandstones on the right bank cease at 
 Kaltag, and below is a long stretch of gravel banks, and then 
 gray sandstones and shales with very poor vegetable remains. 
 At the village near the bluffs below Kaltag there were a few 
 Indians. Here I bought half a dozen martens for a few loads of 
 powder and ball. The wind kept obstinately ahead, and impeded 
 our progress a good deal. We took tea near the mouth of the 
 Kaiyuh River. The left bank of the Yukon appears to be gener- 
 ally low, with hills in the distance. The right bank is always the 
 higher, and the river seems to run on the right side of a broad 
 valley, of which the bluffs on the right bank and the distant hills 
 on the left form the boundaries. The vegetation resembles that 
 farther up the river, but here the willows and poplars attain a 
 larger growth. We pitched the tent on the banks of a small 
 creek, where the level dry ground formed an excellent camp- 
 ing-place. There were the remains of many old Indian camps 
 here, and we saw a large number of sand-hill cranes, besides 
 adding to our collection a specimen of the beautiful purple sand- 
 piper. 
 
 Thursday, ^th. — I rose very early, and taking my gun, went to 
 a pool near by, where I got a shot at a swan, but failed to bring it 
 down. By patient waiting I finally succeeded in getting a brace 
 of green-winged teal, which are the best eating of any of the 
 water-fowl found on the Yukon. The mosquitoes were abundant 
 here, as the location was warm and sunny, and I soon awoke the 
 Indians by raising a corner of their tent and giving the preda- 
 ceous insects access to the interior. The sun shone brightly, and 
 the day was most beautiful. We soon pushed off and continued 
 on our way. We passed through a number of sloughs, and 
 stopped at several of the islands to shoot. On many of them 
 small lagoons exist, and on these the water-fowl congregate early 
 in the morning to feed. We obtained quite a number of brant 
 and several ducks. A downy owl {Braehyotus Cassini) flew out 
 14 
 
 ~l 
 
 
 
 Mr 
 
 !'i 
 
 
 \% 
 
 
 ■I 
 
 
 '■ 
 
 N 1 
 
 !>i 
 
 PI' 5 
 
 it; 
 
 ^1 
 
!.' 
 
 2 lO 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 a 
 
 \-u 
 
 from a thicket and, probably impelled by curiosity, followed the 
 boat at a short distance for nearly a mile. The superstitions of 
 the Indians were excited, and they finally shot the bird, which fell 
 in the water and continued to follow us, carried by the current, 
 even in death. 
 
 The alder buds were just opening, and the tender leaves began 
 to appear. About ten o'clock, passing through a small pratoka, 
 we saw on a gently rising mound a white Greek cross. This 
 spot, according to Kun'lla, was the place where the boat for 
 Nuldto with goods from the Redoubt was once caught by the ice 
 and frozen in. The crew built a house and wintered here. They 
 called it Kwikhtana barrabora or Cold I louse, from the extreme 
 cold which they suftered. One of them, who died, was buried on 
 
 H 
 
 v.r' 
 
 Silc of Kwiklitnna b.irmbora. 
 
 this mound, where the cross marks his resting-place. Game was 
 scarce, and we were obliged to be economical with our stores. 
 For dinner we boiled three geese and a duck in the big kettle. I 
 usually made away with the duck and a plate of soup, beside tea 
 and sukaree, while the Indians never failed to clean out the 
 kettle, leaving only the bones, which were the dog's perquisite. 
 In the afternoon we crossed the river to a slough which Kun'lla 
 said was a short cut ; but after going a little way the wind was^so 
 
 !*■ 
 
■'\ m 
 
 THK YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 21 I 
 
 stronjj and dead ahead that I determined to turn back and j;o by 
 the main river, where we were sheltered by the high l)ani<. We 
 saw many fresh tracks of the black bear along the muddy shore. 
 Crossing again, we continued along the right bank, which in some 
 places is composed of trachytic rocks of dift'erent colors. These 
 do not rise to any great height, and are soft and crumbling. 
 Yellow, red, green, blue, and all transitions from black, through 
 gray, to white were observed. Toward evening we approached 
 the Yakiitz-kakitenik River, at the mouth of which is an Indian 
 house in a very dilapidated condition. This is known as L()fka's 
 barreibora. It had a melancholy appearance in the twilight, 
 
 ,«, 
 
 Kvas 
 
 »res. 
 
 tea 
 Ithe 
 dte. 
 Llla 
 
 so 
 
 Lofka's b;iiral)ora. 
 
 being deserted and falling into ruins. We decided to camp here. 
 .\s we i)ulled toward the beach, a large otter started from among 
 the willows and ran along the shore. We had brought along a 
 small canoe made of three boards, and Kurilla hastily jumped into 
 this and made for the beach. He landed, but the otter was too 
 quick for him ; it plunged into the water near the river and dis- 
 appeared. We put up the tent, boiled the chynik, and retired to 
 rest. The rain, which soon came on, did not disturb us, as every- 
 
 
 K 
 
212 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 
 |!i! 
 
 I!<i/ 
 
 i 
 
 r.i) 
 
 thing had been put ashore and covered with the bidarra before 
 we had turned in. 
 
 Friday, ^i/i. — The rain had ceased about four o'clock in the 
 morning, and it had cleared off finely. A stroll along the banks 
 of the small river revealed many fresh beaver-tracks. The 
 beaver, when forced to leave his house by the spring freshets, 
 v'hich fill it with water, seeks his living along the banks of the 
 small rivers, until the waters subside. He is a gregarious and 
 playful animal, fond of gymnastics for their own sake. When he 
 finds a steep, smooth mud-bank, he usually amuses himself by 
 crawling up and then sliding off into the water, repeating the 
 process many times, apparently enjoying the fun as much as 
 boys do coasting. He is nocturnal in his habits, and very timid. 
 Taking the small canoe, Kun'lla paddled patiently up and down, 
 making as little noise as possible, and scanning the water near 
 the banks for the beaver's nose. This is the only part visible, 
 the rest being below the surface. A crack, followed by a shout, 
 told that my old Scotch rifle had done its work, and Kun'lla soon 
 appeared in triumph, bearing a small beaver. The flesh of this 
 animal is to most personii disagreer.ble. A slight odor and flavor 
 which accompany it frequently produce nausea v. ith il.ose un- 
 accustomed to it. I never ate the meat, but the paws and tail I 
 found very good. The former are covered with a black skin, with 
 on] ' a little hair near the junction with the arm or leg; when 
 thoioughly boiled they resemble pigs' feet. The tail is composed 
 of muscular fibre containing a large amount of a peculiarly sweet 
 fat in the interstices. The skin which covers the tail has the ap- 
 pearance of scales, but there are no real scales. The skin readily 
 peels olf if scorched in the n.'e, and the tail, when well boiled, is a 
 delicious morsel. The muscles and inner skin are reduced by 
 boiling to a kind of jelly and the vhole is so rich that one cannot 
 eat much of it. The castoreum which is used in medicine, is 
 contained in two glands which open near the tail. Their use is 
 rjt clearl;' understood, but is probably similar to that of the 
 musk glands in the muskrat and muskdeer. A favorite amuse- 
 ment among the Kutchin Indians consists in taking the humeru;-, 
 in the hands and endeavoring to break it ; as it is very short and 
 strong, this requires considerable strength. After skinning the 
 beaver, and stretching the skin on a hoop of green willow, we 
 
 '« 
 
eaggj 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 213 
 
 ith 
 
 ap- 
 \\\y 
 is a 
 
 by 
 irot 
 is 
 he is 
 
 the 
 luso- 
 
 1 and 
 
 the 
 
 . we 
 
 pushed oiT. The wind was, as usual, dead ahead and very strong. 
 Although aided by the current, we had hard work to make head- 
 way against it. Blowing against the stream, it raised quite a sea 
 on the bioad river, and as our gunwale was only four inches 
 above tiie water, we found it necessary to keep close in shore. 
 We stopped to rest several times, and arriving near a broad, shal- 
 low lagoon, we went ashore, and creeping behind the willows, 
 tried to get a shot at some of the water-fowl which were feeding 
 there. My favorite, of seven guns, was a Scotch rifle, which had 
 been bored out so that it carried shot as well as ball. It was re- 
 markably long in range, and very true. The ball which I used wilh 
 it was a long conical one, weighing an ounce and a quarter. One 
 of these was quite enough to bring down anything which it hit. 
 Loading with buckshot, I waited for Kurilla, who had gone to the 
 other end of the lagoon, where several swans were gracefully 
 seated in the water. The report of his fowling-piece, which 
 brought down a couple of brant, roused the swans from their 
 reveries; and striking the water with their broad wings, they rose 
 slowly and sailed through the air in single file toward my hiding- 
 place. They are not rapid flyers, and I could count every sweep 
 of their strong white wings. As they followed one another, ut- 
 tering their har.-ili cry at intervals, their heads and necks in a 
 straight line, they looked anything but graceful, and would hardly 
 be recognized as the same birds so lately seated on the water. 
 Just before getting in range, they most provokingly changed their 
 .; jurse and struck out across the Yukon ; so I had my trouble for 
 my pains. 
 
 Before returning to the boat I secured a mallard and a white- 
 fronted goose, to which the Indians added several pintails, and 
 seven brant, so that our larder was well supplied. Toward even- 
 ing we began to look for a camping-place, buL everywhere the 
 siiore was covered with great blocks of ice, some distance a -ove 
 the water, and we were finally obliged to haul the boat ur on a 
 large ice-sheet which was grounded on a sand-bar. Here we 
 camped, and a most uncomfortable camp it was. We had to 
 travel a long distance to obtain driftwood sufficient to make a 
 fire. Sand makes the hardest bed known ; fine gravel is much 
 more comfortable. The mosquitoes too. though not abundant, 
 were by no means idle. Everything along the river showed that 
 
 H! 
 
 Ill 
 
214 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 /: 
 
 1'\ 
 
 ■\ ! 
 
 'M 
 
 1^ i/ 
 
 it was an unusually late season. Few small birds were seen, and 
 no butterflies as yet. The birch, poplar, and willow had only be- 
 gun to unfold their leaves, while on the north slope of the hills 
 snow still rested. 
 
 Saturday, 6t/i. — We started early, and pulled against the same 
 strong wind. We landed at a village which was quite deserted, 
 the inhabitants being away after beaver. The facility in carving, 
 shown by the Ingaliks of the Lower Yukon, was well displayed 
 here. Paddles, dishes, and other articles lay scattered about 
 where the owners had left them. The winter houses were half 
 full of water, and the Indians had evidently been living for some 
 time in three large summer houses. Among other things lying 
 about, I noticed a large scoop or shovel shaped like a table-spoon, 
 but seven feet long. It was carved out of one piece of wood, 
 and ornamented with designs in red chalk and charcoal. It was 
 of very graceful shape, and had evidently been used for throwing 
 cut the ice from the aperture through which the fish-traps are 
 raised in winter. I noticed a small bowl prettily carved, with two 
 ears or handles. A long stick, to which a block of wood is 
 attached at one end, is used, with the bowl referred to, for grind- 
 ing up tobacco into snuff. My Indians were anxious to appro- 
 priate some of these articles, but I would not allow them to do 
 so in the absence of the owners. The paddles, many of which 
 were seen, were curiously painted with green, red, and black, and 
 were smaller and more pointed 'lan those in use farther up the 
 river. The paddles decrease ..i size as we go down the river; 
 those at the Yukon-mouth arc very small and narrow indeed. 
 We passed a very small waterfall during the day, the first I had 
 seen on the river. 
 
 On a small island we saw the first Indians. There were only 
 three or four, and they were much alarmed when they first saw 
 us. We landed, and found that they were making fish-traps. 
 They had nothing to sell except some eggs, and a few ukali, 
 which I bought for the dog. After making them a present of a 
 few leaves of tobacco, we pushed off and continued down the 
 river. 
 
 The boat was ill stowed, and a good deal of mud had gathered 
 in her bottom from our feet, so I determined to cami) early, turn 
 her over, and wash her thoroughly, after taking out the goods. 
 
tid 
 )e- 
 11s 
 
 ne 
 -d, 
 
 ig. 
 ed 
 
 >ut 
 
 alf 
 
 ■ne 
 
 ng 
 
 od, 
 /as 
 
 ng 
 are 
 wo 
 is 
 id- 
 ro- 
 do 
 ich 
 md 
 the 
 cr; 
 :cd. 
 lad 
 
 nly 
 
 ips. 
 :ali, 
 )f a 
 the 
 
 :rcd 
 urn 
 ods. 
 
f\ 
 
 <-m 
 
 V\ 1^ 
 
 lit! 
 
~^. 
 
 
 H 
 I 
 
 •< 
 -1 
 ■J. 
 
 THE YUKOX TERRITORY. 
 
 215 
 
 Nothing rots a bidarra like mud or dirt inside of it. We camped 
 near a small brook, and Kurilla started off after game, while we 
 attended to the boat, We finished cleaning her and gave her a 
 good oiling before getting supper ready. The three Indians pol- 
 ished the beaver's bones, while I regaled myself on a fat teal 
 roasted on a stick before the fire. 
 
 Sunday, Jth. — The day opened fair, but with the same wind, 
 which was soon attended by smart showers of rain. We pulled 
 along shore, and about ten o'clock came to the point where the 
 Russians had located a sort of rapid. It proved to be nothing 
 more than a piece of swift water, running along the base of a 
 range of low conglomerate blufts, for two or three miles. The 
 river here was quite broad ; to the right were successive hills, 
 rising one after another, and fading into purple distance. The 
 left bank was, as usual, low, and a large island divided the river 
 a few miles beyond. Kurilla said that the Indian name of the 
 place was Klan-ti-lin-tcn, meaning " rocks and strong water." 
 
 The Russians had reported a coal seam here, but the rocks are 
 conglomerate, preceded by trachyte of various colors, and fol- 
 lowed by beds of cla)', quartzite, and yellow gravel. 
 
 I landed to take the annexed sketch, and to examine the rocks. 
 While so doing, an arctic hare scampered by on the edge of the 
 bluff. Kurilla was too quick for her, however, and a shot from 
 my rifle brought her down. I was sorry afterward, when we 
 skinned the animal, to see that the teats were full of milk ; for it 
 showed that she had, somewhere, a family of little bunnies, who 
 would suffer and probably die for want of a mother. 
 
 We took tea at a small rivulet about noon, and concluded to 
 remain there until the wind fell somewhat. We scoured the small 
 lakes near the river for game, and came back to camp well loaded. 
 About sunset the wind became less violent, and we pushed a little 
 farther down stream, camping about nine o'clock. 
 
 Monday, St//. — As we slowly descended the river, we saw a few 
 Indians on the bank. They appeared to be shy, and indisposed 
 to meet us, but finally one of them put off in his canoe, and ex- 
 tended a bit of paper in the end of a long cleft stick. I took it, 
 and he immediately paddled away as fast as he could. It was a 
 bit of yellow tissue paper, carefully folded. I opened it, and after 
 removing several wrappings I came to a bit of white paper, ap- 
 
 
 
 n 
 
 1*1 
 
 ' I 
 
 hi \\ 
 
 5. 
 
 \H 
 
 « M 
 
 \ r 
 
 
2l6 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 J • 
 
 in 
 
 1! I Mf 
 
 parently the blank edge of a newspaper. On this was a rude 
 drawing of a boat, by its side a bottle, and under the drawing, in 
 a straggling hand, was written, " Isaac Koliak." 
 
 The meaning was evident. My intelligent Mahlemut friend 
 had crossed the portage from the seaboard to Anvi'k, not far be- 
 low on the Yukon, and was going down the Yukon on a trading- 
 voyage. He knew I was coming down the river, and sent this 
 note by one of the river Indians to inform me of his proximity. 
 We passed the northern entrance of the great Shageluk slough, 
 and continued down the main stream toward Anvi'k. There were 
 numerous large, well-wooded islands, and the mouth of the slough 
 might easily be overlooked. A little later we saw a camp on the 
 right bank, and, pulling toward it, soon recognized Isaac and his 
 party. They received us with the most lively demonstrations of 
 welcome, and declared their intention of going down the river 
 with us. The party comprised about thirty Mahlemuts, male and 
 female, and their children and dogs. Isaac told me that he had 
 crossed from Kegiktowruk late in the spring, with three large 
 bidarnis on sleds drawn by dogs, and had descended the Anvi'k 
 River after the ice had broken up. His intention was to descend 
 the Yukon, trading as he went, and to meet the American traders 
 who were expected at St. Michael's in the early summer. The 
 articles which they had brought for trade were principally skin 
 clothing of their own manufacture, needles, tobacco, guns, and am- 
 munition. They proposed to buy furs, and wooden dishes or kan- 
 tags, of Indian manufacture. The Innuit are accustomed to make 
 these voyages for the purpose of getting rid of their old guns and 
 
 K.inlags and wooden ladle. 
 
 surplus ammunition, at prices much higher than they pay for new 
 ones to the traders at Grantley Harbor and Kotzebue Sound. 
 The wooden ware is an article of trade with the Innuit of Bering 
 Strait, where wood suitable for the purpose does not grow. I 
 
n ';■ 
 
 ^ 
 
 \ I 
 
 \ 
 
ilii I ^ i < 
 
 A X V I K S T A U K E K. 
 "Dnc more leaf nftcbaccn." 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 217 
 
 took Isaac on board as a passenger, while his party got their 
 boats ready to follow us to Anvik. 
 
 We reached the mouth of the Anvi'k River about noon, and 
 pulled up the stream for a short distance, to the point where the 
 village is situated. Here both sides of the Yukon are rather 
 high. Not far below they become low and flat. The Yukon 
 widens, and here a series of sand-bars exists, which is the first ob- 
 struction to navigation as we ascend the river from the sea. 
 These bars change somewhat every year, but a native pilot can 
 find a five-foot channel during the lowest stage of the water in 
 the fall. Anvik is a large village, of some ten or twelve houses, 
 each of which may contain twenty inhabitants. The natives are 
 Ingaliks, but from constant intercourse and close pro.ximity to the 
 Innuit tribes of the coast, they have adopted many of the Innuit 
 customs. Among these, that of wearing labrets is most conspic- 
 uous. The language spoken is the true Ingalik, with no inter- 
 mixture of Innuit words, except such as are used to designate 
 objects which they obtain from the latter in trade, and for which 
 there are no Indian names. A jargon containing a large number 
 of words of both languages is used in trading. This is also used 
 in intercourse with the Russians, who understand something of 
 the Innuit dialects. This fact is a sufficient cause of miscompre- 
 hension in regard to the different dialects, and should be borne in 
 mind by philologists. A similar jargon is in use wherever the 
 Indians trade with the coast tribes. 
 
 We boiled the chynik, while I examined the village and took 
 notes of points of interest. The chief man of the village had 
 been hired by Isaac to descend the Shageluk and meet him at 
 the southern entrance ; but an old fellow who appeared to have a 
 good deal of influence came forward with two fish, which he pro- 
 posed to sell for tobacco. The price of a salmon is a leaf of 
 tobacco, on this part of the Yukon. He wantetl two leaves 
 apiece, complaining that it was early in the season and fish were 
 scarce, while the leaves were very small! His parka was almo t 
 deprived of hair by long use, his breeches were shiny witli 
 grease and dirt, which also incrusted his hands and face, while 
 the hair on his aged head, though cut short, stood erect as if in 
 protest against the invasion of so much raw material. He looked 
 so comic '. as he stood higgling for a leaf of tobacco, with his 
 

 ^ 
 
 t 
 
 'i 1 1 
 
 ;i!: 
 
 1' 1 
 
 ■ ' 1 ; 
 
 i ^^ • 
 
 . ' 1 
 
 u 
 
 1/ 
 
 2l8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 head on one side and his small eyes glistening with excitement, 
 that I gave him the price he asked, and made it square by taking 
 his portrait. Dirt was the prominent characteristic of the village. 
 The year before, we had touched here, and the space in front of 
 the houses was red with thousands of salmon, split and hung up to 
 dry. It was yet too early for the fish this season, and there were 
 many new baskets and nettings lying about, — the material for 
 projected fish-traps. Many of the inhabitants were absent, after 
 beaver. One man brought me ten fine marten, but asked so high 
 a price that I refused to buy them. The Stareek (old man) 
 brought me two marten and some mink, which I bought, but the 
 Mahlemuts had purchased most of the furs. Well armed, bold, 
 and numerous, the latter completely overawed the degraded, fish- 
 eating Indians, and forced them to sell whatever they had, at the 
 purchaser's price. 
 
 I noticed that the graves or coffins here, instead of being 
 covered with logs, as farther up the river, were filled in with 
 earth beaten down hard and plastered over with clay. They 
 were larger, rattier more elevated, and painted more after the In- 
 nuit fashion than those farther up on the Yukon. 
 
 I saw quite a number of clay pots and cups of native manu- 
 facture here. They were mostly large, holding three or four gal- 
 lons, but some were smaller, and one was evidently modelled after 
 
 Indian pottery. 
 
 a Russian mug. The common Innuit lamp is also made of clay, 
 and all their pottery is rudely ornamented with lines, dots, and 
 crosses. They are about three quarters of an inch thick, of a dark 
 bluish clay, and were perfectly black from smoke and grease. I 
 would have purchased some of them, but they were so large and 
 so exceedingly dirty that I did not care to put them in the boat. 
 This kind of pottery was formerly universal, but has been super- 
 seded by the kettles of the traders. The pots are made by hand, 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 219 
 
 and therefore not perfectly round or symmetrical. They are 
 dried in the sun, then baked, and will stand the fire very well. 
 The Innuit name for the pots isAtkusik, for the saucers or lamps 
 Nniiuk, and for the cups hn-oivnn. 
 
 We left Anvi'k soon after drinking our tea, with Isaac on board. 
 The wind was so high that we could not cross the river, and rain 
 coming on, we soon camped on a small island. The other boats 
 crossed to the other side, and we lost sight of them. Starting 
 from camp, I saw and killed a large sand-hill crane. These birds 
 are plenty on the Lower Yukon. I have seen thousands of them, 
 but never of any color except brown, gray, and fawn color. 
 White ones are unknown, and I doubt the correctness of the 
 theory which considers the white crane of the Mississippi valley 
 and the sand-hill crane to be one species. 
 
 Tuesday, ()th. — The rain ceasing, we passed down the river 
 and entered a long slough or cut-off. Near noon we stopped and 
 took tea. Soon after, we came to an Ingalik camp where they 
 were making birch canoes. The birches of the Lower Ingaliks 
 are very different from those of the Upper Yukon Indians. The 
 
 IiiKalik birch canoe. 
 
 rough waters of the broad river need a stronger canoe than those 
 used by the Kutchin tribes. Everything is carefully carved and 
 smoothed. The frame is stout and strong, and ornamented with 
 red paint. The bark is shaped over a mound of the e.\act size of 
 the proposed canoe, and sewed with spruce roots. The cut rep- 
 resents the canoe before the gum is placed over the sewing. 
 The paddles are lance-shaped, small and slender, and ornamented 
 with the most fantastic figures, in red, black, and green. I ex- 
 pressed a desire to see the green pigment, and one of the Indians 
 produced some. It was a sort of fungus (/Vr/.c^z) or mould, which 
 j)enetrates decayed birch wood and colors it a deep bluc-grcen. 
 I bought a small model of a canoe, from which the above figure is 
 drawn. There were seven large canoes nearly finished, and 
 several in process of manufacture. The Ingaliks take fleets of 
 
 I 
 
 1} 
 
 if 
 
 ^\ 
 
 *' 
 
 'I' M 
 
 !':• 
 
 \ 
 
 i' 
 
 ii 
 
 Ml 
 
 i 
 
 ' 
 
IP II^J,P««I,PIII llp 
 
 
 220 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 /I 
 
 !' 
 
 I Kv, 
 
 In 
 
 'T 
 
 M 
 
 these new canoes clown to the delta in the fall, and trade them 
 to the river Innuit for oil, ivory, boot-soles, and other articles, 
 Isaac expressed a great desire to take one of the little model 
 canoes to his baby, and I bought one for him, to his great delight. 
 We also purchased some fish and berries, and went on our way. 
 We passed a large winter village between two hills, known to the 
 Russians as the Murderer's Village. Crossing the Yukon about 
 three o'clock, we came to the southern entrance of the Shagcluk 
 slough. Ascending a little way, we reached the Leather Village 
 of the Russians. This is a large Ingalik summer village, the 
 inhabitants in winter living at the last-mentioned settlement. 
 Here we saw the cotton tents of the Mahlemut camp near the 
 Indian houses. Isaac's wife stood on the bank, holding the baby, 
 which crowed and exhibited all its infantile joy at seeing its 
 father, who still further delighted this jaromising member of the 
 family by producing the toy canoe. 
 
 We left the boat in the water, and took only our tent, cooking 
 utensils, and blankets ashore, as the number of natives was so 
 great that I thought it the safest way, especially as these Indians 
 have a reputation for stealing. Leaving one man on the watch, I 
 strolled into the village. The amount of food collected here was 
 almost inconceivable. Large stages were groaning beneath the 
 weight offish, caught and dried the previous season. Long lines 
 were strung with fresh white-fish, drying in the sun. Rows of 
 caches full of dry fish, meat, fat, and skins of oil, showed that 
 hunger need not exist in this favored locality. 
 
 The fresh meat of three or four moose, just killed, was lying in 
 one pile ; another contained the haunches and shoulders of ten 
 deer. Every few minutes a canoe half full of fresh white-fish 
 would arrive from the fish-traps, and in no part of the Indian 
 country have I ever seen food so plentiful and so easily obtained. 
 I was informed that the natives had quite a trade with those from 
 other places, who came to buy I'lkali in the winter and spring. 
 The summer houses were large and well built. The walls even 
 of the caches were thick, and in many cases pierced with loop- 
 holes for guns. There were but few dogs about, and I noticed a 
 large white-breasted thrush tied by the leg, and apparently quite 
 tame. I tried to buy the bird, which I had not seen elsewhere, 
 but the owner could not be found. The Indians told me that 
 
 c 
 
! 
 
 THE YUKON TERKITORV. 
 
 221 
 
 Teleczliik, the old Russian interpreter, had been there the previous 
 day, and was now trading; for furs farther up the Sh;igehili. I re- 
 turned to my tent, and bought a lot of fresh meat and some fat. 
 Isaac came up and said that his brother hail come with him, and 
 had a little liquor which he had bought of the traders, but not 
 enough to make a " good drunk." " Now," saitl he " we want you 
 to sell us your whiskey, and we will pay you well for it, with furs 
 or anything you want." During my absence the rascals had dis- 
 covered a can of alcoholic specimens in the boat, and supposed it 
 was whiskey. I told him that I wanted it myself, that it was not 
 good to drink, &c., but he went away very sulky. The Mahle- 
 muts, male and female, now dressed themselves in the n-^nv fur 
 clotli i'g which they had brought to sell. Old Abraham, Isaac's 
 father, commenced drumming, and the rest .soon began one of their 
 characteristic dances. Those who did not dance raised the old 
 "Ung-hi-yah" chorus and kept time, clapping their hands. It 
 was a sight to remember. Ten or fifteen clean, handsome, stal- 
 wart Innuit, going through the graceful gesticulations of their 
 national dance, dressed in new and handsomely trimmed parkies 
 of every variety of skin, — with the tall poplars and spruce for a 
 backgi'.und, a fire on one side, and above the genial twilight of 
 the Cliz'^c night. Their wild chorus added to the charm of the 
 scene. Around them in a wide oval were huddled the well-fed 
 but filthy Indians. Their skin clothing was hairless from long 
 use, and while almost dropping off them from decay, glistened 
 with vermin. Degradation, filth, stupidity, fear, and wonder 
 marked their features. The meanest of the Innuit far surpassed 
 the best of them in strength and manliness. Their miserable 
 condition was due in great measure to their sedentary habits, 
 constant fish diet, and natural indolence. Very few had guns at 
 all, and those which they did have were old, worn out, and nearly 
 worthless. The Ingaliks who live farther up the Shdgeluk arc 
 said to be more intelligent and active, probably because they sub- 
 sist on the deer and moose which they are obliged to hunt. Af- 
 ter the jMahlemuts had concluded their dance they distributed 
 tobacco in small pieces to the bystanders. I repaired to my tent, 
 took supper, and putting the alcohol-can, for safety, into the tent, 
 lay down to rest. I had not got asleep, when I heard something 
 crash against the tent-pins, breaking down two of them. At the 
 
 if 
 I 
 
 i 
 
 \ 
 
 I 
 
222 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 m 
 
 
 li. 
 
 hi-' 
 
 same time, Kuri'lla shouted to me from outside that the Mahle- 
 muts were after the alcohol. I shouted back to look sharp, as 
 they would not get it while I had a loaded gi n. I pulled on my 
 boots, seized my revolver, which lay by my head, and threw back 
 the flap of the tent. There stood a Mahlemut with his hand on 
 the trigger, and the muzzle of his gun about two feet from my 
 breast. At the same moment, Kurilla's long arm jerked the gun 
 from his hands, and flung it far away among the bushes. 
 
 I stepped out of the tent, and the Mahlemuts slunk away with- 
 out a word. They were intoxicated, having drunk the liquor of 
 which Isaac had spoken. The In;uans had hidden themselves, 
 while my men, guns in hand, stood near the tent. If the Mahle- 
 muts had been sober, they would not have b^ihaved so. It was a 
 narrow escape, which I hardly realized at the time. The in- 
 truders retired to their tents, seeing us armed and ready for any- 
 thing. The Indians now mustered courage enough to come out, 
 and the chief came to mc and begged me, with many bows and 
 deprecatory gestures, to remove my camp, as he was afraid there 
 would be trouble yet. " You know these Innuit are so very 
 bad, so horribly bad, such beasts, worse than dogs," said he, al- 
 most with tears in his eyes. No doubt he was thinking of the 
 miserable gun which they had just given him for twenty fine 
 marten skins, which he dared not refuse them. I consulted with 
 Kurilla, and then told the '^hief that we would move our camp to 
 the island in the middle of the river, and if any one wished to 
 trade meat or fur they would find us there. The tent and other 
 traps were thrown into the boat, and we pulled across a very swift 
 curi-ent to the island. Just as we hauled up the boat, Kurilla shot 
 a swan who was sailirg slowly overhead, and taking the little 
 canoe, he started do'.vn stream alter it. Some Indians came over 
 with beaver skins and tails, which I purchased ; and I hired one of 
 them to act as sentinel during the night, with a good fire to keep 
 off the mosquitoes. When Kiu-i'lla returned we gave our watch- 
 man the swan to pick, to keep him awake, and turning in, were 
 soon lost \,\ slunil)er. 
 
 ]Vt'tiiics(/(tj', \ot/i. — We pushed out into the rapid current very 
 early in the di.y, while we saw nothing more of our Innuit friends, 
 who were probably sleeping off their headaches. We ]nilled hard, 
 lioping 'o reach the Mission before night. We pass ;d a village 
 
 II v/ 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 223 
 
 of two houses, called Manki, interesting principally as being the 
 most inland Innuit village on the Yukon. The difference of 
 stock was apparent only from the countenances of the natives 
 and the dialect which they spoke. The latter exhibited no signs 
 of any mixture of Indian words. It was quite incomjirehensible 
 to my men, who had been able to conver.se freely at the last vil- 
 lage. I could understand only a few words, which resembleil the 
 Mahlemut, though the grammatical construction was the same as 
 that of the other Innuit dialect.s. These natives belong to the 
 Ekogmut (sometimes called Ki^'iklipagviut) tribe, and are known 
 
 First Premo'^k.i village. 
 
 to the Russians as Pir-morski, or " dwellers near the sea." They 
 extend to the seaboard, on both sides of the river. Tluir habits 
 in general are similar to those of the coast Iniuiit already de- 
 scribed, but are a little modified by their situatiun on a river, 
 which presents some conditions whicli do not ol)tain on the sea- 
 shore. Tlu'v are at peace witii the adjacent Indians, probably 
 as much because both are miserable cowards, as from any other 
 reason. 
 
 As we saiU'd ilown the rivi'r, an old fellow in a small bidarni 
 came out from a river which entered the Yukon horn tin; west, 
 
 
 ■ 
 
 \ \ 
 
 1 
 
 " ''" 1^ 
 
 \ ' !^^ 
 
 ■ ! fi 
 
 
 n 
 
 
 
 '\ 
 
 1 ,(, 
 ! I 
 
 ;il' 
 
 j.r: 
 
 IP 
 I 
 
 -t 'S 
 
 i 
 
 ill; 
 
 '1 
 
 1 
 
 ! 
 ; 
 
 1 
 
 I 
 
 n 
 
 LM 
 
 ii 
 
li 
 
 t 
 
 224 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 
 and brou<jht some cranberries for sale. A great difference is 
 noticeable between the villages on the Upper and those on the 
 Lower Yukon. Below, we find large, solid, permanent houses, 
 gayly painted paddles, and great abundance of skin boats, the 
 prows of which are frequently fashioned to resemble the head of 
 some beast or bird ; above, the dwellings are at best miserable 
 huts, tents, or temporary shelters made of brush. Dirt, and a defi- 
 ciency of the ornamental, mark the upper villages, while the only 
 boats are the frail and carelessly made birch canoes. A little 
 farther on we met a three-holed bidarka with a Creole from the 
 Mission in it. He was going to the small river we had just 
 passed, to try and hire the bidarra from the natives, for a trip to 
 the Redoubt. He gave us some goose-eggs, and went on his way. 
 We kept on until eight o'clock in the evening, and finding that 
 we could not reach the Mission within several hours, camped at a 
 native settlement, called by the Russians Loon-cap Village. We 
 pitched our tent near a small brook, and soon had the kettle on 
 the fire. This village presented many points of interest. The 
 number of inhabitants was only eight or ten, the remainder 
 having died. This decrease in population is noteworthy along 
 the Lower Yukon. ICverywhere there are fewer natives than 
 formerly. The decrease is partly due to lung diseases, which 
 arise from their habit of drawing the smoke of the Circassian 
 tobacco into the lungs. In this particular village, within a gen- 
 eration, there had been several hundred inhabitants. There were 
 eight large summer houses, in each of which a hundred people 
 might have been comfortably accommodated. These houses 
 were built of immense planks, hewn out of single logs with stone 
 adzes. Many of these planks were four inches thick, and three 
 feet wide by twelve feet long. The houses were in a miserable 
 state of decay. Water stood in some of them, and only one or 
 two were habitable. The rafters were carved into rude imitations 
 of animals, and still retained traces of the red earth with whicii 
 they had been painted. The graves were the most conspicuous 
 and remarkable part of the village. They exceeded any I have 
 ever seen on the Yukon, in intricacy of ornament, variety of de- 
 sign, and in their number compared with the size of the village. 
 T1k:\' were on the hillside, a little way above the houses. I no- 
 ticed that they were not covered wit'i logs or slabs of wood like 
 

 THE YUKOxN TERRITORY. 
 
 225 
 
 tis 
 
 lus 
 
 the Ingalik graves, nor with earth and clay like those at An- 
 vi'k, but were filled with earth over the body, and then carefully 
 covered with pieces of birch bark, held down by heavy stones. 
 The supports of the box were immediately underneath it, and 
 large balustei-like standards ornamented the corners. Many of 
 the boxes were carefully fitted, smoothed, and painted with va- 
 rious designs. Some had fur animals depicted on them, showing 
 that the dead person was a successful trapper. Others had the 
 bear, deer, and other animals, denoting the graves to be those of 
 hunters. Fish, birds, pictures of seal and beluga hunting, were 
 painted with the usual red pigment on others. Many were 
 studded with pegs of ivory or bone ; some were surrounded by a 
 carefully carved and painted railing. Drums, kantags, paddles, 
 bows of tremendous size bound with sinew, arrows of bone carved 
 into intricate lace-work, quite different from anything I have seen 
 elsewhere, strings of beads, belts, pieces of brass scratched with 
 patterns, kettles, and other articles of use and ornament were 
 attached to many of the coffins. On posts in front of some of 
 them were separate pieces of wood-carving, such as masks re- 
 sembling the human face, and trimmed with wolfskin, carved 
 human heads, beavers transfixed with arrows, fish, beluga, and 
 boats with men in them, all variously painted. 
 
 The ethnologist would find a wide field in the vicinity of this 
 village alone. The few inhabitants had a melancholy cast of 
 countenance, as if conscious that they were living among the re- 
 mains of the ingenuity of their ancestors, which they could not 
 hope to emulate. They were successful in hunting ; that very 
 day a bear and three deer were killed, with nothing but arrows, a 
 few rods from the houses. The men wore dresses of birdskins, 
 which are common on the Lower Yukon. Some of them had 
 ca|)s made of the skin of a loon or hawk, with the breast above, 
 the head still attached and hanging down behind, and the wings 
 on either side. The vegetation was luxuriant. I forced my 
 way to the vicinity of the graves through a growth of grass and 
 weeds four feet high. Care was necessary to avoid falling into 
 excavations, the sole remains of ancient winter houses long since 
 rotteil away. 
 
 I bought some fresh venison, and after a hearty supper we 
 turned in. 
 
 15 
 
 I! t 
 il' 
 
 :ii 
 
 ri I 
 
 >!i 
 
 -ill 
 
226 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 / 
 
 ; t 
 
 Tlmrsday, nth. — After collecting a few plants, among which 
 were the blossoms of black and red currants, we pushed off on 
 our way to the Mission. The trees had already become less 
 abundant, especially on the right bank. The latter was pretty 
 high in many places, and trachytic rocks were observed. In 
 some places the river is exceedingly wide, and once or twice, 
 when we were in the current close to the right bank, the left 
 bank was quite invisible. A broad, smooth sheet of water 
 stretched to the west, undisturbed by any ripples, and not broken 
 by islands or dry sand-bars. The scene strongly impressed upon 
 the observer the majesty of the great river upon which we were 
 travelling. About ten o'clock the basaltic rocks indicated the 
 proximity of the Mission, and hoisting the American flag and 
 that of the Scientific Corps, we rounded a point, and the build- 
 ings came into view. The water near the shore was shallow, 
 and we had some difficulty in hauling in our heavily loaded 
 boat. We fired a gun, and were saluted in return by the Rus- 
 sians. 
 
 We found that the missionary of the Greek Church in the 
 District of St. Michael's (commonly known to the Russians as 
 the Pope) was on the point of starting for the Redoubt. He 
 had dismantled the church of everything valuable, and had nailed 
 up the door. At his request I took an inventory of the houses 
 and articles of furniture he left behind, as he hoped to sell them 
 to the Americans when they arrived. He then applied for med- 
 ical advice, and gave a lengthy description of his personal mis- 
 eries, which were all clearly referrible to an undue indulgence in 
 alcoholic stimulants. This, I believe, in the Greek Church is 
 not considered to detract from the holiness of its ecclesiastics. 
 All of those I have met with in Alaska and Kamchatka were 
 inveterate topers. He told me that he had been seven years a 
 missionary on the Yukon, and that he thanked God that he now 
 had an opportunity of returning to Russia, where a glass of rum 
 might be had for twenty-five ko])eks (five cents). I cautioned 
 him against iMiriuiii tiriiwiis, and bade him good by. His Creole 
 servant, who accompanied him to St. Michael's, had a very 
 pretty wife, and I doubted if something more than a fatlierly 
 benediction did not lurk in the kiss Father Larriown gave her 
 just before he embarked. 
 
 hi 
 
^(1 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 227 
 
 The other Russians at the Mission were Milavanoflf the bidar- 
 shik, and Goldsen, who had been acting as secretary. Mila- 
 vanoff was a good trader, but an invalid from liver complaint, 
 which is common among the Russians in this country. He gave 
 me a good supply of bread, as my own was nearly exhausted, and 
 I made him a present of my Derringer, to which he had taken a 
 fancy. I was sorry to find that I could not get an interpreter 
 here, as the Innuit dialect of the delta was incomprehensible to 
 all of our party. The buildings at the Mission, except a new 
 house of Milavanoft''s and one belonging to the Pope, are very 
 rotten and miserable. The place is a very unhealthy one. 
 It is situated between two hills which shelter it completely from 
 the wind. Several pools of stagnant water are close by. The In- 
 dian village is very filthy, and their 
 refuse from fish and other matters 
 is everywhere scattered about. I 
 counted si.\ dead dogs among the 
 bushes, and close to the houses there 
 is a large number of graves, both 
 Russian and native. Some of the 
 latter were curious, and were fur- 
 nished with the baluster-like sup- 
 ports before mentioned. 
 
 We emptied our boat, turned her over, gave her a good oiling, 
 and left her to dry. This is imperatively necessary when travel- 
 ling in skin boats, and .should be done at least once in ten days, 
 if possible. We all took a good steam bath, which was a great 
 lu.xury. Once, farther up the Yukon, I had tried the experiment 
 of bathing in the river, but the water was .so cold that only a 
 single plunge was endurable. In this part of the river the water 
 is so muddy that it adds nothing to one's cleanliness to bathe 
 in it. 
 
 Friday, \2tl1. — After securing a number of specimens, grind- 
 ing our a.xes, and performing a variety of similar small jobs, we 
 again j)roceede(l on our way. Just below the Mission we saw a 
 native attacking a beaver with one of their bone tridents. Ku- 
 rilla started to his assistance, in the canoe, with his gun ; after a 
 little while they returned, and I bouglit the animal, as it lay, for 
 three bunches of Circassian tobacco. We kept on all night, as 
 
 ICkogmut grave. 
 
 \ 
 
 \ 
 
 ^J 
 
 
 
 \ 
 
 \' 
 
 
 \ 
 
 i 
 
 i.V 
 
 
 ^1 
 
 
 m 
 
 ■■ \ 
 
 ■t 
 
 \ 
 
 1^1 
 
 'ft 
 
 m 
 
 1 
 
 n 
 
 \ 
 
 i:! 
 
 I! 
 
 a 
 
 I 
 
228 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 .• ,^;> 
 
 the air is cooler than in the clay, and there is no darkness, though 
 the sun goes a little below the horizon. No stars were visible all 
 night. 
 
 Saturday, \yli. — About midnight we rounded the Great IJend. 
 Here we met the head-wind blowing in our teeth with redoubled 
 force. For all the use they had been, so for, we might as well 
 have left the mast and sail at NuUito. At the l^end we found a 
 camp of natives who were waiting for the wind to subside. They 
 had nothing for .sale except a few mink and some eggs. I bought 
 some swan's eggs for scientific purposes, and also a bow of the 
 kind in use in the Yukon delta. These bows are made of spruce, 
 which has little elasticity when dry, and is very liable to break. 
 To remedy this defect the bow is bound with cord."! twisted from 
 deer sinew, as shown in the annexed figure. This gives it great 
 
 ((| 
 
 r 
 
 ia=: 
 
 -51 
 
 rSfc 
 
 1 M 
 
 Kkoi;imit bow. 
 
 Strength, and overcomes the briliicness of the wood. We took tea 
 in a slough, and about noon stopped at a village where the inhab- 
 itants were engaged in fishing. It is only by personal inspection 
 of such a village that any one can obtain an adequate idea of the 
 immense quantity of fish which is annually caught and dried on 
 the Lower Yukon. Several acres of ground in front of the sum- 
 mer houses were literally covered with standards and stages bear- 
 ing line after line of fish, split and hung u]) to dry. The odor is 
 borne to a great distance by the wind. The dogs, children, and 
 other inhabitants of the village, during the fishing-season, recall 
 the old lines, — 
 
 "Jcslninin he \va.\r(l fat. 
 And down liis clieek.s they luinj^ ! " 
 
 while the long rows of caches are crammed with provisions for the 
 winter. This condition of things holds good as far as Anvi'k. 
 Beyond that point the fish are scarcer, and, as previously related, 
 Nulato is far from fiu-nishing food of any kind in plenty. In the 
 foreground the dilferent parts of fish-traps were lying, in readi- 
 
b 
 
 V ; i .;ii 
 
 ''I; 
 
 •* 
 
 ": 
 
 :.»* 
 
 . itti 
 ■ w 
 
 f' 
 
 } 1 
 

 1 
 
 W 
 
 I 
 
 hi: ,te 
 
 i 
 
 I) 
 
 
 1 1, 
 
 ih 
 
 ;:u 
 
 1 
 
 :i 
 
 I 
 
 i 
 
 II 
 
 I 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 229 
 
 ness to repair any damage, or put down a new trap, if the water 
 fell so as to render it necessary. Here some men were emptying 
 the fish out of a basket, and there others were returning with a 
 canoe-load of salmon from some distant zapor. 
 
 We bought a few whitefish, and some mink. I saw two red fox 
 cubs with collars, tied to stakes in some of the houses. These 
 were apparently intended to amuse the children. We then 
 departed, and finally camped on a sand-bar which was literally 
 alive with wild fowl. We were now getting into the region 
 where they abound, during the spring and summer, in myriads. 
 The report of a gun will often raise such immense flocks of geese 
 as literally to darken the air ; sometimes a flock will be four or five 
 miles long, and two or three rods wide, flying as close together 
 as they can with safety. Swans whitened the surface of several 
 lagoons, and from them down to the tiniest snipe, not weighing 
 more than an ounce, every kind of wild fowl abounded in pro- 
 fusion. Their eggs were scattered over the sand-bars, and a 
 hatful could be obtained on any beach. On attempting to empty 
 the swan's-eggs which I had purchased the day before, by means 
 of a blow-pipe, they resisted all my efforts. On breaking them, 
 what was my surprise at finding that they had been hard boiled 
 by the natives, to keep them from spoiling ! 
 
 The real work of the season had been well commenced at Nulato, 
 but partially suspended since we left, as we had procured but few 
 birds new to the collection, since leaving that point. Now I iiad 
 my hands full, and leaving the task of navigating to Kuri'lla, I was 
 constantly occupied skinning the birds which we obtained at 
 every turn. I passed many a night without getting an hour's 
 sleep, in order that rare birds might be preserved ; and the work 
 of preparing birdskins is anything but a pleasant one. The 
 results to be obtained for natural history were so great, that it 
 was impossible to grudge a moment of time so spent, or to neglect 
 any opi)ortunity of ackling to the note-book or the collection. 
 
 Sunday, \/^t/i. — Passed the Rasbinik village, where I bought a 
 marten-skin and a haunch of reindeer meat. The natives here 
 always cut a small piece off every skin after selling it, for luck 
 as they say. Toward night we reached the village of Starry (old) 
 Kwikhpak. Here I found a man named \'aska, who hatl been 
 interpreter at Andreafifsky. I explained to him that I wished to 
 
 u 
 
 (I 
 li 
 
 ij 
 
 •!H 
 
 .-.M'.i 
 
 1m 
 
 ^!' 
 
 
 ■ f 
 
230 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 visit the Kusilvak Slough, and obtain eggs and skins of the 
 beautiful emperor goose i^Cldocphaga axnagica), which breeds in 
 abundance there, and there only. He could not go himself, but 
 obtained a boy who knew the way, and explained to him what I 
 wanted. The village was full of fresh skins of the reindeer fawn. 
 I counted a thousand and seventy-two bunches hanging up to 
 dry. Each bunch contained four skins, or enough to make a 
 parka. This would give a total of nearly four thousand three 
 hundred of these little creatures, which had been killed during 
 the past two months. The village contained a great deal of dry 
 meat and fish, but the inhabitants were squalid and dirty. I saw 
 
 ,1 I 
 
 
 m 
 
 Aiulreaffsky. 
 
 a tame owl sitting on one of the rafters, and a few marten-skins 
 were hanging on a cache. I bought an otter-skin of the finest 
 quality, for four bunches of Circassian tobacco. Not wishing to 
 camp in such a dirty place, we proceeded a little way down the 
 river with our guide, and camped. 
 
 Monday, IS///. — While collecting in the morning, I found cow- 
 slips in blos.som on the marshes, and obtained the eggs of the 
 beautiful white-winged gull. The long-continued and never-tir- 
 ing head-wind was stronger than usual this morning. To avoid 
 it, we entered a long slough, where we took tea, and I collected 
 many yellow butterflies {Picris vctiosa Scud.), the only species 
 
h 
 
 THE YUKON TKRRITORV. 
 
 231 
 
 which I noticed un the Yukon near the sea. About one o'clock 
 we emerged from the slough, and ,it this point killed several 
 geese. The waves were very high, and after an hour's hard pull- 
 ing we passed the mouth of the INIilavanoff River, and finally 
 reached Andreaffsky Fort. It vas quite deserted. The solitary 
 fort, with the window.^ all nailed up, the bare hills, and cloudy 
 sky, made the place seem more lonely and dreary than ever. 
 We hauled up the boat, and boiled the chynik, and rested until 
 the wind should abate a little. 
 
 Andreaffsky was built in the form of a square, the buildings 
 making two of the sides, and a stockade the other two. It con- 
 tained barracks, a store, magazine, cook-house and bath-house. 
 It was erected about the year 1853. In 1855 it was the scene of 
 a mournful tragedy. There was formerly an Ekognuit village 
 near the fort. Several of the natives were workmen at the fort. 
 No trouble had ever occurred. Several of the garrison had gone 
 up to Nulato with the annual provision-boat, and only the bidar- 
 shik and one Russian, besides th ■ native workmen, were left in the 
 fort. One Friday in August, the natives attacked the Russians 
 as they came naked out of the bath, and killed them with clubs 
 and knives. A Creole boy escaped to the hills, and finally crossed 
 the portage to the vicinity of St. Michael's. When he reached that 
 point the Uprovah'sha was away, and his secretary, Ivan Kogen- 
 ikotf, was acting in his stead. 
 
 The Russians had long murmured at the conduct of the Com- 
 pany, in leaving unavenged the Nulato massacre. The oppor- 
 tunity of settling accounts with the natives was too tempting 
 to resist. Kogenikoff and Gregory Ivanhoff, with two Creoles, 
 immediately started for the fort. On reaching it they found 
 everything in confusion. The dead bodies lay at the tloor of 
 the bath-house. The natives, not knowing how to use flour, 
 had merely carried off the sacks. They had also ripped open 
 the beds, and carried away the ticking, while the mass of 
 flour and feathers was left on the floor. After satisfying them- 
 selves that there was no living thing in the fort, the Russians 
 started for the village, which was about a mile otf. As they ap- 
 proached, Kogenikoff saw a man standing in the door of one of the 
 houses and pointing a gun at the approaching partv. It after- 
 ward turned out that the gun had no lock ; but not knowing this, 
 
 i! ill 
 
 U 
 
 J 
 
 
 M 
 
 r > 
 
 
 ir 
 
 
 
m 
 
 r, J' 
 I' J\ 
 
 let- iiJ 
 
 
 I: ^' 
 
 .i^''^' 
 
 •i ! i 
 
 232 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 the Russians fired, and killed the man. The natives, who were 
 few in number, came rushing out, and were shot down without 
 mercy. The Creoles, who, when aroused, have all the ferocity of 
 the aboriginal savage, attacked the shaman and beat out his 
 brains with clubs. None were spared. The blood shed at the 
 fort was not yet dry, and the infuriated Russians resolved that 
 the authors of that cowardly outrage should be e.\terminated 
 without mercy. When they stayed their hands the work was 
 done. Fathers, mothers, and children had passed their " evil 
 quarter of an hour." The result was wonderful. From that day 
 to this not a native on the Lower Yukon has lifted his hand 
 against the whites. The bloody lesson was not thrown away. 
 The strong hand, which alone commands the respect of savages, 
 was worth a thousand missionaries. To this day the natives trav- 
 elling on the river near the fort pass by on the other side. Large 
 quantities of tobacco and other property, stolen from the fort, were 
 found in the village. Around the necks of most of the dead, 
 crosses were found hanging, indicating that the thieves and mur- 
 derers were baptized converts of the Yukon Mission. 
 
 The only articles remaining in the fort at the time of our visit 
 were three si.x-pounders, and some old iron. Toward evening, 
 though the river was still very rough, we embarked, and by keep- 
 ing close to the bank managed to travel several miles farther. 
 The white dome of the Kusilvak mountain loomed up grandly to 
 the southwest. Ju'<t south of it is a shallow slough which leads 
 into the south slough of the delta. This is navigable only for 
 bidarkas. The trees were now reduced to low willows, and the 
 level character of the country to the north and west showed that 
 we had passed all the mountains. A few low hills still fringed 
 the right bank, but the general level of the country was only 
 a few feet above the sea. We finally camped on the bank of a 
 small stream, which our guide said was called Egg River. 
 The evening was cold and raw, the sky cloudy and sombre, and 
 the vegetation far less advanced than that a hundred miles 
 inland. Fragments of ice, the remains of huge blocks left by the 
 freshet, still lay on the shore. 
 
 Tuesday, \6tli. — The whole morning we pulled against a 
 strong steady head-wind. We passed into a narrow sl()u;,di, and 
 by a turn to the northward were able for tlie fust time to use our 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 233 
 
 sail. Convinced that we were passing the mouth of the Kusilvak, 
 we crossed to the other side of the river. Two hours were con- 
 sumed in doing this, although we made at least three knots and a 
 half an hour. The aspect of the country, Hat, marshy, and 
 muddy, was truly desolate. We saw immense numbers of wild 
 fowl in the distance, but no other animals. We camped on the 
 left bank, and I noticed that the mice in winter, crawling along 
 the surface of the snow, had gnawed the bark from the willows 
 full si.\ feet above the ground. This would indicate that the 
 snow falls at least to that depth. A few warblers were building 
 their nests in the thickets, and I noticed the tracks of mink along 
 the muddy beach. 
 
 IVaiiicsday, I'Jtli. — Our guide to my astonishment insisted on 
 crossing the river again. As none of us understood the Pre- 
 morska dialect, we were unable to find out what his intentions 
 were. About noon we stopped at a small island and collected 
 about fifty eggs of the water-hen {Mcrgiis scrrator). They were 
 laid under logs, without any lining to the nest, and covered care- 
 fully with dry leaves and down. The parent birds flew, scream- 
 ing, round the island, out of gunshot. About half an hour alter, 
 our guide brought us to the mouth of the Uphoon ! I recognized 
 the place immediately, and by referring to my vocalnilaries 
 managed to make out that he had supposed this was our desti- 
 nation, and that he knew nothing about the Kusilvak. This was 
 a great disappointment to me, as I had hoped to obtain large 
 numbers of the eggs and skins of the Emperor goose. However, 
 there was nothing to be done but to make the best of it. I paid 
 him, and he started homeward, while we kei)t on our way through 
 the Uphoon. The small beaches were plentifully strewn with 
 eggs. The most common were those of Hutchin's goose, llie 
 white-winged gull, and the pin-tail duck. I had instructed Ku- 
 rilla in the manufacture of omelets, and thev now formed part 
 of every meal. The egg-shells were carefully cm|)tic(l witii a 
 blowpipe and devoted to science, while the contents went into 
 the frying-pan. We camped on a high bank, which bore the re- 
 mains of many native camp-fires, and just before turning in I was 
 fortunate enough to shoot a fine specimen of the beautiful red- 
 necked loon. The Uphoon is an excellent collecting ground, but 
 the emperor goose is seldom seen there. 
 
 i.l 
 
 
 ; \ 
 
 ti', 
 i I 
 
 \\ 
 
 '\ 
 
 : 
 
 i • '■ 
 
 : < < 
 
!34 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 Tluirsday. iS///. — We started kite, alter unlimited omelet, and 
 rowed slowly through the various windings of the slough. 
 Now and then we stopped to collect eggs or specimens, and the 
 boat was fau'ly covered with our feathered prizes. We passed 
 oMe deserted native h'Aise, and about dark arrived safel)' at Kut- 
 lik. This settlement consists of one house, built by a Russian 
 called Ananyan, containing a Ii\'ing-room, kitchen, and bath-room, 
 under one roof; a single Innuit barnibora stands near it, and a 
 great cache, the largest in the country, has been erected behind 
 the house. The house was entirely empty, and had such a smoky 
 smell that I decided to sleep in the tent, and only to do my bird- 
 
 hi Hi/. 
 
 
 Kiitllk. 
 
 skinning inside, where there was room to spread out the skins 
 to thy. I proposed to spend several days here, and to send 
 the Indians out shooting, while I kept at work preparing the speci- 
 mens. Ananyan, with his family, was away in the Kusilwik, where 
 he was salting chowi'chec {Sahiio oviattalis Pall.) for Stepiinoff. 
 
 The ne.\t day I busied myself repacking the specimens which 
 had been collected on the road. I sent out all the Indians with 
 liberal sui)plies of powder and shot, and promised ten balls as a 
 present to whoever should bring in one of the mnch-desired geese. 
 I blew about five dozen eggs during the day which is an under- 
 taking to be appreciated only by those who have tried it. To- 
 
 l\\ 
 
7 
 
 'L^ 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 235 
 
 ward evening it rained, and I moved everything from the tent 
 into the house, except my blankets. The men came back loaded 
 with game, and the indefatigable KuriUa, with an unwonted smile 
 on his sober face, unfoldetl a piece of cotton and brought out a 
 magnificent old gander of the right sort. The golden tips to the 
 snowy feathers of the head, the beautiful "ashe.s-of-ro.ses" color 
 of the body, marked with half-moons of black, gave it the undis- 
 puted right to its proud title of the Emperor, or, in Russian, 
 
 Ca'sdr-hl. 
 
 WJm^-^. 
 
 ,«wW>^— 
 
 The Ef^peror noose. 
 
 The following day and ihe one after that were spent much 
 in th.e '^■•ne way. I was busy preserving and packing the 
 skins, while the Indians were constantly out gnnniiig. Sid(>rka 
 added another goose to my collection, and I ol)t,aim'(l near the 
 hou.se several rairs, and also the eggs of a curlew (Liinosa itiopye^i- 
 alis) not previously found on the American <-ontiiient. On Mon- 
 day, Kurilla heated the bath room, and a.' all took a steam bath. 
 In the evening about half p,.st eleven that nld \eicran Telee/.hik 
 arrived from the Sh;igeluk with a l.oat-load of furs. lie would 
 only stop to drink ti:a, however, and with his two companions 
 pushed on to Pasliilik. He had obtained about a thousand 
 martens. 
 
 ■!l 
 
 
 
 ■ 1 <* 
 
 .*H 
 
 
 ' H 
 
p^iiHpj IV im 
 
 236 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITOKV. 
 
 !•:! 
 
 i: 11' J!' 
 
 Tuesday, 2yi. — After packing up all the collections, 1 con- 
 cluded to follow Teleezhik to Pastolik. We arrived theic saK.l\-, 
 and had hardly landed our cargo before a strong head-wiml 
 sprang up, so that we had been just in time. l*ast(')lik is a Una- 
 leet village of some thirty huts, mostly built of turf and driftwood. 
 Just now it was without inhabitants. It is situated on the shore 
 of a wide inlet, into which the l'ast()lik River empties. Tin; 
 mouth of this inlet is nearly closed by a l)ar which is almost dry 
 at low tide. Inside of the bar there are deep places, and here a 
 beluga fishery is carried on in the month of August. The beluga 
 is a small white whale, allied to the sperm whale and ])orpoi.se. 
 They come into the shallow water to breed, and are prevented 
 from getting out of the inlet by the bar. When the tide falls, the 
 natives in their kyaks attack them with lances, and large num- 
 bers are killed. The flesh is eaten, and the blubber and oil pre- 
 served for trade and winter usl-. The length of tiiese animals 
 seldom exceeds fifteen feel, and a large one will weigh about two 
 thousand pounds. 1 counted eighty skulls lying about tin; Iuil>;, 
 the remains of the fishery of the previous year. The teeth oi the 
 
 being; 
 
 I are 01 
 
 th 
 
 con Istency of ivory, and are e.xlensivel}' use 
 
 by the Iniuiit in making small carvings, liirds, seal, deer, a 
 
 nd 
 
 )th 
 
 er animals are imitated with some s 
 
 ^kiU 
 
 by 
 
 th 
 
 many articles of use and oinament are made by the 
 
 e nativi 
 
 ami 
 
 m ii'oiii i\'or\'. 
 
 Th 
 
 e previous year, on 
 
 ou 
 
 r arrival from NiiliUo, I purchasei 
 
 large number of these articles. An awl or bodkin is here repre- 
 
 ivniy lliulkin. 
 
 sented. The larger articles of ivorv are made fiom w;iliiis tusk<, 
 which aic obtained by trade with the natives ot' llic iiorthi 111 
 coast. In July and September a se.d fishery, similar i>i thai at 
 Kegiktowriik, is carried on hire, and many are secured in n( I ■ 
 These nets are exceedingly strong, and arc made from remni, 
 
 Sriiii nil. Ill- 
 
 with a peculiar medic, which is here rcpresen 
 
 t. .1. 
 
 I miuit 
 
 \i 11 ii 
 
THE YUKON TKKRITORV. 
 
 ■0/ 
 
 women are extremely expert at this kind of work. I am informed 
 that with similar nets, durinj^ the moultini; season, they secin-e 
 large numbers of wild fowl and also many arctie hares in the fall. 
 During the moulting season they obtain many skins of the dift'er- 
 ent species of divers, by driving them into shallow water where 
 they cannot dive, and spearing them with bone tridents. Of these 
 skins they make parkies and other articles of clothing, some of 
 which are very tasteful. 
 
 The Innuit have also a custom of making, on flat pieces of 
 bone, rude drawings of animals, hunting parties, and similar things. 
 
 M 
 
 I 
 
 INNUIT DRAWINGS UN DONE. 
 
 v^^^^^^ ^ 
 
 Spearing geesu. 
 
 Waives alter deer. 
 
 '^^ 
 
 Iiinuit ilaticc. 
 
 nii 
 
 M 
 
 % 
 
 
 Dier luiiitini;. 
 
 These drawings are analogous lo those discovered in France in 
 the caves of iJordogne, and the jireceding sketch of ihe drawings 
 on either side of two bom: knives illustrates their general character. 
 I have seen an ivory bow, used in conni'ction witii a (hill, and 
 made of an entire walrus tusk, whicli had di.'picted on each of 
 the four sides every pursuit folK.-weil by the Iniuiil from birtii Id 
 interment, These fai Is have a peculiar interest as showing some 
 similarity between the customs of tiie [)rescnt Orarian tribes 
 
 III 
 
m 
 
 I 
 
 
 •1 
 
 ft 
 
 h ' il 
 
 ; / ^ 
 
 li 
 
 
 I'. £1- 
 
 «i 
 
 III 
 
 I' 
 
 I ^1 
 
 i 
 
 l!^ 
 
 I < 
 
 ( 
 
 2.^.8 
 
 THE YUKON TERKITURV. 
 
 and those of the ancient European cave-dwellers. Similar draw- 
 ings are common everywhere among the Iiiniiit, while I have 
 never seen among the Tinneh tribes of the northwest any similar 
 specimens of art. Some of the Innuit tribes to the southward 
 exhibit much more ingenuity in such matters than those of Nor- 
 ton Sound and the vicinity. 
 
 Hack of rast<)lik are extensive marshes bounded by the low 
 range of the PastcSlik Hills, while at their foot the Pastoliak 
 River flows, emptying into I'astol Hay. These marshes are the 
 favorite haunts of myriads of wild fowl. 
 
 Wednesday, 24///. — This morning an unexpected misfortune 
 occurred. The strong west wind rai.scd the water so high that it 
 not only invaded our tent near the shore, but surrounded the 
 boxes of birdskins before we became aware of it, and I was 
 obliged to empty them, unpack every individual .specimen, and dry 
 it in the sun. This was fortunately accomplished and the speci- 
 mens repacked, when clouds came u]) and it began to rain. I'"rom 
 the marshes my Indians obtained many fine birds and eggs, 
 including several specimens of the exquisite Sabine's gull {Xema 
 Sabiiiii), and a pair of Emperor geese. This is nearly the most 
 northern point reached by the latter species. 
 
 A solitary native arrived in a kyak at night, and reported 
 others on the way. I picked up near the village a large portion 
 of the skull of the extinct elephant {F.lcplias prii)iii:;ciniis). These 
 bones are not so common as the teeth and tusks, being fanul on 
 the surface only, and usually much decayed ; whde the bones of 
 the musk-ox and fossil buffalo found in the same situations are 
 much better preserved, and sometimes retain some of the ani- 
 mal matter in the bone. The natives have no tradition of any 
 other large animal tli.nn \\\v reiniiccr and moose, and regard the 
 elephant and musk-ox bones as the remains of dead " devils." 
 The tusks are not so well [)reserved as those found in Siberia, 
 which are usually buried in the earth. The former are black- 
 ened, split, and weathered, and conlain little ivory in a stali: fit 
 for use, though the Innuit of the Arctic coast occasionally 'i\w\ 
 them in such preservation that they make kantags or dishes of 
 the ivory, according to Simpson. 
 
 On Friday, Cioldsen arrived in a three-holed bidarka with his son 
 ami an Innuit lad. He reported that Milavanotf was at Kutiik. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY, 
 
 239 
 
 — w? 
 
 m i 
 H 
 
 Saturday, 2'jtli. — The wind being nearly fair, all hands loaded 
 up, and we started for the Redoubt. I had hoped to get a larger 
 boat at Pastolik, fearing to trust my little bidarni to the waves of 
 the open sea, but there were neither boats nor natives at hand. 
 We sailed well, and soon outstripped Teleezhik, though the nim- 
 ble bidarka led the Heet. We drank tea on the shore, about 
 ten miles from Pastolik, and then pushed on toward Point Roma- 
 noff. Goldsen arrived at this point some time ahead of us, as 
 it had become quite calm. 
 
 On reaching the village, near the solitary hill which marks 
 the point (which is the Cape Shallow Water of Cook), I was 
 about to land, when Cioldsen cried out to me, "Hurry up I Mr. 
 Doctor, don't stop for a moment, there are two American ves- 
 sels at the Redoubt I " My joy and excitement can hardly be 
 described. Our ignorance of any details only added to it. The 
 news was obtained through a native who had been to the Canal, 
 and had only .seen the vessels. I immediately proposed to Gold- 
 sen to put his native into the bidarra, while one of my Indians 
 would take the other paddle, and I would accompany him in the 
 swifter bidarka to the Redoubt. This arrangement was soon 
 completed, and I left Kun'lla to i)ring the bidarra to .St. Michael's. 
 We touched at Pikmiktalik, and entering the Canal took tea on 
 the bank. While the chynik was boiling I took a bath in one of 
 the lagoons, and otherwise prepared myself to meet civilized 
 beings once more. After tea we pulled vigorously all night. 
 
 Sunday, 2<S///. — About three o'clock in the morning we reached 
 the northern mouth of the Canal, and saw a small schooner lying 
 in the bay. To the eastward a bidarra was pulling for the Canal, 
 but seemed rather to avoiil us. Taking Goldsen's glass, I made 
 out one white man in it, and the round sides of two barrels rose 
 conspicuously above the gunwale, I felt sick as I sat down, 
 knowing that the cargo must consist of rum, and seeing already 
 the beginning of evils whose future growth none could estimate. 
 
 We jiuUed up to the landing near the Iwat-house. I^verytiiing 
 seemed much as usual, and everybody was evidiMitly a!^leep. My 
 eye soon fell on a pile of bo.xes, whicli were not of Russian make, 
 and just beyond was a lot of American tin cups. I hastened to 
 the house on the point, which was evidently occupied. Entering, 
 I nearly stumbled over a sleeper on the tloor. !Ie rosi and came 
 
 m 
 
 I ' 
 
 ;■:! 
 
 n 
 
 11 t 
 
f'l 
 
 I 
 
 Pri 
 
 
 / 
 
 ill '•■ 
 
 ill 
 
 
 p.ijii? 
 
 '/ 
 
 If. II ■(, 
 
 
 '1 
 
 : 1 
 
 : 
 
 ■ ill 
 
 1 
 
 240 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 out into the light, and I was soon shakhig hands and exchangincf 
 hurried interro<;atories with Mike LelKirfie. The unmixed delight 
 with which I welcomed his familiar face can hardly be appre- 
 ciated. I found, to my own astonishment, that speaking I'jiglish, 
 after a year of nothing but Russian and Indian dialects, was any- 
 thing but easy, and for several days I was obliged to resort to 
 Russian when fluency was required. The news, much of it eigh- 
 teen months old, was all news to me, and it was weeks before I 
 gained anything like a comprehension of the events which had 
 occurred in the civilized world since I last heard from it. My 
 only disappointment was that they brought me not a single home 
 letter. All of these had been sent to Sitka or elsewhere, in ig- 
 norance of my whereabouts. I had not heard from home for 
 nearly two years. 
 
 Captain Smith had left with his vessel for Grantley Harbor. He 
 would return to St. Michael's, and I made the necessary prepara- 
 tions for accompanying him to California. I must pass over the 
 events of the next month at the Redoubt. Several trading com- 
 panies, beside that which Mike represented, intended to send par- 
 ties into the country. The vessel in the bay was principally loaded 
 with liquor, which had in some mysterious way eluded the vigi- 
 lance of the United Suites officials at Sitka ; she belonged to one 
 of these companies. .Some time after, the vessel arrived which 
 hatl been sent to take back those Russians who desired to return 
 to Russia. Very few went in her, as most of them were hired by 
 the new trading companies. I'o Mr. George R. Adams, and Cap- 
 tain Riedell, of the brig Constantine, I was under many obligation.s. 
 On the 2 1 St of July the schooner h" ranees L, Steele arrived from 
 luring Strait with Captain Smith on board. On the gtli of Aii- 
 gu.st, having shipped the collections, I embarked for San l'"ran- 
 cisco via the Aleutian Islands. We touched at St. (ieorge's 
 Island and some of the Aleutians on our way to California. 
 
 The incidents of the voyage need not be recounted here. It 
 is sufficient to say that i ohiaini.'d abimdance of evidence that 
 during r86<S gn^at abuses were prevalent in the new territory. 
 One trading company in ])articnJ:(r, hoping, by its larg*' capital 
 and connection with th< iifficers (tf 'V rlofunct Russi;in Company, 
 to crush all smaller con<..'rns, iiad i^f hesitated at force, fraud, 
 and corruption, to attain r se ends. ft would be impossible to 
 
 Si 
 
TIIK VL'KOX TERRITORY. 
 
 241 
 
 believe in the prol)ity of" some of the officials (since removed; 
 at Sitka, as it was impossible to avoid seeint; the outrages which 
 had been committed. One instance of the temper of these 
 traders will suffice. A party, consisting of several German Jews, 
 one Russian, and some other foreigners, had staked out the places 
 where the fur seal come up on the island of St. George, and 
 declared their intention of holding these tracts of beach under 
 the homestead laws (I) by force, if necessary. Two unarmed 
 Americans, who had served in the army and navy during the late 
 war, and who had a permit to seal from the .Sitka authorities, 
 having trespassed on the land staked out, were set upon by a party 
 of armed natives, led by a member of the company referred 
 to, were tied hand and foot, and left all night in a mud hovel used 
 for storing salt. The ne.xt day they were released on condition 
 that the trespass should nt)t be rejjeated. 
 
 In their present condition the Crecjles are unfit to e.\ercise the 
 franchise, as American citizens. If a territorial government 
 should be granted to the handful of Americans now resilient in 
 the territory, it would simply give the stronger companies the 
 power to crush and ruin the weaker ones, and a full opportunity 
 of smuggling and .selling liquor would be afforded to the former. 
 The present system of a military government, with honest officers, 
 is unquestionably the best, until the proper reserv .tions are made 
 and regulations in regard to trading are enacted, flic territory 
 is not likely to be populous for many years, and shouM i ather be 
 regarded as a great storehouse of fish, timber, and fur ; from 
 which American citizens alone should be allowed to draw sup- 
 plies, under proper restric lions and on payment of reasonable 
 ta.xes. The country, under a monopoly, afforded one hundred 
 thousand silver rubles a year, ta.xes, to the Russian crown, and, 
 with the development of other resources than the traffic in 
 furs, can certainly afford as mucii to the United States. I s])eak 
 from no uncertainty, but from ])ositive knowledge ; I believe that 
 a proper and not onerous system of taxation would aflord two 
 luuulietl and fifty thousand dollars in gold per annum. 
 
 It is but reasonable to supjmse that a territory .separated by sea 
 and foreign territory from the United States — being in point of 
 fact a colony — should need, ami be the subject of, s|)ecial legisla- 
 tion, differing in many particulars from tiiat ap|)lied to territories 
 16 
 
 k 
 
 m 
 
242 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY. 
 
 U (' 
 
 
 I Iff 
 
 In 
 
 '1 
 
 
 ■ !• 
 
 "i' ' 
 
 which are merely continuations of densely populated districts 
 under State jurisdiction. 
 
 I have seen with surprise and regret that men whose fore- 
 fathers wielded the axe in the forests of Maine, or gathered 
 scanty crops -n the granite hillsides of Massachusetts, have seen 
 fit to throw contempt and derision on the acquisition of a great 
 territory naturally far richer than that in which they themselves 
 originated, principally on the ground that it is a " cold " country. 
 This complaint is but half true to begin with, since on half of the 
 coast of the new territory the thermometer has never been known 
 to fall below zero. Icebergs are unknown in Alaska from Dixon's 
 Entrance to Bering Strait, and no polar bear ever came within 
 a thousand miles of Sitka. On the other hand, has the race of 
 hardy pioneers died out among us .' Do we, as a nation, sigh only 
 for indolent siestas in the canebrakes of Cuba .' In a country 
 where all that we honor and respect has grown from the efforts 
 of those whose energy, fostered by conflict with the elements, 
 has made a garden of the rock, turned the forest into fruitful 
 fields, and drawn the precious minerals from the flinty bosom 
 of the earth, there can be but one answer to such a question. 
 
 We have bought for a nominal price the key to the North 
 Pacific. It can no longer be said that three ironclads can block- 
 ade our entire western coast. Two hundred and fifty years hence 
 there may be a new New England where there is now a track- 
 less forest. The time may come when we .shall call on our Pacific 
 fishermen to man our fleets, on the lumbermen of Alaska and 
 our hardy northern trappers to don the blue, and strike another 
 blow for unity and freedom. The oak must weather the storms 
 of many winters before it gains maturity. Alaska is not a Cali- 
 fornia, where cities arise in a night, and may pass away in a day. 
 Meanwhile we must be patient. 
 
 We entered the Golden Gate on the 29th of September. I 
 cannot close this partial record of my experience in the north, 
 without a word of acknowledgment to those Californian friends 
 who made my welcome back so warm. The friendship of Cali- 
 fornians, easily acquired, is as precious as their own gold, and 
 as enduring as their Sierras. When I stepped on board the 
 steamer, eastward bound, I felt almost as if I were leaving rather 
 than approaching home. 
 
i I. 
 
 ' n I r 
 
 . ' ii\ ' 
 sal J - J 
 
 'M'.f 
 
 ■I 
 
 PART II. 
 
 £ATA'ACTS FIWM THE /REPORT 
 
 ON AN 
 
 EXPLORATION MADE IX 1887 IX THE YUKOX 
 DISTRICT N.W.T. 
 
 AND 
 
 Adjacent Northern Portion of British Columhia 
 
 BY 
 
 GEORGK M, DAWSOX, D.S., F.G.S. 
 
 
 .i 
 
 5H 
 
 't * 
 
 It':* ^ 
 
 ! 
 
 r/ 
 
 
 i '\ 
 

 I 
 
 
 W 
 
 
 ' i 
 
 II 
 
 I 
 
 
 h:i Ij 
 
l-t V' 
 
 CHAPTER I. 
 
 Ill 
 
 
 Tlie N'iikoii I'.xpeditiun— Its |)ur|Ajs'; — Arriv;il at Winiigoll — Dcasc Luke — Uoat- 
 l)iiiiiliii!^ — 'riiecoiitlucncecjf tlic Dease and Liard Rivers Ascuiit of thu Liard and 
 I'rancL'S Rivers Id Francos Lake — Lxamiidiij; and uiappinjj the lake — Ditticulties 
 111 p.irta^ir^ — The L'p|)Lr I'elly — Descent of the IVlly — Mr. O^ilvie's preliminary 
 report and mni) sheets -Chilkoot Pass— Distance travelled by the llxpedition 
 dnrini; the exploration — River systems of the northern put of British Columbia 
 and the Yukon district -Characteristic featiues of the rej^ion^The estuary of the 
 Vukun — When lirst explored — The name \'ukon firsl applied in 1846 — The 
 source of the Yukon an interestini; fubjecl of inquiry — Its width, depth, and 
 velocity — Principal routes of travel — The Taku River — Ri\ers of the Upper 
 \'ukon IJasin- Total length of v.alcrs navigable -Routes of access employed in 
 1888. 
 
 THE Yukon Expedition was iindcrtaktjn for the piu'pose of 
 f^aininj.,' information on a vast and previ<Jiisly almost im- 
 kntnvn tract of country which forms the extreme north-westerly 
 portion of the North-west Territory. This tract is bounded 
 on the south b\ the northern line of the Province of British 
 Columbia (lat. 60°), on the west by the eastern line of the United 
 States territory (jf Alaska, on the east by the Rocky Mountain 
 Ranges and 136th meridian, and on the north by the Arctic 
 Ocean. The region thus generally indicated is referred to as 
 the Yukon district, from the fact that the greater part of its area 
 lies within the drainage-basin of the river of that name. 
 
 The Yukon district has a total area of approximately 192,000 
 square miles, 150,768 stpiare miles being included in the water- 
 shed of the Yukon. The superficial extent of the district is 
 nearly equal to that of France, greater than the United Kingdom 
 by 71,100 square miles, ten times the area of the province of Nova 
 Scotia, or nearl\- three times that of the New England States. 
 
 The writer wa^ j^laced in general charge of the expedition, 
 with Mr. R. G. McCoimell, 15. A., and Mr. J. McEvoy, B.Ap.Sc, 
 also of the Gee .graphical Survey, as assistants, while Mr. W. 
 
 B 
 
 f 
 
 mi: 
 
 1^' 
 
 
 '( . ' 
 
 \, 
 
IMAGE EVALUATION 
 TEST TARGET (MT-3) 
 
 ^^^1^^ 
 
 1.0 
 
 I.I 
 
 1.25 
 
 ■^ Ui |22 
 MS 111° 
 
 tu 
 
 1.4 
 
 M 
 
 1.6 
 
 V 
 
 
 Hiotographic 
 
 Sdences 
 
 Corporation 
 
 n WIST MJDM STRUT 
 
 Wlb .r«;,N.Y. 14580 
 
 (716) •73-4503 
 
 ,\ 
 
 iV 
 
 ^ 
 
 '^ 
 
 \ 
 
 o 
 
 Of 
 
 ^>>> 
 
 "^V- 
 
 o'^ 
 
 •'*.'■ 
 

 6^ 
 
246 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ffi 
 
 M 
 
 '*.■■: 
 
 Id ! 
 
 r 
 
 Ogilvie, D.L.S., was intrusted with the conduct of instrumental 
 measurement, and the astronomical work in connection with the 
 determination of the position of the 141st meridian. 
 
 We left Ottawa on the 22nd of April, 1887, travelling by the 
 Canadian Pacific Railway to Victoria, and reached Wrangell, 
 at the mouth of the Stikine River, where our work was 
 practically begun on the 18th of May. Here Mr. McConnell 
 stayed behind, for the purpose of getting Indians and canoes to 
 enable him to make a micrometer survey of the Stikine from 
 the end of the line measured by Mr. J. Hunter in 1877, to 
 Telegraph Creek, while I proceeded up the river by the first 
 steamer of the season to Telegraph Creek, the head of naviga- 
 tion. From thence, goods are carried by pack animals to 
 Dease Lake, the centre of the Cassiar mining district. On 
 June 5th, we reached the head of Dease Lake, and found the 
 greater part of the lake still covered with ice. It was not until 
 the 9th thut v,e were able to reach the point on the shore near 
 Laketon at which two men, previously sent on in advance with 
 an Indian packer, were sawing lumber for boats. Seven days 
 were employed in this work and in constructing three boats. 
 On the evening of the i6th, a strong wind having broken up 
 the remaining barrier of ice, we reached Laketon with our boats, 
 Mr. iucConnell, with a crew of five Coast Indians intended for 
 my work on the Upper Liard, having meanwhile joined us. 
 On the i8th we started, and on the 23rd reached the " Lower 
 Post " at the confluence of the Dease and Liard Rivers. Here 
 Mr. McConnell, with one boat and two men, separated from us 
 for the purpose of surveying and geologically examining the 
 Lower Liard. 
 
 On leaving the confluence of the Dease and Liard, my own 
 party included, besides myself, Mr. McEvoy, Messrs. L. Lewis 
 and D. Johnson, engaged at Victoria, two Tshimsian and three 
 Stikine (Thlinkit) Indians, all good boatmen. Two local 
 Indians hired as guides, and to help in portaging, deserted a 
 day or two after engaging ; and from the " Lower Post " to 
 near the confluence of the Pelly and Lewes, for an interval of 
 more than six weeks, we met neither whites nor Indians. 
 
 The ascent of the Liard and I'rances rivers to Frances Lake 
 proved unexpectedly difficult and tedious, the rivers being swift 
 
THE YUKON TERRirOiiY 
 
 ?47 
 
 throughout and three bad canons having to be passed through. 
 Frances Lake was reached on the 8th of July, and after spending 
 a few days in examining a'-.d mapping the hike, making the 
 observations necessary to fix its position, and in the endeavour 
 to find some Indian trail by which we might travel across to 
 the Pelly, we began the work of portaging on the 17th. 
 
 As we had been unable to discover any route now in use by 
 the Indians, and no trace remained of the trail employed by 
 the Hudson Bay Company in former years ; and as no I(x:al 
 Indians could be found to act as guides or to assist in carrying 
 our stuff, it was evident that the crossing cjf this portage (which 
 had been estimated by Mr. Campbell at about 70 miles in 
 length) would be a difficult matter, and that we might indeed 
 find it impossible to carry over a sufficient supply of provisions 
 for work on the Pelly. We therefore constructed a strong log 
 ak/ic on the shore of Frances Lake, and left there everything we 
 could possibly dispense with, to be taken to Uease Lake by the 
 Indians when they returned. Had we been unable to effect the 
 portage, there was in our ak/w a sufficient supply of provisions 
 to enable the whole party to return to the " Lower Post." We 
 were, however, so fortunate as to reach the bank of the Upper 
 Pelly on the 29th of July, with still nearly a month's provisions 
 for four persons, our instruments and a small camping outfit, a 
 canvas cover from which a canoe might be constructed, and the 
 tools and nails for building a wooden boat, should that prove 
 to be necessary. Our Indians were paid off here, and to their 
 great delight allowed to turn back. 
 
 As a dangerous rapid was reported to exist on the upper part 
 of the Pelly, it was deeidid to construct a canvas canoe in 
 preference to building a boat, which it might prove impossible 
 to portage past the rapid. Having completed the canoe, we 
 descended the Pi-lly, and arrivetl at the rontluence of the Lewes 
 branch with the Upper Pelly on the nth of August. At the 
 mouth of the Lewes we had now reached the line of route 
 which is used by the miners, and I'xpected to rnui a picai ranged 
 memorandum from Mr. Ogilvie, from wIkjiu we had separated 
 in May. As we did not find any such notice, and as Mr. 
 Ogilvie had not been seen on the lower river by a party of 
 miners whom we met here on their way up the Lewes, we were 
 
 n 2 
 
 III 
 
 111 
 
 ' i» 
 
 uH 
 
 : 1 
 
 ; M 
 
 \m 
 
 f mU 
 
 f; iKm 
 
 ^/ ] B 
 
 ' R 
 
 rii 
 
248 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 forced to conclude that he had not yet reached this point. We 
 were also told that Harper's trading post, where I had hoped 
 to be able to get an additional supply of provisions should we 
 fail to come up with Mr. Ogilvie, had been moved from the 
 mouth of the Stewart to Forty-mile Creek. From the place 
 where we now were we still had a journey of nearly 400 miles 
 to the coast, with the swift waters of the Lewes to contend 
 against for the greater part of the distance. If therefore it 
 should have become necessary to go down stream 200 miles to 
 Forty-mile Creek for provisions, so much would have been 
 added to our up-stream journey that it would become doubtful 
 whether we should be able to afford time for geological work on 
 the Lewes, and yet reach the coast before the smaller lakes 
 near the mountains were fro;5en over. I therefore decided to 
 set about the building of another boat, suitable for the ascent 
 of the Lewes, and on the second day after we had begun work, 
 Mr. Ogilvie very opportunely appeared. After having completed 
 our boat and obtained Mr. Ogilvie's preliminary report and 
 map-sheets, together with the necessary provisions, we began 
 the ascent of the Lewes, and from its head-waters we crossed 
 the mountains by the Chilkoot Pass and reached the coast at 
 the head of Lynn Canal on the 20th September. 
 
 In addition to the physical obstacles to be encountered on 
 the long route above outlined, some anxiety was caused by 
 reported Indian troubles on the Yukon. On reaching the 
 mouth of the Lewes we ascertained that the story was entirely 
 false, but it had none the less kept us in a state of watchfulness 
 during a great part of the summer. 
 
 The entire distance travelled by us during the exploration 
 amounts to 1322 miles. This, taken in coimection with the 
 coast-line between the Stikine and Lynn Canal, circumscribes 
 an area of about 63,200 square miles, the interior being, even 
 yet, but for the accounts of a few prospectors and reports of 
 Indians, terra incognita. The same description, with little 
 qualihcation, applies to the whole surrounding region outside 
 the surveyed circuit, but much general information concerning 
 the country has been obtained. 
 
 The region traversed by the routes just mentioned, including 
 
THE YUKON TERI<[TORY 
 
 249 
 
 the extreme northern part of British Columbia and the southern 
 part of the Yukon district (as previously defined), is drained by 
 three great river systems, its waters reachinjT the Pacific by the 
 Stikine, the Mackenzie, (and eventually the Arctic Ocean,) by 
 the Liard, and Behrinj;; Sea, by the Yukon. The south-eastern 
 part of the region is divided between the two first-named rivers 
 whose tributary streams interlock, the Stikine making its way 
 completely through the Coast Ranges in a south-westerly 
 direction, while the Liard, on a north-easterly bearing, cuts 
 across the Rocky Mountains to the Mackenzie valley. The 
 watershed separating these rivers near Dease Lake has a height 
 of 2730 feet, and both streams may be generally characterized 
 as very rapid. 
 
 To the north-westward, branches of the Stikine and Liard 
 again interlock with the head-waters of several tributaries of 
 the Yukon, which here unwater the entire great area enclosed 
 on one side by the Coast Ranges, on the other by the Rocky 
 Mountains. The actual watershed, between the Liard and 
 Pelly, on our line of route, was found to have an elevation of 
 3150 feet, but it is, no doubt, much lower in the central portion 
 of the region between the Rocky Mountains and Coast Ranges. 
 
 To the north of the Stikine, at least one other river, the Takii. 
 also cuts completely across the Coast Ranges, but its ])asin is 
 comparatively restricted and little is yet known of it. 
 
 It will be noticed, that while the several branches of the Yukon 
 conform in a general way to the main orographic axes, the Stikine 
 and Liard appear to be to a large degree independent of these, 
 and to How counter to the direction of three mountain ranges. 
 
 The region, being a portion of the Cordillera belt of thi; west 
 coast, is naturally mountainous, but it comprises as well 
 important areas of merely hilly or gently rolling country, 
 besides many wide, flat-bottomed river-valleys. Higher in 
 its south-eastern part — that drained by the Stikini- and 
 Liard — it subsides gradually, and apparently uniformly, 
 to the north-westward ; the mountains at the same time 
 becoming more isolated, and being separated by broader tracts 
 of low land. The general base-level, or height v)f thi' main 
 valleys, within the Coast Ranges, thus declines from about 
 2500 feet, to nearly 1500 feet at the confluence of the Lewes 
 
 
 .■I 
 i 
 
250 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 in 
 
 ! 
 
 M 
 
 .iii 
 
 and Pelly rivers, and the average base-level of the entire 
 region may be stated as being a little over 2000 feet. 
 
 The Coast Ranges, with an aggregate average width of 
 about eighty miles, closely set with high, rounded or rugged 
 mountains, constitute the most important orographic uplift 
 in the entire region, and reproduce geographically and 
 geologically the characteristic features of the more southern 
 portion of British Columbia. Beyond the vicinity of Lynn 
 Canal, this mountain axis runs behind the St. Elias Alps, 
 ceasing to be the continental border, and may be said to be 
 entirely unknown, as any indications of mountains which 
 have appeared on this part of the map are purely conjectural. 
 Notwithstanding the great width of the Coast Ranges, it is 
 not known that any of their constituent mountains attain 
 very notable altitudes, but it is probable that a great number 
 of the peaks exceed a height of 8000 feet. These ranges are 
 composed of numerous mountain ridges, not always uniform 
 in direction, and, so far as has been observed, no single 
 dominant range can be traced for any considerable distance. 
 
 The mountain axis next in importance to that of the 
 Coast Ranges forms the water-parting between the Upper 
 Liard and Yukon on one side, and the feeder of the main 
 Mackenzie River on the other. This represents the north- 
 western continuation of the Rocky Mountains proper. Its 
 eastern ridges were touched on during the exploration in the 
 vicinity of Frances Lake and the head-waters of the Pelly River, 
 and are there designated on the map as the Tootsho Range. 
 This forms, so far as has been ascertained, the culminating 
 range of a number of more or less exactly parallel ridges, and 
 certain summits attain heights of from 7000 to gcoo feet. 
 
 A third notable mountain axis, which I have designated on the 
 map as the Cassiar Range, is cut through by the Dease River 
 in its upper course, and further to the north-westward appears 
 to form the line of water-parting between the tributaries of the 
 Upper Liard and those of the branches of the Yukon. Peaks 
 near the Dease, in this range, somewhat exceed 7000 feet, but 
 the range in a general way becomes lower to the north-westward. 
 
 In the north-western and less elevated moiety of the region, 
 the mountain ranges and ridges are in general lower and 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 251 
 
 become discontinuous and irregular, or while retaining a general 
 parallelism, assume an overlapping or echelon-like arrangement. 
 
 In each of these mountain chains granitic rocks appear in 
 greater or less force. In the intervening and subordinate 
 mountain systems of the south-east, granitic axes are not found 
 and do not exist as prominent features. 
 
 Scarcely anything is known of the character of the country 
 drained by the Macmillan, Stewart and White rivers, but it is 
 probable that the basins of the two first-named streams closely 
 resemble that of the Upper Pelly. Miners who have ascended 
 the Stewart for a hundred miles or more, report the existence 
 of a continuous range of mountains of considerable height, 
 which runs parallel to the river on the north, from a point about 
 fifty miles from its mouth onward. The absence of tributaries 
 of any size along the south-west side of the Lewes below the 
 Tahk-heena, with the general appearance of the country in that 
 direction, so far as it has been overlooked, shows that the 
 basin of the upper portion of the White River must be com- 
 paratively low. Situated as it is within the St. Elias Alps, 
 this country must possess most remarkable features, both 
 geographically and from a climatic point of view, and well 
 deserves exploration. 
 
 The estuary of the Yukon appears to have been first explored 
 by the Russian, Glasunoff, in 1835 to 1838, and the river was 
 then named by the Russians the Kwikhpak : this name, accord- 
 ing to Mr. W. H. Dall, is in reality that of one of the channels 
 by which it issues to the sea. The lower part of the river, 
 however, continued to be known as the Kwikhpak for a number 
 of years, and it is so called on the (Russian) map of Lieut. 
 Zagoskin, made from reconnaissance surveys which, in 1842-43, 
 he carried up so far as Nowikakat. The mouth of the river is 
 shown on Arrowsmith s map of 1850, but is there nameless. 
 
 The name Yukon was first applied in 1846 by Mr. J. Hell, of 
 the Hudson Bay Company, who reached the main river by 
 descending the Porcupine, and called it by what he understood 
 to be its Indian appellation. The head-waters of one of the 
 main tributaries of the Yukon had previously been attained by 
 Mr. R. Campbell (also an officer of the Hudson Hay Company) 
 in 1840, and in 1850 he descended the river as far as the mouth 
 
 1 
 
252 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 
 !,l 
 
 of the Porcupine, naming the whole river thus traversed the 
 Pelly, and naininj,' also the Lewes, White and Stewart rivers, as 
 well as numerous smaller tributaries. 
 
 The name Yukon does not appear at all on Arrowsmith'sniap 
 of 1854, that of the Pelly standin},' for the whole length of the 
 river explored by Campbell, but since that date the term Yukon 
 has gradually become applied to the main river. In the United 
 States Coast Survey map dated i.S6g the main river between the 
 Porcupine and Lewes is definitely named the Yukon ; but in 
 the map accompanying Rayinond's official report (1871) this 
 name is again confined to the river below the Porcupine, and 
 the statement is made in the report (p. 21) that from Lake 
 Labarge to I'ort Yukon the rivet is called the Lewes. 
 
 With respect to the substitution of the name Yukon for that 
 of Pelly on the portion of the river between the Porcupine and 
 Lewes, it is simply a question of well established priority versus 
 use. It is possibly a matter of small importance which shall be 
 employed in future, but no valid excuse can be offered for the 
 attempt to substitute any new name for that either of the Lewes 
 or Pelly above the site of old Fort Selkirk. 
 
 From the point of view of the physical geographer, and apart 
 from the question of nomenclature, the position of the furthest 
 source of the great Yukon River is, however, an interesting 
 subject of inquiry ; though it may j-et be some years before we 
 are in possession of sufficient information to settle the question 
 definitely. It may be confidently assumed that this point is to 
 be found by following up either the Pelly or the Lewes from 
 their confluence at the site of old Fort Selkirk. The Lewes 
 there carries the greater volume of water, but, draining as it does 
 a considerable length of the humid Coast Ranges, which bear 
 throughout the year great reserves of snow and numerous 
 glaciers, it does not compare on terms of equality with the 
 Upper Pelly, which unwaters a regic^i relatively dry. Whether 
 reckoned by size, or by distance from its mouth, i\\c source of 
 the Lewes must be placed at the head-waters of the Hotilincpi 
 River • explored by Byrnes, of the Telegraph Survey, in approxi- 
 
 ' The Tes-lin-too occupies the main orographic valley above its confluence 
 with the Lewes, but is smaller than the Lewes and besides doubles back on 
 its course, as is shown on the map. 
 
 I 
 
i 
 
 ! 
 
 'I 
 
 ^'t 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 253 
 
 
 mate latitude 59° 10', longitude 132° 40'. In regard to the 
 Pelly, it is not yet absolutely certain that the Pelly proper rises 
 further from the common point at Fort Selkirk than its p^reat 
 branches, the Macmillan and the Ross rivers, but it is highly 
 probable that it will be found to do so. 
 
 I must confess to havinjj been somewhat disappointed in the 
 si^e of the Pelly or Yukon where we saw it below the con- 
 fluence of the Lewes. The river, when undivided by islands, 
 is about 1700 feet only in width, with a maximum depth 
 scarcely excecdinfj ten feet when at a stage which may be 
 considered as its approximate mean. It appeared to me to be 
 about equal in si;?e and velocity to the Peace River at Dunvcgan : 
 Mr. Ogilvie, who is also familiar with the Peace, concurred 
 in this estimate. Helow this place the river, of course, receives 
 a number of important tributaries, but at any fairly comparable 
 point on the two rivers I believe that the Mackenzie must far 
 exceed the Yukon in volume. Statements which have been 
 made that the Yukon discharges a volume comparable with 
 that of the Mississippi are altogether exaggerated. 
 
 The numerous large and important rivers by which the 
 Yukon district and the adjacent northern portion of British 
 Columbia are intersected, constitute the principal routes of 
 travel, and during the summer months render inter-communi- 
 cation comparatively easy. The Stikine is navigable by stern- 
 wheel steamers for a distance of 138 miles. This constitutes 
 the travelled route to the Cassiar mining district. A trail was, 
 at one time, opened from Fraser Lake overland to Dease Lake 
 by which cattle were driven through, but of late no travel has 
 occurred on it. The Dease River can scarcely be considered 
 as navigable for steamers, though constituting a fairly good 
 boat route. The Upper Liard and Frances rivers, above the 
 mouth of the Dease, are also passable for large boats, with 
 occasional portages, but not for steamers. The ditViculties 
 of the Lower Liard are, however, such as to render it an 
 undesirable route, even for boats, and scarcely suitable as 
 an avenue of trade between Cassiar and the Mackenzie. 
 Numerous tributary streams in this district may also be 
 ascended by boat or canoe for considerable distances, though 
 with many interruptions from rapids and bad water. 
 
 ;. f| 
 
254 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 I, I 
 
 Communication may easily be established by railway from 
 the mouth of the Stikine to the centre of the Cassiar district 
 and beyond, when such shall be called for ; and it is probable 
 also that this district might, without difficulty, be connected by 
 rail with the more southern portions of British Columbia by 
 one or more routes. Followinpf the river-valleys, by a route 
 practicable for a railway, from Rothsay Point at the mouth of 
 the Stikine to the mouth of the Dease, the distance is found to 
 be 330 miles. Thence to Fort Simpson on the Mackenzie is a 
 further extension of 390 miles, makinp; the total distance by this 
 route, from the Pacific to the navigable waters of the Mackenzie, 
 720 miles only. 
 
 Little is yet known of the Taku River, but the Indians 
 ascend it in canoes to a point about eighty miles from the 
 head of Taku Inlet, and Indian trails lead south-eastward 
 from this vicinity to the Tahl-tan, eastward to Tes-lin Lake 
 and north-eastward to the lakes near the head of the Lewes. 
 From what has been ascertained of these, it is probable that it 
 would not be difficult to construct a trail suitable for pack- 
 animals, if not a waggon road, from the vicinity of the head 
 of navigation on the Stikine to the lakes which are connected 
 with the navigable waters of the Lewes. 
 
 The rivers that drain the Upper Yukon basin have in general 
 lower grades, and afford better navigable water than those 
 above referred to, and are therefore likely to prove of greater 
 importance in connection with the exploration and develop- 
 ment of the country. The distance to which they may be 
 respectively ascended by boat or canoe has been determined in 
 only a few cases as yet. 
 
 It may, however, be stated that the Yukon is continuously 
 navigable for small steamers from its mouth, on Behring Sea 
 and following the Lewes branch, to Miles Cafion. Thence, 
 after an interruption of about three miles, to the head of 
 Bennett Lake and to an additional considerable, though not 
 precisely determined distance, by the waters extending south- 
 eastward from Tagish Lake. From the site of old Fort 
 Selkirk, the Pelly might be navigated by small steamers of good 
 power to within about fifty miles of the site of old Fort Pelly 
 Banks, and the Macmilla branch is also navigable for a 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 255 
 
 considerable, though not ascertained distance. The same may 
 be said of the Stewart River ; but White River is, so far as 
 known, very swift and shoal. 
 
 The total length of the waters which may be utilized for 
 navigation by light stern-wheel steamers on the main river and 
 its branches to the east of the 141st meridian of Alaskan 
 boundary, measured in straight lengths of fifty miles, is there- 
 fore at least 1000 miles, and, if the sinuosities of the various 
 streams are followed, would be very much greater. This does 
 not include the Porcupine River, and with the exception of the 
 single break above referred to on the Lewes, forms a connected 
 system. If the upper portion of these rivers, above the first 
 obstacles to such navigation, were incUu'i • the total here 
 given would doubtless be greatly increased. 
 
 ' At the present moment [188S] but three routes of access to 
 the Yukon district are employed, (i) Tp it of the portage by 
 the Chilkoot Pass from the head of Lynn Can;il to the navig- 
 able *vaters of the Lewes. (2) Thai from P-jel River, near its 
 confluence with the Mackenzie by portage to La Pierre's House 
 on a branch of the Porcupine, (j) Thai from Behring Sea by 
 the main river. The first is almost exclusively used by the 
 miners, the second is employed only by the Hudson Bay 
 Company, and the last is that of the Alaskan traders. 
 
 ' The date of this report must be borne in mind. 
 
 
 
 I 
 
CHAPTER II. 
 
 P/ 
 
 M'l 
 
 ■1 
 
 Slern-whet'l slcamcrs im the lower river — The Cliilkoot I'ass inipassuMc for pack 
 animals— White Pass— IiuliaMs and llieir travelled routes — C'limat'c condition of 
 the Coast Ranjjes and the interior— Mean annual teuiperalure — Summer and 
 winter winds — Natural flora of the Yukon dislrict — Its aj;ricultural possiliilitiesand 
 timber — The fauna of the region traversed by the Kxpedition Supply offish in 
 the lakes and rivers — Minerals and deposits of precious metals — Winter climate 
 in the northern district — Dilficulties o( " ipiartz-niinin}; " — Abundance of wood 
 and water — Total aniou.U of gold afforded by the N'ukon dislrict in 1887 — 
 Platinum found — Value of furs — Material resources of the district — Difference in 
 climate between its northern extremity and tlie western and eastern sides — 
 ("ieolo(;y of the southern part of Urilish Columbia — Widtli of belt of granitoid 
 rocks comprising the Coast Ranges and Cliilkoot I'ass — Paleozoic formation of the 
 interior region — Comparison of the position of the granitic axis with dejiosits of 
 placer gold — Clue to the search for auriferous ground — Lithological character 
 of the mountainous region east of Frances Lake and River — Fossil molluscs and 
 plants — Conglomerates and sand-stones of Lake Labarge — Fossil jilants on the 
 Upper I'elly River — Formation of rocks in the valley of the Upper I.iard. 
 
 
 i' I 
 
 ! 
 
 THERE arc now tlueo small stern -wheel steamers on the 
 lower river, which ascend each year so far as the tradinj:^ 
 post at Forty-mile Creek, bringinj,' the f,'reater part of the j^'oods 
 used in trade with the Indians and for the supply of miners. 
 
 The character of the Cliilkoot Pass is such that it wt)uld 
 scarcely be possible to construct a useful trail across it for 
 pack-animals, but the White Pass appears to offer a better 
 opportunity for makin;^^ a trail or road, which, if constructed, 
 would render the entire region much more easy of access. 
 Another route, also leadinf:^ from the head of Lyim Canal to 
 navij;able water connected with the Lewes, is that by the 
 Chilkat Pass, formerly much empKned by the Indians, but it 
 entails a much lonj^'er land carriaj^^e, one which is said to 
 occupy the Indians for twelve days whei. carryinj; packs, as 
 against two days of packing by the Cliilkoot Pass. 
 
 The Indians who inhabit the region to the south and east of 
 
 P 
 
THK YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 257 
 
 the site of old I'\)rt Selkirk are poor boatmen, and follow the 
 various rivers, in the course of their periodic journeys, to ;i very 
 limited extent. Most of their travelled routes appear, indeed, 
 to run nearly at right-angles to the direction of drainage. The 
 rivers are crossed in summer on rafts : the remains of these 
 may frequently be obseived. In travelling the Indians carry 
 their small camping outfit on their backs. 
 
 The coast and coastward slopes of the Coast Ranges con- 
 stitute a precipitate belt of excessive humidity, with some- 
 what equable temperatures, while the interior region to the 
 eastward of these ranges is relatively dry, with a ttnipcrature 
 of extremes. In the interior, however, the climate is largely 
 influenced by the altitude of each particular district, and in 
 consequence of the general lowering of the country beyontl the 
 60th parallel (constituting the north line of Hritish Columbia), 
 it is certain that the climatic conditions there are much more 
 favourable than in the Cassiar district. 
 
 The mean annual temperature of the coast region is con- 
 siderably higher than that of the interior ; yet, in consecpience 
 of the great depth of the snow-fall and the persistently clouded 
 aspect of the skies, the Coast Ranges are found to support 
 numerous and massive glaciers, while these are almcst or 
 altogether absent in the Cassiar Mountains, in the mountains 
 about Frances Lake, and in the other ranges seen by us in 
 the interior. The depth of snow in winter continues to be 
 inconsiderable or moderate, at least so far down the Pelly 
 (Yukon) as the mouth of Stewart River and Forty-mile Creek, 
 while at Nulato, on the lower river, and in a similar latitude, 
 but 500 miles further west, the depth of snow from April to 
 November is said to average eight feet and often to reach twelve 
 feet. 
 
 As in the more southern parts of British Columbia, the 
 dryest country is found in a 1 1. bordering the eastern or 
 lee side of the Coast Ranges, and this phenomenon recurs, 
 tlu Mgli in a less marked degree, in coimection with each of the 
 \,'e!l(lefmed mountain ranges of the interior. Thus a region of 
 greater humidity is foimd near Dease Lake, on the western 
 Cassiar Mountains, with a dry belt on the east side of the 
 •range ; while humid conditions, with recurrent showers in 
 
 t' 
 
 ii 
 
 1 1 
 
 y 
 
 if' 
 
258 
 
 THK YUKON TliRKITORV 
 
 i'lV 
 
 %v* 
 
 I : I 
 
 summer, characterize the district in the vicinity of Frances and 
 Finlayson lakes. 
 
 A noteworthy circumstance in connection with the Stikine 
 valley, the passes leading from the head of Lynn Canal, and 
 doubtless in all the low gaps in the Coast Ranges, is the 
 change in direction as between the summer and winter winds. 
 During the summer, strong winds blowing up these valleys 
 inland are of very frequent occurrence, and they commonly 
 freshen in the afternoon and die away toward night. In the 
 winter months the conditions aie precisely reversed, the 
 strongest winds blowing seawLird. 
 
 The temperature of Wrangell, just off the mouth of the 
 Stikine, may probably be taken as fairly representative of that 
 of the coast in these latitudes. For the interior region, here 
 our special subject, we are unfortunately without a series 
 of thermometer readings extending even over a single year, but 
 some idea of its climate may be formed from that of Fort 
 Yukon, which is, however, situated far to the north, almost 
 exactly on the Arctic circle. The mean seasonal tempera- 
 tures for these two stations may be compared as below : — 
 
 Spring 
 
 Summer 
 
 Autumn 
 
 Winter 
 
 Year 
 
 Wrangell. 
 
 Fort Yukon. 
 
 40.4 
 
 14.6 
 
 57.1 
 
 56.7 
 
 43.0 
 
 17.4 
 
 28.3 
 
 -23.8 
 
 42.2 
 
 16.8 
 
 iCi' ' 
 
 At Telegraph Creek, and in its vicinity on the Stikine, to 
 the east of the Coast Ranges (lat. 58), wheat, barley, and 
 potatoes are successfully grown with the aid of irrigation. 
 Their cultivation has so far been attempted on a limited scale 
 only, on account of the want of a market, and wheat has 
 been grown only experimental!}', as it cannot, like barley, be 
 employed for feeding pack-animals. None of these crops can 
 be successfully grown or ripened on the coastward side of the 
 mountains. 
 
 Taking into consideration the facts which I have been able 
 to ascertain, and also those to be derived from an examina- 
 tion of the natural flora of the country, and the observed 
 advance of vegetation, which (in the absence of actual experi- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 259 
 
 merits) are capable of affording valuable data, I feel no 
 hesitation in stating my belief that such hardy crops as barley, 
 rye, turnips and flax can be successfully cultivated in the 
 Yukon district so far north as the former position of Fort 
 Selkirk, near the 63rd parallel, or in other words about 1000 
 miles north of Victoria. Taken in conjunction with the 
 physical features of the region, this means, that chiefly within 
 the drainage area of the Yukon, and for the most part to the 
 north of the Goth parallel, there exists an area of about 60,000 
 square miles, of which a large proportion may be utilized for 
 the cultivation of such crops, and where cattle and horses 
 might be maintained in sufficient number for local purposes, 
 without undue labour, as excellent summer grazing is generally 
 to be found along the river-valleys and natural hay-meadows 
 are frequent. I do not maintain that the region is suitable 
 for immediate occupation by a large, self-supporting agricul- 
 tural community, but I hold that agriculture may before many 
 years be successfully prosecuted, in conjunction with the 
 natural development of the other resources of this grea', 
 country. 
 
 The district is generally wooded, and in all portions of it, in 
 valleys and on low lands, there is abundance of white spruce, 
 of fair to good quality, well suited for building purposes. 
 The other species of trees are of inferior economic impor- 
 tance. 
 
 The fauna of the region traversed by us does not differ 
 notably from that of other parts of the northern country which 
 are already moderately well known. The smaller black-tailed 
 deer [Oiriacus Colmnhiamis) occurs on the islands of the 
 southern p{<rtion of Alaska and the adjacent mainland coast, 
 but is nowhere f(jund on the inland side of the Coast Ranges. 
 The mountain goat is UKjderately abundant in the Coast Ranges, 
 and is also found in the mountainous inland regions, probably 
 throughout. The big-horn or mountain sheep occurs, together 
 with the mountain goat, on the mountains about the head 
 of the Lewes and other parts of the inland spurs of the 
 Cr . I».anges, but does not iidiabit the seaward portions of 
 these ranges. It is also found generally m the mountains of 
 the interior, including the Rocky Mountains. 
 
 
 'i i 
 
 I 
 
 i 
 
 1% 
 "■|f 
 
 Jil 
 
2 6o 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ■' I. 
 
 i' , 
 
 The moose is more or less abundant throughout the entire 
 inland region, and together with the caribou, which is similarly 
 ubiquitous, constitutes a great part of the food of the Indians. 
 We found the moose particularly plentiful along the Upper 
 Liard River, and it is stated that the country drained by the 
 White River is noted among the Indians as a moose and beaver 
 region. The caribou is everywhere common, but is scarcely 
 seen in the valleys or lower country during the summer, when 
 it ranges over the high, alpine moors and open slopes of the 
 mountains. 
 
 The black and grizzly bears roam over the entire region and 
 are often seen along the banks of the rivers in the latter part of 
 the summer, when dead or dying salmon are to be obtained 
 with ease. Wolves are not particularly abundant, but the 
 cross, black and silver-fox, are more than usually common. 
 
 The smaller fur-bearing animals, being similar to those found 
 generally in the northern parts of the continent, do not require 
 separate cimmeration. The entire Upper Yukon basin, how- 
 ever, yields furs of exceptionally high grade. 
 
 Among a few skins brought back by us, is that of a mouse 
 which Dr. C. H. Merriam has found to be a new species, and 
 has described under the name o{ Evotoiiiys Daivsoni.^ 
 
 The salmon ascend the Lewes River so far as the lower end 
 of Lake Marsh, where they were seen in considerable numbers 
 early in September. They also, according to the Indians, run 
 almost to the head-waters of the streams tributary to the Lewes 
 on ^he east side. Salmon also run up the Felly for a consider- 
 able distance above the mouth of the Lewes, but their precise 
 limit on this river was not ascertained. The lakes and rivers 
 generally throughout the country are well supplied with tish, 
 and a small party on any of the larger lakes would run little 
 risk of starvation during the winter, if provided with a couple 
 of good gill-nets and able to devote themselves to laying in a 
 stock of tish in the late autumn. 
 
 The salmon is confin:d to the Yukon tributaries. The 
 principal fishes noticed are white-tish {Coregonus Nelsoni), lake 
 trout {Sa/ve/nius Namayciisli), grayling {riiymallus signifer), 
 pike {Esox iucius), and sucker {Catostotnus axtostomus). 
 ' American Naturalist, July, 1888. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 201 
 
 The Yukon district with the northern part of British 
 Columbia, measured from the vicinity of Dease Lake to the 
 intersection of the Pelly (Yukon) with the 141st meridian, 
 comprises a length of over 500 miles of the Cordillera belt of 
 the west, which, wherever it has been examined, has been found 
 rich in minerals, and particularly in the deposits of the precious 
 metals. The width of this particular part of the Cordillera belt 
 is also great, as it appears, so far as our explorations have 
 gone, to extend from the coast to the eastern ranges of the 
 Rocky Mountains in the vicinity of the Mackenzie River. This 
 portion of the Cordillera region, together with that of the more 
 southern part of British Columbia, gives an aggregate length of 
 between 1200 and 1300 miles, almost exactly equal to the 
 length of the same metalliferous belt contained by the United 
 States, and in all probability susceptible of an eventual mining 
 development equally great. 
 
 In the northern districts the winter climate is a severe one, 
 rendering the working season for ordinary placer-mines short, 
 and likely also to present some special difficulties in the way of 
 " quartz mining." There is, however, on the other hand an 
 abundance of wood and water, matters of great importance in 
 connection with mining, and means of communication once 
 provided, mining operations should be carried on here at a 
 reasonable cost. 
 
 It is difficult to arrive at even an approximate statement of 
 the totid amount of gold which has been so far afforded by the 
 Yukon district, but from such inquiry as I was able to make in 
 1887, I estimated the value of gold obtained in that year at a 
 minimum of !Si6o, 000 ; the number of men engaged in mining 
 at 250. 
 
 Platinum is found in small quantities along all or nearly all 
 the tributarif« >f the Yukon, in association with the gold. It 
 has also been observed in the Cassiar district. 
 
 Gold and furs are at present the only articles of value derived 
 frwm the great n-gioii here refern>d to as the Yukon district. It 
 is impossible to secure accurate information as to the value of 
 furs annually obtained, but sufficient is known to show that it 
 must be very considerable. Petroff, in his report, states that 
 the total annual value of the furs shipped by the Yukon 
 
 c I 
 
 }i 
 
 ir 
 
 ill- 
 
 \ 
 
 V- 
 
1» »■ 
 
 I ! 
 
 It 
 
 Ci 
 
 262 
 
 THE YUKON TKRRITORY 
 
 probably dues not exceed |)75,ooo,' and it is known that a great 
 if not the greater portion of this total is derived from the region 
 lying east of the 141st meridian. 
 
 In addition, however, to the furs taken from the Yukon dis- 
 trict by this route, the Hudson Bay Company obtains a large 
 quantity of skins from their posts on the Porcupine ; these reach 
 the market by the Macken2ie River route. A certain number of 
 skins derived from the country north of British Columbia is, 
 further, annually traded at the little post at the mouth of Dease 
 River, and taken out by the Stikine. A considerable quantity 
 of furs also finds its way each year by the Chilkoot and Chilkat 
 passes to the head of Lynn Canal, and some are brought down 
 by the Taku River to the coast, though the greater part of these 
 last is probably derived from the north-western corner of the 
 province of British Columbia. Information obtained on the 
 spot indicates that the value of the furs reaching Lynn Canal 
 from the interior is from ^12,000 to -IjiiSjOoo annually. 
 
 Without including the northern part of British Columbia, but 
 restricting ourselves to the great area of 192,000 square miles 
 to the north of the Goth parallel and west of the Rocky 
 Mountains, which I have referred to as the Yukon district, the 
 information now obtained is sufficient to warrant belief in its 
 great value. It is known to be rich in furs, well supplied with 
 timber, and it is traversed by a great length of navigable rivers. 
 It is already yielding a considerable yearly product in gold, and 
 presents every indication of wealth in other metals, and in 
 deposits of coal. In its southern portion, situated between the 
 Goth and G^th degrees of latitude, is comprised an area of 
 probably not less than 30,000 square miles, suitable for eventual 
 agricultural occupation, and presenting none of the characters 
 of a sub-Arctic region, which have been attributed to it by some 
 writers. In each of these particulars and in climate it is greatly 
 superior to the corresponding inland portion of the territory of 
 Alaska. It may, in fact, be affirmed that the region here spoken 
 of as the Yukon district surpasses in material resources the 
 whole remaining northern interior portion of the continent 
 between the same parallels of latitude. 
 
 ' Rcjiort on the Populalion, Industries and Resources of Alaska, p. 5, U.S. 
 loth Census, vol. viii. 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 263 
 
 J.S. 
 
 The winter climate of the whole of this j^Tcat region is a severe 
 one, and its northern extremity lies within the Arctic circle, 
 but the climatic conditions on the western and eastern sides of 
 the continent are by no means comparable, and the isothermal 
 lines, representing; the mean annual temperature, trend not 
 westward but north-westward from the Manitoba rej^ion. It is 
 needless to recapitulate the causes which produce this difference 
 in climate, but the lines as already approximately drawn upon 
 the maps, represent the agj^regate of influences which produce 
 at the site of old Fort Selkirk on the 63rd parallel of latitude in 
 the Upper Yukon basin, an attractive landscape, with well- 
 j^rown forests and intervenin<; slopes of meadow, while in the 
 same latitude in Hudson Strait we find, even at midsummer, a 
 barren waste of rocks and ice. 
 
 While the Yukon district and the northern portion of British 
 Columbia are at present far beyond the limits of ordinary settle- 
 ment, we may be prepared at any time to hear of the disc()\ery 
 of important mineral deposits, which will afford the necessary 
 impetus, and may result, in the course of a few years, in the 
 introduction of a considerable population into even its most 
 distant fastnesses. It appears meanwhile eminentl}- desirable 
 that we should encourafje and facilitate, in so far as may be 
 possible, the efforts of the miners and others who constitute our 
 true pioneers in the rej^ion, and to whom, in conjunction with 
 the fur companies and traders, the peaceful conquest of the 
 whole of our Great West has been due. In the future there is 
 every reason to look forward to the time when this country will 
 support a large and hardy population, attached to the soil and 
 making the utmost of its resources. 
 
 The geology of the corresponding portion of the Cordillera 
 belt in the southern part of British Columbia is as yet very 
 imperfectly understood. 
 
 Speaking broadly, however, and with reference to the general 
 features of the region, the rock-series represented are evidently 
 similar to those found in the southern portion of British 
 Columbia between the rocky mountains and the coast. 
 
 The Coast Ranges, where traversed by the valley of the 
 Stikine, and again where crossed still further north by the 
 Chilkoot Pass, consist, for the most part, of granite and granitoid 
 
 i :.M 
 
 ' I i 
 
 *r 
 
 
264 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 rocks, almost invariably of p;ray colour and frequently rich in 
 hornblende. With these are occasionally included stratified or 
 stratiform masses of mica and hornblende-schists, and both 
 these and the fjranites are frequently traversed by pef;fmatite 
 veins, diabase dykes and intrusive masses of coarse diorite. 
 The schistose portions of these ranges may possibly represent 
 the still recognizable remnants of rocks of Archaean age, or may 
 be merely porti'^ns of much newer series which have suffered 
 extreme alteration. 
 
 No demonstration of the date of the origin of the granitic 
 rocks of the Coast Ranges was obtained in this region, but there 
 is every reason to believe that it is comparatively recent, and 
 due to a time lying between the Triassic and the Cretaceous ; 
 this is the case with their continuation to the south, near the 
 northern part of Vancouver Island.' 
 
 The argillites of Wrangell, together with those met with near 
 Juneau, and at Sitka, on the Alaskan coii.st, and also in various 
 places along the east side of Lynn Canal, together with the 
 altered volcanic rocks found in association with these on Lynn 
 Canal and elsewhere (examined by me particularly in the 
 vicinity of Seduction Point), clo. ?ly resemble rocks of the same 
 class composing the Vancouver group of the Queen Charlotte 
 and Vancouver Islands. 
 
 The width of the belt of granitoid rocks composing the Coast 
 Ranges is, on the Stikine, about sixty-five miles, measured from 
 their sea border inland at right angles to the main direction of 
 the mountains. It is somewhat less in the latitude of the 
 Chilkoot Pass, but may be assumed to occupy a border of the 
 mainland about fifty miles in width along the whol'^ of this part 
 of the coast. Broadly viewed, however, the coast archipelago 
 in reality represents a partly submerged margin of the Coast 
 Ranges, and granitic rocks are largely represented in it also. 
 The examination of these two northern cross-sections of the 
 Coast Ranges, serves, with observations previously made, to 
 demonstrate the practical identity in geological character of 
 this great orographic axis, from the vicinity of the Fraser River 
 to the 6oth parallel of north latitude — a length, in all, of about 
 goo miles. 
 
 ' See Annual Report Geol. Surv. Can., 1896. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ?6- 
 
 East and north-east of the Coast Ranfi^es, the interior region 
 traversed is, for the most part, floored by Palaeozoic rocks of 
 very varied appearance, and probably referable to several of the 
 main sub-divisions of the geological scale. In so far as the 
 information obtained in the region here in question enables 
 conclusions on the subject to be formed, the lowest part of the 
 rocks (i) consists of greenish and grey schists, generallj' 
 felspathic or hornblendic, but often quartzose and including 
 distinctly micaceous and talcose schists, with some bands of 
 limestone ; the lithological character of this sub-division being 
 exceedingly varied. Apparently overlying these are (2) grey 
 and blackish, often lustrous and sometimes more or less 
 micaceous calc-schists and quartzites, including beds of lime- 
 stone of moderate thickness, which are often more or less 
 dolomitic. These are associated with, or pass up into (3) black 
 argillites or argillite-schists, also containing thin beds of lime- 
 stone, which, at one locality on the Dease, have afforded a 
 small number of graptolites of Cambro-Silurian age. Next 
 above these is a series (4) consisting chiefly of massive lime- 
 stones, generally of grey or blue-grey colour where unaltered, 
 but often locally changed into white or variegatrd crystalline 
 marbles. 
 
 The preponderantly Palaeozoic floor of the region east of the 
 granites of the Coast Ranges, is broken through on two main 
 lines by granitic axes. The first of these is cut across by the 
 Dease River, a short distance below Dease Lake, and was 
 again met with — over 300 miles north-westward — on the Pelly 
 near the mouth of the Macmillan. Though referred to as a 
 single granitic axis, this uplift probably consists rather of a 
 series of alternating and more or less irregularly shaped 
 granitic masses, which, however, preserve a general alignment. 
 There are on the Upper Pelly in fact three separate granitic 
 ridges in place of the single one met with on the Dease. In 
 close association with these granites are some gneissic rocks 
 and holocrystalline mica and hornblende-schists, which have not 
 been referred to in previous paragraphs as they are regarded as 
 probably Archaean, rather than as representing highly altered 
 Palaeozoic rocks. A small tongue of granite occurs on the 
 Lewes a few miles above the mouth of the Little Salmon, 
 
 :.,,! 
 
 i\ 
 
 
 I 
 
266 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 I 
 
 which may be connected with the south-western side of this 
 ffranitic axis, but with this exception, its continuity between 
 the Dcase and the Pelly is indicated merely by the statement 
 of Mr. J. McCormick that granites and mica-schists occur on 
 the south-west side of Quiet Lake and near the Bif( Sahnon 
 River, below that lake. Its further extension in a north- 
 westerly bearing is, however, proved b)' the occurrence of a 
 great preponderance of rocks of the same character in the 
 collection made by Mr. Ogilvie ' on the lower Pelly or Yukon, 
 between the mouth of the Lewes and Forty-mile Creek. 
 
 On comparing the position of this irregular granitic axis and 
 its surrounding altered rocks with that of the richer deposits of 
 placer gold so far discovered and worked, it will be found that 
 they are closely associated. The chief placers and river-bars 
 are, in faict, scattered along this line or belt, and extend, like it, 
 all the way from Dease Lake and McDame Creek to Forty- 
 mile Creek. Evidence was moreover found on the Pelly to 
 show that the development of quartz veins in the Palaeozoic 
 rocks had occurred contemporaneously with the upheaval of 
 the granites, and probably by some action superinduced by the 
 granite masses themselves while still in a formative condition. 
 While cutting the stratified rocks, the quartz veins seldom or 
 never cut the granite masses in this district. These observa- 
 tions should afford an important clue to the further search for 
 auriferous ground, as well as for the lodes from which the 
 placer gold has itself been derived. 
 
 Of the second granitic axis of the interior region little is yet 
 known, but it is probable that it is still less regular in character 
 than the last. It occurs in the mountainous region to the 
 east of Frances Lake and River, and probably also in the 
 vicinity of the Pelly Lakes. Its lithological characters and 
 those of the rocks in its neighbourhood are similar to those of 
 the last described, and here again in its vicinity, on Frances 
 Lake and on the Liard, paying gold placers have been 
 found. 
 
 The granitoid rocks of the interior region are different in 
 general appearance from those of the Coast Ranges, and 
 
 ' Sent out by him in charge of the latest party of miners in the autumn of 
 
 1887. 
 
THE VIJKOX TERRITORY 
 
 267 
 
 resemble more closely the probably Archaaii granites of the 
 Gold Ranges in southern British Columbia. 
 
 Lithologically the granites and granitoid rocks of the Coast 
 Ranges are generally fresh and unaltered in appearance, grey 
 in colour and not often distinctly foliated, while those of the 
 ranges of the interior show evidence of considerable alteration 
 subsequent to their formation, are more highly quartzose and 
 often reddish in tint. 
 
 The Mesozoic period is represented by strata of Cretaceous 
 and Laramie age. These rocks are more recent in appearance 
 than all the C'lder formations, and rest quite uncomfortably on 
 the latter, though they have since been to some extent 
 involved in their flexures. On the lower part of the Lewes, 
 below the mouth of the Little Salmon, these rocks are cut 
 across by the river for a distance of at least thirty-live miles. 
 Some fossil molluscs and plants have been obtained from this 
 area, from which it would appear to include beds referable to 
 the Middle or Lower Cretaceous and to the Laramie period: it 
 is not improbable that the series is a consecutive one between 
 these limits, as the total thickness represented must be very 
 great. The strike of these beds varies much in direction, and the 
 angles of dip are so irregular that no even proximate estimate of 
 thickness could be formed, and it is impossible to arrive at any 
 definite conclusion with respect to the trend of the basin in 
 which they lie. The rocks comprise, in their lower portion, 
 coarse conglomerates, grauwacke-sandstones, yellowish and 
 grey quartzose sandstones, and dark calcareous slates. The 
 upper portion, in which Laramie plants are found, consists 
 chietly of rather soft sandstones, shales and clays, generally of 
 pale colours. Evidence of contemporaneous volcanic action is 
 observable in both parts of the series, and the higher beds 
 include lignite coal of good quality. 
 
 Some miles further up the Lewes, midway between the 
 Little and Big Salmon rivers, peculiar green, grauwacke-sand- 
 stones and green, calcareous conglomerates occur, which are 
 also provisionally referred, though with some doubt, to the 
 Cretaceous. They are at least newer than the PaUeozoic 
 rocks, being composed of fragments of these and of the 
 granites. 
 
 
 
 m< 
 
 m 
 
 n 
 
268 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 r;i 
 
 Confjlomerates and sandstones similar to the last are again 
 found near the lower end of Lake Labarge, on the east side, and 
 are associated with black calcareous slates, which recur in several 
 places along the same side of the lake, further up ; and from 
 these a few fossils have been obtained. These seem to show 
 that the beds are on or near the horizon of Series C. of the 
 Queen Charlotte Islands, which is of Middle Cretaceous age, 
 approximately equivalent to the Gault. 
 
 On the Upper Pelly River, forty-three miles below Hoole 
 Canon, a single low outcrop of hard, dark shales, containing 
 fossil plants of Cretaceous or Laramie age, was found, but in 
 the absence of further exposures along the river in that vicinity, 
 nothing can be said of the extent of this area, except that it 
 must be quite limited in width. Again, on the Stikine River, 
 between Glenora and Telegraph Creek, there are local 
 occurrences of conglomerates and soft sandstones which may be 
 regarded as probably Cretaceous, though no pala;ontological 
 evidence is forthcoming. 
 
 The position of these last-noted areas, as well as that of those 
 along the Lewes River, occurring as they do in a zone of country 
 immediately within the line of the Coast Ranges, is analogous 
 to that held by Cretaceous rocks on the Skeena, and in other 
 localities still further southward in British Columbia. Further 
 investigation will probably show that rocks of that age occur in 
 many additional places, and occupy somewhat extensive areas 
 in this belt of country. In the vicinity of the Lewes, par- 
 ticularly, it is noted that the plane of the original base of the 
 Cretaceous, now thrown into a number of folds, is about that of 
 the present surface of the country, and these rocks may there- 
 fore be expected to recur frequently in the form of troughs or 
 basins, more or less strictly limited, and only to be discovered 
 in detail by thorough examination. The loose material brought 
 down by the Big Salmon River, appears to indicate the existence 
 of a considerable development of these rocks not far up the 
 valley of that stream. 
 
 No wide-spread Tertiary areas like those of the southern 
 interior portion of British Columbia occur in the region here 
 described. The most important occurrence of beds of this age 
 is that which occupies the wide valley of the Upper Liard, but 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 269 
 
 Its extent to the north-west and south-east was not ascertained. 
 1 he rocks are soft shales, sandstones and clays, generally of 
 pale colour, a-d holdin- beds of lignite in" some places. 
 Flows of basalt either cap these rocks or are included in 
 their upper portion, and from the considerable angles of dip 
 observed, the formation Nvould appear to haxe suffered some 
 flexure subsequent to its deposition. 
 
 I 
 
 '.4 
 
 ij 
 
 P 
 
 
 ■F 
 
/^/ 
 
 p. >. 
 
 !ii 
 
 »-!. 
 
 
 if: 
 
 1 ' 
 
 
 t 
 
 
 1 i 
 
 
 ! 
 ;1 
 
 
 
 J 
 
 1 
 
 
 CHAPTER III. 
 
 Basalt-flows in the Stikine valley — Discovery of jade alonsj the route — Glaciation and 
 superficial leposits — Houlder clay of the Upper I'elly anil Lewes valleys — 
 Mastodon or niamniotli remains — Plienoniena of the glacial period and its 
 connection with the distrilmtion of placer gold deposits— Where the richest of 
 these deposits occur — Wide-spread auriferous character of the Upper Yukon 
 basin — Later superficial deposits — Their character and importance — Volcanic 
 ash deposit spread over the Upper Yukon basin — Mount Wrangell the pro!)ai)lc 
 source of the material — Period of the eruption — Its extent and duration — The 
 placer gold mines of Cassiar — Tiie Stikine River — Its importance as an 
 avcnueof coinmunication---Size and general character — I'ack trail from Telegraph 
 Creek to the centre of the Cassiar mining district — Micrometer survey of tiie 
 Stikine River — Mr. McConnell's notes and map — General trend of the Stikine 
 valley — Width, depth, and velocity of the Siikine River — Most suitai)le vessels 
 for its navigation — ^Fall of the river— The Siikine Indians — Little Cafion^ 
 Kloochman Canon — The " Grand Rapid '' — Aspect of the laniiscape. 
 
 IN the Stikine valley, cast of the Coast Ranges, important 
 local basalt -flows are met with, overlying old river and 
 valley gravels, and the lignite reported to exist some miles up 
 the Tahl-tan is, doubtless, also of Tertiary age and inferior 
 in position to the basalts. Basalt effusions of a sporadic 
 character may be frequent in other places in the region, as such 
 were actually noted in three other widely separated localities, 
 vi/. abo\<' Hoole Canon on the Pelly, at Miles Canon on the 
 Lewes, and again at the confluence of this river with the 
 Pelly. 
 
 The basalts are at least pre-glacial in age, and though no 
 characteristic fossils were observed in the associated bedded 
 deposits, both may be provisionally classed from their analogy 
 with similar deposits in the more southern portion of British 
 Columbia, as Miocene. 
 
 Having become interested in the question of the origin of 
 nephrite or jade, on account of its former extensive employment 
 by the natives of the west coast for the manufacture of imple- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 71 
 
 ments, I kept a close watch for this mineral alonp; our route, 
 and ultimately succeeded in findiuj^ several rolled pieces in 
 gravel-bars along the Lewes. Of the pebbles collected by us 
 at least five had the specific gravity and other physical 
 characters of jade, though they have not yet been subjected to 
 chemical or microscopical analysis. Several of these are 
 evidently, however, jnire and typical jade. One specimen is a 
 pale-green translucent to sub-transparent variety weighing a 
 pound and three-quarters, after a piece, probably equal to about 
 one-fourth of the original mass, had been broken off and un- 
 fortunately lost. Some of the specimens collected indicate 
 the passage, by admixture of other materials, of the pun; jades 
 into various altered rocks of volcanic origin. So far as I have 
 been able to ascertain, this discovery of jade is, with one excep- 
 tion, the first actually direct one made in the region of the 
 Pacific slope. The exception above alluded to is that of jade 
 found at the Kwichpak mouth of the Yukon during Captain 
 Jacobson's stay in that vicinity, which was obtained by him 
 and taken to Berlin.' 
 
 Such details as appear to be of interest respecting glaciation, 
 and the superficial deposits, are given in the subsetpient de- 
 scriptive portion of this report. The general bearings of these 
 are here merely summarized in the briefest possible manner.-' 
 
 Previous observations in British Columbia ' luive shown that 
 at one stage in the glacial period -that of the maximum glacia- 
 tion — a great conlluent ice-mass has occupied the region which 
 may be named the Interior Plateau, between the Coast Ranges 
 and the Cold and Rocky Mountain ranges. I'rom the 55th to 
 the 49th parallel this great glacier has left traces of its general 
 southwaril or south-eastward movement, which are distinct from 
 those of subso()uent local glacii-rs. The southern extensions or 
 terminations of this conllueiit glacier, in Washington and Itlalio 
 Territories, have (juite recently been examined by Mr. Bailley 
 M'illis ami Prof. T. C. Chaniberlin of the U.S. Ceological 
 
 ' See paper l)y I'lof. A. li. Muvit, Jaliii'slji'iiclu des \ cioins fur Enikundc 
 zu nifsilcn, 18S4. 
 
 - 'I'lio siihstaiuo of this suiiiiiiary lias bcL-n i)uhlislu'il in advance in llic 
 Geoloj;ical Mi-.^a/inc. Dcculc 111. vol. v. p. 547 (Any. 1888). 
 
 " Quart. Journ. ( icol. Soc. vol. xxxi. p. 89, Ihiii. vol. xxxiv. p. 272. Canadian 
 Naturalist, \ol. viii. 
 
 ::'l 
 
 ; ( 
 
 ) '1 
 
 'M 
 
 1 1 
 
 I 
 
 h 
 
 1 ; 
 
 1 ■ 
 
 i 
 
 iki 
 
 
 il^ 
 
 i 
 
 i 
 
272 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ;; fi 
 
 i: i . 
 
 f ■! 
 
 ijll 
 
 Survey/ and their observations tend to confirm the views 
 above outlined, which had previously been stated by the 
 writer. There is evidence to show that this inland-ice flowed 
 also, by transverse valleys and gaps, across the Coast Ranges, 
 and that the fiords of the coast were thus deeply filled with 
 glacier-ice, which, supplemented by that originating on the 
 Coast Ranges themselves, buried the entire great valley which 
 separates Vancouver Island from the mainland, and discharged 
 seaward round both e.ids of the island. Further north, the 
 glacier extending from the mainland coast touched the northern 
 shores of the (Jueen Charlotte Islands. 
 
 The littoral of the south-eastern part or " coast strip " of 
 Alaska, presents features identical with those of the previously 
 examined coast of British Columbia, at least so far north as 
 lat. 59°, beyond v 'ach I have not seen it. The coast archipelago 
 has evidently been involved in the border of a confluent glacier 
 which spread from the mainland, and was subject to minor 
 variations in direction of flow dependent on surface irregu- 
 larities. 
 
 It is, however, in the interior region, explored and examined 
 by us in 1887, between the Coast Ranges and the Rocky Moun- 
 tains oroper, and extending northward to lat. 63', that the most 
 interest ing facts have come to light respecting the direction of 
 movement of the Cordilleran glacier. Here, 1 the valleys of 
 the Upper Felly and Lewes, traces were found of the movement 
 of heavy glacier-ice in a northerly direction. Rock- surfaces 
 thus glaciated were observed down the Pelly to the point at 
 which it crosses the ijGth meridian and on the Lewes as far 
 north as lat. 61° 40', the main direction in the first-named 
 valley being north-west, in the second north-north-west. 
 
 On Lake Labarge, in the Lewes valley, both the sides and 
 summits of rocky hills 300 feet above the water were found to 
 be heavily glaciated, the direction on the summit being that of 
 the main (north-north-west) orographic valleys, while that at 
 lower levels in the same vicinity followed more nearly the 
 immediate Nulley of the river, which here turns locally to the 
 east of north. 
 
 Glaciation was also noted in several places in the more 
 ' UuUeiin U.S. Gcol. Survey, No. 40, 1887. 
 
 'ii,ll 
 
 \^\' 
 
THE YUKON TKRRITORY 
 
 273 
 
 mountainous country to the south of the Yukon basin, in the 
 Dease and Liard valleys, but the direction of movement of the 
 ice could not be determined satisfactorily, and the influence of 
 local action is there less certainly eliminated. 
 
 While the greater part of the area traversed is more or less 
 completely mantled with glacial deposits, it will be observed, in 
 referring to subsequent pages, that true boulder-clay was found 
 in certain parts only of the southern and more mountainous 
 portion of the region, while it spreads over almost the entire 
 length of the upper Pell)' and Lewes valleys, though not found 
 quite exposed to their confluence. It may be stated also that 
 the country is generally terraced to a height of 4000 feet or more, 
 while on an isolated mountain-top near the height of land 
 between the Liard and the Pelly rivers (Pacific- Arctic water- 
 shed) rolled gravel of varied origin was found at a height of 4300 
 feet, a height exceeding that of the actual watershed by over 
 1000 feet. 
 
 No remains of mastodon or mammoth were observed in the 
 country traversed by us, but according to Campbell such 
 remains occur not far from the site of Fort Selkirk, and they 
 are known to be moderately abundant at points further down 
 the river. Sir J. Richardson speaks of a tibia oi lUcphas piimi- 
 genius sent to England by Roderick (Robert) Campbell from 
 this region.' 
 
 Reverting to the statements made as to the direction of the 
 general glaciation, the examination of this northern region may 
 now be considered to have established that the main gathering- 
 ground or mvr of what I have called the great Cordilleran 
 glacier or confluent glacier mass of the west coast, was included 
 between the 55th and 59th parallels of latitude, a region which, 
 so far as explored, has proved to be of an exceptionally 
 mountainous character. It would further appear that this 
 great glacier extended, between the Coast Ranges and the 
 Rocky Mountains, south-eastward nearly to hit. 48 , and north- 
 westward to lat. 6j°, or beyond, while sending also smaller 
 streams to the Pacific Coast. 
 
 In connection with the northerly direction of ice-flow here 
 ascertained, it is interesting to recall the observations which I 
 ' \.\x\.. Joiirn. Sci. and Arts, vol. xix., 1855, p. 132. 
 
 
 '\ 
 
 
 W 
 %■ 
 
 
 \\ 
 
I 
 
 % 
 
 1/ 
 
 I ii 
 
 
 1*1 
 
 /; 
 
 I! I 
 
 M> 
 
 ■I! "f 
 ,1 .^i 
 
 274 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 have collected in a recently published report of the Geological 
 Survey, relating to the northern portion of the continent east of 
 the Mackenzie River.' It is there stated that for the Arctic 
 coast of the Continent, and the Islands of the Archipelago off 
 it, there is a considerable volume of evidence to show that the 
 main direction of movement of erratics was noithivard. The 
 most striking facts are those derived from Prof. S. Haughton's 
 Appendix to M'Clintock's Voyage, where the occurrence of 
 boulders and pebbles from North Somerset, at localities loo 
 and 135 miles north-eastward and north-westward from their 
 supposed points of origin, is described. Prof. Haugliton also 
 states that the east side of King William's Land is strewn with 
 boulders of gneiss like that of Montreal Island, to the south- 
 ward, and points out the general northward ice-movement thus 
 indicated, referring the carriage of the boulders to floating ice 
 of the glacial period. 
 
 The copper said to be picked up in large masses by the 
 Eskimo, near Princess Royal Island, in Prince of Wales Strait, 
 as well as on Prince of Wales Island,- has likewise in all 
 probability been derived from the copper-bearing rocks of the 
 Coppermine River region to the south, as this metal can 
 scarcely be supposed to occur in place in the region of 
 horizontal limestone where it is found. 
 
 Dr. A. Armstrong, Surgeon and Naturalist to the Investigator, 
 notes the occurrence of granite and other crystalline rocks not 
 only on the south shore of Baring Land, but also on the hills 
 at some distance from the shore. These, from what is known 
 of the region, must be supposed to have come from the 
 continental land to the southward. 
 
 Dr. R. Hell has found evidence of a northward or north- 
 eastward movement of glacier ice in the northern part of 
 Hudson I)ay, with distinct indications of eastward glaciation in 
 Hudson Strait.-' I'or the northern part of the great Mackenzie 
 valley we are as }et without any definite published information, 
 
 ' Notes tn accompany aCicological Ma|) of the Northern Portion of the 
 Dominion of Canada Mast of the Rocky Mountains, p. 57 K., Annual Report 
 (ieol. Surv. Can., 1886. 
 
 '-' I)e Kance, in Nature, vol. .\i., j). 4<)2. 
 
 •' Annual Report C.col. Surv. Canada, 1883, p. 14 D.l)., and Report of 
 Prog'-ess, i88:-84, p. 36 1).D. 
 
,'n 
 
 10 
 
 )n, 
 
 the 
 lort 
 
 I of 
 
 '.' 
 
:-■ -"f^-j^ Y*v,n.;i.i!fff-m 'rvaf-i 
 
 ':^ ( 
 
 i Mi 
 
 I'vi ■ 
 
 I! . 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 275 
 
 but Sir J. Richardson notes that Laurentian boulders are 
 scattered westward over the nearly horizontal limestones of 
 the district. 
 
 Taken in conjunction with the facts for the more northern 
 portion of the continent, already pretty well known, the 
 observations here outlined indicate a general movement of 
 ice outward, in all directions, from the great Laurentian 
 axis or plateau which extends from Labrador round the 
 southern extremity of Hudson Bay to the Arctic Sea ; while 
 a second, smaller, though still very important region of dis- 
 persion — the Cordilleran glacier mass — occupied the Rocky 
 Mountain region on the west, with the northern and southern 
 Hmits above approximately given, and a length, in a north-west 
 and south-east direction, of at least 1200 miles. 
 
 While the study of the phenomena of the glacial period 
 is one not without its bearings on economic problems even 
 in the eastern part of the continent, it has, in British 
 Columbia and the Yukon district, a direct value in its con- 
 nection with the distribution of the placer gold deposits, and 
 on the existence and position of the buried channels of rivers 
 and streams, in which some of the richest of those deposits 
 often occur. Thus the greater part of the " fine " gold found 
 along the river-bars and banks of the larger streams in the 
 Yukon district is doubtless proximately derived from the 
 gravels and other superficial deposits in which these streams 
 have re-excavated their beds since the period of glaciation. By 
 the general dispersion and intermixture of these materials, 
 composed of the di'bris of the older rock formations, it is even 
 possible that the existence of a few comparatively limited 
 original areas of great richness might account for the latter day 
 wide-spread auriferous character of the alluviums of the Upper 
 Yukon basin. 
 
 A circumstance of some interest in connection with the later 
 superficial deposits of that part of the Upper Yukon basin 
 drained by the Lewes and Pelly rivers, is the occurrence of a 
 wide-spread layer of volcanic ash or pumiceous sand. The 
 existence of a peculiar white line or band in the upper parts of 
 scarped banks along the river, was first remarked not many 
 miles below the point at which we embarked on the Pelly. As 
 
 D 2 
 
 *f 
 
 m\ i 
 
 h 
 
 
 14 i 1' 
 
 ;■ 
 
 
 
 !|' 
 
276 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 *l 
 
 ?if 
 
 its character was not at first understood, I omitted to note the 
 precise point at which it was first seen, but am of opinion that 
 it probably extends to the east of the place where we reached 
 the river. After its character and importance had been recopf- 
 nized, however, it was looked for and noticed almost continu- 
 ously along the whole course of the Pelly, as far down as the 
 mouth of the Macmillan, it was not distinctly recognized, but 
 according to Mr. McConnell (1888) it extends down the river 
 for about ten miles below Fort Selkirk. It is likewise seen 
 along nearly the whole course of the Lewes, being last noted at 
 the narrows between Lake Nares and Bennett Lake, known as 
 Caribou Crossing. 
 
 This ash deposit appears to be entirely due to a single period 
 of eruption. It is homogeneous in character wherever seen, 
 forming a single layer not divided by intercalations of other 
 material, and has been spread everywhere over the entire area 
 characterized by it. It is much more recent in date than the 
 white silt deposits, the last properly referable to the glacial 
 series, these having been deposited after the river-valleys were 
 excavated in the glacial materials, and at a time when the rives 
 had cut down nearly or quite to their present levels. This 
 is made evident by the circumstance that it overlies the deposits 
 of river and valley-gravels and sands in all cases, except m those 
 of some low river-flats, where these deposits sometimes cover it 
 to a depth of several feet. In most places it is overlain merely 
 by the surface soil with a depth of six inches to two feet, and in 
 a few instances it was noted as constituting the actual surface of 
 terraces of moderate height, the present forest being rooted in it. 
 
 The ash appears to have fallen tranquilly, much in the manner 
 of snow deposited from a calm atmosphere. The examination 
 of scarped banks along the two rivers showed it to occur near 
 the surface of terraces about 200 feet in height, as well as on 
 lower terraces and river-flats down to within about ten feet of 
 the actual river-level in August and September. It was also 
 detected in some places on the sloping fronts of terraces. The 
 thickness of the layer was no doubt originally pretty uniform, 
 and it still retains this uniformity where it rests upon wide flat 
 terraces. Its average normal thickness for the Pelly, as a whole, 
 was estimated at about five inches, but this is somewhat 
 
 ■ml 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 277 
 
 exceeded along the part of the river immediately above the 
 Macmillan. On the Lewc^. below Rink Rapid, its normal 
 thickness is about a foot, but above this point it becomes much 
 less, and where last seen, at Caribou Crossing, is not over 
 half an inch thick, and only to be recognized when carefully 
 looked for. 
 
 Where the ash deposit rests undisturbed upon the original 
 surface, this appears very generally to be a yellowish or reddish 
 quart ■^ose sand. There are, in some cases, remains of burnt 
 trees at the base of the layer, and traces of similar forest fires 
 are found as well in the sand or soil overlying it. 
 
 The volcanic ash is thicker on the lower part of the Lewes 
 than elsewhere, and the thickest part of the deposit on the 
 Pelly lies nearly due east of the portion of the Lewes just 
 referred to. The greater mass of the deposit in that direction 
 shows that it was derived from the westward, and a line drawn 
 across the portions of the Pelly and Lewes above defined, lies 
 between the 62nd and 63rd parallels of latitude, with a nearly 
 east-and-west bearing, so that if produced to the westward it 
 would pass, at a distance of about 200 miles, through the 
 mountain region near the Copper Region, of Alaska, which 
 includes Mount Wrangell. Mount WrangcU is the nearest 
 known volcano,* and this or one of the neighbouring mountains 
 in the same group, may not improbably have been the source of 
 the material which has been so widely spread over the Upper 
 Yukon basin. 
 
 Respecting the date of the eruption to which the ash-bed is 
 due, very little can be said with certainty. As already noted, 
 the rivers have not certainly cut their beds perceptibly deeper 
 since the deposit occurred on their flood-flats, so that the period 
 to which it belongs cannot be an exceedingly remote one. It 
 was further observed in one place, on the Lewes, to rest upon 
 stratified sands a few feet thick, which in turn overlie a mass 
 of drift logs still quite sound and undecayed. This fact, with 
 the general appearance and mode of occurrence of the deposit, 
 leads me to believe, that while the eruption must have happened 
 at least several hundreds of j-ears ago, it can scarcely be sup- 
 
 ' Sec Lieut. H. T. Allen's Reconnaissance in Alaska, Washington, Govern- 
 ment, 1887. 
 
 t 
 
 !i 1 
 
 :|i 
 
 'A' 
 
 <l 
 
 :ii 
 
if 
 I 
 
 1 '*'*''' 
 
 ■■I'l 
 
 /it 
 
 i 
 
 < 
 
 i^i 
 
 u 
 
 I 
 
 I' 
 
 278 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 posed to have taken place more than a thousand years before 
 the present time. 
 
 That the eruption of which the occurrence is marked by the 
 ash-bed of the Lewes and Pelly, was on a great scale, is suffi- 
 ciently evident from the extent of the deposit ; which must 
 necessarily be very much greater than the area to which the 
 present observations refer. By drawing a line to include 
 the outer limits of the observed extent of the ash, a roughly 
 triangular area of about 25,000 square miles is outlined, and if 
 we assume the average depth of the layer over this area alone 
 to be three inches, the mass represented would be equivalent 
 to a prism one mile square, with a height of 6240 feet, or 
 (making allowance for interspaces in the comminuted material) 
 equal to nearly a cubic mile of rock. 
 
 Since the year 1873, when the placer gold niines of Cassiar 
 were first developed, the Stikine River has become a somewhat 
 important avenue of communication from the coast to the 
 interior of the northern part of British Columbia. Like the 
 Fraser, the Skeena, the Nass and several other smaller streams, 
 it rises to the east of the broad belt of mountains which consti- 
 tutes the Coast Ranges, and cuts completely through this belt 
 with a nearly uniform gradient. In size and general character 
 the Stikine closely resembles the Skeena, which reaches the 
 coast 200 miles further south. It is navigable for stern-wheel 
 steamers of light draught and good power, to Glenora, 126 miles 
 from Rothsaj' Point, at its mouth, and under favourable circum- 
 stances to Telegraph Creek, twelve miles farther. Above 
 Telegraph Creek is the " Great Canon," which extends for 
 many miles and is quite impassable either for steamers or boats, 
 though traversed by miners in winter on the ice. The head- 
 waters of the Stikine are unknown, but lie for the most part to 
 the south of the 58th parallel of north latitude, in a country 
 said to be very mountainous. From Telegraph Creek, the head 
 of navigation, a pack-trail sixty-two miles and a half in length, 
 constructed by the British Columbian Government, follows the 
 valley of the Stikine, generally at no great distance from the 
 river, and eventually crosses from the Tanzilla or Third North 
 Fork to the head of Dease Lake, which may be regarded as the 
 centre of the Cassiar mining district. 
 
THE YUKON TEKKITOKY 
 
 2 79 
 
 My personal acquaintance with the Stikine, so far as 
 Telegraph Creek, was supplemented by the observations of 
 Mr. McConnell, who remained behind for the purpose of making 
 a micrometer survey of the river from the furthest point 
 reached by Mr. Hunter's survey of 1877 to Telegraph Creek. 
 Mr. McConnell's notes and map with specimens collected by 
 him have been consulted in the following sketch of the river, 
 and are drawn upon particularly in respect of its geological 
 features. 
 
 The general trend of the Stikine valley for twenty miles from 
 the sea, is east and west, corresponding in direction to 
 Bradtield Canal, which penetrates the coast thirty miles to the 
 south, and also to part of the northern portion of Behm Canal 
 and Burroughs' Bay, still further south. At this distance 
 from the coast the river bends through a quadrant of arc, and 
 assumes a nearly due north direction ; this it maintains for 
 about sixty-six miles, beyond which the valley is continued in 
 a nearly direct north-eastward course to the vicinity of Dease 
 Lake, but in its upper portion is occupied, not by the main 
 river, but by the Tanzilla or Third North Fork, the main river 
 entering this continuous valley from the southward. 
 
 The current of the navigable portion of the Stikine is swift 
 throughout, but there are no rapids properly so called, though 
 the Little Canon (fifty-three miles above the great bend) forms 
 a serious impediment to navigation when the river is at its 
 highest stage in June or July, in consequence of the great 
 velocity of the current in this narrow and rocky though deep 
 gorge. The width of the Stikine immediately opposite 
 Telegraph Creek was found on May 2gth to be 480 feet only, 
 but here it is deep, and had a velocity of 6"o8 miles per hour, 
 as determined from several observations. A few days later 
 it was rising fast, and the velocity was considerably greater. 
 
 Stern-wheel steamers for the navigation of the river should 
 have good engine power, and should draw not more than four 
 feet of water when loaded. 
 
 The height of the river above sea-level at Telegraph Creek, 
 as deduced from simultaneous barometric observations at the 
 mouth and at this place, is 540 feet, giving an average fall of 
 over four feet to the mile by the course of the stream. The 
 
 ii 
 
 il 
 
\^ 
 
 m 
 
 ! 
 
 ■I' 
 
 i ' 
 It i 
 
 I 
 
 Jt 
 
 ti 
 
 i 
 
 ■,r' 
 
 ■ i^l 
 
 Ml- 
 
 280 
 
 Till-: YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 actual fall on the upper part of this lenj^'th of the river must, 
 however, considerably exceed this tiprure, while that of the lower 
 portion is inconsiderable. Under ordinary circumstances the 
 ascent of the river to Telegraph Creek, with a suitable steamer, 
 occupies about three days, and it is generally necessary to carry 
 a line ashore at a few places. The extensive flats near the 
 mouth of the river render it necessary to enter it about high 
 tide. Mr. Hunter ascertained that the channel across these 
 flats has from one to two feet only of water at low tide. A 
 considerable proportion of the traffic is carried on by Indians 
 with canoes, and the Stikine Indians are very expert in all 
 the necessary operations of tracking and poling in swift 
 water. 
 
 The entrance to the Stikine from the sea is not distinguish- 
 able in its main orographic features from that of many of the 
 salt-water inlets by which this part of the West Coast is 
 dissected. 
 
 The valley bottom maintains an average width of from two 
 to three miles so far up as the Little Canon ; this place may be 
 regarded as nearly marking the head of the old salt-water inlet 
 which had been silted up by the river. The canon is about 
 three-fifths of a mile long, and in places not more than fifty 
 yards wide. It is bordered by massive granite cliffs, 200 to 300 
 feet in height, above which, on the west side, rugged mountain 
 slopes rise. On the east are low rocky hills representing part 
 of a former spur of the mountain, through which the canon has 
 been cut. A tract of low land separates these hills from the 
 easteiM side of the main valley, and it is difficult to conjecture 
 uu jrwhat circumstances the river has taken its present course. 
 
 Eight miles further up is the " K'oochman Caiion," but it is 
 nearly 300 feet in width and offers no 'inpediment to navigation. 
 At four miles above the " Kloochman Canon " is the so-called 
 '* Grand Rapid," which, in consequence of recent changes in 
 the river, is now by no means formidable, though the water is 
 still particularly swift and the river wide and shallow. Here 
 the valley begins very markedly to open out, the mountains 
 retiring further from the river and decreasing in altitude, while 
 irregular, basaltic hills, of no great height, appear between the 
 river and the bases of the mountains. This, taken in conjunc- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 tion with the dry climate which characterizes the country to 
 the east of he mountains, and the fact that most of the slop s 
 
 Da^tl'f^tf '"' ''^'°r^^ ^^'"'"' ^"^P-'^^^t tributaries in the 
 pa t of Its course above described, though none of these have 
 yet been examined in detail. 
 
 I 
 
 ^ 
 
 i 
 
 yi 
 
 
 11 
 
 , c 
 
 < 1 
 
CHAPTER IV. 
 
 l4i 
 
 Valley of the Scud River — Clearwater River — First South Fori: — Telegraph Creek — 
 Origin of its name — The glaciers of the Stikine valley — First or Little Glacier — 
 Great Glacier — Dirt Cilacier— Flood Glacier — General composition of the central 
 ranges— Basaltic rocks and the occurrence of placer deposits of gold — Com- 
 position of rocks m the vicini'y of Telegraph Creek — Terrace deposits at the 
 mouth of the Stikine — Difierence between the coast and inland climates — 
 Vegetation of the Coa'^t Ranges and Telegraph Creek in May— Loral variations 
 of climate— Cultivation at Telegraph Creek and Glenora — Date when Stikine 
 usually opens lor navigation — When closed — When first discovered — The first 
 discovery of placer gold on the bars of the Stikine — Its exploration by Major 
 I'ope — Discovery of gold in the Cassiar region — Trail from Telegraph Creek to 
 head of Dease, Lake — Country traversed by the trail — The Tahl-tan River — Gold- 
 mining in the Tahl-tan valley — Tooya, or Second North Fork— Caribou Camp — 
 The Tooya valley — Valley of the Tanzilla, or Third North Fork. 
 
 ■/ 
 
 ABOUT seven miles below the Little Cai'ion, the valley of 
 the Scud River opens to the east, but the exact position of 
 the mouth of the stream has not been fixed on the map. Some 
 gold has been found by prospectors on this stream, but nowork- 
 a'Je placer deposits. It is said to head in a low country behind 
 the Coast Mountains, and if this be correct, must neai"ly 
 inosctilate with branches of the Iskoot and I'irst South Fork of 
 the Stikine. 
 
 Six miles above '* Kloochman Cafion," the Clearwater River 
 enters the Stikine on the west side, by several mouths. The 
 latter is a stream of considerable oize, and is navigable for 
 canoes for some distance. It is said to head near the sources 
 of one branch of the Taku River, and is noted by the Indians 
 for the great number of salmon which ascend it. 
 
 The First South Fork joins the Stikine about a mile and 
 a half below Telegraph (3reek. It is a large ttn^bid streaiu, and 
 for a number of miles from the main river, Hows in a rough 
 narrow gorge, between high hills and mountains. Further up, 
 according to the Telegraph Exploration sketch, it is bordered 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 283 
 
 '.!'!? 
 
 
 le 
 or 
 :es 
 ns 
 
 lul 
 nd 
 
 Kli 
 ip, 
 •cd 
 
 by level, partly timbered terraces or " benches." The summit 
 between its head-waters and those of the Iskoot, on ihe route 
 followed by Mr. Leech, is given on his authority at 5000 feet. 
 Salmon do not ascend this stream. 
 
 Telegraph Creek is an inconsiderable stream, which falls 
 rapidly to the river through a narrow rocky cleft in the border- 
 ing hills of the right or north-west bank of the Stikine. Its 
 name is due to the fact that here the Western Union Telegraph 
 line was intended to cross the Stikine. The little town of 
 Telegraph Creek occupies the narrow delta and the lower 
 terraces bordering it on both sides, its site being identical 
 with that of " Tord Mumford"of the older maps. Glenora, 
 twelve miles below Telegraph Creek and on the same side of 
 the Stikine, consists of a single 'row of houses built along 
 the edge of the river at the foot of a steep bank. Both places 
 were at one time busy little towns, but are at present very much 
 reduced in importance, though I believe it will probably not be 
 long before further mining developments in the Cassiar district 
 will lead to the renewal of their activity. 
 
 The glaciers constitute one of the most remarkable features 
 of this part of the Stikine valley. There are a number of these 
 on both sides of the river, in its lower part ; but four only of 
 special importance, all situated to the west of the river, and 
 all but the first on the eastern slopes of the most massive 
 central ranges of the mountainous region. 
 
 Mr. John Muir, who spent some time on tlu' Stikine in i^yg, 
 gives an interesting popular description of its glaciers in a letter 
 dated from Sitka in December of that year, and published in 
 the San Francisco Bulletin. Mr. Muir informs me that no 
 more systematic account of his observation- in this region has 
 yet been made public. 
 
 The glacier known by the nrners as the I'irst or Little 
 Glacier (named the Popoff Glacier by Blake) fills a high valley 
 on the north side of the river, about ten miles from its mouth. 
 As seen from a distance it offers no feature; of particular 
 interest, but resembles many other minor glaciers of the Coast 
 Mountains. 
 
 The next .ind most important glacier is that universally 
 known on ^he river as the Great Glacier. Before entering the 
 
 m 
 1 1?. 
 
 
 
 i i1 
 
 ^li 
 
284 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 V.:' 
 
 /'i 
 
 r) 'I 
 
 Hi ;!• 
 
 ♦1 
 
 i;;' 
 
 III' 
 
 Stikine valley, this j^lacicr has a width estimated at from one- 
 Iialf to three-quarters of a mile, but upon frecinj:^ itself from the 
 bordering mountains immediately expands in a fan-like manner, 
 its actual front upon the river being from three to three and a 
 half miles in width. Large streams issue from beneath the ice, 
 the position of outflow frequently changing from year to year. 
 
 Next to its size, the most remarkable feature about this 
 glacier is the regularity of the fan-like form in which it 
 terminates. It resembles in this I'espect the Davidson Glacier 
 on Lynn Canal. 
 
 The miners state that during the few years of their know- 
 ledge of the Stikine, the Great Glacier has steadily and notably 
 receded, though the total amount of such recession can 
 evidently not have been more than the distance from the 
 wooded bordering moraine to the present ice-front. The 
 Indians relate as a tradition, that at a former period the glacier 
 stretched completely across the valley, the Stikine passing 
 beneath the ice through a tunnel-like opening. It is, however, 
 impossible to determine whetlier this is a remembered fact or 
 only an inference. Curiously enough, a copious hot spring is 
 situated immediately opposite the glacier on the east side of the 
 Stikine valley. 
 
 Ten miles above the Great Glacier, and also on the west side 
 of the valley, is the Dirt Glacier, so named by the miners 
 because of the great quantity of rocky drliris with which its 
 surface is covered.' This is much smaller than the last, having 
 a width estimated at a quarter of a mile, but possibly greater. 
 Like the Great Glacier, it comes quite down on the river-flats. 
 
 The last important glacier, sixteen miles still further up the 
 river, is the L'lood Glacier. This also comes down to the level 
 of the river-flats, but doi'S not closely approach the river. 
 From *-he valley of this glacier a great rush of water O' nrs 
 almost every jear towards the end of the summer. This, no 
 doubt, arises from the blocking by the glacier of the mouth of 
 some lateral \alley in which a lake is formed, and from time to 
 time breaks through the glacier dam. The quantity of water 
 thus liberated is so great as t(j raise the river from a low stag^ 
 
 ' Also so named on sketch mrp in Report on Customs District, Public 
 Service and Resources of Alaska Territory, by \V. G. Morris, 1879. 
 
■el 
 
 rs 
 
 lO 
 
 of 
 
 to 
 
 :cr 
 
 p'' 
 t. 
 
 )lic 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 28' 
 
 to half-flood level for a short time. There is a large quantity 
 oi di'bris also on this jjjlacier, though less than on tho last. 
 
 The Great Glacier, rising many miles back in the higher 
 ranges of the mountains, in the material which it has brought 
 down and deposited in its moraine, affords a mode of ascer- 
 taining the peneral composition of the central ranges. This 
 material was found b}' Mr. McConnell to consist almost 
 entirely of grey granite of medium grain, composed of felspar, 
 quart/ and hornblende in nearly equal proportions, but holding 
 also a little mica and occasional crystals of sphene. Dioritcs 
 and mica-schists occur in smaller quantity, together with coarse 
 pegmatite, which is evidently derived from veins intersecting 
 the granite. 
 
 A short distance below the " Grand Rapid," distinctly strati- 
 fied rocks of dark colour cap some of the mountains and rest 
 upon the granites. Th'.se beds have a dip of N. 70" E. < 30°, 
 which brings them down to the level of the river near the rapid. 
 They consist of hard argillitcs and grauwacke-quartzites, inter- 
 bedded with grey and brownish impure limestones, the whole 
 being considerabl}' disturbed and cut near the granites by coarse 
 grej- porphyritic dykes of that rock. The argillitcs were not 
 observed to hold staurolite, mica, or other crystalline minerals 
 like those of Wrangell, and otherwise differ somewhat in appear- 
 ance from these, though their relation to the granitic rocks 
 appears to be similar. They are followed in ascending order 
 by a massive grey-blue sub-crystalline limestone of considerable 
 though undetermined thickness, which can be t''aced in the 
 mountains for some distance on both sides of the valley. These 
 limestones are believed to represent those afterwards noted on 
 the Dease and there referred to tlie Carboniferous period. 
 
 Altered volcanic rocks only, were seen along the river for 
 al)out twelve miles above the Clearwater, but there is reason to 
 believe that outliers of Tertiary l);.salt also occur in this part of 
 the valley. At the distance just mentioned above the Clear- 
 water, and aliout six miles and a half below f'.lcnora. exposures 
 are found of slaty argillitcs and dark shaly rocks, containing 
 some impure limestone, all very much broki'u and disturbed, 
 and associated with altered volcanic materials. Some beds of 
 these shaly limestones prove on microscopical examination to 
 
 i 
 
 I 
 
 M 
 
 III 
 
 1 1 
 I 
 
 j.' 
 
■:mr' 
 
 gyiMi'. <M.tff' ; s^'iV«sjw>yw? w3 i* ^f^ '»^ yy*f ^ 
 
 286 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 if, 
 
 S I 
 
 I'l 
 
 consist chiefly of organic fragments which are not, however, 
 sufficiently distinctive for the reference of the beds. 
 
 From this point to Telegraph Creek, basaltic and other con 
 paratively modern volcanic rocks become prominent features, 
 the basalts appearing as remnants of horizontal flows, the 
 broken edges of which form scarped cliffs. These rocks are 
 due to a period antecedent to that of the glacial deposits, and 
 are of Tertiary age. Analogy with neighbouring parts of 
 British Columbia indicates that they may be assigned vv'ith 
 probability to the Miocene. The basalts have evidently flowed 
 along and partially filled the old river-valley, and unconformably 
 overlie the old altered volcanic rocks previously alluded to, as 
 well as all the 1"^' rock series. 
 
 About two m elow Glenora, the basaltic rocks were 
 
 noticed in one place > have filled the old river-bed, conforming 
 in their lower la^'ers to the slopes of its sides, and to have been 
 subsequently cut across obliquely by the present river. Other 
 examples of this character are of special interest in connection 
 with the occurrence of placer deposits of gold. 
 
 Betw^een Glenora and Telegraph Creek, the rocks seen below 
 the basalts include at least two distinct series. The first and 
 oldest of these is represented by a number of occurrences of 
 altered volcinic rocks, like those previously referred to, as well 
 as by considerable exposures (beginning about a mile above 
 Glenora) of grey and blackish, rather cherty quartzites, often 
 nearly on edge. The second consists of slightly indurated 
 conglomerates, sandstones and shales, the conglomerates being 
 often very coarse and containing pebbles both of the older 
 volcanic series and of the granites and granitoid rocks. These 
 lie at comparatively moderate angles of inclination. No fossils 
 were observed in them, but in their lithological character as 
 well as in their position relatively to the Coast Ranges, they 
 resemble rocks of Cretaceous age met with in other parts of 
 British Columbia, both to the south and north of the Stikine, 
 and may be provisionally referred to that period. 
 
 In the immediate vicinity of Telegraph Creek, the prevalent 
 rock is a grey-green, speckled, altered volcanic material, which 
 proves to be a fine-grained diabase-tuff. The high hill immedi- 
 ately opposite Telegraph Creek, on the other side of the river, 
 
 i 1 
 
 u\ 
 
ier 
 
 3se 
 
 tils 
 
 as 
 
 ey 
 
 lie, 
 
 tnt 
 ich 
 Idi- 
 icr, 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 28; 
 
 is composed of similar old volcanic rocks, comprising compact 
 diabase and a massive diabase-agglomerate. 
 
 About two miles below Telegraph Creek, on the right bank 
 of the river, a portion of the basaltic filling of the old valley 
 forms a range of columnar cliffs about 200 feet above the 
 present water-level. A second similar remnant occurs just 
 above Telegraph Creek, on the same side, and a portion of it 
 extends vp Telegraph Creek itself for a mile or more. Basaltic 
 dykes, which may have served as sources of supply of molten 
 material at the time of eruption, cut the older rocks. Though 
 in some cases simulating the appearance of terraces, the basaltic 
 shelves along the sides of the valley are quite distinct from 
 and of earlier date than these. 
 
 The portion of the Alaskan coast which I have seen, viz. 
 that to the south of the sgth parallel, shows the same general 
 absence of terrace deposits which has already been noted and 
 commented on in the case of the British Columbian coast. In 
 the vicinity of the mouth of the Stikine, terraces fifteen to 
 twenty feet in height are found, resembling the wooded flats 
 met with further up the river, but as they are here upon tide- 
 water, they indicate doubtless an elevation of the coast-line to 
 that amount. Further up the river, the first appearance of 
 high-level terraces is at about two miles below the Great 
 Glacier. Those here seen are quite narrow, and were estimated 
 to be 500 and 700 feet respectively above the river. The 
 river, for the first time, shows bordering-terraces of from thirty 
 to fifty feet in height, about six miles below the Little Canon, 
 and similar terraces are frequently seen above this point. On 
 the mountain above Glenora a distinct but small terrace was 
 seen from a distance at an estimated height of 1500 feet above 
 the river. At Telegraph Creek the two principal terraces are 
 go and 200 feet respectively above the river-level. 
 
 The traverse of the Coast Ranges by the Stikine River, from 
 its mouth to Telegraph Creek, affords an excellent illustration 
 of the difference between the coast and inland climates, 
 repeating to a great extent the phenotnena met with in making 
 a similar traverse of the same ranges in the southern part of 
 British Columbia. The annual precipitation at Wrangell, at 
 the mouth of the Stikine, is over sixty inches, while in the 
 
 w 
 
 li 
 
 
 It 
 
 I 
 
 'i!; 
 
 [h 
 
 I 
 
M 
 
 
 m 
 
 tlii ;!' 
 i ' 
 
 ,H" 
 
 I. 
 
 
 'it 
 
 288 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 vicinity of Telej^raph Creek, distant only 140 miles, but on the 
 inland side of the mountains, the precipitation is so small that 
 irrigation is necessary to cultivated land. 
 
 Nor does this comparison of rain-fall sufficiently mark the 
 great difference between the two climates. The prevalence of 
 clouded skies in the coast region is accompanied by a saturated 
 state of the atmosphere, precisely opposite conditions being 
 found on the eastern side of the mountain belt, at not more 
 than eighty miles inland from the general line of the coast. The 
 coast climate is, of course, much more temperate than that of 
 the interior, which, even no further off than Telegraph Creek, 
 becomes one of extremes. Miners state that the snow accumu- 
 lates on the river-flats of the lower part of the Stikine, within 
 the mountains, to a depth of from eight to ten feet, while at 
 Telegraph Creek on the eastern slope of the range and on 
 the Tahl-tan River it seldom exceeds eighteen inches. At the 
 latter places horses and mules have been wintering out for a 
 number of years. The great depth of snow retards the advance 
 of spring all along the portion of the river where it occurs. 
 
 Vegetation is much farther advanced in spring on the inland 
 side of the Coast Ranges than elsewhere. In the middle of May 
 the cotton-woods and other deciduous trees at the mouth of the 
 Stikine and along its lower part showed merely a general faint 
 greenish tint as the buds opened. Four days later, in the vicinity 
 of Telegraph Cre^ '.;, the appearance was almost that of early 
 summer. A great number of plants were in flower, and butterflies 
 and humming-birds were abundant. As the river is ascended 
 the change from a very moist to a dry climate is indicated by 
 the variation of the species of plants. 
 
 The local differences of climite are important. Thus Glenora, 
 though about twelve miles only from Telegraph Creek, is said 
 to experie:.:e much greater cold in winter, and the snow-fall is 
 also greater, being estimated at three feet and a half. Less 
 snow falls on the Tahl-tan than elsewhere, the amount increas- 
 ing both to the east and west of that place. Strong winds blow- 
 ing up stream or inland are prevalent in the Stikine valley in 
 summer, but occur in the reverse direction, as a rule, in 
 winter. 
 
 During the few days we spent at Telegraph Creek, in the latte 
 
(led 
 
 by 
 
 )ra, 
 
 ll is 
 
 ^css 
 
 as- 
 
 |o\v- 
 
 in 
 
 in 
 
 Itte 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 >89 
 
 part of May, the wind generally blew up the river and was often 
 strong. The high distant ranges of the Coast Mountains to tlie 
 west were usually enveloped in clouds, and heavy sho\\ers were 
 evidently of common occurrence. The sky at Telegraph Creek 
 was also as a rule largely obscured, but after passing over 
 the Coast Mountains the clouds were more broken, and pro- 
 duced merely a few drops of rain now and then ; the conditions 
 being similar to those met with in the dry country to the east of 
 the same range in the Fraser valley, much further south. 
 
 Cultivation in the vicinity of Telegraph Creek and Glenora is 
 practically confined to the raising of small quantities of vege- 
 tables and of barley and fodder for animals. There is, however, 
 in this vicinity, in the aggregate, a considerable area of land 
 which might be tilled if there were sufficient local demand to 
 warrant it. Excellent potatoes are produced, and though the 
 leaves are occasionally touched by frost, the crop is seldom 
 affected. It has further been ascertained by trial on a sufficient 
 scale that not only barley, but wheat and oats will ripen, and 
 that all ordinary garden vegetables can be produced. The 
 record is a remarkable one for the 58th degree of north lati- 
 tude. 
 
 According to Mr. J. C. Callbreath, of Telegraph Creek, the 
 Stikine generally opens for navigation between April 2otli and 
 May 1st. The river usually freezes over before the end of 
 November. The highest water occurs in the early summer, 
 generally in June. Horses and mules find grazing on the Tahl- 
 tan from April 20th or May ist to about December ist, after 
 which date they require some hay. 
 
 Though the position of the Stikine is indicated on \':mi- 
 couver's charts by the open channels of the river, and the 
 shoals about its estuary are mapped, the existence of a large 
 river was not recognized by that navigator, who visited this part 
 of the coast in 1793. According to Mr. W. H. Dall, the river 
 was first found by fur traders in 1799. In 1S34 the Hudson IJay 
 Company fitted out a vessel named tin; Dryad for the i)urpose 
 of establishing a post and colony at the mouth of the Stikine, 
 but the Russians, being apprised of this circmnstance. sent two 
 small armed vessels to the spot, and constructed a defensive 
 work, which they named Fort Dionysius, on the site of the 
 
 !;! 
 
 ''f 
 
 in 
 
 V 
 
 • 
 
 1 \ 
 
 V 
 
 J 
 
!90 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 I • 
 
 r 
 
 present town of Wrangell. Finding themselves thus fore- 
 stalled, the Company retired. This dispute was compromised 
 in 1837, when an arrangement was made by which the Com- 
 pany leased for a term of years all that part of the Russian 
 territory which now constitutes the " coast strip " of Alaska, 
 and the "fort " was handed over to the Company, the British 
 flag being hoisted under a salute of seven guns, in June, 1840. 
 
 The first discovery of placer gold on its bars was made in 186 1, 
 by two miners named Choquette (" Buck ") and Carpenter. In 
 the following spring several prospecting parties were fitted out in 
 Victoria, and a number of men passed the summer in mining 
 on the river. In 1863, the Russian authorities, hearing of the dis- 
 covery of gold, despatched the corvette Rynda to ascertain 
 whether the mining was being carried on in Russian territory. A 
 boat party from this vessel, under Lieutenant Pereleshin, ascended 
 the river to a point a few miles above the Little Canon, occupying 
 May 23rd to June ist on the expedition. Mr. W. P. Blake 
 accompanied this party, and in addition to the sketch-map 
 published by the Russians, his report on the Stikine, previously 
 alluded to, is based on it.' 
 
 A Hudson Bay post was established on the east side of the 
 river in 1862 or 1863 and maintained till about 1874, when it 
 was moved to the vicinity of Glenora, where it remained till 
 1878, when it was abandoned. 
 
 In 1866, explorations for the line of the Western Union or 
 Collins' Telegraph Company were extended to the Stikine under 
 Major Pope. These were continued in 1867 and embraced most 
 of the principal tributaries of the river. The results were not 
 separately published, and the whole enterprise of which they 
 were a part was abanaoned. The sketch-maps then made were, 
 however; partly embodied in the small map accompanying Mr. 
 W. H. Dall's work on Alaska (1870), and with greater complete- 
 ness in other subsequent maps of the region. 
 
 In 1873, Messrs. Thibert and McCullough, travelling west- 
 ward from the Mackenzie, discovered gold in the Cassiar region, 
 and fell in with the miners already engaged in placer work 
 on the Stikine in the autumn of that year. The subsequent 
 
 ' Geographical Notes upon Russian American and the Stickeen River ; 
 Washington, 1S68. Also, Am. Journ. Sci. and Arts, vol. -xliv , 1867, p. 96. 
 
or 
 ider 
 
 not 
 
 v'cre, 
 
 Mr. 
 
 Ilcte- 
 
 /est- 
 ;ion, 
 Ivork 
 luent 
 
 liver 
 
 THE VUKON TKKRITORY 
 
 291 
 
 history of the river is inckided in that of the Cassiar mining 
 district. 
 
 The trail from Telegraph Creek to the head of Dease Lake 
 was opened by the Government of British Columbia in 1874. 
 It has since been kept in a fair state of repair, and is a good 
 route for pack animals. It follows the north side of the Stikine 
 and Tanzilla valleys, and is sixty-two miles and a half in total 
 length. 
 
 On leaving Telegraph Creek, the trail makes a steep ascent 
 to the level of a broad terrace, and runs along at a considerable 
 height above the river, till it again descends, at eleven miles, to 
 the valley of the Tahl-tan or First North Fork, near its month. 
 The main valley of the Stikine is here about four miles in width, 
 and is bordered by high hills and mountains of rounded forms ; 
 those to the north often nearly bare, while those on the opposite 
 side are generall}- either wooded or strewn with burnt logs 
 where fires have passed. The river occupies a canon, with 
 precipitous banks often 300 feet in height, which has been cut 
 in the bottom of this great valley. It is very rough and rapid, 
 but there are no true falls. Terraces are well developed at 
 several levels on both sides of the river, which is frequently 
 bordered by vertical basaltic cliffs. 
 
 The country traversed b\- the trail between Telegraph Creek 
 and the Tahl-tan is wooded only in patches, the trees being 
 chiefly black pine (Pi'nus M/irravana) and aspen {Popidus 
 treniiiloides), with occasional specimens of white birch, and 
 alder and willow in the hollows. The soil is reddish and rather 
 sandy, and appears very dry, being but scantily clothed with 
 thin, tufty grass and bear-berry. 
 
 The Tahl-tan River, crossed near its mouth by a good bridge, 
 is a large and rapid stream, which rises about thirty miles to the 
 north-westward. Its valley is narrow and almost canon-like 
 where it reaches the Stikine, and has cut through basalt-flows 
 and heavy underlying gravel deposits to a depth of about one 
 hundred and fifty feet, though its right bank, just above the 
 crossing, is composed of the older rocks. It is resorted to by 
 the Indians for salmon fishing during a part of the summer, and 
 there are several temporary houses and a number of graves. 
 The angle between this river and the Stikine, on the right bank, 
 
 E 2 
 
 ! I 
 
 I ; 
 
 U 
 
 • I 
 
 i 
 
 il 
 

 py 
 
 
 W( 
 
 rfi 
 
 uH 
 
 h 'f" 
 
 K!; 
 
 
 m 
 
 '1 
 
 
 1J^ 
 
 
 192 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 shows three clearly dertned, superposed, columiuir hasalt-flcnvs. 
 The opposite angle, up which the trail /i|^'-/ags, is in the form 
 of a long, narrow point, composed of large pieces of basalt lying 
 in great confusion, with deep interspaces and crevices. This is 
 generally known as the " lava-bed." Gold mining was at one 
 time carried on successfully fur some miles up the Tahl-tan 
 valley. 
 
 The Tahl-tan occupies a portion of an important valley which 
 carries, to the north-westward, the upper branches of the Taku 
 and the furthest sources of the Lewes River. The Indians travel 
 along this vallej', and it appears worthy of attention as a route 
 from the navigable waters of the Stikine to the Yukon basin. 
 
 The distance from the Tahl-tan to the Tooya, or Second 
 North Fork, is about six miles. For half this distance, to 
 Ward's house (now abandoned, like other places of call along 
 this route) the trail runs near the Stikine River, whose imme- 
 diate valley still continues to be occupied b}- basaltic-tlows. 
 Above these, however, the sides of the valle\- are generally 
 formed of regular and high terraces of hori;iontally stratified 
 sands, gravels and earthy deposits, which are rather silts than 
 true clays. The gravels frequently include large boulders. At 
 Ward's, the trail turns away from the ri\er and cuts across a 
 high point to the Tooya, the highest terrace-level crossed being 
 about 1000 feet above the river. On these high terraces the 
 vegetation was perceptibly less advanced than in the lower parts 
 of the valley. Swampy spots are frequent, and the country, as 
 we recede from the vicinity of the Coast Mountains, has 
 evidently a more humid climate and is more subject to summer 
 frosts. Potatoes and other crops are successfully grown at 
 Ward's, situated on one of the lower terraces, but irrigation is 
 there necessary. 
 
 The Tooya valley, where it is crossed by the trail, is a great 
 gorge, about 600 feet in depth, cut out through the terrace 
 deposits. The river, which is spaimed by a small bridge, is a 
 wild torrent — almost a series of cascades. 
 
 From " Wilson's house " to Caribou Camp, about twelve 
 miles, th(; trail crosses an extensive high terrace or plateau, 
 with a nearly level or slightly undulating surface, which is 
 generally wooded with aspen, black pine and white spruce of 
 
 
i 
 
 f. 
 
 an 
 At 
 
 the 
 arts 
 
 as 
 
 hi 
 
 IS 
 
 jmer 
 
 at 
 
 m is 
 
 treat 
 
 irace 
 
 is a 
 
 •clve 
 leaii, 
 h is 
 
 |:|t 
 
 y. ■= 
 
 
 'I 
 
 : 1 1 i' 
 
 I'H 
 
 le ot 
 
I . > 
 
 
 IP 
 
 im 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 293 
 
 1 
 
 fair growth. The Tooya valley is here said to run nearly 
 parallel with the main valley of the Stikine and at no great 
 distance from it, but is invisible from the trail. No mountains 
 were seen to the north-eastward, but high, rounded moun- 
 tains, with broad, bare summits, continue to border the south- 
 east side of the Stikine valley. About midway between Wilson's 
 and Caribou Camp, the Stikine, or Too-dessa of the Tahl-tan 
 Indians, coming from the southward, enters the main valley, 
 cutting through the bordering mountains in a narrow canon, 
 which the Indians report impassable. Their route to the upper 
 waters of the river crosses the mountains to the west of this 
 canon. They state that after again reaching the Stikine, above 
 the cauon, they can ascend it in canoes without difficulty for a 
 long distance. 
 
 No rock exposures were seen along this part of the trail, and 
 only occasional groups of boulders. The vegetation and 
 appearance of the country afford evidence that the climate is 
 still a dry one. 
 
 The trail reaches the edge of the valley of the Tanzilla, or 
 Third North Fork, about a mile south-westward from Caribou 
 Camp. This valley is cut out to a depth of 450 feet below the 
 level of the plateau, and is about a mile in width from rim to 
 rim. The sides show evidence of extensive landslips, both old 
 and recent. The river is a comparatively small though swift 
 and muddy stream, with an estimated width of 180 feet and 
 depth of about three feet. No rocks are exposed in the valley, 
 the entire depth of which appears to be excavated in bedded 
 clays and silts, which weather to grey, earthy slopes. 
 
 
 i1> 
 
 r,i 
 
' 
 
 
 i'.^. 
 
 '•I 
 •/I 
 
 J 
 
 ii.i>i 
 
 H, 
 
 ' 
 
 ft , I 
 
 in 
 
 CHAPTER V. 
 
 The Irail frum Caribou Camp to Dense Lake -The Icnaces nl the sides of the Tanzilla 
 — The mountains — The Tanzilla valley part of a river-course of very ancient 
 date — Vole mic origin of the rocks near Telegra])h Creek — rre-glaciol age of the 
 basaltic rocks — The old river-bed below Glenora — IJasaltic formation of the 
 Stikine — Its impcrtance in respect to the dislribiilion cf gold — "Heavy 'gold 
 found along that portion of the stream characterizjd by the basalt— The old 
 channel — Remuneration bars worked up the Tahl-tan valley — Characteristic 
 formation of the count.y betsicen Telegraph Creek and Dease Lake^Dease 
 Lake the centra' point of the Cassiar district — I'lacer mines of value awaiting 
 discovery in this district — This district more accessible than ti.at of Caribou — 
 Construction of a waggon-road — Suitable materials easily obtainable — No 
 serious impediment pre-ented to the construction of a railway —The survey of 
 the Stikine — The route a direct one to Dease Lake — Also a direct line from the 
 Pacific Coast to the Mackenzie River— Arrival of the expedition at the head of 
 Dease Lake — Dates of the opening and closing of the lake — Its elevation and 
 length — -The richest gold deposits discovered at Dease Creck--Tiie head-cpiarters 
 of the Gold Commission — Country surrounding the lake — Vegetation — Agricul- 
 ture not practicable in this region — Resemblance of roi.ks to the gold-bearing 
 series of the Caribou district — The ancient pre-glacial valley — The present 
 valley — Lstimated value cf gold produced by Cassiar district— Summary and 
 particulars as to the condition of the workings in the .aiious localities — Difficulties 
 of mining on account of frozen ground — Prospecting U .■ metalliferous veins in 
 the Cassiar district — Its accessibility to the coast — Facilities afforded for the con- 
 struction of a good road — The district very imperfectly prospected — Probable 
 existence of rich creeks — " (Juartz-mining "" ciinpared with alhivial-mining. 
 
 F*ROM Caribou Camp to the vicinity of Dease Lake, or for 
 about twenty-six miles, the trail runs alonjjf the north-west 
 side of the Tanzilla. The valley of the stream f^radually loses 
 its depth, owipp- to the fact that, while the j;rade of the stream 
 is considerable, ihe terraces at its sides continue at about the 
 same level. I'hese consist, so far as can be seen, of similar 
 silty and clayey matei ials, but the ec!t;es of the terraces arc less 
 marked, and they show a tendency to merj^n; into slopes, which 
 rest upon the bases of the mountains bordering the valley. 
 The mountains whicb extend to the south-east of the river 
 become hij^her here, and take the form of a well-marked range, 
 which is known to the Indians as Ho-tai'-lult. Swampy spots 
 become frequent and the vegetation more alpine in character, 
 
 :<•' ■' 
 
i:H 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 295 
 
 for 
 \-cst 
 
 )ses 
 
 the 
 lilar 
 less 
 lich 
 ley. 
 iver 
 
 [pots 
 :tcr, 
 
 with evidence of a considerably f^reater rainfall. A great part 
 of the forest all alonj; this portion of the valley has been 
 destroyed by fire. Rock is seen in place only on approachinj^ 
 the bases of the monntains. 
 
 The part of the valley which connects the Tanzilla with 
 Dease Lake is floored by terrace deposits, and is without doubt 
 very deeply filled with such material, as no solid rock is seen in 
 it. It has evidently been part of a throuj^di river-course of very 
 ancient date, but in what direction the stream that orif,nn- 
 ated the valley flowed, it is now difficult to surmise. It has, 
 however, been ajj^ain occupied by a river in c(jmparativel}' 
 recent post-j^lacial times, subsequently to the formation of the 
 terrace deposits, as it is traversed by a well-marked river-bed, 
 filled with rolled stones and f^ravels. This old channel appears 
 to rise slij;;htly towards Dease Lake, and there can be little doubt 
 that the stream by which it was formed flowed out of the lake. 
 
 Respecting;' the older rocks which characterize the greater 
 part of the country between Telegraph Creek and Dease Lake, 
 few details were noted, and no approach to a general section 
 was obtained, as the}- are not usually e\j)osed except along the 
 bases of the mountains, which are, as a rule, at some distance 
 from the route oi tra\el. These may be described as consisting 
 of grey and greenish-grey quartidtes and grauwackes. with a 
 large pnjportion t)f altered volcanic materials, generally 
 felspathic, but passing into diabases and becoming in some 
 cases more or less schistose. Rocks originally of volcanic 
 origin notably preponderate in the \icinity of Telegraph Creek, 
 while near Dease Lake they are less abundant, and at about 
 two miles from the lake, on the trail, massive grey fine-grained 
 limestone occurs, in exposures which are nearly continuous for 
 al^out a mile. None of the mountains in sight on either side of 
 the valley are distinctly granitic, and rocks ol this character 
 were observed only in one locality, w'^ 'e they onupy a 
 relatively small arv'a. 
 
 The pre-glacial age of the basaltic n .ks is shown liy their 
 relation to the terraces of the valley, and also b\' the occurrence 
 upon them of large granitic boulders. 
 
 A few miles below Glenora, where the basalt filling of the 
 old valley has been cut across, it seems the old river-bed is 
 
 i,i; 
 
 ■If 
 
 ]{ 
 
296 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 I! r 
 
 Pi 
 
 below the present water-level, indicatirifj, in connection with 
 previous observations, that the j^radc of the orif^nnal river was 
 greater than that of the present. 
 
 Though the basalts of Tertiary age actually seen by me are 
 confined to the Stikine valley, it is highly probable that further 
 explorations will prove their occurrence in other valleys, and 
 possibly also the existence of similar rocks, in the form of 
 plateaux of some size, in the region east of the Coast Ranges. 
 
 The basaltic formation of the Stikine is important in respect 
 of the distribution of gold. The gold along the Stikine was 
 said by the miners to be " spotted," or irregular, in its occur- 
 rence, but the greater part of the " heavy " gold was found just 
 along that portion of the stream now characterized by the 
 basalts, and it appears even possible to trace a connection 
 between the richer bars which have been worked and those 
 places in which the present river has cut through or followed 
 the old basalt-protected channel. Such being the case, it seems 
 very desirable that the old channel should be fully prospected, 
 but this I cannot learn has ever been attempted. If gold should 
 be found in it in paying quantity, it might easily be worked, 
 and would give rise to a considerable renewal of activity in 
 mining. It is not known to what extent similar conditions 
 may occur up the Tahl-tan valley, where also remunerative bars 
 were worked some years ago. 
 
 The most characteristic later formation of the country 
 between Telcgrapl" ^roek and Dcase Lake is the silty deposit 
 which has alreaci} b:on referred to in several places. The 
 vvhole of the great valley has evidently in later-glacial times 
 been filled with this deposit, which must have been laid down 
 in a comparatively tranquil lake-like body of water, into which 
 coarser materi.al was in some places washed by entering torrents, 
 as in the case of the Tooya. It appears to me possible that 
 this body of water was held in by means of glacier-ice accumu- 
 lated on the Coast Ranges on one side and those of the Cassiar 
 Mountains on the other. The increased height of the ter- 
 races in the vicinity of Dease Lake, as compared with those 
 near Telegraph Creek, may show that the terrace-deposits have 
 been laid down near the front of a retreating glacier-mass, the 
 water-level of the lake being reduced />(in' />asst(, with its reces- 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 297 
 
 
 ;n 
 :h 
 ts, 
 at 
 iii- 
 ar 
 
 )se 
 
 XV. 
 
 le 
 
 sion. The hij^hcst terrace-level observed near the Tahl-tan, is 
 at an approximate elevation of 1700 feet above the sea, while 
 half way between the Tooya and Dease Lake the terraces run 
 up to a height of about 2800 feet. At the head of the lake a 
 well-marked terracc-edfi^c was observed at 520 feet above the 
 lake, or 3180 feet above the sea. The irregular surface of the 
 same terrace sloped upward to a further height of about 100 
 feet, and granite boulders were found on the summit of a lime- 
 stone hill 1000 feet above the lake, or 3660 feet above the sea. 
 If the supposition of the considerable inland extension of the 
 glaciers of the Coast Mountains at one epoch of the glacial 
 period be correct (and it is strictly paralleled by similar circum- 
 stances in the more southern part of British Columbia), the 
 greater part of the gigantic erratics met with may probably 
 have been derived from the Coast Ranges, through the Cassiar 
 Mountains : possibly other ranges in the region are charac- 
 terized by similar rocks. 
 
 Dease Lake is the central point of the Cassiar district, and 
 though, as shown by statistics subsequently quoted, the yield 
 of gold has greatly fallen off since the palmy days of its first 
 discovery, it is very probable that further jilacer mines of value 
 may yet be found in this region (of which a great part still 
 remains to be carefully prospected), and there is every reason to 
 believe that (juart/ mining and other imlustries will before long 
 be developed on a considerable scai l-veii at the present 
 moment this district is more easily accessible tltm that of 
 
 Caribou, and when a waggon-road shall have 1) 
 
 )iiiit from 
 
 the head of navigation on the Stikine to Dease Lake it sliould 
 be easy to lay down goods at the latter {)()int at very reasonable 
 rates. 
 
 The construction of a waggon-road, with moderately favour- 
 able grades, between Telegraph Creek and Dease Lake, would 
 not be very difficult or expensive. The first ascent from 
 Telegraph Creek is steep, but might easily be overcome. 
 Hetween eight and ten miles from Telegraph Creek, or for 1 
 distance of about two miles, the road woidd havi' to follow .1 
 rough hill-side above the canon, where some blasting and 
 grading would hv required. The descent to thi' Tahl-tan would 
 entail some heavv side-hill cutting in rock and earth and a 
 
 Mi 
 
 ■1 
 
 iiil 
 
298 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 14 1 
 
 ,n '! , 
 
 bridj^'c would be necessary. The ascent and crossing of the 
 " lava bed " would entail about a mile of rouf,di work on the 
 opposite side of the Tahl-tan, and should the line of the present 
 trail be followed, a low^ and steep ascent, with j^radinf^ in 
 gravel and clay, would be required at \\'ard"s. and again in 
 descending to and ascending from the Tooya vallej-, but no 
 rock work would be necessary. It seems quite probable, how- 
 ever, that a better route might be found for a road, at a lower 
 level, from Ward's to the mouth of the Tooya, in fijllowing 
 the side of the main valley. In eithiT case a good bridge 
 would be required at the Too\a. Beyond this, all the way 
 to Dease Lake, no further serious obstacle presents itself. 
 Portions of the route are clayey and swampy, and to render 
 these easily passable, from eight to ten miles of corduroj' in all 
 would be required, and for this suitable material could be 
 obtained near by in all cases. 
 
 Should the construction of a railway be contemplated, the 
 difficulties to be surmounted would be greater in proportion, 
 particularly l)etween Telegraph ("reek and the Tahl-tan, where 
 the line would have to follow the side of the canon, which is 
 very rough and rocky. Beyond this point, so far as the valley 
 can be seen from the trail, it presents no very serious impedi- 
 ments. Below Telegraph Creek, to Glenora, (jr a little further, 
 a railway would involve some moderately heavy side-hill work : 
 but further dcjwn the Stikine, to the sea, it might fjUow the 
 river-flats at a nearly uniform K'\el. The greatest difficulty to 
 be apprehended on this part of the line would l)e that likely to 
 arise in winter from the very hea\y snow-fall on the river below 
 the Little Caiion. 
 
 It may be pointed out in this coiiiiecticju that the survey of 
 the Stikine and of the valley leading by the Tan/illa to Dease 
 Lake shows the route to be ;in ex( n (Hngly direct one to Dease 
 Lake, and that, taken in ronjunctmn with the valleys of the 
 Dease and Liard Rivers, it alTords almost an air-line from the 
 Paeilic coast to the great Maekeuiiie Ri\-er. 
 
 We reached the head of Dease Lake on June 5th, and evt'U- 
 tuallj' left the hikv on the morning of June i()th, spending thus 
 thirteen days in all upon the lake. At the date of our arrival 
 the lake, with the exception of a small area at its head was 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 299 
 
 still covered with the decayed but unbroken ice of the previous 
 winter, and this did not finally break up and disappear till the 
 i6th. Meanwhile, almost all our time and attention were 
 devoted to sawinjj; out boards and building three boats. 
 
 The followinj,^ dates, obtained from Mr. Robert Reid, of 
 Laketon, are those of the opening; and closin;jf of the lake for 
 the past few years : — 
 
 Voir. 
 
 1882 
 18S3 
 
 18S4 
 1885 
 
 1886 
 
 1887 
 
 Ldh' opened. 
 
 Lake eloscd. 
 December 51I1 or 6lh 
 
 Uecciiiber 5 ill 
 
 June 9th 
 
 May 30th 
 
 (Clear from end to end) 
 
 June 2nd Decemljcr 2nd 
 
 June 3rd December ist 
 
 (Frozen completely across) 
 June 5th December i6tli 
 
 (Crossing on ijtli) 
 June i6th 
 
 of 
 lise 
 lise 
 Ihe 
 
 he 
 
 ■n- 
 
 Mis 
 
 •al 
 
 as 
 
 Dease Lake has an elevation of 2660 feet above the sea, and 
 lies nearly due north-and-south on the ijoth meridian. It has 
 a total lenj^th of twenty-four miles, with an averaj^e width of 
 less than one mile, beinj;- somewhat narrower at the northern 
 than at the southern end. Dease Creek, on the delta of which 
 is situated Laketon, the chief place of the Cassiar district, 
 enters on the west side at sixteen miles and three (luartiis from 
 the head of the lake, and is the largest tributary stream. It is 
 also the most important, beinj^ that on which the richest of 
 the f^old deposits were discovered, and (jn which /^old is still 
 worked to a liiuited extent. A certain amount of business is still 
 carried on here, and it is the lieadcjuarters of the GoUl Com- 
 missioner. The old Hudson IJay Post was situated about two 
 miles from the lower end of the lake, on the east side. A small 
 steamer was put upon the lake when the mines were in a 
 tlourishinj;' condition, anil is still employed in makint;- occasional 
 trips up or down the lake with supplies. 
 
 The country about the lake is everywhere wooded, thouj^h 
 " timber "" trees are lomid only in sheltered valK-ys or on low 
 land. It is not rou;;hly mountainous, tlKJUj^h se\eral prominent 
 summits exist. Near the northern end of the lake do the 
 mountains begin to crowd down closely to tlu' water's edge. 
 
;oo 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ! f 
 
 i 
 
 .1' ,'(' 
 
 1 1 '■ 
 
 ^ '.'r 
 
 The lake is shallow and marshy at both ends, but elsewhere is 
 evidently very deep, though no soundings have been made 
 in It. 
 
 The vegetation gives evidence of a greater rainfall, and 
 conditions more alpine and less favourable than those met 
 with on the trail to the south-eastward, and sharply contrasting 
 with that of Telegraph Creek and the Tahl-tan. The effect of 
 the ice upon the lake in spring in retarding the vegetation in 
 its immediate vicinity, was very apparent. Agriculture can 
 scarcely be regarded as practicable in this region, and the 
 results of gardening, however carefully conducted, are small. 
 Potatoes can be grown, but in some j-ears they are much 
 injured by frost ; carrots, lettuce, cabbage, cauliflowers and 
 turnips may be made to afford a fair return. 
 
 Such rock-exposures as could be reached near the shores of 
 the lake were inspected, and the material brought down from 
 the hills by several streams was examined. The rocks as a 
 whole closely resemble those of parts of the gold-bearing series 
 of Caribou district. 
 
 Dease Creek is said to be about twelve miles in length and 
 to rise in a lake about hve miles long. The ancient pre-glacial 
 valley has, at the same later-glacial period, been tilled with 
 clayey and gravelK' deposits, among which large and often 
 glaciated boulders are common. These deposits frequently 
 resemble boulder-clay, and are possibly entitled to be so called. 
 The present valley has been cut down through them, and 
 often to a consideralile depth into the rock beneath them. 
 The mining has occurred chieily in the bed of the stream, along 
 the surface of the solid rock, in the sides of the valley, and in 
 various places in the gravel deposits which still remain ; also at 
 the head of the flat on which Laketon stands, where the stream 
 issues from the narrow recent valley. Much (]uart2 occurs in 
 the wash of the stream, and the gold, being "coarse," is 
 evidently of local origin and has been liberated by the disinte- 
 gration of the rocks in the immediate vicinity of, if not entirely 
 within, the actual drainage-area of the stream. 
 
 The following table, based on the reports of the Minister of 
 Mines of British Columbia, clearly illustrates the sudden rise 
 and gradual decadence of the gold yield of Cassiar district : — 
 
 'I 
 
 ii 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ;,oi 
 
 Ml 
 
 in 
 at 
 un 
 in 
 
 IS 
 
 .ly 
 
 ot 
 
 lise 
 
 Estimated value of Gold produced by Cassiar District, from 1S74 to iSSy. 
 
 1873 . . . ... ... Not known. 
 
 1874 §1,000,000 
 
 1875 830,000 
 
 1876 S5M74 
 
 1877 499,830 
 
 1878 519,720 
 
 1879 405,200 
 
 1880 297,850 
 
 1881 198,900 
 
 1882 182,800 
 
 1883 ... 119,000 
 
 1884 ... ... ... ... 101,600 
 
 1885 ... ... 50,600 
 
 1886 63,610 
 
 1887 60,485 
 
 Total 
 
 .S4,886,o69 
 
 No estimate has been formed for the yield of the mines in the 
 first year of their operation (1875), but as that ior the following 
 year appears probably to be overstated, it ina)-, for the purpose 
 of arriving at a general estimate of the whole, be assumed that 
 the sum of one million includes both years. The value of the 
 gold may be stated as from S16 to 817 per ounce, though that of 
 Dease Creek is usually priced at about -^iS'So only. 
 
 In the Report of Progress of the Geological Survey for 1886- 
 87, I was enabled to give a general note on the various creeks 
 worked for gold in Cassiar and on the Stikine. The informa- 
 tion there given was chiefiy furnished by Mr. G. 13. Wright. I 
 am now able to add to this, particulars as to the actual con- 
 dition of the workiiigs in 1887. These were largely obtained 
 through the kindness of Mr. J. S. Crimp, the present Gold 
 Commissioner for Cassiar district, thougn facts were also 
 gathered from several old miners who were among the first to 
 enter the country. As explained on a previous page, my oppor- 
 tunities of personally investigating the Cassiar ilistrict were 
 restricted by the necessity of pushing on to our main field of 
 exploration. Chiefly from the sources above-mentioneil the 
 following summary account of the different localities is derived. 
 
 Stikine River. — Gold discovered, 18G1. \'ery fine gold can 
 be found on almost all parts of the river, but \eiy little profit- 
 able work was ever done below the month of the Clearwater. 
 The rich grcjund may be said to have begun about nine miles 
 below Glenora, and to have extended thence to the Grand 
 
 li' 
 
 3 
 
?02 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ;!■> i 
 
 '^i 
 
 1 I 
 
 Cnnon, above Tclej^'rapli Creek. Here Sheck's or Shake's Bar, 
 aiul Carpenter's, Fiddler's and Buck's Bars were situated, the 
 richest bein^ between Clenora and Telef^'raph Creek, thouj^h 
 ;;()ld was also worked in a few places in the Grand Canon. 
 With the exception of a few spots in the lower part of the canon, 
 below the Tahl-tan, and one nearly opposite Wilson's, all the 
 gold was very hne. Coarse j^old was also found on the lower 
 part of Tahl-tan, which proved quite profitable, and bars were 
 worked for a distance of ten or fifteen miles up the river. 
 Pellets supposed to be oi silver, but probably of arquerite or 
 silver-amalgam, were also found on the Tahl-tan. The bars 
 on the Stickinc at first averaged 8j to 8io a day to the 
 hand, and as much as two to three ounces were sometimes 
 obtained, but not more than Si to 85 can now be got, and 
 work has practically ceased. It is stated that none of the 
 higher benches so far prospected will pay for hydraulic work, 
 but it is doubtful whether these have been examined with 
 sufficient care, as the area of such benches is very considerable. 
 
 Dcase Creek. — The bed of this creek has been gcjue over several 
 times, and is now nearly worked out. It formerly yielded 88 to 
 850 a day to the hand, and paid well from the head of the 
 fiat, at its mouth, for six miles up. Above this a few isolated 
 gootl claims were found, particularly the Caribou Company's 
 claim, eight miles up, from which much heavy gold was 
 obtained. This claim has been worked over four times. The 
 best remaining claims are bench claims on the south side of the 
 creek, some of these being upon an old high channel which 
 yields well in places. Some hydraulic work on a small scale is 
 being carried on. In 1886 there were sixteen whites and 
 thirty-five Chinese at work, and the total amount produced 
 was about 815.000. The gold is generally well water-worn and 
 somewhat mixed in character, varying in value from 8i5'5" to 
 81O per ounce. 
 
 '1 liibert Creek.— 'Ww bed of this stream is also worked out. 
 It paid for about six miles up from the mouth, jieldingat about 
 the same rate as the last. Bench claims are now being worked, 
 two by the hydraulic method, the rest by tunnelling. An old 
 high chanrel had also been found on the south side of this 
 creek, upon which two claims are being worked, one paying very 
 
 i> 1' 
 
VWm 
 
 rk, 
 ith 
 
 to 
 
 IV s 
 as 
 
 llie 
 the 
 
 lich 
 is 
 mcl 
 
 :i'ci 
 
 and 
 () to 
 
 )Ut. 
 
 out 
 
 )ld 
 
 this 
 
 I'L'O' 
 
THE YUKON TERUITORV 
 
 303 
 
 well. Yield in 1866, nearly the same with Dease Creek, about 
 twenty-two whites and twenty-tive Chinese bein;,' employed. 
 Gold valued at .^ib per ounce. On a tributary named Mosquito 
 Creek very good prospects have lately been obtained — as much 
 as 340 to a six-foot set oi timbers. Work is now goin<^' on 
 here. 
 
 Defot Creek. — A tributary of Canon Creek, on the same (west) 
 side of Dease River with the last. It rises on a plateau hij^h 
 above the river, where great numbers of quart;; reefs occur, 
 and the gold found is quite rough and full of quartz. Large 
 nuggets have been obtained, including one of fourteen ounces in 
 weight. Some work is still in progress, though the creek-bed 
 is worked out. Gold worth !iiii7 per ounce. 
 
 CaTion Creek. — No paying deposits found. 
 
 Cottomvood Creek. — This large stream heads in the same 
 mountains with the last, but no paying deposits have been found 
 upon it. 
 
 Beady Creek. — A little mining was done here in 1874 and 
 1875, but nothing of importance ever found. 
 
 Eagle River. — No mining ever developed. 
 
 McDame Creek. — Discovered 1874. The highest average 
 daily yield varied from i^G to Sioo to the hand when mining 
 was at its best. Most of the gold was obtained in what appeared 
 to be an old high-level channel, which crossed points of terraces 
 or benches on both sides of the present stream. A very small 
 proportion of the yield was from the stream-bed. Four or five 
 whites and forty Chinese are now at work here, the greater 
 number of the Chinese being employed on wide flats, which 
 occur about nine miles up the creek. Bench claims run for 
 about seven miles up the creek or to Holloway's l>ar. Gold 
 worth from %'i.Tl'S t" •'^iS per ounce. 
 
 Snoiv Creek, a. tributary of the last. — The richest claim foiuid 
 in Cassiar was near the mouth of this creek, yielding ftn" a 
 week 300 ounces for six to eight men. Only two men now at 
 work. 
 
 Quartz Creek, a branch of Trout Creek, which is also a 
 tributary of McDame Creek. — Good claims were worked here, 
 yielding rough gold full of quartz. Much quartz in the vicinity. 
 Two miners now at work. 
 
 F 2 
 
 ti 
 
 « '1 
 
w^ 
 
 i 
 
 MH t 
 
 It' 
 
 
 p 
 
 304 
 
 THE YUKON TEkklTORY 
 
 Rosella Patterson and Dennis Creeks. — Yielded moderate 
 amounts of gold, paying " wages," say, at ^6 a day. Now 
 abandoned. 
 
 The remaining creeks mentioned in the report cited, viz. 
 Gold Creek, Slate Creek, Sotner's Creek or First North Fork 
 of Mc Davie, Third North Fork of McDanie, Sprint^ Creek and 
 Fall Creek, are now abandoned, though several of them yielded 
 a considerable amount of gold at one time. 
 
 Sayyea Creek. — Near the head-waters of the Upper Liard, 
 Nielded excellent prospects, but has never been properly 
 examined. The gold obtained was found in the benches, and 
 some of it was very coarse. The creek yielded at the rate of 
 -Sio'go a day to the hand for a short time, to three miners who 
 discovered it. 
 
 Walker Creek. — Said to be distant about seventy miles in an 
 easterly direction from the mouth of McDame Creek. Some 
 work has been done here, but no great quantity of gold 
 obtained. 
 
 Black, Turnagain or " Muddy " River. — Reached by trail 
 running easterly from a point opposite the mouth of McDame 
 Creek, and said to be ninety miles distant. Fine gold stated 
 to have been obtained to the value of ^10 per day to the hand, 
 and it is generally believed that coarse gold may occur on its 
 head-waters. In 1874 prospectors found streams about seventy 
 miles south-east of Dease Lake, which are supposed to be 
 tributaries of this river, and yielded J^G a day in coarse gold, 
 but at the time this was considered too poor to work. 
 
 Considerable difficulties were experienced in mining opera- 
 tions in some parts of the Cassiar district on account of frozen 
 ground, often met with below the wooded and mossy surface. 
 It is on record that on Dease Creek the ground continued to 
 be frozen to the end of a tunnel driven in one hundred and 
 fifty feet from the slope of the hill, and at a depth of forty feet 
 from the surface ; but after the woods and moss had been 
 burnt off, little further complaint was heard of frozen ground. 
 
 Very little has yet been done in the way of prospecting for 
 metalliferous veins in this district, but from what I have been 
 able to learn it would well repa}- a thorough examination, and 
 the comparative ease with which it may be reached from the 
 
 ^ ^Jl 
 
 
THK YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 305 
 
 
 been 
 lind. 
 
 IVA for 
 been 
 m, and 
 Ini the 
 
 coast, together with the facility it affords for the construction 
 of a good road to the very centre of the district, should not be 
 forgotten. A specimen of gdena, holding a little copper and 
 iron pyrites, from the " Acadia Claim," South Fork of 
 McDame Creek, was given to me some years ago by Mr. J. W. 
 McKay. This has since been ;i'-;ayed by Mr. C. Hoffmann, 
 and proves to contain seventy-five ounces of silver to the ton 
 of 2000 lbs. A piece of native copper, fifteen pounds in weight, 
 was at one time found in Boulder Gulch, Thibert Creek. 
 
 Taking into consideration the great extent of generally 
 auriferous country included in the Cassiar district, it must be 
 conceded, that apart from the immediate vicinity of the well- 
 known productive camps, it has been very imperfectly 
 prospected. A great part of the district has in fact merely 
 been run over in search of rich diggings, the simplest and 
 cheapest methods of prospecting only having been employed in 
 the quest. It is not improbable that additional rich crerks 
 like those of the vicinity of Dease Lake may yet be discovered 
 elsewhere, and it may be considered certain that these arc great 
 areas of poorer deposits which will pay to work with impruved 
 methods, and will eventually be utilized. It is also to be 
 anticipated that "quartz mining" will ere long be inaugurated, 
 and will afford a morj permanent basis of prosperity than 
 alluvial mining, however rich. 
 
 It 
 
 ':':, 
 
^pm 
 
 I' » 
 
 ) * 
 
 ;l 
 
 CHAPTER VI. 
 
 Discovery of the Cassirii- district liy tlic Ihidson li.iy Company — Dense Lnke fouml 
 unci named l)y Mr. J. McLcoii, cliicf trader— The Indian Uridine — Geograpiiical 
 information (>!)tain(.il hy Mr. McLeod — Tooya Kiver the fmthest point reaciie<l 
 by him — Attempt by .Mr. Mcl.eod's successor to establish a tradinf:; jjost — 
 Ilo.stile Indians — Success of Mr. K. Canipl)eil — A winter of constant dangers — 
 Sufferings from starvntion — The post al)andoned in 18J9 — The country practically 
 forj;ottcn fro-n thisd;.i.e until 187^ — Disco\ery of i;old near the abandoned site 
 of Fort Ilallett on the I.inrd i\iver in 1S71 — rojndation in 1S74— Town of 
 LaUeton — Total yield of _i;old from the district, including the SliUine — Active 
 prospectinijin the outlyini;; regie is— A great inlUix of miners in 1876 — Fall in the 
 yield of gold — Decline in the production of the district and the number of miners 
 since 1S76 — The Peak or Uluc Mountains — The Cassiar Range — Length of the 
 Dease River — Height of Dea^ e Lake and the confluence of the Dease and Liard 
 — Descent of the Dease River— lis ascent — Boating done principally Ity crews 
 of Coast Indians — Principal features of Dease River — -Cottonwood Creek — Eagle 
 River— Skree Range — Cottonwood Rapid — McDanie Oeek — Sylvester's Landing 
 the point of supply for miners 01 McDanie Creek — The Dease nine miles below 
 Sylvester's — Sylvester's trail to Turnagnin or HIack River — \ alley of the Rapid 
 River — The last main reach of the Dense— The " Lower Post "' the furthest out- 
 work of " civilization " — Dates of ojiening and closing of the Liard River — Main 
 geological features of the Dease— (ieneral aspect and association of the rocks to 
 the east of the Cassiar Range — Their resemblance to that of the Rocky Mountains 
 — Dease River fossils — Tertiary shaly clays and coarse soft sandstone extremely 
 developed above the mouth of the Dease. 
 
 '^r^HE Cassiar distfict of the nortlii'rn iiitcTior of British 
 X Cohuiibia niay be said to have been twiee ihscovered, 
 first by oflicers and employees of the Hudson l>ay Company, 
 and ajrain, after a considerable interval, by the j^old miners. 
 
 rhe Hudson Hay Company made an iinsnccessfnl atti mpt, in 
 1834, to reach the trade of the inti'rioi" coimtrv west of the 
 Kocky Moimtains from the month of the Stikine. In the 
 summer of iS 54, Mr. J. McLeod, chief trader, was explorinj^' the 
 Liard River above Fort Htilkett, and endeavouring; to discover 
 some stream llowinj; to the westx' id. He found and named 
 Dease L;d<e,' crossed to the head-waters of the Stikine, which 
 he proposed to name tht; " Pelly River," and travelled westward 
 
 ' Dease I.;iki' ami River were so named hv McLeod after I'etcr Warren, 
 tlie Arctic cxjjlorer, 
 
rs 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 507 
 
 )« 
 
 in the valley apjxirently as far as the Tooya or Second North 
 Fork. The Indian bridj^e (afterwards named Terror Bridj^e by 
 Mr, R. Campbell), by wliich this river was crossed at the foot 
 of " Thomas' Fall," was so fraj^ile a construction that neither 
 McLeod nor any of his eijj^ht men ventured to atti'nipt it, and 
 from this point he and his party retraced their steps. 
 
 The ^geographical information obtained by McLeod is incor- 
 porated in .Vrrowsmith's map of 1850. McLeod"s route from 
 the head of Dease Lake, as shown on these maps, crossed the 
 Tan/illa within a few miles of the lake, and followed its left 
 l)ank, recrossiiif^ before the main Stikine enteis the valley, 
 probably by an Indian suspension bridfje, which is reported still 
 to exist, within a mile or two of this point. On careful con- 
 sideration of the facts there can scarcely be any doubt that the 
 Tooya River was McLi^od's furthest point. 
 
 In i(Sj6, McLeod's successor at I'ort Halki'tt was instructed 
 to establish a post across the mountains and to extend tiu' trade 
 down the Stikine or " Pelly," as it was then called from 
 McLeod's namin<;-. He left Fort Halkett early in June, witii a 
 party of men and two lari,^ canoi-s, but tiie expedition entirely 
 miscarried. The appearance, or ri'ported appearance, of a 
 larj^e force of hostile Indians at Porta.qe Hrule, ten miles abo\(> 
 I'ort Halkett, so alarmed the party that they tinni'd back, 
 abandoninjjf their .ijooils, and ran ilown stream to l""ort Simjjson. 
 
 In 1S3JS, Mr. R. Campbill vohmtet'red his services to estal)lish 
 a tradin}; post at Dease l^ake, and in t!ie spriii}; of that yar he 
 succeeded in doin,;; s(/. He was accom|)anied by a half-bii "d 
 and two Indian lads. After ascertainin;,' that tlu' "I'clK"' 
 of McLeod was identical with the Stikine. lu- returned to 
 Dease Lake, ^vhere, to employ his own words, " we passed a 
 winter of constant danj^er from the sava,i;i' Russian (Coast) 
 Indians, and of nuich sufferiufj; from starvation. \\^' wcie 
 dependent for subsistence on what animals we could catch, and, 
 failinj^ that, on ' tripe tie roclie' We were at one tiint- reduced 
 to such dire straits that we were obli.Ljcd to i-at our parchnn-nt 
 windows, and our last meal before abandoning Di-ase Like, on 
 (Sth Maj', iNjfj, consisted of tlu' lacing of our snow shoes." ' 
 
 ' The discovery and cxnloratiou of the Yukon (Pclly) River. Winnipeg-, 
 1885. 
 
 iH 
 
 V ' 
 
 I . 'I 
 
 \ 
 
3o8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 fi 
 
 The post, thus abandoned, was not again re-occupied. It 
 had become unnecessan-, owing to the leasing of the " coast 
 strip " of Russian America by Sir George Simpson for the 
 Company, in consequence of which the trade of the interior 
 was entirely controlled on both sides by the Company. 
 
 From that time the country appears to have been practically 
 forgotten until 1872, when the discovery of gold by Messrs. 
 Thibert and iVIcCulloch brought about an entire change in its 
 conditions. Henry Thibert, a French-Canadian, left the Red 
 River country in i86g on a hunting and prospecting expedition 
 to the west. In 1871 he met McCulloch, a Scotchman, and 
 together they passed the winter near the abandoned site of 
 Fort Halkett, on the Liard River, suffering in their turn severe 
 hardships from scarcity of food. Near this place, probably on 
 what was known afterwards as McCulloch's liar, gold was first 
 found. In 1872 they reached Dease Lake, having been 
 informed that it was a good locality for fish, with the intention 
 of securing a sui'ficient supply for the ensuing winter. Being 
 told, however, by the Indians, that white men were engaged in 
 mining on the Stikine not far off, they crossed by the trail from 
 the head of the lake and reached the mining camp at Buck's 
 Bar. Early in 1873 they set out on their return to the original 
 discovery of gold, but meeting with success on Thibcrt's Creek, 
 at the lower end of the lake, they were deterred from going 
 further, and remained working there during the summer, being 
 joined afterwards by thirteen other miners from the Stikine. 
 Dease Creek was discovered during the same season, and 
 Captain W. Moore was among the first to begin work there. 
 Thibert is still mining in Cassiar, but McCulloch lost his life 
 some years since on a winter journey on the Stikine. 
 
 In 1874 the population, exclusive of Indians, was estimated 
 to have reached 1500. The placers of McDame Creek were 
 discovered. Miners descended the Liard for a long distance, and 
 worked McCulloch's Bar and other river bars. The little town 
 of Laketon was built at the mouth of Dease Creek, and beef 
 cattle were for the first time brought across country from the 
 Upper I'^raser. The total yield of gold from the district (which, 
 from a mining point of vimv, inchulos the Stikine) is roughly 
 estimated to have been equal to $1,000,000. 
 
 J )'»■ 
 
oing 
 ;ine. 
 and 
 icrc. 
 life 
 
 ted 
 
 hvcrc 
 
 , and 
 
 town 
 
 beef 
 
 the 
 
 Ihich, 
 
 rhlv 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 309 
 
 In 187s the population is estimated to have been 1081, and 
 the yield of gold equalled about ^830,000. Three hundred head 
 of cattle were brought from the Fraser overland. This and the 
 preceding season were the best years of the district. Prospect- 
 ing was activel)' carried on in outlying regions, Sayyea Creek 
 being discovered near the Liard head-waters, and the Frances 
 River also apparently examined. 
 
 Owing to the flattering accounts sent out, a great influx of 
 miners occurred in 1876, the population being at one time 
 estimated at 2000. Profitable work could not, however, be 
 found for so many men, and the yield of gold fell to $499,830. 
 Walker Creek, said to be from seventy to eighty miles east of 
 McDame Creek, was discovered, but that stream never proved 
 very remunerative. Defot Creek was also found, and in 1878 
 proved rich for a limited area. 
 
 Since that time the production of the district and the number 
 of miners employed have gradually declined, and no important 
 new creeks have been discovered, though reports of their exist- 
 ence have from time to time been circulated. The Black or 
 Turnagain (Muddy) River is the most recent of these, some 
 attention being drawn to it in i(S86. 
 
 Though the region about Dease Lake is as a whole rather 
 low, with isolated mountains and ridges here and there pro- 
 minent, that to the east and north-east is difterent, being 
 studded with rugged mountains, and constituting an important 
 mountain range with north-west and south-east trend, and a 
 transverse width of nearly fifty miles. This range appears to 
 represent a cuntinu;ition of that named in various maps the 
 Peak Mountains or Blue Mountains, but as its comiection to 
 the south-eastward is as yet uncertain, and as neither of these 
 names possesses cither a distinctive character or any special 
 fitness, I believe it will be most appr(){)riate and convenient to 
 call the rangi' the Otss/ar Range, and shall accordingly so 
 designate it. 
 
 The entire length of the Dease River is one hundred and ten 
 miles, but following all the sinuosities of the stream, one 
 hundred and eighty miles. 
 
 The height of Uease Lake, as previously stated, is 2660 feet. 
 That of the confluence of the Dease and Liard is about 2100 
 
 
 I Hi 
 
 1:> . 
 
 i.1 
 
 ii: Ij 
 
 m. 
 
 i I 
 
:3*" 
 
 % 
 
 \i 
 
 '< 
 
 :i 
 
 m 
 
 ^^1 ji 
 
 ' I, 
 
 V 
 
 ''.i' i 
 
 1 1 
 
 < 1 
 
 5 1 
 
 i)l |>;k!{ 
 
 'I 
 
 310 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 feet. The velocity of tlie current was estimated at three miles 
 an hour, as a general average, but there are several little rapids, 
 as well as some rather long tranquil reaches. 
 
 The river, from Dease Lake to the Liard, maj^ easily be 
 descended in two days, but the ascent is a comparatively slow 
 process, depending much on the height of the water, and, when 
 the bars and beaches are not bare for tracking, is a tedious 
 affair. It is possible that the river might be navigated by small 
 stern-wheel steamers of good power, as there are no insuperable 
 obstacles, but doubtful whether such an enterprise would be a 
 remunerative one, even if the traffic were to assume propor- 
 tions much greater than at present. Such goods as are now 
 required at McDatne Creek (fifty-five and a half miles below 
 Dease Lake by the course of the stream) and at the little 
 trading post at the mouth of the river, are easily taken down 
 stream in large tlat-bottomed boats, which go back light, by 
 poling and tracking, without great difliculty. The boating on 
 the river has been done principally by crews of Coast Indians, 
 who are engaged and brought into the interior for the 
 purpose. 
 
 On leaving Dease Lake, the ri\er is a small stream, averaging 
 from 100 to 150 feet only in width, extremely tortuous and 
 rather swift, meandering in a wide, ilat valley. At about eight 
 miles from the lake it enters the mountains, the valley at the 
 same time gradually narrowing and becoming bordered by 
 mountains from 4500 to 5000 feet in height. At tlhrteen 
 miles from Di-ase Lake, it expands into a little lake about 
 a mile and three quarters in length, and between this and 
 the mouth of Cottonwood Creek it flows through three more 
 similar lake-like expansions. These are probably formed in all 
 cases by tlie partial blocking of the \alley by (h'bris brought 
 in by tributary streams, of which Cottonwood Cr^'ek itself is 
 the last and most important. These lakes constitute impedi- 
 ments to navigation, as they free/Je over in the autumn long 
 before the ice takes on the river, and remain frozen till late in 
 the spring. 
 
 Dease River rapidly increases in si/i', and soon doubles its 
 volume, owing to the number of aflhient streams, of which 
 Cottonwood Creek is the first which may be called a river. 
 
tin- 
 
 lore 
 
 all 
 
 ht 
 
 is 
 
 )c(li- 
 
 lonj;- 
 
 te ill 
 
 its 
 hich 
 ivev. 
 
 fi 
 
 
 ■i i 
 
 11 
 
 r 
 
i: 
 
 'f, s 
 
 I 
 
 iKi I 
 
 ri 
 
 'ft 
 
 '■r f 
 
 M 
 
 
 ff 
 
 1^' J 
 
 
 11 
 
 li 
 
 f5 
 
 
 i 
 
 i 
 
 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 311 
 
 This stream occupies an important valley, bordered by high 
 ranges. No paying deposits of gold have ever been found 
 either on this or on Eagle River, which enters the Dease from 
 the south about four miles further down. Eagle River also 
 flows between high mountains, and its valley appears to be 
 parallel to, and analogous with, that occupied by Dease Lake. 
 It is evidently the "Christie River" of McLeod,' but this 
 name has entirely passed out of use, and it appears hopeless to 
 endeavour to reinstate it. Cottonwood Creek is shown on 
 Arrowsmith's maps, according to McLeod and Campbell, but 
 is not named. 
 
 There is a considerable development of terraces at high levels 
 on the sides of some of the mountains, particularly in the part 
 of the valley which runs along the base of the Skree Range. 
 Well-marked terraces were here seen on the west side of the 
 valley, at an estimated height of 2000 feet above the river, or 
 about 4600 feet above the sea. 
 
 Immediately below the mouth of Cottonwood Creek is the 
 Cottonwood Rapid, in which the course of the river is impeded 
 by a number of boulders. The rapid is not a formidable one, 
 or at all dangerous to run, with ordinary care. The river 
 below Cottonwood Creek runs nearly due east for about ten 
 miles with a rather strong current. It then turns more to the 
 northward, and after making several large flexures, reaches 
 Sylvester's Landing, at the mouth of McDame Creek, in about 
 eight miles. Immediately opposite the mouth of McDame 
 Creek is a remarkably prominent and abrupt rocky mountain, 
 which it is proposed to name Sylvester Peak. Its height was 
 estimated at 7000 feet, but the circumstances did not admit of 
 its measurement. 
 
 Sylvester's Landing is the point of supply for the miners on 
 McDame Creek, also a post for Indian trade. McDame Creek 
 was discovered to be auriferous in 1874. It has since been 
 constantly worked, and, with its tributaries, has yielded much 
 gold, but is now believed to be nearly exhausted. Its valley 
 
 ' I have endeavoured in all cases to identify the orij^inal nrimes given by 
 the first explorers in this country, and also to ascertain the native nanius 
 of places, but where these have passed entirely out of use by the miners and 
 traders now in the country, it becomes necessary to drop them, though in 
 so doing the strict law of priority is, no doubt, transgressed. 
 
 lil^' 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 f i 
 
 ■! I' 
 
 U' III 
 
 liil 
 
 is wide and important, runninj^ north-westward for about seven 
 miles, and then turning nearly due west. 
 
 The mountains bordering McDame Creek, viewed from 
 Sylvester's Landing, are singularly different from any before 
 met with. They are evidently composed for the most part of 
 limestone, and characterised by the occurrence of long, bare 
 slopes of shattered rock-fragments. They are scarcely at all 
 wooded, and in this respect resemble the bare limestone crests 
 of parts of the Rocky Mountains in more southern latitudes. 
 
 Potatoes and turnips of large size are grown every season 
 without difficulty on McDame Creek. 
 
 Nine miles below Sylvester's, the Dease makes its great bend 
 toward the north, the intervening portion of the river some- 
 what changing its character from that above described, rock 
 exposures being comparatively frequent in its banks and bed, 
 where they produce several little rapids. Forty-mile Creek 
 enters from the south at somewhat less than the specified 
 distance below Sylvester's. It appears to be the " Stuart 
 River "of McLeod, shown on Arrowsmith's map of 1850, but 
 neither on this nor on that of 1854 is McDame Creek indicated. 
 Sylvester's trail to Turnagain or Black River (Muddy River of 
 miners) runs up this valley, and follows a tributary — Sheep 
 Creek — to the south-eastward, passing near the base of Sheep 
 Mountain, a high rugged peak estimated at 8000 feet, situated 
 about five miles and a half south of the Dease. The distance 
 to the trading outpost on Turnagain River is estimated at 
 ninet}' miles, but is probably less. Horses are employed in 
 packing over the trail. 
 
 The valley of the Rapid River joins that of the Dease at 
 its great bend, just alluded to, but the stream, running parallel 
 with the Dease for some distance, enters it several miles lower 
 down. 
 
 The northerly course of the river carries it very obliquely 
 through the eastern portion of the Cassiar Range. The 
 quantity of snow resting upon the mountains was observed 
 to be very small, and Sylvester successfully winters his horses 
 here, without cutting hay or otherwise providing for them, 
 the depth of snow in winter being so small that it does not 
 seriously interfere with grazing. This favoured district is, in 
 
in 
 
 uely 
 The 
 rved 
 rses 
 lem, 
 not 
 in 
 
 TFIE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 13 
 
 fact, homologous with that in the vicinity of Telegraph Creek, 
 being in the dry lee of the Cassiar Range, just as that is in a 
 similar situation with respect to the Coast Mountains. Much 
 of the valley, with the slopes of the hills, is open or partially 
 wooded with groves of black pine {P. 3Iurrayaita) and aspen 
 poplar. The grass has the tussocky bunch-grass character 
 usually found in dry regions, and it is intermixed with the 
 small sage {Artemisia frigida). The bear- berry {Arctostapldyos 
 uva-tirsi) is not uncommon, and the strawberry and lupin 
 {LupiiiHS Nootkatcnsis) were in flower. Anemone patens was 
 here also observed for the first time, but long past flowering. 
 Making allowance for the time occupied in reaching this place 
 from Telegraph Creek, the progress of vegetation here was 
 palpably less advanced, but the showing was still a remarkable 
 one for the latitude, elevation and distance from the sea of the 
 region. 
 
 Below the Rapid River the Dease becomes relativelj' wide, 
 with numerous gravel-bars, and in some places many islands, 
 with frequent " drift piles " or accumulations of timber. 
 Terraces are well shown on the sides of the mountains, and 
 reach a height of about 2000 feet above the river. 
 
 A few miles before reaching the second great bend, a stream 
 joins from the west, which has become known to the miners as 
 French Creek, and is probably the " Detour River " of old maps. 
 It rises on the north-east slope of the Cassiar Mountains, and is 
 not large. 
 
 The last main reach of the Dease extends from the second 
 great bend to its mouth, a distance of thirty-one miles in a 
 direction of N. 55° E. Though the course of the river is far 
 from being direct, the general bearing leaves the base of the 
 Cassiar Range nearly at a right-angle. In descending this 
 part of the river, the mountains soon become invisible from 
 the river-valley, which is bordered by undulating lowlands, or 
 low diffuse hills which rise to a plateau at some miles distant, 
 from 400 to 500 feet above the stream. Banks of frozen soil 
 were seen in one or two places beneath a peat}' or mossy cover- 
 ing. The climate is evidently more humid than before, and less 
 favoureible to vegetation. The current of the river is swift, and 
 there are two or three inconsiderable rapids, but none of impor- 
 
 
 I 
 
 VM 
 
 1 I 
 
 i-f 
 
 j'ii 
 
 M 
 
3H 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ! i 
 
 r- 
 
 tance till within about four miles of the mouth, where there 
 are several strong rapids ; these at certain stages of the water 
 are reported to be dangerous, and in all our boats shipped 
 more or less water. Terraces, as much as 300 feet in height, 
 approach the river in some places in this part of its course, and 
 when cut into generally show stratified gravels which sometimes 
 rest directly on low exposures of rock. 
 
 The larch (Lari'x Aincruana) was first seen five miles below 
 the second great bend, and below this place becomes quite 
 abundant in cold, swampy spots, where it grows with the black 
 spruce {Picea nigra). 
 
 Blue River (the " Caribou River " of Campbell) joins the 
 Dease twelve miles below the second great bend. It is a stream 
 fifty feet wide at the mouth, with clear water, and derives its 
 supply from the north-eastern slopes of the Cassiar Range, to 
 the north of French Creek. 
 
 The " Lower Post," which is the furthest outwork of " civili- 
 zation " or trade in this direction, is ituated at the edge of a 
 terrace forty feet in height on the left > ank of the Liard, about 
 half a mile above the mouth of the Dease. It is of a very 
 unpretentious character, consisting of a few low log buildings. 
 In the vicinity the woods have been entirely destroj-ed by fire. 
 
 The Liard River is said to open, as a rule, h-om the ist 
 to the 5th of May, though in 1887 this did not occur till the i8th 
 of that month. In the autumn of 1886 it was frozen over on 
 November 21st. 
 
 It would be impossible, without the expenditure of much time, 
 to make anything like a complete geological section on the line 
 of the Dease, the main geological features are, however, suffi- 
 ciently apparent. 
 
 At the first little lake, a granitic area is entered, which 
 may be i-egarded as constituting the axis of the Cassiar Range, 
 and which extends on the river to the mouth of the Cottonwood, 
 constituting the entire Skree Range, and apparently also Anvil 
 Mountain and the surrounding high mountain region, with a 
 transverse width of about thirteen miles. The granite here 
 differs somewhat from that found on the Stikine in being more 
 highly quartzose and occasionally garnetiferous. Mica is present 
 in great abundance, and is in some specimens black, in others of 
 
THE YUKON TKRRITORY 
 
 315 
 
 time, 
 
 He line 
 
 suffi- 
 
 iwhich 
 ange, 
 Iwood, 
 Anvil 
 Ivith a 
 here 
 niore 
 Iresent 
 liers of 
 
 characteristic pale, silvery colours. The existence of distinctly 
 gneissic rocks was not ascertained, but the lithological character 
 of the series resembles that of the lowest rocks of Shuswap 
 Lake and other districts in the interior of British Columbia to 
 the south, which hr ve been provisionally referred to the Archaean. 
 The valley of Cottonwood Creek appears to coincide with the 
 north-eastern edge of the granites for a number of miles. The 
 mountains to the north of it, and extending eastward along the 
 north side of the Dease, are evidently composed of stratilicd 
 rocks, including important beds of limestone, the average dip 
 being about N. 45° E.< 30°. The northern spur of the moun- 
 tain which terminates the Skree Range, opposite the mouth of 
 Cottonwood Creek, shows the overlap of the stratified rocks 
 upon the granites at a considerable height above the river. The 
 mountains which run southward on both sides of Eagle River 
 valley seem to be also granitic for the most part, though a 
 greenish-grey felsite was collected on the river from the northern 
 spur of the mountain to the east of the valley. 
 
 Little was ascertained respecting the rocks composing the 
 mountains between Eagle River and Sylvester's Landing, but 
 granite does not reappear in them. 
 
 Eleven miles south of the second great bend, on the right 
 bank of the river, is a low, r^ )cky cliff, about fifteen feet above 
 the water, capped by about ten feet of bedded white silts. The 
 rocks are blackish, sandy shales, rather hard in some places, 
 carbonaceous, and holding a little impure lignite. They are 
 extremely irregular in dip, and are broken and jumbled up with 
 a hard, grey quartzite, which is seen in places as the underlying 
 rock, but is even then singularly shattered. The aspect of the 
 shales is that of those of the Tertiary rocks, and it is possible 
 that this locality represents an old shore-line, but more probable 
 that the rocks form part of an ancient slide, or are upon the 
 line of disturbance of a fault. 
 
 From the second great bend to the mouth of the Dease, the 
 underlying rocks consist of grey and black schists, the former 
 generally calc-schists, and the latter more or less highly car- 
 bonaceous. They are interbedded with thin limestones, which 
 often weather brown. The calc-schists are frequently glossy, 
 and in some places form very thin, paper-like layers. Some of 
 
 G 
 
 'II 
 
 if: 
 
 
 til 
 
it 
 
 4) 
 
 '^■> 
 
 ,1 
 
 1 1 
 
 
 ^ 
 
 ! 
 
 
 i 
 
 hi' 
 
 ^^1. 
 
 ! I 
 
 f! 
 
 316 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 these rocks closely resemble those met with at the " Grand 
 Rapid " on the Stikine, The general strike is north-west by 
 south-east, but the direction and auf^le of dip is very varied, and 
 the beds are frequently much disturbed and twisted, and 
 traversed by veins of quartz and calcite. There are probably 
 frequent repetitions of the same horizon, but the f^eneral arrange- 
 ment may be synclinal, the dark shales and schists occupying 
 the higher position, and being most abundant about the middle 
 of this length of the river-section. Graptolites were found in 
 the dark shales, particularly at a locality in a north bend of the 
 river, eleven miles westward in a direct line from the mouth, 
 and in appearance the whole series is much like that of the 
 Cambrian calc-schists and Cambro-Silurian giaptolite-shales of 
 the Kicking Horse (Wapta) valley, west of the summit, on the 
 line of the Canadian Pacific Railway. 
 
 The general aspect and association of the rocks to the east of 
 the granite axis of the Cassiar Range closely resembles that of 
 the Rocky Mountains about the 51st parallel, but differs in the 
 large proportion of metamorphic materials of volcanic origin, 
 which, from the debris brought down by streams, must be even 
 more abundant than the exposures along the river would indicate. 
 This difference is paralleled by the similar change which is met 
 with on the 51st degree of latitude, in passing from the Rocky 
 Mountains proper to the interior plateau of British Columbia. 
 
 A small collection of graptolites, made at the point above 
 indicated, has been submitted by Mr. J. F. Whiteaves to Prof. 
 Charles Lapworth, of Mason College, Birmingham, who has 
 kindly examined them, and furnishes the following note : — 
 
 " The graptolites collected by Dr. Dawson from the Dease 
 River are identical with those examined by me from the rocks 
 of the Kicking Horse Pass, some time last year. The species I 
 notice in the Dease River collection are: — 
 
 Diplograptus eiiglyphus (Lapworth). 
 Climacograptus, comp. antiquus (Lapworth). 
 Cryptcgraptus tricornis (Carruthers). 
 Glossograpttis ciliatus (Emmons). 
 Didymograptus, comp. Sagittarius (Hall). 
 New form allied to Canograptiis. 
 
THE YUKON TKRRITOKY 
 
 '0^7 
 
 Dease 
 
 rocks 
 
 icies I 
 
 "The f^raptolite-bcarinf^ rocks are clearly of about middle 
 Ordovician age. They contain forms which I would refer to 
 the second or Black River Trenton period, i.e. they are never 
 newer than the Point Levis series and older than the Hudson 
 and Utica groups. The association of forms is such as we find 
 in Britain and Western Europe, in the passage-beds between 
 the Llandeilo and Caradoc limestones. The rocks in Canada 
 and New York with which these Dease River beds may best 
 be compared are the Marsouin beds of the St. Lawrence valley 
 and the Norman's Kill beds of New York. The Dease River 
 beds may, perhaps, be a little older than these. 
 
 ** Mr. C. White describes some graptolites from beds in the 
 mountain region of the west, several years ago, which may 
 belong to the same horizon as the Dease River zones, though 
 they have a somewhat more recent aspect. 
 
 " The specific identification of the Dease River fossils I 
 regard as provisional. While the species correspond broadly 
 with those found in their eastern equivalents, they have certain 
 peculiarities, which ma}-, after further study (jr on the discovery 
 of better or more perfect specimens, lead to their separation as 
 distinct species or varieties. 
 
 " It is exceedingly interesting to find graptolites in a region 
 so far removed from the Atlantic basin, and also to note that 
 the typical association of Llandeilo- Bara genera and species is 
 still retained practically unmodified." 
 
 Overlying these old rocks, in several places at about eight 
 miles from the mouth of the Dease, are shaly clays and coarse, 
 soft sandstones, associated with which a thin bed of lignite was 
 observed. These are evidently Tertiary, and referable to the 
 series afterwards found more extensively developed on the 
 Liard, above the mouth of the Dease. Some very obscure 
 remains of leaves were noticed, but none were collected. The 
 beds dip at various angles, sometimes as high as 15 , and thus 
 appear to have been, to some extent, affected by flexure sub- 
 sequent to their deposition. It is not improbable that a con- 
 siderable part of the higher plateau by which the river is here 
 bordered on both sides, is composed of these newer rocks resting 
 upon the upturned edges of the schists. 
 
 G 2 
 
 llil 
 
m 
 
 SM 
 
 CHAPTER VII. 
 
 '« ■ 
 
 J i 
 
 Name of the T.innl River defined -The Liard and Frances ascended as far as 
 Simpson Lake about 1X54 — The same route to Frances and Finlayson I,ai<es 
 explored in 1S40 — Cieo^raphical informalinn obtained — Widlli and velocity of (lie 
 Upper Liaril— (ieneral bearinj^ of tiie I.iard and I'laiice. Rivers — Tiie Lower 
 Canon — Formation of tlic rocks Islands at the conMuence of the Liard with t!'e 
 Frances River — Tlie Liard subject to freshets — Tiend of the valUy al)ove tiie 
 confluence-- Sayyea Creek — Clood t;ol(l " prospects" found in this creek — Otiier 
 trii)utaries of the Liard -('omposition of };ravel bars and shores of the 
 Liard — Favouialile indicalions in respect of mineral development — CJold found 
 in layers of {jravel deposit — Average width and rate of current of the Frances — 
 The Middle Cafioii— Cicneral course of tlij river above the Middle Canon- 
 Simpson Lake- Indian map of tlie triliulary system— -An attractive field for 
 furtlier exploration — False Canon- Simpson Moinilaiiis — Formation (jf the 
 mountains in the vicinity of the Frances— Upper ranon, the last serious impedi- 
 ment to navij,'ation — Rocks of the Upper Canon — The river from the Upper 
 Canon to Frances Lake — Moose Island — Difference of level between Prances 
 Lake and the 'iioiith of the Dease — Flevatioii of Frances Lake — Simpson's 
 Tower — Campbell Mountains -Resemblance of Fiances Lake to a larije number 
 of t;d<e? ill liritish Cohiiiiliia Natural beaui^ of I'Vaiices Lake Thomas River 
 — Aliundance of fish— Ch.uactcr of the country and mountains surrounding the 
 lake — Composition of the central parts of the Toot-sho Range — Promisini; aspect 
 of surface gravel at the mouth of the Finlayson River. 
 
 :i I l» 
 
 THIC name of the Liard River, or Riviere aiL\ Liards, refers 
 t(i tlie abundance ot the Cottonwood orpophir, and was no 
 doiil)t ' I'iginally f^ivt 11 to its lower portion. This name has 
 l)t;en corrupted to ' Delcjirt!," in whiih form it is generally in 
 use by the miners of the Cassiar country. It is often spoken of 
 as the West Branch by traders on the Mackeiiiiie, and has also 
 been named th Mtnmtain River, anil sometimes the fireat 
 C"iu-rent River or Courant-fort. It is called Too-ti' by th,- 
 Indians of the country alonj^^ its upper i)art, wliiU; ;ic((jrdin;.'; to 
 Petitot, the Indians ncanir (he Mackenzie nan;e it \:. ettchichic 
 and Thcttadesse.' 
 
 This river and the iMances appear (o ha\e been ascended by 
 McLeod, about 1^.54, as far as Simpson Lake, but in 1840 Mr, 
 R. Campbell explored the same route to hrances ami I'inlayson 
 
 ' liullctin du ki Sucii'tu dc Gcogi-apliie, vol. x., p. 15 J. 
 
 I!!.: I 
 
IK 
 
 :hi<i 
 
 2(1 by 
 ) Mr. 
 
 ;i)' 
 
 son 
 
 TIIK YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 Lakes (as subsequently mentioned in {greater detail), 
 
 luen 
 accu 
 
 3'9 
 
 anc 
 
 obtained tlie most accurate {^eojj^rapbical information available 
 to the present time. Sir J. Richardson, however, in his Arctic 
 Searchiiif,' Expedition (1H51) ;^nive such particulars of the 
 Liard as he was able to f,Mther from hearsay (Vol. i., p. 167; 
 ii., p. 203), and mentions havinf,^ received in itS4<S, wliile <m the 
 Mackenzie, Honolulu papers of late date by this route from the 
 Pacific. On the older maps, the Black or Turnaf^ain River is 
 desij,Miated as the main contimiation of the Liard, but it is 
 much smaller than the "North-west Branch " of these maps, 
 to which the name is now applied. 
 
 The Ui)i)er Liard, just above the mouth of the Dease and 
 opposite ihe post previously referred to, is 840 feet in width, 
 and on the ;';4th of June, i<S(S7, was found to have a maximum 
 velocity of 4*54 mil(;s per hour. It is a turbid yellowish stream, 
 and contrasts in this respect with the clearer water of the Deaso, 
 which ri\er, at the coidluence with the Li;'nl, probably carries 
 about half the volume of water above assij^^ied to the latter. 
 
 From the mouth of the Dease River to the coulltience of the 
 Frances Ri\( 1, the {general bearin;.,^ of the Liard is nearly due 
 north-west, the distance, in a strai/^dit lin(\ bein}^- thirty-three 
 miles, or following' the course of the river, fort\-ti\-e iniK's. 
 The I'Vances River, which was followed from the last-iiaiiUMl 
 point, disre^.iidiu}; its minor llexures. has a nearly direct uorth- 
 aud-soutli course. A ^trai;4ht line drawn from the mouth of 
 the Dease to the Lower ciul of I'Vances Lake is iiuiety-four 
 miles in leiij^th, but th<' distance between these jjoints. following,' 
 the flexures of the river, is one huiidnd and thirty-Hve mil(!S. 
 
 Six miles above the mouth of l;he' Dease. !)y the course of the 
 river, the entrance of the Lozvcr CaTion is n^aclud. The cauoii 
 is three miles in )en;,'tli. and it hij^h water il is said to hv. 
 necessary to poila;:;e the wholi; of this distance. We were 
 obliged to lij^diteii the boats ;ind make four smrdl portai^es over 
 rocky points, where the < urnMit was daiif^^erously swift. The 
 latitude, obscvcd at noon near the middle of the canon, was 
 60° 01' o<j". Mndin;^' that we were so near the iioitlKin 
 boundary of British (Oluinbia (lat. Oo ), we made a small cairn 
 of stones on a prominent rocky point ; a post was eri'cted 
 in the centre, and on this the latitude was maiked. The Ooth 
 
 m 
 if'} 
 
 li. i 
 
 
 In 
 
I:' ;! 
 
 m 
 
 I > 
 
 r 
 
 i 
 
 ! 
 
 120 
 
 Till', VUKoN I'l'.KKI'rokN' 
 
 parallel may he s;ii(l to coincide ;i!mnst cxaclly willi the lower 
 end of the canon. 
 
 The rocks in (he Lower ("anon resemljle tiiose described as 
 charactc'rizin^; tile lo\\(|- pint of tlic J)ease River. < )iiartzites 
 are also present, and all tile rocks are occasionally loc;allv silici- 
 lied. 'The w liiile series is nnicli di^tnrlted and contorted, and is 
 broken by innnnieial)le small, ii"re;^iilar seams and veins of 
 ipiarl/ and calcite with some dolomite, thoii,i,di no well-marked 
 or important lodes were seen, (ialeiia is reported to lia\-e been 
 found in some of the veins, and to have j'ielded a small return 
 in silver on assa)'. 
 
 'ihi; Liard is full o( islands at its conlluence with the I'rances, 
 renderiii}; it dii'liciilt to estimate the relati\e ini|)ortance of the 
 two streams, but tlie\' appealed to carrv almut an eipial (|iiantity 
 of water, 'ihe Liard is, howe\er, e\idenll\' more subject to 
 freshets; iManci^ I ,ake doid)tless sei'viu;,' to re^idate tlu; How 
 ol the I'rances lvi\er, which is o( a clear, pale, amber colour, 
 and docs not thomunhK' mingle with the yellowish, tiubid 
 watei' ot the Liard lor some miles. Above the conlluence, 
 the Liard valley is seen lo trend off in a south-westerly 
 direction (01 ten miles or nii Me, aitei' w hi( h it iieain turns to the 
 
 north-westwar 
 
 il, and. 
 
 Iron: the scanty information available 
 
 concerning it, seems to flow alon;,f the eastern side of the 
 northern contimiation of the ("assiar Ivanj^c, horn whit h it 
 receives most of its watei". 
 
 Sayyea (reek, which is an inconsiderable stream, flows in 
 from (he west about lifty-fi\e miles above the mouth of the 
 l'"raiices. ("lood ,!^old " |)rosp(!cts " wen; found on this creek in 
 1^(75, a numbei" of pieces worth ten dollais liaviuf^' been 
 obtained, but little work has e\er been done. ( )f a |)arty of 
 miners who spent the wintei of i>'^7-p5 in its vicinitw foui' iied 
 of scurvy. ( )f the other ti ibutaries of the Li.aid, which nnisl be 
 numerous, I have been unable to ascertain anyliiin^' authentic. 
 
 The ,i;r,iveM)ars and the shores of this part of the Liard are 
 almost hall ((im|)osed ol rolled (|uart/ pebbles, which havi' 
 evidently bien derived from \eins traversing' relatively soft 
 schistose rocks like those' of the canon. The j^'reat (piantity of 
 such vein material present in this district m;iv be re^^arded as a 
 favoinable indication in lespecl of miueial development. Some 
 
TIIK VUKf)N TKKRfTOKY 
 
 321 
 
 wrr 
 
 1 as 
 ;it(!S 
 lici- 
 1(1 is 
 
 Ix'cU 
 
 turn 
 
 1" the 
 
 iitity 
 c.t to 
 
 low 
 
 111 liid 
 
 H1>1 c, 
 
 •sU:rly 
 
 to tllc 
 lilaM'' 
 .f llic 
 icli It 
 
 IWS 111 
 
 ,f til.' 
 'ck in 
 hrcii 
 rtv of 
 
 III 
 
 lied 
 
 I list 1)0 
 
 ■iitic. 
 
 id arc 
 
 lia\i' 
 
 iv soft 
 
 Itity of 
 
 Id as a 
 
 Soiik; 
 
 small l);:rs have paid to work ;ilon;^' tins part of tlu; river, and 
 f,'olcl is also foiiiid in sonn' layers of the f^ravel de|)osit wliieli 
 crlies the older rocks aloii}/ tlu; canon and abo\c it, where 
 
 ov 
 
 wai 
 
 ;cs " at i^.\ a day can be made. The anioiint of c( 
 
 )Ver 
 
 wliich it soon becomes necessary to remo\-e in followiiif^ the 
 payin;,' layers, has pi"e\'ented e.\tcnsi\c lninill^^ hut |)robaI)lv 
 tluse ;^Mavcls mif^dit be advantaj^eoiisly worked as a whole, by 
 shiiciitf,^ or by the hydraulic method. 
 
 l"or the first few miles above its mouth the I'lances is 
 extremely tortuous, so much so that the distance following; the 
 actual coiirsc of the ri\'er to tlu! loot ol the canon is t\\('nt\-t\vo 
 miles. This river, like the Liaid, was at a niediinn sta^^c near 
 the (-'iul of June, i.S(S7. Marks aloii^; the banks sliow<(l that it 
 had been about six feet higher in the spriuj^, and that it had 
 
 (• width in this |)art is about f)Oo 
 
 si 
 
 nee been falliiiL;. its aver; 
 
 feet, and the rate ol the cuireiit, at the nicdiiim sta^^'c above 
 referred to, about four miles and a hall an hour. 
 
 Tlu' hij^hest land immediately bordering on tlii^ part of the 
 river isa. tiirace :it a hei,L;lit ol about 150 feet above it, the 
 surface of which is in some places composed ol :ihii<»; |>iir<' 
 sand, iii)on which o|)i 11 woods ol I'diks Miinavtiiia j;iow. 
 Larch was observed to be moderately abiindaiil in dam|), sIkkK' 
 localities, and tlu banks w< re in some places diNcrsilied with 
 llowcrs, of which /'(<trii/iH(i fnifiiour and /'riiiiiil(t iiiis/(ixsini(ii 
 were S|)eciall)' iiote.l. 
 
 (.)uartz is not so abundant a constituent ol the ^ra\'el ol the 
 ri\'er-bars on tlii^ part oi the I''iances as it is on the l.ianl 
 
 nelow, am 
 
 I no basalt blocks or boulders were obsei \-ed here 
 
 '\'\\r /l////f//(! C'lfiiofi, AS it may be called lor the purpose ol 
 (listiii,i,Miishin;,Mt, is about t'lne miles in leiif^lh, the river bein^ 
 hemiiied in bv broken, im k\ clilTs of .ioo to jo" I''''' i'l hei;;ht 
 loi the greater part ol this distance. WC look oiir iioals up 
 alonj,' the south-east bank, making' lour short portages ol part 
 of the stuff, and two of both boats ;iiul |o:id, ncross iiariow, 
 
 i| ;;ii alel leii;;lli, on IIh' opjH i^ite 
 bank, woiiM oNcrcoiiie all the really bad water, but the banks 
 on that side alt; rougher, and the whole lorce oi the ( urreiit 
 sets a;^aiiist the cliff in one |)l,i((' in a daiif.;('rous manner. The 
 total fail ill the canon is estimated at about thirty (eel. 
 
 rocky |)oiiits. < )ne |)orta; 
 
1,1 
 
 II '■ 
 
 \ 
 
 322 
 
 TMK YUKON i'KKRITORY 
 
 Above the Middle^ ("ariDii, the general course of the river is 
 again north-north-\\(;st\vanl for about twelve; miles. It is 
 usually bordered by (luite low land on both sides, and the valley 
 b(!tween the southern i:nd of the Simpson Mountains and 
 northern part of the Tses-T-iih Range is about three miles in 
 width. 'Ihe wide, uniform plateau eoimtry is now, however, 
 left behind, and we enter a generally moimtainous ri'gion, though 
 the highest summits in this innnediate \iriiiity scarcely (exceed 
 3000 feet above (he ri\'er. Their forms are rather rounded and 
 flowing, and the slopes of those on the east bank are nearly bare 
 of trees, while tlu! opposite range is generally wooded, but 
 evidently with trees of small growth. '['\\v river itself is wide 
 and deep, with a rather slack current. 
 
 Near the end (>f this reach of tlu; ii\-er, two considerable 
 streams enter on the west side, and on one or other of these;, 
 at no great distance from the river, Simpson f.akc; of McLeod 
 and (".am|)l)ell is situated. As tiie Indians who had accom- 
 panied US Imm the UHiuth <ii the Dease liad deserted befoic we 
 reached this place;, I was unable to ascertain any (l(;linit(; 
 partic;ulars respecting the lake, though it is reported to bi' a good 
 one for fish. The position of Sinipson Lake, as indicated by 
 broken lines on tlu; map, must therefore ix; regarded as ([uite 
 uncertain. Tlu; s;une doubt ajjplies to the Indian names of 
 several rivers tributary to the I'^raiues above (his |)oint, for 
 although OIK' of tlu; local Indians ha<l made an elaborate char- 
 coal drawing of the whole system for us, u|)on a sheet of canvas 
 used as a boat coxcr, it |)i'oved to be extremely dillicult to 
 recognize the features re|)i('sented. The Indi;in map, siu;li as 
 it is, serves to show that the streams tributarj' to the l-'rances 
 River rise in a number of lakes; sonu; of these; are re;pe)rte;(l te) 
 be of consideMable si/e, and olTei- a most attractive fielel for 
 furthei- exploration, Wewco' told, however, that none; of tlu; 
 lakes in this re'gion are' e'epial in si/i; to l'"rane:e;s Lake-, fe)|- 
 which we' we'ie' heaeling, a state'UU'ut be)rue out by the' eiieimi- 
 staiice that beith this anel Dease' Lake' are; known in their 
 respective districts as Te)o-tshe), e)r " big lak-," while- the I'-rances 
 and hease' KiveTs are, as already me'Utioue'd, both similarly 
 named T(jo-tsh()-te)oa', e)r " big lake river." 
 
 ]'"rom the' point ju^t luited. tlu; ilirection of (luM'ive-r chanpfes 
 
Inr 
 •liar- 
 aiiv;is 
 lit to 
 r]\ as 
 aiici'S 
 ■d to 
 (1 for 
 )!" the 
 ', for 
 iciini- 
 tlicir 
 la.iices 
 
 iUiily 
 
 THR YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 323 
 
 to north-casf, rutting' across the direction of the Tscs-i-nh 
 
 Raiu'c, wliicli tcMiniiiatcs at tlu; c( 
 
 iL'e o 
 
 ftl 
 
 u: river in low, wooc 
 
 (led 
 
 lulls, 'i'lic current is niodcratelv swift throindioiit, and in one 
 
 place tin; river is bordered 
 
 both 
 
 des bv 1< 
 
 laiif^es 
 
 u; liver is Doidered on hotn sides hy low, rocky l)anks, 
 but no rapids aii' met with. This we named the /''n/se Canon. 
 One or possibly two streams enter from a valley which runs to 
 the east of tlu; ran},^' just mentioned, but they are not of lar^u; 
 size, (in^j'ish-'^reeii, (|iiartzos(! mica-schist and j^'rev.'uish silvery 
 schists were seen in one or two places, and in the low rocky 
 banks above alluded to, blackish arj^illiti'S and ;,M-ey (jiiartzites, 
 of a less altered a|)pearance than usual, but from which no fossils 
 were obtained, occur. 
 
 I'^rom the end of this reach th(! i^^eiieral course of tlu; stream 
 af^ain becomes north-north-west for about thirtecin miles, runniu}^ 
 for the greater part of this distance jjarallel to, and a mile or 
 two miles from tlu; base of a mountain ran};(;, which comes in 
 to tlu; (;ast of the 'l"sesi-iih l\an}j;e. The country to the west of 
 the river is here either Hat or characterized m(;relv by low, 
 rounded and wooded hills lor man\' miles back, the eye ran;^dn;^^ 
 at;rf)ss this couiitr}' to tlu' continuation o( the .Simpson Moun- 
 tains, which, with i^'ciierally rounded forms and no stiikin;^' 
 summits, reach (;levations of fxioo to r)5()o fi;(;t. These; 
 niountains do not form a strictly (connected ram,'e, but iippear 
 rather as a series of mountainous aii'as, separated by wide, low 
 passes. The Indian map above relerii'd to shows three or four 
 lakes in this rej^ioii, su|)plyinj,' a str(;am named 'loo-tslu-too-a, 
 which Hows into the I'rances, reach i 11;^' it probably just above 
 the Upper ("anon. Noiu; of these lakes wcri' visible from any 
 |>oint reached by us. On the opposite side, one stream of con- 
 siderable size joins the i'lances. This is sii|)|)osed to be tlu; 
 Ag(l-zl-r:ii oi the Indians, and, if so, is represented as rising,-' 
 in a chain of small lakes, some of which drain in an easterly 
 direction to the Macphersoii [li_ii-is-r-ti>o'-ii) River, 'i'he vallc^y 
 occupied by these lak(!S is a traxi'lled route em|)lo3e(l b}' the 
 Indians. 
 
 The current is swifter in the ii|)per than in the lower portion 
 of this part of the I'^rances, and then; are numerous islands in 
 the river, but no rock-i'xposiires occur. The mountains to tlu; 
 cast ol the river are high, but haxc blunt, rounded forms. 
 
 ,1!^ 
 
 V 
 
 t'i 
 
: 
 
 '. I 
 
 I 
 
 
 ■1 
 
 :f 
 
 1 1^ 
 
 > ( 
 
 » ^i^ 
 
 ! V' 
 
 n^l 
 
 Pi 
 
 ! 
 
 I 
 
 
 ! 1 
 
 
 i 
 
 324 
 
 THI'! YUKON TKRHITOKY 
 
 Much bare rock shows in their sides, but tliere is 110 a|t|)caranc(; 
 of slratilicatioii, and this, witli their form and colour, and th(' 
 ^'reat ahiiiidaiice of tlial material found in the streams in tiiis 
 vicinity, lenders it nearly certain that they are com|»ose(l of 
 ^Manite. 
 
 The mountains so far met with in the vicinity of th(; I'rances 
 form rather isolated lanj^es or masses, wlii( h ris(' somewhat 
 abruptly hom {^'cnerally low count ly, or are siparatcd by wide; 
 valleys, the a|)pearancc beiu/^^ that o( a nioimtain system partly 
 buried in later de|)osils; th<)u;^di no Tertiary rocks, either in 
 place or as loost; fra^nnents, an; met with above the Middle 
 ("anon. TIk' {^Manitic moimlains last refericd to form an out- 
 lying' spur or t)uttress of the most important ran;.;e of the 
 district, the axis of whi( h is Ik re about twelve miles east of (he 
 rivt;r. This it is jiroposed to desi},'nate the Too-tslio Rani^c.^ 
 'I'he sonthernmost hif^di sunmht observed was named, from its 
 foiiu, lent Pi'nk. It is situated in latitude t)o" 5^' ,(5", and has 
 an altitude of 7860 feet above the sea. 
 
 The liver next makes an ai)rupt turn to the west for four 
 miles, a mile and a (jnarler of (his distance bein^' oc( upied by a 
 series of rapids, which are rocky and lather stron^^s and havi' a 
 total fall of about thiity feet, 'i'he baid<s rise s(eeply hoin (he 
 river ( :> hei;4li(s of 100 (o .ioo fee(, (liouf^h the rocky cliffs aloufMlie 
 wa(er are of inconsiderable hei;.;b(, scarcely anywhere exi cedin;; 
 'if(y feet. 'Ibis pla<c ma\' be named the Upftcr Canon, and is 
 the last serious impediment to (he navigation of (he river. We 
 found it nec( ssary (o maki' several short porta;^'es, bu( with a 
 larj^'e boat and a( a /jjood slaf^'<' of (he rivei', it is probable (hat 
 one |»orla^c of about a (liousaiid feet in lcu^,'(h, on (he soudi 
 !-aid<, would overcome all (he dan^'<roiis wa(er, while (he boa( 
 mif{h( be (racked nji li;,di(, A :.(ream, vvi(h nuuhrate ( ur""ent a( 
 (he moiidi and abou( lif(\ lee( wide, enters a short dis(an((: 
 below (he canon, romiiif^ from the moun(ains (o (lienordi o( 
 Ten( I'eak. TIk locks of (he Upper (anon (omprist; black, 
 },dossy calc-schis(s, black (|iiar(/i(e or < her(, bluish limestone, 
 and some ,i,'rceir-).^rey silvery schist. Similar rocks an; sc^en 
 af^'ain a < onple of ii'MrtD" up the river, ibovt; (hi; canon, when; a 
 
 ' ('loni ill) iiivc niiiiK' <^ |**(aiu(s Lake. I «.(>, imablc lo iiscertaai the 
 Indian name vt 'ii's ranjjt-, it »»«ifi:(l it lias any su( li, 
 
Till', YUKON ri'.KKirOKY 
 
 325 
 
 nipid occiiis. 'I"lic (lips iiid all low, and, so far as observed, 
 iiniforniiy in a northerly dir<'(lion. Sonic of the schists an; 
 highly silicilicd by action snl)Sc(|nciil to their deposition, and 
 parts of all the rocks, iiichidinf,' the limestone, arc reticulated 
 with narrow quart/ seams. Near the ii|)|)er part of the canon 
 some hard conjjlomerates occin, holdin;; s(diistose fraf^'meiits, as 
 ell as limestone pebbles, in which crinoidal joints are observ- 
 iblc. It is not improbable that two mu'on forma ble series of lock 
 
 w 
 
 here, but I 
 
 d)l(- to iind II 
 
 occur Here, Dill I was iinal)l(; to imd means oi (iisim^iiisiiin^' 
 them ill tlw sections.' 
 
 I'loiii the l!|)per ("arioii to I'lances i.ake, a distance of 
 twent\-oiie miles and a hall in a stiai};hl line, the river iiiaiii- 
 taiiis a northerly direction with considerable iinitormity. It is 
 deep, with a moderate current, lor about ei^ht miles, or to 
 Moose ls/(iii(/, above wlii( h lor ten miles the ( urreiit is a^'ain 
 swill, avera^diij( from (01 11 and a hall miles to live miles an hour. 
 It a;^^•lin becomes slack lor a short distance below the lake. 
 Some portions oi this jiait ol the river are iiiik h broken up by 
 islands and };ravel-bais. 
 
 Oiir actual workinj; time on I'laiices l\i\(i, liom its mouth 
 to the lake, was sixty-seven hours and a half. The dilTeicnce 
 of level between l'"raiices Lakeaiid the month ofthe Dease is 
 • 177 feet. Hy assif^Miin^' ninety feet to the fall in the three; 
 canons, and dividin;^^ the remainder b\' the total leiij^fth of 
 the ri\'er (less the a/^^^rej^'ate length ol the < arioiis), we obtain 
 an av(!ra}^'e rate ol descent very slij^ditlv e.\( ci'diii},' three leet to 
 the mile, which is about what mi;;ht be anti(ipated from [\\r. 
 current met with in the riv(M", as (oinpaied with (hat of other 
 streams in the (listri( t . 
 
 The I'levation of l'"iances Lake abo\c the sea, as deteiniimd 
 by a series of baroineler obsei \ations e\ tern I in;; liom I he Mh l< i 
 
 the ibtll of |uly, is .^577 feel. Three mile, llMlll its lower end 
 ihe lake biliircates, formiii;; two ajipo iximalely e(|ual and nearly 
 jiaiallel arms, with leiif^'lh . of about lliiitv miles. The two 
 arms are alioiil ei;;hl miles apart, and aic separated i)y ;i 
 f;roiip ol low, idimded nioimlaiiis ; the ( iilmiiial in;; point, 
 with an elevation of 5^50 feet, was named Sim|)sou's Tower by 
 
 ' Ilsd, llic i()( ks licic noled may K'luc.cni lln; ('hM.k (.'ons lu uliii li tlicy an; 
 iithoid^ii ally siiiiiliU. 
 
 11: 
 
 ; 
 
■!/• 
 
 .M 
 
 1 i 
 
 U 
 
 I I 
 
 1! n> ^ 
 
 ■'k 
 
 ii ( 
 
 1 1 -'K 't 
 
 326 
 
 THE YUKON TF.KKITORY 
 
 Cainphell, the lake itself rcceivinf,' its name at the same time 
 in honom- of Lady Simpson. Tlie eastern side of ils east arm 
 is bordered by the Too-tsbo Range or hills attached to it, while 
 th(! country to the west of the west arm rises more gradually to 
 tin; bases of the Campbell Mountains, some miles distant. 
 Though so far referrcid to as a single lake, this body of water is 
 in reality entitled to be considered as a group of lakes. It 
 ap]iears best, how(;ver, to retain Campbell's original name for 
 the whoh; body of water, rather than to multiply names for 
 which there is no immediate call. 
 
 l'"rances Lake closely riisembles a large number of lakes in 
 the motmtainons regions of Jiritish C()lund)ia, and has the long 
 narrow parallel-sided outline characteristic of lak(;s occupying 
 old valley-excavations, the drainage; of which has become 
 int(Mrupted in various ways. In this case, as in a nund)er of 
 others, there can be litth; doubt that the; lake is lu;ld in by 
 moral nic accmnulations. 
 
 JCxcept along the u|)|)er i)art of the eastern side of the east 
 arm, the mountains do not slope down abru|)tly to the shores 
 of the lake. Llsewluac, the lake is almost conlinnonsly 
 bordered by a terrace-like; |)lateaii, which is widest to the west, 
 and has an average; elevation of about 500 fec;t. This reS(;m- 
 bles the low country about Deasi; Lake, though even more 
 uniform and less sloi)ing in charaet(;r, and is not far from tlu; 
 same actual elexation above the sea in both cases. The 
 streams entering the lake generally cut down through tlu; edges 
 of this plateau-like margin, in deep narrow goiges ; th(; sections 
 show that il is (Composed largely of rock, though levelled 
 •i|) to some extent by tlu; addition of sui)(;rrHi;d gravi;lly 
 deposits. There is, in addition to this, a s(;cou<l lower terrace, 
 not so well marked, and not often of great width, at an i;leva- 
 tion of nini'ty feet above the lake. This is sei;n on both arms, 
 and is composed of gravel and other detrital deposits. 
 
 i''ew lakes which I have seen surpass I'Vances Lake in 
 natural beauty, and the scenery of tlu' east arm, bordered on 
 the east by the rugged mass(;s of tlu; Toot-sho Range, is 
 singularly striking, 'ihe mountains of this range are very 
 varied in foim, aiul a number of points surpass 7000 feet in 
 height, while one was found to attain an elevation of about 
 
 hi; :| 
 
to 
 
 norc 
 the 
 
 uv. 
 
 ;li(ins 
 
 ,(llC(l 
 
 i\< 
 
 lly 
 
 laci', 
 •Icvii- 
 
 tunis, 
 
 yC 111 
 
 (I nil 
 
 IS 
 
 very 
 I'l ill 
 iboiit 
 
 
 THK YUKON 1 I;KU1T(3RY 
 
 327 
 
 9000 feet. This is named Moiutt f.(\>^<)ii, for ihc late Sir W. 1'" 
 
 Lop[;in. Heavy 
 
 iti: 
 
 asses 
 10 true glaciers an; produced 
 
 f snow n.'st in some of the valleys, hut 
 a fact indicatinj; a comparatively 
 
 Ul 
 
 small snowl; 
 
 fall. 
 
 The west arm terminates in a nearly circular basin about a 
 (piarter of a mile in diameter ; at one side of this a fair-si/ed 
 river, easily iiavi},^d)le for boats, Hows in. Tiic east arm 
 was not followed to its head, though its tciininatioii in low 
 land was seen. Here also, aceordinj^f to ("ampbeli's sketch, a 
 considerable river, which he has named Thomas Kivcr, enters. 
 
 Tlie two valle}s, the lower |)ails occupied by the east 
 and west arms of the lake, run on far beyond the heads 
 of thes(! arms. ICacli of tiie risers llouin.i; in these valleys 
 (;v(.'ntually bifurcates, and ,.dl four streams thus formed rise in 
 lakes. The river ilowinf^Miito the head of the west arm is named 
 Yus-sez' -nil, and the lake on its western blanch is known as 
 Us-ias'-a-lsf/o. No name was obtained lor the lake on its 
 eastern branch, which is evidently, howcvi'i, Macplursoii Lake 
 
 ol v..am|)U( 
 
 •II. 
 
 T 
 
 P 
 le motmtains 
 
 to tl 
 
 le noith ill whieli the se rivers rise, were 
 
 loo distant to enable us to lix them with any ^Mcat accuracy 
 from points octupied by us on i'Vances Lake, but the whole 
 country in that direction, from such views as were: obtained of 
 it, appeared to be riif^ijed and liij^li. 
 
 The water of l'"rances I^ake is clear andofa|)ale, brownish 
 tint, and the lake is evidently very deep in its iip|)er portions, 
 though ratlu^r shallow where, encumberi'd !))■ the morainic 
 accumulations already alluded to, and it does not appear to be 
 subject to very great lluctiiatioiis. Driltwood is very abundant 
 along some parts of the slioics, particularly in the west arm, 
 and it is probable that much ol this is brought down by the 
 river entering at the head ol this arm. Lake troiil, w liite-lish, 
 pike, and suckers were louiid in the lake in considei able 
 
 al)UiKlaiiC( 
 
 The silt: of the old Hudson Hay ixi^t is jiiht al)o\c the nam 
 
 iw 
 
 entrance to the east arm, on the edge oi 
 westward. Though Mr. (ampbell had 
 
 ll 
 
 le haul 
 
 aeiiij. 
 
 ;i\cii iiie all accurati' 
 
 description of its position, it was so completely overgrown with 
 bushes ami small trees, that it was tliscovered with dilliculty. 
 
 I'l! 
 
 
 "';':, 
 
 'III 
 
 ill 
 
 l\- 
 
1 ! 
 
 hi! 
 
 m 1 ( 
 
 3 28 
 
 TIIK YUKON iKKklTOUY 
 
 Tlic outline of (lie old slo(l<:i(lr, will) liastioiis ;it tlic corners, is 
 still visible, thoiif^li ;ill traces of tiie stiiicture itsi;lf lias dis- 
 appeared. This post lias l)eeii abandoned since 1H51. 
 
 All tlu! lo\V(rr country about l'"ranr,es Lake is well wooded, 
 rind the nioiiiilains arc; also covered with forest, save when 
 c'xre|)tion;dly steep and rocky, to a heij^lit of at least 1500 feit 
 ai)ov(! the laki', while trees of smaller f^'iowtli extend in the 
 valleys considerably hij^dier. The most abundant tree, here 
 as (;Is(!where in the rcf^ioii, is the white spruce {Piini nUui). 
 It fre(|ueiitly attains a diameter oi two li'it, ^'rowin;^' tall and 
 straij^dit on low j^'rouiid and in sheltered places. The black 
 spnic(! {Picca mu^ra) is also abundant. The larch {Larix 
 Auierkann) is characteristic of dam|), cool, northern slopes, and 
 birch [llitnlii pnpyrifcya) is moderately abundant, thoiij^h not 
 larf^'e. The shores, and particiilaily the delta-llats at the 
 mouths of streams, are characterized by j^'ioves of cottonwood 
 (|)rol)ably all referable here to Popnlus balsixmijern) and black 
 pine {Pinus Miirrayaiui). 
 
 \.\\x^v. tracts of country have been burnt over, many years 
 rv/^o, and extensive recent (ires have swept the western side of 
 the upper part of the east arm. Whenr a sicond f^Towth has 
 had time to sprinj^ up, it f^^'iierally consists ol mixed spruce, 
 aspen and birch. Alders art; common, but scarcely arboreal, 
 aloiif^f the borders of the lake, in tin; middle of July thickets 
 of wild roses in hill l)lo<im were seen in many jilaces. 
 
 Taken as a whole, the f^Mowth of the forest and appearance 
 of the c:ountry is remarkably pleasiiif,', consideriii;^' the lii;;h 
 and northern |)osition of tlu; lake. The only characteristic 
 difference ol the woods here, as compared with those of tlu; 
 interior of Ihitish Columbia about the 5|tli parallel, is tlu; 
 great abundance and depth ol the soft, mossy and licheiious 
 lloor which is evtM'vwheic found in them. The trees are also 
 olteii well bearded with moss, aflordiii},' evideiict; of a 
 continuously moist atmosphere, to bi; accoiinti'd for by the 
 alinc^st daily occurrence of lij^ht showers and the ^reat 
 prevalence of c'oiided skies, which was lomid tlirou;^dioui this 
 part of th<' country. As befort; noted, however, the snowfall 
 cannot be great, nor is there any indication that the total annual 
 precipitation is very considerable. 
 
TIIK VnKr)N TKkklTORY 
 
 320 
 
 li;is 
 
 nici', 
 ckcts 
 
 ristic. 
 i\u: 
 ks tlu; 
 •nous 
 also 
 of a 
 y tht: 
 
 li tliis 
 
 owiai 
 unua 
 
 i};i' arc 
 
 'I lie liif^li iiij;;'i(l cciitial parts of tlic 'l"oo fslio Rai 
 com|)osi(l lar;.M'l} or ciilircly of K'"'}' K'''"iitc ; its |m1)1)I(s 
 and hoiildcrs cvcTywlicrc ahiiiidant, and |)art iciilarly so 
 aloiif^' llic l)ca(lics ol llic cast arm. I here is, too, a nolal)le 
 abundance of {jnarl/ alon^; all the heaches of the lake, this 
 inateiial hein;^' derived hoin innnnieialile V(;ins which travcise 
 the schists in all directions, thon;.;h most often lonnd parallel 
 to the l)ed(lin^(-|ilanes, an<I f;encra.lly assuming forms more or 
 less lenticular. The largest ol tln'se are often several feet in 
 width, and those seen in the canon of the i'inlayson, neai' its 
 mouth, are ol workable dimensions, il only moderately ri( h in 
 f^'old. S|)e( imens of (|nart/ \'eins, containiu}^' some iron and 
 cop|)er pyrites, hom the east side o( the east arm about midway 
 u|) it, wei'e lound to contain traces ol ^M)ld on assay by Mr. 
 1 loffmann. 
 
 In ^'eneral a|)|)earance the rocks of brances F,ak(; very 
 closely resemble those bom which the rich |)lacer /^old de|)osits 
 of Dease Lake aic (leri\cd, and they are |)robably of about the 
 same aj^c. Several "colonrs" to the pan weic obtained from 
 surface f^ravel at the mouth ol I'inlayson River, which struck 
 me as specially |)roniisinj^; in aspect, and there seems to be no 
 reason why some ol th<' streams llowinj^' across the schistose 
 rocks into the lake m in its vicinity should not prove to be 
 richly auriferous. This entire district wi-ll deservis carehil 
 pros|)e( tin^;. After my return to the coast, in the autunm, I 
 ascertained from ( h.irles Monroe that he and some other miners 
 had actually done some |)|-ospectinj^ in the vicinity of the lake 
 at the time when the (assiar mines were yielding largely, and 
 the more enterprising men were scouriu}^^ the coimtry in search 
 of new fields. lie reached the lake from Cassiar by the same 
 route we had followed. On comparin^f notes, we found that he 
 
 had 
 
 workec 
 
 I for a short time at the mouth of tin' I'inlav; 
 
 .on. 
 
 where he louu'l the t;ravel to pay at the rati- of hdui ."jjiH to ^(j a 
 
 (la\ 
 
 Ml 
 
 ( 
 
 iii 
 
 r\ 
 
..^... 
 
 
 IMAGE EVALUATION 
 TEST TARGET (MT-S) 
 
 ^ 
 
 1.0 
 
 I.I 
 
 •a tii 12.2 
 :iitt ■— 
 !■ la 120 
 
 1.25 1.4 1.6 
 
 
 < 
 
 6" 
 
 ^ 
 
 ^ J>\'^'' 
 
 Photographic 
 
 Sciences 
 
 Corporation 
 
 
 ia V; w r MAIN STMIT 
 
 WIBSilR.N.Y. MS80 
 
 (716) S73-4S03 
 

 ^ 
 
CHAPTER VIIL 
 
 r. 
 
 ArrivrtI at Frances Lake — Difficulties of overland journey towards the Pelly — Search 
 for the trail used by the Hudson Bay Company — No sign of a trail discovered — 
 Indian assistance unobtainable — The expedition compelled to make the best of 
 its own resources — Continuation of journey — Slow rate of progress— Finlayson 
 Lake eventually reached — Observations taken — Arrival at the Pelly River — The 
 region between Frances Lake and the Pelly — General character of the country 
 and climate — The lower part of the Finlayson — McEvoy Lake — Length and 
 elevation of Finlayson Lake — Fish plentiful — Low and swan. py character of the 
 shores — Distance from the head of the lake to the nearest point on the Pelly — 
 Vegetation in the vicinity of the Pelly — Soil of the river terraces — Quartz vein- 
 stuff everywhere abundant — First camp on the Pelly-- Hoole Caiion — Pelly 
 Range — Identification of Hoole River — Banks and beaches of the Pelly above 
 Hoole River — ^The river at Hoole Canon — Ross River — The Pelly between the 
 caiion and Ross River — Rocks of Hoole Caiion and its vicinity — General course 
 of tr.e Pelly from Ross River to Glenlyon River — Lapie River — Formation of the 
 mountains north and south of the Pelly — Densely wooded character of the 
 northern slopes — Forest growth — Rapids in the vicinity of the Glenlyon — Com- 
 position of rocks between the Ross and Glenlyon — Occurrence of rocks of 
 Laramie or Cretaceous age — Tributary streams — The Pelly below Glenlyon 
 River — Glenlyon Mountains — The Detour — Macmillan River — Coalescence; of 
 the Macmillan and Pelly valleys — Upper part of the Macmillan unexplored — 
 First human beings met with since leaving Dease River — Confluence of the 
 Upper Pelly and Lewes Rivers — The Pelly below the Macmillan — Granite 
 Caiion- Character of the country — The current from Granite Caiion to the 
 coiifluencc. 
 
 WE reached Frances Lake on the morning of the 8th of 
 July, and had we been able to find any local Indians to 
 serve as guides and assist in carrying over our stuff, we should 
 have proceeded at once to the best point for that purpose, and 
 continued our journey overland toward the Pelly. As it was, 
 it became our first object to endeavour to find the trail used 
 many years previously by the Hudson Bay Compay, of which 
 a general description had been furnished by Mr. Campbell. 
 This necessitated a careful examination of the west shore of the 
 west arm to its head, which enabled us to identify, with 
 tolerable certainty, the stream which Campbell had named the 
 Finlayson. It was supposed that the Indians might have 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 331 
 
 employed the same route in the periodical journeys which they 
 were known to make from the Pelly down the Frances to the 
 little tradinff post at the moutn of the Dease ; but thouji;h the 
 remains of an old lo^!; ciu'/ie of the Hudson Bay Company were 
 eventually foimd, together with the nails and ironwork of a 
 large boat which had evidently been burnt on the beach near 
 it, no sign of a trail could be discovered. It thus appeared 
 very doubtful whether we should be able to make our way ;icross 
 to the Pelly, with sufficient provisions and the necessary instru- 
 ments for the continuation of our survey in the Yukon basin. 
 
 In order to exhaust the possibility of obtaining further 
 assistance before making the attempt, I made a light trip in 
 one of 01 r boats round into the east arm; this was knovvu to 
 exist from Campbell's report, but its narrow entrance had 
 not even been observed on our way up the lake. Thus I was 
 enabled to sketch the east arm, but no Indians were found. 
 In fact, we discovered traces of only a single camp which had 
 been made during the same summer, most of the Indian signs 
 being two or more years old. 
 
 All that could now be done was to make the best of 
 our own resources. We went carefully over all our stuff, 
 discarding everj'thing which was not absolutely essential, 
 and making up the remainder in packs, together with as 
 much food as could be carried This done, we stowed a great 
 part of our camp equipage, together with some provisions, in a 
 strong log au/ie, which was constructed for the purpose in 
 the bay immediately south of the mouth of the Finlayson, 
 and moved on the north side of the delta to what we 
 believed to be the best starting-point of that stream. We 
 then hauled out our two boats, and on the 17th and i8th of 
 July carried our remaining stuff to a point some miles up the 
 Finlayson and above the canon and cascades, which render its 
 lower part utterly impassable. Here we set up the Osgood 
 canvas boat, which we had also carried over. Into this a portion 
 of our stuff was put, and two of our Coast Indians were in- 
 structed to endeavour to track it up tlie shallow and winding 
 stream, while the rest of the party found their way as best they 
 could along the valley, with heavy packs. The walking was 
 extremely fatiguing on account of the deep moss, alternating 
 
 H 
 
 V m 
 
 In 
 
 1 
 
 1 
 
 1 i 
 
 1 1 
 
 I ^ ill 
 
 
 1 [r 
 
 in 
 
 li' 
 
 1 
 
 ifr; 
 
 
 '■■'■; 
 
 1* 
 
 ,iii 
 
 i 
 
332 
 
 THE YUKON TEURITORY 
 
 ¥ li 
 
 with brush and swamps, and as the weather was very warm 
 and the mosquitoes innumerable, our rate of profjress was slow. 
 On arriving at the forks of the stream we unfortunately took 
 the wrong branch for several miles, thus losing time, but we 
 eventually reached a lake which we recognized as Finlayson 
 Lake, on July 24th. The canvas boat did not arrive till the 
 evening of the next day ; for we had great difficulty in getting 
 it up the shallow stream, which was badly blocked with fallen 
 trees. In the meantime, observations for latitude and time 
 were taken, and a raft was constructed on which the stuff 
 might be floated to the head of the lake ; the latter lay in the 
 general direction of our route. 
 
 The lake proved to be nine miles and a half in length, and 
 near its head we again found the ruins of a Hudson Bay cache, 
 but no appearance of a trail. Having selected the most 
 promising looking place from which to continue our journey, 
 we took out the raft-sticks, in order that they might remain dry 
 and serviceable for our Indians on their return, and made a 
 second small cAche of provisions. The Osgood boat being 
 almost worn out b)? its hard usage on the Finlayson, and being 
 besides quite too heavy to carry overland in addition to our 
 other stuff, was also drawn up and abandoned. 
 
 Soon after leaving the lake we came upon small streams which 
 evidently drained towards the west, and about noon on the 
 2gth of July we had the satisfaction of reaching the bank of the 
 Felly River. From this place our five Coast Indians were sent 
 back with instructions to take the articles left in the cAchc on 
 PVances Lake to Mr. Reed, at Dease Lake. This duty, we 
 subsequently learned, they faithfully performed. 
 
 Having constructed a canoe from the canvas brought over for 
 that purpose, we began the descent of the Felly on the ist of 
 August. 
 
 Though the region between Frances Lake and the Felly may 
 be described as a mountainous one, no very high summits were 
 seen ; the elevations are, as a rule, rounded and regular in 
 outline, and form broad, plateau-like areas above the timber- 
 line in some places. The Too-tsho Mountains, which run 
 along the east arm of Frances Lake nearly due north, turn more 
 to the westward beyond the head of the lake. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 333 
 
 varm 
 slow. 
 
 took 
 ut we 
 ayson 
 U the 
 ettinf? 
 
 fallen 
 > time 
 e stuff 
 
 in the 
 
 :h, and 
 ^ cache, 
 ; most 
 aurney, 
 ain dry 
 made a 
 ; being 
 id beinf,' 
 to our 
 
 s which 
 on the 
 k of the 
 re sent 
 ache on 
 uty, we 
 
 lover for 
 ic ist of 
 
 Lily may 
 iits were 
 l^ular in 
 timb<;r- 
 Lich run 
 Un more 
 
 It is probable that the general character of the country 
 fairly represents that of a wide belt to the west of the Frances 
 River and north of the Liard, including the Campbell and 
 Simpson Mountains and their vicinity. The mountains are 
 about equal in altitude to those last mentioned, averaging 
 from 5000 to 6000 feet. The country is traversed by wide, 
 wooded valleys ; that occupied by the Finlayson is the princi- 
 pal one. The climate evidently becomes less moist as Frances 
 Lake and the vicinity of the Too-tsho Mountains are left. 
 
 The lower part of the Finlayson for about four miles, near its 
 mouth, forms a series of rapids and small cascades in a narrow, 
 rocky gorge, making in this distance a total descent of 300 feet 
 to the lake. Above this cafion it is rapid for several miles, with 
 gravelly bars, and quite shallow, but further up it becomes a 
 narrow and often deep stream, flowing between muddy or 
 sandy banks. At twenty-two miles from its mouth it divides 
 into two jqual branches ; the northern comes from McEvoy 
 Lake, the southern from Finlayson Lake. Each of these 
 streams, at their confluence, is from twenty-live to thirty feet in 
 average width and about two feet deep. The northern branch, 
 however, soon becomes shallow, rapid and stony, while that 
 coming from Finlayson Lake is extremely crooked, v.inding in 
 all directions in a flat valley about a mile in width, and is 
 besides, as already mentioned, very badly blocked by fallen 
 trees. 
 
 Finlayson Lake {Tle-tlan'-a-tsoots of the Indians) is nine 
 miles and a half in length and irregular in form. Its elevation 
 above sea-level is 3105 feet, and it may be regarded as occupy- 
 ing the summit of the watershed between the Mackenzie and 
 the Yukon, as no stream of any importance enters it. The 
 country about it is all low, but diversified, to some extent, by 
 wooded ridges and hills, which rise highest near its upper end. 
 The water is apparently shallow throughout, and has, in con- 
 sequence, a much higher temperature than that of Frances 
 Lake. It is well stocked with white-fish and lake trout, and 
 also, no doubt, with the other species found in Frances Lake. 
 
 The immediate shores of the lake are generally low and often 
 swampy, and the country is covered with small, poor timber ; 
 much of this has been killed by fire. 
 
 H z 
 
 li 
 
334 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 The distance from the head of the lake to the nearest point 
 on the Pelly, in a straight line, is about fifteen miles, but the 
 low tract of country already referred to runs some miles to the 
 south of such a line for the greater part of the way. The actual 
 watershed in this low country is probably not fifty feet above 
 the lake, but there is no evidence that the lake ever discharges 
 toward the Pelly. Its height above sea-level is about 3150 
 feet. Small streams, rising to the west of the lake, flow 
 together to form a respectable brook about half way across. 
 This occupies a wide, terraced valley, the bordering ridges 
 gradually diverge as the Pelly is approached, and the river 
 itself is bordered by undulating terrace-flats several miles in 
 width. 
 
 On ridges west of the head of Finlayson Lake Abies 
 subalpina becomes moderately abundant, but the white and 
 black spruce are still the characteristic trees, and the former is 
 well grown in sheltered valleys. The vegetation in the vicinity 
 of the Pelly was much further advanced than any we had yet 
 seen, and the climate of the valley is evidently more favourable 
 than that of the watershed region. The soil of the river-terraces 
 is a fine, silty material, which, judging from the luxuriance 
 of plant growth, must be very fertile. 
 
 In consequence of the width of the valleys and the mantle 
 of drift deposits, few rock-exposures were met with along the 
 whole route from Frances Lake to the Pelly. But quartz 
 vein-stuff is everywhere very abundant, and on the terrace 
 overlooking the Finlayson, on the north side, three miles below 
 the lake, a large mass of quartz occurs in places. The extent 
 of this mass of quartz could not be ascertained, as it protruded 
 from the soil only in isolated spots over an area several hundred 
 feet in length and breadth. 
 
 Our first camp on the Pelly was situated in lat. 61° 48' 52", 
 long. 131° 01' 06", the height of the river being at this place, 
 as approximately determined from the mean of a number ^i 
 barometer observations, 2965 feet. The river is here 326 feet 
 wide, with a current slightly exceeding two miles and a half an 
 hour, and a middle depth of seven feet. From explorations 
 made at the time of the existence of the Hudson Hay post, as 
 well as from Indian report, the river is known to be navigable 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 335 
 
 i' 52", 
 
 place, 
 (iber oi 
 26 feet 
 mlf an 
 rations 
 
 ost, as 
 vigable 
 
 by boats for a considerable distance above this point, and to 
 rise in two lakes, the position of which is approximately indi- 
 cated on the map, accordinfj to Mr. Campbell's sketch. Our 
 camp was about two miles above the mouth of the stream which 
 has already been mentioned as rising on the portage near 
 Finlayson Lake, at the angle of the Pelly, the old post named 
 " Felly Banks." We saw no trace of the buildings which 
 formerly existed. 
 
 From the site of our first camp to Hoole Canon, is a dis- 
 tance of thirty-one miles in a straight line ; its direction is 
 a few degrees north of west. The river, however, forms a wide 
 curve to the south of this line, and is tortuous in detail, the 
 actual distance, following its course, being fifty miles. The 
 main orographic river-valley is here not confined between 
 parallel ranges of mountains. There is a wide tract of irregu- 
 larly hilly country, bounded to the south by a well-defined 
 mountain range at a distance of from ten to twelve miles. This 
 range is crowned by a series of square-outlined pyramidal peaks, 
 which are probably composed of stratified rocks. It is proposed 
 to distinguish it as the Pe/// Range. To the northward, no 
 definite boundary to the low hilly region can be seen. The 
 actual trough in which the river meanders is scarcely more than 
 a mile in average width, and is generally bordered by terraces a 
 hundred feet or more in height. 
 
 Thirty-three miles, by the course of the river, below our 
 starting-point, a tributary comes in from the mountains to the 
 southward, about fifty feet wide by one deep, and very rapid. 
 This is identified as Hoole River. Its water is blueish in tint, 
 and clearer than that of the Upper Pelly, which by this time 
 has become slightly turbid from material derived from its soft, 
 silty banks. The river, between our first camp and Hoole River, 
 has a moderate current, scarcely exceeding four miles and a 
 half an hour, though with several little " riffles " or small rapids. 
 
 Just below the mouth of Hoole River is a rapid about 600 
 feet long, with a total fall estimated at about ten feet. There 
 is an easy portage on the right or north bank, but a fair-sized 
 boat might run through without danger at most stages of the 
 water. From this rapid to Hoole Canon the water is swift, and 
 there are several little rapids. 
 
 ii 
 
 i 
 
336 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 i i 
 
 I Til 
 
 The banks and beaches of the Pclly above Hoole River are 
 generally silty or muddy, though the strength of the current is 
 sufficient to produce well-washed gravel-bars in mid-stream. 
 Below that point the banks and beaches are also as a rule 
 gravelly, in conformity with the swifter flow of the stream. 
 
 The banks along the south side of this part of the river are 
 for the most part densely wooded, and where shady and damp 
 the growth of timber is small and scrubby, with much black 
 spruce. The banks on the opposite side above Hoole River 
 show numerous open, grassy patches, and below that place 
 grassy slopes preponderate over the wooded area, the grass 
 having the characteristic growth and dry, tufted appearance of 
 " bunch-grass." The trees are similar to those found along the 
 rivers previously described, except that Pinus Murrayana and 
 larch do not occur, and but a single white birch was noted, 
 near the mouth of Hoole River. 
 
 At Hoole Canon, the river makes a knee-like bend to the 
 north-eastward, and is restricted between rocky banks and 
 cliffs about a hundred feet in height. Yhese render it impractic- 
 able to use the line, and the water is very rough and dangerous. 
 The distance by the river is about three-quarters of a mile, by 
 the portage half a mile, the highest point being one hundred 
 feet above the river. The portage is on the south side of the 
 river, and we found traces on it of skids which had been laid 
 by the Hudson Bay Company many years ago, but no sign 
 that it had been employed by the Indians, who in all this 
 district generally travel by land, making rafts when they are 
 obliged to cross any of the larger rivers. 
 
 Sixteen miles and a half below the canon in a straight line, 
 or twenty-three miles by the course of the Pelly, is the mouth 
 of a river which is identified as the Ross River of Campbell.' 
 This stream, which comes from the north-eastward, is to all 
 appearance equal in volume to the Pelly, having a width of 290 
 feet, with a current of four miles and a half an hour. Its water 
 is turbid and milky, and colder than that of the Pelly, leading 
 to the belief that it is not derived from lakes, like that stream, 
 or that if lakes do occur on its upper waters, they are much less 
 
 ' So named aftir Chief Factor Donald Ross, 
 
it line, 
 mouth 
 ipbell.' 
 to all 
 of 290 
 Is water 
 leading 
 Istream, 
 liich less 
 
 
 O 
 
 cu 
 
 •J 
 y, 
 
 'ji 
 
 o 
 o 
 
 y. 
 
 y. 
 
 4'' 
 
 'H) i 
 
 ft 
 
 I 1 
 
 1: "! 
 
 lI; 
 
 1 i 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 2>Z7 
 
 in area than those of the Pally. Like other streams from that 
 direction, it carries clear, blue, mountain water, and brinjjs 
 down quartzites, argillites and schists of the usual character, 
 tofjether with a {,'reat abundance of quartz-f,'ravel. 
 
 The Pelly, between the canon and Ross River, is swift 
 throughout, with numerous little rapids. To the south of the 
 river there is still a wide extent of low, wooded country between 
 it and the continuous ranp[e before referred to as the Pelly 
 Mountains. To the north the view is more limited, particularly 
 near the mouth of the Ross River, owinf:^ to the existence of a 
 long, steep ridge, parallel to the course of the Pelly, and from 
 600 to 800 feet in height above it. The southern face of this 
 ridge, which is cut through by the Ross River, is more than 
 half, open grass land, and would afford excellent pasturage. 
 
 The rocks of Hoole Canon and its vicinity are chiefly white 
 marble, associated and interbedded with grey and bhiak chert} - 
 looking quartzites, which are often thin-bedded and sometimes 
 rather schistose, and precisely resemble the Cache Creek 
 quartzites of southern Hritish Columbia. 
 
 From the mouth of Ross River to the Glenlyon River, the 
 general course of the Pelly is almost direct, on a bearing of 
 N. 50'^ W., the distance being sixty-four miles. Inconsequence 
 of the number of minor flexures in the stream, this is increased 
 by the river to eighty-two miles. Ten miles below the Ross, 
 following the river, Lapie River,^ sixty feet wide by one foot 
 deep, and resembling in its general character and colour of 
 water Hoole and Ketza Rivers, comes in from the south. 
 Twenty-three miles from the same point a smaller tributary 
 joins from the north, which is supposed to be the Orchay of 
 Campbell. 
 
 All the way from the Ross to the Glenlyon the Pelly is 
 closely bordered on the north by ridges and hills of considerable 
 height, which become mountains of 4000 to over 5000 feet before 
 the last-mentioned stream is reached. These entirely preclude 
 any outlook over the country on that side. To the south, the 
 important and well-marked Pelly Range is continued to a point 
 
 ' This stream was not named by Campbell. I call it Lapie River, after 
 one of his Indians, he having given the name of the other (Ketza) to a 
 neighbouring tributary. 
 
 I! 
 
 
 1 
 
 \ i'ii 
 
 -'r 
 
338 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 6' ... - 
 
 opposite the Orchay River, where it appears to terminate in a 
 group of mountains lower than those of its eastern part, but 
 still from 5000 to 6000 feet in height. The forms of the moun- 
 tains are bold, consisting of steep crests and ridges, with inter- 
 vening narrow gorges, and they appear to be covered with low 
 herbaceous growth, giving them a greenish tint. There are few 
 bare, rocky summits, and the whole appearance is that of a 
 range shaped by normal processes of denudation from schistose 
 or other crumbling rocks of a stratified character and nearly 
 uniform hardness. They still carried a few patches of old snow 
 on the 4th of August. The greater humidity of this part of the 
 valley is particularly marked by the densely wooded character 
 of the slopes on the north side of the river. 
 
 The Pelly, for more than half the distance between the Ross 
 and Glenlyon, continues to be pretty swift, and is much divided 
 among islands and gravel-bars ; the remaining part is compara- 
 tively tranquil, with the exception of the rapids in the immediate 
 vicinity of the Glenlyon. The forest growth throughout is much 
 like that previously described, save that the bircii is now moder- 
 ately abundant, and the black pine {P. Murrayana) appears, 
 coming in first on dry northern slopes thirteen miles eastward from 
 the Glenlyon. Cottonwood, aspen, alder, spruce, and willows are 
 the prevailing trees on the river-flats, which are usually about 
 ten feet above low water level. Frozen soil was again seen in 
 several places along the shady side of this part of the river, 
 extending from about eighteen inches below a mossy and peaty 
 sod to the water level, with a depth of ten feet or more. Some 
 of these banks were being rapidly undercut by the water, which 
 thaws the soil wherever it comes in contact with it, and causes 
 large masses, with the superincumbent sod and trees, to fall 
 into the stream. 
 
 The rapids above alluded to as near the Glenlyon are two in 
 number. The first occurs in an S-shaped bend about two 
 miles east of the Glenljon ; the second just below the mouth 
 of that stream. The uppt r rapid is wide and .rather shallow, 
 with some rocky impediments. It is easily run with a canoe, 
 but at low stages of the river doubtfully passable for a steamer 
 not of light draught. The current in the second rapid strikes 
 full on the face of a rocky bank on the right of the river, and 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 339 
 
 forms a heavy confused wash in consequence, but is otherwise 
 unimpeded and deep. 
 
 The rocks seen along the Pelly, between the Ross and 
 Glenlyon, while resemblinj; in a fjeneral way those previously 
 described, differ in their fjreater alteration and in the evident 
 importance in their composition of products orif,'inally of volcanic 
 origin. The most abundant are blackish-grey and greenish 
 quartzites and schists, often more or less micaceous, and in 
 places passing into true mica-schists. 
 
 The most interesting fact developed on this part of the 
 Pelly is, however, the occurrence of rocks of Laramie or 
 Cretaceous age. These were noted in a singi^ ''>\v exposure 
 on the south side of the river, twenty-seven miks and a half 
 west of the mouth of Ross River. They consist of black car- 
 bonaceous or possibly plumbaginous shale . rathci hard, and 
 interbedded with grey-brown sandstones, the whole dipping 
 near!,' Uie south at an angle of forty-five degrees. Hut this 
 single occurrence of rocks of this character was found, and no 
 rocks are seen for several miles up or down the stream, so that 
 the area characterized by the formation to which they belong 
 is uncertain. 
 
 The total distance, following the course of the river, from the 
 Glenlyon to the Macmillan, is ninety-one miles. The tributary 
 streams in this distance, again measuring by the course of the 
 Pelly, down stream, are as follows : — Glenlyon River, the 
 Earn River of Campbell, and the Tummcl River of Campbell. 
 From this point to the Macmillan no tributary streams were 
 observed, the country to the northward evidently draining 
 toward the last-named stream, and that to the south, at no 
 great distance, being in all probability within the drainage- 
 basin of the Lewes. 
 
 For about twenty miles below the Glenlyon River the Pelly 
 is more than usually free from abrupt bends, and few islands 
 are met with. It is bordered to the south by Glenlyon 
 Mountains, whose higliest points exceed five thousand feet. 
 Lower irregular hiils border the north bank, and these, as 
 usual, show extensive grassy slopes on the southern exposures. 
 At the distance from the Glenlyon just mentioned, the river 
 turns abruptly to the northward, making a sharp bend, and 
 
 WW 
 
340 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 '* 3' 
 
 ■M, 
 
 ,', .i 
 
 cutting completely through the ridge which has previously 
 bounded it on that side. After a sinuous course of about 
 fifteen miles (about midway in which it receives the Earn 
 River), to the north of the ridge, it turns again with equal 
 abruptness to the southward, rounding the west point of the 
 ridge, which here dies away. This peculiar flexure is distin- 
 guished on the map as T/ie Detour. To the south of the ridge 
 is a wide valley, which lies in the general direction of the river, 
 and which doubtless represents a pre-glacial valley of the 
 Pelly, though now apparently floored by drift deposits. The 
 distance from bend to bend of the river, through this disused 
 valley, is eight miles and a half, and the height of its floor 
 above the water-level was estimated at about two hundred feet. 
 As far as the lower end of The Detour the current is swift, and 
 there are a number of little riffles ; some of these might be 
 called rapids, though none are of a character to impede 
 navigation. 
 
 The Macmillan and the Pelly valleys coalesce at an acute 
 angle at the western point of the range of hills which alone has 
 separated them for some distance, and the two streams must 
 run nearly parallel for many miles above their junction. The 
 Macmillan is bordered to the north by a well-defined range of 
 low mountains, which continues to the wertward for about ten 
 miles as the bordering range of the united streams. At the 
 confluence, the Pelly appeared to be somewhat the larger 
 river at the time of our visit, and it is probably so at all 
 properly comparable stages of water. The Macmillan water is 
 much more turbid than that of the Pelly, and of a yellowish 
 colour. The temperature of both rivers was identical on the 
 gth of August, being 54° F. It may probably be assumed 
 from this circumstance that the origin of the rivers is similar, 
 and that the Macmillan, like the Pelly, rises in or flows through 
 considerable lakes, in which the water is warmed to a like 
 extent. The suspended matter of the Macmillan may be 
 entirely due to the washing away of silty banks, which is the 
 usual cause of the turbidity of streams in this district. The 
 upper part of the Macmillan has never been explored, but its 
 size would indicate that it may rise as far to the eastward as the 
 Pelly, and probably, like it, in mountains representing the 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 .341 
 
 western ranges of the Rocky Mountains. We do not, however, 
 know to what extent this river shares with the Stewart the 
 drainage of the comparatively low country to the northward. 
 I afterwards met a couple of miners (Messrs. Monroe and 
 Langtr}) who had ascended the Macmillan for several days in 
 a boat, but, not finding encouraging "prospects," had returned. 
 They reported the existence of a large area of low land with 
 good soil, and had met with no impediments to navigation so 
 far as they had gone. 
 
 Ten miles above the mouth of the Macmillan we encountered 
 a couple of Indians, father and son, working their way up the 
 Pelly with a small dug-out canoe. They were the first human 
 beings we had met with in the country since leaving the mouth 
 of the Dease River, forty-three days previously, but as we were 
 totally unable to communicate with them except by signs, 
 it was impossible to obtain any definite information from 
 them. They were evidently at a loss to know whence we had 
 come, and evinced a peculia" interest in examining our little 
 canvas canoe. 
 
 The range of hills bordering the Pelly on the south, near the 
 mouth of the Macmillan, is composed of granite, which appears 
 in several places on the river. This is of greyish and greenish- 
 grey colours, and similar to that of the Glenlyon Range, though 
 it apparently forms a distinct though parallel granitic axis. 
 
 From the mouth of the Macmillan to the confluence of the 
 Upper Pelly and Lewes Rivers is a distance, in a straight line 
 with a general bearing a few degrees south of west, of forty-six 
 miles. A considerable portion of this part of the river is, 
 however, extremely tortuous. The distance from the Macmillan 
 to the mouth of the Lewes, measured along the course of the 
 stream, is seventy -four miles. 
 
 Four miles below the mouth of th Macmillan, on the north 
 bank, is a small log cabin, the first sign of habitation we had 
 seen. We afterwards ascertained that two miners had Hved 
 here during the winter of 1886-7. At five miles and a half 
 below the Macmillan the Pelly was found to be 754 feet in 
 width, with a current of 2*3 miles per hour ; a few miles below 
 this the river turns south-westward and then nearly due south, 
 entering Granite Canon at thirteen miles from the Macmillan. 
 
 I 
 
 li 
 
 
 1 t;'' 
 
 ! i 
 
 
 I 
 
342 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 
 "U 
 
 mi 
 
 The canon is four miles in length, with steep, rocky, 
 scarped banks and cliffs, 200 to 250 feet in height. In the 
 cafion are several little rapids, but the water is deep, and with 
 the exception of some isolated rocks, the navigation would be 
 quite safe for steamers, even at a low stage of water. As the 
 river is much confined, however, it is probable that rough 
 water may be found here during floods. Just beyond the 
 cafion, or sixteen miles and a half below the Macmillan, a small 
 stream, about ten feet by three inches, enters from the south- 
 eastward. The bed is wide, and it appears at seasons of flood 
 to become a formidable torrent. At thirty-six miles from the 
 Macmillan another small stream was observed on the south 
 side, but with this exception, the river receives no further 
 tributaries before meeting the Lewes. 
 
 After passing the ridge which is cut through by Granite 
 Cafion, the country on both sides of the river for about fifteen 
 miles is quite low. No mountains or high hills are in sight on 
 any bearing to the westward, and wide terraces run far back 
 from the river at heights of 150 to 200 feet above it. These are 
 often lightly wooded, largely with aspen, and are clothed with 
 a good growth of grass, presenting a very attractive appearance. 
 The soil is good, and at the time of our visit the country was 
 very dry. 
 
 For the remaining distance to the mouth of the Lewes, the 
 river is more closely bordered by low hills and ridges, which 
 seldom exceed a height of 400 feet. At one place the stream 
 is confined between high and somewhat rocky banks, but no 
 rapid is met with. The southern slopes of the hills are generally 
 open and grassy, and would afford excellent pasturage. The 
 northern exposures are still thickly wooded. Just above its 
 confluence with the Lewes, the Pelly makes an abrupt turn to 
 the south, and runs for several miles along the eastern base of 
 a scarped cliff of basalt. From Granite Canon to the con- 
 fluence, the current scarcely exceeds two miles and a half an 
 hour. 
 
CHAPTER IX. 
 
 it 
 
 i 
 
 Total length of the Uppur PcUy— Its elevation — Estimated fall in Hoole Canon — 
 Tin; river navigable for stern- wheel steamers— Streams and small rivers fljwin'i 
 into the I'elly— Gravel bars of the Pelly—" Small" and "heavy" colours founu 
 in considerable number — Country about the confluence of the Lewes and Upper 
 I'elly — Temperature of the water — -Ruins of Fort Selkirk — Fort Yukon — Explor- 
 ation of the Upper Liard and Yukon by Mr. Robert Campbell — Campbell's 
 men discouraged by the "Wood Indians " — Fort Selkirk established in 1847-48 
 — Fort Yukon established — The I'elly and Yukon identical — Navigatitin of 'he 
 Liard — The post at I'elly Banks — Dimensions and construction of Fort Selkirk 
 — Its interference with the trade of the Chilkoot and Chilkat Indians — The 
 occupants expelled and the fort pillaged by the Indians — The buildings demo- 
 lished by the local Ind.ians — Fort Yukon maintained till 1869 — The Hudson 
 IJay Company expelled by the United States Government — Abandonment of the 
 fort — I'osts established from Fort Simpson on the Mackenzie to Fort Yukon 
 — Time taken by " returns " to reach the market — Ascent of the 1 ewes and 
 arrival at Lake Lindeman — Ascent of the Yukon by explorers of the Western 
 Union Telegraph Company— Survey of the 1 ewes by Lieutenant Schwalka — 
 Course of the river from Fort Selkirk t(j Rink or Five-finger Rapid — 
 Velocity and width of the river below Rink Rapid — IngersoU Islands — The 
 terraces and llats bordering the river — Character of the river valley — Description 
 of Rink Kapid— Pleasing appearance of the country — lIoo-chee-Roo Bluff — 
 Stratification of the rocks — NordenskiOld River— Little Salmon River — The 
 valley of the Lewes between Rink Rapid and Little Salmon River — Bars worked 
 for gold above the Nordenskiijld — Rock exposures — Coal seams — (leneral bearing 
 of the Lewes from Little Salmon River to the mouth of the Bi^' Salmon or 
 D'Abbadie River — The Seminow Mountains — Particulars respecting the Big 
 Salmon River — " Fine " gold found all along the river. 
 
 THE total length of the Upper Pelly, following the course of 
 the river, from the point where we first reached it at the 
 west end of the Campbell's Portage to its confluence with the 
 Lewes, is 320 miles. The elevation at the first-mentioned point 
 is about 2965 feet, that at the confluence 1555 feet, giving a total 
 fall of 1410 feet, or 4*4 feet to the mile, a considerable portion 
 of which, however, occurs in the numerous little rapids and 
 riffles of its course. In Hoole Canon the estimated fall is about 
 twenty fe- 1. 
 
 Wii.11 tne exception of Granite Canon, where warping might 
 have to be resorted to at one place, the river would be easily 
 navigable for stern-wheel steamers so far up as the mouth of 
 
 ^■;i|j 
 
 -: ti 
 
 
 m 
 
 n 
 
 \ h 
 
344 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 the Macmillan, and the latter stream is also navif,'able for a 
 considerable though unknown distance. Above the Macmillan, 
 I believe, no serious difficulty would be met with in takinj^ a 
 small stern-wheel steamer of good power up to the mouth of 
 the Ross River, and possibly as far as the foot of Hoole Canon. 
 A line might have to be carried ashore at a few of the stronger 
 rapids, but the chief difficulty to be encountered would be from 
 shoal water at low stages. Where the river is widely spread 
 and swift, a depth of three feet could scarcely be found across 
 some of the gravelly bars. The Ross River is a navigable 
 stream at its mouth, but its upper part is quite unknown. 
 Hoole Canon is, of course, quite impassable for a steamer of 
 any kind, and the rapid seventeen miles east of it, at the 
 mouth of Hoole River, might prove to be a diff.cult one to 
 surmount by warping, as its fall is estimated at about eight 
 feet. Above this point, the river is again, however, an easily 
 navigable one for small steamers to the furthest point seen by 
 us, and possibly so far as the lakes. 
 
 All the streams and small rivers flowing into the Pelly from 
 the south and rising in or beyond the Pelly and Glenlyon 
 Mountains, are notabl \ swift, and most of them are evidently 
 subject to heavy freshets. 
 
 On the lower part of the Upper Pelly there are numerous 
 groves on or not far from the banks, with good spruce up to two 
 feet in diameter. Spruce of the same size is found also on the 
 whole upper part of the river, but is relatively less abundant 
 there. 
 
 As in the case of the Upper Liard and Frances Rivers, quartz 
 derived from veins is an abundant constituent of the gravel-bars 
 of the Pelly, and numerous small quartz veins were observed in 
 the rocks in many places. Where the granites are approached, 
 the veins cut all the rocks except these, and it appears that 
 the development of the quartz veins is due to the same 
 period of disturbance which has given rise to the uplift of 
 the granite axes or I heir extrusion. Small "colours" of gold 
 may be found in almost any suitable locdlity along the river, 
 and "heavy colours," in considerable number, were found by us 
 as far up as the mouth of Hoole River, in the bottom of a 
 gravel-bed there resting on the basalt. The river has been 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 345 
 
 quartz 
 |-el-bars 
 irved in 
 jached, 
 rs that 
 same 
 plift of 
 |of gold 
 river, 
 |d by us 
 of a 
 Ls been 
 
 prospected to some extent by a few miners, but no mining of 
 importance has yet been done on it. 
 
 The country about the confluence of the Lewes and Upper 
 Pelly is generally speaking low, with extensive terrace-flats 
 running back to the bases of rounded hills and ridges, of which 
 none in sight probably exceed looo feet above the river. The 
 moderate current which has been described as characteristic of 
 the Upper Pelly for some distance above the confluence, con- 
 tinues to its mouth, but the Lewes is much swifter, and though 
 at the point of junction divided among wooded islands, is 
 evidently the larger stream, carrying a volume of water 
 considerably greater than that of the Pelly, though probably 
 less than twice as great. It does not, however, necessarily 
 follow from this that the Lewes is to be considered the principal 
 head stream or continuation of the Yukon. 
 
 The water of the Lewes is of a bluish, slightly milky cast, and 
 is easily distinguished from the brownish muddy colour by 
 which the Pelly is characterized below its junction with the 
 Macmillan. The temperature of the water in both rivers was 
 found to be practically identical, on the 17th and i8th of August, 
 at 7 p.m., being 59° F. 
 
 The river below the confluence of the Pelly and Lewes averages 
 about a quarter of a mile in width, and though its appear- 
 ance is placid and there is no rough water, it is uniformly swift. 
 Of this width about two-thirds had an average depth often feet, 
 with a surface velocity of four miles and three-quarters an hour. 
 
 The ruins of Fort Selkirk, formerly a post of the Hudson Bay 
 Company, stand on a partly open flat, on the south side, at a 
 short distance back from the river, and about a mile and a half 
 below the confluence of the Pelly and Lewes. One chimney, 
 built of basalt blocks which must have been brought across the 
 river, and ccmcmeu svith clay which has been baked almost 
 .to brick by the combustion of the ruins of the fort, still stands 
 erect and uninjured. The lower part of a second is near it, 
 and the fragments of several others strew the ground, which is 
 partly overgrown by small aspens. These, and the traces of a 
 couple of excavations which have probably been cellars, are all 
 that now remain to mark the site of the buildings which were 
 pillciged by Indians from the coast in 1852. 
 
 ' .1 
 
 lip 
 
 m 
 
 : 1 
 
 
 s 
 
346 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 Fort Selkirk, of which the ruins alone now exist, was at one 
 time the most important post of the Hudson Bay Company to 
 the west of the Rocky Mountains in the far north, and with 
 the exception of Fort Yukon, it was the farthest permanent 
 post ever maintained by the Company to the north-west. 
 
 Mr. J. McLeod appears, in the same year in which he 
 reached the Stikine (1834), to have ascended the Liard as far as 
 Simpson Lake, and to have brought back the information 
 according to which the river was represented on Arrowsmith's 
 map of 1850. It was owing to the energy of Mr. Robert 
 Campbell, however, that the exploration of the Upper Liard and 
 Yukon is almost entirely due. The only published account of 
 Mr. Campbell's work, so far as I know, is that which appeared 
 in the Royal Reader, Fifth Book, Toronto, 1883, p. 435, and 
 which was reprinted, with slight alterations at Winnipeg in 
 1885, as a small pamphlet entitled " Discovery and Exploration 
 of the Youcon (Pelly) River." From this source and from 
 additional facts furnished by Mr. Campbell in answer to 
 questions addressed to him, as well as from allusions in the 
 unpublished journals of Chief Factor James Anderson, the 
 following brief account is drawn up. 
 
 After the abandonment of Dease Lake post in 1839, Mr. 
 Campbell was, in the spring of 1840, commissioned by Sir 
 George Simpson to explore the " north branch " of the Liard 
 to its source, and to cross the height-of-land in search of any 
 river flowing to the westward, especially the head-waters of the 
 Colville, the mouth of which on the Arctic Ocean had recently 
 been discovered by Messrs. Dease and Simpson. 
 
 Mr. Campbell writes : — " In pursuance of these instructions, 
 I left Fort Halkett [on the lower Liard] in May, with a canoe 
 and seven men, among them my trusty Indians, Lapie and 
 Kitza, and the interpreter, Hoole. After ascending the stream 
 some hundreds of miles, far into the mountains, we entered a 
 beautiful lake, which I i amed Frances Lake, in honour of Lady 
 Simpson. . . . Leaving the canoe and part of the crew 
 near the south-west [sic] extremity of this [the west] branch of 
 the lake, I set out with three Indians and the interpreter. 
 Shouldering our blankets and guns, we ascended the valley of a 
 river, which we traced to its source in a lake ten miles long, 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 347 
 
 it one 
 any to 
 d with 
 nanent 
 
 lich he 
 s far as 
 rmation 
 smith's 
 Robert 
 lard and 
 :ount of 
 ppeared 
 «5. and 
 iiipeg in 
 Dloration 
 .nd from 
 iswer to 
 s in the 
 son, the 
 
 839, Mr. 
 by Sir 
 he Liard 
 [h of any 
 ;rs of the 
 recently 
 
 Itructions, 
 a canoe 
 |.apie and 
 [ie stream 
 Entered a 
 of Lady 
 Ithe crew 
 aranch of 
 Iterpreter. 
 lalley of a 
 liles long, 
 
 which, with the river, I named Finlayson's Lake and River." 
 From this point, Mr. Campbell struck across to the Pelly, which 
 he then named in honour of Sir H. Pelly, a Governor of the 
 Company. 
 
 During Campbell's absence the remainder of the party built 
 a house at the point between the two arms of the lake, which 
 was then named " Glenlyon House," but was afterwards known 
 as Frances Lake House or Fort Frances. Returning down the 
 river, they met a trading outfit which had been despatched for 
 them, at Fort Halkett, and turned back with it to Frances 
 Lake, after sending out a report of their proceedings. 
 
 The Company now resolved to follow up those western 
 discoveries, and in 1842 birch bark, for the construction of a 
 large canoe to be used in exploring the Pelly, was sent up from 
 Fort Liard. In the same year Fort Pelly Banks was con- 
 structed, or its construction begun, and early in June, 1843, 
 Campbell left that place in the canoe which had been made, 
 accompanied by Hoole, two French-Canadians and three 
 Indians. 
 
 They saw only one family of Indians (" Knife Indians ") till 
 they reached the mouth of the river which Campbell called the 
 Lewes. Here was a large camp of " Wood Indians," and these, 
 after recovering from their surprise at the sight of the party, so 
 discouraged Campbell's men by their stories of the number 
 and ferocity of the people on the lower river, that he was 
 obliged to turn back. 
 
 For some years afterwards the operations of the Company 
 did not extend beyond " Pelly Banks," though during the 
 summer, hunting parties were sent down the Pelly to collect 
 provisions, and in that way information was received respecting 
 the river and the Indians inhabiting its vicinity. 
 
 In the winter of 1847-48 boats were built at Pelly Banks, and 
 early in June following Campbell set out to establish a fort at 
 the confluence of the Pelly and Lewes Rivers. This was named 
 Fort Selkirk, and was at first situated on the extreme point of 
 land between the two rivers, but this point being found subject 
 to floods during the disruption of the ice, the post was in the 
 spring of 1852 moved to a site a short way below >hc mouth of 
 the Lewes, on the left bank. The inner work of the new 
 
 I 2 
 
 iliii 
 
 n 
 
 i i] 
 
& i ^ 
 
 1 
 
 
 i i 
 1 
 
 ij: 1 
 
 i 1 
 
 1 
 
 i 
 
 :| 
 
 i 
 1 
 
 i 
 
 mil 
 
 • 1 
 
 II 
 
 
 ihi 
 
 1 
 
 1 I 
 
 i nil > 
 
 Hi 1 
 
 i 
 
 ^^Bl 
 
 348 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 buildings was still unfinished at the time of the Indian raid, 
 noticed further on. 
 
 Meanwhile an entry was being made into the Yukon basin 
 from another direction. Mr. J. Bell had already in 1842 
 reached the Porcupine or Rat River, and had descended it for 
 three days' journey. He was in 1846 in charge of the Hudson 
 Bay post on Peel River, near the mouth of the Mackenzie, and 
 was instructed again to cross the mountains and to further 
 explore the Porcupine River. In pursuance of these instruc- 
 tions, he in that year reached the mouth of the Porcupine 
 and saw the great river into which it flows, which the Indians 
 informed him was named the Yukon. In 1847 Fort Yukon 
 was established at the mouth of the Porcupine by Mr. A. H. 
 Murray. 
 
 It still remained, however, for Campbell, in 1850, to prove 
 that the Pelly and Yukon were identical. This he did by 
 descending the river from Fort Selkirk to Fort Yukon, after 
 which he ascended the Porcupine, crossed the mountain-portage, 
 and returned to Fort Simpson by the Mackenzie.' One result 
 of this journey was to show that the route from Fort Selkirk by 
 way of the Porcupine River to the Mackenzie was preferable 
 to that originally discovered. The navigation of the Liard was 
 both arduous and dangerous, and several lives had been lost in 
 boating on that stream. Added to this was the length of the 
 land transport from Frances Lake to the Upper Pelly and the 
 fact that great difficulty had been found in maintaining the 
 posts in that district. 
 
 ' Mr. Campbell states that when again on his w.-.y down the river from 
 Fort Selkirk to Fort Yukon, in 1851, he found that a great number of the 
 Indians had been carried off during the previous winter by some virulent 
 disease. 
 
 He has further informed me, in answer to my inquiries on the subject, 
 that the Stewart River was so named after his 'dear and gallant friend and 
 assistant-clerk, James G. Stewart, son of the late Hon. John Stewart, of 
 Quebec." Stewart was sent out in the winter of 1849 to follow the Indian 
 hunters in quest of meat. He found them some distance north of this river, 
 which he crossed on the ice. 
 
 White River, Mr. Campbell named on account of its milky colour. Of 
 the other streams entering between Forts Selkirk and Yukon he says, 
 "Antoine River" was named after the intcipreter at one time at Fort 
 Yukon, a son of his interpreter Hoolc ; " Forcier River,'' after his guide, 
 Baptistc Fortier ; " Lolique River," for Forcier's wife ; and " Ayonie's 
 River," below the White River, was named after the natives of that quarter 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 149 
 
 raid, 
 
 basin 
 1 1842 
 1 it for 
 ludson . 
 ie, and 
 further 
 nstruc- 
 rciipine 
 Indians 
 
 Yukon 
 r. A. H. 
 
 o prove 
 did by 
 jn, after 
 -portage, 
 lie result 
 elkirk by 
 •referable 
 iard was 
 n lost in 
 1 of the 
 and the 
 ning the 
 
 iver from 
 iber of the 
 nc virulent 
 
 lie subject, 
 friend and 
 tewcart, ot 
 the Indian 
 f this river, 
 
 colour. Of 
 n he says, 
 ne at Fort 
 his guide, 
 " Ayonie's 
 hat quarter 
 
 In 1849, the post at Pelly Banks, with the exception of the 
 men's house, was accidentally burnt. In 1850 it was finally 
 abandoned, and in the spring of 1851 Fort Frances was like- 
 wise abandoned.' The abandonment of these posts was not 
 due to any hostility of the natives, who were on the contrary- 
 most friendly, but in consequence of the circumstances above 
 noted, and the fact that while these establishments were 
 very expensive to maintain, they merely bought furs which 
 would otherwise have been carried by the Indians themselves to 
 other posts, if these particular, and to them more convenient 
 ones, had not been in existence. 
 
 The several ruined chimneys of Fort Selkirk still to be seen, 
 with other traces on the ground, arc in themselves evidence of 
 the important dimensions and careful construction of this post. 
 The establishment consisted, I believe, in 1852, of one senior 
 and one junior clerk and eight men. The existence of this post 
 in the centre of the inland or " Wood Indian " country had, 
 however, very seriously interfered with a lucrative and usurious 
 trade which the Chilkoot and Chilkat Indians of Lynn Canal, 
 on the coast, had long been accustomed to carry on wi*h these 
 people ; acting as intermediaries between them and the white 
 traders on the Pacific and holding the passes at the head- 
 waters of the Lewes with all the spirit of robber barons of old. 
 In 1852, rumours were current that these people meditated a 
 raid upon the post, in consequence of which the friendly local 
 Indians stayed by it nearly all summer, of their own accord. It 
 so happened, however, that they absented themselves for a 
 couple of days, and at that unlucky moment the Coast Indians 
 arrived. The post was unguarded by a stockade, and, yielding 
 to sheer force of numbers, the occupants were expelled and the 
 place was pillaged, on the 21st of August. Two days afterward 
 Campbell, having found the local Indians, returned with them 
 and surrounded the post, but the robbers had flown. Being 
 now without means of support for the winter, Campbell set off 
 down stream to meet Mr. Stenart and the men who were on 
 the way back from Fort Yukon. He met them at the mouth of 
 
 ' Forts Frances and Pelly Banks are erroneously stated in Dall's "Alaska 
 and its Resources," to have been burnt and pillaged, p. 115, foot-note and 
 p. 508. 
 
350 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 f 
 
 V 
 
 1 ■ ' ffl 
 
 I'S; l!':l 1- 
 
 m i 
 
 White River, and after turning them back with instructions to 
 arrange for wintering at Fort Yukon, set out himself in a small 
 canoe up the Pelly River, crossed to Frances Lake, descended 
 the Liard and arrived at Fort Simpson with the tidings of the 
 disaster, amid drifting ice, on the 21st of October. 
 
 Being anxious to obtain Sir George Simpson's permission to 
 re-establish Fort Selkirk, Campbell waited only till the river 
 froze, when he left Fort Simpson on snow-shoes and travelled 
 overland to Crow Wing in Minnesota, where he arrived on the 
 13th of March. On the i8th of April he reached London, but 
 was unable to obtain from the directors of the company the 
 permission he desired. A short account of this remarkable 
 journey appeared in the Perthshire Advertiser and Inverness 
 Courier, but I do not know the precise date of the publication. 
 
 In the autumn of 1853, one of Campbell's hunters arrived at 
 Fort Halkett on the Lower Liard by way of the Pelly and 
 Frances. This is the last traverse of Campbell's Portage of 
 which I can find any record, though it may doubtless have been 
 used by the Indians subsequently. From this man it was learnt 
 that the buildings at Fort Selkirk had been all but demolished 
 by the local Indians for the purpose of getting the ironwork 
 and the nails. He also stated that the Chilkats, being unable 
 to carry away all their plunder in the preceding year, had taken 
 merely the guns, powder and tobacco. They had cached the 
 heavier goods, which were afterwards found and appropriated 
 by the local or wood Indians. At a later date the ruins of the 
 post must have been burnt, as their present appearance indicates.' 
 
 Fort Yukon, at the mouth of the Porcupine, was continuously 
 maintained till i86g, when the Hudson Bay Company was 
 expelled by the United States Government as represented by 
 Capt. Charles W. Raymond, Corps of Engineers, U.S. Army; 
 he having ascertained by astronomical observations that the 
 post was situated to the west of the 141st meridian. He 
 describes his proceedings as follows. — "On the 9th of August, 
 at 12 noon, I notified the representative of the Hudson Bay Com- 
 pany that the station is in the territory of the United States ; that 
 
 ' Of Reid House, shown on Arrowsmith's map of 1854, near the Stewart 
 River and to the north of Fort Selkirk, I have been unable to learn any- 
 thing. Mr. Campbell never heard of it, and if it had any existence it was 
 probably a temporary outpost of Fort Yukon. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 351 
 
 the introduction of trading goods, or any trade by foreigners 
 with the natives, is illegal, and must cease ; and that the 
 Hudson Bay Company must vacate the buildings as soon as 
 practicable. I then took possession of the buildings and raised 
 the flag of the United States over the fort.'" The fort was 
 afterwards abandoned and allowed to go to ruin. 
 
 The utmost credit must be accorded to the pioneers of the 
 Hudson Bay Company for the enterprise displayed by them in 
 carrying their trade into the Yukon basin in the face of 
 difficulties so great and at such an immense distance from their 
 base of supplies. To explorations of this kind performed in the 
 service of commerce, unostentatiously and as matters of simple 
 duty by such men as Mackenzie, Fraser, Thompson, and 
 Campbell, we owe the discovery of our great north-west 
 country. Their journeys were not marked by incidents of 
 conflict or bloodshed, but were accomplished on the contrary 
 with the friendly assistance and co-operation of the natives. 
 Less resolute men would scarcely have entertained the idea of 
 utilizing, as an avenue of trade, a river so perilous of navigation 
 as the Liard had proved to be when explored. So long, how- 
 ever, as this appeared to be the most practicable route to the 
 country beyond the mountains, its abandonment was not even 
 contemplated. Neither distance nor danger appears to have 
 been taken into account, and in spite of every obstacle a way 
 was opened and a series of posts established extending from 
 Fort Simpson, on the Mackenzie, to Fort Yukon. Fort 
 Simpson may itself be regarded, even at the present day, as a 
 post very far removed from the borders of civilization, but this 
 further route, which nearly half a century ago became familiar 
 to the Company's voyageurs, stretched out beyond it for over a 
 thousand miles. Mr. James Anderson, in 1853, writes thus of 
 the Liard River : " You can hardly conceive the intense horror 
 the men have to go up to Frances Lake. They invariably on 
 re-hiring endeavour to be exempted from the West Branch 
 [Liard]. The number of deaths which have occurred there is 
 fourteen, viz. three in connection with Dease Lake and eleven 
 in connection with Frances Lake and Pelly Banks, of these 
 last three died from starvation and eight from drowning." 
 ' Report of a Reconnaissance of the Yukon River, 1871, p. 16. 
 
 rhtf 
 
 ! I- 
 
:>52 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 At the time of the establishment of Forts Yukon and Selkirk, 
 and for many years afterwards, the " returns " from the furthest 
 stations reached the market only after seven years, the course 
 of trade beinj,' as follows : Goods. — ist year, reach York Factory ; 
 2nd year, Norway House ; 3rd year. Peel River, and were 
 hauled during; the winter across the mountains to La Pierre's 
 House ; 4th year, reach F"ort Yukon. Returns. — 5th year, reach 
 La Pierre's House and are hauled across to Peel River ; 6th 
 year, reach depot at Fort Simpson ; 7th year, reach market. 
 
 We left the confluence and began the ascent of the Lewes 
 on the i8th of August, and arrived at Lake Lindeman, where 
 the portage to the coast begins, on September i6th. We were 
 during this time on the one travelled route of the country, and 
 every few days fell in with small parties of miners, generally on 
 their way out, up the river. A few men were still found 
 working on bars, and six or eight passed down stream with the 
 purpose of wintering at or near Forty-mile Creek. 
 
 The Lewes River was discovered and named by Mr. Camp- 
 bell in 1842, as already stated. It is indicated in an approximate 
 manner, according to information supplied by this gentleman, 
 on Arrowsmith's map of 1854. Mr. Campbell informs me that 
 he was well aware of the existence at its head of a portage to 
 the sea by which the Chilkat Indians came inland to trade. 
 This route he had the intention of exploring, but the question 
 of supplies and other difficulties prevented him from doing so. 
 Communication was occasionally had by this route with the 
 Hudson Bay steamer which traded along the coast, and it was 
 thus that the Honolulu paper mentioned as received in 1848 by 
 Sir J. Richardson, on the Mackenzie, was sent inland. Such 
 communication was, however, only accomplished by travelling 
 parties of Indians. 
 
 In 1867, explorers in the employ of the Western Union Tele- 
 graph Company ascended the Pelly or Yukon from Fort Yukon 
 to the mouth of the Lewes, returning down the river. In the same 
 year another explorer of the Telegraph Company reached the 
 Hotolinqu (of Telegraph Survey map, not the river subsequently 
 so called by miners), which is now known to be one of the 
 furthest if not the most remote source of the Lewes. This he 
 did from the direction of the Stikine, but was recalled before 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 353 
 
 Tele- 
 Yukon 
 le same 
 led the 
 uently 
 of the 
 his he 
 before 
 
 he had, by descendinpj the river, proved its relation to the 
 Lewes. 
 
 The head-quarters of the Lewes River were first reached from 
 the head of Lynn Canal about 1878. Between the date of the 
 explorations of the Telegraph Company and this time, the 
 Lewes may have been visited by traders ascending from the 
 Lower Yukon, but of this we have no record. Previous to 1883, 
 however, the river and some of its tributaries had become 
 well known to a number of miners and prospectors, and when 
 Lieutenant Schwatka, in the last-mentioned year, crossed the 
 Chilkoot Pass and descended the Lewes, he merely followed in 
 their footsteps. To Lieutenant Schwatka is, however, due the 
 credit of having made the first survey of the river, a survey 
 which Mr. Ogilvie's work of 1887 has proved to be a reason- 
 ably accurate one, in so far as its main features are con- 
 cerned. 
 
 While the general course of the Upper Pelly is remarkably 
 straight, that of the Lewes makes several important and well- 
 marked bends, and is besides interrupted by lakes, and other- 
 wise irregular. 
 
 From the site of Fort Selkirk to Rink or Five-finger Rapid, 
 the course of the river is nearly straight, the bearing being 
 about S. 50° W., and the distance, measured by the stream, 
 fifty-five miles. The current of this part of the river is swift 
 throughout, averaging about four miles and a half an hour and 
 seldom being under four miles. At a point six miles below 
 Rink Rapid, where the course of the river was uninterrupted by 
 islands, and its velocity and width about normal, the rate of 
 flow was found to be 4*8 miles per hour, the width 732 feet. 
 There are numerous islands, which differ from most of those 
 met with on the Pelly in frequently occupying positions in mid- 
 channel instead of being merely portions of river-flats cut off" by 
 lateral sloughs. A few miles above the mouth of the Lewes, 
 these islands are particularly numerous for a distance of about 
 five miles, and the total width of the stream from bank to bank 
 is increased to nearly a mile. This group has been named 
 IngersoU Islands by Schwatka. 
 
 The terraces and flats immediately bordering the river are at 
 first quite low, but in ascending, increase in height till they 
 
 I t, 
 1 i. 
 
 I ■ ■ ^^ 
 
354 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 stand often at loo to 200 feet above it before reaching Rink 
 Rapid. 
 
 The river valley is generally wide and somewhat ill-defined, 
 the ridges and low hills bounding it seldom exceeding 1000 feet 
 in height. Near the mouth of the river these are irregularly 
 disposed, but further up, those on the north-east bank become 
 more uniform and run parallel to the stream like the hills on 
 that part of the Pelly near the Macmillan. 
 
 Two miles below Rink Rapid the Lewes makes a right-angled 
 bend to the south-westward. The rapid itself is caused by the 
 occurrence of several bold rocky islands which obstruct the 
 river, and is only a few yards in length where the water flows 
 swiftly between them. The channels are deep and un- 
 obstructed, and at low stages of water might, I believe, be 
 ascended by a steamer of good power even without the assis- 
 tance of warping. At high-water this rapid would, of course, 
 be more formidable, as the velocity of the stream would be 
 increased. It is pretty evident that a fall has at one time 
 existed here, but the barrier of conglomerate which has pro- 
 duced it has now been cut con.pletcly through by the river. 
 Below the main rapid there is a second " riffle " or minor rapid 
 which appears to be somewhat stony, but which would not be a 
 serious impediment to a properly constructed steamer. 
 
 The general, appearance of the country along this part of 
 the river is pleasing, and resembles that of the correspondinfr 
 part of the Pelly. It is usually wooded, but the southern 
 exposures of some of the hills are partly open, and dry, grass- 
 covt red terrace-flats are frequent. The trees are of the same 
 specji s before mentioned, and birch is moderately abundant. 
 
 For about twelve miles above the Hoo-chee-koo Bluff no 
 rocks were seen, after which, for eight miles, or to Rink Rapid, 
 there are frequent exposures of rocks of a different series, of 
 much less altered appearance, and all probably referable to the 
 Cretaceous. These include coarse, hard, dark, grauvvacke- 
 sandstones, with softer shaly sandstones, passing into dark 
 sandy shales, all more or less calcareous. 
 
 The rock of the islands and banks of the actual rapid is coarse 
 conglomerate which often contains boulders of granite up to 
 eighteen inches in diameter, and is interstratified with irregular 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 355 
 
 beds of yellowish sandstone, the appearance of the conglomerate 
 being much like that of the conglomerate of Jackass Mountain 
 on the Fraser River, though somewhat less altered. Imme- 
 diately above the rapid, on the south-east side of the river, 
 grey and blackish shales, with thin beds of sandstone and of 
 limestone, appear from below the conglomerates. These were 
 found to contain fossils in considerable abundance, though 
 representing but a few species. 
 
 Quartz vein-stuff is much less important as a constituent of 
 the river-gravel? than it is on the Upper Pelly, Upper Liard, 
 and other streams to the eastward. 
 
 From Rink Rapid to the mouth of the Nordenskiold the 
 general bearing of the river is nearly due south, the distance in 
 a straight line being twelve miles. 
 
 The Nordenskiold is a small swift river with clear bluish 
 water, which enters the Lewes on the west side. It was 
 estimated as eighty feet wide by six inches deep, a couple of 
 hundred yards above its mouth. Its vallev is not a wide or 
 important one, it being in fact difficult to decide from which 
 direction the stream comes a few miles back from the Lewes. 
 The Little Salmon (or Daly, as re-christened by Schwatka) 
 joins the Lewes on the opposite side, and was estimated to 
 carry about twice as much water as the Nordenskiold. It is 
 about one hundred feet wide, with an average depth of three 
 feet. The water is clear and brownish in tint, and the current 
 not rapid at the mouth. 
 
 The valley of the Lewes, between Rink Rapid and the Little 
 Salmon River, is in general somewhat irregular and not very 
 wide, and no mountains are in sight from this part of the 
 river. Terraces rising to 20c feet are frequent, and often run 
 back at about that level to the bases of the hills. Near the 
 mouth of the Nordenskiiild the river is extremely crooked, 
 and the current is everywhere swift. The southern slopes of 
 the hills and terraces are generally in large part open and 
 grassy, no difference such as might indicate a climate more 
 humid than that of the region about old Fort Selkirk being met 
 with. Several magpies were seen, for the first time, on this part 
 of the river. 
 
 The first spot observed by us in ascending the river where 
 
 
356 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 '/ 
 
 t 
 
 bars have been worked for gold, is situated six miles above the 
 Nordenskiold. 
 
 The rocks along this portion of the river, like those last 
 described, belong to the Cretaceous series, but their attitudes 
 are too varied to enable anything like a complete section to be 
 gained from the isolated exposures met with. A few localities, 
 however, show features worthy of special mention. 
 
 One of these is found five miles and a half above Rink 
 Rapid, where a high bluff shows a series principally composed 
 of sandstones, shales and shaly clays. This exposure includes, 
 within sixty feet of the base of the bluff, at least three coaly 
 beds, of which the lowest is about three feet thick. This 
 and the other beds contain some good-looking coal, of which a 
 thickness of abjut a foot sometimes occurs, but the greater 
 part of the material is so sandy and impure as to be use- 
 less. 
 
 The condition of all the beds in this vicinity is remarkably 
 unaltered, as compared with those seen lower down the river, 
 and would appear to show that if (as assumed) they form a 
 connected series, th'^'^e lepresent its upper part. 
 
 The thin coal-seams here actually seen cannot be considered 
 as of economic value, but are important as indicating the exis- 
 tence of a coal-bearing horizon which may prove to contain 
 thicker beds elsewhere, and might become an important point 
 in connection with the navigation of the river. The coal has 
 been examined by Mr. G. C. Hoffmann, who describes it as a 
 lignite-coal, with the following composition : — 
 
 m.'' 
 
 Hygroscopic water 
 Volatile combustible matter 
 Fixed Carbon . 
 
 Ash 
 
 603 
 36'92 
 4903 
 
 8 '02 
 
 1 0000 
 
 From the Little Salmon to the mouth of the Big Salmon 
 River or D'Abbadio, the general bearing of the Lewes is about 
 east-south-east, and the sinuosities of the river are not nearly 
 so great as in the portion last described. The distance by the 
 stream between these tributaries is thirty- four miles. A con- 
 siderable portion of this part of the river is not so swift as 
 
? r'l 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 357 
 
 usual, and for eight or ten miles, midway between the Little 
 and Big Salmon Rivers, both the river and its valley are more 
 than usually narrowed. Beyond this, the valley begins to widen 
 rapidly, and, for some miles before the mouth of the Big Salmon 
 is reached, is notably wide between the bases of the limiting 
 hills. At the mouth of the Big Salmon, the Lewes turns 
 abruptly to the south, while the main valley is continued in a 
 south-easterly direction, becoming there the valley of the Big 
 Salmon. From the confluence of the rivers, the main valley 
 can be seen running on for a distance of about fifteen miles, 
 bordered by low hills to the northward, and by higher hills to 
 the south. These last are the Sominow Mountains of Schwatki. 
 The Lewes cuts through this range, which is continued also for 
 some miles westward, forming the south-west side of the Lewes 
 valley. The hiUs are rounded in form and wooded, and rise to 
 heights of 1500 to 2000 feet above the river. 
 
 Several bars which had been worked on for gold were seen 
 along the Lewes, below the confluence of the Big Salmon. 
 
 The Big Salmon ' has been re-named by Schwatka the 
 D'Abbadie River a name which has the merit of being more 
 distinctive than that previously in use, but the miners, who 
 (with the exception of the Indians) alone travel through the 
 country, refuse to know it by any but the old name. It is much 
 more important than any of the tributaries joining the Lewes 
 further down, being 347 feet wide, with a depth of five feet for 
 about one-third of its width, and a current of about two miles 
 an hour. The water is clear and of a bluer tint than that of the 
 Little Salmon, and the discharge was estimated at 272G cubic 
 feet per second, when probably rather below its mean stage. 
 It might, no doubt, be navigated by a small stern-wheel steamer 
 for many miles. 
 
 I was afterward so fortunate as to meet a party of four 
 miners who had spent a part of the summer of I1SM7 in 
 prospecting this stream, and from one of them, Mr. John 
 McCormack, obtained some particulars respecting it, together 
 with a sketch of its course. Thirty-two miles from the Lewes, 
 the Big Salmon is said to be joined by a smaller stream, which 
 McCormack calls the North Fork. I'or about a mile and a half 
 
 I 
 
 
 !:i 
 
 lb 
 
 hi 
 
 1,'ri 
 
 Ta-tlin-hl-ni of the Tu^ish. 
 
358 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ilV 
 
 V/ 
 
 below and a short distance above the mouth of this branch 
 the river is very rocky and rapid. Half a mile above it there 
 is an Indian salmon fishing place. For some distance beyond 
 this the river is sluggish, and at sixty-six miles from the Lewes 
 the South Fork branches off. This fork occupies a wide valley 
 and comes from the south-eastward. Above it the water is 
 swifter and the valley of the river is narrow, with high 
 mountains on both sides, but particularly on the north. 
 Granite and mica-schist were seen along this part of the river. 
 At a supposed distance of one hundred and five miles from the 
 Lewes, another stream joins from the south-east, and this also 
 occupies an important valley, though not so wide as that of the 
 South Fork. Above this point the river turns to a northerly 
 bearing for about fifteen miles, the current being, in general, 
 slack. It then reverts to an easterly bearing, and after passing 
 a rapid, at one place, Island Lake is reached at igo miles from 
 the Lewes. This lake is four miles long, and has two arms at 
 its upper end, from the southern of which a river leads, in eight 
 miles, to a second lake two miles and a half long. A stretch of 
 river, a mile and a half long, joins this to the highest lake, 
 which McCormack named Quiet Lake, and whose length he 
 estimates at twenty-four miles. At the outlet of the lake is 
 an Indian fishing place. The country to the south of these 
 lakes is mountainous, granite being a common rock, and 
 several streams run from these mountains into Quiet Lake. 
 The north-east side of the lake is bordered by lower ridges, and 
 from its head, McCormack travelled about eight miles, through 
 a low country, to the bank of the Tes-lin-too, which he found 
 here flowing from north to south. 
 
 These miners found " fine " gold all along the river, but no 
 good paying bars. They were in search of " ( oarse " gold, but 
 did not discover any. A small specimen of pyrites and quartz, 
 from veins met with on one of the streams flowing into Quiet 
 Lake, given to me by Mr. McCorm.'ck, was found by Mr. 
 Hoffmann to contain very distinct traces of gold with a trace 
 of silver. 
 
 According to the Indians, the salmon run up this river to its 
 source, and the same is reported of the Little Salmon and the 
 Tes-lin-too. 
 
CHAPTER X. 
 
 General bearing of the Lcwe^ at the mouth of the Big Salmon River — The con- 
 fluence of the Tes-lin-too and Lewes — Auriferous gold bars — Cassiar Bar the 
 richest on the river — Valley of the Tes-lin-too — Composition of the Seminow 
 Hills — The river unexplored — Notes from Mr. T. Boswell's description and 
 Indian sketches — General trend of the Tes-lin-too — Estimated length to the great 
 lake— Its continuation — Navigation fairly good — The great lake, represented as the 
 largest known to the Indians— The Indian trail — Distance covered l)y the trail 
 — Indian salmon fishing stations above Tes-lin Lake — Fine gold found by Mr. 
 Boswell all along the Tes-lin-too — The Lewes from the mouth of the Tes-lin-too 
 to Lake Labarge — Length and formation of Lake Labargc — Country surrounding 
 the lake — Ogilvie Valley — Richtofen Island — Hills and mountains along the 
 lake — Miner's Range — The Lewes beyond the head of Lake Labarge — Tahk- 
 heena River — Its principal sources — The river employed iiy Indians to reach the 
 interior — White Horse Rapid and Miles Canon — The valley occupied by Lake 
 Labarge — Its climate — Bennett Lake— Lake Marsh— Country in its vicinity — 
 Tagish Lake — Jubilee Mountain — Navigation by steamers— Lake Marsh portion 
 of a system of still water navigation — Probable utility of this system in opening 
 up and developing the mineral resources of the country — Main continuation of 
 the Lewes — Lake Nares — The lake sy.item — Lake Lindeman — Trail over the 
 Coast Mountains — Dates of opening and closing of the rivers throughout the 
 region — Entrance to the Yukon district by tlie Chilkoot Pass and Lewes River — 
 SheepCanip— Mr. J. Healey— Mountain portage from Lake Lindeman tollealey's 
 house — The trail across the summit of Chilkoot Pass — The "Stone house" — 
 Formation of rocks on the Chilkoot Pass — Its vegetation — White Pass — Altitude 
 of its summit — Another route to the intirior — Ma]) of the Chilkoot and Chilkat 
 Passes and their vicinity — Earliest reference to the discovery of gold in the 
 Yukon waters. 
 
 THE bearing of the Lewes becomes nearly due south, at the 
 mouth of the Big Salmon. Though crooked in detail, it 
 preserves this general bearing to the mouth of the Tes-lin-too, 
 a distance by the river of thirt\-one miles. The actual width 
 of the river, at a point nine miles below the mouth of the Tes- 
 lin-too, was ascertained to be 483 feet, the current being at the 
 rate of 4*84 miles per hour. A short distance south of this 
 point, the river again begins to widen and to resume its usual 
 aspect. The hills bounding the valley on the south of the 
 Seminow Range seldom exceed a height of 800 feet till the 
 vicinity of the confluence of the Tes-lin-too and Lewes is 
 reached, when they gradually increase to 1000 or 1500 feet. 
 
 fit 
 
56o 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 m 
 
 'hi 
 
 m 
 
 Kill! 
 
 A number of auriferous gravel-bars have been worked along 
 this part of the Lewes, including Cassiar Bar, which has so far 
 proved the richest on the river. Limited areas of the river-flats 
 have also been worked over, where the alluvial cover is not too 
 deep. 
 
 The valley near the mouth of the Tes-lin-too is again nar- 
 rower than usual, singularly so for the point of confluence of 
 two important rivers. The valley of the Tes-lin-too is evidently 
 the main orographic depression which continues that occupied 
 by the Lewes below the confluence. The Lewes flows in 
 through a narrow gap, closely bordered by high hills and nearly 
 at right angles to the lower course of the river. 
 
 The water of the Lewes has a blue, slightly opalescent colour, 
 much resembling that of the Rhone where it issues from the 
 Lake of Geneva, while that of the Tes-lin-too is brownish and 
 somewhat turbid. A considerable pa"t of the water of the 
 former stream must be derived from the glaciers and snows of the 
 Coast Ranges, but the existence of large lakes on both streams 
 doubtless accounts for their proximate equality in temperature. 
 
 From the few exposures on that part of the Lewes which 
 cuts across the Seminow Hills, the range would appear to be 
 composed of greenish, altered volcanic rocks, probably diabase, 
 interbedded with grey or whitish marble. 
 
 The Teslin-too River is named the Newberry or Tess-el- 
 heena ' on Schwatka's map, and is evidently the same which is 
 sketched on the U.S. Coast Survey map of Alaska, etc. (1884), 
 as the Nas-a-thane. By the miners who pass along the Lewes, 
 it is known as the Hootalinkwa or Hotalinqu, in consequence, 
 as it proves, of a misapprehension. The Hotilinqu, which has 
 appeared on the maps for many years, was traversed in its 
 upper part by Byrnes in the course of his exploration. I have 
 ascertained that one or more of the miners who first descended 
 the Lewes knew Byrnes, and were familiar with his work ; 
 
 ' This is doubtless a version of Tes-lin-hi-ni, ///// (or in combination /il-ftJ), 
 beintj 'lanisli for river. Tes-lin-too is the name given to me by the Tagish 
 Indians, the termination being the Tinne equivalent for /////. This is, how- 
 ever, not the only case of such use of Tinne words by the Tagish. Nas-a- 
 thane is doubtless NIsutlin or Ni-sutlin-hi-ni, the name of the river above 
 the great lake. Krause names this river, on an Indian sketch attached to his 
 map, Tis-lin-hin. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 361 
 
 n hi -til), 
 
 Tagish 
 
 IS, liow- 
 
 Nas-a- 
 
 er above 
 
 led to his 
 
 they naturally enough, on finding the river, jumped to the con- 
 clusion that it was the Hotalinqu of which he had told them. 
 
 This river still remains to be explored and mapped, and as it 
 drains a country with a rather dry climate, the area of its basin 
 is probably very considerable. It has been prospected to some 
 extent by a few miners, but it is difficult, from the accounts 
 which they are able to give, to ascertain much of a definite 
 character respecting it. At the mouth of the river we met Mr. 
 T. Boswell and two other miners who had spent most of the 
 summer on it, and from Boswell's description, together with 
 sketches subsequently obtained from Indians, the following 
 notes are drawn up. 
 
 The general trend of the Tes-lin-too appears to be south- 
 eastward, and Boswell estimates its length, to the great lake, at 
 one hundred miles. There are no rapids or falls in this distance, 
 but the water for sixty or seventy miles from the mouth is 
 moderately swift, the remaining distance to the lake being quite 
 slack. Tiie lake is represented as being at least one hundred 
 miles in length, but accounts differ as to the existence of a large 
 tributary river at its head, some affirming that there is merely a 
 small unimportant stream. Be that as it may, the main con- 
 tinuation of the Tes-lin-too is found at the head of an arm ten 
 or twelve miles long, on the east side of the lake. This river, 
 known to the Tagish Indians as Ni-sutlln-hl-nl, must come 
 from a north-easterly direction in the first instance, and it is 
 represented as circling completely round the head of the Big 
 Salmon River and rising between that River and the Upper 
 Pelly. At a distance variously estimated at from eighty to one 
 hundred and twenty miles from its mouth (and said by the 
 Indians to be two days' travel down stream), the river forks, the 
 west fork being the larger and that of which the course has just 
 been described. The east fork is swift and full of rapids ; it 
 rises in a mountainous country, which no doubt represents a 
 portion of the northern continuation of the Cassiar Range. The 
 Indians travel several days up this fork and then cross moun- 
 tains to tributaries of the Upper Liard and descend by these to 
 the little trading post at the confluence of the Liard and Dcase. 
 Between the mouth of the main river and the forks above men- 
 tioned, the navigation is fairly good and no heavy rapids occur. 
 
 K 
 
 i ! 
 
 f 
 
 !-.•>** 
 
 !:>..! 
 
 ii ' t- 
 
362 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 If ^' 
 
 The great lake above mentioned, into which the Ni-sutlin- 
 hi-nl discharges, is said by the Indians to be the largest known 
 to them. It is named Tes-lin by the Tagish Indians, and is 
 bordered to the westward, at a distance of several miles, by a 
 high range of mountains, while a similar range, but of inferior 
 height, runs along its east side and separates the Tes-lin-too 
 from the Big Salmon further north. Near the head of the lake 
 is an Indian trail by which, it is said, the head of canoe naviga- 
 tion on the Taku River may be reached in two long days' 
 packing. Inquiry seems to show that the distance from point 
 to point by this trail is about sixty miles, and that it crosses a 
 range of mountains, but not at such a height as to pass entirely 
 out of the timber. It is stated that a miner named Mike Powers, 
 with eight or nine other men, crossed from the Taku to the lake 
 in 1876 or 1877. These men built three boats on the lake, but 
 do not appear to have done much prospecting, and came out by 
 the same route by which they had entered. 
 
 There are two Indian salmon-fishing stations on the Ni-sutlin- 
 hi-ni above Tes-lin Lake. Mr. Boswell and his partners found 
 fine gold all along the Tes-lin-too and also on the Ni-sutlin-hi-nl. 
 They worked in different places along the river and appear to 
 have done fairly well. 
 
 From the mouth of the Tes-lin-too or Newberry to the lower 
 end of Lake Labarge the distance by the Lewes is twenty-seven 
 miles and a half. The river is very crooked, and for the first 
 six or seven miles very rapid, averaging probably six miles an 
 hour. Large boulders occur in its bed in some places, but it 
 is believed that a stern-wheel steamer of good power might 
 ascend without difficulty. The current becomes slack three 
 or four miles before reaching the lake. The river does not 
 follow any well marked or important valley, but an irregular 
 depression among lumpy inconsequent hills, probably none 
 rising over 1000 feet above it. 
 
 This lake, through which the Lewes River flows, is un- 
 doubtedly that named for Lake Labarge on the older maps, 
 though Schwatka names it Kluk-tas-si, which is no doubt an 
 attempt at its Tagish Indian name Tloo-tat-sai'. Krause calls 
 it Tahiniwud, which is evidently the name given to me as that 
 of the Lewes River. 
 
?;: 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ?>^2> 
 
 sutlin- 
 known 
 and is 
 s, by a 
 nferior 
 lin-too 
 he lake 
 naviga- 
 ig days' 
 Ti. point 
 osses a 
 entirely 
 Powers, 
 the lake 
 ake, but 
 le out by 
 
 li-sutlin- 
 ;rs found 
 lin-hl-ni. 
 appear to 
 
 le lower 
 
 ty-seven 
 
 the first 
 
 miles an 
 
 es, but it 
 
 'er might 
 
 ck three 
 
 does not 
 
 irregular 
 
 ly none 
 
 s, is un- 
 ler maps, 
 loubt an 
 [use calls 
 le as that 
 
 The lake is a little over thirty-one miles in length. It lies 
 nearly north-and-south, but is somewhat irregular in outline and 
 does not present the parallel-sided form and constant width of 
 most of the mountain lakes. It is bordered nearly everywhere 
 by billy or mountainous country, but two important valleys 
 require special mention. The first of these evidently forms 
 the continuation of the hollow occupied by the lake itself, 
 and runs on from its north or lower end in a north-west- 
 ward direction, while the river, where it leaves the lake, 
 turns to the north-east and breaks through the range of hills 
 on that side. The greater part of this valley, which I propose 
 to name the Ogilvie Valley, appears to drain from the lake in a 
 north-westerly direction and probably to White River, as it is 
 seen to be blocked by terrace-flats about 200 feet above the 
 lake, at a distance of a few miles from it. The second valley 
 begins in a tract of low land to the west of Richtofen Island, 
 and runs parallel to the first, being, like it, one of the main 
 orographic valleys of the region. A small river appears to enter 
 the lake from this valley. The mountains on the south-west 
 side form a well characterized range, but appear scarcely to 
 exceed 2500 feet in height above the lake. They carried, 
 however, some patches of old snow, the first seen by us since 
 leaving the upper part of the Pelly River. 
 
 The hills along the lower part of the lake on the east side 
 are remarkable in their abrupt forms and have white limestone 
 summits. They rise from 300 to 1000 feet above the lake, and 
 no higher mountains were seen behind them. Further up the 
 lake, on the same side, similar limestone mountains attain a 
 height of about 2000 feet at a short distance back, but are not so 
 remarkable in form. On the west side of the lake, north of the 
 Richtofen valley, the hills slope gradually back from the shore and 
 in a few places reach a height of probably 2000 feet above it, at 
 some miles inland. The outlines of these hills are monotonous 
 and they are wooded nearly to the summits. South of the 
 Richtofen valley the Miner's Range ' approaches the lake at an 
 oblique angle, but decreasing in altitude. The mountains that 
 form this range are more varied in form than those just described. 
 
 ' I name this for the miners met by us along the river, good fellows all of 
 them. 
 
 K 2 
 
 . i! 
 
 
 I I ■ 
 
;64 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 i .1-. 
 
 Thouf^h local tokens of a more humid climate were noted on 
 the Lewes near the Seminow Hills, these are soon lost after 
 passing; that ranj^^e, and alonj,' Lake Laharj^e, southern slopes 
 of terraces and hills are often grassy and open. Anemone 
 patens was noted as abundant in many places. 
 
 No definite indication of the mode of orif,Mn of the lake was 
 obtained. Observation shows that the valley throuf,'h which it 
 now discharges existed in glacial times, but it may probably 
 have been of less importance, and it is not impossible that before 
 the glacial period the river flowed out by the Ogilvie valley, 
 which may since have become blocked by morainic or other 
 drift deposits. 
 
 Beyond the head of Lake Labarge, the valley of the Lewes 
 continues equally wide, and runs in a gerieral southward direc- 
 tion like that of the lake. At the head of the lake, the valley is 
 occupied by swampy flats nearly at the water-level and by low 
 terrace-flats, which, where cut in the river banks, are seen to be 
 composed of stratified fine sands, which are often iron-stained, 
 and a few miles up the river are found to rest upon the white 
 silts, showing that they are valley deposits of post-glacial date. 
 The limestone range which has bordered the east side of Lake 
 Labarge, runs on in a southward direction, forming the east 
 side of the wide valley. Eleven miles and a half from the head 
 of the lake the Tahk-heena River flows in from the west, 
 making a right angle with the main river, and at thirteen 
 miles further (still measuring along the river) the foot of 
 White Horse Rapid is reached. The current of the Lewes is 
 rather slack for eleven miles from the lake, and the bed and 
 banks are clayey or sandy. Above this point, the river becomes 
 swift, averaging about four miles an hour, and gravel banks and 
 bars reappear. For about two miles below the White Horse 
 Rapid the current is very swift, and though the latter may be 
 designated as the head of possible steamer navigation, it would 
 scarcely pay to endeavour to force a steamer up to the very foot 
 of the rapid. No rock exposures whatever were seen along 
 this part of the Lewes, the scarped banks, which are often a 
 hundred feet in height, consisting almost entirely of white silts 
 with a widely undulated bedding. 
 
 The Tahk-heena River is named the Tukon at its outflow from 
 
 wm 
 
! ■]'■] 
 
 ;ed on 
 ,t after 
 slopes 
 neiiione 
 
 kc was 
 hich it 
 robably 
 t before 
 valley, 
 ir other 
 
 2 Lewes 
 d direc- 
 valley is 
 by low 
 sen to be 
 -stained, 
 he white 
 :ial date. 
 f of Lake 
 the east 
 the head 
 he west, 
 thirteen 
 foot of 
 Lewes is 
 bed and 
 becomes 
 anks and 
 te Horse 
 may be 
 it wonld 
 very foot 
 en along 
 often a 
 hite silts 
 
 (/3 
 
 a 
 
 o 
 
 X 
 
 X 
 
 1'^ 
 
 i: i: 
 
 • y 
 
 Iflow from 
 
■ 
 
 i'i 
 
 liJ 
 
 i 
 
 M 
 
 '1^,.^. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 565 
 
 "west Kussooa Lake" at its head, on Krause's map. The 
 orthography of the published maps is retained here. The name 
 would probably be more correctly rendered Ta-hi-nT. It is a 
 considerable stream and is wide and slack at its confluence with 
 the Lewes. At about 200 yards from the Lewes, where it has 
 attained its normal size, it was ascertained to be 237 feet wide, 
 with a depth of ten feet for about one-third of this width, and 
 a current estimated at two miles an hour. The hills which 
 border the south side of this river at its mouth, rise to high 
 rugged mountains at about fifteen miles to the west, and these 
 have the appearance of being largely composed of granite. The 
 water of this river is very turbid as compared with that of the 
 Lewes. 
 
 The principal sources of the Tahk-heena are shown by Dr. 
 A. Krause's exploration to be at a distance of forty to fifty miles 
 from the head of the west branch of Lynn Canal, and the river 
 was formerly much employed by the Chilkat Indians, whose 
 chief place is on that arm, as a means of reaching the interior. 
 It is not used by the miners, and is now used to only a small 
 extent by the Indians themselves, on account of the long and 
 difficult carriage from the sea to its head ; but the lake at the 
 head of the river once reached, the voyage down stream is 
 reported to be easier than that by the main river, the rapids 
 being less serious. 
 
 The White Horse Rapid and Miles Caiion form together the 
 most formidable obstacle to the use of the Lewes as a route 
 into the interior, constituting an interruption to navigation of 
 two and three-quarter miles in total length. White Horse 
 Rapid is three-eighths of a mile long.' The worst rapid is at 
 the lower end of the White Horse, where the river scarcely 
 exceeds a hundred feet in width, with low basaltic banks, and 
 the force of the water is very great. In the upper part of the 
 White Horse, the water flows between low basalt cliffs scarcely 
 exceeding twenty feet in height, but sufficient to render track- 
 ing precarious and difficult, while the numerous rocks in mid- 
 channel make the rapid dangerous to run. The portage is on 
 the west bank, and it is usual to carry both boats and cargo 
 over it. 
 
 ' The distances here given are those measured by Mr. Ogilvie. 
 
 '1'!^^ 
 
566 
 
 THK YUKON TKRKITORY 
 
 Il;i 
 
 /. 
 
 ' ' . ! 
 
 ^ 
 
 i i 
 
 % ii 
 
 !i'*; : i , 
 
 Between the White Horse and the foot of the canon the river 
 is very swift, and iit one phice, a mile above the former and 
 three-quarters of a mile below the latter, the set of the stieam 
 is so strong; round a rock}- point as to render it advisable to 
 make an additional short portage of i jo feet. A third portage 
 of hve-eighths of a mile is necessary at Miles Cauon. This 
 portage is on the east bank, and at the lower end a very steep 
 ascent has first to be overcome. Here a sort of extemporized 
 windlass has been rigged up by the miners for the purpose of 
 hauling up their boats. The canon is cut through a nearly 
 horizontal tlov/ of basalt and is not more than a hundred feet 
 in width, with vertical cliffs averaging about fifty feet, and 
 never exceeding one hundrt-d feet, at the sides. It opens out 
 into a basin in the middle, but the river is elsewhere inaccessi- 
 ble from the banks. Terraced hills rise above the basalt walls 
 on each side of the valley, but are particularly abrupt on the 
 west bank, The river flows through the canon with great 
 velocity, but is unimpeded in its course, and it is tlierefore not 
 very risky to run with a good boat. The White Horse Rapid 
 is, however, much more dangerous, and though some of the 
 miners have run through it — generally accidentally — it should 
 not be attempted. 
 
 The great structural valley which is occupieil by Lake 
 Labarge and by the ri\er above it up to this point, runs on 
 above the canon as a wide, important depression, bearing 
 nearly due south, and appears to be uniiiterr\ipted till it joins 
 the lower end of Bennett Lake, thirty-two miles distant. 
 The course of the river, however, diverges to the south-easi. in 
 which liirection also a wick" \alley runs, and in twenty-three 
 miles (fi)llowing the stream) the lower enil of Lake Marsh is 
 reached, 'i'liis valley, thougli extensive between its limiting 
 slopes, is iu)t regularly bounileil by parallel ranges, like that 
 first mentioned. 
 
 The climate is drj-, the black pine {Piniis .Uz/rrdjui/tti) is now 
 very abundant, nuich more so than on the lower river, and it 
 
 w;is 
 
 here observed that this tree began to ass 
 
 uine a more 
 
 branching and less rigid form than it has to the north. Large 
 numbers of salmon wert- found di-ad or dynig rdong the banks 
 lor a few miles above (he canon, and the grass along the 
 
 n 
 
am 
 
 1 1 
 
 the river 
 iicr and 
 e stream 
 isable to 
 porta{j;e 
 n. This 
 cry steep 
 mporized 
 irpose i)f 
 a nearly 
 dred feet 
 feet, and 
 3pens out 
 inaccessi- 
 salt walls 
 )t on the 
 •ith f^rreat 
 refore not 
 rse Rapid 
 lie of the 
 -it slu>uld 
 
 by Lake 
 , runs on 
 
 learinj; 
 11 it joins 
 
 ilistant. 
 h-easi. in 
 I'uty-tlnve 
 Marsh is 
 
 liniitin^^ 
 like that 
 
 \(i) is now 
 •r, anil it 
 a more 
 Lar^c 
 Ihe banks 
 U)nt: the 
 
 y. 
 
 o 
 
 -1" 
 
 
 
 ■Mi 
 
 >M 
 
 ;i, 
 
 iMi 
 
ii 
 
 
 
 % 
 
 i' 
 
 il!! 
 
 > 
 
 i 
 
 f' 
 

 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 3^7 
 
 shores was trodden down by bears attracted here by this 
 circumstance. No salmon were found so far up as Lake 
 Marsh, and the Indians consider this is the hmit of the fish. 
 It would appear that after their long journey from the sea, 
 those which get so far, exhaust their last remaining strength 
 in ascending th'^ canon. 
 
 Lake Marsh, so named by Schwatka, in honour of Prof. O. 
 C. Marsh, is known to the miners as ' Mud Lake." It is 
 twenty miles in length, with an average width of about two 
 miles, pretty uniformly maintained. The valley of which whose 
 centre the lake occupies, is notably wide, and the country in 
 the immediate vicinity of the lake is quite low, consisting 
 of terrace-flats, or low rounded or wooded hills and ridges. 
 Conspicuous mountain summits, however, occur at a distance 
 of some miles inland on bo*^h sides of the lake. A moderately 
 well-defined range, of which Michie Mountain ' 5540 feet in 
 height is the most ele^■ated point, bounds the view on the east 
 side of the lake. To the west is an irregular and broken mass 
 of mountains in which several notable gaps occur, and which 
 occupy the country between Lake Marsh and the Watson 
 valley, previously referred to. The highest pointr, of these, 
 Mounts Lome and Lansdozvne, were ascertained to have 
 approximate elevations of 6400 and 6140 feet respectively. 
 The diversified forms of the mountains in view from this lake 
 render it particularly picturesque, and at the time of our visit 
 the autumn tints of the aspens and other deciduous trees and 
 shrubs, mingled witb the sombre greens of the spiuces and 
 pines, added to its beauty. 
 
 The upper end of Lake Marsh i.s connected with Tagish 
 I ke by a wide tranquil reach of river five miles in length. 
 !'li<» current is here very slack, and the depth, according to 
 Ogilvie, from six to twelve feet. The river is bordered by low 
 terraces, which are particularly wide on the west side, and are 
 covered with open woods, chiefly consisting of white spruce and 
 Cottonwood. To the eust, the long irregular ridge? and slopes 
 which culminate in Jubilee ?dountain begin to rise a short 
 distance back from the river. A mile above Lake Marsh, on 
 the east bank of the river, are two roughly built houses 
 ' So named by Schwatka. 
 
 
 'I' 
 
 . ,Jlj 
 
 ■vm 
 
 n ■ 
 
 ■>! m 
 
 
368 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 Im- 
 
 belonging to the Tagish Indians. These are the only 
 permanent houses seen along the whole course of thi "^.ewes, 
 and here the Tagish people, who roam over this part of the 
 country, reside during the winter months. 
 
 From the description just given, it will be seen that the 
 navigation, by steamers, from the head of the canon through 
 Lake Marsh and to Tagish Lake would offer no difficulties, 
 while the tranquil character of the connecting river between the 
 two lakes last mentioned, is such as practically to render Lake 
 Marsh the lower portion of an extensive system of still-water 
 navigation which includes not only Tagish Lake, but also Lake 
 Nares, I. 'le Bennett, and possibly other connected waters, and 
 which w J e of the greatest utility at no distant date in 
 
 facilitating opening up and development of the mineral 
 
 resources of the tract of country in their vicinity. 
 
 Taken as a whole, these lakes constitute a singularly 
 picturesque region, abounding in striking points of view and in 
 landscapes pleasing in their variety, or grand and impressive in 
 their combination of rugged mountain forms. 
 
 The inner or north-eastern edge of the Coast Ranges is not 
 here very well defined, but Tagish and Bennett Lakes, with 
 their several arms, may be described as lying upon this border 
 and as in part penetrating the outskirts of the range. The 
 lower part of Tagish Lake occupies the continuation of the 
 same wide valley in which Lake Marsh lies, and the valley of 
 the Tako Arm may also be included as a part of the same 
 depression. To the west of this, the upper part of Tagish Lake 
 and Bennett Lake must be considered as lying among the 
 mountains of the Coast Ranges, and the height as well as the 
 abrupt and rugged character of the mountains increase in that 
 direction, their slopes and summits holding large areas of 
 permanent snow, even late in the summer. 
 
 In consequence of the position of this country, in the lee of 
 the higher crests of the Coast Ranges, and notwithstanding its 
 considerable altitude, the climate appears to be equally dry 
 with that about the site of old Fort Selkirk, and no very 
 striking difference exists in the character of the vegetation. 
 The southward facing slopes of some of the mountains, to a 
 height of a thousand feet or more above the lake, are grassy 
 
^'n 
 
 11 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 369 
 
 and open, a circumstance particularly observable on the north 
 side of the west part of Tagish Lake and on Lake Nares. 
 
 This is the main continuation of the Lewes, and is reported 
 to be a tranquil stream of no great length, resembling that 
 between Marsh and Tagish lakes. It flows out of the west side 
 of another very long lake which lies nearly parallel to Tahko 
 Arm. This lake, near the south end, receives several feeders, 
 one of which, entering at its extremity, I suppose to be the 
 Hotalinqu River of the Telegraph Survey, though the Tagish 
 Indians informed me they named it Yd-hl-nT. 
 
 The Indian name of the lake here named Tagish Lake, is 
 Ta-gish-ai (Taglscha of Krause). It is commonly known by 
 the miners as Tako Lake, and Schwatka adopts this name on 
 his map. It appears, however, admissible to revert to the 
 proper Indian pronunciation of the name. I am obliged, by 
 the facts of the case, to include Bove Lake, of Schwatka, as 
 part of Tagish Lake, but, in order to preserve the nam.e, propose 
 to attach it to the large island in the mouth of Windy Arm. 
 Lake Nares is known to the miners as " Moose Lake," Lake 
 Bennett as "Boat Lake." 
 
 A glance at the map will show that the lakes of this system 
 occupy a portion only of a still more extensive system of wide 
 valleys, which are probably of great antiquity. The pre-glacial 
 direction of drainage in some of these can only be conjectured. 
 All those valleys are now, to a great extent, filled with detrital 
 deposits, probably due for the most part to the glacial period. 
 No appreciable deepening of drainage levels is f^oing on, and 
 the action at present in progress is constantly tending toward 
 the filling up of the lake basins. It may be presumed, here as 
 elsewhere, that the lakes of this region now occupy the place of 
 the last tongues of the great glacier, which in the end dis- 
 appeared so rapidly that their beds had not time to become 
 filled with detritus. 
 
 Lake Lindeman occupies the continuation of the same valley 
 in which Lake Bennett lies, but is separated from that lake by 
 a small rapid stream, three-quarters of a mile in length. This 
 stream falls about twenty feet between the two lakes, and is 
 rough and rocky. The portage is on ihe east side, and after 
 carrying the greater part of our stuff overland, we experienced 
 
3fo 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORV 
 
 !. !;.ii;l 
 
 no difficulty in bringing the boat up the rapids. Lake Linde- 
 man (Tl-tshoo-tah-minI of the Tagish Indians SchiitliichroA 
 Lake of Krause) is five miles in total length, with an average 
 width of about half a mile. It is the extreme head of naviga- 
 tion in this direction. The lower end is shallow, and the 
 occurrence there of many large boulders may show that it is 
 moraine-dammed. Its shores are rough and rocky along both 
 sides, high rough mountains rising on its north bank, while 
 lower country, consisting of rocky hills, extends to the south- 
 eastward, as far as the White Pass. A stream joins the head 
 of the lake from the west, in which direction the main valley 
 runs, but bifurcates at a distance of about three miles, the 
 branches running off among high granite mountains. A second 
 stream of some size, which evidently becomes a formidable 
 torrent at certain seasons, flows into the lake about a mile from 
 its head, on the south side. It is the valley of this stream 
 which is followed by the trail by which the Coast Mountains 
 are crossed. The scenery about this lake is wild and fine, 
 though solitary and alpine in the extreme. The rocks every- 
 where about the lake are granites of the kind just described. 
 
 As a number of miners had preceded us, on their way to the 
 coast, we found several boats drawn up on the shore at the 
 mouth of the stream above mentioned. We were also so 
 fortunate as ■ o find a small party of Tagish Indians camped 
 there, but most of the men had already gone over the portage 
 with some of the miners, and we were obliged to wait two days 
 for their return, before we could obtain the requisite assistance 
 to carry over our stuff. 
 
 The total length of the route by the Lewes River from "the 
 Landing " on Lake Lindeman to the site of Fort Selkirk is 357 
 miles. From the outlet of Lake Labarge to the same point is 
 a distance of 200 miles, in which the total descent is 595 feet, 
 or at the rate of 2*97 feet to the mile. 
 
 The information obtained respecting the dates of opening and 
 closing of the river in spring and autumn is very fragmentary. 
 It would appear, however, that the rivers generally throughout 
 the region open early in May, while they may be expected to 
 freeze over, in slack-water reaches, any time after the middle of 
 October, on the occurrence of a few consecutive days of hard 
 
w 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 371 
 
 pm " the 
 [k is 357 
 Ipoint is 
 1)95 f«et, 
 
 ung and 
 
 lentary. 
 
 [oughout 
 
 lected to 
 
 liddle of 
 
 of hard 
 
 frost. Loose ice sometimes begins to run in the rivers as early 
 as September 20th, but this generally precedes the actual 
 closing of the rivers by a couple of weeks. In some seasons 
 the rivers do not freeze over till well on in November. The 
 ice, however, remains much longer unbroken upon the lakes, 
 the lakes on the course of the Lewes thus generally preventing 
 the descent of that river by boats till June. 
 
 Miners entering the Yukon district by the Chilkoot Pass and 
 Lewes River, frequently leave the head of Lynn Canal in April, 
 and after crossing the pass — for this fine weather is essential 
 ■ — continue on down the lakes on the ice, and then, if necessary, 
 wait at some convenient point for the opening of navigation, 
 and build their boats. 
 
 In ascending the river, much depends on the build of 'the 
 boat employed and skill of the men in poling, as well as on the 
 occurrence, or otherwise, of head-winds on the lakes. The 
 whole distance from Forty-mile Creek to Lake Lindeman has 
 been made once or twice in so short a time as thirty days, and 
 I believe that even this record has been surpassed by a couple 
 of days on one occasion, but under very exceptional circum- 
 stances. 
 
 Much, however, depends on the stage of water in the river, 
 as when it is unusually high, the current is not only stronger, 
 but many of the bars and beaches are covered, and the poling 
 and tracking is much more laborious. 
 
 Timber suitable for building boats can scarcely be found in 
 the cinity of Lake Lindeman, but no difficulty is met with in 
 obtaming trees of fair size on Bennett and Tagish Lakes. Below 
 these lakes the country is generally wooded, and there is an 
 abundance of spruce of fair quality, growing tall and straight in 
 sheltered localities, but seldom attaining a diameter of two 
 feet. 
 
 On the igth of September, 1887, we set out with four Indian 
 packers, crossed the summit, and reached a point in the valley 
 of the west slope near what is known as Sheep Camp, the same 
 evening. On the evening of the 20th, we arrived at the head of 
 tide-water on Taiya Inlet, and were hospitably received by Mr. 
 J. Healeyj who has established himself at that point for 
 purposes of trade with the Indians and miners. We had at 
 
 ■II: 
 
 '1: 
 
 1 
 
 
 '^li 
 
 1' 
 
 1 
 
 V 
 
 :'3 
 
 1 
 
 1 
 
 i^llMlIl 
 
372 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 this time just completed our fourth month of arduous and 
 incessant travel from Wrangell, at the mouth of the Stikine 
 River, by the rivers, Kikes and portages of the interior described 
 in the foregoing pages, the total distance traversed being about 
 1322 miles. It was not the least pleasing moment of the entire 
 journey when, from a distance of some miles, we first caught 
 sight of the sea shining like a plate of beaten bronze under the 
 rays of the evening sun. 
 
 The length of the mountain portage from Lake Lindeman to 
 Healey's house is twenty-three miles and a half, the summit of 
 the pass being at a distance of eight miles and a half from Lake 
 Lindeman, with an elevation of 3502 feet. 
 
 The valley on the north or inland side of the summit contains 
 several little lakes which are evidently true rock-basins, with 
 lumpy bottoms and irregular contours. The trail is rough and 
 crooked, and entirely without attempt at improvement of any 
 kind. It follows the stream in one place, for about a mile, 
 through a narrow rocky defile, which has evidently been cut 
 out since the glacial period. Where it crosses wide areas of 
 shattered rocks, the closest attention is required to follow it, 
 and this can only be done, in the absence of guides, by noting 
 the slightly soiled appearance of the grey stones from one to 
 another of which the Indians step. Some of the valleys to the 
 north of the summit, and near it, are deeply filled with perennial 
 snow, over which the trail runs by preference, to avoid the 
 rocky slopes. The small lakes highest in the pass were, at the 
 time we crossed, about two-thirds covered with new ice ; this 
 showed little sign of melting, even under the bright sun that 
 prevailed. Hard frosts were evidently occurring here in the 
 mountains every night at this season. 
 
 From seven to eight miles of the highest part of the pass is 
 entirely destitute of timber, even of a stunted growth such as 
 might be used for firewood. The nature of the ground is, how- 
 ever, so rocky that it does not afford a proper criterion of the 
 normal height of the timber-line. 
 
 At the actual summit, the trail leads through a narrow, rocky 
 gap, and the whole scene is one of complete desolation, the 
 naked granite rocks rising steeply to partly snow-clad mountains 
 on either side. The slope of the pass on the north side is 
 
ffltt 
 
 ) • ' 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 373 
 
 and 
 ikine 
 ribed 
 ibout 
 entire 
 aught 
 er the 
 
 aan to 
 mit of 
 1 Lake 
 
 )ntains 
 
 s, with 
 
 gh and 
 
 of any 
 a mile, 
 
 sen cut 
 
 ireas of 
 
 )llo\v it, 
 
 f noting 
 one to 
 
 |s to the 
 
 [erennial 
 Old the 
 :, at the 
 
 Ice ; this 
 sun that 
 e in the 
 
 [e pass is 
 such as 
 is, how- 
 )n of the 
 
 3\v, rocky 
 Ition, the 
 lountains 
 |h side is 
 
 gradual, and the total ascent from the lake not very great, being 
 but 1334 f^^t. To the south, on the contrary, it is at first 
 abrupt and even precipitous, being accomplished over huge 
 masses of fallen rock, which alternate here and there with steep 
 slippery surfaces of rock in places ; but the travelling here is 
 after all not so bad as that met with lower down the valley, 
 where the trail goes through the woods along the steep, rocky 
 and often boggy hillside, leading up and down the sides of 
 several deep, narrow gullies. Two small detached glaciers 
 occupy hollows in the slope of the mountains on the west side 
 of this valley, and from these a considerable part of the water 
 of the stream is derived. The " Stone house," or stone houses, 
 and "Sheep camp" are points noted in this part of the pass, 
 the first consisting of several natural though inconvenient 
 shelters, beneath great masses of rock which have rolled down 
 from the mountain, where the Indians often stop over night ; 
 the second being the point where arboreal vegetation of fair 
 growth begins. 
 
 At six miles from the head of the inlet, the stream followed 
 down from the summit is joined by another which has been 
 dignified by the name of the Nourse River. A short distance 
 up the valley of the latter are somewhat extensive glaciers and 
 high snow-covered mountains. Both the valley of this stream 
 and that coming from the pass are narrow and V-shaped, but 
 from their point of junction a wide flat-bottomed valley runs 
 due south between high mountain walls and is continued further 
 on in that occupied by the inlet itself. This valley is largely 
 floored by gravel-flats and is evidently subjected at times to 
 heavy floods. The little river formed by the confluence of these 
 streams may be ascended with difficulty by canoes, for some 
 miles, when the water is not low, but at the time we passed this 
 was scarcely practicable. It is, however, easy to walk along the 
 gravel-flats, the only discomfort being the necessity of fording 
 the ice-cold and very swift water several times en route. 
 
 The rocks met with on the Chilkoot Pass are practically all 
 granites, generally hornblendic and grey, though varying in 
 coarseness of grain, and often porphyritic with pink orthoclase. 
 Below the Forks, on the east side of the valley, the summits of 
 several mountains show rocks evidently stratified, dipping at 
 
 I 
 
374 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 'If Li] f 
 
 Ml 
 
 high angles. These are probably gneiss or schist, like those 
 seen in the valley of the pass. 
 
 Scrubby hemlock {Tsuga Pattoniana) in a prostrate form 
 occurs not far below the actual summit on both slopes. 
 Below the " Stone house " this tree becomes arboreal, and a 
 few miles further down the valley grows tall and straight, 
 forming entire groves. Menzies spruce {Abies Sitchensts) also 
 appears, a short distance below " Sheep camp," together with 
 Cottonwood (probably Populus balsamiferd). Here also elder 
 and birch were first seen on the south slope. The devil's club 
 {Fatsia horrida) comes in about a mile above " Sheep camp." 
 Pinus contorta was not seen till the Forks was reached. 
 
 The " Stone house " is named Te-hit by the Indians. The 
 Indian name of the Taiya River of the maps, is Dai-e'. Nourse 
 River is named Kit-li-koo-goo-a', the stream followed southward 
 from the summit of the pass Si-tik'. These rivers are named 
 Katlakuchra and Ssidrajik on the map of Dr. A. Krause. 
 
 Having heard reports of the existence of a second pass from 
 Taiya Inlet to the lakes on the head-waters of the Lewes, Mr. 
 Ogilvie sent Capt. W. Moore to make an examination of it, with 
 instructions to rejoin the party to the east of the mountains. 
 This pass Mr. Ogilvie has named White Pass in honour of the 
 late Minister of the Interior. It leaves the coast at the mouth 
 of the Shkagway River ' five miles south of the head of Taiya 
 Inlet, and runs parallel to Chilkoot Pass at no great distance 
 from it. The distance from the coast to the summit is stated as 
 seventeen n.'iles ; the first five miles are of level bottom-land, 
 thickly timbered. The next nine miles is in a canon-like valley 
 where heavy wcrk would be encountered in constructing a trail. 
 The remaining distance of three miles, to the summit, is 
 comparatively easy. The altitude of the summit is roughly 
 estimated at 2600 feet. Beyond the summit a wide valley is 
 entered, and the descent to the first little lake is said to be not 
 more than one hundred feet. The mountains rapidly decrease 
 in height and abruptness after the summit is passed, and the 
 valley bifurcates, one branch leading to the head of Windy Arm 
 of Tagish Lake, the other (down which the water drains) going 
 to Tako Arm of the same lake. 
 
 ' So named on chart in U.S. Coast Pilot, Schkague River of Krause. 
 
; •■■■^ 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 375 
 
 .ss from 
 /es, Mr. 
 "it, with 
 untains. 
 ir of the 
 mouth 
 ,f Taiya 
 istance 
 itated as 
 )m-land, 
 ;e valley 
 a trail. 
 mit, is 
 roughly 
 'alley is 
 be not 
 ecrease 
 and the 
 dy Arm 
 s) going 
 
 There is still another route into the interior, which the 
 Indians occasionally employ in winter when the travelling is 
 good over the snow. This lea\-es the Nourse or west branch of 
 the Taiya, and runs west of the Chilkoot Pass to the head of 
 Lake Lindeman. 
 
 The first map of the Chilkoot and Chilkat Passes and their 
 vicinity is due, as mentioned further on, to Dr. A. Krause. The 
 passes connecting the coast with the interior country, from the 
 heads of Lynn Canal to the upper waters of the Lewes, were 
 always jealously guarded by the Chilkat and Chilkoot Indians 
 of the coast, who carried on a lucrative trade with the interior 
 or " Stick" Indians, and held these people in a species of sub- 
 jection. Though the existence of these routes to the interior 
 was known to the traders and prospectors, the hostility of the 
 Chilkats and Chilkoots to the passage of whites long prevented 
 their exploration. 
 
 I have not been able to find any reference to the discovery of 
 gold in the Yukon waters earlier than that given by Mr. 
 F. Whymper, who writes in i86g : " It is worthy of mention 
 that minute specks of gold have been found by some of the 
 Hudson Bay Company's men in the Yukon, but not in quan- 
 tities to warrant a * rush ' to the locality." ' 
 
 ' Travels in Alaska and on the Yukon. London, 1869, p. 227. 
 
 il 
 
 irause. 
 
 L 2 
 
l'<fr 
 
 ii'i 
 
 CHAPTER XI. 
 
 George Holt the first white man to cross — Date of Holt's journey — By the Chilkoot 
 or White Pass to the head of the Lewes — The river followed doA'n to Lake 
 Marsh — Over the Indian trail to the Tes-lin-too — Return to the coast by the 
 same route — Holt reported the discovery of "coarse gold" — His statement 
 uncontirmeil by subsequent prospectors — Prospecting party organized at Sitka in 
 1880 — Chilkoot Pass crossed to Lake Lindeman — The Tes-lin-too ascended 
 and prospected — No encouraging "prospects" met with — The Chilkoot Pass 
 again crossed in 1881 — First discovery of (laying placers in the Big Salmon 
 district — Entry of the Yukon country by the Chilkoot Pass in 1882 — Exploration 
 of the Chilkoot and Chilkat Passes by Dr. Arthur Krause — Progress of mining 
 during 188.?, 1884, and 1885— Discovery of Cassiar Bar in 1886 — "Coarse gold" 
 found on Forty Mile Creek— General view of the gold discoveries in the Upper 
 Yukon counuy — Number of miners in 1887 — Extent of country over which gol 
 has been found — Promising prospect for the utilization of this great mining fitl 
 — Difficulties and hardships to be overcome by miners now entering the country 
 — Long and severe winters — Short season for working on river bars— Frozen 
 ground — Capability of country to support a considerable mining population. 
 
 THE first white man who crossed from the coast to the 
 head-waters of the Lewes was probably one George 
 Hoh,' who did so with the object of prospecting the country.' 
 
 The date of Holt's journey was, I believe, 1878. He was 
 accompanied by one or more Indians, and crossed by the 
 Chilkoot or by the White Pass to the head of the Lewes. He 
 followed the river down to the lower end of Lake Marsh, and 
 walked over the Indu^n trail thence to the Tes-lin-too, return- 
 ing to the coast again by the same route. On his return, he 
 reported the discovery of " coarse gold," but none of the miners 
 who afterwards prospected the region mentioned have been 
 able to confirm his statement in this particular. In the Alaska 
 Coast Pilot the date of Holt's journey is given as 1875, and in 
 
 'i 
 
 ' Afterwards murdered by Indians at Cook's Inlet in 1885. 
 Alps of Alaska, H. W. Seton Karr, London, 1887. 
 - U.S. Coast Pilot, Alaska, 1883. pp. 200, 278. 
 
 Shores and 
 
1\ 
 
 Chilkoot 
 
 to Lake 
 St l>y the 
 statement 
 it Sitka ill 
 
 ascend etl 
 koot Pass 
 ig Salmon 
 ;xploration 
 
 of mining 
 larse gold " 
 
 the Upper 
 which gol 
 nining fitl 
 the country 
 irs— Frozen 
 lation. 
 
 It to the 
 
 George 
 )untry.'' 
 He was 
 by the 
 ■es. He 
 rsh, and 
 return- 
 turn, he 
 e miners 
 ,ve been 
 e Alaska 
 5, and in 
 
 Ishores and 
 
 III 
 
 y. 
 
 M 
 
 X 
 
 
 y. 
 
 o 
 
 y, 
 
 < 
 
 ■A 
 
 H 
 X 
 O 
 
 o 
 
 y. 
 o 
 
 H 
 
 y, 
 
 1 
 
 -: \ 
 
 > I 
 
 II 
 
 WW, 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 T^n 
 
 ' Other extraordinary journeys assigned to Holt in Mrs. Sridmore's book 
 are, according to tiie miners, altogether incorrect. Holt appears to have 
 been a romancer with considerable inventive ])o\vers, but it is possible that 
 he made more than one journey. In May, 1878, Mcssi. Rath iSrothcrs, of 
 Victoria, and Mr. IJean, of California, set out to cross by the Chilkoot Pass 
 for the purpose of prospecting, but were not allowed m go inland by the 
 Indians. Morris, Report upon the Customs Districi, etc., of Alaska, [879, 
 p. 97. 
 
 •^ It had increased to twenty shortly after leavmg Sitka. See Report by 
 Captain lieardslee,47th Congress, ist Session, Senate, E.x. Doc. No. 71, p. 65. 
 In the same report, the names of the nineteen original members of the 
 party are given and some account of its organization, etc. 
 
 •' The account of the further wanderings of the party given in the U,S, 
 Coast Pilot, Alaska (1883), p. 278, is incorrect. 
 
 ill 
 
 the addendum to the same work as 1872,' in Mrs. Scidmore's 
 book, already quoted, as " 1872 or 1884." The date and route 
 above assigned to Holt are, however, probably correct, being 
 the result of inquiry among miners who knew him, followed his 
 route through the country, and came in contact with the Indians 
 whom he had met. 
 
 Some years later, in 1880, a prospecting party of nineteen 
 men was organized at Sitka under the leadership of one Edward 
 Bean. Amicable relations were established with the Chilkats 
 and Chilkoots through the kind offices of Captain Beardslee, 
 U.S.N., and the Chilkoot Pass was crossed to Lake Lindeman. 
 The party had, by this time, increased to twenty-five in 
 number." Boats were built on Lake Lindeman, and on the 4th 
 of July the prospectors set out down stream. The Tes-lin-too 
 was reached and was then, for the first time (and as it proves, 
 erroneously) recognized as the Hotalinqu. Before returning, 
 the Tes-lin too was ascended and prospected for some 
 distance. From George Langtry, who was a member of the 
 original party, and R. Steel, who joined in later, the facts, as 
 above given, are derived.'' No encouraging "prospects" were 
 mrt with at this time, though Steel states that he found bars 
 yielding at the rate of %z'^o a day in a small stream which joins 
 the Lewes fifteen miles above the canon. 
 
 This large party was closely followed by two miners known 
 as Johnny Mackenzie and " Slim Jim," who reached Lake 
 Lindeman on July 3rd. It is possible that other parties as well 
 entered the country in that year; but if so, I have been unable 
 to trace them. 
 
 >'( 
 
 I 1 
 
378 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ;i. ,Ti 
 
 '<! 
 
 In 1881, a party of four miners, including G. Langtry and 
 P. McGlinchey, again crossed the Chilkoot Pass. These men 
 got as far as the Big Salmon River, which they called the lyon, 
 by which name it is marked on the U.S. Coast Survey map of 
 1884. They ascended the Big Salmon, according to their 
 estimate, about 200 miles, finding a little gold all along its 
 course and meeting with some remunerative river-bars. This 
 may be characterized as tiic first discovery of paying placers in 
 the district. 
 
 In 1882, a number of miners entered the Yukon country by 
 the Chilkoot Pass, and probably during this season, but 
 certainly not before,' two prospecting parties ascended the 
 Pelly to Hoole Canon, and some of the men appear to have 
 even gone some distance further up.- 
 
 Dr. Arthur Krause, engaged in an expedition on behalf of the 
 Bremen Geographical Society, in May and June, 1882, made 
 an exploration of the Chilkoot and Chilkat Passes, reaching 
 Lake Lindeman and the sources of the Tahk-heena River 
 respectively. His work is embodied in maps published by the 
 Bremen and Berlin Geographical Societies, and it is worthy of 
 special note on account of its conscientious accuracy.'' 
 
 In 1883, some mining was again in progress, but details 
 respecting it have not been obtained. It was in this year that 
 Lieut. Schwatka crossed the Chilkoot Pass and descended the 
 Lewes and Yukon to the sea.^ In 1884 a little mining was 
 done on the ^ dly ; nd on the Tes-lin-too, and possibly also on 
 the Lewes. In 1885, mining was begun along the Stewart 
 
 ' According to miners wlio were in the country <it the time, the statements 
 which have been ini])hshecl of earlier |3ros|)ucting along the Upper I'elly are 
 erroneous. 
 
 - Through the kindness of Mr. Frangois Mercier, I have obtained from 
 Mr. I). Hertrand, wliowasa member of one of the parties alcove referred to, 
 tlie names of tlie men composing both, as follows ; — Thomas Boswcll, John 
 Dougan, Robert Robertson, I). Hertrand, Frank Densmore, John Riley, I*. 
 Cloudman, Robert Fox, Thomas Curney, 'i'hc date as above given is from 
 Mr. Hertrand. Mr. HoswcU, whom we met on the Lewes in 1887, was 
 understood to say that he had been prospecting up the Pelly in 1884 or 
 1885, but this statement ]irobably referred to a subsec|uent expedition. 
 
 ■' Deutsche ("ieogia])hisclH' Hlattcr Hd. v. Heft. 4, 1882. Zeitschr. des Cles 
 fiir Erdk. zu Herlin Hd. xviii., 1883. 
 
 ■■ See Science, vol, iii,, 1884, also Report of a Military Reconnaissance in 
 Alaska, Washington Government, 1885, Along Alaska's (Ireat River, New 
 York,. 1885. 
 
rn ic 
 
 
 c 
 < 
 
 I 
 
 H 
 
 X 
 
 o 
 
 X 
 
 y. 
 o 
 
 c 
 y. 
 <; 
 
 U 
 
 H 
 
 o 
 
 y. 
 o 
 
 y. 
 
 II i 
 
 i ' t 
 
 H 
 
f 
 
 1 I 
 
 I' i 
 
 \i 
 
 1 ! 
 
 ni 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 379 
 
 River, and in the following year, the greater part of the mining 
 population was engaged on that river. Cassiar Bar, on the 
 Lewes, twenty-seven miles below the Tes-lin-too, was dis- 
 covered in the spring of 1886, and actively worked during the 
 same summer. 
 
 Late in the autumn of 1886, " coarse gold " was found on 
 Forty-mile Creek still further down the main river than the 
 Stewart, and the announcement drew off nearly all the mining 
 population to that place in 1887. In the attempt to bring out 
 the news of this discovery, a miner named Williams was frozen 
 to death on the Chilkoot Pass in January, 1887. 
 
 Taking a general view of the gold discoveries so far as made 
 in the Upper Yukon country, we find that, though some small 
 bars have been worked on the upper part of the Lewes, and 
 " prospects " have been obtained even in the stream flowing 
 into Bennett Lake, paying bars have been found on this river 
 only below the mouth of the Tes-lin-too. The best of these 
 are within about seventy miles below this confluence, and the 
 richest so far has been Cassiar Bar. This is reported to have 
 yielded, in some cases, at the rate of !ii!30 a day to the hand, 
 and gold to the value of many thousand dollars has been 
 obtained from it, chiefly in 1886. In 1887 only three or four 
 men worked here. All along the Lewes below the Tes-lin-too, 
 many bars occur which, according to the reports of prospectors, 
 yield as much as $10 a day, and the same is true of the Tes- 
 lin-too itself, both below and above Tes-lin Lake. 
 
 Gold has also been found for a long distance up the Big 
 Salmon River, and on the Upper Pelly so far as it has been 
 prospected. The Tes-lin-too, Big Salmon and Pelly have each 
 already afforded some good paying ground, but in consequence 
 of the rush to Forty-mile Creek only about thirteen miners 
 remained in 1887 on the first named river, four on the second, 
 and two on the Pelly. On the Stewart River, as much as ^100 
 a day to the hand was obtained in iS<S5 and 1886, and probably 
 over J$ioo, 000 worth of gold has already been obtained along 
 this stream. It has been prospected for a distance of 100 to 
 200 miles from its mouth (according to varying statements), 
 and the gold found furthest up is said to be somewhat 
 " coarser " than that of the lower part. 
 
 iii 
 
 ■ 1 1 
 
 ! 
 
38o 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 /Vr 
 
 ml 
 
 Forty Mile Creek is reported to be a river of some size, but 
 more rapid than most of those in the district. It has, accord- 
 ing to miners, been prospected for about a hundred miles from 
 its mouth, gold being found almost everywhere along it as well 
 as in tributary gulches. The gold varies much in character, 
 but is quite often coarse and nuggety, and very large amounts 
 have been taken out in favourable places by individual miners. 
 Few of the men mining here in 1887 were content with ground 
 yielding less than $14 a day, and several had taken out nearly 
 f 100 a day for a short time. The amount obtained from this 
 stream in 1887 is reckoned by some as high as $120,000, but I 
 believe it would be safe to put the entire output of the Upper 
 Yukon region for the year at a minimum of §75,000, of which 
 the greatest part was derived from this stream. 
 
 The number of miners in the whole Upper Yukon country in 
 1887 may be stated at about 250 ; of these, 200 were on Forty 
 Mile Creek, and it was estimated that at least 100 would winter 
 on the creek to be ready for work in the spring. 
 
 Forty Mile Creek is what the miners term a " bed-rock 
 creek," i.e. one in which there is no great depth of drift or 
 detrital deposits below the level of the actual stream. It is so 
 far the only locality which has been found to yield " coarse 
 gold," but from the extremely wide distribution of " fine gold " 
 it may safely be predicted that many more like it remain to be 
 discovered. 
 
 Mining can scarcely be said to have begun in the region 
 more than five years ago, and the extent of country over which 
 gold has been found in greater or less quantity is already very 
 great. Most of the prospecting has been confined to the banks 
 and bars of the larger rivers, and it is only when their innumer- 
 able tributary streams begin to be closely searched, that " gulch 
 diggings " like those of Dease, McDame and other streams in 
 the Cassiar district, and possibly even on a par with Williams 
 and Lightning Creeks in Caribou, will be found and worked. The 
 general result so far has been to prove that six large and long 
 rivers, the Lewes, Tes-lin-too, Big Salmon, Pelly, Stewart and 
 White, yield " fine gold " along hundreds of miles of their lower 
 courses. With the exception of the Lewes, no part of the head- 
 waters of any of these have yet been prospected or even reached 
 
 I m 
 
e, but 
 :cord- 
 5 from 
 Ls well 
 racter, 
 lounts 
 niners. 
 ground 
 
 nearly 
 •m this 
 ), but I 
 
 Upper 
 f which 
 
 intry in 
 n Forty 
 i winter 
 
 jed-rock 
 drift or 
 It is so 
 •' coarse 
 le gold " 
 lin to be 
 
 region 
 ;r which 
 |ady very 
 le banks 
 Innumer- 
 " gulch 
 reams in 
 A'illiams 
 .ed. The 
 [and long 
 rart and 
 leir lower 
 Ihe head- 
 reached 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 581 
 
 by the miners, and scarcely any of their innumerable tributaries 
 have been examined. The developments up to this time 
 are sufficient to show that when means of access are improved, 
 important bar-mining will take place along all these main 
 rivers, and there is every reason to anticipate that the result of 
 the examination in detail of the smaller streams will be the 
 discovery of much richer auriferous alluviums. When these 
 have been found and worked, quartz mining will doubtless 
 follow, and the prospects for the utilization of this great mining 
 field in the near future eippear to be very promising. 
 
 I must not, however, omit to state that great difficulties 
 and hardships have to be overcome by the miners who now 
 enter this country. The winter in the country is long and 
 severe, and the season of low water suitable for working on 
 river-bars is short. It is also found that beneath its mossy 
 covering, the ground is often frozen, presenting difiticulties 
 of another character, which have prevented the working of 
 many promising flats and benches. This, however, is likely 
 to be remedied by the general burning off of the woods and 
 moss in the mining camps. Frozen ground was found in the 
 same way in the early days of the Cassiar mines, but the 
 destruction of the timber has now allowed the summer heat to 
 penetrate to the lower layers of the soil almost everywhere. 
 It is not likely that thiis great inland country will long be 
 without some easy means of connection between the coast and 
 its great length of navigable lake and river waters, and when 
 this is afforded, there is every reason to believe that it will 
 support a considerable mining population. 
 
 END OF PART II. 
 
 1 
 
 ■ 1 
 
 I i: 
 li 
 
 : 
 
 ■< 
 
 I 
 
ii 
 
 PART III. 
 
 EXTRACTS FROM THE REPORT 
 OP 
 
 AN EXPLORATION MADE IN 1896.18,7 
 
 BY 
 
 WM. OGILVIE, D.L.S., F.R.G.S. 
 
 % 
 
 m m\ 
 
 P t 
 
 m 
 
 
1 
 
 a 
 r 
 c 
 
 . 
 
 k 
 
 C( 
 Ol 
 
 m 
 lir 
 is 
 
MR. WM. OGILVIE'S EXPLORATION, 1896-1897. 
 
 Fort Cudahy, Yukon River, N.W.T. 
 4th Sept., 1895. 
 
 I ARRIVED here on the evening of the 30th ult., after a tedious 
 journey through much bad weather which delayed me fully ten 
 days. I leave for the boundary in a day, and will commence 
 marking it at once. With reference to the applications for 
 land at Selkirk, I may say I have not seen the applicants as yet, 
 as they are away. It appears to me, however, from what I 
 have learned, that the best policy is to sell the applicants the 
 land they ask for. They have all occupied and cultivated part 
 of it, for several years, raising in their gardens such roots and 
 vegetables as the climate will permit, on which I will report 
 more fully later on. There is no great prospect of any town of 
 importance ever being either at Cudahy or Forty Mile. There 
 are many mining camps now in the country, and besides, the 
 miners find it pays well, to what they call " drift," that is 
 quarry out the frozen gravel during the winter, pile it up, and 
 wash it during the spring and summer. This keeps scores of 
 them on their claims all the winter, so that there is not that 
 demand for town residences during the winter that existed 
 formerly, and, consequently, town lots are somewhat at a dis- 
 count. Coarse gold and excellent prospects have been found 
 on the Hootalinqua (Teslin), and there will likely be a rush there 
 next spring. I will report more fully on that in future. 
 
 I propose, if I can close my operations here early enough 
 next spring, to make a survey and examination of the Hoota- 
 linqua rivers and basins on my way out to Yunean. I think this 
 is desirable in view of the prospects of that region. 
 
 M 
 
 
 Iff I 
 
 I 
 
386 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORV 
 
 Fort Cudaliv, N.W.T. 
 8th Jan., 1896. 
 
 I HAVE already sent out a short report from that place, being 
 fortunate enough to catch th' boat here when I came down. 
 In that report I made some remarks on the town sites in our 
 territories ; since then I have learned nothing of importance in 
 that connection, the most noteworthy fact being that gold- 
 bearing quartz has been found in Cone Hill, which stands mid- 
 way in the valley of the Forty Mile River, a couple of miles 
 above the junction with the Yukon. The quantity in sight 
 rivals that of the Treadwell mine on the coast, and the quality 
 is better, so much so that it is thought it will pay well to work 
 it, even under the conditions existing here. 
 
 Application has been made to purchase it, and an expert is 
 now engaged in putting in a tunnel to test the extent. In- 
 dications in sight point to the conclusion that the whole hill is 
 composed of this metalliferous rock. If the tests corroborate 
 this, a stamp mill will be erected next season, which will have 
 an important bearing on the future of this country. If this 
 venture succeeds (as it doubtless will, for it is in the hands of 
 parties who are able to push it) it will give permanent employ- 
 ment to a good many men, who with their families will form 
 quite a community. 
 
 Apart from this I cannot see very much of a chance for 
 speculation for buying or selling town sites ; and my opinion is 
 confirmed by the present condition of Forty Mile, which now 
 contains very few people, the great majority of the miners 
 remaining on their claims all winter, coming in only once or 
 twice for supplies. Even in the case of the mine at Cone 
 Hill being worked, only a village v.'ould be formed around 
 it. 
 
 Outside of all such considerations, the present applicants for 
 " Forty Mile " and " Cudahy " town sites have either directly 
 or indirectly occupied the present sites for years and spent 
 thousands of dollars improving and building on them. One 
 house erected in " Forty Mile " last summer is said to have cost 
 $10,000. It would cost between two and three thousand in 
 Ottawa. Those improvements cover so much ground that even 
 if it were decided to lay out the tov/n site and convey it in 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 3^7 
 
 lots, the applicants would have a claim i-' most of the ground 
 they ask for. 
 
 A couple of coal claims have been staked and applied for, 
 which I will survey in the spring, and „t the same time make 
 an examination of the coal area where they are. I may 
 anticipate this to a certain extent by saying that a few days 
 after I reported to you last fall, I went up Coal Creek to search 
 for this coal, to which I referred in my report of 1887 and 1888. 
 I found it about seven miles up the creek overlying a coarse 
 sandstone, and under drift clay and gravel. 
 
 The seam is about twelve feet six inches thick. It seems to 
 me to be a good quality of lignite. I have packed thirty or 
 forty pounds of the best specimens I found a few feet in, and 
 will send them out to you in the spring, that a test may be 
 made. That exposure has now been staked and applied for to 
 the agent here. I judge from the position of these coal claims 
 that we have quite an area of coal here. Both exposures 
 furnished, as far as exterior features show, the same character 
 of coal, and are about the same level, so that it is fair to assume 
 Uiey are in the same seam. I will make a search in the 
 intervening distance to determine this, when I make a survey 
 of the claims. Coal is reported in the drift on Chandinduh, 
 about thirty miles up the river from here, which would go to 
 show that there is another area or continuation of this one 
 here. 
 
 On my way down the river I saw the copper-bearing vein 
 near Ton-dac Creek above Fort Reliance. It does not appear 
 to be extensive, but there are several small veins in the 
 vicinity, and it may be that a commercially valuable deposit 
 may be found ; about twenty-five miles further down I found 
 a small vein which indicates that this copper deposit is 
 extensive. 
 
 I found a small seam of rather poor asbestos a short distance 
 from Fort Cudahy, and, as there is quite an extensive area of 
 serpentine around here, asbestos may yet be found of commer- 
 cial value. 
 
 Very rich placer diggings are now being worked on the 
 creeks flowing into Sixty Mile, part of which are supposed to 
 
 M 2 
 
 ■ ^ " 
 
 ■'V 
 
388 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 be in Canada. I shall be able to say definitely, when I produce 
 the line that far, where they are and how much we have of 
 them. 
 
 Last season good placer mines were found on the 
 Hootalinqua — Teslin of Dawson — with coarse gold in them, 
 and there will probably be a lot of claims worked there next 
 season. Several miners were wintering there to commence 
 operations early in the spring. A great deal of improvement 
 has been introduced into the working of placer diggings, 
 which has much increased the output. The miner, instead of 
 spending the winter months in the towns and saloons, 
 remains on his claim ill winter, cutting wood in the earlier 
 months, with which he builds fires and thaws the frozen 
 gravel, piling it up to be washed as soon as the flow of water 
 in the spring will permit. In this way, the work is more than 
 doubled, but as the supply of wood is very limited, except on 
 the main river, this cannot always be done. 
 
 I-- 
 
 The timber fit for building and lumber is fast disappearing 
 along the river, and in a few years there will be none left near 
 here. There is a portable saw-mill at Fort Ogilvie — loo miles 
 above this — and one here, which yearly cut a good deal of lumber. 
 Were uU this utilized in Canada, nothing might be said of it, 
 but some of it goes down the river into American territory, in 
 addition to which a good deal of wood and logs is cut on our 
 side and floated into Alaska, where it is sold. Some men 
 make a business of this, and on this at least the department 
 might collect dues. There is very little good timber on the 
 American side of the line, hence the demand for our timber. 
 
 >k|.r| 
 
 The police have, so far, made a very favourable impression, 
 and the general policy of the Government in connection with 
 this district is admired. 
 
 The merchants are well sat lied with the establishment of a 
 court of justice, and look for the early addition of some sort of 
 a court of record where transfers and claims can be recorded, 
 so that the collection of debts can be undertaken with some 
 degree of certainty. As it is nov —A transfers to B, who keeps 
 the record as long as it pays him to do so, but if he is dishonest 
 
 . ^ 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 589 
 
 and A absent or dishonest too, he may destroy it, and repudiate 
 payment of his debts. This has occurred aheady, and as a 
 good deal of transferring and counter-transferring is indulged 
 in, it may occur more frequently in the future, unless some 
 court of record is created. 
 
 It is probable the boundaries of the police jurisdiction may 
 have to be extended in the near future, for a good deal of trading 
 is done on the head-waters of the river by parties who cross the 
 summit of the coast-passes with goods from Yunean. Also the 
 miners on the head-waters and on the Hootaliiiqua bring their 
 supplies from Yunean. Now one of the traders here — Harper 
 — has a small steamboat named the Beaver, which he got last 
 season for the express purpose of reaching the upper parts of 
 the river and its affluents with supplies, and having paid duty 
 on all his foreign goods, expects to be protected against 
 smuggled goods. Should the Hootalinqua turn out as expected, 
 and promised, a police force will be required there. Harper will 
 try hard to get up with supplies to it and Teslin Lake. I fancy he 
 can lay down most things there as cheaply as they can be brought 
 over the pass. It costs 814 to $15, sometimes more, per hundred 
 pounds to transport from Taiya to the lakes, which makes 
 flour 816 to 817 pt^i" hundred at the lake, while it costs, or is 
 sold here for -f 8. Things here are sold so low now, that were I 
 ever coming in from the Pacific again, I would bring nothing in 
 quantity but bacon, on which I might save a dollar or two a 
 hundred, it being sold here fiom ^yy to 8j5 per hundred. 
 
 I have produced the boundary line about five miles north of 
 where it crosses the \uk()n Kivir, which is as far as I thought 
 needful at present. I have also produced it about seven miles 
 south, and about the end of I'ebruary will resume work, and run 
 it as far as vSixty Mile Creek. In connection with this I have 
 occupied six photOi.naph stations and developed all the plates 
 exposed, which ha\( turned out satisfactorily. I have made a 
 cross section measurement of the Yukon River where the 
 boundary crosses it. 
 
 In order to determine the exact position of the boundary as 
 referred to the longitude of my observatory of i887-iS(S, I made 
 a careful triangulation and transverse survey from the obser- 
 
 ir It 
 
390 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 vatory westward, which located it log feet west of the spot I 
 marked in 1888 as the boundary, this being estabHshed by 
 micrometer measurements — the distance is three miles. In 
 the vicinity of the river, I have opened out a wide line in the 
 woods which will remain visible for several years, but I erected 
 nothing permanent on it. In the valley of the river the 
 distances are chained ; elsewhere they are deducted from 
 micrometer measurements. 
 
 During the November-December lunation I got several lunar 
 culminations, of which I have only had time to completely 
 reduce one, and the result differs from the mean of my 1887-88 
 determinations by only o*i3 seconds. I hope to get some more 
 in the January-February lunation. 
 
 On the way in, the system of thirteen wires in the transit got 
 so damp that they bent into a useless mass of lines, some in, some 
 out of focus ; of course I did not open the box until I arrived at 
 my winter quarters. I repeatedly dried them, thinking I might 
 make them serve, but, after a few hours in the cold damp 
 atmosphere, they were as bad as ever. Finally, one of them 
 became detached at one end, fell across the others and rendered 
 them completely useless, there being a lump of glue attached 
 to the loose end. A diligent search for several days discovered 
 no spider lines that could be used to replace them, and I was 
 hopeless of doing anything with the transit this winter, until 
 one day I discovered that a solution of indiarubber I had, might, 
 with careful manipulation, furnish what I wanted. I tried it, 
 and after several attempts succeeded in getting five fair threads 
 on in the place of the original five — ten seconds apart. These 
 wires possess the virtue of always being taut by reason of the 
 elasticity of the rubber, so temperature does not aifect their 
 positions, but they stick together like gum if they touch, so 
 that I could not use a micrometer wire, and consequently 
 cannot get latitudes with the zenith telescope bubble. 
 
 Up to date, our lowest temperature has been 63° below 
 zero. The winter has been unusually windy. Coming up here 
 we had to face a strong wind when 52^ below icvo, and frozen 
 noses were the rule of the day. 
 
 No mail from outside since September. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 591 
 
 Fort Cudahy, N.W.T. 
 loth June, 1896. 
 
 After sending my last report, I left Cudahy on the 12th 
 January, reaching the boundary on the 13th, when I imme- 
 diately set to work reducing the observations I had taken of 
 lunar culminations up to that date, six in number, on one of 
 which both limbs of the moon were observed, making several 
 determinations of the longitude. 
 
 After my return there was some fine clear weather in January, 
 but it was exceedingly cold and more than 60° below zero, one 
 night 68° 5', and as I had both my ears pretty badly frozen I could 
 not go out in such cold without having them covered, so that I 
 could not hear the chronometer beat, I could not observe until 
 the end of the month, when we had two fine nights — 2gth and 30th 
 — mild enough for me to work. On the 29th I again observed 
 both limbs, the moon on both these occasions being suitably 
 full at transit here. This makes in all ten different determina- 
 tions of the longitude to be summed with my work of 1887-88, 
 and as most of my observations were then on the first limb, and 
 most of these on the second, the total result is better balanced. 
 
 Having reduced all my observations, and the days having 
 attained a reasonable length, I went into camp on the line on 
 20th February, resuming work on the 22nd. But as the hill- 
 tops are all bare, and from two to three thousand feet above the 
 river, we lost many days through the fierce winds. 
 
 Our progress was necessarily slow for this reason, and also from 
 the fact that I photographed from several stations, which took 
 some time. As there were no important creeks between Yukon 
 and Forty Mile Rivers, I did not cut the line out continuously, 
 but left it so that any one wishing to can place himself on or 
 very near to the line. The distance from Yukon to Forty Mile 
 River is a little over twenty-five miles. In the valleys along the 
 line the timber wns thick with much underbrush, but very little 
 of it is of much value. Curiously enough the line kept 
 generally in the valleys or on the sides of them, and very little 
 of it was in the open. Going from point to point, we had to 
 follow as much as possible the hill-tops and ridges. I reached 
 Forty Mile with this survey on the 13th of March. From this 
 point southwards there are many streams cut by the line, all 
 
392 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 !» 
 
 n 
 
 I 
 
 f 
 
 I 
 
 li 
 
 
 of which are more or less gold-bearing, and all have been more 
 or less prospected. This necessitated my cutting out the line 
 continuously from Forty Mile River onwards, which increased 
 our work very much. The valleys traversed are generally up- 
 wards of 1000 feet deep, and often very steep, so that our work 
 was exceedingly laborious. 
 
 Transporting our outfit from camp to camp was often a very 
 hard task, as the hills were so steep everything had to be packed 
 up them, which, in the deep soft snow, was anything but easy. 
 I reached a point within two miles of Sixty Mile River on the 
 14th April, and as I had passed all the creeks of any note, and 
 many of them were already running water, and our way lay down 
 them, I thought it well to quit work on the line and return to 
 Forty Mile and Cudahy, and attend to the local surveys there. 
 The weather was fine and warm, and so much water ran in the 
 creeks by which we had to return, that we could only travel a 
 few hours in the early morning and forenoon. Had the season 
 been more favourable, I would have visited Glacier and Miller 
 Creeks, which were generally supposed to be in Alaska, but are 
 found to run in Canada for some distance. They are the two 
 richest creeks yet found on the Yukon, and are both tributaries 
 of Sixty Mile River. Both creeks are fully located and worked, 
 each claim being 500 feet along the creek and the width of the 
 valley or creek bed. There are nearly 100 claims, all of which 
 pay well. One on Miller Creek I understand will yield seventy- 
 five to eighty thousand dollars this season, and the owner will 
 net, it is said, between forty and fifty thousand dollars. He 
 took out, it is reported, nearly half that sum last year off the 
 same claim, and expects to do equally well next year. This is 
 much the richest claim yet found, but all on those creeks do 
 well. There are many other creeks in this vicinity yet to be 
 prospected, and some will, I have no doubt, pay well. Gold is 
 found all along the valley of Sixty Mile River, and under more 
 favourable conditions, both mercantile and climatic, it would 
 yield good results to large enterprises. The mercantile con- 
 ditions will improve. The climate is a serious difficulty, but 
 will be surmounted in time, I believe. Along the last ten or 
 twelve miles of the line I ran, the mountains consist principally 
 of quarts and schists, which no doubt originally held the gold 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 593 
 
 found in the valleys, and doubtless hold some yet. Several men 
 have taken to quartz prospecting, and from indications which I 
 will dwell on later, I believe we are on the eve of sonie magnifi- 
 cent discoveries. 
 
 The miners on all the creeks referred to have quietly accepted 
 my line as the boundary /w tern., and as far as I can learn at 
 present, the general feeling is satisfaction that one can now 
 know where he is. Even if the line is not final, no one doubts 
 its being very near the final position. The line as far as run is 
 marked by cairns of stones, wherever it was possible to procure 
 them with reasonable time and labour, and is cut through the 
 woods and blazed, so that no one who wants to find it can 
 mistake it. Another source of satisfaction to all is that they 
 know distances and directions. Many miners remark to me, 
 " We know where we are going, we can see where south is." In 
 this high latitude in the summer months, it is impossible to tell 
 when the sun is near the meridian because its change in altitude 
 is so little for eight or nine hours, consequently any point 
 between east and west was called somewhere near south. This 
 helps to explain much of the variance in the direction of points 
 as given by miners and others who have no compass or are 
 unacquainted with the use of one and the application of the 
 declination. 
 
 On my arrival at Fort Cudahy I rented two cabins from the 
 N. A. T. and T. Co., to house my men and self, as I would be 
 around here probably until I started up the river. I did this 
 because there are no convenient camping places in the vicinity, 
 and in the spring all the flats are like lakes along the river until 
 well into the month of June. 
 
 After a couple of days' rest for the party, who had worked very 
 hard, and after I had developed all my photographs, I began to 
 attend to the local surveys, first surveying the coal claims on 
 Coal Creek and making a chain transverse survey of the creek 
 from the claims down to the Yukon. I mail you a plot of this 
 and the claim on a scale of forty chains to the inch. I also 
 mail you a sketch map of my survey of the boundary line on a 
 scale of twenty miles to the foot, and have piMicilled in an idea 
 of the topography ; it is made on the best paper I could get 
 here as I brought none with me. I next made a survey of the 
 
 I 
 
394 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 m 
 
 
 H 
 
 ■'Is (4 
 ^. ^ I' 
 
 I'i 
 
 IP' 
 
 ti 
 
 ■11 P 
 
 PP 
 
 Cone Hill quartz-mining claim and a chain transverse survey of 
 the Forty Mile River from the claim down to the Yukon. I then 
 went to work on the Forty Mile town site and the Cudahy town 
 site. The last I was asked to block out, which I have done. 
 The manager, Mr. C. H. Hamilton, objected to streets sixty-six 
 feet wide on such a small plot of ground (there are only about 
 fifty acres). I read him my instructions and wrote him an 
 official letter on the subject, but he insisted on streets only fifty 
 feet wide, and assumed all responsibility, so I did as he desired. I 
 made him a plot of the work done on the ground, and he under- 
 stands that he will have to pay the department for the service 
 rendered in blocking as well as the original survey, and wishes 
 a plan of it, which of course can only be prepared when I go 
 out. 
 
 I made a complete survey of Forty Mile, locating and taking 
 the dimensions of every house in it, and it is the worst jumble 
 I ever saw. I had to do this, though it entailed a great deal of 
 work, for there were so many claimholders, and there appeared 
 to be a general distrust in the vicinity ; every man wants 
 himself on record in evidence as to his claim. I have taken 
 some, but I have several days' work yet. I made a survey of 
 the island for the Anglican mission, and of another island for 
 a man named Gibson. This is the delta of Forty Mile Creek, 
 and he intends to make a market garden for the growth of such 
 vegetables as the country will produce. In my final report I 
 will deal as fully as my experiences here will permit with that 
 phase of the country's character. Many here have small 
 gardens and are fairly successful with ordinary vegetables. I 
 have advised many to correspond with the experimental farm 
 at Ottawa, with a view to learning the best sort of vegetables 
 for growth in this climate. There is an application in, and the 
 purchase money and cost of survey paid, for eighty acres just 
 west of Cudahy town site, which I will survey in a few days. 
 There is also an appli( ition in for forty acres, containing a 
 hay swamp, on the east side of the river, about two miles below 
 here, which I will survey before starting out. There are many 
 other applications in, but I shall not have time to attend to 
 them, nor have the parties asked for a survey. I think these 
 applications are simply intended to hold the ground until the 
 
mwi 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 395 
 
 future of this region is forecasted; it certainly looks promising ^ 
 now. I would respectfully call the attention of the department <:;; 
 to the fact that the services of a surveyor are urgently needed 
 in here, and will be for some years to come, and I would 
 suggest that one be appointed to look after and take charge of 
 all the land interests in the district. He will find plenty to do, 
 and any work outside of departmental which he might be asked 
 to do (rnd there is much of it, and will be more in the way of 
 engineering) would help materially to pay his salary, which 
 would, of course, in here have to be liberal. 
 
 Another inconvenience is the want of a trade medium ; there 
 is very little coin, nearly all business being transacted in gold 
 dust, which passes current at .$17 per ounce troy, but as most 
 of it will not assay that, there is some hardship to those taking 
 it out, though there may be no actual loss. If enough money 
 were sent in to pay the North-West Mounted Police for some 
 time, it would help for a period at least, and would emphasise 
 the existence of Canada. What coin and bills are here are 
 largely American. 
 
 Another important question is the treatment of the liquor 
 business which cannot be ignored much longer ; there are 
 several saloons in Forty Mile and one in Cudahy, yet there is 
 no law recognizing them nor regulating them in any way. It 
 would be almost impossible, and very unpopular, were any 
 attempt made to close them. Liquor could not be kept out of 
 the country if the whole North-West Mounted Police were 
 scattered around the river. 
 
 Another subject which I have mentioned before is that of the 
 timber. Large quantities of timber are being and have been 
 cut in our territory, and floated down the river to American 
 territory where it is used, and Canada derives no benefit. 
 Were it used to develop our country it would matter less, in 
 fact I would encourage such use, but to see our timber taken 
 out without any sort of benefit to the country is, I think, worthy 
 of some sort of attention. There is very little useful timber in 
 the country, and much of what does exist is cut into fuel, while 
 more of it goes beyond the boundary. In the near future we 
 shall feel the want of it. I have spoken to the agent about it, 
 but he has no authority to act, and, if he had, is disinclined to 
 
 V 
 
 ■^5* 
 
 I •t£~H'«»->'- r 
 
 ii 
 
 11 
 
39^ 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 r'' 
 
 i 
 
 .1 1: 
 
 . j,i. 
 
 m 
 
 1 
 
 
 run up and down the river looking after it, unless he has a 
 steamer. 
 
 A word or two on the steamer question. He labours under the 
 delusion that a small steam launch is all he requires. Now the 
 best of them can only make five to seven miles per hour in dead 
 water, and here we have a river with a current of six to eight miles 
 per hour the greater part of the summer ; even in low water it is 
 five to six generally. To get up at all his launch would have to 
 keep inshore, and even then she would not make more miles 
 per day than the same number of men would with a good canoe 
 or boat, tracking or poling, with the advantage to canoe or boat 
 of not having to stop for fuel. The only boat suitable for this 
 river is a stern-wheeler, and one of the most suitable size for 
 police purposes would cost ten to twenty thousand dollars, and 
 require experienced men to run her. 
 
 Some sort of court for the collection of debts is required here 
 now, and whether or not the agent could act in that capacity 
 is a question to be decided. 
 
 The merchants here who pay duty are naturally dissatisfied 
 at the smuggling done on the upper river, and ask for some 
 sort of protection. It might be advisable to have a squad of 
 police and an officer somewhere on the lake to look after that. 
 I am thoroughly convinced that a road from the coast to some 
 point on the head-waters of the river, preferably by the Taku, 
 if at all practicable, would convert all our part of the river 
 into a hive of industry. It may be said there is no competition, 
 and anyway, in the present condition of trade, things cannot 
 be sold much cheaper at a fair rate of profit. Once let a 
 railroad get from some point on the coast to some point on the 
 river, so that we can have quick, cheap and certain entrance 
 and exit, and the whole Yukon basin will be worked. At 
 present the long haul makes the expense of mining machinery 
 practically prohibitive, for the cost of transport is often more 
 than the first cost of the machine. 
 
 Assays of Cone Hill quarts are very satisfactory, and the 
 quantity good for generations of work ; were it on the coast, 
 the Treadwell Mine would be diminutive beside it. Five tons 
 of rock from it are being sent out for a mill test, and should 
 they prove as satisfactory as the test of a ton sent out last year. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 Z^7 
 
 I understand the parties owning it will proceed to develop it. 
 If it starts and proves reasonably successful, there are scores of 
 other places in the country that may yield as well. An expert 
 here who prospects for the N. A. T. and T. Company, found a 
 ledge last spring on the Chandindu River of Schwatka (known 
 as Twelve Mile Creek here) and located two full claims on it. 
 He told me the assay he made of many specimens of it was 
 much more satisfactory than that of Cone Hill, and this ledge, 
 he claims, is where a commencement should be made in quartz 
 milling in this country, and there would be no fear of the result. 
 He appeared to be pretty well versed in mining lore, is a 
 practical assayer — that is his profession — and he says he never 
 saw or read of anything like it for extent in the world. He 
 informed me there were extensive deposits of coal about twenty 
 miles up the creek, and this ledge was about four miles up. 
 He had no doubt but that the copper about F"ort Reliance will 
 with better facihties yet be a valuable feature in the country. 
 He showed me a lump of native copper some Indians said they 
 found at the head of White River, but could not or would not 
 specify where. Speaking of White River reminds me that it 
 and Sixty Mile are very close together in the vicinity of the 
 boundary. I was told it was only a short walk from the creeks 
 of one to the creeks of the other, but how far from stream to 
 stream is uncertain. 
 
 This expert is an American who has spent many years of his 
 life in the best mining districts of the United States, and he 
 assures me this country promises better than any he ever saw 
 before, and as an evidence of his satisfaction with it he is going 
 to spend the rest of his life here. 
 
 Great anxiety is felt here about a mail route and regular 
 mail. Last winter three mails left the coast, one by the Taku 
 route, one by the White Pass, and one via Taiya : the first 
 two got here in good time, the last (ours by the way) did not, 
 nor is likely to arrive, for some time — may be, never. The 
 man in charge was badly frozen on the summit, and had to 
 turn back, leaving the mail behind him, and it is now probably 
 buried in fathoms of snow. An Indian brought the mail in by 
 the Taku, and took the Slocoh branch of it to Atlin Lake. 
 From what I learnt of this route while up there, it may be 
 
 lii 
 
 •i (1 
 
398 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 found to afford an easier way than by Teslin Lake, but it has 
 the disadvantage of landing on the head of the Lewes instead 
 of the Hootahnqua or TesHn, and so takes in the canon and 
 White Horse Rapids. 
 
 Last winter many of the miners and residents here talked 
 to me about the mails, and what the government intended 
 in this direction ; of course I could tell them nothing, but 
 suggested they should make their views known by getting up 
 a petition to the Minister of the Interior, which I understand 
 they did. 
 
 The Alaska Commercial Company are putting a new and 
 powerful steamer on the river, which will make four ; the 
 Arctic, Alice, and Emma, large, and the Bedon, small. There is 
 some talk of the N. A. T. and T. Company putting on a sister 
 boat to the Partus />'. Weare. All are stern-wheeled boats. 
 
 From my camera stations on the boundary I saw many 
 high mountains, some of them not less than 8000 feet, some 
 I believe 10,000. Some of the promint ones I have 
 named after the pioneers of this country, notably one Mount 
 Campbell after the late Mr. Robert Campbell, who estab- 
 lished Fort Selkirk, It is about sixty miles due east of here, 
 and is a noteworthy peak, in that it stands on the top of an 
 extensive, well-defined range, rising like a lofty pillar about 
 1000 feet above the ridge. It is, as far as seen, the most 
 remarkable peak in the country. I have not made any compu- 
 tations yet, but I do not think its summit is much, if any, less 
 than 10,000 feet above the sea ; no one noticed it before for 
 the reason that it is only about 600 feet wide, is always black, 
 and very distant from points where it can be seen around here. 
 
 Fort Cudahy, N.W.T. 
 June 25th, 1896. 
 
 My experience last winter was that a party of say eight men, 
 three on the line continuously, and four forwarding continuously, 
 and one cook, the line could be advanced at the rate of twenty- 
 five miles per month with no great difficulty during February, 
 March, April and May, and part of October, November, and 
 part of December. 
 
THE YUKON lERRITORY 
 
 399 
 
 Good strong toboggans and good strong large snow-shoes are 
 required. During June, July, August and September, the same 
 party with say five pack horses, three at camp and two for- 
 warding from depot of supplies, could proceed at an equal if not 
 faster rate. There would be ab( ut two or two and a half months 
 too dark to profitably work on the line. This, I think, would 
 be more satisfactory than putting in a few isolated points here 
 and there, certainly it would give us a continuous boundary and 
 a more extended geographical knowledge of the country, as well 
 as botanical and geographical information of importance. 
 Horses could be laid down here for, I should say, about 8250 
 per head — and the same animals ought to last the whole survey. 
 Horses have been in use here, packing to the mines in summer 
 and hauling wood in the winter, for several years, and are still 
 serviceable, notwithstanding that they live only on the coarse 
 grasses of the country. They pack 200 lbs. apiece from Forty 
 Mile River at the mouth of Moore Creek to the mines on Miller 
 Creek (about seventeen and a liilf or eighteen miles), and climb 
 some very steep long hills on the way, taking two da}'s with 
 loads, and one day without ; all they get to eat is what they 
 find. 
 
 As a gauge of what can be done I refer you to what I did 
 last winter. In less than two months, TYbruary 22nd to April 
 13th, I produced the line nearly fifty miles, cutting every bit of 
 bush on twenty-five miles of it, and partly cutting the rest, 
 besides spending several days on my photograph stations, and 
 I had only six men. I am confident that a joint party consist- 
 ing of say twelve altogether, could produce this line at the rate 
 of 300 miles per year, marking it properly and permanently, and 
 enabling a fair map of the country on both sides to be made. 
 The cost of this you can easily estimate and add, say 25 per 
 cent, for the establishment of provision depots and incidentals. 
 
 My last report told you of the agent here going to Miller and 
 Glacier Creeks, and collecting fees and making entries ; as he 
 did not go west of those creeks no complications will arise for 
 you, as you will see by my sketch map they are within Canada. I 
 may say here that one claim on Miller Creek has turned out 
 about §70,000 last winter, and several others have done very 
 well too ; so far nearly all the miners have passed here going to 
 
 li 
 
 i:' M 
 
400 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 Circle City (about 200 miles down), and I have no doubt many 
 of them will keep on f^oing. 
 
 About 100 miners are reported on the Hootalinqua this 
 summer. We shall probably soon have to extend law and order 
 there. 
 
 Many here make gardens, using any seeds they can get, and 
 some are going to try grasses for fodder. I would suggest the 
 director of the central experimental farm be asked to send in 
 seeds of the kinds of ordinary vegetables and grasses best suited 
 to such a climate as this, to be distributed by the agent hereto 
 those who will make a proper use of them, or for sale at cost. 
 I am quite sure it would be of much service, and if some hints 
 on the proper care of plants were sent in, it would be more so, 
 as most of the people in here know practically nothing of 
 gardening or farming. Besides, it would improve the feeling 
 among the people here towards our country and institutions, 
 and would cost the country practically nothing. 
 
 if ; 
 
 Fort Cudahy. 
 
 August iStli, 1896. 
 
 It is now certain that coal extends along the valley of the 
 Yukon from Coal Creek for ten or twelve miles down, and from 
 Coal Creek up to Twelve Mile Creek which flows into the Yukon 
 about thirty miles above here. The latter stretch is cut off from 
 the river by several miles of hills, and is about six miles direct 
 from the river at Coal Creek and about eighteen on Twelve 
 Mile Creek. This is the stream named Chandindu by Schwatka. 
 There is a seam on it about six feet thick, as reported by an 
 expert who went in search of it. I found drift coal on the south 
 branch of Coal Creek. 
 
 On the Cornell claim off Cliff Creek the seam is five feet four 
 inches thick. I have sent specimens of it out. I found it 
 necessary to refer to the different creeks, so had to name them 
 " Shell Creek," because I found a stone with a shell impression 
 at its mouth, " Cliff Creek," because it enters the river at the 
 foot of a high cliff, and " Flat Creek," because it enters the 
 river in a large flat. 
 
 Glacier Creek is turning out very well, and several good 
 creeks have been discovered up Forty Mile in Alaska. 
 
^^i: 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 401 
 
 Fort Cudahy. 
 
 6th Sept., 1896, 
 
 I HAVE been in hourly expectation of the Canadian mail for 
 some days now, but it has not arrived yet. The steamer 
 Alice came up on the 4th inst., but brought no news for me, 
 so that I am completely in the dark as to my movements 
 yet, and if I am to go out, it is time I was on the way. I do 
 not wish to remain here another winter unless it is absolutely 
 necessary ; more especially with my party and all its expenses. 
 In case I go out I will try to accompany Mr. J. Dalton over his 
 trail from the head of Chilkat Inlet to Selkirk on the Yukon. 
 He has made several entries over that route with horses and 
 packs, and speaks very highly of it. I will make a rough 
 survey of it, and take some photographs along the route. 
 
 I have taken notes from him, but would like to see it for 
 myself. 
 
 I am very much pleased to be able to inform you that a most 
 important discovery of gold has been made on a creek called 
 Bonanza Creek, an affluent of the river known here as the 
 Klondyke. It is marked on the maps extant as Deer River, 
 and joins the Yukon a few miles above the site of Fort 
 Reliance. 
 
 The discovery was made by G. \V. Cormack, who worked 
 with me in 1887 on the Coast Range. The indications are that 
 it is very rich, indeed the richest yet found, and as far as work 
 has been carried on it realizes expectations. It is only two 
 weeks since it was known, and already about 200 claims have 
 been staked on it, and the creek is not yet exhausted ; it, and 
 its branches are considered good for 300 or 400 claims. 
 Besides, there are two other creeks above it, which it is 
 confidently expected will yield good pay ; and if they do so, we 
 shall have from 800 to 1000 claims on this river, which will 
 require over 2000 men for their proper working. Between Deer 
 River (or Klondyke) and Stewart River a large creek called 
 Indian Creek flows into the Yukon, and rich prospects ha\ e 
 been found on it, and no doubt it is in the gold-bearing country 
 between Klondyke and Stewart Rivers, which is considered by 
 all the old miners the best and most extensive gold country yet 
 found. Scores of them would prospect it but for the fact that 
 
 N 
 
 I ti 
 
 1 1! r 
 
402 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ■A 
 u 
 
 '■,y 
 
 m 
 
 ill 
 
 
 they cannot get provisions up there, and it is too far to beat 
 them up from here in small boats. 
 
 This new find will necessitate an upward step on the Yukon, 
 and help the Ste\'art River region. 
 
 New3 has just arrived from Bonanza Creek that three men 
 worked out $75 in four hours the other day, and a $i2'oo 
 nugget has been found, which assures the character of the 
 ground, namely, coarse gold and plenty of it, as three times 
 this can be done with sluice boxes. You can fancy the excite- 
 ment here. It is claimed that from $100 to $500 per day can 
 be made off the ground that has been prospected so far. As we 
 have about 100 claims on Glacier and Miller, with 300 or 400 
 in this vicinity, next year it is imperative that a man be sent 
 in here to look after these claims and all land matters, and it 
 is almost imperative that the agent be a surveyor. Already 
 on Bonanza Creek they are disputing about the size of 
 claims. 
 
 I would have gone up and laid out the claims properly, but 
 it would take me ten or twelve days to do so, and meantime 
 my presence might be more urgently required eLewhere. 
 
 Another important matter is the appointnient of some sort 
 of legal machinery here. Before the police came miners' 
 meetings administered justice, collected debts, etc. ; now the 
 magistrates here are expected to do all that, and when it is 
 found that they do not> it causes much dissatisfaction, and there 
 are several cases of real hardship where parties will not pay 
 their just debts, though able to do so. If a miners' meeting 
 were held, and jucigment gi> en against the delinquent, it would 
 do no good, for he would and does resist payment, and were 
 force resorted to, he would appeal to the police for protection. 
 A continuation of this ' ate of affairs is most undesirable in the 
 interests of our country, for we have a reputation as a justice- 
 administering, law-abiding people to maintain, and i would 
 urgently press this matter on thr authorities. 
 
 From the indications I have mentioned, it will be seen that 
 this corner of the North-West is not going to be the least 
 important part of it, more especially when we consider the fact 
 that gold-bearing quartz has been found in it at numerous 
 places, and much will no doubt be worked. It is apparent that 
 
■^"^t 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 403 
 
 the revenue and business of the country will more than offset 
 the expense of administration. 
 
 I cannot here enter into the reasons for it, but I unhesi- 
 tatingly make the assertion that this corner of our territory 
 from the coast strip down, and from the 141st meridian east- 
 ward, will be found to be a fairly rich and very extensive mining 
 region. 
 
 As I have already pretty fully reported on coal, I will only 
 add that it is reported in abundance only eight miles up the 
 Chandinaler River, where a seam over six feet thick has been 
 found of the same quality as that already described. 
 
 Fort Cudahy. 
 
 November 6th, i8g6. 
 
 Your official letter informing me that negotiations for a joint 
 survey of the 141st meridian had so far failed, and that I had 
 better return to Ottawa for the winter, reached m? here on the 
 nth September, As the Alaska Commercial Company's 
 steamer Arctic was then hourly expected up the river on her 
 way to Selkirk, I thought it best to wait ;iiid go up on her to 
 that point. Day after day passed without any sign of her; 
 wearied of waiting and hopeless of her arrival at all this year, I 
 determined to start out on 27th September, a late date, but 
 with fair conditions feasibK . On the 25th a tremendous storm 
 of snow set in which so chilled the river that a few days after 
 it was < hoked with ice, which precluded all idea of getting up 
 the river, and it was equally hopeless down the river. 
 
 Threj parti'^^s have announced their intention of starting for 
 the or.tsid" world about the ist prox,, and I write this contem- 
 plating its transmission by one or other of these parties. For 
 myself, t(j think of going out in the winter is, I think, unwise for 
 the following r-^asons. Dogs, the only means of transport, are 
 scarce and dear, ranging from thirty or forty dollars to one 
 hundred and twenty-five dollars apiece. Dogs' foo'l, like all other 
 food, is scarce by reason of tl>e poor salmon run in the river last 
 season ; practically none were caught near here, and the result 
 is the dog owners have to use bacon for food, which at twenty- 
 five to forty r(;nts per pound is (expensive. 
 
 It would require a team of eight dogs to take my (>utfit and my 
 
 N 2 
 
 .. ^ 
 
404 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ' it 
 
 /^/;I 
 
 'Fl .11 
 
 man Fawcett with our provisions and the dogs' food as far as 
 Taiya. There, the dogs would have to be abandoned or killed, 
 as they are worthless on the coast except to parties coming in 
 here early in the scison. Starting from here say December 
 1st, it would be February before I reached Ottawa, and during 
 thirty-five or forty days of this time we would be exposed to much 
 cold and hardship and some hazard from storms. 
 
 The journey has been m;ide, and I would not hesitate to 
 undertake it were things more reasonable here and dog food 
 plentiful, but it would take at least ijjiiooo to equip us with 
 transport and outfit, which sum I think I can expend more in 
 the interests of the country by remaining here and working a 
 survey of the Klondvke of the miners — a mispronunciation of tlie 
 Indian word or words " Thron-dak " or " duick," which means 
 plenty offish, from the fact that it is a famous salmon stream. 
 It is marked Tondak on our maps. It joins the Yukon from 
 the east — a few miles above the site of T'ort Reliance — about 
 fifty miles above here. As I have already intimated, rich 
 placer mines of gold were discovered on the branches of 
 this stream. The discovery, I believe, was due to the reports of 
 Indians. A white man named G. W. Cormack, who worked 
 with me in 1887, was the first to take advantage of the rumours 
 and locate a claim on the first branch which was named by the 
 miners Bonan/ja Creek. Cormack located late in August, but 
 had to cut some logs for the mill here to get a few pounds of 
 provisions to enable him to begin work on his claim. The 
 fishing at Klcjndyke having totally failed him, he returned with a 
 few weeks' provisions for himself, his wife and brother-in-law 
 (Indians), and another Indian, in the last days of August, and 
 immediately set about working the claim. As he was very short 
 of appliances he could only put together a rather defective 
 apparatus to wash the gravel with. Tlu; gravel itself he had to 
 carry in a box on his back from thirty to a hundred feet ; not- 
 withstanding this, the three men working very irregularly 
 washed out lii!i2o() in eight days, and Cormack asserts with 
 reason that had he proper facilities if could have been done in 
 two days, besides Inning several hundred dollars more g(jld 
 which was lost in the tailings through defective apparatus. 
 
 On the same creek two men rocked out lii>75 in about four 
 
ill 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 405 
 
 hours, and it is asserted that two men in the same creek took out 
 !|{>40o8 m two days with only two Iciif^ths of sluice boxes. This 
 last is doubted, but Mr. Ledue assures me he weighed that much 
 f^old for them, hut it is not positive where they f,'ot it. They 
 were new comers, and had not d(jne much in the country, so the 
 probabilities are they /,'ot it on Bonanza Creek. A branch of 
 Bonanza named Eldorado has prospected magnificently, and 
 ancjther branch named Tilly Creek has prospected well ; in all 
 there are some four or five branches of lionanza Creek which 
 have given good prospects. There are about 170 claims staked 
 on the main ceek, and the branches are good for about as many 
 more, aggregating say 350 claims, which will require over 1000 
 men to work properly. 
 
 A few miles farther up Bear Creek enters Klondyke, and it has 
 been prospected and located on. Compared with Bonanza it 
 is small, and will not afford more than twenty or thirty claims, 
 it is said. About twelve miles above the mouth " Gold Bottom 
 Creek" jcjins Klondyke, and on it and a branch named Hunker 
 
 , 'k, after the discoverer, vtry rich ground has been found. 
 U(.o man showed me r?22"/^ he took (uit in a few hours on 
 Hunker Creek with a gtjld pan, prospecting his claim on the 
 surface, taking a handful here and there as fancy suggested. 
 On " Gold Ijottom Creek " and branches there will probably 
 be two or three hundred claims. The Indians have reported 
 another creek much farther up, which the}' call " Too Much 
 Gold Creek," on which gold is so plentiful, that, as the miners 
 say in joke, " you ha\e to mix gravel with it to sluice it." Up 
 to date nothing definite has been ht'ard from this creek. 
 
 From all this we may, I think, infer th;it we have a district 
 which will give 1000 claims of 500 feet in length each. Now 
 1000 such claims will rccpiire at least jooo men to work them 
 properly, and as wages for working men in tln' mines are from 
 eight to ten dollars per day without board, wt' have every 
 reason to assume that this part of our territory will in a year or 
 two contain 10,000 souls at least. For the coast rm unpre- 
 cedented influx is expected next spring. And this is not all, 
 for a large creek called Ind''Ui Creek joins the Yukon about 
 mid-way between Klondyke and Stewart Rivers, and all along this 
 creek good pay has been found. All that has stood in the way 
 
 I 
 

 ! 
 
 m 
 
 406 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 i 
 
 i, 
 
 ) J 
 
 1 
 
 \ 
 
 1 
 
 1 
 
 • J 
 \ 
 
 1 
 
 i 
 
 '1 
 
 ill 
 
 1 
 
 J 
 
 tit 
 
 of working it heretofore has been the scarcity of provisions, and 
 the difficulty of getting them up there, even when here. Indian 
 Creek is (piite a large strean:i, and it is probable it will yield five 
 or six hundred claims. I'^arther south yet lies the head of 
 several branches of Stewart River, on which some prospectmg 
 has been done this summer, and good indications found, but the 
 want of provisions prevented development. Now gold has been 
 found in several of the streams joining Pelly River, and also all 
 along the Hootalinqua. In the line of these finds farther south 
 is the Cassiar goldfield in British Columbia ; so the presumption 
 is, that we have in our territory along the easterly watershed of 
 the Yukon a gold-bearing belt of indefinite width, and upwards 
 of joo miles long, exclusive of the British Columbia part of it. 
 On the westerly side of the Yukon prospecting has been done 
 on a creek a short distance above Selkirk with a fair amount of 
 success, and on a large creek some thirty or forty miles below 
 Selkirk fair prospects have been found, but as has been before 
 remarked, the difficulty of getting supplies up here prevents any 
 extensive or extended prospecting. 
 
 Dalton informed me he had found good prospects on a small 
 creek nearly mid-way between the Coast Range and Selkirk in 
 his route. His man showed me some coarse gold, about a dollar s 
 worth, he found on the head of a branch of the Altsek River, 
 near the head of Chilkat Inlet, which is inside the summit of 
 the Coast Range, and, of course, in our territory. Vxow. this 
 you will gather that we have a very large area all more or less 
 gold-bearing, and which will all yet be worked. 
 
 Gold quartiJ has been found in places just across the line on 
 Davis Cre(?k (see my map of the 141st sent you), but, of 
 what is unknown, as it is in the bed of the creek and covered 
 with gravel. Good quartz is also reported on the hills around 
 Bona n/a Cret'k, but of this I will be able to speak more fully 
 after my proposed survey. It is pretty certain from information 
 I have got from prospectors that all or nearly all of the 
 northerly branch of White River is on our side of the line, 
 and copper is found on it, but more abundantly on the 
 southerly branch, of which a great portion is in our territory 
 also ; so it is probable we have that metal toe. I have seen 
 here several lumps of native copper brought by the natives 
 
 ii! If 
 
11 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 407 
 
 from " White River," but just from what part is uncertain. I 
 have also seen a specimen of silver ore said to have been picked 
 up in a creek flowinj,' into Bennett Lake, about fourteen miles 
 down it on the east side. 
 
 I think this is etiouj^'h to show that we may look forward 
 with confidence to a fairly brif,'ht future for this part of the 
 tcrritoiy. 
 
 When it was fairly established that Bonan;ja Creek was 
 rich in gold, which took a few days, for Klondykc had been 
 prospected several times with no encouraginj,' result, there was 
 a great rush from all over the courtry adjacent to Forty Mile. 
 The town was almost deserted; men who had been in a chronic 
 state of drunkenness for weeks were pitched into boats as 
 Indlast and taken up to stake themselves a claim, and claims 
 were staked by men for their friends who were not in the 
 country at the time. All this gave rise to much conflict and 
 confusion, there being no one present to take charge of matters, 
 the agent being unable to go up and attend to the thing, and 
 myself not yet knowing what to do, so that the miners held a 
 meeting and appointed one of themselves to measure off and 
 stake the claims, and record the owner's name in connection 
 therewith, for which he got a fee of ^2'oo, it being of course 
 understood that each clanii-holder would have to record his 
 claim with the D minion agent and pay his fee of !ii>i5'oo. 
 
 At the same meeting they discussed our law on mining, and 
 discovered, as they thought, that it was very defective. They 
 appointed a committee to wait on the agent and ask him to 
 ratify their course in appointing the surveyor and recorder to 
 act pro tern, on the creek, and to forward their views on the 
 law to the department at Ottawa. Now it appears to me that 
 a good deal of fault of the law as they found it lay in the fact 
 that they did not read it in all its proper connection ; and 
 because the printed law did not start out from a given point 
 and detail consecutively what was to be done under every 
 possible contingency that might arise, under that reading they 
 thought it defective, I brliove this to be the case, because I 
 have never had any difiir .Ity in explaining any case that has 
 been submitted to me for an opinion; and there have been a 
 good many. 
 
4o8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 
 III /ff 
 
 !;l i! 
 
 The miners, as a rule, are dissatisfied with the claims laid 
 out for them by their own surveyor, appointed as I have already 
 intimated, and many of them are claiming for a remeasurement 
 now that they know I am going to make a survey of the creeks. 
 In fact many of them thought that a survey of the creeks 
 necessarily meant a survey and adjustment of the claims, and 
 it took me some time to correct that impression. I made them 
 understand that as the claims had been laid out by their 
 own act, and had been approved of by the agent, I could not 
 interfere without the consent and approval of all the original 
 parties to the act, and that they would have to meet and 
 discuss the questions and determine whether they would have 
 them adjusted or not. If they decide to have it done, I made 
 them understand they would have to assist me at work as I 
 passed along. If they do not recpiire it, I will take the 
 necessary steps to enable me to picjt very closely where every 
 claim is. I may yet make a good deal of the survey by photo- 
 graph as I have about ten dozen good plates yet. In any case, 
 I will occupy several photo stations to enable me to give some 
 idea of the mountain ranges around — if any — and supplement 
 my views from the boundary last winter. As soon as this is 
 done my men will take their discharge, Adam b'awcctt going 
 into the service of the Alaska Commercial Company, and all 
 the rest mining. 
 
 If you want any further surveys made in here, men will have 
 to be sent to do it, for men c;uui(jt be had here for less than 
 $5"oo to .^i()"oo per day. Any man sent in for survey purposes 
 will require to bring a good canoe with him, say nineteen feet 
 long and forty-four inches widi , and eighteen to two and a lialf 
 deep. vSuch a canoe will l)ring in five or six men, and their 
 stock of proxisions for the trip. P>y the time th(;y would arrive 
 here |)rovisi()ns will i)e plentiful, for the bvxits will tJKMi be 
 up from Circle City, where two of them are probably winter- 
 ing. A party crossing the summit early in June would 
 just about liiid the lakes open for the run down. You might 
 warn any such \y.ivty tha< th*y had b(;tter run no risk at the 
 canon, White iiorse and l^ A""' Fingers. The canon is not 
 dangerous, but th<H;o is a gow^ portagt; past it. The rapids 
 between it and Whitf Horse arc rough in high water, but with care 
 
I 
 
 rm 
 
 TiiE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 409 
 
 are safe. A ^^rcat many larj^'c boats run the White Horse, but 
 most of them take more or less water ; many iill altof^ether and 
 the owners are often drowned ; in any case they lose all their 
 effects if they do escape. A careful estimate of those drowned 
 in 1895 places the number at thirteen, a large percentaj,'e, I 
 think, of those who tried it. The l'"iv(; I'ingers are at certain 
 stages of the water uncertain. Last time I came down I found 
 it very nice on the left side — no danger at all, while boats 
 passing the right side took in water. In every case the party 
 m charge will do well to carefully examine beforehand all the 
 points named. Should you deem it advisable for myself to 
 return early in the summer, I will have to make my way around 
 by the mouth, as I will have no men to help me upstream, and 
 no one will be ascending the river until near September, and 
 indeed very few do it at all now. Any party coming in would 
 reasonably be expected in before I started down, and I could 
 confer with them on the w(;rk to be done, should you deem it 
 advisable to do so. 
 
 In the course of a year I believe coal will supersede wood for 
 fuel, which will relieve the demand as far as t(jwns and villages 
 are concerned, but mining interests will require a lot of fuel 
 where coal cannot be taken. 
 
 The traffic in liquor will have to be taken hold of and 
 regulated at once ; it is here now and cannot be kept out by 
 any reasonably practical nnians. The majority — the great 
 majority of miners — will have it, and all th(; more will their 
 predilection be if it is attempted to stop the entry of it. 
 
 In my opinion it is imperative that this business Ik; brought 
 under control at once, or it may develop phases that will be at 
 least annoying in the near futun;. 
 
 I have in previous reports intimated that some sort of legal 
 machinery is absolutely necessary for the tri.ii of cases of 
 contract, collection of debts, and gi^nerally the judicial interests 
 of the country. There are several cases of hardship now for 
 the want of a proper court. 
 
 If some sort of court, to satisfy the necessities of the people 
 in business here, is not at once established, serious incon- 
 venience will result. The officer appointed will rcMjuire to be a 
 hale, vigorous person, for it is probable he will have to make 
 
 .' 
 
4IO 
 
 THE YUKON TERklTOUV 
 
 1 
 'J. ,1 
 
 H 
 
 4 
 
 \ 
 
 
 K < 
 
 journeys of considerable lenj^th across unoccupied country in 
 the discharfje of his duty. 
 
 There have been several applications for land in the vicinity 
 of the mouth of the Klondyke, and Inspector Constantine has 
 selected a reserve for {,'overnnient jjiirposcs at the conlluence 
 of that stream with the Yukon, forty acres in extent. 
 
 A court or office of record in real estate transactions will 
 require to be opened here at once. A recorder was appointed 
 i' T'orty Mile, and a plot made in 1894. In anticipation of my 
 j^oinfj out this fall I j;ot a meetinj^' held of the property owners, 
 and had them hand th(; records over to me for the information 
 of the department. They are in my possession yet, and I will 
 take them out with me when I go. They are rather crude in 
 form, and require an initiale to understand them. I act as 
 recorder pro tan. 
 
 Before closing I may say that every report that comes from 
 Bonanza Creek is more encouraging than the last. Prospecting 
 has only begun, and up to date of mailing, November 22nd, 
 very rich prospects have been found on the few claims 
 prospected on ; from one dollar to the pan of dirt up to twelve 
 dollars are reported, and no bed rock found yet. This means 
 from $1000 to $12,000 per day per man sluicing. 
 
 The excitement is intense, but at this season of the year it is 
 naturally very local. 
 
 I expect a mail will be starting from here in January, and I 
 will try to send out a short report by it embracing events up-to- 
 date. 
 
 Kort Cudahy. 
 
 9th Dec, 1896, 
 
 A MAIL left here for the outside on the 27th ult. by which I 
 sent you an interim report, which will probably reach you in 
 January. From it you will learn how I came to be caught in 
 the country, and why I have not attempted to get out in 
 winter. As you are as likely to get that report as you are this 
 one, I refrain from repeating more here than to say that should 
 it be necessary for me to go out before summer, I will try and 
 get out by dog team, starting in the last days of February or 
 
. |('?IT 
 
 TIIK YUKON TEKKITOKV 
 
 411 
 
 (Mrly in March, when the days an; lon;^ and the weather mild, 
 {^'ettin;^' out, say early in May. 
 
 Since my last the prospects on Honan;ja Creek and tributaries 
 are increasing in richness and extent, until now it is certain 
 that millions will be taken out of the district in the next few 
 years. 
 
 On some of the claims prospected the pay dirt is of great 
 extent and very rich. One m.Mi told me yesterday that he 
 washed out a single pan of dirt on one of the claims on Bonanza 
 and found $I4'25 in it. Of course, that may be an exception- 
 ally rich pan, but ^^ to fjjSj pc;r pan is the average on that claim 
 it is reported, with five feet of pay flirt and the width yet 
 undetermined, but it is known t(j be thirty feet even at that ; 
 figure the result at nine or ten pans to the cubic foot, .iiui 500 
 feet long : nearly •'$4,000,000, at $5 per pan — one fourth of this 
 would be enormous. 
 
 Another claim has been prospected to such an extent that it 
 is known there is about five feet of pay dirt, averaging ^2 per 
 pan, and width not less than thirty feet. ICncjiigh prospecting 
 has been done to show that there are at least fifteen miles of 
 this extraordinary richness, and the indications are that we will 
 have three or four that extent, if not all e(]ual to the above at 
 least very rich. 
 
 It appears a great deal of staking for absentees has been done, 
 some of whom have turned up, and some have not. This has 
 caused confusion, and leads to a good deal of what might be 
 called fraud, for it is easy fen- a few in the inner circU' to know 
 what claims have been recorded in accordtmce with the law, and 
 what have not. They can for themselves, directly or through 
 the intervention of a friend, have the latter jumped f(jr their 
 whole or partial interest. It appears this has been done in 
 several instances. 
 
 I think the department should get large posters printed, on 
 which shall be shown the sections of tin: l.iw governing the 
 location and recording of (juartz and placer mines, the extent f)f 
 each, the duties of miners in both cases, and the rulings of the 
 department on the (juestions I have submitted, with the 
 penalties attached to (jffences against the law. Some of these 
 should be printed on stout paper or parchment capable of 
 
 I. 
 
 Ill m 
 
 I 
 
r^ 
 
 412 
 
 TIIK YUKON Ti:URITORV 
 
 11' 
 
 /h 
 
 ii *. 
 
 standing,' exposure to the weather, ruid posted at every important 
 ])oiiit ill tile coiintry, so tliat then- may he no excuse hi;reaiter 
 for if^Mioiauce. 
 
 A larf,'e numher of copies of the iniiiinf^ act, land act, and 
 timher and hay land rej^'ulations should also he sent in. 
 
 As to tin; extent of mining' districts, they should, I think, i)e 
 made Vdv^v, and section 21 amended to (Miahle a man who 
 has located a claim which does not pa}- a reasonahle return 
 on the outlay the lirst si'iisou after his claim has been pros- 
 pected, to make a second location in the same locality or district, 
 provided he can (ind one in it. The aj^^iuit would have to 
 determine whether or not he had expended the pn^per amount 
 of labour on his claim to '^vt r(;asoiiable returns ; this I know 
 opens the door for a lot of trouble and, maybe, fraud, but on the 
 other hand a f^reat many worthy men suffer from the want of 
 some such rej^'ulation, and as very few would be in a position to 
 take advantage of such a provision until after their second 
 season, there would hardly be anythinf,' left for them to take- 
 Enterprisinj,' men who would work almost continuously niij^ht 
 fijet some benefit — probably would — but no others, so such a 
 rcf^ulation could not do very much harm, and mij,dit help some 
 deservinj,^ people. As it is now, men stake claims on nearly 
 every new find, s(Mne having several claims in the Klondyke 
 locality. They know, I believe, that they will not be able to 
 hold them, but, as the localities are not yet clearly defined, they 
 can hold on to them for a while, and fnially by collusion with 
 others actjuire an interest in them. 
 
 The miners here are, I understand, getting up a petition to 
 the Minister of the Interior, asking for aid in (jpeiiing a way to 
 the south and building along it a shelter for winter travellers, 
 with suitable supplies scattered along. 
 
 As it is n(nv, a winter trip out from here is, on account of the 
 long haul and want of shelter, tedious and ha/ardous, and their 
 representations are worthy t>f consideration. 
 
 Fort (lulaliy, 
 
 nth J;u)., 1.S97. 
 
 The reports from Klondyke region are still \(.'ry encouraging ; 
 so much so, that all the other creeks around are practically 
 
 l;:^^''|. 
 
;.;7. 
 
 o 
 
 o 
 
 y. 
 o 
 
 o 
 ■x 
 
 w 
 
 H 
 
 I (i 
 


 
 IMAGE EVALUATION 
 TEST TARGET (MT-3) 
 
 // 
 
 
 
 y. 
 
 f/i 
 
 
 1.0 
 
 I.I 
 
 11.25 
 
 ?■ MS 1110 
 
 LA. 11116 
 
 Hiotographic 
 
 Sciences 
 
 Corporation 
 
 4 
 
 ^1 
 
 V 
 
 :1>' 
 
 :\ 
 
 \ 
 
 *> 
 ^ * 
 
 ^.^^. 
 
 
 '^'^' 
 
 O^ 
 
 23 WK '^AIN STRUT 
 
 WIBSTIR, N.Y. MSSO 
 
 (716) •73-4503 
 
 9,^ 
 
.^. 
 
 ^^A^ 
 k^.. %> 
 
 Md 
 
 «!?/' 
 
 O^ 
 
fM 
 
 I 
 
 
' »i;l 
 
 1,;^' 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 4M 
 
 abandoned, especially those on the head of Forty Mile in 
 American territory, and nearly loo men have made their way up 
 from Circle City, many of them hauling their sleds themselves. 
 Those who cannot get claims are buying in those already 
 located. Men cannot be got to work for love or money, and 
 development is consequently slow ; one and a half dollars per 
 hour is the wages paid the few men who have to work for hire, 
 and work as many hours as they like. 
 
 Some of the claims are so rich that every night a few pans of 
 dirt suffices to pay the hired help where there is any ; as high 
 as $204*00 has been reported to a single pan, but this is not 
 generally credited. Claim-owners are now very reticent about 
 what they get, so you can hardly credit anything you hear ; but 
 one thing is certain, we have one of the richest mining areas 
 ever found, with a fair prospect that we have not yei discovered 
 its limits. 
 
 Miller and Glacier Creeks, on the head of Sixty Mile River, 
 which my survey of the 141st meridian determined to be in 
 Canada, were thought to be very rich, but they are both poor 
 in quality and quantity compared with Klondyke. 
 
 Chicken Creek, on the head of Forty Mile in Alaska, dis- 
 covered a year ago p.nd rated very high, is to-day practically 
 abandoned. 
 
 • • • • • • • 
 
 Some quartz prospecting has been done in the Klondyke 
 region, and it is probable that some good veins will be found 
 there. Coal is found on the upper part of Klondyke, so that the 
 facilities for working it if found are good and convenient. 
 
 [Mr. Ogilvie has subsequently (in November, 1897) given the 
 following account of the discovery of gold on the Klondyke.] 
 
 The discovery of the gold on the Klondyke, as it is called — 
 the proper name of the creek is an Indian one, Thronda — was 
 made by three n>en, Robert Henderson, Frank Swanson, ;\nd 
 another one named Munson, who in July, 1896, were prospecting 
 on Indian Creek. They proceeded up the creek without finding 
 
414 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 
 sufficient to satisfy them until they reached Dominion Creek, 
 and after prospecting there they crossed over the divide and 
 found Gold Bottom, got good prospects, and went to work. 
 
 Provisions running short, they decided to make their way to 
 Sixty Mile to obtain a fresh supply, and went up Indian Creek 
 to the Yukon to Sixty Mile, where Harper had established 
 a trading post. Striking upwards on Forty Mile they came 
 across a man, a Californian who was fishing in company 
 with two Indians. The Indians were Canadian Indians, or 
 King George men, as they proudly called themselves. Now, 
 one of the articles of the miner's code of procedure is that 
 when he makes a discovery he shall lose no time in proclaiming 
 it, and the man felt bound to make the prospectors acquainted 
 with the information that there was a rich pay to be got in 
 Gold Bottom. The two Indians showed a route to this creek, 
 and from there they crossed over the high ridge to Bonanza. 
 
 From there to El Dorado is three miles, and they climbed 
 up over the ridge between it and Bonanza, and reaching 
 between Klondyke and Indian Creeks, they went down into 
 Gold Bottom. Here they did half a day's prospecting, and 
 came back, striking into Bonanza about ten miles beyond, 
 where they took out from a little nook a pan which encouraged 
 them to try further. In a few moments more they had taken 
 out $1275. A discovery claim was located, and also one 
 above and below for the two Indians. 
 
 In August, i8g6, the leader, generally known as Siwash 
 George, because he lived with the Indians, went down to 
 Forty Mile to get provisions. He met several miners on his 
 way and told them of his find, showing the !j>i275 which he 
 had put in an old Winchester cartridge. They would not 
 believe him, his reputation for truth being somewhat below 
 par. The miners said that he was the greatest liar this side of 
 — a great many places. 
 
 They came to me finally and asked me my opinion, and I 
 pointed out to them that there was no question about his 
 having the $1275 in gold ; the only question was, therefore, 
 where he had got it. He had not been up Miller or Glacier 
 Creek, nor Forty Mile. Then followed the excitement. Boat 
 load after boat load of men went up at once. Men who had 
 
Y. 
 
 i\ 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 415 
 
 been drunk for weeks and weeks, in fact, were tumbled into 
 the boats and taken up without being conscious that they were 
 travelling. 
 
 One man who went up was so drunk that he did not wake 
 up to realization that he was being taken by boat until a third 
 of the journey had been accomplished, and he owns one of the 
 very best claims on the Klondyke to-day. The whole creek, a 
 distance of about twenty miles, giving in the neighbourhood of 
 two hundred claims, was staked in a few weeks. El Dorado 
 Creek, seven and a half or eight miles long, providing eighty 
 claims, was staked in about the same length of time. 
 
 Boulder, Adams, and other gulches were prospected, and 
 gave good surface showings, gold being found in the gravel in 
 the creeks. Good surface prospects may be taken as an 
 indication of the existence of very fair bed-rock. It was in 
 December that the character of the diggings was established. 
 Twenty-one above discovery on Bonanza was the one which 
 first proved the value of the district. The owner of this claim 
 was in the habit of cleaning up a couple of tubfuls every night, 
 and paying his workmen at the rate of a dollar and a half an 
 hour. Claim No. 5, Eldorado, was the next notable one, and 
 here the pan of $112 was taken out. That was great. There 
 was then a pan of even greater amount on No. 6, and they 
 continued to run up every day. 
 
 The news went down to Circle City, which emptied itself at 
 once and came up to Dawson. The miners came up any way 
 they could, at all hours of the day and night, with provisions 
 and without supplies. On their arrival they found that the 
 whole creeks had been staked months before. A good many 
 Canadians, who were in their talk out-and-out Americans, 
 came up to Canadian territory with a certain expectation of 
 realizing something out of this rich ground by reason of their 
 nationality. One of them, particularly, on finding that he was 
 too late, cursed his luck, and said that it was awfully strange 
 that a man could not get a footing in his own country. 
 
 Another of these men who arrived too late was an Irishman, 
 when he found he could not get a claim he went up and down 
 the creek, trying to bully the owners into selling, boasting 
 that he had a pull at Ottawa, and threatening to have the claims 
 
 t<> 
 
 
4i6 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 M' 
 
 i 
 
 cut down from 500 to 250 feet. He came along one day and 
 offered to wager $2000 that before August ist they would be 
 reduced to 250 feet. One of the men to whom he had made 
 this offer came and asked me about it. I said to him, " Do 
 you gamble ? " His reply was " A little." Then I told him 
 that he was never surer of 1^2000 than he would have been if 
 he had taken that bet. 
 
 This ran to such an extent that I put up notices to the effect 
 that the length of the claims was regulated by Act of Parlia- 
 ment of Canada, and that no change could be made except by 
 that Parliament, and telling the miners to take no notice of 
 the threats that had been made. 
 
 Jim White then adopted another dodge, locating a fraction 
 between 36 and ^y, thinking that by getting in between he 
 could force the owners to come to his terms, forgetting that 
 .the law of this country does not allow any man to play the 
 hog. For three or four days this state of things kept the men 
 in an uproar. I was making my survey, and getting towards 
 36 and 37 ; when I got near, I delayed my operations and went 
 up to 36, finding there would be no fraction, or at least an 
 insignificant one of inches. 
 
 I took my time, and in the meantime the owner of 36 became 
 very uneasy, and White also. I set in a stake down in the 
 hollow until I saw how much fraction there was. I found only 
 a few inches. I was very tedious with this portion of the 
 work, and the man who was with me seemed to have quite a 
 difficulty in fixing the stake. Then I went down with the 
 remark that I would do that myself. I had made it a rule 
 never to tell anyone whether there was a fraction until it was 
 parked on the post. 
 
 While I was standing by the post, Jim White came up to 
 me. He had a long way to go down the creek, he said — and 
 he did not want to wait any longer than was necessary. 
 " Well," I said, " I can't tell you just yet exactly how much of 
 a fraction it will be— but something about three inches." 
 ^That is how Jim comes to be known as " Three Inch White." 
 
 Bonanza and El Dorado Creeks afford between them 278 
 claims ; the several affluences will yield as many more, and all 
 of these claims are good. I have no hesitation in saying that 
 
m. 
 
 THE YUKON TERUrTOKY 
 
 417 
 
 the 
 tc a 
 the 
 rule 
 was 
 
 ties, 
 ite." 
 
 278 
 dall 
 
 that 
 
 about a hundred of those on Bonanza will yield upwards of 
 $30,000,000. Claim 30 below, on El Dorado, will yield a 
 million in itself, and ten others will yield from a hundred 
 thousand dollars up. These two creeks will, I am quite 
 confident, turn out from 360,000,000 to $75,000,000, and I can 
 safely say that there is no other region in the world of the 
 same extent that has afforded in the same length of time so 
 many homestakes — fortunes enabling the owners to go home 
 and enjoy the remainder of their days— considering that tlie 
 work has had to be done with very limited facilities, the 
 scarcity of provisions and of labour, and that the crudest 
 appliances only are as yet available. When I tell you that to 
 properly work each claim ten or twelve men are required, and 
 only 200 were available that season, it will give you an idea of 
 the difficulties which had to be contended with. 
 
 On Bear Creek, about seven or eight miles above that, good 
 claims have been found, and on Gold Bottom, Hunker, Last 
 Chance, and Cripple Creeks. On Gold Bottom, as high as 
 $15 to the pan has been taken, and on Hunker Creek the same, 
 and although we cannot say that they are as rich as El Dorado 
 or Bonanza, they are richer than any other creeks known in 
 that country. Then, thirty-five miles higher up the Klondyke, 
 Too-Much-Gold Creek was found. It obtained its name from 
 the fact that the Indians who discovered it saw mica glistening 
 at the bottom, and, thinking it was gold, said there wa^ " too 
 much gold — more gold than gravel." 
 
 A fact I am now going to state to you, and one that is easily 
 demonstrated, is that from Telegraph Creek northward to the 
 boundary line we have in the Dominion and in this province an 
 area of from 550 to 600 miles in length, and from 100 to 150 
 miles in width, over the whole of which rich prospects have 
 been found. We must have from 90,000 to 100,000 square 
 miles, which, with proper care, judicious handling, and better 
 facilities for the transportation of food and utensils, will be the 
 largest, as it is the richest, goldfield the world has ever 
 known. 
 
 Stewart and Pelly, in the gold-bearing zone, also give 
 promising indications. Everywhere good pay has been found 
 on the bars, and there is no reason why, when good pay is 
 
 Q a 
 
 t| 
 
4i8 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 ! 
 
 f iM 
 
 i' ' 
 
 i 
 
 I 
 
 obtained on the bars, the results should not be richer in the 
 creeks The Klondyke was prospected for forty miles up in 
 1887 without anything being found, and again in 1893 with a 
 similar lack of result, but the difference is seen when the right 
 course is taken, and this was led up to by Robert Henderson. 
 This man is a born prospector, and you could not persuade 
 him to stay on even the richest claim on Bonanza. He started 
 up in a small boat to spend this summer and winter on Stewart 
 River, prospecting. That is the stuff the true prospector is 
 made of, and I am proud to say that he is a Canadian. 
 
 In regard to quartz claims, seven have already been located 
 in the vicinity of Forty Mile and Dawson, and there is also a 
 mountain of gold-bearing ore in the neighbourhood yielding $5 
 to $7 a ton. The question to be considered is whether with 
 that return it will pay to work under the peculiar conditions 
 which exist, and the enormous freight rates charged for trans- 
 portation for anything of that kind. 
 
 About forty miles further up the river two large claims have 
 been located by a mining expert hailing from the United States, 
 and who has had considerable experience in Montana and 
 other mineral States, and he assured me that the extent of the 
 lode is such that these two claims are greater than any proposi- 
 tion in the world, going from $3 to §11 a ton. On Bear 
 Creek a quartz claim was located last winter, and I drev/ up 
 the papers for the owner. He had to swear that he had found 
 gold ; he swore that he did, and he told me the amount, which, 
 if true, will make it one of the most valuable properties that 
 exists in the country. 
 
 On Gold Bottom another claim has been located, and I made 
 a test of the ore. I had no sieve, and had to employ a hand 
 mortar, which you who know anything of the work will under- 
 stand would not give best results. The poorest result obtained 
 was, however, $ioo to the ton, while the richest was $1000. 
 Of course, I do not know what the extent of the claim is, but 
 the man who found it said that from the rock exposed the 
 deposit must be considerable in extent. He didn't know 
 whether the exposure was the result of a slide, but said that it 
 would be an easy matter to find the lode. 
 
 About thirty miles up the Klondyke another claim was 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 419 
 
 located, and the man swore that it was rich, althouprh he 
 wouldn't say how rich. 
 
 On El Dorado and Bonanza, the gold obtained on the 
 different benches has about the same value, that is, it has about 
 the same degree of fineness, and is worth about $16 per oz., and 
 as you go down the creek this value decreases to abou* $I5"25. 
 From that point, however, it increases again, and from this the 
 inference appears to be plain that the same lode runs right 
 across the region that these creeks cut through, which is proved 
 still more surely by the fact that the value increases as you 
 strike Hunker, and in the other direction Miller and Glacier. 
 The nuggets found in El Dorado and Bonanza show no 
 evidence of having travelled any great distance, and some I 
 have are as rough as though they had been hammered out of 
 the mother lode. 
 
 That mother lode is yet to be found in the ridges between the 
 creeks, and when it is found it may be discovered to consist of 
 several large lodes, or a succession of small ones that may not 
 pay to work. 
 
 On Stewart and Pelly Rivers, some prospecting has been 
 done and gold found, and on the Hootalinqua in 1895 good pay 
 was discovered, and the richness of the gold increases as work 
 is continued further down. Some men, working fifteen feet 
 down, found coarse gold, when the water drove them out, and 
 they had to abandon the work and come out, determined to 
 return ; but they did not go back, as in the meantime the 
 Klondyke excitement knocked that place out. 
 
 Gold has been found at the head of Lake Labarge, on the 
 stream flowing into the lake at this point. In fact, there is 
 gold everywhere in this zone, which is 500 miles long by 150 
 wide. Prospects, too, are to be found on the Dalton Trail, on 
 the other side of the Yukon River. A man, riding along the 
 Altsek Trail, was thrown from his horse, and, in falling, caught 
 at the branch of a tree. As he drew himself up, he saw sf)me- 
 thing shining on the rock which fixed his attention at once. 
 He picked it up and found that it was gold. Other excellent 
 prospects have also been found along the same creek. From 
 these circumstances and discoveries it may be assumed that in 
 all this country there is gold, while in this particular zone it is 
 
 i^ 
 
420 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 hfi 
 
 i 
 
 especially abundant. This zone lies outside of the Rocky 
 Mountains, J\nd distant from them about 150 miles. 
 
 Another product of the country that demands attention is 
 copper. It is doubtless to be found somewhere in that 
 district in great abundance, although the location of the main 
 deposit has yet to be discovered. Mr. Harper was shown a 
 large piece of pure copper in the possession of the Indians — 
 indeed I have seen it myself. It comes from the vicinity of the 
 "White River somewhere — ^just where has yet to be disclosed. 
 Silver has also been found, and lead, while to work our precious 
 metals we have coal in abundance. It is to be found in the 
 Rocky Mountains, or, rather, the ridge of high mountains 
 running parallel to them in the interior. A deposit of coal in 
 this range runs right through our territory. At two points, 
 near Forty Mile, it also crops out, in one place only about 
 forty feet from the River Yukon. Further up the Yukon, on 
 one of its many smaller feeders, at Fifteen Mile Creek and on 
 the head of the Thronda, there are also out-croppings of coal. 
 On the branches of the Stewart and on some of the Five 
 Fingers of the Yukon coal is also exposed. In fact, there is any 
 amount of coal in the country with which to work our minerals 
 when we can get in the necessary facilities. 
 
 Regarding the surface of the country and the difficulties of 
 prospecting : Passing down the river in a boat one sees a suc- 
 cession of trees, ten, twelve, fourteen and sixteen inches in 
 diameter, and he naturally comes to the conclusion that it is a 
 well-timbered country. And so it is, along the margin of the 
 river. But let him land and go inland, and he will find the 
 ground covered with what is locally known as " nigger grass." 
 This is a coarse grass which each year is killed and falls, 
 tangling in such a way as to make pedestrian progress all but 
 impossible, tripping one up every few feet. It is, as might be 
 imagined, a most difficult thing to walk through this grass, great 
 areas of which are found all through the district. And where 
 these areas are found the miners avoid them as they would the 
 plague. 
 
 For the rest of the country the rocks are covered by one foot 
 to two of moss — and underneath, the everlasting ice. On this 
 a scrubby growth of trees is found, extending up the mountains. 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 421 
 
 It is this which appears to those passing down the river in 
 boats to be a continuation of the good timber seen along the 
 banks. Timber that is fit for anything is scarce, and \vc should 
 husband it carefully. Our timber has built Circle City. Our 
 timber has served all the purposes of the Upper Yukon 
 country. A large amount of timber is required, and what we 
 have we should keep for our own use, particularly as the ground 
 has to be burned to be worked. 
 
 Above the timber line you come to the bare rocks — the crests 
 bare save where clothed with a growth of lichen on which the 
 caribou feed. There is no timber in the way here — no moss 
 and no brush. The miners in travelling consequently keep as 
 much as possible to the top of the ridge. 
 
 Bedrock prospecting necessarily has to be reserved for the 
 winter. First the moss has to be cleared away, and then the 
 muck — or decayed rubbish and vegetable matter. The fire is 
 applied to burn down to bedrock. The frost in the ground 
 gives way before the fire, ten, twelve, or perhaps sixteen inches 
 in a day. The next day the fire has to be again applied, and 
 so the work proceeds until gravel is reached. It may be twenty 
 feet or so below the surface, in which case it is usually reached 
 in about twenty days. Prospecting is now commenced — that 
 is, a pan or two of dirt is washed to determine whether it is 
 worth keeping or not — the refuse is thrown on one side of the 
 hole, and the paying dirt on the other. Near to and on bed- 
 rock the pay is found, which is generally not more than two or 
 three feet deep. Having burned down to the bedrock and 
 found the paystreak, you start drifting in the direction of the 
 best pay. The distance this process can be conducted depends 
 on the thickness of the crust on top. If this is soft, you may 
 drift thirty feet with safety, when a new hole or shaft must be 
 sunk and the drifting continued. Very few people have the 
 good fortune to succeed with one shaft ; prospecting holes as 
 many as twenty or thirty must be dug until you cut the whole 
 valley across before you find pay. The next man may strike it 
 at the first hole. To give you an instance: One man put down 
 eleven holes, and didn't find anything, and yet other men had 
 confidence enough in the claim to pay $2500 for a half interest 
 in it, knowing that the owner had put in eleven holes and found 
 
422 
 
 THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 I 
 
 I, 
 
 nothing, a fact which will go to prove the character of the 
 country. 
 
 After you have worked until April or May the water begins to 
 run, and the trouble is that the water accumulates and you 
 cannot work, as it puts out the fires which have been used to 
 thaw out and soften the ground. Then the dams are built, 
 timber prepared, and the sluice-boxes put in to wash the 
 dump. 
 
 In one clean-up eighty pounds avoirdupois of gold was taken 
 out, or a total value of about $i6,qoo. The dump from which 
 this partial return was obtained contained in all $110,000, the 
 result of the united efforts of five or six men, at 3i'5o per hour, 
 for upwards of six months, not inclutjin}.'; the labour of sluicing. 
 You can understand, therefore, that although the pay is very 
 rich, it is not exactl}' all profit. 
 
 One man, who owns a claim on El Dorado and one on 
 Bonanza, has sold out, so it is said, for a million dollars. He 
 went into the country a poor man, with the intention of raising 
 sufficient money to pay off the mortgage on his place. He has, 
 I believe, not only done so, but paid off those of all his 
 neighbours. 
 
 Although these creeks are rich — and, as I have told you, more 
 men have made homestakes (fortunes) there than anywhere else 
 in the world — I do not wish you to look only on the bright side 
 of the picture. An American from Seattle came in June, i8g6, 
 to the Forty Mile, with his wife, with the intention of bettering 
 his condition. They went out again last July with $52,000. I 
 was well acquainted with this man, a very decent, intelligent 
 man. He told me one day that if he could remain in this 
 country from three to five years, and go out with $5000, he 
 would consider himself in luck. He has gone out with $52,000, 
 and after the prospecting he has done, a little in the middle 
 and at one end of the claim, he believes that he has $1,500,000 
 there. 
 
 On the other hand, however, a Scotchman named Marks has 
 been in there for eleven years. I have known him well, and 
 once last fall when he was sick, I asked him how long he had 
 been mining. His reply was forty-two years — in all parts of 
 the world, except in Australia. In reply to the question as to 
 
THE YUKON TERRITORY 
 
 423 
 
 whether he had ever made his stake, he told me he had never 
 yet made more than a living, and very often that was a scanty 
 one. This, of course, is the opposite extreme. I could quote 
 scores of cases similar to that, so that I would not have you 
 look too much on the bright side. 
 
 There are men in that country who are poor, and who will 
 remain so. It has not been their " luck," as they call it, to 
 strike it rich. But I may say that that country offers to men of 
 great fortitude and sci me intelligence and steadiness an oppor- 
 tunity to make more money in a given time than they possibly 
 could make anywhere else. You have, of course ;- good deal 
 to contend with ; your patience will be sorely t»i' 1,, for the 
 conditions are so unique that they have surprised many who 
 have gone in, and they have left in disgust. 
 
 We have there a vast region comprising Irom go,coo to 
 100,000 cuare miles of untold possibilities. Rich deposits we 
 know to exist, and all may be as rich. We know now that there 
 IS sufficient to supply a population of a hundred thousand 
 people, and I look forward to seeing that number of people in 
 that country within the next ten years. It is a vast inheritance. 
 Let us use it as becomes Canadians — intelligently, liberally, 
 and in the way to advance our country— Canada. Let us use 
 it as it becomes the offspring of the Mother of Nations ! 
 
 END OF PART III. 
 
INDEX 
 
 I 
 
 I 
 
 Adams, George R. 
 
 Dall, VV. H., Obligations to, 240. 
 One of pioneers, 34. 
 Starts for Nulato, 52. 
 Alaska. 
 Coast, absence of terrace deposits, 
 
 287. 
 Commercial Company's steamers, 
 
 398. 
 No icebergs from Dixon's Entrance 
 to Behring Strait, 242. 
 Alaskan traders, route to Yukon 
 
 district, 255. 
 Aleutian Islands, touched at, 240. 
 , Aleuts. 
 
 Bathing customs, 139. 
 Nominal Christians, 88. 
 Promise of ultimate civilization, 115. 
 Aloshka, accompanies Dyer as inter- 
 preter, etc., 74. 
 Arrives at Nulato, 181. 
 Allsek Trail, Gold found on, 419, 
 American ships at St. Michael's, News 
 
 of, 239. 
 Amilka, inhabitant of Ikig.ilik, 27. 
 Builds winter house near Nukkoh, 
 
 167. 
 House at Ulukuk, 36. 
 Ananyan, builds house at Kutlik, 234. 
 Anderson, James, account of Liard 
 
 navigation, 351. 
 Anderson, James, unpublished journals, 
 
 346. 
 Andrea steals dogs, 185. 
 Andreaffsky Fort deserted, 231. 
 Andreaffsky Fort, Tragedy at, 231. 
 Antoshka. 
 Accompanies Dyer to Fort Yukon, 
 
 74- 
 Beaten by Russian, 62. 
 Returns from foraging expedition, 
 
 68. 
 Anvik village, 217. 
 Graves, 218. 
 Natives Ingaliks, 217. 
 
 areek, 217. 
 
 Anvil Mountain, 314. 
 
 Armstrong, Dr. A., on granite rocks, 
 
 274. 
 Arrowsmith, map of Cassiar District 
 
 (1850), 307. 
 Arrowsmith, map of Yukon (1850), 
 
 251- 
 
 Ash deposit. Account of, 276. 
 Atlantic cable, success of, 1 19. 
 Auriferous ground, clue to search for, 
 
 266. 
 Aurora Borealis, 59. 
 Aziak or Sledge Island, 138. 
 
 B. 
 
 " Backfat," 136. 
 
 Bank Swallow on \'ukon, 80. 
 
 Barininsler, H. M., takes R, Kenni- 
 
 cott's body home, 6. 
 Barnard, Lieut. J. J. 
 Arrives at Nulato, 48. 
 Grave, 52. 
 .Murdered, 51. 
 Remark about "sending '' lor chief, 
 
 EITects of, 48. 
 Bean, Edward, organizes prospecting 
 
 party to cross Chilkoot, 377. 
 Bear Creek, Claims on, 405, 417, 418. 
 Bear- Hunting, 133. 
 liear, tracks of black, 211. 
 Beardslee, Captain, establishes amic- 
 able ri'lations with Clulkoots and 
 
 Chilkats, 377. 
 Beaver, habits of, 212. 
 Beaver Lake, 39 ; passed, 169. 
 Bedrock prospecting, 421. 
 Hehm Canal, 279. 
 Bell, Dr. R., on glacier ice movement, 
 
 274. 
 Bell, J., explores Porcupine River, 348. 
 Bell, J., reaches Yukon by Porcupine, 
 
 251. 
 Beluga (white whale), Account of, 
 
 236. 
 Bennett Lake, 254, 366, 368 ; Silver 
 
 ore near, 407. 
 
INDEX 
 
 425 
 
 Berlin Geographical Society, Map of 
 
 Chilkoot Country, 378. 
 Besboro' Island, Water-fowl on, 147. 
 Big Salmon River (D'Abbadie), 356, 
 First discovery of paying placers, 
 
 378- 
 (Jold found on, 358, 379. 
 Material brouglit down by, 268. 
 Birch Canoes, 219, 
 Birch River, loi. 
 Birds (rare) obtained on Lower Yukon, 
 
 229. 
 Birdskin dresses on Lower Yukon, 
 
 225. 
 Black or Turnagain (Muddy) River 
 
 aiscovered, 309. 
 Black, Turnaj^ain, or " Muddy " 
 
 River, Gold in, 304. 
 Blake, W. P., Report on Slikine, 290. 
 Blue River, " Caribou," of Campbell, 
 
 314- 
 Bonanza Creek. 
 
 Claims on branches, 405. 
 Claims, probable yield, 417. 
 Discovery of gold at, 401, 402. 
 Reports from, 410, 411. 
 Value of gold obtai-ied from, 419. 
 Boswell, T., description of Tts-lin-too, 
 
 361. 
 Boulder-clay, where found, 273, 
 Bradfield Canal, 279. 
 Bremen Geographical Society, Dr. A. 
 
 Krause's expedition for, 378. 
 British Columbia. 
 
 Coast, absence of terrace deposits, 
 
 287. 
 Geology of southern part, 263. 
 (Nortliern Part) River System, 249. 
 " Broken Stare" jargon, 106. 
 Buck's Bar, Mining-camp at, 308. 
 Bulegin, Ivan, massacred, 49. 
 Bulkley, Captain Cliarles S., linginecr- 
 
 in-chief of expedition, 6. 
 Burrough's Bay, 279. 
 Butterflies caught, 84. 
 Butterttics, yellow, on Yukon, 230. 
 Byrnes explores llotilinqu River 
 (Tes-lin-too), 252, 360. 
 
 Call' Ri'.AiH, J. C. , en opening of 
 
 navigation on Stikine, 289, 
 Campbell Mountains, 326, ^^j. 
 Campbell, Robert. 
 
 Describes Hudson B.iy Company's 
 
 trail iU Frances Lake, 330. 
 Established Fort Selkirk, 398. 
 Establishes trading-post at Dease 
 Lake, 307. 
 
 Campbell, Robert (etnt.) : 
 Estimate of portage, 247. 
 Explores to Frances and Finlayson 
 
 Lakes, 318. 
 Explores Upper Liard and Yukon , 
 
 346. 
 Explores Yukon River, 251. 
 Journey to Minnesota and London, 
 
 350- 
 
 Meeting Stewart, 349. 
 
 Names Terror Bridge, 307. 
 
 Proves identity of Pelly and Yukon, 
 348. 
 Camping in Yukon Territory, 188. 
 Canadian mining law, 407. 
 Canal, St. Michael's, reached, 119, 
 
 239 ; Straight and Crooked, 11. 
 Caribou Camp, 292, 293. 
 
 Trail to Dease Lake, 294. 
 Caribou Crossing, Ash deposit at, 277. 
 Caribou, where found, 260, 
 Cassiar Bar on Lewes. 
 
 Discovered and worked, 379. 
 
 Rich in gold, 360. 
 Cassiar District 
 
 Climate, 257. 
 
 Destruction of Timber, effects of, 
 381. 
 
 Discovery of, 306. 
 
 Gold yield, 308, 309. 
 
 Gold Yield T.able (1873-87), 301. 
 
 Imperfectly prospected, 305. 
 
 More accessible than Caribou, 297. 
 
 Placer gold-mines, 278. 
 
 Population, 308, 309. 
 Cassiar Range, 250, 309. 
 
 Rocks resemble Ro:ky Mountains, 
 316. 
 Chambcrlin, Professor T. C, examines 
 
 glacier, 271. 
 Chandinaler River, Coal reported on, 
 
 403- 
 Chandindu River (Twelve Mile Creek), 
 
 Claims on, 397. 
 Chandindu River, Coal deposits 
 
 . 387, 397- 
 Chicken Creek abandoned, 413. 
 Chilkat Pass, explored by Dr. 
 
 . K ■ c, 378. 
 Chilkat I'ass used by Indians, 256. 
 Chilkoot Pass. 
 
 Crossed, 248. 
 
 Explored by Dr. A. Krause, 378. 
 
 First crossed by G. Holt, 376. 
 
 (Jeology, 263. 
 
 Impassable for pack-horses, 256. 
 
 Rocks, 373. 
 
 Trail across, 371. 
 
 Vegetation, 374. 
 Cliippewayans, Meaning of word, 108. 
 Christmas festivities, 58. 
 Circassian tobacco, effect of, 81, 224. 
 
 on, 
 
 A. 
 
 ? ■ I i 
 
 h' 
 
426 
 
 INDEX 
 
 IN' 
 
 
 1M 
 
 ui 
 
 Circle City built of Canadian timber, 
 421. 
 
 News of gold fi ids reaching, 415. 
 Claims, Act of Parliament regulating 
 
 length, 416. 
 Clara Bell. 
 
 Arrives at Fort St. Michael's, I2I. 
 
 Expected at St. Michael's, 119. 
 
 Departure from St. Michael's, 122. 
 
 Search for parties left at Grantley 
 Harbour, 120. 
 Clearwater River enters Stikine, 282. 
 Cliff Creek, Coal at, 400. 
 Coal Creek. 
 
 Coal at , 400. 
 
 Coal examined by Wm. Ogilvie, 387. 
 
 Wm. Ogilvie's survey of, 393. 
 Coal-seam, Nulato, examined, 56. 
 Coast, Character of, 20. 
 Coast Ranges, 250. 
 
 Climate, 257, 368. 
 
 Geology, 263. 
 
 Trail over, 370. 
 
 Traversed by Stikine River, 287. 
 Collections sent by Clara Bell, 122, 
 Cone Hill. 
 
 Assays satisfactory, 396. 
 
 Gold quartz found at, 386. 
 
 Wm. Ogilvie's survey, 394. 
 Copper Region, Alaska, 277. 
 Copper, where found, 274. 
 Cormack, G. W., discovers gold on 
 
 Bonanza Creek, 401, 404. 
 Cottonwood Creek on Arrowsmith's 
 
 Map, 311. 
 Cottonwood Creek Valley, geological 
 
 features, 315. 
 Couriers on important occasions, 1 23. 
 Cowley drowned, 109. 
 Crane (Sand-hill) on Lower ^'ukon, 
 
 219. 
 Creeks abandoned, no paying gold, 
 
 304- 
 Creoles, 12 ; Condition of, 241. 
 Crimp, J. K., Gold Commissioner for 
 
 Cassiar District, 301. 
 Cripple Creek, Claims on, 417. 
 Cudahy, no prospect of town at, 386. 
 Cudahy town blocked out, 394. 
 Curlew {Limosa uro/iygialis) eggs found, 
 
 235- 
 
 D. 
 
 D'Abhadik River {see Big Salmon). 
 Dall, W. H. 
 Appointed Director of Scientific 
 
 Corps ; plans, 6. 
 Assists in transporting goods to 
 
 Ulukuk, 35, 37. 
 Dog-leim, 185. 
 
 Dall, W. H. (cont.) : 
 
 Embarks for San Francisco, 240. 
 
 Illness; return to Redoubt, 157. 
 
 Journey to Iktigalik, 33. 
 
 Knowledge of Innuit and Indian 
 dialects, 121. 
 
 Narrow escape on Klat>Kakhatne 
 River, 205. 
 
 On discovery of Stikine River, 289. 
 
 On Kwikhpak, 251. 
 
 Party starts for Fort Yukon, 74. 
 
 Plans, 123. 
 
 Plans to ascend Yukon, 56. 
 
 Prepares to accompany Captain 
 Smith to California, 240. 
 
 Remains at .St. Michael's, 122. 
 
 Work on Alaska (1870), 290. 
 Dall, W. H., and Pupoff give festival, 
 
 154. 
 Dalton, J. 
 
 On gold prospects between Coast 
 Range and Selkirk, 406. 
 
 Trail from Chilkat Inlet to Selkirk, 
 401. 
 
 Trail, Gold prospects on, 419. 
 Dance-house, uses of, 16. 
 Dances (Innuit), 149. 
 Davidson Glacier on I.ynn Canal, 284. 
 Davis Creek, Gold quartz at, 406. 
 Dawson, Dr. 
 
 Graptolites collected by, 316. 
 
 In charge of expedition, 245, 
 
 Party, Members of, 246. 
 
 Report on Yukon Expedition, 245. 
 Dawson, Quartz claims near, 418. 
 Dense Creek. 
 
 Discovered, 308. 
 
 Gold deposits, 299, 302. 
 
 Headquarters of Gold Commission, 
 299. 
 Dease Lake. 
 
 Account of, 299. 
 
 Centre of Cassiar mining district, 
 246, 278. 
 
 Dates of opening imd closing, 299, 
 
 Height of watershed near, 249. 
 
 Humid, 257. 
 
 Placer gold, 297. 
 
 Reiiched, 298. 
 
 Trading-post established and aban- 
 donetl, 307, 346. 
 Dease River. 
 
 Account of, 310. 
 
 Fossils, 317. 
 
 Geological features, 314. 
 
 Good boat-route, 253. 
 
 Length of, 309. 
 Dease River and Liard, confluence, 246. 
 December Mail, 123. 
 December 27th, length of day, 58. 
 Deer becoming scarcer, 147. 
 Deer River {see Klondyke). 
 
INDEX 
 
 427 
 
 Defot Creek discovered, 309. 
 Defot Creek, Gold in, 303. 
 Derabin. 
 
 Rebuilds fort of Nulato, 48. 
 
 Stabbed, 50. 
 
 Traffic-; with natives for furs, 48. 
 Doe killed, 161. 
 Dog driving, 186. 
 Dog harness, 163. 
 Dogs escape, 30. 
 Dogs for Eskimo sleds, 25. 
 Dordogne, dra'vings in caves, 237, 
 Dry fish, 30. 
 Dyer, Quartermaster, 25. 
 
 Plans to investigate Yukon delta, 
 
 56. 
 Sends dogs back, 32, 
 Starts for Fort Yukon, 74. 
 "Telegraph Stew," 36. 
 
 Eagle River, "Christie," of McLeod, 
 
 II. 
 Earn River, tributary of Pelly, 339. 
 Earthquake shock, 118. 
 Egg River, camping on bank, 232. 
 Ekogmut tribe (Prc-morski). 
 
 Graves, 227. 
 
 Habits, 223. 
 El Dorado Creek, Claims on, 415. 
 
 Probable yield, 417, 419. 
 Elephant bones found, 238. 
 Emperor goose breeding at Kusilvak 
 
 Slough, 230. 
 Emperor goose found, 235. 
 Ennis, VV. H., in charge of exploring 
 
 party West of Yukon, 8. 
 Enterprise abandoned, 1 19. 
 Eskimo boots described, 22. 
 Eskimo, derivation of word, 144. 
 Etolin, Creole officer of Russian 
 American Company, 12. 
 
 F. 
 
 Festivals (Innuit), 149. 
 
 Fifteen Mile Creek, Coal found on, 
 
 420. 
 Finlayson Lake. 
 
 Account of, 333. 
 
 Expedition reaches, 332. 
 
 Vegetation on, 334. 
 Finlayson i''ive>- '-'-'d found at mouth, 
 
 Finiayson River, named by Campbell, 
 
 330- 
 Fire-drills, 142. 
 
 First South Fork joins Slikinc, 282. 
 Fish, Scarcity of, 179. 
 Fish-traps described, 172. 
 Fishing village on Lower Yukon, 228. 
 
 Flowers on Yukon, 98, 99. 
 
 Food, Scarcity of, 64, 66. 
 
 '• Ford Mumford " {sec- Telegraph 
 
 Creek). 
 Fort Cudahy. 
 
 Asbestos near, 387. 
 
 Difficulties of winter journey to 
 Ottawa, 403. 
 
 Mail routes to, 397, 
 
 Wm. Ogilvie arrives at, 385. 
 
 \Vm. Ogilvie's work at, 393. 
 Fort Derabin {see Nulato). 
 Fort Dionysius constructed by Russians, 
 
 289. 
 Fort Frances abandoned, 349. 
 Fort Halkett, Campbell leaves to ex- 
 plore Liard, 346. 
 P'ort Malkett, J. McLeod explores near, 
 
 306. 
 Fort Kennicott, founding, 63. 
 Fort Kennicott, orders for repairing, 
 
 124. 
 Fort Liards, 114. 
 Fort Nelson massacre, 113. 
 Fort Ogilvie, portable saw-mill at, 388. 
 Fort Pelly Hanks constructed, 347. 
 Fort Reliance, Copper near, 397. 
 Fort Selkirk. 
 
 Account of, 349. 
 
 Applications for land at, 385. 
 
 Demolislied by local Indians, 350. 
 
 Established, 347. 
 
 Pillaged by Indians, 349. 
 
 Site of, no, 345. 
 
 Site of, confluence of Pelly and 
 Lewes .it, 252. 
 Fort Simpson to Fort Yukon, Posts 
 
 between, 351. 
 Fort Yukon. 
 
 Abandoned, 351. 
 
 Annual trade, 106. 
 
 Arrival at, 102. 
 
 B.iteaux arrive, 105. 
 
 Departure from, 116. 
 
 Described, 103. 
 
 F^st.iblished, 348. 
 
 Fare for men and dogs at, 103. 
 
 Furs in storehouse, 115. 
 
 History of, 102. 
 
 Maintained till 1869, 350. 
 
 Mean annual temperature, 258. 
 
 Preparations for journey to, 72. 
 
 Range of temperature, 105. 
 
 Region to be explored, 6. 
 
 Transport difficulties, 103. 
 
 Tribes represented at, 109. 
 
 United Stales of America, 206. 
 Forty Mile Creek. 
 
 American's experience at ; Marks', 
 422. 
 
 Enters Dease ("Stuart" of McLeod), 
 312. 
 
428 
 
 INDEX 
 
 / 
 
 11 .1 
 
 in 
 
 Forty Mile Creek (cont.) : 
 
 Gold found on, 379, 380. 
 
 Liquor question, 395. 
 
 No prospects of town at, 386. 
 
 Ogilvie, Wni., reaches, 391. 
 
 Ogilvie's, VVm , survey, 394. 
 
 Rush to, 407. 
 
 Snow at, 257. 
 
 Steamers to, 256. 
 Fossil elephant tusk, 134. 
 Fossil molluscs and plants, 267. 
 Fossils, 71 J at Tolstoi I'oint, 135. 
 Fossils found near Nulato, 67. 
 Frances Lake. 
 
 Described, 325. 
 
 Examined and mapped, 247. 
 
 Exjjedition arrives at, 330. 
 
 Fish in, 327. 
 
 Gold placers on, 266, 
 
 Log cache constructed on, 247. 
 
 Named after Lady Simpson, 346. 
 
 Woods round, 328. 
 Frances Lake and River geology, 266. 
 Frances River. 
 • Ascent difficult, 246. 
 
 Course of, 319, 321. 
 
 False Canon, 323. 
 
 Lower Canon, 319 ; Rocks, 320. 
 
 Middle Cafion, 321. 
 
 Passable by large boat, 253. 
 
 Upper Canoii, 323. 
 Frances L. Steele, \V'. 11. Dall leaves 
 
 St. Michael's by, 240. 
 Francis, engineer of Wilder, 25. 
 
 Helps in transporting goods to 
 Ulukuk, 3S, 36. 
 
 Returns to Unalaklik a third time, 
 38. 
 Eraser Lake, trail to Dease Lake, 253. 
 Free traders in Hudson Bay territory, 
 
 105. 
 French Creek, " Detour River,' 313. 
 Furs, Manner of packing, 106. 
 
 G. 
 
 " George S. Wright," ss., anchors at 
 
 Egg Island, 5. 
 Glaciation, 271. 
 Glaciation and placer gold deposits, 
 
 275- 
 Glaciation, Direction of, 273. 
 Glacier Creek, Yukon, Claim i on, 392, 
 402. • 
 Returns poor compared to Klondyke, 
 
 413- 
 GlasunofT first explores Yukon Estuary, 
 
 251. 
 
 •'Glenlyon House;" Fort Frances 
 
 built. 347. 
 Glenlyon Mountains, 339. 
 Glenlyon River, tributary of Telly, 339. 
 
 I Glenora, Account of, 283. 
 Cultivation at, 289. 
 Gold. 
 
 Bar-mining prospects, 381. 
 Discovered m Cassiar region, 290. 
 First discovery ol paying placers on 
 ' Big Salmon River, 378. 
 
 " Gulch <liggings," 380. 
 Mining (1883-S), 378. 
 1 I'lacer deposits, where found, 275. 
 I'lacer mines of Cassiar, 278. 
 Yield, Cassiar District, Table (1873- 
 87), 301. 
 Gold Bottom, Claims on, 417. 
 I Gold Bottom, ore tested, 418. 
 ' GoUlsen, Russian Creole, 160. 
 I Acting as Secretary to Greek 
 i Mission, 227. 
 
 Arrives at Pastolik, 238. 
 Golsona River reached, 129. 
 Goose, first seen, 68. 
 Grantley Harbour. 
 
 Parties embark safely, 121. 
 Telegraph poles erected near, 61. 
 Traders visiting, 200. 
 Graptolites found, 316. 
 Great Bend rounded, 228. 
 "CJreat Canon" on Stikine River, 278. 
 Greek priests, 226. 
 
 H. 
 
 H.M.S. "Enterprise" at St. 
 
 Michael's, 48. 
 Han Kutcliin (Gens de Bois) at Fort 
 
 Yukon, 109. 
 Hardistz, Wm. L., on Kutchin castes, 
 
 196. 
 Hurlequin duck found, 208. 
 Harper. 
 
 Carries supplies by steamer to Hoot- 
 
 ulinqua, 389. 
 Trading post at Sixty Mile, 414. 
 Trading post moved to Forty Mile 
 
 Creek, 248. 
 Haughton, Professor S., on northward 
 
 ice movement, 274. 
 Healey. J., trading post at Taiya Inlet, 
 
 37«- 
 Henderson, Robert, discovers gold in 
 
 Klondyke, 413. 
 Henderson, Robert, prospecting on 
 
 Stewart, 418. 
 Henry, dispute with Indian chief at 
 
 Fort Nelson, 1 12. 
 Henry, Mr. and Mrs., murdered, 113. 
 Hoffmann, G. C, examines coal on 
 
 Lewes, 356. 
 Finds traces of gold at mouth of 
 
 Finlayson, 329. 
 Hohonila, Mount, 85. 
 
INDEX 
 
 429 
 
 Holt, George, first to cross Chilkoot 1 
 to heatl of Lewes, 376. 
 
 Hoole Ca&on, Rocks of, 337. 
 
 Hootalinqua (Teslin). | 
 
 Gold found on, 385, 419. ! 
 
 Numl)er of miners on, 400. j 
 
 Ogilvie, Wm., proposes to survey, 
 
 385- 
 
 Placer mines on, 388. 
 Hootalinqua (see also Teslin). 
 Houle, Antoine, interpreter, at Nuk- 
 lukahyet, 86, 91. 
 
 House at Fort Yukon, 103. 
 
 Sketch of, 106. 
 Hudson Bay Company. 
 
 Cache discovered in ruins, 331, 332. 
 
 Dealings witli Indians, 112. 
 
 Discover Cassiar District, 306. 
 
 Employes at Fort Yukon, 103. 
 
 Enterprise in Yukon basin, 351. 
 
 Forts abandoned by, 114. 
 
 Post established on Stikine, 290. 
 
 Route to Yukon District, 255. 
 
 Servants' hardships, 104. 
 Hudson Bay knives, 105. 
 Hudson Bay sled, 165, 170. 
 Hunker Creek, Claims on, 417. 
 
 Gold found on, 405. 
 Hunter, J., measurements in 1877, 246. 
 Survey of Stikine River, 279, 280. 
 
 I. 
 
 IKiIOALIK. 
 
 Arrival at, 167. 
 
 Best route to Vesolia Sopka, 185. 
 
 Dall, W. H., journey to, 33. 
 
 Described, 26. 
 
 Ingaliks at, 132. 
 
 Stolen dogs found at, 185. 
 In<lian. 
 
 Avarice, examples of, 167. 
 
 Belief in Shamanism, 88. 
 
 Carvings, 214. 
 
 Chiefs, why chosen, 202. 
 
 Children, 68. 
 
 Dances, 198. 
 
 Dialects, 28, 109. 
 
 Grave, 79. 
 
 Life, a struggle with Nature, 200. 
 
 Map of Frances tributaries, 322. 
 
 Pipes, 81. 
 
 Sled of Yukon, 166. 
 Indian Creek, gold found on, 401, 405. 
 Indians. 
 
 Character, ill. 
 
 Habits of, 58. 
 
 Love of singing and tobacco, III. 
 
 Near site of Fort Selkirk, travelling 
 routes, 257. 
 
 Of Western United States, 115. 
 
 On Yukon, 215. 
 
 Painting their faces, 94. 
 
 Indians {lO/ii. ) : 
 
 Sham fits cured, 171. 
 
 Suspicions, illustration of, 61. 
 
 Unused to steady hard work, 100. 
 Ingalik trilie (Nulato), 28. 
 
 Account of, 53. 
 
 Camp, birch canoes made at, 219. 
 
 Character, 193. 
 
 Customs, 196. 
 
 Diseases among, 195. 
 
 Grave, 132. 
 
 Proper names, 202. 
 
 Skull taken from grave, 67. 
 Ingechuk. 
 
 Brings white grouse and reindeer 
 meat, 29. 
 
 Carries note to Ketchum, 34. 
 
 Takes MetrikofTs sons to Ulukuk, 
 174. 
 IngersoU Islands, 353 
 lunuit. 
 
 Bith, 20. 
 
 Casine, diagram of, 127. 
 
 Dialect of delta of Yukon, 28, 227. 
 
 Drawings on bone, 237. 
 
 Graves, 19. 
 
 Ivory carvinijs, 236. 
 
 National dance, 221. 
 
 Potteiy, 218. 
 
 Sleds, 164, 170. 
 
 Trading voyages, 216. 
 Innult of Norton Sound. 
 
 Boats, 137. 
 
 Dances and festivals, 148. 
 
 Disposition, 138. 
 
 Dress, 141. 
 
 Games, 137. 
 
 Graves, 145. 
 
 Habits, 147. 
 
 Infanticide, 139. 
 
 Intercourse with Indians, 144. 
 
 Labrets, 140. 
 
 Map drawing, 142. 
 
 Marriages, 139. 
 
 Mode of life, 136. 
 
 Patron spirits, 145. 
 
 Physique, 137. 
 
 Property, 142. 
 
 Shamanism among, 14.^. 
 
 Tattooing, 140. 
 
 Trading, 143. 
 
 Tribes, 137. . ... 
 
 Weapons, 143. 
 
 Women, 139. 
 International Telegraph, exploration to 
 
 decide on line for, 4. 
 Isaac ill-treated by Russians, 162. 
 Iskoot River, 2S3. 
 Ivanhoff, Gregory, action in Andre- 
 
 affaky tragedy, 231. 
 Ivanovich, Yagor, assistant to Ivan 
 PavlotT, 45. 
 
430 
 
 INDEX 
 
 \i. 
 
 Jacobson, Captain, obtains jade at 
 Yukon mouth, 271. 
 
 Jade, where found, 271. 
 
 Jearny's barrabora, Camping near, 176. 
 
 Johnson, D., assistant in Yukon expedi- 
 tion, 246. 
 
 Jones, Strachan, on Kutchin castes, 
 196. 
 
 Jubilee Mountain, 367. 
 
 K. 
 
 through 
 
 Kaiyuh Indians starved 
 
 scarcity offish, 179. 
 Kaiyuh Mountains, 42. 
 Kaiyuh River, Journey to, 175. 
 Kahag, 41 ; Camping at, 208. 
 " Kaltag Stareek," death, 133. 
 Kamaroflf arrives at Nulato, 181. 
 KamarofF trading at Koynkuk, 182. 
 Kamokin assists Captain Pirn and 
 
 explorers ; barbarity to sick, 162. 
 Karpoff at Nulato, 45. 
 Kaviaks, 137, 138. 
 Kegiklowruk village, 128. 
 
 Casine described, 126. 
 
 Ball, W. H., ill at, 158. 
 
 Departure from, 20. 
 
 Expedition detained at, 16. 
 
 Goods fetched from, 132. 
 
 Seal fishery at, 236. 
 
 Voyage to, 126. 
 Kennicott, Robert, Director of 
 Scientific Corps. 
 
 Body brought home, 6. 
 
 Character: death, 5, 70. 
 
 Explores Yukon, 4. 
 Ketchum, F. E., Captain of Expedition. 
 
 Arrangements for trip up Yukon, 31. 
 
 At Nulato, 43. 
 
 Explores north and east of Nulato, 
 8. 
 
 Journey to Fort Yukon, 63. 
 
 Last visit to Redoubt, 59. 
 
 Plans to ascend Yukon, 56. 
 
 Return to Fort Yukon, 1 10. 
 
 Fends necessaries to repair boat, 18. 
 
 Starts for Fort Selkirk, 85. 
 
 Starts for Nulato, 34. 
 Klat-Kakhatne River, Dall, W. H., 
 narrow escape on, 205. 
 
 Torrent on, 69. 
 Klan-li-lin-tcn, 215. 
 Klondyke River. 
 
 Applications for land near mouth, 
 410. 
 
 Coal on upper part, 413. 
 
 Placer gold on, 404. 
 
 Ogilvie, Wm., account of his dis- 
 cevery of gold on, 413. 
 
 Prospected in 1887, 418. 
 
 Reports from, 412. 
 
 " Kloochman Canon " on Stikine River, 
 
 280. 
 Kluk-tas-si {see Lake Labarge). 
 KogenikofT, Ivan, action in Andre- 
 
 affsky traj^edy, 231. 
 Koliak, Ichuk, brings new bidarra to 
 Unaliiklik, 157. 
 ! Note from ; meeting, 216. 
 I Koloshes, pride of family, 196. 
 I Kotelkakat Village, 53. 
 ' Kotelno River, vdlage on, 53. 
 ' Kotzebue Sound, Traders visiting, 
 200. 
 Winter visit proposed to, 123. 
 Koyukuk Sopka, 77. 
 Koyukun tribe, 48. 
 Accompany W. H. Dall's party, 77. 
 Account of, 53, 54. 
 Customs, 196. 
 Dress, 82. 
 Hostility of, 192. 
 Insolence to Russians, 118. 
 Proper names, 202. 
 Song, translation of, 199. 
 Threaten to burn Nulato, 207. 
 Krause, Dr. A. 
 
 Explores Chilkoot and Chilkat Passes, 
 
 378. 
 Explores Tahk-heena, 365. 
 Map of Chilkoot and Chilkat Passes, 
 
 375- 
 Naminf; rivers, 374. 
 Kurilla, Indian cook. 
 Accompanies W. H. Dall to Fort 
 
 Yukon, 74. 
 Arrives at Unalaklik, 164. 
 Engaged as permanent assistant ; 
 
 starts for Unalaklik, 124. 
 Good shot and sportsman, 57. 
 History of, 55. 
 Kills first goose, 69, 204. 
 Returns to Nulato with goods, 174. 
 Wounded, 179. 
 Kurupanoff defends St. Michael's 
 
 Redoubt, 10. 
 Kushevaroff, Creole officer of Russian 
 
 American Company, 12. 
 Kusilvak Mountain, Vie* of, 232. 
 Kusilvak Slough, Emperor goose 
 
 breeding at, 230. 
 Kutcha Kutchin camp, loi. 
 Kutchin Indians died of scarlet fever, 
 
 100. 
 Kutchin Totems (castes) three, 169. 
 Kutchin tribes, habits, 200. 
 Kutlik, arrived at, 234. 
 Russian house at, 119. 
 Kwikhpak, Russian name for Yukon, 
 
 251. 
 Kwikhtana barrabora (cold house), 
 
 210. 
 Kyaks, 137. 
 
; r 
 
 I 
 
 INDEX 
 
 43' 
 
 L. 
 
 La Pierre's house, Porcupine River, 
 
 ■03. ass- 
 Lake Labarge, 252, 362. 
 
 Conglomerates and sandstones, 268. 
 
 Gluciation, 272. 
 
 Gold found at, 419. 
 Lake Labarge Valley, its climate, 366. 
 Lake Lindeinan, account of, 369. 
 
 Expedition reaches, 352. 
 
 Prospectors at, 377. 
 Lake Marsh (Mud Lake), Account of, 
 
 367-. 
 
 Part of still-water navigation, 368. 
 Lake Nares, " Mdosc Lake," 368, 369. 
 Laketon built, 308 ; reached, 246. 
 Langtry, (ieorge, account of pro- 
 specting for gold, 377. 
 Lapie River, 337. 
 Lapworth, Professor Charles, note on 
 
 graptolites, 316. 
 Larriown. 
 
 Appearance, 52. 
 
 Appears at Nowikakat, 85. 
 
 Meets VV. H. Ball's party, 77. 
 
 Reputation, 53. 
 
 Treats sick man, 89. 
 
 Wounded, Si. 
 Larriown family, conduct of, 192. 
 Larriown, Father, Greek missionary 
 
 at St. Michael's, 226. 
 Leather village, Food at, 220. 
 Lebarge, Michael. 
 
 Arrives at Nulato, 38. 
 
 Explores near Nulato, 8. 
 
 Journey to Fort Yukon, 63. 
 
 Meeting with W. H. Dall at St. 
 Michael's, 240. 
 
 Plans to ascend V'ukon, 56. 
 
 Return to Fort Yukon, 1 10. 
 Leech on First South Fork and Iskoot 
 
 head-waters, 283. 
 Lewes River. 
 
 Ascent of, 248, 352. 
 
 Cassiar Bar rich in gold, 360. 
 
 Confluence with Upper Pelly, 247. 
 
 Course of, 3S3- 
 
 Dates of opening and closing, 370. 
 
 Discovered by R. Campbell, 352. 
 
 Gold found on, 380. 
 
 Part of Yukon, so called, 252. 
 
 Rink Rapid, 353 ; ash deposit, 277. 
 
 Rocks, 354. 
 
 Source of, 252. 
 
 White Horse Rapid and Miles Cation, 
 obstacle to navigation, 365. 
 
 Width, 3S9. 
 Lewes River and Upper Pelly, country 
 
 about confluence, 345. 
 Lewes Valley beyond Lake Labarge, 
 364- 
 
 Lewes Valley, traces of glacier ice, 272. 
 Lewis, L., assistant in Yukon expedi- 
 tion, 246. 
 Liard River. 
 
 Ascent difficult, 246. 
 
 Course of, 249. 
 
 Dates of opening and closing, 314. 
 
 Defined, 318. 
 
 Fort Nelson on, 112. 
 
 Gold placers on, 266. 
 Liard River, Lower, undesirable route, 
 
 T. ^53; 
 
 Liard River, Upper, Account of, 319. 
 
 Geology, 268. 
 
 Passable by larije boats, 253. 
 Liard Valley, Trend of, 320. 
 Liijuor question, 409. 
 " Little Canon," Stikine River, 279, 
 
 280. 
 Little Salmon River, tributary of 
 
 Lewes, 355. 
 Lofka, 
 
 Barrabora, 211. 
 
 Buys accordeon, 37. 
 
 Sent with letter to P.edoubt, 51. 
 Loon-cap village. 
 
 Camping at, 224. 
 
 Graves, 224. 
 
 Inhabitants, 225. 
 " Lower Post," furthest outwork of 
 
 civilization, 314. 
 Lower Yukon {see Yukon, Lower). 
 Lukeen brings news of sale of territory, 
 
 181. 
 Lynn Canal. 
 
 Furs reaching, their value, 262. 
 
 Head of, reached, 248. 
 
 Passes from head of, 256, 25S. 
 
 M. 
 
 McCoNNELi., R. G., assistant in the 
 Yukon Expedition, 245. 
 On Great Glacier Moraine, 285. 
 Survey of 1 .ow er Liuril, 246. 
 Survey of Stikine, 246, 279. 
 McCormack, John, gives particulars of 
 
 Big Salmon, 357, 
 McCormick, John, on geology of S. W. 
 
 of (^uiel Lake, 266. 
 McCulloch (lies on Stikine, 308. 
 
 Discovers gold in Cassiar district, 
 290, 30S. 
 McDame Creek. 
 Gold in, 303, 311. 
 Mountains bordering, 312. 
 Placers discovered, 308. 
 McDonald, Rev., at Fort Yukon, loj. 
 Held services for Indians, no, 
 P 
 
 ill 
 
432 
 
 INDEX 
 
 U 
 
 \ 
 
 I 
 
 McDougal, J. , Commander of garrison 
 at Fort Yukon, 103. 
 
 Letters for, 206. 
 McEvoy, J., assistant in Yukon Ex- 
 
 liedition, 245, 246. 
 McEvoy Lake, 333. 
 McLeod, J. 
 
 Ascends Liard to Simpson Lake, 
 
 346- 
 Discovers Dcase Lake, 306. 
 Explores to Simpson Lake, 318. 
 McLeod, Peter, story of escape from 
 Fort Yukon, 91. 
 McDougal's suggestion about, 1 16. 
 Mackenzie Kiver, 249. 
 Macmillan, branch of Pelly River, 251, 
 
 253- , 
 
 Account of, 340. 
 
 Upi'^r part unexplored, 340. 
 McMurray founds Fort Yukon, 102. 
 Magemuts tribe, south of Yukon 
 
 Mouth, 140. 
 ^^ahlemuts, 
 
 Attempt to steal alcohol, 221. 
 
 Camp, cotton tents, 220. 
 
 Dall, W. IL, interview with, 17. 
 
 Engaged for journey to Unalaklik, 
 125. 
 
 Fest ,al, 152. 
 
 Kind-heartedness, IS9- 
 
 Meeting party of, 216. 
 
 Of Kotzebue Sound, 139. 
 
 Shaman, 144. 
 Major's Cove, 125 ; Camping at, 159. 
 Malakoff, Creole officer of Russian 
 American Company, 12. 
 
 Explored Yukon to Nulato, 48. 
 Mallard's nest found, 83. 
 Mammoth remains, R. Campbell on, 
 
 273- . .„ 
 Manki, Innuit village, 223. 
 
 Maria, at Nulato massacre, 51. 
 
 Death, 68. 
 
 Marks' experience at Forty Mile, 
 
 422. 
 Martha reports arrival of Clara Bell, 
 
 121. 
 Mastodon, or mammoth remains, R. 
 
 Campbell on, 273. 
 Matfaz and family at Kaltag, 208. 
 Matfaz, inhabitant of Iktigalik, 28. 
 
 Reluses use of dogs, 167. 
 Medical supplies deficient, 25. 
 Melozikakat or Clear River, 84. 
 Merriam, Dr. C. H., description of 
 
 new species of moose, 2C0. 
 Metrikoft, death ; fate of sons, 173. 
 Michaelovski Redoubt {se,: St. 
 
 Michael's). 
 Milavanoff, at Greek Mission, St. 
 
 Michael's, 227. 
 Miles Cafion on Lewes, 254, 366. 
 
 Miller Creek, Yukon. 
 Claims on, 392, 402. 
 Output of one claim, 399. 
 Returns poor compared with Klou- 
 
 dyke, 413. 
 Miners' Range, 363. 
 •Miners' route to Yukon District, 255. 
 Mining districts, \\m. Ogilvie on 
 
 extent of, 412. 
 .Missionaries to Indians, iii. 
 Monroe, Charles, prospecting near 
 
 Frances Lake, 329. 
 Moore, Captain \V., explores White 
 
 Pass, 374. 
 Working at Dease Creek, 308. 
 Moose Island, 325. 
 .Moose killing, 99, lOO. 
 Moose, where found, 260. 
 Mosquitoes, 70 ; four kinds, loo. 
 Mount Campbell, Description of, 398. 
 Mountain goat, where found, 259. 
 Muir, John, describes Stikine glaciers, 
 
 283. 
 Munson discovers gold in Klondyke, 
 
 413- 
 Murray, A. IL, establishes Fort Yukon, 
 
 34«- 
 Mushrooms, 123. 
 
 N. 
 
 Natche Kutchin (Gens de Large) at 
 
 Fort Yukon, 109. 
 Native clothing described, 21. 
 Native house described, 13. 
 Natives, 13. 
 
 Natural History specimens, 61, 203. 
 Newberry River (se^ Tes-lin-too). 
 " Nigj^er grass," 420. 
 Ni,i;htingale. 
 
 Arrival in Norton Sound, 3. 
 Rations carried back by, 66. 
 Sails for Plover Bay, 8. 
 Nikolia brothers murdered, 19. 
 Ni-sutlin-hi-ni River, Gold found 
 along, 362. 
 Indian salmon-fishing stations on, 
 362. 
 Nordenskiold River, tributary of 
 
 Lewes, 355. 
 North Pacific, Key to, 242. 
 Norton Sound, Fish in, 148. 
 
 Region boidering to be explored, 6. 
 Notarmi leaves Nulato, 48. 
 Notokakat or Dall River enters Yukon, 
 
 100. 
 Nourse River, west branch of Taiya, 
 374- 
 
INDEX 
 
 433 
 
 Nowikakat. 
 
 Arrival al, 85. 
 
 llarbour-view of Yukon Mountains 
 from, 87. 
 
 Noted for birch canoes, 90. 
 
 Tyone, 86. 
 
 Village and River, 86. 
 Nuklukahyet and Twin Mountains, 93. 
 Nuklukahyet Chief, 57. 
 
 Dress, 94. 
 
 Fishing; lor .salmon, 117. 
 
 Meeting VV. II. Dall's party, 93. 
 Nuklukahyet, Departure from, 96. 
 Nulato. 
 
 Arrivals at, 8, 43, 171, 191. 
 
 Christmas at, 178. 
 
 Crockery broken, 177. 
 
 Departure from, 207. 
 
 Depth of snow at, 257. 
 
 History of, 48. 
 
 Housekeeping at, 177. 
 
 " Hungry " place, 38. 
 
 Inhabitants, 45. 
 
 Party for, 25. 
 
 Party remaining at, 63. 
 
 Return to, 117. 
 Nulato and Fort Kennicott, Telegraph 
 
 poles erected between, 64, 72. 
 Nulato and sea, region between to be 
 
 explored, 6. 
 Nulato Fort described, 45. 
 Nulato Hills, expeditions to, 192. 
 Nulato massacre, history of, 49. 
 Nulato River, 47 ; Ice breaking up on, 
 69, 205. 
 
 O. 
 
 Ogilvie, William. 
 Account of discovery of gold in 
 
 Klondyke, 413. 
 Astronomical work of Yukon Ex- 
 pedition, 246. 
 Familiar with Peace River, 253. 
 Measuring claim, 416. 
 Names White Pass, 374. 
 On extent of mining districts, 412. 
 Photo-stations, 389, 391, 398, 408. 
 Preliminary report and map-sheets, 
 
 248. 
 Report of exploration (1896-7), 385. 
 Rock specimen from Lower Yukon, 
 
 266. 
 Waiting for Arctic, 403. 
 Work of, 399. 
 Ogilvie Valley, 363. 
 Okeeogemuts arrive at St. Michael's, 
 
 121. 
 Ooskon, Sketch of, 80. 
 Orarian tril)es,similarity of customs and I 
 
 those of cave-dwellers, 237. 
 Orchay River, 338. ' 
 
 P 
 
 Orders to remove property to Redoubt, 
 
 118. 
 Ottawa, Expedition leaving, 246. 
 Otter seen, 211. 
 Owls, specimens found, 67. 
 
 P. 
 
 Parhelia ilcscribed, 40. 
 Paspilkoff, assistant at Nulato, 45. 
 
 Cuts Cross in memory of R. Kenni- 
 cott, 70. 
 
 Erects Fort Kennicott, 6r, 63, 68. 
 
 Makes new sled, 182, 
 Pastolik, Eskimo viilaie. 
 
 Keluga, Seal-fishing at, 236. 
 
 Natives kdliiig white whale at, 14. 
 
 Reached, 119, 236. 
 
 Wild fowl in marshes, 238. 
 Pavloff, Ivan, commander of Nulato 
 trading post, 44. 
 
 Accident and rescue, 69. 
 
 Meets W. II. Dall at Nuklukahyet, 
 
 93- 
 Return to Nulato, 172. 
 Return with sable skins, 59. 
 Sketch of, 44. 
 Traps foxes, 57. 
 Type of Creole, 45, 
 Pavloff, Ivan, and party start for Nuk- 
 lukahyet, 206. 
 Peace River at Dunvegan, size of, 253. 
 Peak or Blue Mouniains (Cassiar 
 
 Range), 309. 
 Pease, Charles, takes R. Kennicott's 
 
 body home, 6. 
 Peechka, Russian store described, 9. 
 Peel River, confluence with Mackenzie, 
 
 255- 
 Peetka, cook at Nulato, 52. 
 Pelly Banks Fort abandoned, 349. 
 Pelly Range, 335, 337. 
 Pelly River. 
 
 Detour, 340. 
 
 Difficulties of overland 
 ward.s, 331. 
 
 Expedition reaches, 332. 
 
 First camp on, 334. 
 
 Gold found on, 379, 419. 
 
 Granite Canon, 341. 
 
 Gravel-bed, Gold in, 344. 
 
 Iloole Canon, 335. 
 
 Indications of gold on, 417. 
 
 Navigable for small steamers, 344. 
 
 Part of Yukon, so called, 252. 
 
 Prospecting parties ascend (1882), 
 
 378- 
 Rocks on, 337, 339. 
 Pelly River, Upper. 
 Bank reached, 247. 
 Confluence with Lewes, 252, 341. 
 
 journey to- 
 
434 
 
 INDEX 
 
 "J 
 
 Pelly River, Upper (ro;//.) : 
 
 Descent of, 247. 
 
 Fossil plants, 268. 
 
 Length, 343. 
 
 Rapid on, 247. 
 I'elly (Upper) Valley, traces of glacier 
 
 ice, 272. 
 I'emmican, how made, 136. 
 I'ereleshin, Lieut., ascends Stikine, 
 
 290. 
 I'erivalli, camping at, 169. 
 Petroff, report of value of furs shipped, 
 
 261. 
 Pikmiktalik, Touched at, 239. 
 Pirn, Captain Hedford. 
 
 Frost-bitten, 52. 
 
 In Kaviak Peninsula, 51. 
 Pipes, Indian, 8l. 
 Placer gold {see under Gold). 
 Platinum, where found, 261. 
 Point Romanoff (Cape Shallow Water) 
 
 reached, 1 19. 
 Pope, Major, explores for Collins' 
 
 Telegraph Company, 290. 
 Poplar Creek good tor trapping, 39. 
 Popoff (Unalaklik Vidarshik), 131. 
 Popoft' and W. H. Dall give festival, 
 
 154- 
 Popoft" Glacier, 283. 
 Porcupine River, 102, 255. 
 Explored by J. Bell, 348. 
 Navigation of, 105. 
 Powers, Mike, crossing from Taku to 
 Teslin Lake, 362. 
 
 Quartz Creek, Gold in, 303. 
 
 R. 
 
 Ramparts on Yukon River, 97. 
 
 Fine view of, 100. 
 Rapid River Valley, 312; Plants found 
 
 in, 313- 
 
 Rapids of Yukon, 97, 117. 
 
 Rasbinik Village, 229. 
 
 Raymond, Captain Charles W., obser- 
 vations o! 141st Meridian, 350. 
 
 Red I.eggins, intelligence and influ- 
 ence, no. 
 
 Reed at Dease Lake, 332. 
 
 Reid, Robert, dates of opening and 
 closing Lake Dease, 299. 
 
 Reindeer fawns hunted by women, 148. 
 
 Reindeer, habits of, 29. 
 
 Report of Progress of Geological Survey 
 for 1886-7 ; notes on gold, 301. 
 
 Reports on Medical Depiirtment and 
 Scientific Corps, 122. 
 
 Richardson, Sir J. 
 
 Honolulu paper reaching, 352. 
 
 On Laurentian boulders, 275. 
 
 On tibia of Elsphas primigenius, 
 
 273- 
 Particulars of Liard River, 319. 
 Richtofen Valley, 363 
 Riedell, Captain of Constantiiie, 240. 
 Rocky Mountains, minerals found near, 
 
 420. 
 Romantzolf Mountains, loi. 
 Ross, Bernard R., on Eastern Tinneh 
 
 Indians, 112. 
 Ross, branch of Pelly River, 253. 
 
 Named by Campbell, 336. 
 Rousseau, General, arrival at Sitka, 
 
 184. 
 Rubber blankets, 76. 
 Rusanoff, S. S. {see Stepanofl', S. R.). 
 Russian American Company. 
 Not retaliating fcr Nulato massacre, 
 
 52- 
 
 Workmen, 11. 
 
 Wound up, 181. 
 Russian bath described, 31. 
 Russian mail route from St. Michael's, 
 
 4- 
 Russian peasants' ingenuity, 62. 
 Russian plans for return from Nulato, 
 
 192. 
 Russian led, 166, 170. 
 Russian treatment of natives, 161 ; 
 
 effect of, 231. 
 Russian v. American travelling, 182. 
 
 St. Elias Alps, 250. 
 
 St. George's Island touched at, 240. 
 
 St. Michael Island composed of basaltic 
 
 lava, 33. 
 St. Michael's Mission, Arrival at, 226 
 St. Michael's Redoubt. 
 
 Arrival at, 184, 239. 
 
 Dall, W. H., takes survey of, 9. 
 
 Described, 9. 
 
 Expedition lands at, 7. 
 
 Expedition leaves, 15. 
 
 Inmates, three classes, 11. 
 
 Journey to, 182. 
 
 Observations at, 6. 
 
 Reached on foot, 160. 
 
 Return to, 119. 
 
 Vessel taking liquor to, 239. 
 S.ikhniti, chief of Kutclia llutchin, 102, 
 107. 
 
 Character, 1 1 1 . 
 Salmon fishing, 147. 
 Salmon trout at Ulukuk, 36. 
 
INDEX 
 
 435 
 
 San Francisco. 
 
 Arrival at, 242. 
 
 Voyage to, 240. 
 Sayyea Creek, (iokl in, 304, 320. 
 Scarnmon, captain of Nii^htingale, 3. 
 Scarlet fever among Indians, 100. 
 Schwatka, Lieut., crosses Chilkoot and 
 descends Yukon to sea, 378. 
 
 Survey of Lewes, 353. 
 Scidmore, Mrs., on date of G. Holt's 
 
 crossing Cliilkoot, 377. 
 Scratchett. 
 
 Hard journey from L'nalaklik, 69. 
 
 Obtains reindeer meat, 66. 
 
 Remains at Kulato, 72. 
 
 Rescues Ivan Pavloff, 69. 
 
 Return brig.ide entrusted to, 57. 
 
 Sent to Kaltag with fish, 65. 
 Scud River, 282. 
 Seal fishing, 148. 
 Seal huntmg, 1 8. 
 Seasons in Yukon Territory, 200. 
 Seniinon Mountains, 357 ; rocks, 360. 
 Shabounin attacks Tekunka, 204. 
 Shageluk Ingaliks, Rumours of invasion 
 
 by, 161. 
 Shageluk, Leather village on, 220. 
 Shaman Mountains, 43. 
 Shamanism, belief in, 88. 
 Sheep camp on Chilkoot Pass, 371. 
 Shooting expeditions in canal, 125. 
 Shot, \V. II. Dall makes, 203. 
 Shuswap Lake, Rocks of, 315. 
 Simpson Lake, 318, 322. 
 Simpson Mountains, 323, 333. 
 Simpson, Sir George. 
 
 Commissions R. Campbell to explore 
 Liard, 346. 
 
 Leases coast strip of Russian 
 America, 308. 
 Simpson's Tower, 325. 
 Sitka, No polar bears near, 242. 
 Sixty Mile River. 
 
 Gold found on, 392. 
 
 Harper's trading post at, 414. 
 
 Placer diggings at, 387. 
 Skin boats, three kinds, described, 15. 
 Skree Range, 311. 
 Sled (Eskimo) described, 25. 
 Sled runner broken and repaired, 185. 
 Small Houses, Game and fish plentiful 
 
 at, 100. 
 Smith, Captain Everett, of the Wilder, 
 8,60. 
 
 Enthusiastic sportsman, 24. 
 Smith, captain of Frances L. Steele, 
 
 at St Michael's, 240. 
 Smith, Lieul. F. M., acting surgeon for 
 
 Unalaklik party, 25. 
 Snares for grouse and rabbits, 178. 
 Snow Creek, Gold in, 303. 
 Snow goggles, 195. 
 
 Snowshoes, different kinds, 190. 
 Spring, Signs of, 66. 
 Starry Kwikhpak village, 229. 
 Steel, R. , account of finding gold, 377. 
 Stejianofi", S. Rusanoff, commands 
 trading-posts in district of St. 
 Michael, II, 122. 
 
 Character, 12. 
 Stewart River, 251, 252. 
 
 Gold found on. 379, 417, 419. 
 
 Navigable, 255. 
 
 Prospecting on, 406. 
 
 \Vhom named after, 348 n. 
 Stikine Indians expert on river, 280. 
 Stikine River. 
 
 Course of, 249. 
 
 Discovery of, 289. 
 
 Gold found on, 296, 301. 
 
 Mouth of, mean annual temperature, 
 258. 
 
 Navigable for steamers, 253. 
 
 Opening of navig.ition, 289. 
 
 Placer gold discovered on bars, 290. 
 
 Sketch of. 278. 
 
 Terrace deposits at mouth, 287. 
 Stikine Valley. 
 
 fiasalt-fiows in, 270. 
 
 Climate of coast and inland, 287. 
 
 Geology, 285, 
 
 Glaciers, 283. 
 
 Placer gold deposits, 286. 
 
 Railway not difficult to construct, 
 298. 
 
 Rainfall, 287. 
 
 Survey, 298. 
 
 Trend of, 279. 
 
 Vegetation in May, 288. 
 " Stone house" on Chilkoot Pass, 373. 
 Stuart Island, 33. 
 Sugar scarce ; mode of using, 79. 
 Sukaree, 75. 
 Swans at Nulato, 69. 
 Swans on Yukon, 213. 
 Swanson, Frank, discovers gold in 
 
 Klondyke, 413. 
 Sylvester's landing at mouth of 
 
 McDame Creek, 311. 
 Sylvester's trail to Turnagain or Black 
 River, 312. 
 
 Tagish Lake, connected with Lake 
 Marsh, 254, 367, 368. 
 Tako and Windy Arms, 374. 
 Tahk-heena River, confluence with 
 
 Lewes, 364. 
 Tahl-tan River. Account of, 291. 
 Gold-mining formerly at, 292. 
 
436 
 
 INDEX 
 
 Tahl-tan Valley, gold worked formerly, 
 
 296. 
 Taiya Inlet, Reports of second pass 
 
 from, 374. 
 Tako Lake (see Tagish). 
 Tuku River, 249, 254. 
 Tananah Indians arriving at Fort 
 
 Yukon, 107. 
 1 ananah River junction with Yukon, 93. 
 Tanzilla, or Third North I'ork. 
 Old river channel, 295. 
 Terrace deposits, 295. 
 Valley, 293. 
 Tarentoff, convict, and Major Kcnni- 
 
 cott, 70. 
 Teal, green-winged, shot on Yukon, 
 
 209. 
 Tebcnkoff Cove, II. 
 Tebcnkoff, Michael, establishes trading 
 
 post at St. Michael's, 9. 
 Tekunka Shaman among Kaiyuh 
 Indians, 66. 
 Announces festival, 167. 
 Attacked by Shabounin, 204. 
 Festival on Kaiyuh River, 175. 
 Telegraph Creek. 
 Cultivation at, 289. 
 Crops grown near, 258. 
 Dawson arrives at, 246. 
 Origin of name, 283. 
 Origin of rocks near, 295. 
 Pack trail from, 278. 
 Rich prospects in country round, 
 
 417- 
 Rocks near, 286. 
 
 Trail to Dease Lake, country 
 traversed by, 291. 
 Telegraph Creek and Dease Lake, 
 waggon road easily constructed, 
 297. 
 " Telegraph Stew," 29. 
 Teluzhik, Russian interpreter, on 
 Shageluk, 29, 51, 221. 
 Passes through Kutlik to Pastolik, 
 
 235- 
 Tenan Kutchin (Gens des Buttes), 
 
 Account of, 108. 
 
 Method of dressing hair, 108. 
 Tern (river), common on Yukon, 92. 
 Teslin Lake, largest known to Indians, 
 
 362. 
 Tes-liii-too River. 
 
 Confluence with Lewes, 359. 
 
 Course of, 361. 
 
 Gold found on, 362, 379, 380. 
 
 Thought to be the Hotalinqu, 377. 
 Tes-lin-too Valley, 360. 
 Theatricals, Impromptu, 35. 
 Thibert Creek, Gold in, 302. 
 Thiberl, Henry, discovers gold in 
 
 Ciissiar district, 290, 308. 
 Thomas River, 327. 
 
 Tikhmenief, historian of Russian 
 American Company, 48. 
 On attack on St. .Michael's Redoubt, 
 9- 
 
 Timber for Iwats, where obtainable, 
 371- 
 
 Tinneh, Eastern, women and children, 
 202. 
 
 Tinneh, Tribes belonging to family of, 
 109. 
 
 Tinneh, Western, Account of, I93seq<i. 
 
 Tohonidoia, dress descrilied, 82. 
 
 Tolstoi Point, ^^ ; Geological observa- 
 tions at, 135. 
 
 Ton-dac Creek, Copper deposit at, 387. 
 
 Tootsho Range, 250, 332 ; Composi- 
 tion of, 329. 
 
 Tooya, or Second North Fork, 292. 
 Reached by McLeod, 307. 
 
 Tooya Valley, 292, 293. 
 
 Topanika, beach at, io. 
 Dall, W. H., lands at, 129. 
 
 Totems (castes), account of, 196. 
 
 Tozikakat River, bar at mouth, 92. 
 
 Trading at Nowikakat, 86. 
 
 Trading companies in Yukon Terri- 
 tory, conduct of, 240. 
 I Travelling, examples of diflFiculties, 
 128, 168. 
 
 Tummel River, tributary of Peliy, 339. 
 
 Tundra, prairie*Iike plain, 39. 
 
 Tutchone Kutchin (Gens de Foux) at 
 Fo't Yukon, 109. 
 
 Tyone of Koyukuk, 49. 
 
 U. 
 
 Ui-UKUK, branch of Unalaklik River, 
 
 30, 36, 39- 
 Ulukuk Hills, larch and alders on, 29. 
 Ulukuk Indians back out of engage- 
 ment, 63. 
 Ulukuk village, 32. 
 
 Camping at, 168. 
 
 Departure from, 38. 
 
 Described, 36. 
 
 Journey to, 35. 
 
 Journey to bring remaining goods, 
 171. 
 
 Start for, 166. 
 
 Trip to, 139. 
 Unakatana Indians, 53. 
 Unalaklik Fort described, 23. 
 Unalaklik River, bar at mouth, 32. 
 
 Crossing, 130. 
 L^nalaklik village. 
 
 Arrival at, 21, 131. 
 
 Beach and village described, 24. 
 
 Dall, W. H., return to, 135. 
 
 Deaths in village, 162. 
 
 Journey to, 15. 
 
INDEX 
 
 437 
 
 Unalaklik village {cont. ) : 
 
 I'arties attacked by scurvy, 69. 
 
 ['reparations for trip to, 8, 124. 
 
 Return for missing dogs, 31. 
 
 Return journey to, 34, 160. 
 
 Start for, 125. 
 
 Telegraph poles erected near, 61. 
 Unalitjmuis attack St. Michael's 
 
 Redoubt, 9. 
 United States Coast Survey Map, 252. 
 United States negotiating for purchase 
 
 of Russian America, 1 19. 
 Uphoon. 
 
 Arrival at mouth, 233. 
 
 Birds found on, 233. 
 
 Northern mouth of Yukon reached, 
 119. 
 Upper Telly («« Pelly, Upper). 
 
 V. 
 
 Vesolia Sopka, cheerful mountain, 37, 
 
 39- 
 Camping near, 169, 185. 
 Villages on Upper and Lower Yukon, 
 
 Difference between, 224. 
 Vunta Kutchin or Rat-Indians at Fort 
 
 Yukon, 109. 
 
 W. 
 
 Walrus unknown in Norton Sound, 
 
 •34- 
 Ward buried by McDonald, 1 10. 
 Water-fowl at Nulato, 69. 
 Water-fowl breeding on Uesboro' 
 
 Island, 147. 
 Watson Valley, 367. 
 Westdahl, astronomer of expedition, 
 
 14- 
 Accident to boat, 18. 
 Western Union Telegraph explorers 
 
 ascend Pelly, 352. 
 White, C, describes graptolitcs, 317. 
 White Horse Rapid on Lewes River, 
 
 364- 
 White, Jim, " Three-Inch White,"4i6. 
 White I'ass, near Lake Lindeman, 
 256, 370. 
 Account of, 374. 
 White River, 251, 252. 
 
 Copper found on, 397, 406, 420. 
 Gold found on, 380. 
 Swift, 255. 
 Whiteares, J. F., submits graptolites to 
 
 Professor Lapworth, 316. 
 Whymper, I''., artist of expedition, 8. 
 At Nulato, 43 
 
 Earliest mention of gold found on 
 Yukon, 375. 
 
 I Whymper, F. (cont.): 
 
 Plans to ascend Yukon with W. II. 
 Dall, 56. 
 ] Starts fur Fort Yukon, 74. 
 I Wild fowl on Lower Yukon, 229. 
 Wild rose found on Yukon, 80. 
 Il'ilder, small steamer, 7. 
 
 Departure for Unalaklik, 8. 
 Williams frozen to death on Chilkoot 
 
 Pass, 379. 
 Willis, Uailley, examii:es glacier, 271. 
 : Winter supplies purchased, 135. 
 I Wola^atux barrabora, trip to, 64. 
 Wolasatux escapes massacre, 50. 
 Wolasatux, illness of family, 171. 
 " Wood Indians " met by R. Camp- 
 bell, 347. 
 Wrangell, Baron, orders establishment 
 of trading post at St. Michael's, 9. 
 Wrangell, at mouth of Stikine River, 
 liritish flag hoisted at, 290. 
 Expedition reaches, 246. 
 Mean annual temperature, 258. 
 Wrangell, Mount, 277. 
 
 Argdlltes at, 264, 285. 
 Wright, G. B., information on gold, 
 
 . 301- 
 Wright, Major George M., Adjutant of 
 Expedition, 122. 
 
 Yagorsha (Yakut). 
 
 Arrives at Nulato with skin boat, 64. 
 
 At Nulato, 45. 
 
 Greets W. H. Dall on return to 
 Nulato, 117. 
 Yakuto, 12. 
 Yakutz-Kalatenik 
 
 mouth, 211. 
 Yaska, interpreter, at Andreaffsky, 229. 
 Veto (Sidorka), accompanies W. II. 
 
 Dall, 209. 
 Yukon District. 
 
 Abuses prevalent in, 241. 
 
 Agricultural possibilities of, 259. 
 
 Alluvial soil. Formation of. 71. 
 
 Area, 245, 261. 
 
 Bouniiaries, 245. 
 
 Boundary determined by Wm. 
 Ogilvie, 389. 
 
 Characteristics, 249. 
 
 Climate in N.W. and E., 263. 
 
 Cost of transport, 396. 
 
 Difficulties of prcispecting, 420. 
 
 Entry by Chilkoot Pass and Lewes, 
 
 371- 
 Fauna, 259. 
 Fish in, 260. 
 First telegraph pole, 59. 
 Furs taken by different routes from, 
 
 261. 
 
 River, house at 
 
i 
 
 438 
 
 INDEX 
 
 Yukon District {cont.): 
 
 Geology of interior region, 265. 
 Gold-bearing belt, 406. 
 Gold found in 1887, 261. 
 Headquarters, 61. 
 Interior plateau glacier, 271. 
 Legislation (special) necessary, 241. 
 Mail routes to Fort Cudaliy, 397. 
 Miners enter by Chiikoot (1882), 
 
 378. 
 
 Mining expert's opinion of, 397. 
 
 Police ji'.iisdiction, 389. 
 
 Possibilities of, 423. 
 
 Resources of, 262. 
 
 River system, 249. 
 
 Rivers principal routes of travel, 253. 
 
 Seasons in, 200. 
 
 Sold to United States, i8i. 
 
 Suitable railway routes, 254. 
 
 Temperature, 390. 
 
 Three routes of access, 255. 
 
 Timber, 395. 
 
 Trade returns, time taken for, 352. 
 
 White spruce abundant, 259. 
 
 Winds, summer and winter, 258. 
 
 Winter climate in north, 261. 
 Yukon Expedition. 
 
 Distance travelled, 248. 
 
 Purpose of, 245. 
 
 Sails, 4. 
 Yukon Indians. 
 
 Dances, 95. 
 
 Graves, 95. 
 
 Ornaments, 95. 
 Yukon River. 
 
 Hanks, Vegetation on, 209. 
 
 Haiter on, 78. 
 
 branches of, 249. 
 
 Hroad at mouth, 85. 
 
 Different names given to parts of, 
 252. 
 
 Distance navigable, 254. 
 
 Earliest mention of gold found on, 
 375- 
 
 Yukon River (cont.): 
 
 Estuary, fr st exploration, 251. 
 
 First glimpse of, 41. 
 
 Fish found in, 180. 
 
 Ice breaking up en, 72. 
 
 Identical with Colville or Kwikhpak, 
 
 4- 
 
 Indian fishing-camps on, 118. 
 
 Journey down, 1 16. 
 
 Lateness of season, 208. 
 
 Mouth, Preparations for journey to, 
 203. 
 
 Plain north of, loi. 
 
 Seal (leopard) in, 118. 
 
 Source of intereslini^ inquiry, 252. 
 
 Steamers suitable for, 396. 
 
 Trees growing near, 77. 
 
 White whale (beluga) in, 119. 
 
 Width, depth and velocity, 253. 
 Yukon River, Lower, Breadth of, 226. 
 Yukon River, Lower district, decrease 
 
 in populiition, 224. 
 Yukon River, Upper. 
 
 Ash deposit, 275. 
 
 Auriferous deposits, 275, 
 
 Rivers draining basin, 254. 
 Yukon River [see also Lewes and 
 
 Pelly). 
 Yukon, Upper District. 
 
 Frozen ground in, 3S1. 
 
 Gold discoveries in, 379, 
 
 Hardships to be overcome by miners, 
 381. 
 
 Number of miners in, 380. 
 Yukon Valley, Coal in, 400. 
 Yukutzcharkat (Wliymper) River, 90. 
 Yunean, 385, 389. 
 
 Z. 
 
 Zacoskin, Lieut. 
 At Nulato, 48. 
 I'"ables about deer, 148. 
 Map of Yukon, 251. 
 
 n 
 
 rRINTKD BY CILDEKT AND RIVINGTON, LTD,, SI. JOHN'S HOUSK, CLKKKRNWBI.I., LONDON, E.C. 
 
ii 
 
 53^^<^